xref: /dragonfly/contrib/gcc-4.7/gcc/doc/invoke.texi (revision 335b9e93)
1@c Copyright (C) 1988, 1989, 1992, 1993, 1994, 1995, 1996, 1997, 1998, 1999,
2@c 2000, 2001, 2002, 2003, 2004, 2005, 2006, 2007, 2008, 2009, 2010, 2011, 2012
3@c Free Software Foundation, Inc.
4@c This is part of the GCC manual.
5@c For copying conditions, see the file gcc.texi.
6
7@ignore
8@c man begin INCLUDE
9@include gcc-vers.texi
10@c man end
11
12@c man begin COPYRIGHT
13Copyright @copyright{} 1988, 1989, 1992, 1993, 1994, 1995, 1996, 1997, 1998,
141999, 2000, 2001, 2002, 2003, 2004, 2005, 2006, 2007, 2008, 2009, 2010, 2011,
152012
16Free Software Foundation, Inc.
17
18Permission is granted to copy, distribute and/or modify this document
19under the terms of the GNU Free Documentation License, Version 1.3 or
20any later version published by the Free Software Foundation; with the
21Invariant Sections being ``GNU General Public License'' and ``Funding
22Free Software'', the Front-Cover texts being (a) (see below), and with
23the Back-Cover Texts being (b) (see below).  A copy of the license is
24included in the gfdl(7) man page.
25
26(a) The FSF's Front-Cover Text is:
27
28     A GNU Manual
29
30(b) The FSF's Back-Cover Text is:
31
32     You have freedom to copy and modify this GNU Manual, like GNU
33     software.  Copies published by the Free Software Foundation raise
34     funds for GNU development.
35@c man end
36@c Set file name and title for the man page.
37@setfilename gcc
38@settitle GNU project C and C++ compiler
39@c man begin SYNOPSIS
40gcc [@option{-c}|@option{-S}|@option{-E}] [@option{-std=}@var{standard}]
41    [@option{-g}] [@option{-pg}] [@option{-O}@var{level}]
42    [@option{-W}@var{warn}@dots{}] [@option{-pedantic}]
43    [@option{-I}@var{dir}@dots{}] [@option{-L}@var{dir}@dots{}]
44    [@option{-D}@var{macro}[=@var{defn}]@dots{}] [@option{-U}@var{macro}]
45    [@option{-f}@var{option}@dots{}] [@option{-m}@var{machine-option}@dots{}]
46    [@option{-o} @var{outfile}] [@@@var{file}] @var{infile}@dots{}
47
48Only the most useful options are listed here; see below for the
49remainder.  @samp{g++} accepts mostly the same options as @samp{gcc}.
50@c man end
51@c man begin SEEALSO
52gpl(7), gfdl(7), fsf-funding(7),
53cpp(1), gcov(1), as(1), ld(1), gdb(1), adb(1), dbx(1), sdb(1)
54and the Info entries for @file{gcc}, @file{cpp}, @file{as},
55@file{ld}, @file{binutils} and @file{gdb}.
56@c man end
57@c man begin BUGS
58For instructions on reporting bugs, see
59@w{@value{BUGURL}}.
60@c man end
61@c man begin AUTHOR
62See the Info entry for @command{gcc}, or
63@w{@uref{http://gcc.gnu.org/onlinedocs/gcc/Contributors.html}},
64for contributors to GCC@.
65@c man end
66@end ignore
67
68@node Invoking GCC
69@chapter GCC Command Options
70@cindex GCC command options
71@cindex command options
72@cindex options, GCC command
73
74@c man begin DESCRIPTION
75When you invoke GCC, it normally does preprocessing, compilation,
76assembly and linking.  The ``overall options'' allow you to stop this
77process at an intermediate stage.  For example, the @option{-c} option
78says not to run the linker.  Then the output consists of object files
79output by the assembler.
80
81Other options are passed on to one stage of processing.  Some options
82control the preprocessor and others the compiler itself.  Yet other
83options control the assembler and linker; most of these are not
84documented here, since you rarely need to use any of them.
85
86@cindex C compilation options
87Most of the command-line options that you can use with GCC are useful
88for C programs; when an option is only useful with another language
89(usually C++), the explanation says so explicitly.  If the description
90for a particular option does not mention a source language, you can use
91that option with all supported languages.
92
93@cindex C++ compilation options
94@xref{Invoking G++,,Compiling C++ Programs}, for a summary of special
95options for compiling C++ programs.
96
97@cindex grouping options
98@cindex options, grouping
99The @command{gcc} program accepts options and file names as operands.  Many
100options have multi-letter names; therefore multiple single-letter options
101may @emph{not} be grouped: @option{-dv} is very different from @w{@samp{-d
102-v}}.
103
104@cindex order of options
105@cindex options, order
106You can mix options and other arguments.  For the most part, the order
107you use doesn't matter.  Order does matter when you use several
108options of the same kind; for example, if you specify @option{-L} more
109than once, the directories are searched in the order specified.  Also,
110the placement of the @option{-l} option is significant.
111
112Many options have long names starting with @samp{-f} or with
113@samp{-W}---for example,
114@option{-fmove-loop-invariants}, @option{-Wformat} and so on.  Most of
115these have both positive and negative forms; the negative form of
116@option{-ffoo} would be @option{-fno-foo}.  This manual documents
117only one of these two forms, whichever one is not the default.
118
119@c man end
120
121@xref{Option Index}, for an index to GCC's options.
122
123@menu
124* Option Summary::      Brief list of all options, without explanations.
125* Overall Options::     Controlling the kind of output:
126                        an executable, object files, assembler files,
127                        or preprocessed source.
128* Invoking G++::        Compiling C++ programs.
129* C Dialect Options::   Controlling the variant of C language compiled.
130* C++ Dialect Options:: Variations on C++.
131* Objective-C and Objective-C++ Dialect Options:: Variations on Objective-C
132                        and Objective-C++.
133* Language Independent Options:: Controlling how diagnostics should be
134                        formatted.
135* Warning Options::     How picky should the compiler be?
136* Debugging Options::   Symbol tables, measurements, and debugging dumps.
137* Optimize Options::    How much optimization?
138* Preprocessor Options:: Controlling header files and macro definitions.
139                         Also, getting dependency information for Make.
140* Assembler Options::   Passing options to the assembler.
141* Link Options::        Specifying libraries and so on.
142* Directory Options::   Where to find header files and libraries.
143                        Where to find the compiler executable files.
144* Spec Files::          How to pass switches to sub-processes.
145* Target Options::      Running a cross-compiler, or an old version of GCC.
146* Submodel Options::    Specifying minor hardware or convention variations,
147                        such as 68010 vs 68020.
148* Code Gen Options::    Specifying conventions for function calls, data layout
149                        and register usage.
150* Environment Variables:: Env vars that affect GCC.
151* Precompiled Headers:: Compiling a header once, and using it many times.
152@end menu
153
154@c man begin OPTIONS
155
156@node Option Summary
157@section Option Summary
158
159Here is a summary of all the options, grouped by type.  Explanations are
160in the following sections.
161
162@table @emph
163@item Overall Options
164@xref{Overall Options,,Options Controlling the Kind of Output}.
165@gccoptlist{-c  -S  -E  -o @var{file}  -no-canonical-prefixes  @gol
166-pipe  -pass-exit-codes  @gol
167-x @var{language}  -v  -###  --help@r{[}=@var{class}@r{[},@dots{}@r{]]}  --target-help  @gol
168--version -wrapper @@@var{file} -fplugin=@var{file} -fplugin-arg-@var{name}=@var{arg}  @gol
169-fdump-ada-spec@r{[}-slim@r{]} -fdump-go-spec=@var{file}}
170
171@item C Language Options
172@xref{C Dialect Options,,Options Controlling C Dialect}.
173@gccoptlist{-ansi  -std=@var{standard}  -fgnu89-inline @gol
174-aux-info @var{filename} -fallow-parameterless-variadic-functions @gol
175-fno-asm  -fno-builtin  -fno-builtin-@var{function} @gol
176-fhosted  -ffreestanding -fopenmp -fms-extensions -fplan9-extensions @gol
177-trigraphs  -no-integrated-cpp  -traditional  -traditional-cpp @gol
178-fallow-single-precision  -fcond-mismatch -flax-vector-conversions @gol
179-fsigned-bitfields  -fsigned-char @gol
180-funsigned-bitfields  -funsigned-char}
181
182@item C++ Language Options
183@xref{C++ Dialect Options,,Options Controlling C++ Dialect}.
184@gccoptlist{-fabi-version=@var{n}  -fno-access-control  -fcheck-new @gol
185-fconserve-space  -fconstexpr-depth=@var{n}  -ffriend-injection @gol
186-fno-elide-constructors @gol
187-fno-enforce-eh-specs @gol
188-ffor-scope  -fno-for-scope  -fno-gnu-keywords @gol
189-fno-implicit-templates @gol
190-fno-implicit-inline-templates @gol
191-fno-implement-inlines  -fms-extensions @gol
192-fno-nonansi-builtins  -fnothrow-opt  -fno-operator-names @gol
193-fno-optional-diags  -fpermissive @gol
194-fno-pretty-templates @gol
195-frepo  -fno-rtti  -fstats  -ftemplate-depth=@var{n} @gol
196-fno-threadsafe-statics -fuse-cxa-atexit  -fno-weak  -nostdinc++ @gol
197-fno-default-inline  -fvisibility-inlines-hidden @gol
198-fvisibility-ms-compat @gol
199-Wabi  -Wconversion-null  -Wctor-dtor-privacy @gol
200-Wdelete-non-virtual-dtor -Wnarrowing -Wnoexcept @gol
201-Wnon-virtual-dtor  -Wreorder @gol
202-Weffc++  -Wstrict-null-sentinel @gol
203-Wno-non-template-friend  -Wold-style-cast @gol
204-Woverloaded-virtual  -Wno-pmf-conversions @gol
205-Wsign-promo}
206
207@item Objective-C and Objective-C++ Language Options
208@xref{Objective-C and Objective-C++ Dialect Options,,Options Controlling
209Objective-C and Objective-C++ Dialects}.
210@gccoptlist{-fconstant-string-class=@var{class-name} @gol
211-fgnu-runtime  -fnext-runtime @gol
212-fno-nil-receivers @gol
213-fobjc-abi-version=@var{n} @gol
214-fobjc-call-cxx-cdtors @gol
215-fobjc-direct-dispatch @gol
216-fobjc-exceptions @gol
217-fobjc-gc @gol
218-fobjc-nilcheck @gol
219-fobjc-std=objc1 @gol
220-freplace-objc-classes @gol
221-fzero-link @gol
222-gen-decls @gol
223-Wassign-intercept @gol
224-Wno-protocol  -Wselector @gol
225-Wstrict-selector-match @gol
226-Wundeclared-selector}
227
228@item Language Independent Options
229@xref{Language Independent Options,,Options to Control Diagnostic Messages Formatting}.
230@gccoptlist{-fmessage-length=@var{n}  @gol
231-fdiagnostics-show-location=@r{[}once@r{|}every-line@r{]}  @gol
232-fno-diagnostics-show-option}
233
234@item Warning Options
235@xref{Warning Options,,Options to Request or Suppress Warnings}.
236@gccoptlist{-fsyntax-only  -fmax-errors=@var{n}  -pedantic @gol
237-pedantic-errors @gol
238-w  -Wextra  -Wall  -Waddress  -Waggregate-return  -Warray-bounds @gol
239-Wno-attributes -Wno-builtin-macro-redefined @gol
240-Wc++-compat -Wc++11-compat -Wcast-align  -Wcast-qual  @gol
241-Wchar-subscripts -Wclobbered  -Wcomment @gol
242-Wconversion  -Wcoverage-mismatch  -Wno-cpp  -Wno-deprecated  @gol
243-Wno-deprecated-declarations -Wdisabled-optimization  @gol
244-Wno-div-by-zero -Wdouble-promotion -Wempty-body  -Wenum-compare @gol
245-Wno-endif-labels -Werror  -Werror=* @gol
246-Wfatal-errors  -Wfloat-equal  -Wformat  -Wformat=2 @gol
247-Wno-format-contains-nul -Wno-format-extra-args -Wformat-nonliteral @gol
248-Wformat-security  -Wformat-y2k @gol
249-Wframe-larger-than=@var{len} -Wno-free-nonheap-object -Wjump-misses-init @gol
250-Wignored-qualifiers @gol
251-Wimplicit  -Wimplicit-function-declaration  -Wimplicit-int @gol
252-Winit-self  -Winline -Wmaybe-uninitialized @gol
253-Wno-int-to-pointer-cast -Wno-invalid-offsetof @gol
254-Winvalid-pch -Wlarger-than=@var{len}  -Wunsafe-loop-optimizations @gol
255-Wlogical-op -Wlong-long @gol
256-Wmain -Wmaybe-uninitialized -Wmissing-braces  -Wmissing-field-initializers @gol
257-Wmissing-format-attribute  -Wmissing-include-dirs @gol
258-Wno-mudflap @gol
259-Wno-multichar  -Wnonnull  -Wno-overflow @gol
260-Woverlength-strings  -Wpacked  -Wpacked-bitfield-compat  -Wpadded @gol
261-Wparentheses  -Wpedantic-ms-format -Wno-pedantic-ms-format @gol
262-Wpointer-arith  -Wno-pointer-to-int-cast @gol
263-Wredundant-decls @gol
264-Wreturn-type  -Wsequence-point  -Wshadow @gol
265-Wsign-compare  -Wsign-conversion  -Wstack-protector @gol
266-Wstack-usage=@var{len} -Wstrict-aliasing -Wstrict-aliasing=n @gol
267-Wstrict-overflow -Wstrict-overflow=@var{n} @gol
268-Wsuggest-attribute=@r{[}pure@r{|}const@r{|}noreturn@r{]} @gol
269-Wswitch  -Wswitch-default  -Wswitch-enum -Wsync-nand @gol
270-Wsystem-headers  -Wtrampolines  -Wtrigraphs  -Wtype-limits  -Wundef @gol
271-Wuninitialized  -Wunknown-pragmas  -Wno-pragmas @gol
272-Wunsuffixed-float-constants  -Wunused  -Wunused-function @gol
273-Wunused-label  -Wunused-local-typedefs -Wunused-parameter @gol
274-Wno-unused-result -Wunused-value @gol -Wunused-variable @gol
275-Wunused-but-set-parameter -Wunused-but-set-variable @gol
276-Wvariadic-macros -Wvector-operation-performance -Wvla
277-Wvolatile-register-var  -Wwrite-strings -Wzero-as-null-pointer-constant}
278
279@item C and Objective-C-only Warning Options
280@gccoptlist{-Wbad-function-cast  -Wmissing-declarations @gol
281-Wmissing-parameter-type  -Wmissing-prototypes  -Wnested-externs @gol
282-Wold-style-declaration  -Wold-style-definition @gol
283-Wstrict-prototypes  -Wtraditional  -Wtraditional-conversion @gol
284-Wdeclaration-after-statement -Wpointer-sign}
285
286@item Debugging Options
287@xref{Debugging Options,,Options for Debugging Your Program or GCC}.
288@gccoptlist{-d@var{letters}  -dumpspecs  -dumpmachine  -dumpversion @gol
289-fdbg-cnt-list -fdbg-cnt=@var{counter-value-list} @gol
290-fdisable-ipa-@var{pass_name} @gol
291-fdisable-rtl-@var{pass_name} @gol
292-fdisable-rtl-@var{pass-name}=@var{range-list} @gol
293-fdisable-tree-@var{pass_name} @gol
294-fdisable-tree-@var{pass-name}=@var{range-list} @gol
295-fdump-noaddr -fdump-unnumbered -fdump-unnumbered-links @gol
296-fdump-translation-unit@r{[}-@var{n}@r{]} @gol
297-fdump-class-hierarchy@r{[}-@var{n}@r{]} @gol
298-fdump-ipa-all -fdump-ipa-cgraph -fdump-ipa-inline @gol
299-fdump-passes @gol
300-fdump-statistics @gol
301-fdump-tree-all @gol
302-fdump-tree-original@r{[}-@var{n}@r{]}  @gol
303-fdump-tree-optimized@r{[}-@var{n}@r{]} @gol
304-fdump-tree-cfg -fdump-tree-vcg -fdump-tree-alias @gol
305-fdump-tree-ch @gol
306-fdump-tree-ssa@r{[}-@var{n}@r{]} -fdump-tree-pre@r{[}-@var{n}@r{]} @gol
307-fdump-tree-ccp@r{[}-@var{n}@r{]} -fdump-tree-dce@r{[}-@var{n}@r{]} @gol
308-fdump-tree-gimple@r{[}-raw@r{]} -fdump-tree-mudflap@r{[}-@var{n}@r{]} @gol
309-fdump-tree-dom@r{[}-@var{n}@r{]} @gol
310-fdump-tree-dse@r{[}-@var{n}@r{]} @gol
311-fdump-tree-phiprop@r{[}-@var{n}@r{]} @gol
312-fdump-tree-phiopt@r{[}-@var{n}@r{]} @gol
313-fdump-tree-forwprop@r{[}-@var{n}@r{]} @gol
314-fdump-tree-copyrename@r{[}-@var{n}@r{]} @gol
315-fdump-tree-nrv -fdump-tree-vect @gol
316-fdump-tree-sink @gol
317-fdump-tree-sra@r{[}-@var{n}@r{]} @gol
318-fdump-tree-forwprop@r{[}-@var{n}@r{]} @gol
319-fdump-tree-fre@r{[}-@var{n}@r{]} @gol
320-fdump-tree-vrp@r{[}-@var{n}@r{]} @gol
321-ftree-vectorizer-verbose=@var{n} @gol
322-fdump-tree-storeccp@r{[}-@var{n}@r{]} @gol
323-fdump-final-insns=@var{file} @gol
324-fcompare-debug@r{[}=@var{opts}@r{]}  -fcompare-debug-second @gol
325-feliminate-dwarf2-dups -feliminate-unused-debug-types @gol
326-feliminate-unused-debug-symbols -femit-class-debug-always @gol
327-fenable-@var{kind}-@var{pass} @gol
328-fenable-@var{kind}-@var{pass}=@var{range-list} @gol
329-fdebug-types-section @gol
330-fmem-report -fpre-ipa-mem-report -fpost-ipa-mem-report -fprofile-arcs @gol
331-frandom-seed=@var{string} -fsched-verbose=@var{n} @gol
332-fsel-sched-verbose -fsel-sched-dump-cfg -fsel-sched-pipelining-verbose @gol
333-fstack-usage  -ftest-coverage  -ftime-report -fvar-tracking @gol
334-fvar-tracking-assignments  -fvar-tracking-assignments-toggle @gol
335-g  -g@var{level}  -gtoggle  -gcoff  -gdwarf-@var{version} @gol
336-ggdb  -grecord-gcc-switches  -gno-record-gcc-switches @gol
337-gstabs  -gstabs+  -gstrict-dwarf  -gno-strict-dwarf @gol
338-gvms  -gxcoff  -gxcoff+ @gol
339-fno-merge-debug-strings -fno-dwarf2-cfi-asm @gol
340-fdebug-prefix-map=@var{old}=@var{new} @gol
341-femit-struct-debug-baseonly -femit-struct-debug-reduced @gol
342-femit-struct-debug-detailed@r{[}=@var{spec-list}@r{]} @gol
343-p  -pg  -print-file-name=@var{library}  -print-libgcc-file-name @gol
344-print-multi-directory  -print-multi-lib  -print-multi-os-directory @gol
345-print-prog-name=@var{program}  -print-search-dirs  -Q @gol
346-print-sysroot -print-sysroot-headers-suffix @gol
347-save-temps -save-temps=cwd -save-temps=obj -time@r{[}=@var{file}@r{]}}
348
349@item Optimization Options
350@xref{Optimize Options,,Options that Control Optimization}.
351@gccoptlist{-falign-functions[=@var{n}] -falign-jumps[=@var{n}] @gol
352-falign-labels[=@var{n}] -falign-loops[=@var{n}] -fassociative-math @gol
353-fauto-inc-dec -fbranch-probabilities -fbranch-target-load-optimize @gol
354-fbranch-target-load-optimize2 -fbtr-bb-exclusive -fcaller-saves @gol
355-fcheck-data-deps -fcombine-stack-adjustments -fconserve-stack @gol
356-fcompare-elim -fcprop-registers -fcrossjumping @gol
357-fcse-follow-jumps -fcse-skip-blocks -fcx-fortran-rules @gol
358-fcx-limited-range @gol
359-fdata-sections -fdce -fdelayed-branch @gol
360-fdelete-null-pointer-checks -fdevirtualize -fdse @gol
361-fearly-inlining -fipa-sra -fexpensive-optimizations -ffat-lto-objects @gol
362-ffast-math -ffinite-math-only -ffloat-store -fexcess-precision=@var{style} @gol
363-fforward-propagate -ffp-contract=@var{style} -ffunction-sections @gol
364-fgcse -fgcse-after-reload -fgcse-las -fgcse-lm -fgraphite-identity @gol
365-fgcse-sm -fif-conversion -fif-conversion2 -findirect-inlining @gol
366-finline-functions -finline-functions-called-once -finline-limit=@var{n} @gol
367-finline-small-functions -fipa-cp -fipa-cp-clone -fipa-matrix-reorg @gol
368-fipa-pta -fipa-profile -fipa-pure-const -fipa-reference @gol
369-fira-algorithm=@var{algorithm} @gol
370-fira-region=@var{region} @gol
371-fira-loop-pressure -fno-ira-share-save-slots @gol
372-fno-ira-share-spill-slots -fira-verbose=@var{n} @gol
373-fivopts -fkeep-inline-functions -fkeep-static-consts @gol
374-floop-block -floop-flatten -floop-interchange -floop-strip-mine @gol
375-floop-parallelize-all -flto -flto-compression-level @gol
376-flto-partition=@var{alg} -flto-report -fmerge-all-constants @gol
377-fmerge-constants -fmodulo-sched -fmodulo-sched-allow-regmoves @gol
378-fmove-loop-invariants fmudflap -fmudflapir -fmudflapth -fno-branch-count-reg @gol
379-fno-default-inline @gol
380-fno-defer-pop -fno-function-cse -fno-guess-branch-probability @gol
381-fno-inline -fno-math-errno -fno-peephole -fno-peephole2 @gol
382-fno-sched-interblock -fno-sched-spec -fno-signed-zeros @gol
383-fno-toplevel-reorder -fno-trapping-math -fno-zero-initialized-in-bss @gol
384-fomit-frame-pointer -foptimize-register-move -foptimize-sibling-calls @gol
385-fpartial-inlining -fpeel-loops -fpredictive-commoning @gol
386-fprefetch-loop-arrays @gol
387-fprofile-correction -fprofile-dir=@var{path} -fprofile-generate @gol
388-fprofile-generate=@var{path} @gol
389-fprofile-use -fprofile-use=@var{path} -fprofile-values @gol
390-freciprocal-math -free -fregmove -frename-registers -freorder-blocks @gol
391-freorder-blocks-and-partition -freorder-functions @gol
392-frerun-cse-after-loop -freschedule-modulo-scheduled-loops @gol
393-frounding-math -fsched2-use-superblocks -fsched-pressure @gol
394-fsched-spec-load -fsched-spec-load-dangerous @gol
395-fsched-stalled-insns-dep[=@var{n}] -fsched-stalled-insns[=@var{n}] @gol
396-fsched-group-heuristic -fsched-critical-path-heuristic @gol
397-fsched-spec-insn-heuristic -fsched-rank-heuristic @gol
398-fsched-last-insn-heuristic -fsched-dep-count-heuristic @gol
399-fschedule-insns -fschedule-insns2 -fsection-anchors @gol
400-fselective-scheduling -fselective-scheduling2 @gol
401-fsel-sched-pipelining -fsel-sched-pipelining-outer-loops @gol
402-fshrink-wrap -fsignaling-nans -fsingle-precision-constant @gol
403-fsplit-ivs-in-unroller -fsplit-wide-types -fstack-protector @gol
404-fstack-protector-all -fstrict-aliasing -fstrict-overflow @gol
405-fthread-jumps -ftracer -ftree-bit-ccp @gol
406-ftree-builtin-call-dce -ftree-ccp -ftree-ch -ftree-copy-prop @gol
407-ftree-copyrename -ftree-dce -ftree-dominator-opts -ftree-dse @gol
408-ftree-forwprop -ftree-fre -ftree-loop-if-convert @gol
409-ftree-loop-if-convert-stores -ftree-loop-im @gol
410-ftree-phiprop -ftree-loop-distribution -ftree-loop-distribute-patterns @gol
411-ftree-loop-ivcanon -ftree-loop-linear -ftree-loop-optimize @gol
412-ftree-parallelize-loops=@var{n} -ftree-pre -ftree-pta -ftree-reassoc @gol
413-ftree-sink -ftree-sra -ftree-switch-conversion -ftree-tail-merge @gol
414-ftree-ter -ftree-vect-loop-version -ftree-vectorize -ftree-vrp @gol
415-funit-at-a-time -funroll-all-loops -funroll-loops @gol
416-funsafe-loop-optimizations -funsafe-math-optimizations -funswitch-loops @gol
417-fvariable-expansion-in-unroller -fvect-cost-model -fvpt -fweb @gol
418-fwhole-program -fwpa -fuse-linker-plugin @gol
419--param @var{name}=@var{value}
420-O  -O0  -O1  -O2  -O3  -Os -Ofast}
421
422@item Preprocessor Options
423@xref{Preprocessor Options,,Options Controlling the Preprocessor}.
424@gccoptlist{-A@var{question}=@var{answer} @gol
425-A-@var{question}@r{[}=@var{answer}@r{]} @gol
426-C  -dD  -dI  -dM  -dN @gol
427-D@var{macro}@r{[}=@var{defn}@r{]}  -E  -H @gol
428-idirafter @var{dir} @gol
429-include @var{file}  -imacros @var{file} @gol
430-iprefix @var{file}  -iwithprefix @var{dir} @gol
431-iwithprefixbefore @var{dir}  -isystem @var{dir} @gol
432-imultilib @var{dir} -isysroot @var{dir} @gol
433-M  -MM  -MF  -MG  -MP  -MQ  -MT  -nostdinc  @gol
434-P  -fdebug-cpp -ftrack-macro-expansion -fworking-directory @gol
435-remap -trigraphs  -undef  -U@var{macro}  @gol
436-Wp,@var{option} -Xpreprocessor @var{option}}
437
438@item Assembler Option
439@xref{Assembler Options,,Passing Options to the Assembler}.
440@gccoptlist{-Wa,@var{option}  -Xassembler @var{option}}
441
442@item Linker Options
443@xref{Link Options,,Options for Linking}.
444@gccoptlist{@var{object-file-name}  -l@var{library} @gol
445-nostartfiles  -nodefaultlibs  -nostdlib -pie -rdynamic @gol
446-s  -static  -static-libgcc  -static-libstdc++ -shared  @gol
447-shared-libgcc  -symbolic @gol
448-T @var{script}  -Wl,@var{option}  -Xlinker @var{option} @gol
449-u @var{symbol}}
450
451@item Directory Options
452@xref{Directory Options,,Options for Directory Search}.
453@gccoptlist{-B@var{prefix} -I@var{dir} -iplugindir=@var{dir} @gol
454-iquote@var{dir} -L@var{dir} -specs=@var{file} -I- @gol
455--sysroot=@var{dir}}
456
457@item Machine Dependent Options
458@xref{Submodel Options,,Hardware Models and Configurations}.
459@c This list is ordered alphanumerically by subsection name.
460@c Try and put the significant identifier (CPU or system) first,
461@c so users have a clue at guessing where the ones they want will be.
462
463@emph{Adapteva Epiphany Options}
464@gccoptlist{-mhalf-reg-file -mprefer-short-insn-regs @gol
465-mbranch-cost=@var{num} -mcmove -mnops=@var{num} -msoft-cmpsf @gol
466-msplit-lohi -mpost-inc -mpost-modify -mstack-offset=@var{num} @gol
467-mround-nearest -mlong-calls -mshort-calls -msmall16 @gol
468-mfp-mode=@var{mode} -mvect-double -max-vect-align=@var{num} @gol
469-msplit-vecmove-early -m1reg-@var{reg}}
470
471@emph{ARM Options}
472@gccoptlist{-mapcs-frame  -mno-apcs-frame @gol
473-mabi=@var{name} @gol
474-mapcs-stack-check  -mno-apcs-stack-check @gol
475-mapcs-float  -mno-apcs-float @gol
476-mapcs-reentrant  -mno-apcs-reentrant @gol
477-msched-prolog  -mno-sched-prolog @gol
478-mlittle-endian  -mbig-endian  -mwords-little-endian @gol
479-mfloat-abi=@var{name}  -mfpe @gol
480-mfp16-format=@var{name}
481-mthumb-interwork  -mno-thumb-interwork @gol
482-mcpu=@var{name}  -march=@var{name}  -mfpu=@var{name}  @gol
483-mstructure-size-boundary=@var{n} @gol
484-mabort-on-noreturn @gol
485-mlong-calls  -mno-long-calls @gol
486-msingle-pic-base  -mno-single-pic-base @gol
487-mpic-register=@var{reg} @gol
488-mnop-fun-dllimport @gol
489-mcirrus-fix-invalid-insns -mno-cirrus-fix-invalid-insns @gol
490-mpoke-function-name @gol
491-mthumb  -marm @gol
492-mtpcs-frame  -mtpcs-leaf-frame @gol
493-mcaller-super-interworking  -mcallee-super-interworking @gol
494-mtp=@var{name} -mtls-dialect=@var{dialect} @gol
495-mword-relocations @gol
496-mfix-cortex-m3-ldrd @gol
497-munaligned-access}
498
499@emph{AVR Options}
500@gccoptlist{-mmcu=@var{mcu} -maccumulate-args -mbranch-cost=@var{cost} @gol
501-mcall-prologues -mint8 -mno-interrupts -mrelax -mshort-calls @gol
502-mstrict-X -mtiny-stack}
503
504@emph{Blackfin Options}
505@gccoptlist{-mcpu=@var{cpu}@r{[}-@var{sirevision}@r{]} @gol
506-msim -momit-leaf-frame-pointer  -mno-omit-leaf-frame-pointer @gol
507-mspecld-anomaly  -mno-specld-anomaly  -mcsync-anomaly  -mno-csync-anomaly @gol
508-mlow-64k -mno-low64k  -mstack-check-l1  -mid-shared-library @gol
509-mno-id-shared-library  -mshared-library-id=@var{n} @gol
510-mleaf-id-shared-library  -mno-leaf-id-shared-library @gol
511-msep-data  -mno-sep-data  -mlong-calls  -mno-long-calls @gol
512-mfast-fp -minline-plt -mmulticore  -mcorea  -mcoreb  -msdram @gol
513-micplb}
514
515@emph{C6X Options}
516@gccoptlist{-mbig-endian  -mlittle-endian -march=@var{cpu} @gol
517-msim -msdata=@var{sdata-type}}
518
519@emph{CRIS Options}
520@gccoptlist{-mcpu=@var{cpu}  -march=@var{cpu}  -mtune=@var{cpu} @gol
521-mmax-stack-frame=@var{n}  -melinux-stacksize=@var{n} @gol
522-metrax4  -metrax100  -mpdebug  -mcc-init  -mno-side-effects @gol
523-mstack-align  -mdata-align  -mconst-align @gol
524-m32-bit  -m16-bit  -m8-bit  -mno-prologue-epilogue  -mno-gotplt @gol
525-melf  -maout  -melinux  -mlinux  -sim  -sim2 @gol
526-mmul-bug-workaround  -mno-mul-bug-workaround}
527
528@emph{CR16 Options}
529@gccoptlist{-mmac @gol
530-mcr16cplus -mcr16c @gol
531-msim -mint32 -mbit-ops
532-mdata-model=@var{model}}
533
534@emph{Darwin Options}
535@gccoptlist{-all_load  -allowable_client  -arch  -arch_errors_fatal @gol
536-arch_only  -bind_at_load  -bundle  -bundle_loader @gol
537-client_name  -compatibility_version  -current_version @gol
538-dead_strip @gol
539-dependency-file  -dylib_file  -dylinker_install_name @gol
540-dynamic  -dynamiclib  -exported_symbols_list @gol
541-filelist  -flat_namespace  -force_cpusubtype_ALL @gol
542-force_flat_namespace  -headerpad_max_install_names @gol
543-iframework @gol
544-image_base  -init  -install_name  -keep_private_externs @gol
545-multi_module  -multiply_defined  -multiply_defined_unused @gol
546-noall_load   -no_dead_strip_inits_and_terms @gol
547-nofixprebinding -nomultidefs  -noprebind  -noseglinkedit @gol
548-pagezero_size  -prebind  -prebind_all_twolevel_modules @gol
549-private_bundle  -read_only_relocs  -sectalign @gol
550-sectobjectsymbols  -whyload  -seg1addr @gol
551-sectcreate  -sectobjectsymbols  -sectorder @gol
552-segaddr -segs_read_only_addr -segs_read_write_addr @gol
553-seg_addr_table  -seg_addr_table_filename  -seglinkedit @gol
554-segprot  -segs_read_only_addr  -segs_read_write_addr @gol
555-single_module  -static  -sub_library  -sub_umbrella @gol
556-twolevel_namespace  -umbrella  -undefined @gol
557-unexported_symbols_list  -weak_reference_mismatches @gol
558-whatsloaded -F -gused -gfull -mmacosx-version-min=@var{version} @gol
559-mkernel -mone-byte-bool}
560
561@emph{DEC Alpha Options}
562@gccoptlist{-mno-fp-regs  -msoft-float  -malpha-as  -mgas @gol
563-mieee  -mieee-with-inexact  -mieee-conformant @gol
564-mfp-trap-mode=@var{mode}  -mfp-rounding-mode=@var{mode} @gol
565-mtrap-precision=@var{mode}  -mbuild-constants @gol
566-mcpu=@var{cpu-type}  -mtune=@var{cpu-type} @gol
567-mbwx  -mmax  -mfix  -mcix @gol
568-mfloat-vax  -mfloat-ieee @gol
569-mexplicit-relocs  -msmall-data  -mlarge-data @gol
570-msmall-text  -mlarge-text @gol
571-mmemory-latency=@var{time}}
572
573@emph{DEC Alpha/VMS Options}
574@gccoptlist{-mvms-return-codes -mdebug-main=@var{prefix} -mmalloc64}
575
576@emph{FR30 Options}
577@gccoptlist{-msmall-model -mno-lsim}
578
579@emph{FRV Options}
580@gccoptlist{-mgpr-32  -mgpr-64  -mfpr-32  -mfpr-64 @gol
581-mhard-float  -msoft-float @gol
582-malloc-cc  -mfixed-cc  -mdword  -mno-dword @gol
583-mdouble  -mno-double @gol
584-mmedia  -mno-media  -mmuladd  -mno-muladd @gol
585-mfdpic  -minline-plt -mgprel-ro  -multilib-library-pic @gol
586-mlinked-fp  -mlong-calls  -malign-labels @gol
587-mlibrary-pic  -macc-4  -macc-8 @gol
588-mpack  -mno-pack  -mno-eflags  -mcond-move  -mno-cond-move @gol
589-moptimize-membar -mno-optimize-membar @gol
590-mscc  -mno-scc  -mcond-exec  -mno-cond-exec @gol
591-mvliw-branch  -mno-vliw-branch @gol
592-mmulti-cond-exec  -mno-multi-cond-exec  -mnested-cond-exec @gol
593-mno-nested-cond-exec  -mtomcat-stats @gol
594-mTLS -mtls @gol
595-mcpu=@var{cpu}}
596
597@emph{GNU/Linux Options}
598@gccoptlist{-mglibc -muclibc -mbionic -mandroid @gol
599-tno-android-cc -tno-android-ld}
600
601@emph{H8/300 Options}
602@gccoptlist{-mrelax  -mh  -ms  -mn  -mint32  -malign-300}
603
604@emph{HPPA Options}
605@gccoptlist{-march=@var{architecture-type} @gol
606-mbig-switch  -mdisable-fpregs  -mdisable-indexing @gol
607-mfast-indirect-calls  -mgas  -mgnu-ld   -mhp-ld @gol
608-mfixed-range=@var{register-range} @gol
609-mjump-in-delay -mlinker-opt -mlong-calls @gol
610-mlong-load-store  -mno-big-switch  -mno-disable-fpregs @gol
611-mno-disable-indexing  -mno-fast-indirect-calls  -mno-gas @gol
612-mno-jump-in-delay  -mno-long-load-store @gol
613-mno-portable-runtime  -mno-soft-float @gol
614-mno-space-regs  -msoft-float  -mpa-risc-1-0 @gol
615-mpa-risc-1-1  -mpa-risc-2-0  -mportable-runtime @gol
616-mschedule=@var{cpu-type}  -mspace-regs  -msio  -mwsio @gol
617-munix=@var{unix-std}  -nolibdld  -static  -threads}
618
619@emph{i386 and x86-64 Options}
620@gccoptlist{-mtune=@var{cpu-type}  -march=@var{cpu-type} @gol
621-mfpmath=@var{unit} @gol
622-masm=@var{dialect}  -mno-fancy-math-387 @gol
623-mno-fp-ret-in-387  -msoft-float @gol
624-mno-wide-multiply  -mrtd  -malign-double @gol
625-mpreferred-stack-boundary=@var{num} @gol
626-mincoming-stack-boundary=@var{num} @gol
627-mcld -mcx16 -msahf -mmovbe -mcrc32 @gol
628-mrecip -mrecip=@var{opt} @gol
629-mvzeroupper -mprefer-avx128 @gol
630-mmmx  -msse  -msse2 -msse3 -mssse3 -msse4.1 -msse4.2 -msse4 -mavx @gol
631-mavx2 -maes -mpclmul -mfsgsbase -mrdrnd -mf16c -mfma @gol
632-msse4a -m3dnow -mpopcnt -mabm -mbmi -mtbm -mfma4 -mxop -mlzcnt @gol
633-mbmi2 -mlwp -mthreads  -mno-align-stringops  -minline-all-stringops @gol
634-minline-stringops-dynamically -mstringop-strategy=@var{alg} @gol
635-mpush-args  -maccumulate-outgoing-args  -m128bit-long-double @gol
636-m96bit-long-double  -mregparm=@var{num}  -msseregparm @gol
637-mveclibabi=@var{type} -mvect8-ret-in-mem @gol
638-mpc32 -mpc64 -mpc80 -mstackrealign @gol
639-momit-leaf-frame-pointer  -mno-red-zone -mno-tls-direct-seg-refs @gol
640-mcmodel=@var{code-model} -mabi=@var{name} @gol
641-m32 -m64 -mx32 -mlarge-data-threshold=@var{num} @gol
642-msse2avx -mfentry -m8bit-idiv @gol
643-mavx256-split-unaligned-load -mavx256-split-unaligned-store}
644
645@emph{i386 and x86-64 Windows Options}
646@gccoptlist{-mconsole -mcygwin -mno-cygwin -mdll @gol
647-mnop-fun-dllimport -mthread @gol
648-municode -mwin32 -mwindows -fno-set-stack-executable}
649
650@emph{IA-64 Options}
651@gccoptlist{-mbig-endian  -mlittle-endian  -mgnu-as  -mgnu-ld  -mno-pic @gol
652-mvolatile-asm-stop  -mregister-names  -msdata -mno-sdata @gol
653-mconstant-gp  -mauto-pic  -mfused-madd @gol
654-minline-float-divide-min-latency @gol
655-minline-float-divide-max-throughput @gol
656-mno-inline-float-divide @gol
657-minline-int-divide-min-latency @gol
658-minline-int-divide-max-throughput  @gol
659-mno-inline-int-divide @gol
660-minline-sqrt-min-latency -minline-sqrt-max-throughput @gol
661-mno-inline-sqrt @gol
662-mdwarf2-asm -mearly-stop-bits @gol
663-mfixed-range=@var{register-range} -mtls-size=@var{tls-size} @gol
664-mtune=@var{cpu-type} -milp32 -mlp64 @gol
665-msched-br-data-spec -msched-ar-data-spec -msched-control-spec @gol
666-msched-br-in-data-spec -msched-ar-in-data-spec -msched-in-control-spec @gol
667-msched-spec-ldc -msched-spec-control-ldc @gol
668-msched-prefer-non-data-spec-insns -msched-prefer-non-control-spec-insns @gol
669-msched-stop-bits-after-every-cycle -msched-count-spec-in-critical-path @gol
670-msel-sched-dont-check-control-spec -msched-fp-mem-deps-zero-cost @gol
671-msched-max-memory-insns-hard-limit -msched-max-memory-insns=@var{max-insns}}
672
673@emph{IA-64/VMS Options}
674@gccoptlist{-mvms-return-codes -mdebug-main=@var{prefix} -mmalloc64}
675
676@emph{LM32 Options}
677@gccoptlist{-mbarrel-shift-enabled -mdivide-enabled -mmultiply-enabled @gol
678-msign-extend-enabled -muser-enabled}
679
680@emph{M32R/D Options}
681@gccoptlist{-m32r2 -m32rx -m32r @gol
682-mdebug @gol
683-malign-loops -mno-align-loops @gol
684-missue-rate=@var{number} @gol
685-mbranch-cost=@var{number} @gol
686-mmodel=@var{code-size-model-type} @gol
687-msdata=@var{sdata-type} @gol
688-mno-flush-func -mflush-func=@var{name} @gol
689-mno-flush-trap -mflush-trap=@var{number} @gol
690-G @var{num}}
691
692@emph{M32C Options}
693@gccoptlist{-mcpu=@var{cpu} -msim -memregs=@var{number}}
694
695@emph{M680x0 Options}
696@gccoptlist{-march=@var{arch}  -mcpu=@var{cpu}  -mtune=@var{tune}
697-m68000  -m68020  -m68020-40  -m68020-60  -m68030  -m68040 @gol
698-m68060  -mcpu32  -m5200  -m5206e  -m528x  -m5307  -m5407 @gol
699-mcfv4e  -mbitfield  -mno-bitfield  -mc68000  -mc68020 @gol
700-mnobitfield  -mrtd  -mno-rtd  -mdiv  -mno-div  -mshort @gol
701-mno-short  -mhard-float  -m68881  -msoft-float  -mpcrel @gol
702-malign-int  -mstrict-align  -msep-data  -mno-sep-data @gol
703-mshared-library-id=n  -mid-shared-library  -mno-id-shared-library @gol
704-mxgot -mno-xgot}
705
706@emph{MCore Options}
707@gccoptlist{-mhardlit  -mno-hardlit  -mdiv  -mno-div  -mrelax-immediates @gol
708-mno-relax-immediates  -mwide-bitfields  -mno-wide-bitfields @gol
709-m4byte-functions  -mno-4byte-functions  -mcallgraph-data @gol
710-mno-callgraph-data  -mslow-bytes  -mno-slow-bytes  -mno-lsim @gol
711-mlittle-endian  -mbig-endian  -m210  -m340  -mstack-increment}
712
713@emph{MeP Options}
714@gccoptlist{-mabsdiff -mall-opts -maverage -mbased=@var{n} -mbitops @gol
715-mc=@var{n} -mclip -mconfig=@var{name} -mcop -mcop32 -mcop64 -mivc2 @gol
716-mdc -mdiv -meb -mel -mio-volatile -ml -mleadz -mm -mminmax @gol
717-mmult -mno-opts -mrepeat -ms -msatur -msdram -msim -msimnovec -mtf @gol
718-mtiny=@var{n}}
719
720@emph{MicroBlaze Options}
721@gccoptlist{-msoft-float -mhard-float -msmall-divides -mcpu=@var{cpu} @gol
722-mmemcpy -mxl-soft-mul -mxl-soft-div -mxl-barrel-shift @gol
723-mxl-pattern-compare -mxl-stack-check -mxl-gp-opt -mno-clearbss @gol
724-mxl-multiply-high -mxl-float-convert -mxl-float-sqrt @gol
725-mxl-mode-@var{app-model}}
726
727@emph{MIPS Options}
728@gccoptlist{-EL  -EB  -march=@var{arch}  -mtune=@var{arch} @gol
729-mips1  -mips2  -mips3  -mips4  -mips32  -mips32r2 @gol
730-mips64  -mips64r2 @gol
731-mips16  -mno-mips16  -mflip-mips16 @gol
732-minterlink-mips16  -mno-interlink-mips16 @gol
733-mabi=@var{abi}  -mabicalls  -mno-abicalls @gol
734-mshared  -mno-shared  -mplt  -mno-plt  -mxgot  -mno-xgot @gol
735-mgp32  -mgp64  -mfp32  -mfp64  -mhard-float  -msoft-float @gol
736-msingle-float  -mdouble-float  -mdsp  -mno-dsp  -mdspr2  -mno-dspr2 @gol
737-mfpu=@var{fpu-type} @gol
738-msmartmips  -mno-smartmips @gol
739-mpaired-single  -mno-paired-single  -mdmx  -mno-mdmx @gol
740-mips3d  -mno-mips3d  -mmt  -mno-mt  -mllsc  -mno-llsc @gol
741-mlong64  -mlong32  -msym32  -mno-sym32 @gol
742-G@var{num}  -mlocal-sdata  -mno-local-sdata @gol
743-mextern-sdata  -mno-extern-sdata  -mgpopt  -mno-gopt @gol
744-membedded-data  -mno-embedded-data @gol
745-muninit-const-in-rodata  -mno-uninit-const-in-rodata @gol
746-mcode-readable=@var{setting} @gol
747-msplit-addresses  -mno-split-addresses @gol
748-mexplicit-relocs  -mno-explicit-relocs @gol
749-mcheck-zero-division  -mno-check-zero-division @gol
750-mdivide-traps  -mdivide-breaks @gol
751-mmemcpy  -mno-memcpy  -mlong-calls  -mno-long-calls @gol
752-mmad  -mno-mad  -mfused-madd  -mno-fused-madd  -nocpp @gol
753-mfix-24k -mno-fix-24k @gol
754-mfix-r4000  -mno-fix-r4000  -mfix-r4400  -mno-fix-r4400 @gol
755-mfix-r10000 -mno-fix-r10000  -mfix-vr4120  -mno-fix-vr4120 @gol
756-mfix-vr4130  -mno-fix-vr4130  -mfix-sb1  -mno-fix-sb1 @gol
757-mflush-func=@var{func}  -mno-flush-func @gol
758-mbranch-cost=@var{num}  -mbranch-likely  -mno-branch-likely @gol
759-mfp-exceptions -mno-fp-exceptions @gol
760-mvr4130-align -mno-vr4130-align -msynci -mno-synci @gol
761-mrelax-pic-calls -mno-relax-pic-calls -mmcount-ra-address}
762
763@emph{MMIX Options}
764@gccoptlist{-mlibfuncs  -mno-libfuncs  -mepsilon  -mno-epsilon  -mabi=gnu @gol
765-mabi=mmixware  -mzero-extend  -mknuthdiv  -mtoplevel-symbols @gol
766-melf  -mbranch-predict  -mno-branch-predict  -mbase-addresses @gol
767-mno-base-addresses  -msingle-exit  -mno-single-exit}
768
769@emph{MN10300 Options}
770@gccoptlist{-mmult-bug  -mno-mult-bug @gol
771-mno-am33 -mam33 -mam33-2 -mam34 @gol
772-mtune=@var{cpu-type} @gol
773-mreturn-pointer-on-d0 @gol
774-mno-crt0  -mrelax -mliw -msetlb}
775
776@emph{PDP-11 Options}
777@gccoptlist{-mfpu  -msoft-float  -mac0  -mno-ac0  -m40  -m45  -m10 @gol
778-mbcopy  -mbcopy-builtin  -mint32  -mno-int16 @gol
779-mint16  -mno-int32  -mfloat32  -mno-float64 @gol
780-mfloat64  -mno-float32  -mabshi  -mno-abshi @gol
781-mbranch-expensive  -mbranch-cheap @gol
782-munix-asm  -mdec-asm}
783
784@emph{picoChip Options}
785@gccoptlist{-mae=@var{ae_type} -mvliw-lookahead=@var{N} @gol
786-msymbol-as-address -mno-inefficient-warnings}
787
788@emph{PowerPC Options}
789See RS/6000 and PowerPC Options.
790
791@emph{RL78 Options}
792@gccoptlist{-msim -mmul=none -mmul=g13 -mmul=rl78}
793
794@emph{RS/6000 and PowerPC Options}
795@gccoptlist{-mcpu=@var{cpu-type} @gol
796-mtune=@var{cpu-type} @gol
797-mcmodel=@var{code-model} @gol
798-mpower  -mno-power  -mpower2  -mno-power2 @gol
799-mpowerpc  -mpowerpc64  -mno-powerpc @gol
800-maltivec  -mno-altivec @gol
801-mpowerpc-gpopt  -mno-powerpc-gpopt @gol
802-mpowerpc-gfxopt  -mno-powerpc-gfxopt @gol
803-mmfcrf  -mno-mfcrf  -mpopcntb  -mno-popcntb -mpopcntd -mno-popcntd @gol
804-mfprnd  -mno-fprnd @gol
805-mcmpb -mno-cmpb -mmfpgpr -mno-mfpgpr -mhard-dfp -mno-hard-dfp @gol
806-mnew-mnemonics  -mold-mnemonics @gol
807-mfull-toc   -mminimal-toc  -mno-fp-in-toc  -mno-sum-in-toc @gol
808-m64  -m32  -mxl-compat  -mno-xl-compat  -mpe @gol
809-malign-power  -malign-natural @gol
810-msoft-float  -mhard-float  -mmultiple  -mno-multiple @gol
811-msingle-float -mdouble-float -msimple-fpu @gol
812-mstring  -mno-string  -mupdate  -mno-update @gol
813-mavoid-indexed-addresses  -mno-avoid-indexed-addresses @gol
814-mfused-madd  -mno-fused-madd  -mbit-align  -mno-bit-align @gol
815-mstrict-align  -mno-strict-align  -mrelocatable @gol
816-mno-relocatable  -mrelocatable-lib  -mno-relocatable-lib @gol
817-mtoc  -mno-toc  -mlittle  -mlittle-endian  -mbig  -mbig-endian @gol
818-mdynamic-no-pic  -maltivec -mswdiv  -msingle-pic-base @gol
819-mprioritize-restricted-insns=@var{priority} @gol
820-msched-costly-dep=@var{dependence_type} @gol
821-minsert-sched-nops=@var{scheme} @gol
822-mcall-sysv  -mcall-netbsd @gol
823-maix-struct-return  -msvr4-struct-return @gol
824-mabi=@var{abi-type} -msecure-plt -mbss-plt @gol
825-mblock-move-inline-limit=@var{num} @gol
826-misel -mno-isel @gol
827-misel=yes  -misel=no @gol
828-mspe -mno-spe @gol
829-mspe=yes  -mspe=no @gol
830-mpaired @gol
831-mgen-cell-microcode -mwarn-cell-microcode @gol
832-mvrsave -mno-vrsave @gol
833-mmulhw -mno-mulhw @gol
834-mdlmzb -mno-dlmzb @gol
835-mfloat-gprs=yes  -mfloat-gprs=no -mfloat-gprs=single -mfloat-gprs=double @gol
836-mprototype  -mno-prototype @gol
837-msim  -mmvme  -mads  -myellowknife  -memb  -msdata @gol
838-msdata=@var{opt}  -mvxworks  -G @var{num}  -pthread @gol
839-mrecip -mrecip=@var{opt} -mno-recip -mrecip-precision @gol
840-mno-recip-precision @gol
841-mveclibabi=@var{type} -mfriz -mno-friz @gol
842-mpointers-to-nested-functions -mno-pointers-to-nested-functions @gol
843-msave-toc-indirect -mno-save-toc-indirect}
844
845@emph{RX Options}
846@gccoptlist{-m64bit-doubles  -m32bit-doubles  -fpu  -nofpu@gol
847-mcpu=@gol
848-mbig-endian-data -mlittle-endian-data @gol
849-msmall-data @gol
850-msim  -mno-sim@gol
851-mas100-syntax -mno-as100-syntax@gol
852-mrelax@gol
853-mmax-constant-size=@gol
854-mint-register=@gol
855-mpid@gol
856-msave-acc-in-interrupts}
857
858@emph{S/390 and zSeries Options}
859@gccoptlist{-mtune=@var{cpu-type}  -march=@var{cpu-type} @gol
860-mhard-float  -msoft-float  -mhard-dfp -mno-hard-dfp @gol
861-mlong-double-64 -mlong-double-128 @gol
862-mbackchain  -mno-backchain -mpacked-stack  -mno-packed-stack @gol
863-msmall-exec  -mno-small-exec  -mmvcle -mno-mvcle @gol
864-m64  -m31  -mdebug  -mno-debug  -mesa  -mzarch @gol
865-mtpf-trace -mno-tpf-trace  -mfused-madd  -mno-fused-madd @gol
866-mwarn-framesize  -mwarn-dynamicstack  -mstack-size -mstack-guard}
867
868@emph{Score Options}
869@gccoptlist{-meb -mel @gol
870-mnhwloop @gol
871-muls @gol
872-mmac @gol
873-mscore5 -mscore5u -mscore7 -mscore7d}
874
875@emph{SH Options}
876@gccoptlist{-m1  -m2  -m2e @gol
877-m2a-nofpu -m2a-single-only -m2a-single -m2a @gol
878-m3  -m3e @gol
879-m4-nofpu  -m4-single-only  -m4-single  -m4 @gol
880-m4a-nofpu -m4a-single-only -m4a-single -m4a -m4al @gol
881-m5-64media  -m5-64media-nofpu @gol
882-m5-32media  -m5-32media-nofpu @gol
883-m5-compact  -m5-compact-nofpu @gol
884-mb  -ml  -mdalign  -mrelax @gol
885-mbigtable -mfmovd -mhitachi -mrenesas -mno-renesas -mnomacsave @gol
886-mieee -mno-ieee -mbitops  -misize  -minline-ic_invalidate -mpadstruct @gol
887-mspace -mprefergot  -musermode -multcost=@var{number} -mdiv=@var{strategy} @gol
888-mdivsi3_libfunc=@var{name} -mfixed-range=@var{register-range} @gol
889-madjust-unroll -mindexed-addressing -mgettrcost=@var{number} -mpt-fixed @gol
890-maccumulate-outgoing-args -minvalid-symbols -msoft-atomic @gol
891-mbranch-cost=@var{num} -mcbranchdi -mcmpeqdi -mfused-madd -mpretend-cmove}
892
893@emph{Solaris 2 Options}
894@gccoptlist{-mimpure-text  -mno-impure-text @gol
895-pthreads -pthread}
896
897@emph{SPARC Options}
898@gccoptlist{-mcpu=@var{cpu-type} @gol
899-mtune=@var{cpu-type} @gol
900-mcmodel=@var{code-model} @gol
901-mmemory-model=@var{mem-model} @gol
902-m32  -m64  -mapp-regs  -mno-app-regs @gol
903-mfaster-structs  -mno-faster-structs  -mflat  -mno-flat @gol
904-mfpu  -mno-fpu  -mhard-float  -msoft-float @gol
905-mhard-quad-float  -msoft-quad-float @gol
906-mstack-bias  -mno-stack-bias @gol
907-munaligned-doubles  -mno-unaligned-doubles @gol
908-mv8plus  -mno-v8plus  -mvis  -mno-vis @gol
909-mvis2  -mno-vis2  -mvis3  -mno-vis3 @gol
910-mfmaf  -mno-fmaf  -mpopc  -mno-popc @gol
911-mfix-at697f}
912
913@emph{SPU Options}
914@gccoptlist{-mwarn-reloc -merror-reloc @gol
915-msafe-dma -munsafe-dma @gol
916-mbranch-hints @gol
917-msmall-mem -mlarge-mem -mstdmain @gol
918-mfixed-range=@var{register-range} @gol
919-mea32 -mea64 @gol
920-maddress-space-conversion -mno-address-space-conversion @gol
921-mcache-size=@var{cache-size} @gol
922-matomic-updates -mno-atomic-updates}
923
924@emph{System V Options}
925@gccoptlist{-Qy  -Qn  -YP,@var{paths}  -Ym,@var{dir}}
926
927@emph{TILE-Gx Options}
928@gccoptlist{-mcpu=@var{cpu} -m32 -m64}
929
930@emph{TILEPro Options}
931@gccoptlist{-mcpu=@var{cpu} -m32}
932
933@emph{V850 Options}
934@gccoptlist{-mlong-calls  -mno-long-calls  -mep  -mno-ep @gol
935-mprolog-function  -mno-prolog-function  -mspace @gol
936-mtda=@var{n}  -msda=@var{n}  -mzda=@var{n} @gol
937-mapp-regs  -mno-app-regs @gol
938-mdisable-callt  -mno-disable-callt @gol
939-mv850e2v3 @gol
940-mv850e2 @gol
941-mv850e1 -mv850es @gol
942-mv850e @gol
943-mv850  -mbig-switch}
944
945@emph{VAX Options}
946@gccoptlist{-mg  -mgnu  -munix}
947
948@emph{VxWorks Options}
949@gccoptlist{-mrtp  -non-static  -Bstatic  -Bdynamic @gol
950-Xbind-lazy  -Xbind-now}
951
952@emph{x86-64 Options}
953See i386 and x86-64 Options.
954
955@emph{Xstormy16 Options}
956@gccoptlist{-msim}
957
958@emph{Xtensa Options}
959@gccoptlist{-mconst16 -mno-const16 @gol
960-mfused-madd  -mno-fused-madd @gol
961-mforce-no-pic @gol
962-mserialize-volatile  -mno-serialize-volatile @gol
963-mtext-section-literals  -mno-text-section-literals @gol
964-mtarget-align  -mno-target-align @gol
965-mlongcalls  -mno-longcalls}
966
967@emph{zSeries Options}
968See S/390 and zSeries Options.
969
970@item Code Generation Options
971@xref{Code Gen Options,,Options for Code Generation Conventions}.
972@gccoptlist{-fcall-saved-@var{reg}  -fcall-used-@var{reg} @gol
973-ffixed-@var{reg}  -fexceptions @gol
974-fnon-call-exceptions  -funwind-tables @gol
975-fasynchronous-unwind-tables @gol
976-finhibit-size-directive  -finstrument-functions @gol
977-finstrument-functions-exclude-function-list=@var{sym},@var{sym},@dots{} @gol
978-finstrument-functions-exclude-file-list=@var{file},@var{file},@dots{} @gol
979-fno-common  -fno-ident @gol
980-fpcc-struct-return  -fpic  -fPIC -fpie -fPIE @gol
981-fno-jump-tables @gol
982-frecord-gcc-switches @gol
983-freg-struct-return  -fshort-enums @gol
984-fshort-double  -fshort-wchar @gol
985-fverbose-asm  -fpack-struct[=@var{n}]  -fstack-check @gol
986-fstack-limit-register=@var{reg}  -fstack-limit-symbol=@var{sym} @gol
987-fno-stack-limit -fsplit-stack @gol
988-fleading-underscore  -ftls-model=@var{model} @gol
989-ftrapv  -fwrapv  -fbounds-check @gol
990-fvisibility -fstrict-volatile-bitfields}
991@end table
992
993@menu
994* Overall Options::     Controlling the kind of output:
995                        an executable, object files, assembler files,
996                        or preprocessed source.
997* C Dialect Options::   Controlling the variant of C language compiled.
998* C++ Dialect Options:: Variations on C++.
999* Objective-C and Objective-C++ Dialect Options:: Variations on Objective-C
1000                        and Objective-C++.
1001* Language Independent Options:: Controlling how diagnostics should be
1002                        formatted.
1003* Warning Options::     How picky should the compiler be?
1004* Debugging Options::   Symbol tables, measurements, and debugging dumps.
1005* Optimize Options::    How much optimization?
1006* Preprocessor Options:: Controlling header files and macro definitions.
1007                         Also, getting dependency information for Make.
1008* Assembler Options::   Passing options to the assembler.
1009* Link Options::        Specifying libraries and so on.
1010* Directory Options::   Where to find header files and libraries.
1011                        Where to find the compiler executable files.
1012* Spec Files::          How to pass switches to sub-processes.
1013* Target Options::      Running a cross-compiler, or an old version of GCC.
1014@end menu
1015
1016@node Overall Options
1017@section Options Controlling the Kind of Output
1018
1019Compilation can involve up to four stages: preprocessing, compilation
1020proper, assembly and linking, always in that order.  GCC is capable of
1021preprocessing and compiling several files either into several
1022assembler input files, or into one assembler input file; then each
1023assembler input file produces an object file, and linking combines all
1024the object files (those newly compiled, and those specified as input)
1025into an executable file.
1026
1027@cindex file name suffix
1028For any given input file, the file name suffix determines what kind of
1029compilation is done:
1030
1031@table @gcctabopt
1032@item @var{file}.c
1033C source code that must be preprocessed.
1034
1035@item @var{file}.i
1036C source code that should not be preprocessed.
1037
1038@item @var{file}.ii
1039C++ source code that should not be preprocessed.
1040
1041@item @var{file}.m
1042Objective-C source code.  Note that you must link with the @file{libobjc}
1043library to make an Objective-C program work.
1044
1045@item @var{file}.mi
1046Objective-C source code that should not be preprocessed.
1047
1048@item @var{file}.mm
1049@itemx @var{file}.M
1050Objective-C++ source code.  Note that you must link with the @file{libobjc}
1051library to make an Objective-C++ program work.  Note that @samp{.M} refers
1052to a literal capital M@.
1053
1054@item @var{file}.mii
1055Objective-C++ source code that should not be preprocessed.
1056
1057@item @var{file}.h
1058C, C++, Objective-C or Objective-C++ header file to be turned into a
1059precompiled header (default), or C, C++ header file to be turned into an
1060Ada spec (via the @option{-fdump-ada-spec} switch).
1061
1062@item @var{file}.cc
1063@itemx @var{file}.cp
1064@itemx @var{file}.cxx
1065@itemx @var{file}.cpp
1066@itemx @var{file}.CPP
1067@itemx @var{file}.c++
1068@itemx @var{file}.C
1069C++ source code that must be preprocessed.  Note that in @samp{.cxx},
1070the last two letters must both be literally @samp{x}.  Likewise,
1071@samp{.C} refers to a literal capital C@.
1072
1073@item @var{file}.mm
1074@itemx @var{file}.M
1075Objective-C++ source code that must be preprocessed.
1076
1077@item @var{file}.mii
1078Objective-C++ source code that should not be preprocessed.
1079
1080@item @var{file}.hh
1081@itemx @var{file}.H
1082@itemx @var{file}.hp
1083@itemx @var{file}.hxx
1084@itemx @var{file}.hpp
1085@itemx @var{file}.HPP
1086@itemx @var{file}.h++
1087@itemx @var{file}.tcc
1088C++ header file to be turned into a precompiled header or Ada spec.
1089
1090@item @var{file}.f
1091@itemx @var{file}.for
1092@itemx @var{file}.ftn
1093Fixed form Fortran source code that should not be preprocessed.
1094
1095@item @var{file}.F
1096@itemx @var{file}.FOR
1097@itemx @var{file}.fpp
1098@itemx @var{file}.FPP
1099@itemx @var{file}.FTN
1100Fixed form Fortran source code that must be preprocessed (with the traditional
1101preprocessor).
1102
1103@item @var{file}.f90
1104@itemx @var{file}.f95
1105@itemx @var{file}.f03
1106@itemx @var{file}.f08
1107Free form Fortran source code that should not be preprocessed.
1108
1109@item @var{file}.F90
1110@itemx @var{file}.F95
1111@itemx @var{file}.F03
1112@itemx @var{file}.F08
1113Free form Fortran source code that must be preprocessed (with the
1114traditional preprocessor).
1115
1116@item @var{file}.go
1117Go source code.
1118
1119@c FIXME: Descriptions of Java file types.
1120@c @var{file}.java
1121@c @var{file}.class
1122@c @var{file}.zip
1123@c @var{file}.jar
1124
1125@item @var{file}.ads
1126Ada source code file that contains a library unit declaration (a
1127declaration of a package, subprogram, or generic, or a generic
1128instantiation), or a library unit renaming declaration (a package,
1129generic, or subprogram renaming declaration).  Such files are also
1130called @dfn{specs}.
1131
1132@item @var{file}.adb
1133Ada source code file containing a library unit body (a subprogram or
1134package body).  Such files are also called @dfn{bodies}.
1135
1136@c GCC also knows about some suffixes for languages not yet included:
1137@c Pascal:
1138@c @var{file}.p
1139@c @var{file}.pas
1140@c Ratfor:
1141@c @var{file}.r
1142
1143@item @var{file}.s
1144Assembler code.
1145
1146@item @var{file}.S
1147@itemx @var{file}.sx
1148Assembler code that must be preprocessed.
1149
1150@item @var{other}
1151An object file to be fed straight into linking.
1152Any file name with no recognized suffix is treated this way.
1153@end table
1154
1155@opindex x
1156You can specify the input language explicitly with the @option{-x} option:
1157
1158@table @gcctabopt
1159@item -x @var{language}
1160Specify explicitly the @var{language} for the following input files
1161(rather than letting the compiler choose a default based on the file
1162name suffix).  This option applies to all following input files until
1163the next @option{-x} option.  Possible values for @var{language} are:
1164@smallexample
1165c  c-header  cpp-output
1166c++  c++-header  c++-cpp-output
1167objective-c  objective-c-header  objective-c-cpp-output
1168objective-c++ objective-c++-header objective-c++-cpp-output
1169assembler  assembler-with-cpp
1170ada
1171f77  f77-cpp-input f95  f95-cpp-input
1172go
1173java
1174@end smallexample
1175
1176@item -x none
1177Turn off any specification of a language, so that subsequent files are
1178handled according to their file name suffixes (as they are if @option{-x}
1179has not been used at all).
1180
1181@item -pass-exit-codes
1182@opindex pass-exit-codes
1183Normally the @command{gcc} program will exit with the code of 1 if any
1184phase of the compiler returns a non-success return code.  If you specify
1185@option{-pass-exit-codes}, the @command{gcc} program will instead return with
1186numerically highest error produced by any phase that returned an error
1187indication.  The C, C++, and Fortran frontends return 4, if an internal
1188compiler error is encountered.
1189@end table
1190
1191If you only want some of the stages of compilation, you can use
1192@option{-x} (or filename suffixes) to tell @command{gcc} where to start, and
1193one of the options @option{-c}, @option{-S}, or @option{-E} to say where
1194@command{gcc} is to stop.  Note that some combinations (for example,
1195@samp{-x cpp-output -E}) instruct @command{gcc} to do nothing at all.
1196
1197@table @gcctabopt
1198@item -c
1199@opindex c
1200Compile or assemble the source files, but do not link.  The linking
1201stage simply is not done.  The ultimate output is in the form of an
1202object file for each source file.
1203
1204By default, the object file name for a source file is made by replacing
1205the suffix @samp{.c}, @samp{.i}, @samp{.s}, etc., with @samp{.o}.
1206
1207Unrecognized input files, not requiring compilation or assembly, are
1208ignored.
1209
1210@item -S
1211@opindex S
1212Stop after the stage of compilation proper; do not assemble.  The output
1213is in the form of an assembler code file for each non-assembler input
1214file specified.
1215
1216By default, the assembler file name for a source file is made by
1217replacing the suffix @samp{.c}, @samp{.i}, etc., with @samp{.s}.
1218
1219Input files that don't require compilation are ignored.
1220
1221@item -E
1222@opindex E
1223Stop after the preprocessing stage; do not run the compiler proper.  The
1224output is in the form of preprocessed source code, which is sent to the
1225standard output.
1226
1227Input files that don't require preprocessing are ignored.
1228
1229@cindex output file option
1230@item -o @var{file}
1231@opindex o
1232Place output in file @var{file}.  This applies regardless to whatever
1233sort of output is being produced, whether it be an executable file,
1234an object file, an assembler file or preprocessed C code.
1235
1236If @option{-o} is not specified, the default is to put an executable
1237file in @file{a.out}, the object file for
1238@file{@var{source}.@var{suffix}} in @file{@var{source}.o}, its
1239assembler file in @file{@var{source}.s}, a precompiled header file in
1240@file{@var{source}.@var{suffix}.gch}, and all preprocessed C source on
1241standard output.
1242
1243@item -v
1244@opindex v
1245Print (on standard error output) the commands executed to run the stages
1246of compilation.  Also print the version number of the compiler driver
1247program and of the preprocessor and the compiler proper.
1248
1249@item -###
1250@opindex ###
1251Like @option{-v} except the commands are not executed and arguments
1252are quoted unless they contain only alphanumeric characters or @code{./-_}.
1253This is useful for shell scripts to capture the driver-generated command lines.
1254
1255@item -pipe
1256@opindex pipe
1257Use pipes rather than temporary files for communication between the
1258various stages of compilation.  This fails to work on some systems where
1259the assembler is unable to read from a pipe; but the GNU assembler has
1260no trouble.
1261
1262@item --help
1263@opindex help
1264Print (on the standard output) a description of the command-line options
1265understood by @command{gcc}.  If the @option{-v} option is also specified
1266then @option{--help} will also be passed on to the various processes
1267invoked by @command{gcc}, so that they can display the command-line options
1268they accept.  If the @option{-Wextra} option has also been specified
1269(prior to the @option{--help} option), then command-line options that
1270have no documentation associated with them will also be displayed.
1271
1272@item --target-help
1273@opindex target-help
1274Print (on the standard output) a description of target-specific command-line
1275options for each tool.  For some targets extra target-specific
1276information may also be printed.
1277
1278@item --help=@{@var{class}@r{|[}^@r{]}@var{qualifier}@}@r{[},@dots{}@r{]}
1279Print (on the standard output) a description of the command-line
1280options understood by the compiler that fit into all specified classes
1281and qualifiers.  These are the supported classes:
1282
1283@table @asis
1284@item @samp{optimizers}
1285This will display all of the optimization options supported by the
1286compiler.
1287
1288@item @samp{warnings}
1289This will display all of the options controlling warning messages
1290produced by the compiler.
1291
1292@item @samp{target}
1293This will display target-specific options.  Unlike the
1294@option{--target-help} option however, target-specific options of the
1295linker and assembler will not be displayed.  This is because those
1296tools do not currently support the extended @option{--help=} syntax.
1297
1298@item @samp{params}
1299This will display the values recognized by the @option{--param}
1300option.
1301
1302@item @var{language}
1303This will display the options supported for @var{language}, where
1304@var{language} is the name of one of the languages supported in this
1305version of GCC.
1306
1307@item @samp{common}
1308This will display the options that are common to all languages.
1309@end table
1310
1311These are the supported qualifiers:
1312
1313@table @asis
1314@item @samp{undocumented}
1315Display only those options that are undocumented.
1316
1317@item @samp{joined}
1318Display options taking an argument that appears after an equal
1319sign in the same continuous piece of text, such as:
1320@samp{--help=target}.
1321
1322@item @samp{separate}
1323Display options taking an argument that appears as a separate word
1324following the original option, such as: @samp{-o output-file}.
1325@end table
1326
1327Thus for example to display all the undocumented target-specific
1328switches supported by the compiler the following can be used:
1329
1330@smallexample
1331--help=target,undocumented
1332@end smallexample
1333
1334The sense of a qualifier can be inverted by prefixing it with the
1335@samp{^} character, so for example to display all binary warning
1336options (i.e., ones that are either on or off and that do not take an
1337argument) that have a description, use:
1338
1339@smallexample
1340--help=warnings,^joined,^undocumented
1341@end smallexample
1342
1343The argument to @option{--help=} should not consist solely of inverted
1344qualifiers.
1345
1346Combining several classes is possible, although this usually
1347restricts the output by so much that there is nothing to display.  One
1348case where it does work however is when one of the classes is
1349@var{target}.  So for example to display all the target-specific
1350optimization options the following can be used:
1351
1352@smallexample
1353--help=target,optimizers
1354@end smallexample
1355
1356The @option{--help=} option can be repeated on the command line.  Each
1357successive use will display its requested class of options, skipping
1358those that have already been displayed.
1359
1360If the @option{-Q} option appears on the command line before the
1361@option{--help=} option, then the descriptive text displayed by
1362@option{--help=} is changed.  Instead of describing the displayed
1363options, an indication is given as to whether the option is enabled,
1364disabled or set to a specific value (assuming that the compiler
1365knows this at the point where the @option{--help=} option is used).
1366
1367Here is a truncated example from the ARM port of @command{gcc}:
1368
1369@smallexample
1370  % gcc -Q -mabi=2 --help=target -c
1371  The following options are target specific:
1372  -mabi=                                2
1373  -mabort-on-noreturn                   [disabled]
1374  -mapcs                                [disabled]
1375@end smallexample
1376
1377The output is sensitive to the effects of previous command-line
1378options, so for example it is possible to find out which optimizations
1379are enabled at @option{-O2} by using:
1380
1381@smallexample
1382-Q -O2 --help=optimizers
1383@end smallexample
1384
1385Alternatively you can discover which binary optimizations are enabled
1386by @option{-O3} by using:
1387
1388@smallexample
1389gcc -c -Q -O3 --help=optimizers > /tmp/O3-opts
1390gcc -c -Q -O2 --help=optimizers > /tmp/O2-opts
1391diff /tmp/O2-opts /tmp/O3-opts | grep enabled
1392@end smallexample
1393
1394@item -no-canonical-prefixes
1395@opindex no-canonical-prefixes
1396Do not expand any symbolic links, resolve references to @samp{/../}
1397or @samp{/./}, or make the path absolute when generating a relative
1398prefix.
1399
1400@item --version
1401@opindex version
1402Display the version number and copyrights of the invoked GCC@.
1403
1404@item -wrapper
1405@opindex wrapper
1406Invoke all subcommands under a wrapper program.  The name of the
1407wrapper program and its parameters are passed as a comma separated
1408list.
1409
1410@smallexample
1411gcc -c t.c -wrapper gdb,--args
1412@end smallexample
1413
1414This will invoke all subprograms of @command{gcc} under
1415@samp{gdb --args}, thus the invocation of @command{cc1} will be
1416@samp{gdb --args cc1 @dots{}}.
1417
1418@item -fplugin=@var{name}.so
1419Load the plugin code in file @var{name}.so, assumed to be a
1420shared object to be dlopen'd by the compiler.  The base name of
1421the shared object file is used to identify the plugin for the
1422purposes of argument parsing (See
1423@option{-fplugin-arg-@var{name}-@var{key}=@var{value}} below).
1424Each plugin should define the callback functions specified in the
1425Plugins API.
1426
1427@item -fplugin-arg-@var{name}-@var{key}=@var{value}
1428Define an argument called @var{key} with a value of @var{value}
1429for the plugin called @var{name}.
1430
1431@item -fdump-ada-spec@r{[}-slim@r{]}
1432@opindex fdump-ada-spec
1433For C and C++ source and include files, generate corresponding Ada specs.
1434@xref{Generating Ada Bindings for C and C++ headers,,, gnat_ugn,
1435GNAT User's Guide}, which provides detailed documentation on this feature.
1436
1437@item -fdump-go-spec=@var{file}
1438@opindex fdump-go-spec
1439For input files in any language, generate corresponding Go
1440declarations in @var{file}.  This generates Go @code{const},
1441@code{type}, @code{var}, and @code{func} declarations which may be a
1442useful way to start writing a Go interface to code written in some
1443other language.
1444
1445@include @value{srcdir}/../libiberty/at-file.texi
1446@end table
1447
1448@node Invoking G++
1449@section Compiling C++ Programs
1450
1451@cindex suffixes for C++ source
1452@cindex C++ source file suffixes
1453C++ source files conventionally use one of the suffixes @samp{.C},
1454@samp{.cc}, @samp{.cpp}, @samp{.CPP}, @samp{.c++}, @samp{.cp}, or
1455@samp{.cxx}; C++ header files often use @samp{.hh}, @samp{.hpp},
1456@samp{.H}, or (for shared template code) @samp{.tcc}; and
1457preprocessed C++ files use the suffix @samp{.ii}.  GCC recognizes
1458files with these names and compiles them as C++ programs even if you
1459call the compiler the same way as for compiling C programs (usually
1460with the name @command{gcc}).
1461
1462@findex g++
1463@findex c++
1464However, the use of @command{gcc} does not add the C++ library.
1465@command{g++} is a program that calls GCC and treats @samp{.c},
1466@samp{.h} and @samp{.i} files as C++ source files instead of C source
1467files unless @option{-x} is used, and automatically specifies linking
1468against the C++ library.  This program is also useful when
1469precompiling a C header file with a @samp{.h} extension for use in C++
1470compilations.  On many systems, @command{g++} is also installed with
1471the name @command{c++}.
1472
1473@cindex invoking @command{g++}
1474When you compile C++ programs, you may specify many of the same
1475command-line options that you use for compiling programs in any
1476language; or command-line options meaningful for C and related
1477languages; or options that are meaningful only for C++ programs.
1478@xref{C Dialect Options,,Options Controlling C Dialect}, for
1479explanations of options for languages related to C@.
1480@xref{C++ Dialect Options,,Options Controlling C++ Dialect}, for
1481explanations of options that are meaningful only for C++ programs.
1482
1483@node C Dialect Options
1484@section Options Controlling C Dialect
1485@cindex dialect options
1486@cindex language dialect options
1487@cindex options, dialect
1488
1489The following options control the dialect of C (or languages derived
1490from C, such as C++, Objective-C and Objective-C++) that the compiler
1491accepts:
1492
1493@table @gcctabopt
1494@cindex ANSI support
1495@cindex ISO support
1496@item -ansi
1497@opindex ansi
1498In C mode, this is equivalent to @samp{-std=c90}. In C++ mode, it is
1499equivalent to @samp{-std=c++98}.
1500
1501This turns off certain features of GCC that are incompatible with ISO
1502C90 (when compiling C code), or of standard C++ (when compiling C++ code),
1503such as the @code{asm} and @code{typeof} keywords, and
1504predefined macros such as @code{unix} and @code{vax} that identify the
1505type of system you are using.  It also enables the undesirable and
1506rarely used ISO trigraph feature.  For the C compiler,
1507it disables recognition of C++ style @samp{//} comments as well as
1508the @code{inline} keyword.
1509
1510The alternate keywords @code{__asm__}, @code{__extension__},
1511@code{__inline__} and @code{__typeof__} continue to work despite
1512@option{-ansi}.  You would not want to use them in an ISO C program, of
1513course, but it is useful to put them in header files that might be included
1514in compilations done with @option{-ansi}.  Alternate predefined macros
1515such as @code{__unix__} and @code{__vax__} are also available, with or
1516without @option{-ansi}.
1517
1518The @option{-ansi} option does not cause non-ISO programs to be
1519rejected gratuitously.  For that, @option{-pedantic} is required in
1520addition to @option{-ansi}.  @xref{Warning Options}.
1521
1522The macro @code{__STRICT_ANSI__} is predefined when the @option{-ansi}
1523option is used.  Some header files may notice this macro and refrain
1524from declaring certain functions or defining certain macros that the
1525ISO standard doesn't call for; this is to avoid interfering with any
1526programs that might use these names for other things.
1527
1528Functions that would normally be built in but do not have semantics
1529defined by ISO C (such as @code{alloca} and @code{ffs}) are not built-in
1530functions when @option{-ansi} is used.  @xref{Other Builtins,,Other
1531built-in functions provided by GCC}, for details of the functions
1532affected.
1533
1534@item -std=
1535@opindex std
1536Determine the language standard. @xref{Standards,,Language Standards
1537Supported by GCC}, for details of these standard versions.  This option
1538is currently only supported when compiling C or C++.
1539
1540The compiler can accept several base standards, such as @samp{c90} or
1541@samp{c++98}, and GNU dialects of those standards, such as
1542@samp{gnu90} or @samp{gnu++98}.  By specifying a base standard, the
1543compiler will accept all programs following that standard and those
1544using GNU extensions that do not contradict it.  For example,
1545@samp{-std=c90} turns off certain features of GCC that are
1546incompatible with ISO C90, such as the @code{asm} and @code{typeof}
1547keywords, but not other GNU extensions that do not have a meaning in
1548ISO C90, such as omitting the middle term of a @code{?:}
1549expression. On the other hand, by specifying a GNU dialect of a
1550standard, all features the compiler support are enabled, even when
1551those features change the meaning of the base standard and some
1552strict-conforming programs may be rejected.  The particular standard
1553is used by @option{-pedantic} to identify which features are GNU
1554extensions given that version of the standard. For example
1555@samp{-std=gnu90 -pedantic} would warn about C++ style @samp{//}
1556comments, while @samp{-std=gnu99 -pedantic} would not.
1557
1558A value for this option must be provided; possible values are
1559
1560@table @samp
1561@item c90
1562@itemx c89
1563@itemx iso9899:1990
1564Support all ISO C90 programs (certain GNU extensions that conflict
1565with ISO C90 are disabled). Same as @option{-ansi} for C code.
1566
1567@item iso9899:199409
1568ISO C90 as modified in amendment 1.
1569
1570@item c99
1571@itemx c9x
1572@itemx iso9899:1999
1573@itemx iso9899:199x
1574ISO C99.  Note that this standard is not yet fully supported; see
1575@w{@uref{http://gcc.gnu.org/gcc-4.7/c99status.html}} for more information.  The
1576names @samp{c9x} and @samp{iso9899:199x} are deprecated.
1577
1578@item c11
1579@itemx c1x
1580@itemx iso9899:2011
1581ISO C11, the 2011 revision of the ISO C standard.
1582Support is incomplete and experimental.  The name @samp{c1x} is
1583deprecated.
1584
1585@item gnu90
1586@itemx gnu89
1587GNU dialect of ISO C90 (including some C99 features). This
1588is the default for C code.
1589
1590@item gnu99
1591@itemx gnu9x
1592GNU dialect of ISO C99.  When ISO C99 is fully implemented in GCC,
1593this will become the default.  The name @samp{gnu9x} is deprecated.
1594
1595@item gnu11
1596@item gnu1x
1597GNU dialect of ISO C11.  Support is incomplete and experimental.  The
1598name @samp{gnu1x} is deprecated.
1599
1600@item c++98
1601The 1998 ISO C++ standard plus amendments. Same as @option{-ansi} for
1602C++ code.
1603
1604@item gnu++98
1605GNU dialect of @option{-std=c++98}.  This is the default for
1606C++ code.
1607
1608@item c++11
1609The 2011 ISO C++ standard plus amendments.  Support for C++11 is still
1610experimental, and may change in incompatible ways in future releases.
1611
1612@item gnu++11
1613GNU dialect of @option{-std=c++11}. Support for C++11 is still
1614experimental, and may change in incompatible ways in future releases.
1615@end table
1616
1617@item -fgnu89-inline
1618@opindex fgnu89-inline
1619The option @option{-fgnu89-inline} tells GCC to use the traditional
1620GNU semantics for @code{inline} functions when in C99 mode.
1621@xref{Inline,,An Inline Function is As Fast As a Macro}.  This option
1622is accepted and ignored by GCC versions 4.1.3 up to but not including
16234.3.  In GCC versions 4.3 and later it changes the behavior of GCC in
1624C99 mode.  Using this option is roughly equivalent to adding the
1625@code{gnu_inline} function attribute to all inline functions
1626(@pxref{Function Attributes}).
1627
1628The option @option{-fno-gnu89-inline} explicitly tells GCC to use the
1629C99 semantics for @code{inline} when in C99 or gnu99 mode (i.e., it
1630specifies the default behavior).  This option was first supported in
1631GCC 4.3.  This option is not supported in @option{-std=c90} or
1632@option{-std=gnu90} mode.
1633
1634The preprocessor macros @code{__GNUC_GNU_INLINE__} and
1635@code{__GNUC_STDC_INLINE__} may be used to check which semantics are
1636in effect for @code{inline} functions.  @xref{Common Predefined
1637Macros,,,cpp,The C Preprocessor}.
1638
1639@item -aux-info @var{filename}
1640@opindex aux-info
1641Output to the given filename prototyped declarations for all functions
1642declared and/or defined in a translation unit, including those in header
1643files.  This option is silently ignored in any language other than C@.
1644
1645Besides declarations, the file indicates, in comments, the origin of
1646each declaration (source file and line), whether the declaration was
1647implicit, prototyped or unprototyped (@samp{I}, @samp{N} for new or
1648@samp{O} for old, respectively, in the first character after the line
1649number and the colon), and whether it came from a declaration or a
1650definition (@samp{C} or @samp{F}, respectively, in the following
1651character).  In the case of function definitions, a K&R-style list of
1652arguments followed by their declarations is also provided, inside
1653comments, after the declaration.
1654
1655@item -fallow-parameterless-variadic-functions
1656Accept variadic functions without named parameters.
1657
1658Although it is possible to define such a function, this is not very
1659useful as it is not possible to read the arguments.  This is only
1660supported for C as this construct is allowed by C++.
1661
1662@item -fno-asm
1663@opindex fno-asm
1664Do not recognize @code{asm}, @code{inline} or @code{typeof} as a
1665keyword, so that code can use these words as identifiers.  You can use
1666the keywords @code{__asm__}, @code{__inline__} and @code{__typeof__}
1667instead.  @option{-ansi} implies @option{-fno-asm}.
1668
1669In C++, this switch only affects the @code{typeof} keyword, since
1670@code{asm} and @code{inline} are standard keywords.  You may want to
1671use the @option{-fno-gnu-keywords} flag instead, which has the same
1672effect.  In C99 mode (@option{-std=c99} or @option{-std=gnu99}), this
1673switch only affects the @code{asm} and @code{typeof} keywords, since
1674@code{inline} is a standard keyword in ISO C99.
1675
1676@item -fno-builtin
1677@itemx -fno-builtin-@var{function}
1678@opindex fno-builtin
1679@cindex built-in functions
1680Don't recognize built-in functions that do not begin with
1681@samp{__builtin_} as prefix.  @xref{Other Builtins,,Other built-in
1682functions provided by GCC}, for details of the functions affected,
1683including those which are not built-in functions when @option{-ansi} or
1684@option{-std} options for strict ISO C conformance are used because they
1685do not have an ISO standard meaning.
1686
1687GCC normally generates special code to handle certain built-in functions
1688more efficiently; for instance, calls to @code{alloca} may become single
1689instructions which adjust the stack directly, and calls to @code{memcpy}
1690may become inline copy loops.  The resulting code is often both smaller
1691and faster, but since the function calls no longer appear as such, you
1692cannot set a breakpoint on those calls, nor can you change the behavior
1693of the functions by linking with a different library.  In addition,
1694when a function is recognized as a built-in function, GCC may use
1695information about that function to warn about problems with calls to
1696that function, or to generate more efficient code, even if the
1697resulting code still contains calls to that function.  For example,
1698warnings are given with @option{-Wformat} for bad calls to
1699@code{printf}, when @code{printf} is built in, and @code{strlen} is
1700known not to modify global memory.
1701
1702With the @option{-fno-builtin-@var{function}} option
1703only the built-in function @var{function} is
1704disabled.  @var{function} must not begin with @samp{__builtin_}.  If a
1705function is named that is not built-in in this version of GCC, this
1706option is ignored.  There is no corresponding
1707@option{-fbuiltin-@var{function}} option; if you wish to enable
1708built-in functions selectively when using @option{-fno-builtin} or
1709@option{-ffreestanding}, you may define macros such as:
1710
1711@smallexample
1712#define abs(n)          __builtin_abs ((n))
1713#define strcpy(d, s)    __builtin_strcpy ((d), (s))
1714@end smallexample
1715
1716@item -fhosted
1717@opindex fhosted
1718@cindex hosted environment
1719
1720Assert that compilation takes place in a hosted environment.  This implies
1721@option{-fbuiltin}.  A hosted environment is one in which the
1722entire standard library is available, and in which @code{main} has a return
1723type of @code{int}.  Examples are nearly everything except a kernel.
1724This is equivalent to @option{-fno-freestanding}.
1725
1726@item -ffreestanding
1727@opindex ffreestanding
1728@cindex hosted environment
1729
1730Assert that compilation takes place in a freestanding environment.  This
1731implies @option{-fno-builtin}.  A freestanding environment
1732is one in which the standard library may not exist, and program startup may
1733not necessarily be at @code{main}.  The most obvious example is an OS kernel.
1734This is equivalent to @option{-fno-hosted}.
1735
1736@xref{Standards,,Language Standards Supported by GCC}, for details of
1737freestanding and hosted environments.
1738
1739@item -fopenmp
1740@opindex fopenmp
1741@cindex OpenMP parallel
1742Enable handling of OpenMP directives @code{#pragma omp} in C/C++ and
1743@code{!$omp} in Fortran.  When @option{-fopenmp} is specified, the
1744compiler generates parallel code according to the OpenMP Application
1745Program Interface v3.0 @w{@uref{http://www.openmp.org/}}.  This option
1746implies @option{-pthread}, and thus is only supported on targets that
1747have support for @option{-pthread}.
1748
1749@item -fgnu-tm
1750@opindex fgnu-tm
1751When the option @option{-fgnu-tm} is specified, the compiler will
1752generate code for the Linux variant of Intel's current Transactional
1753Memory ABI specification document (Revision 1.1, May 6 2009).  This is
1754an experimental feature whose interface may change in future versions
1755of GCC, as the official specification changes.  Please note that not
1756all architectures are supported for this feature.
1757
1758For more information on GCC's support for transactional memory,
1759@xref{Enabling libitm,,The GNU Transactional Memory Library,libitm,GNU
1760Transactional Memory Library}.
1761
1762Note that the transactional memory feature is not supported with
1763non-call exceptions (@option{-fnon-call-exceptions}).
1764
1765@item -fms-extensions
1766@opindex fms-extensions
1767Accept some non-standard constructs used in Microsoft header files.
1768
1769In C++ code, this allows member names in structures to be similar
1770to previous types declarations.
1771
1772@smallexample
1773typedef int UOW;
1774struct ABC @{
1775  UOW UOW;
1776@};
1777@end smallexample
1778
1779Some cases of unnamed fields in structures and unions are only
1780accepted with this option.  @xref{Unnamed Fields,,Unnamed struct/union
1781fields within structs/unions}, for details.
1782
1783@item -fplan9-extensions
1784Accept some non-standard constructs used in Plan 9 code.
1785
1786This enables @option{-fms-extensions}, permits passing pointers to
1787structures with anonymous fields to functions that expect pointers to
1788elements of the type of the field, and permits referring to anonymous
1789fields declared using a typedef.  @xref{Unnamed Fields,,Unnamed
1790struct/union fields within structs/unions}, for details.  This is only
1791supported for C, not C++.
1792
1793@item -trigraphs
1794@opindex trigraphs
1795Support ISO C trigraphs.  The @option{-ansi} option (and @option{-std}
1796options for strict ISO C conformance) implies @option{-trigraphs}.
1797
1798@item -no-integrated-cpp
1799@opindex no-integrated-cpp
1800Performs a compilation in two passes: preprocessing and compiling.  This
1801option allows a user supplied "cc1", "cc1plus", or "cc1obj" via the
1802@option{-B} option.  The user supplied compilation step can then add in
1803an additional preprocessing step after normal preprocessing but before
1804compiling.  The default is to use the integrated cpp (internal cpp)
1805
1806The semantics of this option will change if "cc1", "cc1plus", and
1807"cc1obj" are merged.
1808
1809@cindex traditional C language
1810@cindex C language, traditional
1811@item -traditional
1812@itemx -traditional-cpp
1813@opindex traditional-cpp
1814@opindex traditional
1815Formerly, these options caused GCC to attempt to emulate a pre-standard
1816C compiler.  They are now only supported with the @option{-E} switch.
1817The preprocessor continues to support a pre-standard mode.  See the GNU
1818CPP manual for details.
1819
1820@item -fcond-mismatch
1821@opindex fcond-mismatch
1822Allow conditional expressions with mismatched types in the second and
1823third arguments.  The value of such an expression is void.  This option
1824is not supported for C++.
1825
1826@item -flax-vector-conversions
1827@opindex flax-vector-conversions
1828Allow implicit conversions between vectors with differing numbers of
1829elements and/or incompatible element types.  This option should not be
1830used for new code.
1831
1832@item -funsigned-char
1833@opindex funsigned-char
1834Let the type @code{char} be unsigned, like @code{unsigned char}.
1835
1836Each kind of machine has a default for what @code{char} should
1837be.  It is either like @code{unsigned char} by default or like
1838@code{signed char} by default.
1839
1840Ideally, a portable program should always use @code{signed char} or
1841@code{unsigned char} when it depends on the signedness of an object.
1842But many programs have been written to use plain @code{char} and
1843expect it to be signed, or expect it to be unsigned, depending on the
1844machines they were written for.  This option, and its inverse, let you
1845make such a program work with the opposite default.
1846
1847The type @code{char} is always a distinct type from each of
1848@code{signed char} or @code{unsigned char}, even though its behavior
1849is always just like one of those two.
1850
1851@item -fsigned-char
1852@opindex fsigned-char
1853Let the type @code{char} be signed, like @code{signed char}.
1854
1855Note that this is equivalent to @option{-fno-unsigned-char}, which is
1856the negative form of @option{-funsigned-char}.  Likewise, the option
1857@option{-fno-signed-char} is equivalent to @option{-funsigned-char}.
1858
1859@item -fsigned-bitfields
1860@itemx -funsigned-bitfields
1861@itemx -fno-signed-bitfields
1862@itemx -fno-unsigned-bitfields
1863@opindex fsigned-bitfields
1864@opindex funsigned-bitfields
1865@opindex fno-signed-bitfields
1866@opindex fno-unsigned-bitfields
1867These options control whether a bit-field is signed or unsigned, when the
1868declaration does not use either @code{signed} or @code{unsigned}.  By
1869default, such a bit-field is signed, because this is consistent: the
1870basic integer types such as @code{int} are signed types.
1871@end table
1872
1873@node C++ Dialect Options
1874@section Options Controlling C++ Dialect
1875
1876@cindex compiler options, C++
1877@cindex C++ options, command-line
1878@cindex options, C++
1879This section describes the command-line options that are only meaningful
1880for C++ programs; but you can also use most of the GNU compiler options
1881regardless of what language your program is in.  For example, you
1882might compile a file @code{firstClass.C} like this:
1883
1884@smallexample
1885g++ -g -frepo -O -c firstClass.C
1886@end smallexample
1887
1888@noindent
1889In this example, only @option{-frepo} is an option meant
1890only for C++ programs; you can use the other options with any
1891language supported by GCC@.
1892
1893Here is a list of options that are @emph{only} for compiling C++ programs:
1894
1895@table @gcctabopt
1896
1897@item -fabi-version=@var{n}
1898@opindex fabi-version
1899Use version @var{n} of the C++ ABI@.  Version 2 is the version of the
1900C++ ABI that first appeared in G++ 3.4.  Version 1 is the version of
1901the C++ ABI that first appeared in G++ 3.2.  Version 0 will always be
1902the version that conforms most closely to the C++ ABI specification.
1903Therefore, the ABI obtained using version 0 will change as ABI bugs
1904are fixed.
1905
1906The default is version 2.
1907
1908Version 3 corrects an error in mangling a constant address as a
1909template argument.
1910
1911Version 4, which first appeared in G++ 4.5, implements a standard
1912mangling for vector types.
1913
1914Version 5, which first appeared in G++ 4.6, corrects the mangling of
1915attribute const/volatile on function pointer types, decltype of a
1916plain decl, and use of a function parameter in the declaration of
1917another parameter.
1918
1919Version 6, which first appeared in G++ 4.7, corrects the promotion
1920behavior of C++11 scoped enums and the mangling of template argument
1921packs, const/static_cast, prefix ++ and --, and a class scope function
1922used as a template argument.
1923
1924See also @option{-Wabi}.
1925
1926@item -fno-access-control
1927@opindex fno-access-control
1928Turn off all access checking.  This switch is mainly useful for working
1929around bugs in the access control code.
1930
1931@item -fcheck-new
1932@opindex fcheck-new
1933Check that the pointer returned by @code{operator new} is non-null
1934before attempting to modify the storage allocated.  This check is
1935normally unnecessary because the C++ standard specifies that
1936@code{operator new} will only return @code{0} if it is declared
1937@samp{throw()}, in which case the compiler will always check the
1938return value even without this option.  In all other cases, when
1939@code{operator new} has a non-empty exception specification, memory
1940exhaustion is signalled by throwing @code{std::bad_alloc}.  See also
1941@samp{new (nothrow)}.
1942
1943@item -fconserve-space
1944@opindex fconserve-space
1945Put uninitialized or run-time-initialized global variables into the
1946common segment, as C does.  This saves space in the executable at the
1947cost of not diagnosing duplicate definitions.  If you compile with this
1948flag and your program mysteriously crashes after @code{main()} has
1949completed, you may have an object that is being destroyed twice because
1950two definitions were merged.
1951
1952This option is no longer useful on most targets, now that support has
1953been added for putting variables into BSS without making them common.
1954
1955@item -fconstexpr-depth=@var{n}
1956@opindex fconstexpr-depth
1957Set the maximum nested evaluation depth for C++11 constexpr functions
1958to @var{n}.  A limit is needed to detect endless recursion during
1959constant expression evaluation.  The minimum specified by the standard
1960is 512.
1961
1962@item -fdeduce-init-list
1963@opindex fdeduce-init-list
1964Enable deduction of a template type parameter as
1965std::initializer_list from a brace-enclosed initializer list, i.e.
1966
1967@smallexample
1968template <class T> auto forward(T t) -> decltype (realfn (t))
1969@{
1970  return realfn (t);
1971@}
1972
1973void f()
1974@{
1975  forward(@{1,2@}); // call forward<std::initializer_list<int>>
1976@}
1977@end smallexample
1978
1979This deduction was implemented as a possible extension to the
1980originally proposed semantics for the C++11 standard, but was not part
1981of the final standard, so it is disabled by default.  This option is
1982deprecated, and may be removed in a future version of G++.
1983
1984@item -ffriend-injection
1985@opindex ffriend-injection
1986Inject friend functions into the enclosing namespace, so that they are
1987visible outside the scope of the class in which they are declared.
1988Friend functions were documented to work this way in the old Annotated
1989C++ Reference Manual, and versions of G++ before 4.1 always worked
1990that way.  However, in ISO C++ a friend function that is not declared
1991in an enclosing scope can only be found using argument dependent
1992lookup.  This option causes friends to be injected as they were in
1993earlier releases.
1994
1995This option is for compatibility, and may be removed in a future
1996release of G++.
1997
1998@item -fno-elide-constructors
1999@opindex fno-elide-constructors
2000The C++ standard allows an implementation to omit creating a temporary
2001that is only used to initialize another object of the same type.
2002Specifying this option disables that optimization, and forces G++ to
2003call the copy constructor in all cases.
2004
2005@item -fno-enforce-eh-specs
2006@opindex fno-enforce-eh-specs
2007Don't generate code to check for violation of exception specifications
2008at run time.  This option violates the C++ standard, but may be useful
2009for reducing code size in production builds, much like defining
2010@samp{NDEBUG}.  This does not give user code permission to throw
2011exceptions in violation of the exception specifications; the compiler
2012will still optimize based on the specifications, so throwing an
2013unexpected exception will result in undefined behavior.
2014
2015@item -ffor-scope
2016@itemx -fno-for-scope
2017@opindex ffor-scope
2018@opindex fno-for-scope
2019If @option{-ffor-scope} is specified, the scope of variables declared in
2020a @i{for-init-statement} is limited to the @samp{for} loop itself,
2021as specified by the C++ standard.
2022If @option{-fno-for-scope} is specified, the scope of variables declared in
2023a @i{for-init-statement} extends to the end of the enclosing scope,
2024as was the case in old versions of G++, and other (traditional)
2025implementations of C++.
2026
2027The default if neither flag is given to follow the standard,
2028but to allow and give a warning for old-style code that would
2029otherwise be invalid, or have different behavior.
2030
2031@item -fno-gnu-keywords
2032@opindex fno-gnu-keywords
2033Do not recognize @code{typeof} as a keyword, so that code can use this
2034word as an identifier.  You can use the keyword @code{__typeof__} instead.
2035@option{-ansi} implies @option{-fno-gnu-keywords}.
2036
2037@item -fno-implicit-templates
2038@opindex fno-implicit-templates
2039Never emit code for non-inline templates that are instantiated
2040implicitly (i.e.@: by use); only emit code for explicit instantiations.
2041@xref{Template Instantiation}, for more information.
2042
2043@item -fno-implicit-inline-templates
2044@opindex fno-implicit-inline-templates
2045Don't emit code for implicit instantiations of inline templates, either.
2046The default is to handle inlines differently so that compiles with and
2047without optimization will need the same set of explicit instantiations.
2048
2049@item -fno-implement-inlines
2050@opindex fno-implement-inlines
2051To save space, do not emit out-of-line copies of inline functions
2052controlled by @samp{#pragma implementation}.  This will cause linker
2053errors if these functions are not inlined everywhere they are called.
2054
2055@item -fms-extensions
2056@opindex fms-extensions
2057Disable pedantic warnings about constructs used in MFC, such as implicit
2058int and getting a pointer to member function via non-standard syntax.
2059
2060@item -fno-nonansi-builtins
2061@opindex fno-nonansi-builtins
2062Disable built-in declarations of functions that are not mandated by
2063ANSI/ISO C@.  These include @code{ffs}, @code{alloca}, @code{_exit},
2064@code{index}, @code{bzero}, @code{conjf}, and other related functions.
2065
2066@item -fnothrow-opt
2067@opindex fnothrow-opt
2068Treat a @code{throw()} exception specification as though it were a
2069@code{noexcept} specification to reduce or eliminate the text size
2070overhead relative to a function with no exception specification.  If
2071the function has local variables of types with non-trivial
2072destructors, the exception specification will actually make the
2073function smaller because the EH cleanups for those variables can be
2074optimized away.  The semantic effect is that an exception thrown out of
2075a function with such an exception specification will result in a call
2076to @code{terminate} rather than @code{unexpected}.
2077
2078@item -fno-operator-names
2079@opindex fno-operator-names
2080Do not treat the operator name keywords @code{and}, @code{bitand},
2081@code{bitor}, @code{compl}, @code{not}, @code{or} and @code{xor} as
2082synonyms as keywords.
2083
2084@item -fno-optional-diags
2085@opindex fno-optional-diags
2086Disable diagnostics that the standard says a compiler does not need to
2087issue.  Currently, the only such diagnostic issued by G++ is the one for
2088a name having multiple meanings within a class.
2089
2090@item -fpermissive
2091@opindex fpermissive
2092Downgrade some diagnostics about nonconformant code from errors to
2093warnings.  Thus, using @option{-fpermissive} will allow some
2094nonconforming code to compile.
2095
2096@item -fno-pretty-templates
2097@opindex fno-pretty-templates
2098When an error message refers to a specialization of a function
2099template, the compiler will normally print the signature of the
2100template followed by the template arguments and any typedefs or
2101typenames in the signature (e.g. @code{void f(T) [with T = int]}
2102rather than @code{void f(int)}) so that it's clear which template is
2103involved.  When an error message refers to a specialization of a class
2104template, the compiler will omit any template arguments that match
2105the default template arguments for that template.  If either of these
2106behaviors make it harder to understand the error message rather than
2107easier, using @option{-fno-pretty-templates} will disable them.
2108
2109@item -frepo
2110@opindex frepo
2111Enable automatic template instantiation at link time.  This option also
2112implies @option{-fno-implicit-templates}.  @xref{Template
2113Instantiation}, for more information.
2114
2115@item -fno-rtti
2116@opindex fno-rtti
2117Disable generation of information about every class with virtual
2118functions for use by the C++ run-time type identification features
2119(@samp{dynamic_cast} and @samp{typeid}).  If you don't use those parts
2120of the language, you can save some space by using this flag.  Note that
2121exception handling uses the same information, but it will generate it as
2122needed. The @samp{dynamic_cast} operator can still be used for casts that
2123do not require run-time type information, i.e.@: casts to @code{void *} or to
2124unambiguous base classes.
2125
2126@item -fstats
2127@opindex fstats
2128Emit statistics about front-end processing at the end of the compilation.
2129This information is generally only useful to the G++ development team.
2130
2131@item -fstrict-enums
2132@opindex fstrict-enums
2133Allow the compiler to optimize using the assumption that a value of
2134enumerated type can only be one of the values of the enumeration (as
2135defined in the C++ standard; basically, a value that can be
2136represented in the minimum number of bits needed to represent all the
2137enumerators).  This assumption may not be valid if the program uses a
2138cast to convert an arbitrary integer value to the enumerated type.
2139
2140@item -ftemplate-depth=@var{n}
2141@opindex ftemplate-depth
2142Set the maximum instantiation depth for template classes to @var{n}.
2143A limit on the template instantiation depth is needed to detect
2144endless recursions during template class instantiation.  ANSI/ISO C++
2145conforming programs must not rely on a maximum depth greater than 17
2146(changed to 1024 in C++11).  The default value is 900, as the compiler
2147can run out of stack space before hitting 1024 in some situations.
2148
2149@item -fno-threadsafe-statics
2150@opindex fno-threadsafe-statics
2151Do not emit the extra code to use the routines specified in the C++
2152ABI for thread-safe initialization of local statics.  You can use this
2153option to reduce code size slightly in code that doesn't need to be
2154thread-safe.
2155
2156@item -fuse-cxa-atexit
2157@opindex fuse-cxa-atexit
2158Register destructors for objects with static storage duration with the
2159@code{__cxa_atexit} function rather than the @code{atexit} function.
2160This option is required for fully standards-compliant handling of static
2161destructors, but will only work if your C library supports
2162@code{__cxa_atexit}.
2163
2164@item -fno-use-cxa-get-exception-ptr
2165@opindex fno-use-cxa-get-exception-ptr
2166Don't use the @code{__cxa_get_exception_ptr} runtime routine.  This
2167will cause @code{std::uncaught_exception} to be incorrect, but is necessary
2168if the runtime routine is not available.
2169
2170@item -fvisibility-inlines-hidden
2171@opindex fvisibility-inlines-hidden
2172This switch declares that the user does not attempt to compare
2173pointers to inline functions or methods where the addresses of the two functions
2174were taken in different shared objects.
2175
2176The effect of this is that GCC may, effectively, mark inline methods with
2177@code{__attribute__ ((visibility ("hidden")))} so that they do not
2178appear in the export table of a DSO and do not require a PLT indirection
2179when used within the DSO@.  Enabling this option can have a dramatic effect
2180on load and link times of a DSO as it massively reduces the size of the
2181dynamic export table when the library makes heavy use of templates.
2182
2183The behavior of this switch is not quite the same as marking the
2184methods as hidden directly, because it does not affect static variables
2185local to the function or cause the compiler to deduce that
2186the function is defined in only one shared object.
2187
2188You may mark a method as having a visibility explicitly to negate the
2189effect of the switch for that method.  For example, if you do want to
2190compare pointers to a particular inline method, you might mark it as
2191having default visibility.  Marking the enclosing class with explicit
2192visibility will have no effect.
2193
2194Explicitly instantiated inline methods are unaffected by this option
2195as their linkage might otherwise cross a shared library boundary.
2196@xref{Template Instantiation}.
2197
2198@item -fvisibility-ms-compat
2199@opindex fvisibility-ms-compat
2200This flag attempts to use visibility settings to make GCC's C++
2201linkage model compatible with that of Microsoft Visual Studio.
2202
2203The flag makes these changes to GCC's linkage model:
2204
2205@enumerate
2206@item
2207It sets the default visibility to @code{hidden}, like
2208@option{-fvisibility=hidden}.
2209
2210@item
2211Types, but not their members, are not hidden by default.
2212
2213@item
2214The One Definition Rule is relaxed for types without explicit
2215visibility specifications that are defined in more than one different
2216shared object: those declarations are permitted if they would have
2217been permitted when this option was not used.
2218@end enumerate
2219
2220In new code it is better to use @option{-fvisibility=hidden} and
2221export those classes that are intended to be externally visible.
2222Unfortunately it is possible for code to rely, perhaps accidentally,
2223on the Visual Studio behavior.
2224
2225Among the consequences of these changes are that static data members
2226of the same type with the same name but defined in different shared
2227objects will be different, so changing one will not change the other;
2228and that pointers to function members defined in different shared
2229objects may not compare equal.  When this flag is given, it is a
2230violation of the ODR to define types with the same name differently.
2231
2232@item -fno-weak
2233@opindex fno-weak
2234Do not use weak symbol support, even if it is provided by the linker.
2235By default, G++ will use weak symbols if they are available.  This
2236option exists only for testing, and should not be used by end-users;
2237it will result in inferior code and has no benefits.  This option may
2238be removed in a future release of G++.
2239
2240@item -nostdinc++
2241@opindex nostdinc++
2242Do not search for header files in the standard directories specific to
2243C++, but do still search the other standard directories.  (This option
2244is used when building the C++ library.)
2245@end table
2246
2247In addition, these optimization, warning, and code generation options
2248have meanings only for C++ programs:
2249
2250@table @gcctabopt
2251@item -fno-default-inline
2252@opindex fno-default-inline
2253Do not assume @samp{inline} for functions defined inside a class scope.
2254@xref{Optimize Options,,Options That Control Optimization}.  Note that these
2255functions will have linkage like inline functions; they just won't be
2256inlined by default.
2257
2258@item -Wabi @r{(C, Objective-C, C++ and Objective-C++ only)}
2259@opindex Wabi
2260@opindex Wno-abi
2261Warn when G++ generates code that is probably not compatible with the
2262vendor-neutral C++ ABI@.  Although an effort has been made to warn about
2263all such cases, there are probably some cases that are not warned about,
2264even though G++ is generating incompatible code.  There may also be
2265cases where warnings are emitted even though the code that is generated
2266will be compatible.
2267
2268You should rewrite your code to avoid these warnings if you are
2269concerned about the fact that code generated by G++ may not be binary
2270compatible with code generated by other compilers.
2271
2272The known incompatibilities in @option{-fabi-version=2} (the default) include:
2273
2274@itemize @bullet
2275
2276@item
2277A template with a non-type template parameter of reference type is
2278mangled incorrectly:
2279@smallexample
2280extern int N;
2281template <int &> struct S @{@};
2282void n (S<N>) @{2@}
2283@end smallexample
2284
2285This is fixed in @option{-fabi-version=3}.
2286
2287@item
2288SIMD vector types declared using @code{__attribute ((vector_size))} are
2289mangled in a non-standard way that does not allow for overloading of
2290functions taking vectors of different sizes.
2291
2292The mangling is changed in @option{-fabi-version=4}.
2293@end itemize
2294
2295The known incompatibilities in @option{-fabi-version=1} include:
2296
2297@itemize @bullet
2298
2299@item
2300Incorrect handling of tail-padding for bit-fields.  G++ may attempt to
2301pack data into the same byte as a base class.  For example:
2302
2303@smallexample
2304struct A @{ virtual void f(); int f1 : 1; @};
2305struct B : public A @{ int f2 : 1; @};
2306@end smallexample
2307
2308@noindent
2309In this case, G++ will place @code{B::f2} into the same byte
2310as@code{A::f1}; other compilers will not.  You can avoid this problem
2311by explicitly padding @code{A} so that its size is a multiple of the
2312byte size on your platform; that will cause G++ and other compilers to
2313layout @code{B} identically.
2314
2315@item
2316Incorrect handling of tail-padding for virtual bases.  G++ does not use
2317tail padding when laying out virtual bases.  For example:
2318
2319@smallexample
2320struct A @{ virtual void f(); char c1; @};
2321struct B @{ B(); char c2; @};
2322struct C : public A, public virtual B @{@};
2323@end smallexample
2324
2325@noindent
2326In this case, G++ will not place @code{B} into the tail-padding for
2327@code{A}; other compilers will.  You can avoid this problem by
2328explicitly padding @code{A} so that its size is a multiple of its
2329alignment (ignoring virtual base classes); that will cause G++ and other
2330compilers to layout @code{C} identically.
2331
2332@item
2333Incorrect handling of bit-fields with declared widths greater than that
2334of their underlying types, when the bit-fields appear in a union.  For
2335example:
2336
2337@smallexample
2338union U @{ int i : 4096; @};
2339@end smallexample
2340
2341@noindent
2342Assuming that an @code{int} does not have 4096 bits, G++ will make the
2343union too small by the number of bits in an @code{int}.
2344
2345@item
2346Empty classes can be placed at incorrect offsets.  For example:
2347
2348@smallexample
2349struct A @{@};
2350
2351struct B @{
2352  A a;
2353  virtual void f ();
2354@};
2355
2356struct C : public B, public A @{@};
2357@end smallexample
2358
2359@noindent
2360G++ will place the @code{A} base class of @code{C} at a nonzero offset;
2361it should be placed at offset zero.  G++ mistakenly believes that the
2362@code{A} data member of @code{B} is already at offset zero.
2363
2364@item
2365Names of template functions whose types involve @code{typename} or
2366template template parameters can be mangled incorrectly.
2367
2368@smallexample
2369template <typename Q>
2370void f(typename Q::X) @{@}
2371
2372template <template <typename> class Q>
2373void f(typename Q<int>::X) @{@}
2374@end smallexample
2375
2376@noindent
2377Instantiations of these templates may be mangled incorrectly.
2378
2379@end itemize
2380
2381It also warns psABI related changes.  The known psABI changes at this
2382point include:
2383
2384@itemize @bullet
2385
2386@item
2387For SYSV/x86-64, when passing union with long double, it is changed to
2388pass in memory as specified in psABI.  For example:
2389
2390@smallexample
2391union U @{
2392  long double ld;
2393  int i;
2394@};
2395@end smallexample
2396
2397@noindent
2398@code{union U} will always be passed in memory.
2399
2400@end itemize
2401
2402@item -Wctor-dtor-privacy @r{(C++ and Objective-C++ only)}
2403@opindex Wctor-dtor-privacy
2404@opindex Wno-ctor-dtor-privacy
2405Warn when a class seems unusable because all the constructors or
2406destructors in that class are private, and it has neither friends nor
2407public static member functions.
2408
2409@item -Wdelete-non-virtual-dtor @r{(C++ and Objective-C++ only)}
2410@opindex Wdelete-non-virtual-dtor
2411@opindex Wno-delete-non-virtual-dtor
2412Warn when @samp{delete} is used to destroy an instance of a class that
2413has virtual functions and non-virtual destructor. It is unsafe to delete
2414an instance of a derived class through a pointer to a base class if the
2415base class does not have a virtual destructor.  This warning is enabled
2416by @option{-Wall}.
2417
2418@item -Wnarrowing @r{(C++ and Objective-C++ only)}
2419@opindex Wnarrowing
2420@opindex Wno-narrowing
2421Warn when a narrowing conversion prohibited by C++11 occurs within
2422@samp{@{ @}}, e.g.
2423
2424@smallexample
2425int i = @{ 2.2 @}; // error: narrowing from double to int
2426@end smallexample
2427
2428This flag is included in @option{-Wall} and @option{-Wc++11-compat}.
2429
2430With -std=c++11, @option{-Wno-narrowing} suppresses the diagnostic
2431required by the standard.  Note that this does not affect the meaning
2432of well-formed code; narrowing conversions are still considered
2433ill-formed in SFINAE context.
2434
2435@item -Wnoexcept @r{(C++ and Objective-C++ only)}
2436@opindex Wnoexcept
2437@opindex Wno-noexcept
2438Warn when a noexcept-expression evaluates to false because of a call
2439to a function that does not have a non-throwing exception
2440specification (i.e. @samp{throw()} or @samp{noexcept}) but is known by
2441the compiler to never throw an exception.
2442
2443@item -Wnon-virtual-dtor @r{(C++ and Objective-C++ only)}
2444@opindex Wnon-virtual-dtor
2445@opindex Wno-non-virtual-dtor
2446Warn when a class has virtual functions and accessible non-virtual
2447destructor, in which case it would be possible but unsafe to delete
2448an instance of a derived class through a pointer to the base class.
2449This warning is also enabled if @option{-Weffc++} is specified.
2450
2451@item -Wreorder @r{(C++ and Objective-C++ only)}
2452@opindex Wreorder
2453@opindex Wno-reorder
2454@cindex reordering, warning
2455@cindex warning for reordering of member initializers
2456Warn when the order of member initializers given in the code does not
2457match the order in which they must be executed.  For instance:
2458
2459@smallexample
2460struct A @{
2461  int i;
2462  int j;
2463  A(): j (0), i (1) @{ @}
2464@};
2465@end smallexample
2466
2467The compiler will rearrange the member initializers for @samp{i}
2468and @samp{j} to match the declaration order of the members, emitting
2469a warning to that effect.  This warning is enabled by @option{-Wall}.
2470@end table
2471
2472The following @option{-W@dots{}} options are not affected by @option{-Wall}.
2473
2474@table @gcctabopt
2475@item -Weffc++ @r{(C++ and Objective-C++ only)}
2476@opindex Weffc++
2477@opindex Wno-effc++
2478Warn about violations of the following style guidelines from Scott Meyers'
2479@cite{Effective C++, Second Edition} book:
2480
2481@itemize @bullet
2482@item
2483Item 11:  Define a copy constructor and an assignment operator for classes
2484with dynamically allocated memory.
2485
2486@item
2487Item 12:  Prefer initialization to assignment in constructors.
2488
2489@item
2490Item 14:  Make destructors virtual in base classes.
2491
2492@item
2493Item 15:  Have @code{operator=} return a reference to @code{*this}.
2494
2495@item
2496Item 23:  Don't try to return a reference when you must return an object.
2497
2498@end itemize
2499
2500Also warn about violations of the following style guidelines from
2501Scott Meyers' @cite{More Effective C++} book:
2502
2503@itemize @bullet
2504@item
2505Item 6:  Distinguish between prefix and postfix forms of increment and
2506decrement operators.
2507
2508@item
2509Item 7:  Never overload @code{&&}, @code{||}, or @code{,}.
2510
2511@end itemize
2512
2513When selecting this option, be aware that the standard library
2514headers do not obey all of these guidelines; use @samp{grep -v}
2515to filter out those warnings.
2516
2517@item -Wstrict-null-sentinel @r{(C++ and Objective-C++ only)}
2518@opindex Wstrict-null-sentinel
2519@opindex Wno-strict-null-sentinel
2520Warn also about the use of an uncasted @code{NULL} as sentinel.  When
2521compiling only with GCC this is a valid sentinel, as @code{NULL} is defined
2522to @code{__null}.  Although it is a null pointer constant not a null pointer,
2523it is guaranteed to be of the same size as a pointer.  But this use is
2524not portable across different compilers.
2525
2526@item -Wno-non-template-friend @r{(C++ and Objective-C++ only)}
2527@opindex Wno-non-template-friend
2528@opindex Wnon-template-friend
2529Disable warnings when non-templatized friend functions are declared
2530within a template.  Since the advent of explicit template specification
2531support in G++, if the name of the friend is an unqualified-id (i.e.,
2532@samp{friend foo(int)}), the C++ language specification demands that the
2533friend declare or define an ordinary, nontemplate function.  (Section
253414.5.3).  Before G++ implemented explicit specification, unqualified-ids
2535could be interpreted as a particular specialization of a templatized
2536function.  Because this non-conforming behavior is no longer the default
2537behavior for G++, @option{-Wnon-template-friend} allows the compiler to
2538check existing code for potential trouble spots and is on by default.
2539This new compiler behavior can be turned off with
2540@option{-Wno-non-template-friend}, which keeps the conformant compiler code
2541but disables the helpful warning.
2542
2543@item -Wold-style-cast @r{(C++ and Objective-C++ only)}
2544@opindex Wold-style-cast
2545@opindex Wno-old-style-cast
2546Warn if an old-style (C-style) cast to a non-void type is used within
2547a C++ program.  The new-style casts (@samp{dynamic_cast},
2548@samp{static_cast}, @samp{reinterpret_cast}, and @samp{const_cast}) are
2549less vulnerable to unintended effects and much easier to search for.
2550
2551@item -Woverloaded-virtual @r{(C++ and Objective-C++ only)}
2552@opindex Woverloaded-virtual
2553@opindex Wno-overloaded-virtual
2554@cindex overloaded virtual function, warning
2555@cindex warning for overloaded virtual function
2556Warn when a function declaration hides virtual functions from a
2557base class.  For example, in:
2558
2559@smallexample
2560struct A @{
2561  virtual void f();
2562@};
2563
2564struct B: public A @{
2565  void f(int);
2566@};
2567@end smallexample
2568
2569the @code{A} class version of @code{f} is hidden in @code{B}, and code
2570like:
2571
2572@smallexample
2573B* b;
2574b->f();
2575@end smallexample
2576
2577will fail to compile.
2578
2579@item -Wno-pmf-conversions @r{(C++ and Objective-C++ only)}
2580@opindex Wno-pmf-conversions
2581@opindex Wpmf-conversions
2582Disable the diagnostic for converting a bound pointer to member function
2583to a plain pointer.
2584
2585@item -Wsign-promo @r{(C++ and Objective-C++ only)}
2586@opindex Wsign-promo
2587@opindex Wno-sign-promo
2588Warn when overload resolution chooses a promotion from unsigned or
2589enumerated type to a signed type, over a conversion to an unsigned type of
2590the same size.  Previous versions of G++ would try to preserve
2591unsignedness, but the standard mandates the current behavior.
2592
2593@smallexample
2594struct A @{
2595  operator int ();
2596  A& operator = (int);
2597@};
2598
2599main ()
2600@{
2601  A a,b;
2602  a = b;
2603@}
2604@end smallexample
2605
2606In this example, G++ will synthesize a default @samp{A& operator =
2607(const A&);}, while cfront will use the user-defined @samp{operator =}.
2608@end table
2609
2610@node Objective-C and Objective-C++ Dialect Options
2611@section Options Controlling Objective-C and Objective-C++ Dialects
2612
2613@cindex compiler options, Objective-C and Objective-C++
2614@cindex Objective-C and Objective-C++ options, command-line
2615@cindex options, Objective-C and Objective-C++
2616(NOTE: This manual does not describe the Objective-C and Objective-C++
2617languages themselves.  @xref{Standards,,Language Standards
2618Supported by GCC}, for references.)
2619
2620This section describes the command-line options that are only meaningful
2621for Objective-C and Objective-C++ programs, but you can also use most of
2622the language-independent GNU compiler options.
2623For example, you might compile a file @code{some_class.m} like this:
2624
2625@smallexample
2626gcc -g -fgnu-runtime -O -c some_class.m
2627@end smallexample
2628
2629@noindent
2630In this example, @option{-fgnu-runtime} is an option meant only for
2631Objective-C and Objective-C++ programs; you can use the other options with
2632any language supported by GCC@.
2633
2634Note that since Objective-C is an extension of the C language, Objective-C
2635compilations may also use options specific to the C front-end (e.g.,
2636@option{-Wtraditional}).  Similarly, Objective-C++ compilations may use
2637C++-specific options (e.g., @option{-Wabi}).
2638
2639Here is a list of options that are @emph{only} for compiling Objective-C
2640and Objective-C++ programs:
2641
2642@table @gcctabopt
2643@item -fconstant-string-class=@var{class-name}
2644@opindex fconstant-string-class
2645Use @var{class-name} as the name of the class to instantiate for each
2646literal string specified with the syntax @code{@@"@dots{}"}.  The default
2647class name is @code{NXConstantString} if the GNU runtime is being used, and
2648@code{NSConstantString} if the NeXT runtime is being used (see below).  The
2649@option{-fconstant-cfstrings} option, if also present, will override the
2650@option{-fconstant-string-class} setting and cause @code{@@"@dots{}"} literals
2651to be laid out as constant CoreFoundation strings.
2652
2653@item -fgnu-runtime
2654@opindex fgnu-runtime
2655Generate object code compatible with the standard GNU Objective-C
2656runtime.  This is the default for most types of systems.
2657
2658@item -fnext-runtime
2659@opindex fnext-runtime
2660Generate output compatible with the NeXT runtime.  This is the default
2661for NeXT-based systems, including Darwin and Mac OS X@.  The macro
2662@code{__NEXT_RUNTIME__} is predefined if (and only if) this option is
2663used.
2664
2665@item -fno-nil-receivers
2666@opindex fno-nil-receivers
2667Assume that all Objective-C message dispatches (@code{[receiver
2668message:arg]}) in this translation unit ensure that the receiver is
2669not @code{nil}.  This allows for more efficient entry points in the
2670runtime to be used.  This option is only available in conjunction with
2671the NeXT runtime and ABI version 0 or 1.
2672
2673@item -fobjc-abi-version=@var{n}
2674@opindex fobjc-abi-version
2675Use version @var{n} of the Objective-C ABI for the selected runtime.
2676This option is currently supported only for the NeXT runtime.  In that
2677case, Version 0 is the traditional (32-bit) ABI without support for
2678properties and other Objective-C 2.0 additions.  Version 1 is the
2679traditional (32-bit) ABI with support for properties and other
2680Objective-C 2.0 additions.  Version 2 is the modern (64-bit) ABI.  If
2681nothing is specified, the default is Version 0 on 32-bit target
2682machines, and Version 2 on 64-bit target machines.
2683
2684@item -fobjc-call-cxx-cdtors
2685@opindex fobjc-call-cxx-cdtors
2686For each Objective-C class, check if any of its instance variables is a
2687C++ object with a non-trivial default constructor.  If so, synthesize a
2688special @code{- (id) .cxx_construct} instance method which will run
2689non-trivial default constructors on any such instance variables, in order,
2690and then return @code{self}.  Similarly, check if any instance variable
2691is a C++ object with a non-trivial destructor, and if so, synthesize a
2692special @code{- (void) .cxx_destruct} method which will run
2693all such default destructors, in reverse order.
2694
2695The @code{- (id) .cxx_construct} and @code{- (void) .cxx_destruct}
2696methods thusly generated will only operate on instance variables
2697declared in the current Objective-C class, and not those inherited
2698from superclasses.  It is the responsibility of the Objective-C
2699runtime to invoke all such methods in an object's inheritance
2700hierarchy.  The @code{- (id) .cxx_construct} methods will be invoked
2701by the runtime immediately after a new object instance is allocated;
2702the @code{- (void) .cxx_destruct} methods will be invoked immediately
2703before the runtime deallocates an object instance.
2704
2705As of this writing, only the NeXT runtime on Mac OS X 10.4 and later has
2706support for invoking the @code{- (id) .cxx_construct} and
2707@code{- (void) .cxx_destruct} methods.
2708
2709@item -fobjc-direct-dispatch
2710@opindex fobjc-direct-dispatch
2711Allow fast jumps to the message dispatcher.  On Darwin this is
2712accomplished via the comm page.
2713
2714@item -fobjc-exceptions
2715@opindex fobjc-exceptions
2716Enable syntactic support for structured exception handling in
2717Objective-C, similar to what is offered by C++ and Java.  This option
2718is required to use the Objective-C keywords @code{@@try},
2719@code{@@throw}, @code{@@catch}, @code{@@finally} and
2720@code{@@synchronized}.  This option is available with both the GNU
2721runtime and the NeXT runtime (but not available in conjunction with
2722the NeXT runtime on Mac OS X 10.2 and earlier).
2723
2724@item -fobjc-gc
2725@opindex fobjc-gc
2726Enable garbage collection (GC) in Objective-C and Objective-C++
2727programs.  This option is only available with the NeXT runtime; the
2728GNU runtime has a different garbage collection implementation that
2729does not require special compiler flags.
2730
2731@item -fobjc-nilcheck
2732@opindex fobjc-nilcheck
2733For the NeXT runtime with version 2 of the ABI, check for a nil
2734receiver in method invocations before doing the actual method call.
2735This is the default and can be disabled using
2736@option{-fno-objc-nilcheck}.  Class methods and super calls are never
2737checked for nil in this way no matter what this flag is set to.
2738Currently this flag does nothing when the GNU runtime, or an older
2739version of the NeXT runtime ABI, is used.
2740
2741@item -fobjc-std=objc1
2742@opindex fobjc-std
2743Conform to the language syntax of Objective-C 1.0, the language
2744recognized by GCC 4.0.  This only affects the Objective-C additions to
2745the C/C++ language; it does not affect conformance to C/C++ standards,
2746which is controlled by the separate C/C++ dialect option flags.  When
2747this option is used with the Objective-C or Objective-C++ compiler,
2748any Objective-C syntax that is not recognized by GCC 4.0 is rejected.
2749This is useful if you need to make sure that your Objective-C code can
2750be compiled with older versions of GCC.
2751
2752@item -freplace-objc-classes
2753@opindex freplace-objc-classes
2754Emit a special marker instructing @command{ld(1)} not to statically link in
2755the resulting object file, and allow @command{dyld(1)} to load it in at
2756run time instead.  This is used in conjunction with the Fix-and-Continue
2757debugging mode, where the object file in question may be recompiled and
2758dynamically reloaded in the course of program execution, without the need
2759to restart the program itself.  Currently, Fix-and-Continue functionality
2760is only available in conjunction with the NeXT runtime on Mac OS X 10.3
2761and later.
2762
2763@item -fzero-link
2764@opindex fzero-link
2765When compiling for the NeXT runtime, the compiler ordinarily replaces calls
2766to @code{objc_getClass("@dots{}")} (when the name of the class is known at
2767compile time) with static class references that get initialized at load time,
2768which improves run-time performance.  Specifying the @option{-fzero-link} flag
2769suppresses this behavior and causes calls to @code{objc_getClass("@dots{}")}
2770to be retained.  This is useful in Zero-Link debugging mode, since it allows
2771for individual class implementations to be modified during program execution.
2772The GNU runtime currently always retains calls to @code{objc_get_class("@dots{}")}
2773regardless of command-line options.
2774
2775@item -gen-decls
2776@opindex gen-decls
2777Dump interface declarations for all classes seen in the source file to a
2778file named @file{@var{sourcename}.decl}.
2779
2780@item -Wassign-intercept @r{(Objective-C and Objective-C++ only)}
2781@opindex Wassign-intercept
2782@opindex Wno-assign-intercept
2783Warn whenever an Objective-C assignment is being intercepted by the
2784garbage collector.
2785
2786@item -Wno-protocol @r{(Objective-C and Objective-C++ only)}
2787@opindex Wno-protocol
2788@opindex Wprotocol
2789If a class is declared to implement a protocol, a warning is issued for
2790every method in the protocol that is not implemented by the class.  The
2791default behavior is to issue a warning for every method not explicitly
2792implemented in the class, even if a method implementation is inherited
2793from the superclass.  If you use the @option{-Wno-protocol} option, then
2794methods inherited from the superclass are considered to be implemented,
2795and no warning is issued for them.
2796
2797@item -Wselector @r{(Objective-C and Objective-C++ only)}
2798@opindex Wselector
2799@opindex Wno-selector
2800Warn if multiple methods of different types for the same selector are
2801found during compilation.  The check is performed on the list of methods
2802in the final stage of compilation.  Additionally, a check is performed
2803for each selector appearing in a @code{@@selector(@dots{})}
2804expression, and a corresponding method for that selector has been found
2805during compilation.  Because these checks scan the method table only at
2806the end of compilation, these warnings are not produced if the final
2807stage of compilation is not reached, for example because an error is
2808found during compilation, or because the @option{-fsyntax-only} option is
2809being used.
2810
2811@item -Wstrict-selector-match @r{(Objective-C and Objective-C++ only)}
2812@opindex Wstrict-selector-match
2813@opindex Wno-strict-selector-match
2814Warn if multiple methods with differing argument and/or return types are
2815found for a given selector when attempting to send a message using this
2816selector to a receiver of type @code{id} or @code{Class}.  When this flag
2817is off (which is the default behavior), the compiler will omit such warnings
2818if any differences found are confined to types that share the same size
2819and alignment.
2820
2821@item -Wundeclared-selector @r{(Objective-C and Objective-C++ only)}
2822@opindex Wundeclared-selector
2823@opindex Wno-undeclared-selector
2824Warn if a @code{@@selector(@dots{})} expression referring to an
2825undeclared selector is found.  A selector is considered undeclared if no
2826method with that name has been declared before the
2827@code{@@selector(@dots{})} expression, either explicitly in an
2828@code{@@interface} or @code{@@protocol} declaration, or implicitly in
2829an @code{@@implementation} section.  This option always performs its
2830checks as soon as a @code{@@selector(@dots{})} expression is found,
2831while @option{-Wselector} only performs its checks in the final stage of
2832compilation.  This also enforces the coding style convention
2833that methods and selectors must be declared before being used.
2834
2835@item -print-objc-runtime-info
2836@opindex print-objc-runtime-info
2837Generate C header describing the largest structure that is passed by
2838value, if any.
2839
2840@end table
2841
2842@node Language Independent Options
2843@section Options to Control Diagnostic Messages Formatting
2844@cindex options to control diagnostics formatting
2845@cindex diagnostic messages
2846@cindex message formatting
2847
2848Traditionally, diagnostic messages have been formatted irrespective of
2849the output device's aspect (e.g.@: its width, @dots{}).  The options described
2850below can be used to control the diagnostic messages formatting
2851algorithm, e.g.@: how many characters per line, how often source location
2852information should be reported.  Right now, only the C++ front end can
2853honor these options.  However it is expected, in the near future, that
2854the remaining front ends would be able to digest them correctly.
2855
2856@table @gcctabopt
2857@item -fmessage-length=@var{n}
2858@opindex fmessage-length
2859Try to format error messages so that they fit on lines of about @var{n}
2860characters.  The default is 72 characters for @command{g++} and 0 for the rest of
2861the front ends supported by GCC@.  If @var{n} is zero, then no
2862line-wrapping will be done; each error message will appear on a single
2863line.
2864
2865@opindex fdiagnostics-show-location
2866@item -fdiagnostics-show-location=once
2867Only meaningful in line-wrapping mode.  Instructs the diagnostic messages
2868reporter to emit @emph{once} source location information; that is, in
2869case the message is too long to fit on a single physical line and has to
2870be wrapped, the source location won't be emitted (as prefix) again,
2871over and over, in subsequent continuation lines.  This is the default
2872behavior.
2873
2874@item -fdiagnostics-show-location=every-line
2875Only meaningful in line-wrapping mode.  Instructs the diagnostic
2876messages reporter to emit the same source location information (as
2877prefix) for physical lines that result from the process of breaking
2878a message which is too long to fit on a single line.
2879
2880@item -fno-diagnostics-show-option
2881@opindex fno-diagnostics-show-option
2882@opindex fdiagnostics-show-option
2883By default, each diagnostic emitted includes text indicating the
2884command-line option that directly controls the diagnostic (if such an
2885option is known to the diagnostic machinery).  Specifying the
2886@option{-fno-diagnostics-show-option} flag suppresses that behavior.
2887
2888@end table
2889
2890@node Warning Options
2891@section Options to Request or Suppress Warnings
2892@cindex options to control warnings
2893@cindex warning messages
2894@cindex messages, warning
2895@cindex suppressing warnings
2896
2897Warnings are diagnostic messages that report constructions that
2898are not inherently erroneous but that are risky or suggest there
2899may have been an error.
2900
2901The following language-independent options do not enable specific
2902warnings but control the kinds of diagnostics produced by GCC.
2903
2904@table @gcctabopt
2905@cindex syntax checking
2906@item -fsyntax-only
2907@opindex fsyntax-only
2908Check the code for syntax errors, but don't do anything beyond that.
2909
2910@item -fmax-errors=@var{n}
2911@opindex fmax-errors
2912Limits the maximum number of error messages to @var{n}, at which point
2913GCC bails out rather than attempting to continue processing the source
2914code.  If @var{n} is 0 (the default), there is no limit on the number
2915of error messages produced.  If @option{-Wfatal-errors} is also
2916specified, then @option{-Wfatal-errors} takes precedence over this
2917option.
2918
2919@item -w
2920@opindex w
2921Inhibit all warning messages.
2922
2923@item -Werror
2924@opindex Werror
2925@opindex Wno-error
2926Make all warnings into errors.
2927
2928@item -Werror=
2929@opindex Werror=
2930@opindex Wno-error=
2931Make the specified warning into an error.  The specifier for a warning
2932is appended, for example @option{-Werror=switch} turns the warnings
2933controlled by @option{-Wswitch} into errors.  This switch takes a
2934negative form, to be used to negate @option{-Werror} for specific
2935warnings, for example @option{-Wno-error=switch} makes
2936@option{-Wswitch} warnings not be errors, even when @option{-Werror}
2937is in effect.
2938
2939The warning message for each controllable warning includes the
2940option that controls the warning.  That option can then be used with
2941@option{-Werror=} and @option{-Wno-error=} as described above.
2942(Printing of the option in the warning message can be disabled using the
2943@option{-fno-diagnostics-show-option} flag.)
2944
2945Note that specifying @option{-Werror=}@var{foo} automatically implies
2946@option{-W}@var{foo}.  However, @option{-Wno-error=}@var{foo} does not
2947imply anything.
2948
2949@item -Wfatal-errors
2950@opindex Wfatal-errors
2951@opindex Wno-fatal-errors
2952This option causes the compiler to abort compilation on the first error
2953occurred rather than trying to keep going and printing further error
2954messages.
2955
2956@end table
2957
2958You can request many specific warnings with options beginning
2959@samp{-W}, for example @option{-Wimplicit} to request warnings on
2960implicit declarations.  Each of these specific warning options also
2961has a negative form beginning @samp{-Wno-} to turn off warnings; for
2962example, @option{-Wno-implicit}.  This manual lists only one of the
2963two forms, whichever is not the default.  For further,
2964language-specific options also refer to @ref{C++ Dialect Options} and
2965@ref{Objective-C and Objective-C++ Dialect Options}.
2966
2967When an unrecognized warning option is requested (e.g.,
2968@option{-Wunknown-warning}), GCC will emit a diagnostic stating
2969that the option is not recognized.  However, if the @option{-Wno-} form
2970is used, the behavior is slightly different: No diagnostic will be
2971produced for @option{-Wno-unknown-warning} unless other diagnostics
2972are being produced.  This allows the use of new @option{-Wno-} options
2973with old compilers, but if something goes wrong, the compiler will
2974warn that an unrecognized option was used.
2975
2976@table @gcctabopt
2977@item -pedantic
2978@opindex pedantic
2979Issue all the warnings demanded by strict ISO C and ISO C++;
2980reject all programs that use forbidden extensions, and some other
2981programs that do not follow ISO C and ISO C++.  For ISO C, follows the
2982version of the ISO C standard specified by any @option{-std} option used.
2983
2984Valid ISO C and ISO C++ programs should compile properly with or without
2985this option (though a rare few will require @option{-ansi} or a
2986@option{-std} option specifying the required version of ISO C)@.  However,
2987without this option, certain GNU extensions and traditional C and C++
2988features are supported as well.  With this option, they are rejected.
2989
2990@option{-pedantic} does not cause warning messages for use of the
2991alternate keywords whose names begin and end with @samp{__}.  Pedantic
2992warnings are also disabled in the expression that follows
2993@code{__extension__}.  However, only system header files should use
2994these escape routes; application programs should avoid them.
2995@xref{Alternate Keywords}.
2996
2997Some users try to use @option{-pedantic} to check programs for strict ISO
2998C conformance.  They soon find that it does not do quite what they want:
2999it finds some non-ISO practices, but not all---only those for which
3000ISO C @emph{requires} a diagnostic, and some others for which
3001diagnostics have been added.
3002
3003A feature to report any failure to conform to ISO C might be useful in
3004some instances, but would require considerable additional work and would
3005be quite different from @option{-pedantic}.  We don't have plans to
3006support such a feature in the near future.
3007
3008Where the standard specified with @option{-std} represents a GNU
3009extended dialect of C, such as @samp{gnu90} or @samp{gnu99}, there is a
3010corresponding @dfn{base standard}, the version of ISO C on which the GNU
3011extended dialect is based.  Warnings from @option{-pedantic} are given
3012where they are required by the base standard.  (It would not make sense
3013for such warnings to be given only for features not in the specified GNU
3014C dialect, since by definition the GNU dialects of C include all
3015features the compiler supports with the given option, and there would be
3016nothing to warn about.)
3017
3018@item -pedantic-errors
3019@opindex pedantic-errors
3020Like @option{-pedantic}, except that errors are produced rather than
3021warnings.
3022
3023@item -Wall
3024@opindex Wall
3025@opindex Wno-all
3026This enables all the warnings about constructions that some users
3027consider questionable, and that are easy to avoid (or modify to
3028prevent the warning), even in conjunction with macros.  This also
3029enables some language-specific warnings described in @ref{C++ Dialect
3030Options} and @ref{Objective-C and Objective-C++ Dialect Options}.
3031
3032@option{-Wall} turns on the following warning flags:
3033
3034@gccoptlist{-Waddress   @gol
3035-Warray-bounds @r{(only with} @option{-O2}@r{)}  @gol
3036-Wc++11-compat  @gol
3037-Wchar-subscripts  @gol
3038-Wenum-compare @r{(in C/Objc; this is on by default in C++)} @gol
3039-Wimplicit-int @r{(C and Objective-C only)} @gol
3040-Wimplicit-function-declaration @r{(C and Objective-C only)} @gol
3041-Wcomment  @gol
3042-Wformat   @gol
3043-Wmain @r{(only for C/ObjC and unless} @option{-ffreestanding}@r{)}  @gol
3044-Wmaybe-uninitialized @gol
3045-Wmissing-braces  @gol
3046-Wnonnull  @gol
3047-Wparentheses  @gol
3048-Wpointer-sign  @gol
3049-Wreorder   @gol
3050-Wreturn-type  @gol
3051-Wsequence-point  @gol
3052-Wsign-compare @r{(only in C++)}  @gol
3053-Wstrict-aliasing  @gol
3054-Wstrict-overflow=1  @gol
3055-Wswitch  @gol
3056-Wtrigraphs  @gol
3057-Wuninitialized  @gol
3058-Wunknown-pragmas  @gol
3059-Wunused-function  @gol
3060-Wunused-label     @gol
3061-Wunused-value     @gol
3062-Wunused-variable  @gol
3063-Wvolatile-register-var @gol
3064}
3065
3066Note that some warning flags are not implied by @option{-Wall}.  Some of
3067them warn about constructions that users generally do not consider
3068questionable, but which occasionally you might wish to check for;
3069others warn about constructions that are necessary or hard to avoid in
3070some cases, and there is no simple way to modify the code to suppress
3071the warning. Some of them are enabled by @option{-Wextra} but many of
3072them must be enabled individually.
3073
3074@item -Wextra
3075@opindex W
3076@opindex Wextra
3077@opindex Wno-extra
3078This enables some extra warning flags that are not enabled by
3079@option{-Wall}. (This option used to be called @option{-W}.  The older
3080name is still supported, but the newer name is more descriptive.)
3081
3082@gccoptlist{-Wclobbered  @gol
3083-Wempty-body  @gol
3084-Wignored-qualifiers @gol
3085-Wmissing-field-initializers  @gol
3086-Wmissing-parameter-type @r{(C only)}  @gol
3087-Wold-style-declaration @r{(C only)}  @gol
3088-Woverride-init  @gol
3089-Wsign-compare  @gol
3090-Wtype-limits  @gol
3091-Wuninitialized  @gol
3092-Wunused-parameter @r{(only with} @option{-Wunused} @r{or} @option{-Wall}@r{)} @gol
3093-Wunused-but-set-parameter @r{(only with} @option{-Wunused} @r{or} @option{-Wall}@r{)}  @gol
3094}
3095
3096The option @option{-Wextra} also prints warning messages for the
3097following cases:
3098
3099@itemize @bullet
3100
3101@item
3102A pointer is compared against integer zero with @samp{<}, @samp{<=},
3103@samp{>}, or @samp{>=}.
3104
3105@item
3106(C++ only) An enumerator and a non-enumerator both appear in a
3107conditional expression.
3108
3109@item
3110(C++ only) Ambiguous virtual bases.
3111
3112@item
3113(C++ only) Subscripting an array that has been declared @samp{register}.
3114
3115@item
3116(C++ only) Taking the address of a variable that has been declared
3117@samp{register}.
3118
3119@item
3120(C++ only) A base class is not initialized in a derived class' copy
3121constructor.
3122
3123@end itemize
3124
3125@item -Wchar-subscripts
3126@opindex Wchar-subscripts
3127@opindex Wno-char-subscripts
3128Warn if an array subscript has type @code{char}.  This is a common cause
3129of error, as programmers often forget that this type is signed on some
3130machines.
3131This warning is enabled by @option{-Wall}.
3132
3133@item -Wcomment
3134@opindex Wcomment
3135@opindex Wno-comment
3136Warn whenever a comment-start sequence @samp{/*} appears in a @samp{/*}
3137comment, or whenever a Backslash-Newline appears in a @samp{//} comment.
3138This warning is enabled by @option{-Wall}.
3139
3140@item -Wno-coverage-mismatch
3141@opindex Wno-coverage-mismatch
3142Warn if feedback profiles do not match when using the
3143@option{-fprofile-use} option.
3144If a source file was changed between @option{-fprofile-gen} and
3145@option{-fprofile-use}, the files with the profile feedback can fail
3146to match the source file and GCC cannot use the profile feedback
3147information.  By default, this warning is enabled and is treated as an
3148error.  @option{-Wno-coverage-mismatch} can be used to disable the
3149warning or @option{-Wno-error=coverage-mismatch} can be used to
3150disable the error.  Disabling the error for this warning can result in
3151poorly optimized code and is useful only in the
3152case of very minor changes such as bug fixes to an existing code-base.
3153Completely disabling the warning is not recommended.
3154
3155@item -Wno-cpp
3156@r{(C, Objective-C, C++, Objective-C++ and Fortran only)}
3157
3158Suppress warning messages emitted by @code{#warning} directives.
3159
3160@item -Wdouble-promotion @r{(C, C++, Objective-C and Objective-C++ only)}
3161@opindex Wdouble-promotion
3162@opindex Wno-double-promotion
3163Give a warning when a value of type @code{float} is implicitly
3164promoted to @code{double}.  CPUs with a 32-bit ``single-precision''
3165floating-point unit implement @code{float} in hardware, but emulate
3166@code{double} in software.  On such a machine, doing computations
3167using @code{double} values is much more expensive because of the
3168overhead required for software emulation.
3169
3170It is easy to accidentally do computations with @code{double} because
3171floating-point literals are implicitly of type @code{double}.  For
3172example, in:
3173@smallexample
3174@group
3175float area(float radius)
3176@{
3177   return 3.14159 * radius * radius;
3178@}
3179@end group
3180@end smallexample
3181the compiler will perform the entire computation with @code{double}
3182because the floating-point literal is a @code{double}.
3183
3184@item -Wformat
3185@opindex Wformat
3186@opindex Wno-format
3187@opindex ffreestanding
3188@opindex fno-builtin
3189Check calls to @code{printf} and @code{scanf}, etc., to make sure that
3190the arguments supplied have types appropriate to the format string
3191specified, and that the conversions specified in the format string make
3192sense.  This includes standard functions, and others specified by format
3193attributes (@pxref{Function Attributes}), in the @code{printf},
3194@code{scanf}, @code{strftime} and @code{strfmon} (an X/Open extension,
3195not in the C standard) families (or other target-specific families).
3196Which functions are checked without format attributes having been
3197specified depends on the standard version selected, and such checks of
3198functions without the attribute specified are disabled by
3199@option{-ffreestanding} or @option{-fno-builtin}.
3200
3201The formats are checked against the format features supported by GNU
3202libc version 2.2.  These include all ISO C90 and C99 features, as well
3203as features from the Single Unix Specification and some BSD and GNU
3204extensions.  Other library implementations may not support all these
3205features; GCC does not support warning about features that go beyond a
3206particular library's limitations.  However, if @option{-pedantic} is used
3207with @option{-Wformat}, warnings will be given about format features not
3208in the selected standard version (but not for @code{strfmon} formats,
3209since those are not in any version of the C standard).  @xref{C Dialect
3210Options,,Options Controlling C Dialect}.
3211
3212Since @option{-Wformat} also checks for null format arguments for
3213several functions, @option{-Wformat} also implies @option{-Wnonnull}.
3214
3215@option{-Wformat} is included in @option{-Wall}.  For more control over some
3216aspects of format checking, the options @option{-Wformat-y2k},
3217@option{-Wno-format-extra-args}, @option{-Wno-format-zero-length},
3218@option{-Wformat-nonliteral}, @option{-Wformat-security}, and
3219@option{-Wformat=2} are available, but are not included in @option{-Wall}.
3220
3221@item -Wformat-y2k
3222@opindex Wformat-y2k
3223@opindex Wno-format-y2k
3224If @option{-Wformat} is specified, also warn about @code{strftime}
3225formats that may yield only a two-digit year.
3226
3227@item -Wno-format-contains-nul
3228@opindex Wno-format-contains-nul
3229@opindex Wformat-contains-nul
3230If @option{-Wformat} is specified, do not warn about format strings that
3231contain NUL bytes.
3232
3233@item -Wno-format-extra-args
3234@opindex Wno-format-extra-args
3235@opindex Wformat-extra-args
3236If @option{-Wformat} is specified, do not warn about excess arguments to a
3237@code{printf} or @code{scanf} format function.  The C standard specifies
3238that such arguments are ignored.
3239
3240Where the unused arguments lie between used arguments that are
3241specified with @samp{$} operand number specifications, normally
3242warnings are still given, since the implementation could not know what
3243type to pass to @code{va_arg} to skip the unused arguments.  However,
3244in the case of @code{scanf} formats, this option will suppress the
3245warning if the unused arguments are all pointers, since the Single
3246Unix Specification says that such unused arguments are allowed.
3247
3248@item -Wno-format-zero-length
3249@opindex Wno-format-zero-length
3250@opindex Wformat-zero-length
3251If @option{-Wformat} is specified, do not warn about zero-length formats.
3252The C standard specifies that zero-length formats are allowed.
3253
3254@item -Wformat-nonliteral
3255@opindex Wformat-nonliteral
3256@opindex Wno-format-nonliteral
3257If @option{-Wformat} is specified, also warn if the format string is not a
3258string literal and so cannot be checked, unless the format function
3259takes its format arguments as a @code{va_list}.
3260
3261@item -Wformat-security
3262@opindex Wformat-security
3263@opindex Wno-format-security
3264If @option{-Wformat} is specified, also warn about uses of format
3265functions that represent possible security problems.  At present, this
3266warns about calls to @code{printf} and @code{scanf} functions where the
3267format string is not a string literal and there are no format arguments,
3268as in @code{printf (foo);}.  This may be a security hole if the format
3269string came from untrusted input and contains @samp{%n}.  (This is
3270currently a subset of what @option{-Wformat-nonliteral} warns about, but
3271in future warnings may be added to @option{-Wformat-security} that are not
3272included in @option{-Wformat-nonliteral}.)
3273
3274@item -Wformat=2
3275@opindex Wformat=2
3276@opindex Wno-format=2
3277Enable @option{-Wformat} plus format checks not included in
3278@option{-Wformat}.  Currently equivalent to @samp{-Wformat
3279-Wformat-nonliteral -Wformat-security -Wformat-y2k}.
3280
3281@item -Wnonnull
3282@opindex Wnonnull
3283@opindex Wno-nonnull
3284Warn about passing a null pointer for arguments marked as
3285requiring a non-null value by the @code{nonnull} function attribute.
3286
3287@option{-Wnonnull} is included in @option{-Wall} and @option{-Wformat}.  It
3288can be disabled with the @option{-Wno-nonnull} option.
3289
3290@item -Winit-self @r{(C, C++, Objective-C and Objective-C++ only)}
3291@opindex Winit-self
3292@opindex Wno-init-self
3293Warn about uninitialized variables that are initialized with themselves.
3294Note this option can only be used with the @option{-Wuninitialized} option.
3295
3296For example, GCC will warn about @code{i} being uninitialized in the
3297following snippet only when @option{-Winit-self} has been specified:
3298@smallexample
3299@group
3300int f()
3301@{
3302  int i = i;
3303  return i;
3304@}
3305@end group
3306@end smallexample
3307
3308@item -Wimplicit-int @r{(C and Objective-C only)}
3309@opindex Wimplicit-int
3310@opindex Wno-implicit-int
3311Warn when a declaration does not specify a type.
3312This warning is enabled by @option{-Wall}.
3313
3314@item -Wimplicit-function-declaration @r{(C and Objective-C only)}
3315@opindex Wimplicit-function-declaration
3316@opindex Wno-implicit-function-declaration
3317Give a warning whenever a function is used before being declared. In
3318C99 mode (@option{-std=c99} or @option{-std=gnu99}), this warning is
3319enabled by default and it is made into an error by
3320@option{-pedantic-errors}. This warning is also enabled by
3321@option{-Wall}.
3322
3323@item -Wimplicit @r{(C and Objective-C only)}
3324@opindex Wimplicit
3325@opindex Wno-implicit
3326Same as @option{-Wimplicit-int} and @option{-Wimplicit-function-declaration}.
3327This warning is enabled by @option{-Wall}.
3328
3329@item -Wignored-qualifiers @r{(C and C++ only)}
3330@opindex Wignored-qualifiers
3331@opindex Wno-ignored-qualifiers
3332Warn if the return type of a function has a type qualifier
3333such as @code{const}.  For ISO C such a type qualifier has no effect,
3334since the value returned by a function is not an lvalue.
3335For C++, the warning is only emitted for scalar types or @code{void}.
3336ISO C prohibits qualified @code{void} return types on function
3337definitions, so such return types always receive a warning
3338even without this option.
3339
3340This warning is also enabled by @option{-Wextra}.
3341
3342@item -Wmain
3343@opindex Wmain
3344@opindex Wno-main
3345Warn if the type of @samp{main} is suspicious.  @samp{main} should be
3346a function with external linkage, returning int, taking either zero
3347arguments, two, or three arguments of appropriate types.  This warning
3348is enabled by default in C++ and is enabled by either @option{-Wall}
3349or @option{-pedantic}.
3350
3351@item -Wmissing-braces
3352@opindex Wmissing-braces
3353@opindex Wno-missing-braces
3354Warn if an aggregate or union initializer is not fully bracketed.  In
3355the following example, the initializer for @samp{a} is not fully
3356bracketed, but that for @samp{b} is fully bracketed.
3357
3358@smallexample
3359int a[2][2] = @{ 0, 1, 2, 3 @};
3360int b[2][2] = @{ @{ 0, 1 @}, @{ 2, 3 @} @};
3361@end smallexample
3362
3363This warning is enabled by @option{-Wall}.
3364
3365@item -Wmissing-include-dirs @r{(C, C++, Objective-C and Objective-C++ only)}
3366@opindex Wmissing-include-dirs
3367@opindex Wno-missing-include-dirs
3368Warn if a user-supplied include directory does not exist.
3369
3370@item -Wparentheses
3371@opindex Wparentheses
3372@opindex Wno-parentheses
3373Warn if parentheses are omitted in certain contexts, such
3374as when there is an assignment in a context where a truth value
3375is expected, or when operators are nested whose precedence people
3376often get confused about.
3377
3378Also warn if a comparison like @samp{x<=y<=z} appears; this is
3379equivalent to @samp{(x<=y ? 1 : 0) <= z}, which is a different
3380interpretation from that of ordinary mathematical notation.
3381
3382Also warn about constructions where there may be confusion to which
3383@code{if} statement an @code{else} branch belongs.  Here is an example of
3384such a case:
3385
3386@smallexample
3387@group
3388@{
3389  if (a)
3390    if (b)
3391      foo ();
3392  else
3393    bar ();
3394@}
3395@end group
3396@end smallexample
3397
3398In C/C++, every @code{else} branch belongs to the innermost possible
3399@code{if} statement, which in this example is @code{if (b)}.  This is
3400often not what the programmer expected, as illustrated in the above
3401example by indentation the programmer chose.  When there is the
3402potential for this confusion, GCC will issue a warning when this flag
3403is specified.  To eliminate the warning, add explicit braces around
3404the innermost @code{if} statement so there is no way the @code{else}
3405could belong to the enclosing @code{if}.  The resulting code would
3406look like this:
3407
3408@smallexample
3409@group
3410@{
3411  if (a)
3412    @{
3413      if (b)
3414        foo ();
3415      else
3416        bar ();
3417    @}
3418@}
3419@end group
3420@end smallexample
3421
3422Also warn for dangerous uses of the
3423?: with omitted middle operand GNU extension. When the condition
3424in the ?: operator is a boolean expression the omitted value will
3425be always 1. Often the user expects it to be a value computed
3426inside the conditional expression instead.
3427
3428This warning is enabled by @option{-Wall}.
3429
3430@item -Wsequence-point
3431@opindex Wsequence-point
3432@opindex Wno-sequence-point
3433Warn about code that may have undefined semantics because of violations
3434of sequence point rules in the C and C++ standards.
3435
3436The C and C++ standards defines the order in which expressions in a C/C++
3437program are evaluated in terms of @dfn{sequence points}, which represent
3438a partial ordering between the execution of parts of the program: those
3439executed before the sequence point, and those executed after it.  These
3440occur after the evaluation of a full expression (one which is not part
3441of a larger expression), after the evaluation of the first operand of a
3442@code{&&}, @code{||}, @code{? :} or @code{,} (comma) operator, before a
3443function is called (but after the evaluation of its arguments and the
3444expression denoting the called function), and in certain other places.
3445Other than as expressed by the sequence point rules, the order of
3446evaluation of subexpressions of an expression is not specified.  All
3447these rules describe only a partial order rather than a total order,
3448since, for example, if two functions are called within one expression
3449with no sequence point between them, the order in which the functions
3450are called is not specified.  However, the standards committee have
3451ruled that function calls do not overlap.
3452
3453It is not specified when between sequence points modifications to the
3454values of objects take effect.  Programs whose behavior depends on this
3455have undefined behavior; the C and C++ standards specify that ``Between
3456the previous and next sequence point an object shall have its stored
3457value modified at most once by the evaluation of an expression.
3458Furthermore, the prior value shall be read only to determine the value
3459to be stored.''.  If a program breaks these rules, the results on any
3460particular implementation are entirely unpredictable.
3461
3462Examples of code with undefined behavior are @code{a = a++;}, @code{a[n]
3463= b[n++]} and @code{a[i++] = i;}.  Some more complicated cases are not
3464diagnosed by this option, and it may give an occasional false positive
3465result, but in general it has been found fairly effective at detecting
3466this sort of problem in programs.
3467
3468The standard is worded confusingly, therefore there is some debate
3469over the precise meaning of the sequence point rules in subtle cases.
3470Links to discussions of the problem, including proposed formal
3471definitions, may be found on the GCC readings page, at
3472@uref{http://gcc.gnu.org/@/readings.html}.
3473
3474This warning is enabled by @option{-Wall} for C and C++.
3475
3476@item -Wreturn-type
3477@opindex Wreturn-type
3478@opindex Wno-return-type
3479Warn whenever a function is defined with a return-type that defaults
3480to @code{int}.  Also warn about any @code{return} statement with no
3481return-value in a function whose return-type is not @code{void}
3482(falling off the end of the function body is considered returning
3483without a value), and about a @code{return} statement with an
3484expression in a function whose return-type is @code{void}.
3485
3486For C++, a function without return type always produces a diagnostic
3487message, even when @option{-Wno-return-type} is specified.  The only
3488exceptions are @samp{main} and functions defined in system headers.
3489
3490This warning is enabled by @option{-Wall}.
3491
3492@item -Wswitch
3493@opindex Wswitch
3494@opindex Wno-switch
3495Warn whenever a @code{switch} statement has an index of enumerated type
3496and lacks a @code{case} for one or more of the named codes of that
3497enumeration.  (The presence of a @code{default} label prevents this
3498warning.)  @code{case} labels outside the enumeration range also
3499provoke warnings when this option is used (even if there is a
3500@code{default} label).
3501This warning is enabled by @option{-Wall}.
3502
3503@item -Wswitch-default
3504@opindex Wswitch-default
3505@opindex Wno-switch-default
3506Warn whenever a @code{switch} statement does not have a @code{default}
3507case.
3508
3509@item -Wswitch-enum
3510@opindex Wswitch-enum
3511@opindex Wno-switch-enum
3512Warn whenever a @code{switch} statement has an index of enumerated type
3513and lacks a @code{case} for one or more of the named codes of that
3514enumeration.  @code{case} labels outside the enumeration range also
3515provoke warnings when this option is used.  The only difference
3516between @option{-Wswitch} and this option is that this option gives a
3517warning about an omitted enumeration code even if there is a
3518@code{default} label.
3519
3520@item -Wsync-nand @r{(C and C++ only)}
3521@opindex Wsync-nand
3522@opindex Wno-sync-nand
3523Warn when @code{__sync_fetch_and_nand} and @code{__sync_nand_and_fetch}
3524built-in functions are used.  These functions changed semantics in GCC 4.4.
3525
3526@item -Wtrigraphs
3527@opindex Wtrigraphs
3528@opindex Wno-trigraphs
3529Warn if any trigraphs are encountered that might change the meaning of
3530the program (trigraphs within comments are not warned about).
3531This warning is enabled by @option{-Wall}.
3532
3533@item -Wunused-but-set-parameter
3534@opindex Wunused-but-set-parameter
3535@opindex Wno-unused-but-set-parameter
3536Warn whenever a function parameter is assigned to, but otherwise unused
3537(aside from its declaration).
3538
3539To suppress this warning use the @samp{unused} attribute
3540(@pxref{Variable Attributes}).
3541
3542This warning is also enabled by @option{-Wunused} together with
3543@option{-Wextra}.
3544
3545@item -Wunused-but-set-variable
3546@opindex Wunused-but-set-variable
3547@opindex Wno-unused-but-set-variable
3548Warn whenever a local variable is assigned to, but otherwise unused
3549(aside from its declaration).
3550This warning is enabled by @option{-Wall}.
3551
3552To suppress this warning use the @samp{unused} attribute
3553(@pxref{Variable Attributes}).
3554
3555This warning is also enabled by @option{-Wunused}, which is enabled
3556by @option{-Wall}.
3557
3558@item -Wunused-function
3559@opindex Wunused-function
3560@opindex Wno-unused-function
3561Warn whenever a static function is declared but not defined or a
3562non-inline static function is unused.
3563This warning is enabled by @option{-Wall}.
3564
3565@item -Wunused-label
3566@opindex Wunused-label
3567@opindex Wno-unused-label
3568Warn whenever a label is declared but not used.
3569This warning is enabled by @option{-Wall}.
3570
3571To suppress this warning use the @samp{unused} attribute
3572(@pxref{Variable Attributes}).
3573
3574@item -Wunused-local-typedefs @r{(C, Objective-C, C++ and Objective-C++ only)}
3575@opindex Wunused-local-typedefs
3576Warn when a typedef locally defined in a function is not used.
3577
3578@item -Wunused-parameter
3579@opindex Wunused-parameter
3580@opindex Wno-unused-parameter
3581Warn whenever a function parameter is unused aside from its declaration.
3582
3583To suppress this warning use the @samp{unused} attribute
3584(@pxref{Variable Attributes}).
3585
3586@item -Wno-unused-result
3587@opindex Wunused-result
3588@opindex Wno-unused-result
3589Do not warn if a caller of a function marked with attribute
3590@code{warn_unused_result} (@pxref{Function Attributes}) does not use
3591its return value. The default is @option{-Wunused-result}.
3592
3593@item -Wunused-variable
3594@opindex Wunused-variable
3595@opindex Wno-unused-variable
3596Warn whenever a local variable or non-constant static variable is unused
3597aside from its declaration.
3598This warning is enabled by @option{-Wall}.
3599
3600To suppress this warning use the @samp{unused} attribute
3601(@pxref{Variable Attributes}).
3602
3603@item -Wunused-value
3604@opindex Wunused-value
3605@opindex Wno-unused-value
3606Warn whenever a statement computes a result that is explicitly not
3607used. To suppress this warning cast the unused expression to
3608@samp{void}. This includes an expression-statement or the left-hand
3609side of a comma expression that contains no side effects. For example,
3610an expression such as @samp{x[i,j]} will cause a warning, while
3611@samp{x[(void)i,j]} will not.
3612
3613This warning is enabled by @option{-Wall}.
3614
3615@item -Wunused
3616@opindex Wunused
3617@opindex Wno-unused
3618All the above @option{-Wunused} options combined.
3619
3620In order to get a warning about an unused function parameter, you must
3621either specify @samp{-Wextra -Wunused} (note that @samp{-Wall} implies
3622@samp{-Wunused}), or separately specify @option{-Wunused-parameter}.
3623
3624@item -Wuninitialized
3625@opindex Wuninitialized
3626@opindex Wno-uninitialized
3627Warn if an automatic variable is used without first being initialized
3628or if a variable may be clobbered by a @code{setjmp} call. In C++,
3629warn if a non-static reference or non-static @samp{const} member
3630appears in a class without constructors.
3631
3632If you want to warn about code that uses the uninitialized value of the
3633variable in its own initializer, use the @option{-Winit-self} option.
3634
3635These warnings occur for individual uninitialized or clobbered
3636elements of structure, union or array variables as well as for
3637variables that are uninitialized or clobbered as a whole.  They do
3638not occur for variables or elements declared @code{volatile}.  Because
3639these warnings depend on optimization, the exact variables or elements
3640for which there are warnings will depend on the precise optimization
3641options and version of GCC used.
3642
3643Note that there may be no warning about a variable that is used only
3644to compute a value that itself is never used, because such
3645computations may be deleted by data flow analysis before the warnings
3646are printed.
3647
3648@item -Wmaybe-uninitialized
3649@opindex Wmaybe-uninitialized
3650@opindex Wno-maybe-uninitialized
3651For an automatic variable, if there exists a path from the function
3652entry to a use of the variable that is initialized, but there exist
3653some other paths the variable is not initialized, the compiler will
3654emit a warning if it can not prove the uninitialized paths do not
3655happen at run time. These warnings are made optional because GCC is
3656not smart enough to see all the reasons why the code might be correct
3657despite appearing to have an error.  Here is one example of how
3658this can happen:
3659
3660@smallexample
3661@group
3662@{
3663  int x;
3664  switch (y)
3665    @{
3666    case 1: x = 1;
3667      break;
3668    case 2: x = 4;
3669      break;
3670    case 3: x = 5;
3671    @}
3672  foo (x);
3673@}
3674@end group
3675@end smallexample
3676
3677@noindent
3678If the value of @code{y} is always 1, 2 or 3, then @code{x} is
3679always initialized, but GCC doesn't know this. To suppress the
3680warning, the user needs to provide a default case with assert(0) or
3681similar code.
3682
3683@cindex @code{longjmp} warnings
3684This option also warns when a non-volatile automatic variable might be
3685changed by a call to @code{longjmp}.  These warnings as well are possible
3686only in optimizing compilation.
3687
3688The compiler sees only the calls to @code{setjmp}.  It cannot know
3689where @code{longjmp} will be called; in fact, a signal handler could
3690call it at any point in the code.  As a result, you may get a warning
3691even when there is in fact no problem because @code{longjmp} cannot
3692in fact be called at the place that would cause a problem.
3693
3694Some spurious warnings can be avoided if you declare all the functions
3695you use that never return as @code{noreturn}.  @xref{Function
3696Attributes}.
3697
3698This warning is enabled by @option{-Wall} or @option{-Wextra}.
3699
3700@item -Wunknown-pragmas
3701@opindex Wunknown-pragmas
3702@opindex Wno-unknown-pragmas
3703@cindex warning for unknown pragmas
3704@cindex unknown pragmas, warning
3705@cindex pragmas, warning of unknown
3706Warn when a @code{#pragma} directive is encountered that is not understood by
3707GCC@.  If this command-line option is used, warnings will even be issued
3708for unknown pragmas in system header files.  This is not the case if
3709the warnings were only enabled by the @option{-Wall} command-line option.
3710
3711@item -Wno-pragmas
3712@opindex Wno-pragmas
3713@opindex Wpragmas
3714Do not warn about misuses of pragmas, such as incorrect parameters,
3715invalid syntax, or conflicts between pragmas.  See also
3716@samp{-Wunknown-pragmas}.
3717
3718@item -Wstrict-aliasing
3719@opindex Wstrict-aliasing
3720@opindex Wno-strict-aliasing
3721This option is only active when @option{-fstrict-aliasing} is active.
3722It warns about code that might break the strict aliasing rules that the
3723compiler is using for optimization.  The warning does not catch all
3724cases, but does attempt to catch the more common pitfalls.  It is
3725included in @option{-Wall}.
3726It is equivalent to @option{-Wstrict-aliasing=3}
3727
3728@item -Wstrict-aliasing=n
3729@opindex Wstrict-aliasing=n
3730@opindex Wno-strict-aliasing=n
3731This option is only active when @option{-fstrict-aliasing} is active.
3732It warns about code that might break the strict aliasing rules that the
3733compiler is using for optimization.
3734Higher levels correspond to higher accuracy (fewer false positives).
3735Higher levels also correspond to more effort, similar to the way -O works.
3736@option{-Wstrict-aliasing} is equivalent to @option{-Wstrict-aliasing=n},
3737with n=3.
3738
3739Level 1: Most aggressive, quick, least accurate.
3740Possibly useful when higher levels
3741do not warn but -fstrict-aliasing still breaks the code, as it has very few
3742false negatives.  However, it has many false positives.
3743Warns for all pointer conversions between possibly incompatible types,
3744even if never dereferenced.  Runs in the front end only.
3745
3746Level 2: Aggressive, quick, not too precise.
3747May still have many false positives (not as many as level 1 though),
3748and few false negatives (but possibly more than level 1).
3749Unlike level 1, it only warns when an address is taken.  Warns about
3750incomplete types.  Runs in the front end only.
3751
3752Level 3 (default for @option{-Wstrict-aliasing}):
3753Should have very few false positives and few false
3754negatives.  Slightly slower than levels 1 or 2 when optimization is enabled.
3755Takes care of the common pun+dereference pattern in the front end:
3756@code{*(int*)&some_float}.
3757If optimization is enabled, it also runs in the back end, where it deals
3758with multiple statement cases using flow-sensitive points-to information.
3759Only warns when the converted pointer is dereferenced.
3760Does not warn about incomplete types.
3761
3762@item -Wstrict-overflow
3763@itemx -Wstrict-overflow=@var{n}
3764@opindex Wstrict-overflow
3765@opindex Wno-strict-overflow
3766This option is only active when @option{-fstrict-overflow} is active.
3767It warns about cases where the compiler optimizes based on the
3768assumption that signed overflow does not occur.  Note that it does not
3769warn about all cases where the code might overflow: it only warns
3770about cases where the compiler implements some optimization.  Thus
3771this warning depends on the optimization level.
3772
3773An optimization that assumes that signed overflow does not occur is
3774perfectly safe if the values of the variables involved are such that
3775overflow never does, in fact, occur.  Therefore this warning can
3776easily give a false positive: a warning about code that is not
3777actually a problem.  To help focus on important issues, several
3778warning levels are defined.  No warnings are issued for the use of
3779undefined signed overflow when estimating how many iterations a loop
3780will require, in particular when determining whether a loop will be
3781executed at all.
3782
3783@table @gcctabopt
3784@item -Wstrict-overflow=1
3785Warn about cases that are both questionable and easy to avoid.  For
3786example: @code{x + 1 > x}; with @option{-fstrict-overflow}, the
3787compiler will simplify this to @code{1}.  This level of
3788@option{-Wstrict-overflow} is enabled by @option{-Wall}; higher levels
3789are not, and must be explicitly requested.
3790
3791@item -Wstrict-overflow=2
3792Also warn about other cases where a comparison is simplified to a
3793constant.  For example: @code{abs (x) >= 0}.  This can only be
3794simplified when @option{-fstrict-overflow} is in effect, because
3795@code{abs (INT_MIN)} overflows to @code{INT_MIN}, which is less than
3796zero.  @option{-Wstrict-overflow} (with no level) is the same as
3797@option{-Wstrict-overflow=2}.
3798
3799@item -Wstrict-overflow=3
3800Also warn about other cases where a comparison is simplified.  For
3801example: @code{x + 1 > 1} will be simplified to @code{x > 0}.
3802
3803@item -Wstrict-overflow=4
3804Also warn about other simplifications not covered by the above cases.
3805For example: @code{(x * 10) / 5} will be simplified to @code{x * 2}.
3806
3807@item -Wstrict-overflow=5
3808Also warn about cases where the compiler reduces the magnitude of a
3809constant involved in a comparison.  For example: @code{x + 2 > y} will
3810be simplified to @code{x + 1 >= y}.  This is reported only at the
3811highest warning level because this simplification applies to many
3812comparisons, so this warning level will give a very large number of
3813false positives.
3814@end table
3815
3816@item -Wsuggest-attribute=@r{[}pure@r{|}const@r{|}noreturn@r{]}
3817@opindex Wsuggest-attribute=
3818@opindex Wno-suggest-attribute=
3819Warn for cases where adding an attribute may be beneficial. The
3820attributes currently supported are listed below.
3821
3822@table @gcctabopt
3823@item -Wsuggest-attribute=pure
3824@itemx -Wsuggest-attribute=const
3825@itemx -Wsuggest-attribute=noreturn
3826@opindex Wsuggest-attribute=pure
3827@opindex Wno-suggest-attribute=pure
3828@opindex Wsuggest-attribute=const
3829@opindex Wno-suggest-attribute=const
3830@opindex Wsuggest-attribute=noreturn
3831@opindex Wno-suggest-attribute=noreturn
3832
3833Warn about functions that might be candidates for attributes
3834@code{pure}, @code{const} or @code{noreturn}.  The compiler only warns for
3835functions visible in other compilation units or (in the case of @code{pure} and
3836@code{const}) if it cannot prove that the function returns normally. A function
3837returns normally if it doesn't contain an infinite loop nor returns abnormally
3838by throwing, calling @code{abort()} or trapping.  This analysis requires option
3839@option{-fipa-pure-const}, which is enabled by default at @option{-O} and
3840higher.  Higher optimization levels improve the accuracy of the analysis.
3841@end table
3842
3843@item -Warray-bounds
3844@opindex Wno-array-bounds
3845@opindex Warray-bounds
3846This option is only active when @option{-ftree-vrp} is active
3847(default for @option{-O2} and above). It warns about subscripts to arrays
3848that are always out of bounds. This warning is enabled by @option{-Wall}.
3849
3850@item -Wno-div-by-zero
3851@opindex Wno-div-by-zero
3852@opindex Wdiv-by-zero
3853Do not warn about compile-time integer division by zero.  Floating-point
3854division by zero is not warned about, as it can be a legitimate way of
3855obtaining infinities and NaNs.
3856
3857@item -Wsystem-headers
3858@opindex Wsystem-headers
3859@opindex Wno-system-headers
3860@cindex warnings from system headers
3861@cindex system headers, warnings from
3862Print warning messages for constructs found in system header files.
3863Warnings from system headers are normally suppressed, on the assumption
3864that they usually do not indicate real problems and would only make the
3865compiler output harder to read.  Using this command-line option tells
3866GCC to emit warnings from system headers as if they occurred in user
3867code.  However, note that using @option{-Wall} in conjunction with this
3868option will @emph{not} warn about unknown pragmas in system
3869headers---for that, @option{-Wunknown-pragmas} must also be used.
3870
3871@item -Wtrampolines
3872@opindex Wtrampolines
3873@opindex Wno-trampolines
3874 Warn about trampolines generated for pointers to nested functions.
3875
3876 A trampoline is a small piece of data or code that is created at run
3877 time on the stack when the address of a nested function is taken, and
3878 is used to call the nested function indirectly.  For some targets, it
3879 is made up of data only and thus requires no special treatment.  But,
3880 for most targets, it is made up of code and thus requires the stack
3881 to be made executable in order for the program to work properly.
3882
3883@item -Wfloat-equal
3884@opindex Wfloat-equal
3885@opindex Wno-float-equal
3886Warn if floating-point values are used in equality comparisons.
3887
3888The idea behind this is that sometimes it is convenient (for the
3889programmer) to consider floating-point values as approximations to
3890infinitely precise real numbers.  If you are doing this, then you need
3891to compute (by analyzing the code, or in some other way) the maximum or
3892likely maximum error that the computation introduces, and allow for it
3893when performing comparisons (and when producing output, but that's a
3894different problem).  In particular, instead of testing for equality, you
3895would check to see whether the two values have ranges that overlap; and
3896this is done with the relational operators, so equality comparisons are
3897probably mistaken.
3898
3899@item -Wtraditional @r{(C and Objective-C only)}
3900@opindex Wtraditional
3901@opindex Wno-traditional
3902Warn about certain constructs that behave differently in traditional and
3903ISO C@.  Also warn about ISO C constructs that have no traditional C
3904equivalent, and/or problematic constructs that should be avoided.
3905
3906@itemize @bullet
3907@item
3908Macro parameters that appear within string literals in the macro body.
3909In traditional C macro replacement takes place within string literals,
3910but does not in ISO C@.
3911
3912@item
3913In traditional C, some preprocessor directives did not exist.
3914Traditional preprocessors would only consider a line to be a directive
3915if the @samp{#} appeared in column 1 on the line.  Therefore
3916@option{-Wtraditional} warns about directives that traditional C
3917understands but would ignore because the @samp{#} does not appear as the
3918first character on the line.  It also suggests you hide directives like
3919@samp{#pragma} not understood by traditional C by indenting them.  Some
3920traditional implementations would not recognize @samp{#elif}, so it
3921suggests avoiding it altogether.
3922
3923@item
3924A function-like macro that appears without arguments.
3925
3926@item
3927The unary plus operator.
3928
3929@item
3930The @samp{U} integer constant suffix, or the @samp{F} or @samp{L} floating-point
3931constant suffixes.  (Traditional C does support the @samp{L} suffix on integer
3932constants.)  Note, these suffixes appear in macros defined in the system
3933headers of most modern systems, e.g.@: the @samp{_MIN}/@samp{_MAX} macros in @code{<limits.h>}.
3934Use of these macros in user code might normally lead to spurious
3935warnings, however GCC's integrated preprocessor has enough context to
3936avoid warning in these cases.
3937
3938@item
3939A function declared external in one block and then used after the end of
3940the block.
3941
3942@item
3943A @code{switch} statement has an operand of type @code{long}.
3944
3945@item
3946A non-@code{static} function declaration follows a @code{static} one.
3947This construct is not accepted by some traditional C compilers.
3948
3949@item
3950The ISO type of an integer constant has a different width or
3951signedness from its traditional type.  This warning is only issued if
3952the base of the constant is ten.  I.e.@: hexadecimal or octal values, which
3953typically represent bit patterns, are not warned about.
3954
3955@item
3956Usage of ISO string concatenation is detected.
3957
3958@item
3959Initialization of automatic aggregates.
3960
3961@item
3962Identifier conflicts with labels.  Traditional C lacks a separate
3963namespace for labels.
3964
3965@item
3966Initialization of unions.  If the initializer is zero, the warning is
3967omitted.  This is done under the assumption that the zero initializer in
3968user code appears conditioned on e.g.@: @code{__STDC__} to avoid missing
3969initializer warnings and relies on default initialization to zero in the
3970traditional C case.
3971
3972@item
3973Conversions by prototypes between fixed/floating-point values and vice
3974versa.  The absence of these prototypes when compiling with traditional
3975C would cause serious problems.  This is a subset of the possible
3976conversion warnings, for the full set use @option{-Wtraditional-conversion}.
3977
3978@item
3979Use of ISO C style function definitions.  This warning intentionally is
3980@emph{not} issued for prototype declarations or variadic functions
3981because these ISO C features will appear in your code when using
3982libiberty's traditional C compatibility macros, @code{PARAMS} and
3983@code{VPARAMS}.  This warning is also bypassed for nested functions
3984because that feature is already a GCC extension and thus not relevant to
3985traditional C compatibility.
3986@end itemize
3987
3988@item -Wtraditional-conversion @r{(C and Objective-C only)}
3989@opindex Wtraditional-conversion
3990@opindex Wno-traditional-conversion
3991Warn if a prototype causes a type conversion that is different from what
3992would happen to the same argument in the absence of a prototype.  This
3993includes conversions of fixed point to floating and vice versa, and
3994conversions changing the width or signedness of a fixed-point argument
3995except when the same as the default promotion.
3996
3997@item -Wdeclaration-after-statement @r{(C and Objective-C only)}
3998@opindex Wdeclaration-after-statement
3999@opindex Wno-declaration-after-statement
4000Warn when a declaration is found after a statement in a block.  This
4001construct, known from C++, was introduced with ISO C99 and is by default
4002allowed in GCC@.  It is not supported by ISO C90 and was not supported by
4003GCC versions before GCC 3.0.  @xref{Mixed Declarations}.
4004
4005@item -Wundef
4006@opindex Wundef
4007@opindex Wno-undef
4008Warn if an undefined identifier is evaluated in an @samp{#if} directive.
4009
4010@item -Wno-endif-labels
4011@opindex Wno-endif-labels
4012@opindex Wendif-labels
4013Do not warn whenever an @samp{#else} or an @samp{#endif} are followed by text.
4014
4015@item -Wshadow
4016@opindex Wshadow
4017@opindex Wno-shadow
4018Warn whenever a local variable or type declaration shadows another variable,
4019parameter, type, or class member (in C++), or whenever a built-in function
4020is shadowed. Note that in C++, the compiler will not warn if a local variable
4021shadows a struct/class/enum, but will warn if it shadows an explicit typedef.
4022
4023@item -Wlarger-than=@var{len}
4024@opindex Wlarger-than=@var{len}
4025@opindex Wlarger-than-@var{len}
4026Warn whenever an object of larger than @var{len} bytes is defined.
4027
4028@item -Wframe-larger-than=@var{len}
4029@opindex Wframe-larger-than
4030Warn if the size of a function frame is larger than @var{len} bytes.
4031The computation done to determine the stack frame size is approximate
4032and not conservative.
4033The actual requirements may be somewhat greater than @var{len}
4034even if you do not get a warning.  In addition, any space allocated
4035via @code{alloca}, variable-length arrays, or related constructs
4036is not included by the compiler when determining
4037whether or not to issue a warning.
4038
4039@item -Wno-free-nonheap-object
4040@opindex Wno-free-nonheap-object
4041@opindex Wfree-nonheap-object
4042Do not warn when attempting to free an object that was not allocated
4043on the heap.
4044
4045@item -Wstack-usage=@var{len}
4046@opindex Wstack-usage
4047Warn if the stack usage of a function might be larger than @var{len} bytes.
4048The computation done to determine the stack usage is conservative.
4049Any space allocated via @code{alloca}, variable-length arrays, or related
4050constructs is included by the compiler when determining whether or not to
4051issue a warning.
4052
4053The message is in keeping with the output of @option{-fstack-usage}.
4054
4055@itemize
4056@item
4057If the stack usage is fully static but exceeds the specified amount, it's:
4058
4059@smallexample
4060  warning: stack usage is 1120 bytes
4061@end smallexample
4062@item
4063If the stack usage is (partly) dynamic but bounded, it's:
4064
4065@smallexample
4066  warning: stack usage might be 1648 bytes
4067@end smallexample
4068@item
4069If the stack usage is (partly) dynamic and not bounded, it's:
4070
4071@smallexample
4072  warning: stack usage might be unbounded
4073@end smallexample
4074@end itemize
4075
4076@item -Wunsafe-loop-optimizations
4077@opindex Wunsafe-loop-optimizations
4078@opindex Wno-unsafe-loop-optimizations
4079Warn if the loop cannot be optimized because the compiler could not
4080assume anything on the bounds of the loop indices.  With
4081@option{-funsafe-loop-optimizations} warn if the compiler made
4082such assumptions.
4083
4084@item -Wno-pedantic-ms-format @r{(MinGW targets only)}
4085@opindex Wno-pedantic-ms-format
4086@opindex Wpedantic-ms-format
4087Disables the warnings about non-ISO @code{printf} / @code{scanf} format
4088width specifiers @code{I32}, @code{I64}, and @code{I} used on Windows targets
4089depending on the MS runtime, when you are using the options @option{-Wformat}
4090and @option{-pedantic} without gnu-extensions.
4091
4092@item -Wpointer-arith
4093@opindex Wpointer-arith
4094@opindex Wno-pointer-arith
4095Warn about anything that depends on the ``size of'' a function type or
4096of @code{void}.  GNU C assigns these types a size of 1, for
4097convenience in calculations with @code{void *} pointers and pointers
4098to functions.  In C++, warn also when an arithmetic operation involves
4099@code{NULL}.  This warning is also enabled by @option{-pedantic}.
4100
4101@item -Wtype-limits
4102@opindex Wtype-limits
4103@opindex Wno-type-limits
4104Warn if a comparison is always true or always false due to the limited
4105range of the data type, but do not warn for constant expressions.  For
4106example, warn if an unsigned variable is compared against zero with
4107@samp{<} or @samp{>=}.  This warning is also enabled by
4108@option{-Wextra}.
4109
4110@item -Wbad-function-cast @r{(C and Objective-C only)}
4111@opindex Wbad-function-cast
4112@opindex Wno-bad-function-cast
4113Warn whenever a function call is cast to a non-matching type.
4114For example, warn if @code{int malloc()} is cast to @code{anything *}.
4115
4116@item -Wc++-compat @r{(C and Objective-C only)}
4117Warn about ISO C constructs that are outside of the common subset of
4118ISO C and ISO C++, e.g.@: request for implicit conversion from
4119@code{void *} to a pointer to non-@code{void} type.
4120
4121@item -Wc++11-compat @r{(C++ and Objective-C++ only)}
4122Warn about C++ constructs whose meaning differs between ISO C++ 1998
4123and ISO C++ 2011, e.g., identifiers in ISO C++ 1998 that are keywords
4124in ISO C++ 2011.  This warning turns on @option{-Wnarrowing} and is
4125enabled by @option{-Wall}.
4126
4127@item -Wcast-qual
4128@opindex Wcast-qual
4129@opindex Wno-cast-qual
4130Warn whenever a pointer is cast so as to remove a type qualifier from
4131the target type.  For example, warn if a @code{const char *} is cast
4132to an ordinary @code{char *}.
4133
4134Also warn when making a cast that introduces a type qualifier in an
4135unsafe way.  For example, casting @code{char **} to @code{const char **}
4136is unsafe, as in this example:
4137
4138@smallexample
4139  /* p is char ** value.  */
4140  const char **q = (const char **) p;
4141  /* Assignment of readonly string to const char * is OK.  */
4142  *q = "string";
4143  /* Now char** pointer points to read-only memory.  */
4144  **p = 'b';
4145@end smallexample
4146
4147@item -Wcast-align
4148@opindex Wcast-align
4149@opindex Wno-cast-align
4150Warn whenever a pointer is cast such that the required alignment of the
4151target is increased.  For example, warn if a @code{char *} is cast to
4152an @code{int *} on machines where integers can only be accessed at
4153two- or four-byte boundaries.
4154
4155@item -Wwrite-strings
4156@opindex Wwrite-strings
4157@opindex Wno-write-strings
4158When compiling C, give string constants the type @code{const
4159char[@var{length}]} so that copying the address of one into a
4160non-@code{const} @code{char *} pointer will get a warning.  These
4161warnings will help you find at compile time code that can try to write
4162into a string constant, but only if you have been very careful about
4163using @code{const} in declarations and prototypes.  Otherwise, it will
4164just be a nuisance. This is why we did not make @option{-Wall} request
4165these warnings.
4166
4167When compiling C++, warn about the deprecated conversion from string
4168literals to @code{char *}.  This warning is enabled by default for C++
4169programs.
4170
4171@item -Wclobbered
4172@opindex Wclobbered
4173@opindex Wno-clobbered
4174Warn for variables that might be changed by @samp{longjmp} or
4175@samp{vfork}.  This warning is also enabled by @option{-Wextra}.
4176
4177@item -Wconversion
4178@opindex Wconversion
4179@opindex Wno-conversion
4180Warn for implicit conversions that may alter a value. This includes
4181conversions between real and integer, like @code{abs (x)} when
4182@code{x} is @code{double}; conversions between signed and unsigned,
4183like @code{unsigned ui = -1}; and conversions to smaller types, like
4184@code{sqrtf (M_PI)}. Do not warn for explicit casts like @code{abs
4185((int) x)} and @code{ui = (unsigned) -1}, or if the value is not
4186changed by the conversion like in @code{abs (2.0)}.  Warnings about
4187conversions between signed and unsigned integers can be disabled by
4188using @option{-Wno-sign-conversion}.
4189
4190For C++, also warn for confusing overload resolution for user-defined
4191conversions; and conversions that will never use a type conversion
4192operator: conversions to @code{void}, the same type, a base class or a
4193reference to them. Warnings about conversions between signed and
4194unsigned integers are disabled by default in C++ unless
4195@option{-Wsign-conversion} is explicitly enabled.
4196
4197@item -Wno-conversion-null @r{(C++ and Objective-C++ only)}
4198@opindex Wconversion-null
4199@opindex Wno-conversion-null
4200Do not warn for conversions between @code{NULL} and non-pointer
4201types. @option{-Wconversion-null} is enabled by default.
4202
4203@item -Wzero-as-null-pointer-constant @r{(C++ and Objective-C++ only)}
4204@opindex Wzero-as-null-pointer-constant
4205@opindex Wno-zero-as-null-pointer-constant
4206Warn when a literal '0' is used as null pointer constant.  This can
4207be useful to facilitate the conversion to @code{nullptr} in C++11.
4208
4209@item -Wempty-body
4210@opindex Wempty-body
4211@opindex Wno-empty-body
4212Warn if an empty body occurs in an @samp{if}, @samp{else} or @samp{do
4213while} statement.  This warning is also enabled by @option{-Wextra}.
4214
4215@item -Wenum-compare
4216@opindex Wenum-compare
4217@opindex Wno-enum-compare
4218Warn about a comparison between values of different enumerated types.
4219In C++ enumeral mismatches in conditional expressions are also
4220diagnosed and the warning is enabled by default.  In C this warning is
4221enabled by @option{-Wall}.
4222
4223@item -Wjump-misses-init @r{(C, Objective-C only)}
4224@opindex Wjump-misses-init
4225@opindex Wno-jump-misses-init
4226Warn if a @code{goto} statement or a @code{switch} statement jumps
4227forward across the initialization of a variable, or jumps backward to a
4228label after the variable has been initialized.  This only warns about
4229variables that are initialized when they are declared.  This warning is
4230only supported for C and Objective-C; in C++ this sort of branch is an
4231error in any case.
4232
4233@option{-Wjump-misses-init} is included in @option{-Wc++-compat}.  It
4234can be disabled with the @option{-Wno-jump-misses-init} option.
4235
4236@item -Wsign-compare
4237@opindex Wsign-compare
4238@opindex Wno-sign-compare
4239@cindex warning for comparison of signed and unsigned values
4240@cindex comparison of signed and unsigned values, warning
4241@cindex signed and unsigned values, comparison warning
4242Warn when a comparison between signed and unsigned values could produce
4243an incorrect result when the signed value is converted to unsigned.
4244This warning is also enabled by @option{-Wextra}; to get the other warnings
4245of @option{-Wextra} without this warning, use @samp{-Wextra -Wno-sign-compare}.
4246
4247@item -Wsign-conversion
4248@opindex Wsign-conversion
4249@opindex Wno-sign-conversion
4250Warn for implicit conversions that may change the sign of an integer
4251value, like assigning a signed integer expression to an unsigned
4252integer variable. An explicit cast silences the warning. In C, this
4253option is enabled also by @option{-Wconversion}.
4254
4255@item -Waddress
4256@opindex Waddress
4257@opindex Wno-address
4258Warn about suspicious uses of memory addresses. These include using
4259the address of a function in a conditional expression, such as
4260@code{void func(void); if (func)}, and comparisons against the memory
4261address of a string literal, such as @code{if (x == "abc")}.  Such
4262uses typically indicate a programmer error: the address of a function
4263always evaluates to true, so their use in a conditional usually
4264indicate that the programmer forgot the parentheses in a function
4265call; and comparisons against string literals result in unspecified
4266behavior and are not portable in C, so they usually indicate that the
4267programmer intended to use @code{strcmp}.  This warning is enabled by
4268@option{-Wall}.
4269
4270@item -Wlogical-op
4271@opindex Wlogical-op
4272@opindex Wno-logical-op
4273Warn about suspicious uses of logical operators in expressions.
4274This includes using logical operators in contexts where a
4275bit-wise operator is likely to be expected.
4276
4277@item -Waggregate-return
4278@opindex Waggregate-return
4279@opindex Wno-aggregate-return
4280Warn if any functions that return structures or unions are defined or
4281called.  (In languages where you can return an array, this also elicits
4282a warning.)
4283
4284@item -Wno-attributes
4285@opindex Wno-attributes
4286@opindex Wattributes
4287Do not warn if an unexpected @code{__attribute__} is used, such as
4288unrecognized attributes, function attributes applied to variables,
4289etc.  This will not stop errors for incorrect use of supported
4290attributes.
4291
4292@item -Wno-builtin-macro-redefined
4293@opindex Wno-builtin-macro-redefined
4294@opindex Wbuiltin-macro-redefined
4295Do not warn if certain built-in macros are redefined.  This suppresses
4296warnings for redefinition of @code{__TIMESTAMP__}, @code{__TIME__},
4297@code{__DATE__}, @code{__FILE__}, and @code{__BASE_FILE__}.
4298
4299@item -Wstrict-prototypes @r{(C and Objective-C only)}
4300@opindex Wstrict-prototypes
4301@opindex Wno-strict-prototypes
4302Warn if a function is declared or defined without specifying the
4303argument types.  (An old-style function definition is permitted without
4304a warning if preceded by a declaration that specifies the argument
4305types.)
4306
4307@item -Wold-style-declaration @r{(C and Objective-C only)}
4308@opindex Wold-style-declaration
4309@opindex Wno-old-style-declaration
4310Warn for obsolescent usages, according to the C Standard, in a
4311declaration. For example, warn if storage-class specifiers like
4312@code{static} are not the first things in a declaration.  This warning
4313is also enabled by @option{-Wextra}.
4314
4315@item -Wold-style-definition @r{(C and Objective-C only)}
4316@opindex Wold-style-definition
4317@opindex Wno-old-style-definition
4318Warn if an old-style function definition is used.  A warning is given
4319even if there is a previous prototype.
4320
4321@item -Wmissing-parameter-type @r{(C and Objective-C only)}
4322@opindex Wmissing-parameter-type
4323@opindex Wno-missing-parameter-type
4324A function parameter is declared without a type specifier in K&R-style
4325functions:
4326
4327@smallexample
4328void foo(bar) @{ @}
4329@end smallexample
4330
4331This warning is also enabled by @option{-Wextra}.
4332
4333@item -Wmissing-prototypes @r{(C and Objective-C only)}
4334@opindex Wmissing-prototypes
4335@opindex Wno-missing-prototypes
4336Warn if a global function is defined without a previous prototype
4337declaration.  This warning is issued even if the definition itself
4338provides a prototype.  The aim is to detect global functions that
4339are not declared in header files.
4340
4341@item -Wmissing-declarations
4342@opindex Wmissing-declarations
4343@opindex Wno-missing-declarations
4344Warn if a global function is defined without a previous declaration.
4345Do so even if the definition itself provides a prototype.
4346Use this option to detect global functions that are not declared in
4347header files.  In C++, no warnings are issued for function templates,
4348or for inline functions, or for functions in anonymous namespaces.
4349
4350@item -Wmissing-field-initializers
4351@opindex Wmissing-field-initializers
4352@opindex Wno-missing-field-initializers
4353@opindex W
4354@opindex Wextra
4355@opindex Wno-extra
4356Warn if a structure's initializer has some fields missing.  For
4357example, the following code would cause such a warning, because
4358@code{x.h} is implicitly zero:
4359
4360@smallexample
4361struct s @{ int f, g, h; @};
4362struct s x = @{ 3, 4 @};
4363@end smallexample
4364
4365This option does not warn about designated initializers, so the following
4366modification would not trigger a warning:
4367
4368@smallexample
4369struct s @{ int f, g, h; @};
4370struct s x = @{ .f = 3, .g = 4 @};
4371@end smallexample
4372
4373This warning is included in @option{-Wextra}.  To get other @option{-Wextra}
4374warnings without this one, use @samp{-Wextra -Wno-missing-field-initializers}.
4375
4376@item -Wmissing-format-attribute
4377@opindex Wmissing-format-attribute
4378@opindex Wno-missing-format-attribute
4379@opindex Wformat
4380@opindex Wno-format
4381Warn about function pointers that might be candidates for @code{format}
4382attributes.  Note these are only possible candidates, not absolute ones.
4383GCC will guess that function pointers with @code{format} attributes that
4384are used in assignment, initialization, parameter passing or return
4385statements should have a corresponding @code{format} attribute in the
4386resulting type.  I.e.@: the left-hand side of the assignment or
4387initialization, the type of the parameter variable, or the return type
4388of the containing function respectively should also have a @code{format}
4389attribute to avoid the warning.
4390
4391GCC will also warn about function definitions that might be
4392candidates for @code{format} attributes.  Again, these are only
4393possible candidates.  GCC will guess that @code{format} attributes
4394might be appropriate for any function that calls a function like
4395@code{vprintf} or @code{vscanf}, but this might not always be the
4396case, and some functions for which @code{format} attributes are
4397appropriate may not be detected.
4398
4399@item -Wno-multichar
4400@opindex Wno-multichar
4401@opindex Wmultichar
4402Do not warn if a multicharacter constant (@samp{'FOOF'}) is used.
4403Usually they indicate a typo in the user's code, as they have
4404implementation-defined values, and should not be used in portable code.
4405
4406@item -Wnormalized=<none|id|nfc|nfkc>
4407@opindex Wnormalized=
4408@cindex NFC
4409@cindex NFKC
4410@cindex character set, input normalization
4411In ISO C and ISO C++, two identifiers are different if they are
4412different sequences of characters.  However, sometimes when characters
4413outside the basic ASCII character set are used, you can have two
4414different character sequences that look the same.  To avoid confusion,
4415the ISO 10646 standard sets out some @dfn{normalization rules} which
4416when applied ensure that two sequences that look the same are turned into
4417the same sequence.  GCC can warn you if you are using identifiers that
4418have not been normalized; this option controls that warning.
4419
4420There are four levels of warning supported by GCC.  The default is
4421@option{-Wnormalized=nfc}, which warns about any identifier that is
4422not in the ISO 10646 ``C'' normalized form, @dfn{NFC}.  NFC is the
4423recommended form for most uses.
4424
4425Unfortunately, there are some characters allowed in identifiers by
4426ISO C and ISO C++ that, when turned into NFC, are not allowed in
4427identifiers.  That is, there's no way to use these symbols in portable
4428ISO C or C++ and have all your identifiers in NFC@.
4429@option{-Wnormalized=id} suppresses the warning for these characters.
4430It is hoped that future versions of the standards involved will correct
4431this, which is why this option is not the default.
4432
4433You can switch the warning off for all characters by writing
4434@option{-Wnormalized=none}.  You would only want to do this if you
4435were using some other normalization scheme (like ``D''), because
4436otherwise you can easily create bugs that are literally impossible to see.
4437
4438Some characters in ISO 10646 have distinct meanings but look identical
4439in some fonts or display methodologies, especially once formatting has
4440been applied.  For instance @code{\u207F}, ``SUPERSCRIPT LATIN SMALL
4441LETTER N'', will display just like a regular @code{n} that has been
4442placed in a superscript.  ISO 10646 defines the @dfn{NFKC}
4443normalization scheme to convert all these into a standard form as
4444well, and GCC will warn if your code is not in NFKC if you use
4445@option{-Wnormalized=nfkc}.  This warning is comparable to warning
4446about every identifier that contains the letter O because it might be
4447confused with the digit 0, and so is not the default, but may be
4448useful as a local coding convention if the programming environment is
4449unable to be fixed to display these characters distinctly.
4450
4451@item -Wno-deprecated
4452@opindex Wno-deprecated
4453@opindex Wdeprecated
4454Do not warn about usage of deprecated features.  @xref{Deprecated Features}.
4455
4456@item -Wno-deprecated-declarations
4457@opindex Wno-deprecated-declarations
4458@opindex Wdeprecated-declarations
4459Do not warn about uses of functions (@pxref{Function Attributes}),
4460variables (@pxref{Variable Attributes}), and types (@pxref{Type
4461Attributes}) marked as deprecated by using the @code{deprecated}
4462attribute.
4463
4464@item -Wno-overflow
4465@opindex Wno-overflow
4466@opindex Woverflow
4467Do not warn about compile-time overflow in constant expressions.
4468
4469@item -Woverride-init @r{(C and Objective-C only)}
4470@opindex Woverride-init
4471@opindex Wno-override-init
4472@opindex W
4473@opindex Wextra
4474@opindex Wno-extra
4475Warn if an initialized field without side effects is overridden when
4476using designated initializers (@pxref{Designated Inits, , Designated
4477Initializers}).
4478
4479This warning is included in @option{-Wextra}.  To get other
4480@option{-Wextra} warnings without this one, use @samp{-Wextra
4481-Wno-override-init}.
4482
4483@item -Wpacked
4484@opindex Wpacked
4485@opindex Wno-packed
4486Warn if a structure is given the packed attribute, but the packed
4487attribute has no effect on the layout or size of the structure.
4488Such structures may be mis-aligned for little benefit.  For
4489instance, in this code, the variable @code{f.x} in @code{struct bar}
4490will be misaligned even though @code{struct bar} does not itself
4491have the packed attribute:
4492
4493@smallexample
4494@group
4495struct foo @{
4496  int x;
4497  char a, b, c, d;
4498@} __attribute__((packed));
4499struct bar @{
4500  char z;
4501  struct foo f;
4502@};
4503@end group
4504@end smallexample
4505
4506@item -Wpacked-bitfield-compat
4507@opindex Wpacked-bitfield-compat
4508@opindex Wno-packed-bitfield-compat
4509The 4.1, 4.2 and 4.3 series of GCC ignore the @code{packed} attribute
4510on bit-fields of type @code{char}.  This has been fixed in GCC 4.4 but
4511the change can lead to differences in the structure layout.  GCC
4512informs you when the offset of such a field has changed in GCC 4.4.
4513For example there is no longer a 4-bit padding between field @code{a}
4514and @code{b} in this structure:
4515
4516@smallexample
4517struct foo
4518@{
4519  char a:4;
4520  char b:8;
4521@} __attribute__ ((packed));
4522@end smallexample
4523
4524This warning is enabled by default.  Use
4525@option{-Wno-packed-bitfield-compat} to disable this warning.
4526
4527@item -Wpadded
4528@opindex Wpadded
4529@opindex Wno-padded
4530Warn if padding is included in a structure, either to align an element
4531of the structure or to align the whole structure.  Sometimes when this
4532happens it is possible to rearrange the fields of the structure to
4533reduce the padding and so make the structure smaller.
4534
4535@item -Wredundant-decls
4536@opindex Wredundant-decls
4537@opindex Wno-redundant-decls
4538Warn if anything is declared more than once in the same scope, even in
4539cases where multiple declaration is valid and changes nothing.
4540
4541@item -Wnested-externs @r{(C and Objective-C only)}
4542@opindex Wnested-externs
4543@opindex Wno-nested-externs
4544Warn if an @code{extern} declaration is encountered within a function.
4545
4546@item -Winline
4547@opindex Winline
4548@opindex Wno-inline
4549Warn if a function can not be inlined and it was declared as inline.
4550Even with this option, the compiler will not warn about failures to
4551inline functions declared in system headers.
4552
4553The compiler uses a variety of heuristics to determine whether or not
4554to inline a function.  For example, the compiler takes into account
4555the size of the function being inlined and the amount of inlining
4556that has already been done in the current function.  Therefore,
4557seemingly insignificant changes in the source program can cause the
4558warnings produced by @option{-Winline} to appear or disappear.
4559
4560@item -Wno-invalid-offsetof @r{(C++ and Objective-C++ only)}
4561@opindex Wno-invalid-offsetof
4562@opindex Winvalid-offsetof
4563Suppress warnings from applying the @samp{offsetof} macro to a non-POD
4564type.  According to the 1998 ISO C++ standard, applying @samp{offsetof}
4565to a non-POD type is undefined.  In existing C++ implementations,
4566however, @samp{offsetof} typically gives meaningful results even when
4567applied to certain kinds of non-POD types. (Such as a simple
4568@samp{struct} that fails to be a POD type only by virtue of having a
4569constructor.)  This flag is for users who are aware that they are
4570writing nonportable code and who have deliberately chosen to ignore the
4571warning about it.
4572
4573The restrictions on @samp{offsetof} may be relaxed in a future version
4574of the C++ standard.
4575
4576@item -Wno-int-to-pointer-cast
4577@opindex Wno-int-to-pointer-cast
4578@opindex Wint-to-pointer-cast
4579Suppress warnings from casts to pointer type of an integer of a
4580different size. In C++, casting to a pointer type of smaller size is
4581an error. @option{Wint-to-pointer-cast} is enabled by default.
4582
4583
4584@item -Wno-pointer-to-int-cast @r{(C and Objective-C only)}
4585@opindex Wno-pointer-to-int-cast
4586@opindex Wpointer-to-int-cast
4587Suppress warnings from casts from a pointer to an integer type of a
4588different size.
4589
4590@item -Winvalid-pch
4591@opindex Winvalid-pch
4592@opindex Wno-invalid-pch
4593Warn if a precompiled header (@pxref{Precompiled Headers}) is found in
4594the search path but can't be used.
4595
4596@item -Wlong-long
4597@opindex Wlong-long
4598@opindex Wno-long-long
4599Warn if @samp{long long} type is used.  This is enabled by either
4600@option{-pedantic} or @option{-Wtraditional} in ISO C90 and C++98
4601modes.  To inhibit the warning messages, use @option{-Wno-long-long}.
4602
4603@item -Wvariadic-macros
4604@opindex Wvariadic-macros
4605@opindex Wno-variadic-macros
4606Warn if variadic macros are used in pedantic ISO C90 mode, or the GNU
4607alternate syntax when in pedantic ISO C99 mode.  This is default.
4608To inhibit the warning messages, use @option{-Wno-variadic-macros}.
4609
4610@item -Wvector-operation-performance
4611@opindex Wvector-operation-performance
4612@opindex Wno-vector-operation-performance
4613Warn if vector operation is not implemented via SIMD capabilities of the
4614architecture.  Mainly useful for the performance tuning.
4615Vector operation can be implemented @code{piecewise}, which means that the
4616scalar operation is performed on every vector element;
4617@code{in parallel}, which means that the vector operation is implemented
4618using scalars of wider type, which normally is more performance efficient;
4619and @code{as a single scalar}, which means that vector fits into a
4620scalar type.
4621
4622@item -Wvla
4623@opindex Wvla
4624@opindex Wno-vla
4625Warn if variable length array is used in the code.
4626@option{-Wno-vla} will prevent the @option{-pedantic} warning of
4627the variable length array.
4628
4629@item -Wvolatile-register-var
4630@opindex Wvolatile-register-var
4631@opindex Wno-volatile-register-var
4632Warn if a register variable is declared volatile.  The volatile
4633modifier does not inhibit all optimizations that may eliminate reads
4634and/or writes to register variables.  This warning is enabled by
4635@option{-Wall}.
4636
4637@item -Wdisabled-optimization
4638@opindex Wdisabled-optimization
4639@opindex Wno-disabled-optimization
4640Warn if a requested optimization pass is disabled.  This warning does
4641not generally indicate that there is anything wrong with your code; it
4642merely indicates that GCC's optimizers were unable to handle the code
4643effectively.  Often, the problem is that your code is too big or too
4644complex; GCC will refuse to optimize programs when the optimization
4645itself is likely to take inordinate amounts of time.
4646
4647@item -Wpointer-sign @r{(C and Objective-C only)}
4648@opindex Wpointer-sign
4649@opindex Wno-pointer-sign
4650Warn for pointer argument passing or assignment with different signedness.
4651This option is only supported for C and Objective-C@.  It is implied by
4652@option{-Wall} and by @option{-pedantic}, which can be disabled with
4653@option{-Wno-pointer-sign}.
4654
4655@item -Wstack-protector
4656@opindex Wstack-protector
4657@opindex Wno-stack-protector
4658This option is only active when @option{-fstack-protector} is active.  It
4659warns about functions that will not be protected against stack smashing.
4660
4661@item -Wno-mudflap
4662@opindex Wno-mudflap
4663Suppress warnings about constructs that cannot be instrumented by
4664@option{-fmudflap}.
4665
4666@item -Woverlength-strings
4667@opindex Woverlength-strings
4668@opindex Wno-overlength-strings
4669Warn about string constants that are longer than the ``minimum
4670maximum'' length specified in the C standard.  Modern compilers
4671generally allow string constants that are much longer than the
4672standard's minimum limit, but very portable programs should avoid
4673using longer strings.
4674
4675The limit applies @emph{after} string constant concatenation, and does
4676not count the trailing NUL@.  In C90, the limit was 509 characters; in
4677C99, it was raised to 4095.  C++98 does not specify a normative
4678minimum maximum, so we do not diagnose overlength strings in C++@.
4679
4680This option is implied by @option{-pedantic}, and can be disabled with
4681@option{-Wno-overlength-strings}.
4682
4683@item -Wunsuffixed-float-constants @r{(C and Objective-C only)}
4684@opindex Wunsuffixed-float-constants
4685
4686GCC will issue a warning for any floating constant that does not have
4687a suffix.  When used together with @option{-Wsystem-headers} it will
4688warn about such constants in system header files.  This can be useful
4689when preparing code to use with the @code{FLOAT_CONST_DECIMAL64} pragma
4690from the decimal floating-point extension to C99.
4691@end table
4692
4693@node Debugging Options
4694@section Options for Debugging Your Program or GCC
4695@cindex options, debugging
4696@cindex debugging information options
4697
4698GCC has various special options that are used for debugging
4699either your program or GCC:
4700
4701@table @gcctabopt
4702@item -g
4703@opindex g
4704Produce debugging information in the operating system's native format
4705(stabs, COFF, XCOFF, or DWARF 2)@.  GDB can work with this debugging
4706information.
4707
4708On most systems that use stabs format, @option{-g} enables use of extra
4709debugging information that only GDB can use; this extra information
4710makes debugging work better in GDB but will probably make other debuggers
4711crash or
4712refuse to read the program.  If you want to control for certain whether
4713to generate the extra information, use @option{-gstabs+}, @option{-gstabs},
4714@option{-gxcoff+}, @option{-gxcoff}, or @option{-gvms} (see below).
4715
4716GCC allows you to use @option{-g} with
4717@option{-O}.  The shortcuts taken by optimized code may occasionally
4718produce surprising results: some variables you declared may not exist
4719at all; flow of control may briefly move where you did not expect it;
4720some statements may not be executed because they compute constant
4721results or their values were already at hand; some statements may
4722execute in different places because they were moved out of loops.
4723
4724Nevertheless it proves possible to debug optimized output.  This makes
4725it reasonable to use the optimizer for programs that might have bugs.
4726
4727The following options are useful when GCC is generated with the
4728capability for more than one debugging format.
4729
4730@item -ggdb
4731@opindex ggdb
4732Produce debugging information for use by GDB@.  This means to use the
4733most expressive format available (DWARF 2, stabs, or the native format
4734if neither of those are supported), including GDB extensions if at all
4735possible.
4736
4737@item -gstabs
4738@opindex gstabs
4739Produce debugging information in stabs format (if that is supported),
4740without GDB extensions.  This is the format used by DBX on most BSD
4741systems.  On MIPS, Alpha and System V Release 4 systems this option
4742produces stabs debugging output that is not understood by DBX or SDB@.
4743On System V Release 4 systems this option requires the GNU assembler.
4744
4745@item -feliminate-unused-debug-symbols
4746@opindex feliminate-unused-debug-symbols
4747Produce debugging information in stabs format (if that is supported),
4748for only symbols that are actually used.
4749
4750@item -femit-class-debug-always
4751Instead of emitting debugging information for a C++ class in only one
4752object file, emit it in all object files using the class.  This option
4753should be used only with debuggers that are unable to handle the way GCC
4754normally emits debugging information for classes because using this
4755option will increase the size of debugging information by as much as a
4756factor of two.
4757
4758@item -fno-debug-types-section
4759@opindex fno-debug-types-section
4760@opindex fdebug-types-section
4761By default when using DWARF v4 or higher type DIEs will be put into
4762their own .debug_types section instead of making them part of the
4763.debug_info section.  It is more efficient to put them in a separate
4764comdat sections since the linker will then be able to remove duplicates.
4765But not all DWARF consumers support .debug_types sections yet.
4766
4767@item -gstabs+
4768@opindex gstabs+
4769Produce debugging information in stabs format (if that is supported),
4770using GNU extensions understood only by the GNU debugger (GDB)@.  The
4771use of these extensions is likely to make other debuggers crash or
4772refuse to read the program.
4773
4774@item -gcoff
4775@opindex gcoff
4776Produce debugging information in COFF format (if that is supported).
4777This is the format used by SDB on most System V systems prior to
4778System V Release 4.
4779
4780@item -gxcoff
4781@opindex gxcoff
4782Produce debugging information in XCOFF format (if that is supported).
4783This is the format used by the DBX debugger on IBM RS/6000 systems.
4784
4785@item -gxcoff+
4786@opindex gxcoff+
4787Produce debugging information in XCOFF format (if that is supported),
4788using GNU extensions understood only by the GNU debugger (GDB)@.  The
4789use of these extensions is likely to make other debuggers crash or
4790refuse to read the program, and may cause assemblers other than the GNU
4791assembler (GAS) to fail with an error.
4792
4793@item -gdwarf-@var{version}
4794@opindex gdwarf-@var{version}
4795Produce debugging information in DWARF format (if that is
4796supported).  This is the format used by DBX on IRIX 6.  The value
4797of @var{version} may be either 2, 3 or 4; the default version is 2.
4798
4799Note that with DWARF version 2 some ports require, and will always
4800use, some non-conflicting DWARF 3 extensions in the unwind tables.
4801
4802Version 4 may require GDB 7.0 and @option{-fvar-tracking-assignments}
4803for maximum benefit.
4804
4805@item -grecord-gcc-switches
4806@opindex grecord-gcc-switches
4807This switch causes the command-line options used to invoke the
4808compiler that may affect code generation to be appended to the
4809DW_AT_producer attribute in DWARF debugging information.  The options
4810are concatenated with spaces separating them from each other and from
4811the compiler version.  See also @option{-frecord-gcc-switches} for another
4812way of storing compiler options into the object file.
4813
4814@item -gno-record-gcc-switches
4815@opindex gno-record-gcc-switches
4816Disallow appending command-line options to the DW_AT_producer attribute
4817in DWARF debugging information.  This is the default.
4818
4819@item -gstrict-dwarf
4820@opindex gstrict-dwarf
4821Disallow using extensions of later DWARF standard version than selected
4822with @option{-gdwarf-@var{version}}.  On most targets using non-conflicting
4823DWARF extensions from later standard versions is allowed.
4824
4825@item -gno-strict-dwarf
4826@opindex gno-strict-dwarf
4827Allow using extensions of later DWARF standard version than selected with
4828@option{-gdwarf-@var{version}}.
4829
4830@item -gvms
4831@opindex gvms
4832Produce debugging information in VMS debug format (if that is
4833supported).  This is the format used by DEBUG on VMS systems.
4834
4835@item -g@var{level}
4836@itemx -ggdb@var{level}
4837@itemx -gstabs@var{level}
4838@itemx -gcoff@var{level}
4839@itemx -gxcoff@var{level}
4840@itemx -gvms@var{level}
4841Request debugging information and also use @var{level} to specify how
4842much information.  The default level is 2.
4843
4844Level 0 produces no debug information at all.  Thus, @option{-g0} negates
4845@option{-g}.
4846
4847Level 1 produces minimal information, enough for making backtraces in
4848parts of the program that you don't plan to debug.  This includes
4849descriptions of functions and external variables, but no information
4850about local variables and no line numbers.
4851
4852Level 3 includes extra information, such as all the macro definitions
4853present in the program.  Some debuggers support macro expansion when
4854you use @option{-g3}.
4855
4856@option{-gdwarf-2} does not accept a concatenated debug level, because
4857GCC used to support an option @option{-gdwarf} that meant to generate
4858debug information in version 1 of the DWARF format (which is very
4859different from version 2), and it would have been too confusing.  That
4860debug format is long obsolete, but the option cannot be changed now.
4861Instead use an additional @option{-g@var{level}} option to change the
4862debug level for DWARF.
4863
4864@item -gtoggle
4865@opindex gtoggle
4866Turn off generation of debug info, if leaving out this option would have
4867generated it, or turn it on at level 2 otherwise.  The position of this
4868argument in the command line does not matter, it takes effect after all
4869other options are processed, and it does so only once, no matter how
4870many times it is given.  This is mainly intended to be used with
4871@option{-fcompare-debug}.
4872
4873@item -fdump-final-insns@r{[}=@var{file}@r{]}
4874@opindex fdump-final-insns
4875Dump the final internal representation (RTL) to @var{file}.  If the
4876optional argument is omitted (or if @var{file} is @code{.}), the name
4877of the dump file will be determined by appending @code{.gkd} to the
4878compilation output file name.
4879
4880@item -fcompare-debug@r{[}=@var{opts}@r{]}
4881@opindex fcompare-debug
4882@opindex fno-compare-debug
4883If no error occurs during compilation, run the compiler a second time,
4884adding @var{opts} and @option{-fcompare-debug-second} to the arguments
4885passed to the second compilation.  Dump the final internal
4886representation in both compilations, and print an error if they differ.
4887
4888If the equal sign is omitted, the default @option{-gtoggle} is used.
4889
4890The environment variable @env{GCC_COMPARE_DEBUG}, if defined, non-empty
4891and nonzero, implicitly enables @option{-fcompare-debug}.  If
4892@env{GCC_COMPARE_DEBUG} is defined to a string starting with a dash,
4893then it is used for @var{opts}, otherwise the default @option{-gtoggle}
4894is used.
4895
4896@option{-fcompare-debug=}, with the equal sign but without @var{opts},
4897is equivalent to @option{-fno-compare-debug}, which disables the dumping
4898of the final representation and the second compilation, preventing even
4899@env{GCC_COMPARE_DEBUG} from taking effect.
4900
4901To verify full coverage during @option{-fcompare-debug} testing, set
4902@env{GCC_COMPARE_DEBUG} to say @samp{-fcompare-debug-not-overridden},
4903which GCC will reject as an invalid option in any actual compilation
4904(rather than preprocessing, assembly or linking).  To get just a
4905warning, setting @env{GCC_COMPARE_DEBUG} to @samp{-w%n-fcompare-debug
4906not overridden} will do.
4907
4908@item -fcompare-debug-second
4909@opindex fcompare-debug-second
4910This option is implicitly passed to the compiler for the second
4911compilation requested by @option{-fcompare-debug}, along with options to
4912silence warnings, and omitting other options that would cause
4913side-effect compiler outputs to files or to the standard output.  Dump
4914files and preserved temporary files are renamed so as to contain the
4915@code{.gk} additional extension during the second compilation, to avoid
4916overwriting those generated by the first.
4917
4918When this option is passed to the compiler driver, it causes the
4919@emph{first} compilation to be skipped, which makes it useful for little
4920other than debugging the compiler proper.
4921
4922@item -feliminate-dwarf2-dups
4923@opindex feliminate-dwarf2-dups
4924Compress DWARF2 debugging information by eliminating duplicated
4925information about each symbol.  This option only makes sense when
4926generating DWARF2 debugging information with @option{-gdwarf-2}.
4927
4928@item -femit-struct-debug-baseonly
4929Emit debug information for struct-like types
4930only when the base name of the compilation source file
4931matches the base name of file in which the struct was defined.
4932
4933This option substantially reduces the size of debugging information,
4934but at significant potential loss in type information to the debugger.
4935See @option{-femit-struct-debug-reduced} for a less aggressive option.
4936See @option{-femit-struct-debug-detailed} for more detailed control.
4937
4938This option works only with DWARF 2.
4939
4940@item -femit-struct-debug-reduced
4941Emit debug information for struct-like types
4942only when the base name of the compilation source file
4943matches the base name of file in which the type was defined,
4944unless the struct is a template or defined in a system header.
4945
4946This option significantly reduces the size of debugging information,
4947with some potential loss in type information to the debugger.
4948See @option{-femit-struct-debug-baseonly} for a more aggressive option.
4949See @option{-femit-struct-debug-detailed} for more detailed control.
4950
4951This option works only with DWARF 2.
4952
4953@item -femit-struct-debug-detailed@r{[}=@var{spec-list}@r{]}
4954Specify the struct-like types
4955for which the compiler will generate debug information.
4956The intent is to reduce duplicate struct debug information
4957between different object files within the same program.
4958
4959This option is a detailed version of
4960@option{-femit-struct-debug-reduced} and @option{-femit-struct-debug-baseonly},
4961which will serve for most needs.
4962
4963A specification has the syntax@*
4964[@samp{dir:}|@samp{ind:}][@samp{ord:}|@samp{gen:}](@samp{any}|@samp{sys}|@samp{base}|@samp{none})
4965
4966The optional first word limits the specification to
4967structs that are used directly (@samp{dir:}) or used indirectly (@samp{ind:}).
4968A struct type is used directly when it is the type of a variable, member.
4969Indirect uses arise through pointers to structs.
4970That is, when use of an incomplete struct would be legal, the use is indirect.
4971An example is
4972@samp{struct one direct; struct two * indirect;}.
4973
4974The optional second word limits the specification to
4975ordinary structs (@samp{ord:}) or generic structs (@samp{gen:}).
4976Generic structs are a bit complicated to explain.
4977For C++, these are non-explicit specializations of template classes,
4978or non-template classes within the above.
4979Other programming languages have generics,
4980but @samp{-femit-struct-debug-detailed} does not yet implement them.
4981
4982The third word specifies the source files for those
4983structs for which the compiler will emit debug information.
4984The values @samp{none} and @samp{any} have the normal meaning.
4985The value @samp{base} means that
4986the base of name of the file in which the type declaration appears
4987must match the base of the name of the main compilation file.
4988In practice, this means that
4989types declared in @file{foo.c} and @file{foo.h} will have debug information,
4990but types declared in other header will not.
4991The value @samp{sys} means those types satisfying @samp{base}
4992or declared in system or compiler headers.
4993
4994You may need to experiment to determine the best settings for your application.
4995
4996The default is @samp{-femit-struct-debug-detailed=all}.
4997
4998This option works only with DWARF 2.
4999
5000@item -fno-merge-debug-strings
5001@opindex fmerge-debug-strings
5002@opindex fno-merge-debug-strings
5003Direct the linker to not merge together strings in the debugging
5004information that are identical in different object files.  Merging is
5005not supported by all assemblers or linkers.  Merging decreases the size
5006of the debug information in the output file at the cost of increasing
5007link processing time.  Merging is enabled by default.
5008
5009@item -fdebug-prefix-map=@var{old}=@var{new}
5010@opindex fdebug-prefix-map
5011When compiling files in directory @file{@var{old}}, record debugging
5012information describing them as in @file{@var{new}} instead.
5013
5014@item -fno-dwarf2-cfi-asm
5015@opindex fdwarf2-cfi-asm
5016@opindex fno-dwarf2-cfi-asm
5017Emit DWARF 2 unwind info as compiler generated @code{.eh_frame} section
5018instead of using GAS @code{.cfi_*} directives.
5019
5020@cindex @command{prof}
5021@item -p
5022@opindex p
5023Generate extra code to write profile information suitable for the
5024analysis program @command{prof}.  You must use this option when compiling
5025the source files you want data about, and you must also use it when
5026linking.
5027
5028@cindex @command{gprof}
5029@item -pg
5030@opindex pg
5031Generate extra code to write profile information suitable for the
5032analysis program @command{gprof}.  You must use this option when compiling
5033the source files you want data about, and you must also use it when
5034linking.
5035
5036@item -Q
5037@opindex Q
5038Makes the compiler print out each function name as it is compiled, and
5039print some statistics about each pass when it finishes.
5040
5041@item -ftime-report
5042@opindex ftime-report
5043Makes the compiler print some statistics about the time consumed by each
5044pass when it finishes.
5045
5046@item -fmem-report
5047@opindex fmem-report
5048Makes the compiler print some statistics about permanent memory
5049allocation when it finishes.
5050
5051@item -fpre-ipa-mem-report
5052@opindex fpre-ipa-mem-report
5053@item -fpost-ipa-mem-report
5054@opindex fpost-ipa-mem-report
5055Makes the compiler print some statistics about permanent memory
5056allocation before or after interprocedural optimization.
5057
5058@item -fstack-usage
5059@opindex fstack-usage
5060Makes the compiler output stack usage information for the program, on a
5061per-function basis.  The filename for the dump is made by appending
5062@file{.su} to the @var{auxname}.  @var{auxname} is generated from the name of
5063the output file, if explicitly specified and it is not an executable,
5064otherwise it is the basename of the source file.  An entry is made up
5065of three fields:
5066
5067@itemize
5068@item
5069The name of the function.
5070@item
5071A number of bytes.
5072@item
5073One or more qualifiers: @code{static}, @code{dynamic}, @code{bounded}.
5074@end itemize
5075
5076The qualifier @code{static} means that the function manipulates the stack
5077statically: a fixed number of bytes are allocated for the frame on function
5078entry and released on function exit; no stack adjustments are otherwise made
5079in the function.  The second field is this fixed number of bytes.
5080
5081The qualifier @code{dynamic} means that the function manipulates the stack
5082dynamically: in addition to the static allocation described above, stack
5083adjustments are made in the body of the function, for example to push/pop
5084arguments around function calls.  If the qualifier @code{bounded} is also
5085present, the amount of these adjustments is bounded at compile time and
5086the second field is an upper bound of the total amount of stack used by
5087the function.  If it is not present, the amount of these adjustments is
5088not bounded at compile time and the second field only represents the
5089bounded part.
5090
5091@item -fprofile-arcs
5092@opindex fprofile-arcs
5093Add code so that program flow @dfn{arcs} are instrumented.  During
5094execution the program records how many times each branch and call is
5095executed and how many times it is taken or returns.  When the compiled
5096program exits it saves this data to a file called
5097@file{@var{auxname}.gcda} for each source file.  The data may be used for
5098profile-directed optimizations (@option{-fbranch-probabilities}), or for
5099test coverage analysis (@option{-ftest-coverage}).  Each object file's
5100@var{auxname} is generated from the name of the output file, if
5101explicitly specified and it is not the final executable, otherwise it is
5102the basename of the source file.  In both cases any suffix is removed
5103(e.g.@: @file{foo.gcda} for input file @file{dir/foo.c}, or
5104@file{dir/foo.gcda} for output file specified as @option{-o dir/foo.o}).
5105@xref{Cross-profiling}.
5106
5107@cindex @command{gcov}
5108@item --coverage
5109@opindex coverage
5110
5111This option is used to compile and link code instrumented for coverage
5112analysis.  The option is a synonym for @option{-fprofile-arcs}
5113@option{-ftest-coverage} (when compiling) and @option{-lgcov} (when
5114linking).  See the documentation for those options for more details.
5115
5116@itemize
5117
5118@item
5119Compile the source files with @option{-fprofile-arcs} plus optimization
5120and code generation options.  For test coverage analysis, use the
5121additional @option{-ftest-coverage} option.  You do not need to profile
5122every source file in a program.
5123
5124@item
5125Link your object files with @option{-lgcov} or @option{-fprofile-arcs}
5126(the latter implies the former).
5127
5128@item
5129Run the program on a representative workload to generate the arc profile
5130information.  This may be repeated any number of times.  You can run
5131concurrent instances of your program, and provided that the file system
5132supports locking, the data files will be correctly updated.  Also
5133@code{fork} calls are detected and correctly handled (double counting
5134will not happen).
5135
5136@item
5137For profile-directed optimizations, compile the source files again with
5138the same optimization and code generation options plus
5139@option{-fbranch-probabilities} (@pxref{Optimize Options,,Options that
5140Control Optimization}).
5141
5142@item
5143For test coverage analysis, use @command{gcov} to produce human readable
5144information from the @file{.gcno} and @file{.gcda} files.  Refer to the
5145@command{gcov} documentation for further information.
5146
5147@end itemize
5148
5149With @option{-fprofile-arcs}, for each function of your program GCC
5150creates a program flow graph, then finds a spanning tree for the graph.
5151Only arcs that are not on the spanning tree have to be instrumented: the
5152compiler adds code to count the number of times that these arcs are
5153executed.  When an arc is the only exit or only entrance to a block, the
5154instrumentation code can be added to the block; otherwise, a new basic
5155block must be created to hold the instrumentation code.
5156
5157@need 2000
5158@item -ftest-coverage
5159@opindex ftest-coverage
5160Produce a notes file that the @command{gcov} code-coverage utility
5161(@pxref{Gcov,, @command{gcov}---a Test Coverage Program}) can use to
5162show program coverage.  Each source file's note file is called
5163@file{@var{auxname}.gcno}.  Refer to the @option{-fprofile-arcs} option
5164above for a description of @var{auxname} and instructions on how to
5165generate test coverage data.  Coverage data will match the source files
5166more closely, if you do not optimize.
5167
5168@item -fdbg-cnt-list
5169@opindex fdbg-cnt-list
5170Print the name and the counter upper bound for all debug counters.
5171
5172
5173@item -fdbg-cnt=@var{counter-value-list}
5174@opindex fdbg-cnt
5175Set the internal debug counter upper bound.  @var{counter-value-list}
5176is a comma-separated list of @var{name}:@var{value} pairs
5177which sets the upper bound of each debug counter @var{name} to @var{value}.
5178All debug counters have the initial upper bound of @var{UINT_MAX},
5179thus dbg_cnt() returns true always unless the upper bound is set by this option.
5180e.g. With -fdbg-cnt=dce:10,tail_call:0
5181dbg_cnt(dce) will return true only for first 10 invocations
5182
5183@item -fenable-@var{kind}-@var{pass}
5184@itemx -fdisable-@var{kind}-@var{pass}=@var{range-list}
5185@opindex fdisable-
5186@opindex fenable-
5187
5188This is a set of debugging options that are used to explicitly disable/enable
5189optimization passes. For compiler users, regular options for enabling/disabling
5190passes should be used instead.
5191
5192@itemize
5193
5194@item -fdisable-ipa-@var{pass}
5195Disable ipa pass @var{pass}. @var{pass} is the pass name.  If the same pass is
5196statically invoked in the compiler multiple times, the pass name should be
5197appended with a sequential number starting from 1.
5198
5199@item -fdisable-rtl-@var{pass}
5200@item -fdisable-rtl-@var{pass}=@var{range-list}
5201Disable rtl pass @var{pass}.  @var{pass} is the pass name.  If the same pass is
5202statically invoked in the compiler multiple times, the pass name should be
5203appended with a sequential number starting from 1.  @var{range-list} is a comma
5204seperated list of function ranges or assembler names.  Each range is a number
5205pair seperated by a colon.  The range is inclusive in both ends.  If the range
5206is trivial, the number pair can be simplified as a single number.  If the
5207function's cgraph node's @var{uid} is falling within one of the specified ranges,
5208the @var{pass} is disabled for that function.  The @var{uid} is shown in the
5209function header of a dump file, and the pass names can be dumped by using
5210option @option{-fdump-passes}.
5211
5212@item -fdisable-tree-@var{pass}
5213@item -fdisable-tree-@var{pass}=@var{range-list}
5214Disable tree pass @var{pass}.  See @option{-fdisable-rtl} for the description of
5215option arguments.
5216
5217@item -fenable-ipa-@var{pass}
5218Enable ipa pass @var{pass}.  @var{pass} is the pass name.  If the same pass is
5219statically invoked in the compiler multiple times, the pass name should be
5220appended with a sequential number starting from 1.
5221
5222@item -fenable-rtl-@var{pass}
5223@item -fenable-rtl-@var{pass}=@var{range-list}
5224Enable rtl pass @var{pass}.  See @option{-fdisable-rtl} for option argument
5225description and examples.
5226
5227@item -fenable-tree-@var{pass}
5228@item -fenable-tree-@var{pass}=@var{range-list}
5229Enable tree pass @var{pass}.  See @option{-fdisable-rtl} for the description
5230of option arguments.
5231
5232@smallexample
5233
5234# disable ccp1 for all functions
5235   -fdisable-tree-ccp1
5236# disable complete unroll for function whose cgraph node uid is 1
5237   -fenable-tree-cunroll=1
5238# disable gcse2 for functions at the following ranges [1,1],
5239# [300,400], and [400,1000]
5240# disable gcse2 for functions foo and foo2
5241   -fdisable-rtl-gcse2=foo,foo2
5242# disable early inlining
5243   -fdisable-tree-einline
5244# disable ipa inlining
5245   -fdisable-ipa-inline
5246# enable tree full unroll
5247   -fenable-tree-unroll
5248
5249@end smallexample
5250
5251@end itemize
5252
5253@item -d@var{letters}
5254@itemx -fdump-rtl-@var{pass}
5255@opindex d
5256Says to make debugging dumps during compilation at times specified by
5257@var{letters}.  This is used for debugging the RTL-based passes of the
5258compiler.  The file names for most of the dumps are made by appending
5259a pass number and a word to the @var{dumpname}, and the files are
5260created in the directory of the output file.  Note that the pass
5261number is computed statically as passes get registered into the pass
5262manager.  Thus the numbering is not related to the dynamic order of
5263execution of passes.  In particular, a pass installed by a plugin
5264could have a number over 200 even if it executed quite early.
5265@var{dumpname} is generated from the name of the output file, if
5266explicitly specified and it is not an executable, otherwise it is the
5267basename of the source file. These switches may have different effects
5268when @option{-E} is used for preprocessing.
5269
5270Debug dumps can be enabled with a @option{-fdump-rtl} switch or some
5271@option{-d} option @var{letters}.  Here are the possible
5272letters for use in @var{pass} and @var{letters}, and their meanings:
5273
5274@table @gcctabopt
5275
5276@item -fdump-rtl-alignments
5277@opindex fdump-rtl-alignments
5278Dump after branch alignments have been computed.
5279
5280@item -fdump-rtl-asmcons
5281@opindex fdump-rtl-asmcons
5282Dump after fixing rtl statements that have unsatisfied in/out constraints.
5283
5284@item -fdump-rtl-auto_inc_dec
5285@opindex fdump-rtl-auto_inc_dec
5286Dump after auto-inc-dec discovery.  This pass is only run on
5287architectures that have auto inc or auto dec instructions.
5288
5289@item -fdump-rtl-barriers
5290@opindex fdump-rtl-barriers
5291Dump after cleaning up the barrier instructions.
5292
5293@item -fdump-rtl-bbpart
5294@opindex fdump-rtl-bbpart
5295Dump after partitioning hot and cold basic blocks.
5296
5297@item -fdump-rtl-bbro
5298@opindex fdump-rtl-bbro
5299Dump after block reordering.
5300
5301@item -fdump-rtl-btl1
5302@itemx -fdump-rtl-btl2
5303@opindex fdump-rtl-btl2
5304@opindex fdump-rtl-btl2
5305@option{-fdump-rtl-btl1} and @option{-fdump-rtl-btl2} enable dumping
5306after the two branch
5307target load optimization passes.
5308
5309@item -fdump-rtl-bypass
5310@opindex fdump-rtl-bypass
5311Dump after jump bypassing and control flow optimizations.
5312
5313@item -fdump-rtl-combine
5314@opindex fdump-rtl-combine
5315Dump after the RTL instruction combination pass.
5316
5317@item -fdump-rtl-compgotos
5318@opindex fdump-rtl-compgotos
5319Dump after duplicating the computed gotos.
5320
5321@item -fdump-rtl-ce1
5322@itemx -fdump-rtl-ce2
5323@itemx -fdump-rtl-ce3
5324@opindex fdump-rtl-ce1
5325@opindex fdump-rtl-ce2
5326@opindex fdump-rtl-ce3
5327@option{-fdump-rtl-ce1}, @option{-fdump-rtl-ce2}, and
5328@option{-fdump-rtl-ce3} enable dumping after the three
5329if conversion passes.
5330
5331@item -fdump-rtl-cprop_hardreg
5332@opindex fdump-rtl-cprop_hardreg
5333Dump after hard register copy propagation.
5334
5335@item -fdump-rtl-csa
5336@opindex fdump-rtl-csa
5337Dump after combining stack adjustments.
5338
5339@item -fdump-rtl-cse1
5340@itemx -fdump-rtl-cse2
5341@opindex fdump-rtl-cse1
5342@opindex fdump-rtl-cse2
5343@option{-fdump-rtl-cse1} and @option{-fdump-rtl-cse2} enable dumping after
5344the two common sub-expression elimination passes.
5345
5346@item -fdump-rtl-dce
5347@opindex fdump-rtl-dce
5348Dump after the standalone dead code elimination passes.
5349
5350@item -fdump-rtl-dbr
5351@opindex fdump-rtl-dbr
5352Dump after delayed branch scheduling.
5353
5354@item -fdump-rtl-dce1
5355@itemx -fdump-rtl-dce2
5356@opindex fdump-rtl-dce1
5357@opindex fdump-rtl-dce2
5358@option{-fdump-rtl-dce1} and @option{-fdump-rtl-dce2} enable dumping after
5359the two dead store elimination passes.
5360
5361@item -fdump-rtl-eh
5362@opindex fdump-rtl-eh
5363Dump after finalization of EH handling code.
5364
5365@item -fdump-rtl-eh_ranges
5366@opindex fdump-rtl-eh_ranges
5367Dump after conversion of EH handling range regions.
5368
5369@item -fdump-rtl-expand
5370@opindex fdump-rtl-expand
5371Dump after RTL generation.
5372
5373@item -fdump-rtl-fwprop1
5374@itemx -fdump-rtl-fwprop2
5375@opindex fdump-rtl-fwprop1
5376@opindex fdump-rtl-fwprop2
5377@option{-fdump-rtl-fwprop1} and @option{-fdump-rtl-fwprop2} enable
5378dumping after the two forward propagation passes.
5379
5380@item -fdump-rtl-gcse1
5381@itemx -fdump-rtl-gcse2
5382@opindex fdump-rtl-gcse1
5383@opindex fdump-rtl-gcse2
5384@option{-fdump-rtl-gcse1} and @option{-fdump-rtl-gcse2} enable dumping
5385after global common subexpression elimination.
5386
5387@item -fdump-rtl-init-regs
5388@opindex fdump-rtl-init-regs
5389Dump after the initialization of the registers.
5390
5391@item -fdump-rtl-initvals
5392@opindex fdump-rtl-initvals
5393Dump after the computation of the initial value sets.
5394
5395@item -fdump-rtl-into_cfglayout
5396@opindex fdump-rtl-into_cfglayout
5397Dump after converting to cfglayout mode.
5398
5399@item -fdump-rtl-ira
5400@opindex fdump-rtl-ira
5401Dump after iterated register allocation.
5402
5403@item -fdump-rtl-jump
5404@opindex fdump-rtl-jump
5405Dump after the second jump optimization.
5406
5407@item -fdump-rtl-loop2
5408@opindex fdump-rtl-loop2
5409@option{-fdump-rtl-loop2} enables dumping after the rtl
5410loop optimization passes.
5411
5412@item -fdump-rtl-mach
5413@opindex fdump-rtl-mach
5414Dump after performing the machine dependent reorganization pass, if that
5415pass exists.
5416
5417@item -fdump-rtl-mode_sw
5418@opindex fdump-rtl-mode_sw
5419Dump after removing redundant mode switches.
5420
5421@item -fdump-rtl-rnreg
5422@opindex fdump-rtl-rnreg
5423Dump after register renumbering.
5424
5425@item -fdump-rtl-outof_cfglayout
5426@opindex fdump-rtl-outof_cfglayout
5427Dump after converting from cfglayout mode.
5428
5429@item -fdump-rtl-peephole2
5430@opindex fdump-rtl-peephole2
5431Dump after the peephole pass.
5432
5433@item -fdump-rtl-postreload
5434@opindex fdump-rtl-postreload
5435Dump after post-reload optimizations.
5436
5437@item -fdump-rtl-pro_and_epilogue
5438@opindex fdump-rtl-pro_and_epilogue
5439Dump after generating the function prologues and epilogues.
5440
5441@item -fdump-rtl-regmove
5442@opindex fdump-rtl-regmove
5443Dump after the register move pass.
5444
5445@item -fdump-rtl-sched1
5446@itemx -fdump-rtl-sched2
5447@opindex fdump-rtl-sched1
5448@opindex fdump-rtl-sched2
5449@option{-fdump-rtl-sched1} and @option{-fdump-rtl-sched2} enable dumping
5450after the basic block scheduling passes.
5451
5452@item -fdump-rtl-see
5453@opindex fdump-rtl-see
5454Dump after sign extension elimination.
5455
5456@item -fdump-rtl-seqabstr
5457@opindex fdump-rtl-seqabstr
5458Dump after common sequence discovery.
5459
5460@item -fdump-rtl-shorten
5461@opindex fdump-rtl-shorten
5462Dump after shortening branches.
5463
5464@item -fdump-rtl-sibling
5465@opindex fdump-rtl-sibling
5466Dump after sibling call optimizations.
5467
5468@item -fdump-rtl-split1
5469@itemx -fdump-rtl-split2
5470@itemx -fdump-rtl-split3
5471@itemx -fdump-rtl-split4
5472@itemx -fdump-rtl-split5
5473@opindex fdump-rtl-split1
5474@opindex fdump-rtl-split2
5475@opindex fdump-rtl-split3
5476@opindex fdump-rtl-split4
5477@opindex fdump-rtl-split5
5478@option{-fdump-rtl-split1}, @option{-fdump-rtl-split2},
5479@option{-fdump-rtl-split3}, @option{-fdump-rtl-split4} and
5480@option{-fdump-rtl-split5} enable dumping after five rounds of
5481instruction splitting.
5482
5483@item -fdump-rtl-sms
5484@opindex fdump-rtl-sms
5485Dump after modulo scheduling.  This pass is only run on some
5486architectures.
5487
5488@item -fdump-rtl-stack
5489@opindex fdump-rtl-stack
5490Dump after conversion from GCC's "flat register file" registers to the
5491x87's stack-like registers.  This pass is only run on x86 variants.
5492
5493@item -fdump-rtl-subreg1
5494@itemx -fdump-rtl-subreg2
5495@opindex fdump-rtl-subreg1
5496@opindex fdump-rtl-subreg2
5497@option{-fdump-rtl-subreg1} and @option{-fdump-rtl-subreg2} enable dumping after
5498the two subreg expansion passes.
5499
5500@item -fdump-rtl-unshare
5501@opindex fdump-rtl-unshare
5502Dump after all rtl has been unshared.
5503
5504@item -fdump-rtl-vartrack
5505@opindex fdump-rtl-vartrack
5506Dump after variable tracking.
5507
5508@item -fdump-rtl-vregs
5509@opindex fdump-rtl-vregs
5510Dump after converting virtual registers to hard registers.
5511
5512@item -fdump-rtl-web
5513@opindex fdump-rtl-web
5514Dump after live range splitting.
5515
5516@item -fdump-rtl-regclass
5517@itemx -fdump-rtl-subregs_of_mode_init
5518@itemx -fdump-rtl-subregs_of_mode_finish
5519@itemx -fdump-rtl-dfinit
5520@itemx -fdump-rtl-dfinish
5521@opindex fdump-rtl-regclass
5522@opindex fdump-rtl-subregs_of_mode_init
5523@opindex fdump-rtl-subregs_of_mode_finish
5524@opindex fdump-rtl-dfinit
5525@opindex fdump-rtl-dfinish
5526These dumps are defined but always produce empty files.
5527
5528@item -da
5529@itemx -fdump-rtl-all
5530@opindex da
5531@opindex fdump-rtl-all
5532Produce all the dumps listed above.
5533
5534@item -dA
5535@opindex dA
5536Annotate the assembler output with miscellaneous debugging information.
5537
5538@item -dD
5539@opindex dD
5540Dump all macro definitions, at the end of preprocessing, in addition to
5541normal output.
5542
5543@item -dH
5544@opindex dH
5545Produce a core dump whenever an error occurs.
5546
5547@item -dp
5548@opindex dp
5549Annotate the assembler output with a comment indicating which
5550pattern and alternative was used.  The length of each instruction is
5551also printed.
5552
5553@item -dP
5554@opindex dP
5555Dump the RTL in the assembler output as a comment before each instruction.
5556Also turns on @option{-dp} annotation.
5557
5558@item -dv
5559@opindex dv
5560For each of the other indicated dump files (@option{-fdump-rtl-@var{pass}}),
5561dump a representation of the control flow graph suitable for viewing with VCG
5562to @file{@var{file}.@var{pass}.vcg}.
5563
5564@item -dx
5565@opindex dx
5566Just generate RTL for a function instead of compiling it.  Usually used
5567with @option{-fdump-rtl-expand}.
5568@end table
5569
5570@item -fdump-noaddr
5571@opindex fdump-noaddr
5572When doing debugging dumps, suppress address output.  This makes it more
5573feasible to use diff on debugging dumps for compiler invocations with
5574different compiler binaries and/or different
5575text / bss / data / heap / stack / dso start locations.
5576
5577@item -fdump-unnumbered
5578@opindex fdump-unnumbered
5579When doing debugging dumps, suppress instruction numbers and address output.
5580This makes it more feasible to use diff on debugging dumps for compiler
5581invocations with different options, in particular with and without
5582@option{-g}.
5583
5584@item -fdump-unnumbered-links
5585@opindex fdump-unnumbered-links
5586When doing debugging dumps (see @option{-d} option above), suppress
5587instruction numbers for the links to the previous and next instructions
5588in a sequence.
5589
5590@item -fdump-translation-unit @r{(C++ only)}
5591@itemx -fdump-translation-unit-@var{options} @r{(C++ only)}
5592@opindex fdump-translation-unit
5593Dump a representation of the tree structure for the entire translation
5594unit to a file.  The file name is made by appending @file{.tu} to the
5595source file name, and the file is created in the same directory as the
5596output file.  If the @samp{-@var{options}} form is used, @var{options}
5597controls the details of the dump as described for the
5598@option{-fdump-tree} options.
5599
5600@item -fdump-class-hierarchy @r{(C++ only)}
5601@itemx -fdump-class-hierarchy-@var{options} @r{(C++ only)}
5602@opindex fdump-class-hierarchy
5603Dump a representation of each class's hierarchy and virtual function
5604table layout to a file.  The file name is made by appending
5605@file{.class} to the source file name, and the file is created in the
5606same directory as the output file.  If the @samp{-@var{options}} form
5607is used, @var{options} controls the details of the dump as described
5608for the @option{-fdump-tree} options.
5609
5610@item -fdump-ipa-@var{switch}
5611@opindex fdump-ipa
5612Control the dumping at various stages of inter-procedural analysis
5613language tree to a file.  The file name is generated by appending a
5614switch specific suffix to the source file name, and the file is created
5615in the same directory as the output file.  The following dumps are
5616possible:
5617
5618@table @samp
5619@item all
5620Enables all inter-procedural analysis dumps.
5621
5622@item cgraph
5623Dumps information about call-graph optimization, unused function removal,
5624and inlining decisions.
5625
5626@item inline
5627Dump after function inlining.
5628
5629@end table
5630
5631@item -fdump-passes
5632@opindex fdump-passes
5633Dump the list of optimization passes that are turned on and off by
5634the current command-line options.
5635
5636@item -fdump-statistics-@var{option}
5637@opindex fdump-statistics
5638Enable and control dumping of pass statistics in a separate file.  The
5639file name is generated by appending a suffix ending in
5640@samp{.statistics} to the source file name, and the file is created in
5641the same directory as the output file.  If the @samp{-@var{option}}
5642form is used, @samp{-stats} will cause counters to be summed over the
5643whole compilation unit while @samp{-details} will dump every event as
5644the passes generate them.  The default with no option is to sum
5645counters for each function compiled.
5646
5647@item -fdump-tree-@var{switch}
5648@itemx -fdump-tree-@var{switch}-@var{options}
5649@opindex fdump-tree
5650Control the dumping at various stages of processing the intermediate
5651language tree to a file.  The file name is generated by appending a
5652switch specific suffix to the source file name, and the file is
5653created in the same directory as the output file.  If the
5654@samp{-@var{options}} form is used, @var{options} is a list of
5655@samp{-} separated options which control the details of the dump.  Not
5656all options are applicable to all dumps; those that are not
5657meaningful will be ignored.  The following options are available
5658
5659@table @samp
5660@item address
5661Print the address of each node.  Usually this is not meaningful as it
5662changes according to the environment and source file.  Its primary use
5663is for tying up a dump file with a debug environment.
5664@item asmname
5665If @code{DECL_ASSEMBLER_NAME} has been set for a given decl, use that
5666in the dump instead of @code{DECL_NAME}.  Its primary use is ease of
5667use working backward from mangled names in the assembly file.
5668@item slim
5669Inhibit dumping of members of a scope or body of a function merely
5670because that scope has been reached.  Only dump such items when they
5671are directly reachable by some other path.  When dumping pretty-printed
5672trees, this option inhibits dumping the bodies of control structures.
5673@item raw
5674Print a raw representation of the tree.  By default, trees are
5675pretty-printed into a C-like representation.
5676@item details
5677Enable more detailed dumps (not honored by every dump option).
5678@item stats
5679Enable dumping various statistics about the pass (not honored by every dump
5680option).
5681@item blocks
5682Enable showing basic block boundaries (disabled in raw dumps).
5683@item vops
5684Enable showing virtual operands for every statement.
5685@item lineno
5686Enable showing line numbers for statements.
5687@item uid
5688Enable showing the unique ID (@code{DECL_UID}) for each variable.
5689@item verbose
5690Enable showing the tree dump for each statement.
5691@item eh
5692Enable showing the EH region number holding each statement.
5693@item scev
5694Enable showing scalar evolution analysis details.
5695@item all
5696Turn on all options, except @option{raw}, @option{slim}, @option{verbose}
5697and @option{lineno}.
5698@end table
5699
5700The following tree dumps are possible:
5701@table @samp
5702
5703@item original
5704@opindex fdump-tree-original
5705Dump before any tree based optimization, to @file{@var{file}.original}.
5706
5707@item optimized
5708@opindex fdump-tree-optimized
5709Dump after all tree based optimization, to @file{@var{file}.optimized}.
5710
5711@item gimple
5712@opindex fdump-tree-gimple
5713Dump each function before and after the gimplification pass to a file.  The
5714file name is made by appending @file{.gimple} to the source file name.
5715
5716@item cfg
5717@opindex fdump-tree-cfg
5718Dump the control flow graph of each function to a file.  The file name is
5719made by appending @file{.cfg} to the source file name.
5720
5721@item vcg
5722@opindex fdump-tree-vcg
5723Dump the control flow graph of each function to a file in VCG format.  The
5724file name is made by appending @file{.vcg} to the source file name.  Note
5725that if the file contains more than one function, the generated file cannot
5726be used directly by VCG@.  You will need to cut and paste each function's
5727graph into its own separate file first.
5728
5729@item ch
5730@opindex fdump-tree-ch
5731Dump each function after copying loop headers.  The file name is made by
5732appending @file{.ch} to the source file name.
5733
5734@item ssa
5735@opindex fdump-tree-ssa
5736Dump SSA related information to a file.  The file name is made by appending
5737@file{.ssa} to the source file name.
5738
5739@item alias
5740@opindex fdump-tree-alias
5741Dump aliasing information for each function.  The file name is made by
5742appending @file{.alias} to the source file name.
5743
5744@item ccp
5745@opindex fdump-tree-ccp
5746Dump each function after CCP@.  The file name is made by appending
5747@file{.ccp} to the source file name.
5748
5749@item storeccp
5750@opindex fdump-tree-storeccp
5751Dump each function after STORE-CCP@.  The file name is made by appending
5752@file{.storeccp} to the source file name.
5753
5754@item pre
5755@opindex fdump-tree-pre
5756Dump trees after partial redundancy elimination.  The file name is made
5757by appending @file{.pre} to the source file name.
5758
5759@item fre
5760@opindex fdump-tree-fre
5761Dump trees after full redundancy elimination.  The file name is made
5762by appending @file{.fre} to the source file name.
5763
5764@item copyprop
5765@opindex fdump-tree-copyprop
5766Dump trees after copy propagation.  The file name is made
5767by appending @file{.copyprop} to the source file name.
5768
5769@item store_copyprop
5770@opindex fdump-tree-store_copyprop
5771Dump trees after store copy-propagation.  The file name is made
5772by appending @file{.store_copyprop} to the source file name.
5773
5774@item dce
5775@opindex fdump-tree-dce
5776Dump each function after dead code elimination.  The file name is made by
5777appending @file{.dce} to the source file name.
5778
5779@item mudflap
5780@opindex fdump-tree-mudflap
5781Dump each function after adding mudflap instrumentation.  The file name is
5782made by appending @file{.mudflap} to the source file name.
5783
5784@item sra
5785@opindex fdump-tree-sra
5786Dump each function after performing scalar replacement of aggregates.  The
5787file name is made by appending @file{.sra} to the source file name.
5788
5789@item sink
5790@opindex fdump-tree-sink
5791Dump each function after performing code sinking.  The file name is made
5792by appending @file{.sink} to the source file name.
5793
5794@item dom
5795@opindex fdump-tree-dom
5796Dump each function after applying dominator tree optimizations.  The file
5797name is made by appending @file{.dom} to the source file name.
5798
5799@item dse
5800@opindex fdump-tree-dse
5801Dump each function after applying dead store elimination.  The file
5802name is made by appending @file{.dse} to the source file name.
5803
5804@item phiopt
5805@opindex fdump-tree-phiopt
5806Dump each function after optimizing PHI nodes into straightline code.  The file
5807name is made by appending @file{.phiopt} to the source file name.
5808
5809@item forwprop
5810@opindex fdump-tree-forwprop
5811Dump each function after forward propagating single use variables.  The file
5812name is made by appending @file{.forwprop} to the source file name.
5813
5814@item copyrename
5815@opindex fdump-tree-copyrename
5816Dump each function after applying the copy rename optimization.  The file
5817name is made by appending @file{.copyrename} to the source file name.
5818
5819@item nrv
5820@opindex fdump-tree-nrv
5821Dump each function after applying the named return value optimization on
5822generic trees.  The file name is made by appending @file{.nrv} to the source
5823file name.
5824
5825@item vect
5826@opindex fdump-tree-vect
5827Dump each function after applying vectorization of loops.  The file name is
5828made by appending @file{.vect} to the source file name.
5829
5830@item slp
5831@opindex fdump-tree-slp
5832Dump each function after applying vectorization of basic blocks.  The file name
5833is made by appending @file{.slp} to the source file name.
5834
5835@item vrp
5836@opindex fdump-tree-vrp
5837Dump each function after Value Range Propagation (VRP).  The file name
5838is made by appending @file{.vrp} to the source file name.
5839
5840@item all
5841@opindex fdump-tree-all
5842Enable all the available tree dumps with the flags provided in this option.
5843@end table
5844
5845@item -ftree-vectorizer-verbose=@var{n}
5846@opindex ftree-vectorizer-verbose
5847This option controls the amount of debugging output the vectorizer prints.
5848This information is written to standard error, unless
5849@option{-fdump-tree-all} or @option{-fdump-tree-vect} is specified,
5850in which case it is output to the usual dump listing file, @file{.vect}.
5851For @var{n}=0 no diagnostic information is reported.
5852If @var{n}=1 the vectorizer reports each loop that got vectorized,
5853and the total number of loops that got vectorized.
5854If @var{n}=2 the vectorizer also reports non-vectorized loops that passed
5855the first analysis phase (vect_analyze_loop_form) - i.e.@: countable,
5856inner-most, single-bb, single-entry/exit loops.  This is the same verbosity
5857level that @option{-fdump-tree-vect-stats} uses.
5858Higher verbosity levels mean either more information dumped for each
5859reported loop, or same amount of information reported for more loops:
5860if @var{n}=3, vectorizer cost model information is reported.
5861If @var{n}=4, alignment related information is added to the reports.
5862If @var{n}=5, data-references related information (e.g.@: memory dependences,
5863memory access-patterns) is added to the reports.
5864If @var{n}=6, the vectorizer reports also non-vectorized inner-most loops
5865that did not pass the first analysis phase (i.e., may not be countable, or
5866may have complicated control-flow).
5867If @var{n}=7, the vectorizer reports also non-vectorized nested loops.
5868If @var{n}=8, SLP related information is added to the reports.
5869For @var{n}=9, all the information the vectorizer generates during its
5870analysis and transformation is reported.  This is the same verbosity level
5871that @option{-fdump-tree-vect-details} uses.
5872
5873@item -frandom-seed=@var{string}
5874@opindex frandom-seed
5875This option provides a seed that GCC uses when it would otherwise use
5876random numbers.  It is used to generate certain symbol names
5877that have to be different in every compiled file.  It is also used to
5878place unique stamps in coverage data files and the object files that
5879produce them.  You can use the @option{-frandom-seed} option to produce
5880reproducibly identical object files.
5881
5882The @var{string} should be different for every file you compile.
5883
5884@item -fsched-verbose=@var{n}
5885@opindex fsched-verbose
5886On targets that use instruction scheduling, this option controls the
5887amount of debugging output the scheduler prints.  This information is
5888written to standard error, unless @option{-fdump-rtl-sched1} or
5889@option{-fdump-rtl-sched2} is specified, in which case it is output
5890to the usual dump listing file, @file{.sched1} or @file{.sched2}
5891respectively.  However for @var{n} greater than nine, the output is
5892always printed to standard error.
5893
5894For @var{n} greater than zero, @option{-fsched-verbose} outputs the
5895same information as @option{-fdump-rtl-sched1} and @option{-fdump-rtl-sched2}.
5896For @var{n} greater than one, it also output basic block probabilities,
5897detailed ready list information and unit/insn info.  For @var{n} greater
5898than two, it includes RTL at abort point, control-flow and regions info.
5899And for @var{n} over four, @option{-fsched-verbose} also includes
5900dependence info.
5901
5902@item -save-temps
5903@itemx -save-temps=cwd
5904@opindex save-temps
5905Store the usual ``temporary'' intermediate files permanently; place them
5906in the current directory and name them based on the source file.  Thus,
5907compiling @file{foo.c} with @samp{-c -save-temps} would produce files
5908@file{foo.i} and @file{foo.s}, as well as @file{foo.o}.  This creates a
5909preprocessed @file{foo.i} output file even though the compiler now
5910normally uses an integrated preprocessor.
5911
5912When used in combination with the @option{-x} command-line option,
5913@option{-save-temps} is sensible enough to avoid over writing an
5914input source file with the same extension as an intermediate file.
5915The corresponding intermediate file may be obtained by renaming the
5916source file before using @option{-save-temps}.
5917
5918If you invoke GCC in parallel, compiling several different source
5919files that share a common base name in different subdirectories or the
5920same source file compiled for multiple output destinations, it is
5921likely that the different parallel compilers will interfere with each
5922other, and overwrite the temporary files.  For instance:
5923
5924@smallexample
5925gcc -save-temps -o outdir1/foo.o indir1/foo.c&
5926gcc -save-temps -o outdir2/foo.o indir2/foo.c&
5927@end smallexample
5928
5929may result in @file{foo.i} and @file{foo.o} being written to
5930simultaneously by both compilers.
5931
5932@item -save-temps=obj
5933@opindex save-temps=obj
5934Store the usual ``temporary'' intermediate files permanently.  If the
5935@option{-o} option is used, the temporary files are based on the
5936object file.  If the @option{-o} option is not used, the
5937@option{-save-temps=obj} switch behaves like @option{-save-temps}.
5938
5939For example:
5940
5941@smallexample
5942gcc -save-temps=obj -c foo.c
5943gcc -save-temps=obj -c bar.c -o dir/xbar.o
5944gcc -save-temps=obj foobar.c -o dir2/yfoobar
5945@end smallexample
5946
5947would create @file{foo.i}, @file{foo.s}, @file{dir/xbar.i},
5948@file{dir/xbar.s}, @file{dir2/yfoobar.i}, @file{dir2/yfoobar.s}, and
5949@file{dir2/yfoobar.o}.
5950
5951@item -time@r{[}=@var{file}@r{]}
5952@opindex time
5953Report the CPU time taken by each subprocess in the compilation
5954sequence.  For C source files, this is the compiler proper and assembler
5955(plus the linker if linking is done).
5956
5957Without the specification of an output file, the output looks like this:
5958
5959@smallexample
5960# cc1 0.12 0.01
5961# as 0.00 0.01
5962@end smallexample
5963
5964The first number on each line is the ``user time'', that is time spent
5965executing the program itself.  The second number is ``system time'',
5966time spent executing operating system routines on behalf of the program.
5967Both numbers are in seconds.
5968
5969With the specification of an output file, the output is appended to the
5970named file, and it looks like this:
5971
5972@smallexample
59730.12 0.01 cc1 @var{options}
59740.00 0.01 as @var{options}
5975@end smallexample
5976
5977The ``user time'' and the ``system time'' are moved before the program
5978name, and the options passed to the program are displayed, so that one
5979can later tell what file was being compiled, and with which options.
5980
5981@item -fvar-tracking
5982@opindex fvar-tracking
5983Run variable tracking pass.  It computes where variables are stored at each
5984position in code.  Better debugging information is then generated
5985(if the debugging information format supports this information).
5986
5987It is enabled by default when compiling with optimization (@option{-Os},
5988@option{-O}, @option{-O2}, @dots{}), debugging information (@option{-g}) and
5989the debug info format supports it.
5990
5991@item -fvar-tracking-assignments
5992@opindex fvar-tracking-assignments
5993@opindex fno-var-tracking-assignments
5994Annotate assignments to user variables early in the compilation and
5995attempt to carry the annotations over throughout the compilation all the
5996way to the end, in an attempt to improve debug information while
5997optimizing.  Use of @option{-gdwarf-4} is recommended along with it.
5998
5999It can be enabled even if var-tracking is disabled, in which case
6000annotations will be created and maintained, but discarded at the end.
6001
6002@item -fvar-tracking-assignments-toggle
6003@opindex fvar-tracking-assignments-toggle
6004@opindex fno-var-tracking-assignments-toggle
6005Toggle @option{-fvar-tracking-assignments}, in the same way that
6006@option{-gtoggle} toggles @option{-g}.
6007
6008@item -print-file-name=@var{library}
6009@opindex print-file-name
6010Print the full absolute name of the library file @var{library} that
6011would be used when linking---and don't do anything else.  With this
6012option, GCC does not compile or link anything; it just prints the
6013file name.
6014
6015@item -print-multi-directory
6016@opindex print-multi-directory
6017Print the directory name corresponding to the multilib selected by any
6018other switches present in the command line.  This directory is supposed
6019to exist in @env{GCC_EXEC_PREFIX}.
6020
6021@item -print-multi-lib
6022@opindex print-multi-lib
6023Print the mapping from multilib directory names to compiler switches
6024that enable them.  The directory name is separated from the switches by
6025@samp{;}, and each switch starts with an @samp{@@} instead of the
6026@samp{-}, without spaces between multiple switches.  This is supposed to
6027ease shell-processing.
6028
6029@item -print-multi-os-directory
6030@opindex print-multi-os-directory
6031Print the path to OS libraries for the selected
6032multilib, relative to some @file{lib} subdirectory.  If OS libraries are
6033present in the @file{lib} subdirectory and no multilibs are used, this is
6034usually just @file{.}, if OS libraries are present in @file{lib@var{suffix}}
6035sibling directories this prints e.g.@: @file{../lib64}, @file{../lib} or
6036@file{../lib32}, or if OS libraries are present in @file{lib/@var{subdir}}
6037subdirectories it prints e.g.@: @file{amd64}, @file{sparcv9} or @file{ev6}.
6038
6039@item -print-multiarch
6040@opindex print-multiarch
6041Print the path to OS libraries for the selected multiarch,
6042relative to some @file{lib} subdirectory.
6043
6044@item -print-prog-name=@var{program}
6045@opindex print-prog-name
6046Like @option{-print-file-name}, but searches for a program such as @samp{cpp}.
6047
6048@item -print-libgcc-file-name
6049@opindex print-libgcc-file-name
6050Same as @option{-print-file-name=libgcc.a}.
6051
6052This is useful when you use @option{-nostdlib} or @option{-nodefaultlibs}
6053but you do want to link with @file{libgcc.a}.  You can do
6054
6055@smallexample
6056gcc -nostdlib @var{files}@dots{} `gcc -print-libgcc-file-name`
6057@end smallexample
6058
6059@item -print-search-dirs
6060@opindex print-search-dirs
6061Print the name of the configured installation directory and a list of
6062program and library directories @command{gcc} will search---and don't do anything else.
6063
6064This is useful when @command{gcc} prints the error message
6065@samp{installation problem, cannot exec cpp0: No such file or directory}.
6066To resolve this you either need to put @file{cpp0} and the other compiler
6067components where @command{gcc} expects to find them, or you can set the environment
6068variable @env{GCC_EXEC_PREFIX} to the directory where you installed them.
6069Don't forget the trailing @samp{/}.
6070@xref{Environment Variables}.
6071
6072@item -print-sysroot
6073@opindex print-sysroot
6074Print the target sysroot directory that will be used during
6075compilation.  This is the target sysroot specified either at configure
6076time or using the @option{--sysroot} option, possibly with an extra
6077suffix that depends on compilation options.  If no target sysroot is
6078specified, the option prints nothing.
6079
6080@item -print-sysroot-headers-suffix
6081@opindex print-sysroot-headers-suffix
6082Print the suffix added to the target sysroot when searching for
6083headers, or give an error if the compiler is not configured with such
6084a suffix---and don't do anything else.
6085
6086@item -dumpmachine
6087@opindex dumpmachine
6088Print the compiler's target machine (for example,
6089@samp{i686-pc-linux-gnu})---and don't do anything else.
6090
6091@item -dumpversion
6092@opindex dumpversion
6093Print the compiler version (for example, @samp{3.0})---and don't do
6094anything else.
6095
6096@item -dumpspecs
6097@opindex dumpspecs
6098Print the compiler's built-in specs---and don't do anything else.  (This
6099is used when GCC itself is being built.)  @xref{Spec Files}.
6100
6101@item -feliminate-unused-debug-types
6102@opindex feliminate-unused-debug-types
6103Normally, when producing DWARF2 output, GCC will emit debugging
6104information for all types declared in a compilation
6105unit, regardless of whether or not they are actually used
6106in that compilation unit.  Sometimes this is useful, such as
6107if, in the debugger, you want to cast a value to a type that is
6108not actually used in your program (but is declared).  More often,
6109however, this results in a significant amount of wasted space.
6110With this option, GCC will avoid producing debug symbol output
6111for types that are nowhere used in the source file being compiled.
6112@end table
6113
6114@node Optimize Options
6115@section Options That Control Optimization
6116@cindex optimize options
6117@cindex options, optimization
6118
6119These options control various sorts of optimizations.
6120
6121Without any optimization option, the compiler's goal is to reduce the
6122cost of compilation and to make debugging produce the expected
6123results.  Statements are independent: if you stop the program with a
6124breakpoint between statements, you can then assign a new value to any
6125variable or change the program counter to any other statement in the
6126function and get exactly the results you would expect from the source
6127code.
6128
6129Turning on optimization flags makes the compiler attempt to improve
6130the performance and/or code size at the expense of compilation time
6131and possibly the ability to debug the program.
6132
6133The compiler performs optimization based on the knowledge it has of the
6134program.  Compiling multiple files at once to a single output file mode allows
6135the compiler to use information gained from all of the files when compiling
6136each of them.
6137
6138Not all optimizations are controlled directly by a flag.  Only
6139optimizations that have a flag are listed in this section.
6140
6141Most optimizations are only enabled if an @option{-O} level is set on
6142the command line.  Otherwise they are disabled, even if individual
6143optimization flags are specified.
6144
6145Depending on the target and how GCC was configured, a slightly different
6146set of optimizations may be enabled at each @option{-O} level than
6147those listed here.  You can invoke GCC with @samp{-Q --help=optimizers}
6148to find out the exact set of optimizations that are enabled at each level.
6149@xref{Overall Options}, for examples.
6150
6151@table @gcctabopt
6152@item -O
6153@itemx -O1
6154@opindex O
6155@opindex O1
6156Optimize.  Optimizing compilation takes somewhat more time, and a lot
6157more memory for a large function.
6158
6159With @option{-O}, the compiler tries to reduce code size and execution
6160time, without performing any optimizations that take a great deal of
6161compilation time.
6162
6163@option{-O} turns on the following optimization flags:
6164@gccoptlist{
6165-fauto-inc-dec @gol
6166-fcompare-elim @gol
6167-fcprop-registers @gol
6168-fdce @gol
6169-fdefer-pop @gol
6170-fdelayed-branch @gol
6171-fdse @gol
6172-fguess-branch-probability @gol
6173-fif-conversion2 @gol
6174-fif-conversion @gol
6175-fipa-pure-const @gol
6176-fipa-profile @gol
6177-fipa-reference @gol
6178-fmerge-constants
6179-fsplit-wide-types @gol
6180-ftree-bit-ccp @gol
6181-ftree-builtin-call-dce @gol
6182-ftree-ccp @gol
6183-ftree-ch @gol
6184-ftree-copyrename @gol
6185-ftree-dce @gol
6186-ftree-dominator-opts @gol
6187-ftree-dse @gol
6188-ftree-forwprop @gol
6189-ftree-fre @gol
6190-ftree-phiprop @gol
6191-ftree-sra @gol
6192-ftree-pta @gol
6193-ftree-ter @gol
6194-funit-at-a-time}
6195
6196@option{-O} also turns on @option{-fomit-frame-pointer} on machines
6197where doing so does not interfere with debugging.
6198
6199@item -O2
6200@opindex O2
6201Optimize even more.  GCC performs nearly all supported optimizations
6202that do not involve a space-speed tradeoff.
6203As compared to @option{-O}, this option increases both compilation time
6204and the performance of the generated code.
6205
6206@option{-O2} turns on all optimization flags specified by @option{-O}.  It
6207also turns on the following optimization flags:
6208@gccoptlist{-fthread-jumps @gol
6209-falign-functions  -falign-jumps @gol
6210-falign-loops  -falign-labels @gol
6211-fcaller-saves @gol
6212-fcrossjumping @gol
6213-fcse-follow-jumps  -fcse-skip-blocks @gol
6214-fdelete-null-pointer-checks @gol
6215-fdevirtualize @gol
6216-fexpensive-optimizations @gol
6217-fgcse  -fgcse-lm  @gol
6218-finline-small-functions @gol
6219-findirect-inlining @gol
6220-fipa-sra @gol
6221-foptimize-sibling-calls @gol
6222-fpartial-inlining @gol
6223-fpeephole2 @gol
6224-fregmove @gol
6225-freorder-blocks  -freorder-functions @gol
6226-frerun-cse-after-loop  @gol
6227-fsched-interblock  -fsched-spec @gol
6228-fschedule-insns  -fschedule-insns2 @gol
6229-fstrict-aliasing -fstrict-overflow @gol
6230-ftree-switch-conversion -ftree-tail-merge @gol
6231-ftree-pre @gol
6232-ftree-vrp}
6233
6234Please note the warning under @option{-fgcse} about
6235invoking @option{-O2} on programs that use computed gotos.
6236
6237@item -O3
6238@opindex O3
6239Optimize yet more.  @option{-O3} turns on all optimizations specified
6240by @option{-O2} and also turns on the @option{-finline-functions},
6241@option{-funswitch-loops}, @option{-fpredictive-commoning},
6242@option{-fgcse-after-reload}, @option{-ftree-vectorize} and
6243@option{-fipa-cp-clone} options.
6244
6245@item -O0
6246@opindex O0
6247Reduce compilation time and make debugging produce the expected
6248results.  This is the default.
6249
6250@item -Os
6251@opindex Os
6252Optimize for size.  @option{-Os} enables all @option{-O2} optimizations that
6253do not typically increase code size.  It also performs further
6254optimizations designed to reduce code size.
6255
6256@option{-Os} disables the following optimization flags:
6257@gccoptlist{-falign-functions  -falign-jumps  -falign-loops @gol
6258-falign-labels  -freorder-blocks  -freorder-blocks-and-partition @gol
6259-fprefetch-loop-arrays  -ftree-vect-loop-version}
6260
6261@item -Ofast
6262@opindex Ofast
6263Disregard strict standards compliance.  @option{-Ofast} enables all
6264@option{-O3} optimizations.  It also enables optimizations that are not
6265valid for all standard compliant programs.
6266It turns on @option{-ffast-math} and the Fortran-specific
6267@option{-fno-protect-parens} and @option{-fstack-arrays}.
6268
6269If you use multiple @option{-O} options, with or without level numbers,
6270the last such option is the one that is effective.
6271@end table
6272
6273Options of the form @option{-f@var{flag}} specify machine-independent
6274flags.  Most flags have both positive and negative forms; the negative
6275form of @option{-ffoo} would be @option{-fno-foo}.  In the table
6276below, only one of the forms is listed---the one you typically will
6277use.  You can figure out the other form by either removing @samp{no-}
6278or adding it.
6279
6280The following options control specific optimizations.  They are either
6281activated by @option{-O} options or are related to ones that are.  You
6282can use the following flags in the rare cases when ``fine-tuning'' of
6283optimizations to be performed is desired.
6284
6285@table @gcctabopt
6286@item -fno-default-inline
6287@opindex fno-default-inline
6288Do not make member functions inline by default merely because they are
6289defined inside the class scope (C++ only).  Otherwise, when you specify
6290@w{@option{-O}}, member functions defined inside class scope are compiled
6291inline by default; i.e., you don't need to add @samp{inline} in front of
6292the member function name.
6293
6294@item -fno-defer-pop
6295@opindex fno-defer-pop
6296Always pop the arguments to each function call as soon as that function
6297returns.  For machines that must pop arguments after a function call,
6298the compiler normally lets arguments accumulate on the stack for several
6299function calls and pops them all at once.
6300
6301Disabled at levels @option{-O}, @option{-O2}, @option{-O3}, @option{-Os}.
6302
6303@item -fforward-propagate
6304@opindex fforward-propagate
6305Perform a forward propagation pass on RTL@.  The pass tries to combine two
6306instructions and checks if the result can be simplified.  If loop unrolling
6307is active, two passes are performed and the second is scheduled after
6308loop unrolling.
6309
6310This option is enabled by default at optimization levels @option{-O},
6311@option{-O2}, @option{-O3}, @option{-Os}.
6312
6313@item -ffp-contract=@var{style}
6314@opindex ffp-contract
6315@option{-ffp-contract=off} disables floating-point expression contraction.
6316@option{-ffp-contract=fast} enables floating-point expression contraction
6317such as forming of fused multiply-add operations if the target has
6318native support for them.
6319@option{-ffp-contract=on} enables floating-point expression contraction
6320if allowed by the language standard.  This is currently not implemented
6321and treated equal to @option{-ffp-contract=off}.
6322
6323The default is @option{-ffp-contract=fast}.
6324
6325@item -fomit-frame-pointer
6326@opindex fomit-frame-pointer
6327Don't keep the frame pointer in a register for functions that
6328don't need one.  This avoids the instructions to save, set up and
6329restore frame pointers; it also makes an extra register available
6330in many functions.  @strong{It also makes debugging impossible on
6331some machines.}
6332
6333On some machines, such as the VAX, this flag has no effect, because
6334the standard calling sequence automatically handles the frame pointer
6335and nothing is saved by pretending it doesn't exist.  The
6336machine-description macro @code{FRAME_POINTER_REQUIRED} controls
6337whether a target machine supports this flag.  @xref{Registers,,Register
6338Usage, gccint, GNU Compiler Collection (GCC) Internals}.
6339
6340Starting with GCC version 4.6, the default setting (when not optimizing for
6341size) for 32-bit Linux x86 and 32-bit Darwin x86 targets has been changed to
6342@option{-fomit-frame-pointer}.  The default can be reverted to
6343@option{-fno-omit-frame-pointer} by configuring GCC with the
6344@option{--enable-frame-pointer} configure option.
6345
6346Enabled at levels @option{-O}, @option{-O2}, @option{-O3}, @option{-Os}.
6347
6348@item -foptimize-sibling-calls
6349@opindex foptimize-sibling-calls
6350Optimize sibling and tail recursive calls.
6351
6352Enabled at levels @option{-O2}, @option{-O3}, @option{-Os}.
6353
6354@item -fno-inline
6355@opindex fno-inline
6356Do not expand any functions inline apart from those marked with
6357the @code{always_inline} attribute.  This is the default when not
6358optimizing.
6359
6360Single functions can be exempted from inlining by marking them
6361with the @code{noinline} attribute.
6362
6363@item -finline-small-functions
6364@opindex finline-small-functions
6365Integrate functions into their callers when their body is smaller than expected
6366function call code (so overall size of program gets smaller).  The compiler
6367heuristically decides which functions are simple enough to be worth integrating
6368in this way.  This inlining applies to all functions, even those not declared
6369inline.
6370
6371Enabled at level @option{-O2}.
6372
6373@item -findirect-inlining
6374@opindex findirect-inlining
6375Inline also indirect calls that are discovered to be known at compile
6376time thanks to previous inlining.  This option has any effect only
6377when inlining itself is turned on by the @option{-finline-functions}
6378or @option{-finline-small-functions} options.
6379
6380Enabled at level @option{-O2}.
6381
6382@item -finline-functions
6383@opindex finline-functions
6384Consider all functions for inlining, even if they are not declared inline.
6385The compiler heuristically decides which functions are worth integrating
6386in this way.
6387
6388If all calls to a given function are integrated, and the function is
6389declared @code{static}, then the function is normally not output as
6390assembler code in its own right.
6391
6392Enabled at level @option{-O3}.
6393
6394@item -finline-functions-called-once
6395@opindex finline-functions-called-once
6396Consider all @code{static} functions called once for inlining into their
6397caller even if they are not marked @code{inline}.  If a call to a given
6398function is integrated, then the function is not output as assembler code
6399in its own right.
6400
6401Enabled at levels @option{-O1}, @option{-O2}, @option{-O3} and @option{-Os}.
6402
6403@item -fearly-inlining
6404@opindex fearly-inlining
6405Inline functions marked by @code{always_inline} and functions whose body seems
6406smaller than the function call overhead early before doing
6407@option{-fprofile-generate} instrumentation and real inlining pass.  Doing so
6408makes profiling significantly cheaper and usually inlining faster on programs
6409having large chains of nested wrapper functions.
6410
6411Enabled by default.
6412
6413@item -fipa-sra
6414@opindex fipa-sra
6415Perform interprocedural scalar replacement of aggregates, removal of
6416unused parameters and replacement of parameters passed by reference
6417by parameters passed by value.
6418
6419Enabled at levels @option{-O2}, @option{-O3} and @option{-Os}.
6420
6421@item -finline-limit=@var{n}
6422@opindex finline-limit
6423By default, GCC limits the size of functions that can be inlined.  This flag
6424allows coarse control of this limit.  @var{n} is the size of functions that
6425can be inlined in number of pseudo instructions.
6426
6427Inlining is actually controlled by a number of parameters, which may be
6428specified individually by using @option{--param @var{name}=@var{value}}.
6429The @option{-finline-limit=@var{n}} option sets some of these parameters
6430as follows:
6431
6432@table @gcctabopt
6433@item max-inline-insns-single
6434is set to @var{n}/2.
6435@item max-inline-insns-auto
6436is set to @var{n}/2.
6437@end table
6438
6439See below for a documentation of the individual
6440parameters controlling inlining and for the defaults of these parameters.
6441
6442@emph{Note:} there may be no value to @option{-finline-limit} that results
6443in default behavior.
6444
6445@emph{Note:} pseudo instruction represents, in this particular context, an
6446abstract measurement of function's size.  In no way does it represent a count
6447of assembly instructions and as such its exact meaning might change from one
6448release to an another.
6449
6450@item -fno-keep-inline-dllexport
6451@opindex -fno-keep-inline-dllexport
6452This is a more fine-grained version of @option{-fkeep-inline-functions},
6453which applies only to functions that are declared using the @code{dllexport}
6454attribute or declspec (@xref{Function Attributes,,Declaring Attributes of
6455Functions}.)
6456
6457@item -fkeep-inline-functions
6458@opindex fkeep-inline-functions
6459In C, emit @code{static} functions that are declared @code{inline}
6460into the object file, even if the function has been inlined into all
6461of its callers.  This switch does not affect functions using the
6462@code{extern inline} extension in GNU C90@.  In C++, emit any and all
6463inline functions into the object file.
6464
6465@item -fkeep-static-consts
6466@opindex fkeep-static-consts
6467Emit variables declared @code{static const} when optimization isn't turned
6468on, even if the variables aren't referenced.
6469
6470GCC enables this option by default.  If you want to force the compiler to
6471check if the variable was referenced, regardless of whether or not
6472optimization is turned on, use the @option{-fno-keep-static-consts} option.
6473
6474@item -fmerge-constants
6475@opindex fmerge-constants
6476Attempt to merge identical constants (string constants and floating-point
6477constants) across compilation units.
6478
6479This option is the default for optimized compilation if the assembler and
6480linker support it.  Use @option{-fno-merge-constants} to inhibit this
6481behavior.
6482
6483Enabled at levels @option{-O}, @option{-O2}, @option{-O3}, @option{-Os}.
6484
6485@item -fmerge-all-constants
6486@opindex fmerge-all-constants
6487Attempt to merge identical constants and identical variables.
6488
6489This option implies @option{-fmerge-constants}.  In addition to
6490@option{-fmerge-constants} this considers e.g.@: even constant initialized
6491arrays or initialized constant variables with integral or floating-point
6492types.  Languages like C or C++ require each variable, including multiple
6493instances of the same variable in recursive calls, to have distinct locations,
6494so using this option will result in non-conforming
6495behavior.
6496
6497@item -fmodulo-sched
6498@opindex fmodulo-sched
6499Perform swing modulo scheduling immediately before the first scheduling
6500pass.  This pass looks at innermost loops and reorders their
6501instructions by overlapping different iterations.
6502
6503@item -fmodulo-sched-allow-regmoves
6504@opindex fmodulo-sched-allow-regmoves
6505Perform more aggressive SMS based modulo scheduling with register moves
6506allowed.  By setting this flag certain anti-dependences edges will be
6507deleted which will trigger the generation of reg-moves based on the
6508life-range analysis.  This option is effective only with
6509@option{-fmodulo-sched} enabled.
6510
6511@item -fno-branch-count-reg
6512@opindex fno-branch-count-reg
6513Do not use ``decrement and branch'' instructions on a count register,
6514but instead generate a sequence of instructions that decrement a
6515register, compare it against zero, then branch based upon the result.
6516This option is only meaningful on architectures that support such
6517instructions, which include x86, PowerPC, IA-64 and S/390.
6518
6519The default is @option{-fbranch-count-reg}.
6520
6521@item -fno-function-cse
6522@opindex fno-function-cse
6523Do not put function addresses in registers; make each instruction that
6524calls a constant function contain the function's address explicitly.
6525
6526This option results in less efficient code, but some strange hacks
6527that alter the assembler output may be confused by the optimizations
6528performed when this option is not used.
6529
6530The default is @option{-ffunction-cse}
6531
6532@item -fno-zero-initialized-in-bss
6533@opindex fno-zero-initialized-in-bss
6534If the target supports a BSS section, GCC by default puts variables that
6535are initialized to zero into BSS@.  This can save space in the resulting
6536code.
6537
6538This option turns off this behavior because some programs explicitly
6539rely on variables going to the data section.  E.g., so that the
6540resulting executable can find the beginning of that section and/or make
6541assumptions based on that.
6542
6543The default is @option{-fzero-initialized-in-bss}.
6544
6545@item -fmudflap -fmudflapth -fmudflapir
6546@opindex fmudflap
6547@opindex fmudflapth
6548@opindex fmudflapir
6549@cindex bounds checking
6550@cindex mudflap
6551For front-ends that support it (C and C++), instrument all risky
6552pointer/array dereferencing operations, some standard library
6553string/heap functions, and some other associated constructs with
6554range/validity tests.  Modules so instrumented should be immune to
6555buffer overflows, invalid heap use, and some other classes of C/C++
6556programming errors.  The instrumentation relies on a separate runtime
6557library (@file{libmudflap}), which will be linked into a program if
6558@option{-fmudflap} is given at link time.  Run-time behavior of the
6559instrumented program is controlled by the @env{MUDFLAP_OPTIONS}
6560environment variable.  See @code{env MUDFLAP_OPTIONS=-help a.out}
6561for its options.
6562
6563Use @option{-fmudflapth} instead of @option{-fmudflap} to compile and to
6564link if your program is multi-threaded.  Use @option{-fmudflapir}, in
6565addition to @option{-fmudflap} or @option{-fmudflapth}, if
6566instrumentation should ignore pointer reads.  This produces less
6567instrumentation (and therefore faster execution) and still provides
6568some protection against outright memory corrupting writes, but allows
6569erroneously read data to propagate within a program.
6570
6571@item -fthread-jumps
6572@opindex fthread-jumps
6573Perform optimizations where we check to see if a jump branches to a
6574location where another comparison subsumed by the first is found.  If
6575so, the first branch is redirected to either the destination of the
6576second branch or a point immediately following it, depending on whether
6577the condition is known to be true or false.
6578
6579Enabled at levels @option{-O2}, @option{-O3}, @option{-Os}.
6580
6581@item -fsplit-wide-types
6582@opindex fsplit-wide-types
6583When using a type that occupies multiple registers, such as @code{long
6584long} on a 32-bit system, split the registers apart and allocate them
6585independently.  This normally generates better code for those types,
6586but may make debugging more difficult.
6587
6588Enabled at levels @option{-O}, @option{-O2}, @option{-O3},
6589@option{-Os}.
6590
6591@item -fcse-follow-jumps
6592@opindex fcse-follow-jumps
6593In common subexpression elimination (CSE), scan through jump instructions
6594when the target of the jump is not reached by any other path.  For
6595example, when CSE encounters an @code{if} statement with an
6596@code{else} clause, CSE will follow the jump when the condition
6597tested is false.
6598
6599Enabled at levels @option{-O2}, @option{-O3}, @option{-Os}.
6600
6601@item -fcse-skip-blocks
6602@opindex fcse-skip-blocks
6603This is similar to @option{-fcse-follow-jumps}, but causes CSE to
6604follow jumps that conditionally skip over blocks.  When CSE
6605encounters a simple @code{if} statement with no else clause,
6606@option{-fcse-skip-blocks} causes CSE to follow the jump around the
6607body of the @code{if}.
6608
6609Enabled at levels @option{-O2}, @option{-O3}, @option{-Os}.
6610
6611@item -frerun-cse-after-loop
6612@opindex frerun-cse-after-loop
6613Re-run common subexpression elimination after loop optimizations has been
6614performed.
6615
6616Enabled at levels @option{-O2}, @option{-O3}, @option{-Os}.
6617
6618@item -fgcse
6619@opindex fgcse
6620Perform a global common subexpression elimination pass.
6621This pass also performs global constant and copy propagation.
6622
6623@emph{Note:} When compiling a program using computed gotos, a GCC
6624extension, you may get better run-time performance if you disable
6625the global common subexpression elimination pass by adding
6626@option{-fno-gcse} to the command line.
6627
6628Enabled at levels @option{-O2}, @option{-O3}, @option{-Os}.
6629
6630@item -fgcse-lm
6631@opindex fgcse-lm
6632When @option{-fgcse-lm} is enabled, global common subexpression elimination will
6633attempt to move loads that are only killed by stores into themselves.  This
6634allows a loop containing a load/store sequence to be changed to a load outside
6635the loop, and a copy/store within the loop.
6636
6637Enabled by default when gcse is enabled.
6638
6639@item -fgcse-sm
6640@opindex fgcse-sm
6641When @option{-fgcse-sm} is enabled, a store motion pass is run after
6642global common subexpression elimination.  This pass will attempt to move
6643stores out of loops.  When used in conjunction with @option{-fgcse-lm},
6644loops containing a load/store sequence can be changed to a load before
6645the loop and a store after the loop.
6646
6647Not enabled at any optimization level.
6648
6649@item -fgcse-las
6650@opindex fgcse-las
6651When @option{-fgcse-las} is enabled, the global common subexpression
6652elimination pass eliminates redundant loads that come after stores to the
6653same memory location (both partial and full redundancies).
6654
6655Not enabled at any optimization level.
6656
6657@item -fgcse-after-reload
6658@opindex fgcse-after-reload
6659When @option{-fgcse-after-reload} is enabled, a redundant load elimination
6660pass is performed after reload.  The purpose of this pass is to cleanup
6661redundant spilling.
6662
6663@item -funsafe-loop-optimizations
6664@opindex funsafe-loop-optimizations
6665If given, the loop optimizer will assume that loop indices do not
6666overflow, and that the loops with nontrivial exit condition are not
6667infinite.  This enables a wider range of loop optimizations even if
6668the loop optimizer itself cannot prove that these assumptions are valid.
6669Using @option{-Wunsafe-loop-optimizations}, the compiler will warn you
6670if it finds this kind of loop.
6671
6672@item -fcrossjumping
6673@opindex fcrossjumping
6674Perform cross-jumping transformation.  This transformation unifies equivalent code and save code size.  The
6675resulting code may or may not perform better than without cross-jumping.
6676
6677Enabled at levels @option{-O2}, @option{-O3}, @option{-Os}.
6678
6679@item -fauto-inc-dec
6680@opindex fauto-inc-dec
6681Combine increments or decrements of addresses with memory accesses.
6682This pass is always skipped on architectures that do not have
6683instructions to support this.  Enabled by default at @option{-O} and
6684higher on architectures that support this.
6685
6686@item -fdce
6687@opindex fdce
6688Perform dead code elimination (DCE) on RTL@.
6689Enabled by default at @option{-O} and higher.
6690
6691@item -fdse
6692@opindex fdse
6693Perform dead store elimination (DSE) on RTL@.
6694Enabled by default at @option{-O} and higher.
6695
6696@item -fif-conversion
6697@opindex fif-conversion
6698Attempt to transform conditional jumps into branch-less equivalents.  This
6699include use of conditional moves, min, max, set flags and abs instructions, and
6700some tricks doable by standard arithmetics.  The use of conditional execution
6701on chips where it is available is controlled by @code{if-conversion2}.
6702
6703Enabled at levels @option{-O}, @option{-O2}, @option{-O3}, @option{-Os}.
6704
6705@item -fif-conversion2
6706@opindex fif-conversion2
6707Use conditional execution (where available) to transform conditional jumps into
6708branch-less equivalents.
6709
6710Enabled at levels @option{-O}, @option{-O2}, @option{-O3}, @option{-Os}.
6711
6712@item -fdelete-null-pointer-checks
6713@opindex fdelete-null-pointer-checks
6714Assume that programs cannot safely dereference null pointers, and that
6715no code or data element resides there.  This enables simple constant
6716folding optimizations at all optimization levels.  In addition, other
6717optimization passes in GCC use this flag to control global dataflow
6718analyses that eliminate useless checks for null pointers; these assume
6719that if a pointer is checked after it has already been dereferenced,
6720it cannot be null.
6721
6722Note however that in some environments this assumption is not true.
6723Use @option{-fno-delete-null-pointer-checks} to disable this optimization
6724for programs that depend on that behavior.
6725
6726Some targets, especially embedded ones, disable this option at all levels.
6727Otherwise it is enabled at all levels: @option{-O0}, @option{-O1},
6728@option{-O2}, @option{-O3}, @option{-Os}.  Passes that use the information
6729are enabled independently at different optimization levels.
6730
6731@item -fdevirtualize
6732@opindex fdevirtualize
6733Attempt to convert calls to virtual functions to direct calls.  This
6734is done both within a procedure and interprocedurally as part of
6735indirect inlining (@code{-findirect-inlining}) and interprocedural constant
6736propagation (@option{-fipa-cp}).
6737Enabled at levels @option{-O2}, @option{-O3}, @option{-Os}.
6738
6739@item -fexpensive-optimizations
6740@opindex fexpensive-optimizations
6741Perform a number of minor optimizations that are relatively expensive.
6742
6743Enabled at levels @option{-O2}, @option{-O3}, @option{-Os}.
6744
6745@item -free
6746@opindex free
6747Attempt to remove redundant extension instructions.  This is especially
6748helpful for the x86-64 architecture which implicitly zero-extends in 64-bit
6749registers after writing to their lower 32-bit half.
6750
6751Enabled for x86 at levels @option{-O2}, @option{-O3}.
6752
6753@item -foptimize-register-move
6754@itemx -fregmove
6755@opindex foptimize-register-move
6756@opindex fregmove
6757Attempt to reassign register numbers in move instructions and as
6758operands of other simple instructions in order to maximize the amount of
6759register tying.  This is especially helpful on machines with two-operand
6760instructions.
6761
6762Note @option{-fregmove} and @option{-foptimize-register-move} are the same
6763optimization.
6764
6765Enabled at levels @option{-O2}, @option{-O3}, @option{-Os}.
6766
6767@item -fira-algorithm=@var{algorithm}
6768Use the specified coloring algorithm for the integrated register
6769allocator.  The @var{algorithm} argument can be @samp{priority}, which
6770specifies Chow's priority coloring, or @samp{CB}, which specifies
6771Chaitin-Briggs coloring.  Chaitin-Briggs coloring is not implemented
6772for all architectures, but for those targets that do support it, it is
6773the default because it generates better code.
6774
6775@item -fira-region=@var{region}
6776Use specified regions for the integrated register allocator.  The
6777@var{region} argument should be one of the following:
6778
6779@table @samp
6780
6781@item all
6782Use all loops as register allocation regions.
6783This can give the best results for machines with a small and/or
6784irregular register set.
6785
6786@item mixed
6787Use all loops except for loops with small register pressure
6788as the regions.  This value usually gives
6789the best results in most cases and for most architectures,
6790and is enabled by default when compiling with optimization for speed
6791(@option{-O}, @option{-O2}, @dots{}).
6792
6793@item one
6794Use all functions as a single region.
6795This typically results in the smallest code size, and is enabled by default for
6796@option{-Os} or @option{-O0}.
6797
6798@end table
6799
6800@item -fira-loop-pressure
6801@opindex fira-loop-pressure
6802Use IRA to evaluate register pressure in loops for decisions to move
6803loop invariants.  This option usually results in generation
6804of faster and smaller code on machines with large register files (>= 32
6805registers), but it can slow the compiler down.
6806
6807This option is enabled at level @option{-O3} for some targets.
6808
6809@item -fno-ira-share-save-slots
6810@opindex fno-ira-share-save-slots
6811Disable sharing of stack slots used for saving call-used hard
6812registers living through a call.  Each hard register gets a
6813separate stack slot, and as a result function stack frames are
6814larger.
6815
6816@item -fno-ira-share-spill-slots
6817@opindex fno-ira-share-spill-slots
6818Disable sharing of stack slots allocated for pseudo-registers.  Each
6819pseudo-register that does not get a hard register gets a separate
6820stack slot, and as a result function stack frames are larger.
6821
6822@item -fira-verbose=@var{n}
6823@opindex fira-verbose
6824Control the verbosity of the dump file for the integrated register allocator.
6825The default value is 5.  If the value @var{n} is greater or equal to 10,
6826the dump output is sent to stderr using the same format as @var{n} minus 10.
6827
6828@item -fdelayed-branch
6829@opindex fdelayed-branch
6830If supported for the target machine, attempt to reorder instructions
6831to exploit instruction slots available after delayed branch
6832instructions.
6833
6834Enabled at levels @option{-O}, @option{-O2}, @option{-O3}, @option{-Os}.
6835
6836@item -fschedule-insns
6837@opindex fschedule-insns
6838If supported for the target machine, attempt to reorder instructions to
6839eliminate execution stalls due to required data being unavailable.  This
6840helps machines that have slow floating point or memory load instructions
6841by allowing other instructions to be issued until the result of the load
6842or floating-point instruction is required.
6843
6844Enabled at levels @option{-O2}, @option{-O3}.
6845
6846@item -fschedule-insns2
6847@opindex fschedule-insns2
6848Similar to @option{-fschedule-insns}, but requests an additional pass of
6849instruction scheduling after register allocation has been done.  This is
6850especially useful on machines with a relatively small number of
6851registers and where memory load instructions take more than one cycle.
6852
6853Enabled at levels @option{-O2}, @option{-O3}, @option{-Os}.
6854
6855@item -fno-sched-interblock
6856@opindex fno-sched-interblock
6857Don't schedule instructions across basic blocks.  This is normally
6858enabled by default when scheduling before register allocation, i.e.@:
6859with @option{-fschedule-insns} or at @option{-O2} or higher.
6860
6861@item -fno-sched-spec
6862@opindex fno-sched-spec
6863Don't allow speculative motion of non-load instructions.  This is normally
6864enabled by default when scheduling before register allocation, i.e.@:
6865with @option{-fschedule-insns} or at @option{-O2} or higher.
6866
6867@item -fsched-pressure
6868@opindex fsched-pressure
6869Enable register pressure sensitive insn scheduling before the register
6870allocation.  This only makes sense when scheduling before register
6871allocation is enabled, i.e.@: with @option{-fschedule-insns} or at
6872@option{-O2} or higher.  Usage of this option can improve the
6873generated code and decrease its size by preventing register pressure
6874increase above the number of available hard registers and as a
6875consequence register spills in the register allocation.
6876
6877@item -fsched-spec-load
6878@opindex fsched-spec-load
6879Allow speculative motion of some load instructions.  This only makes
6880sense when scheduling before register allocation, i.e.@: with
6881@option{-fschedule-insns} or at @option{-O2} or higher.
6882
6883@item -fsched-spec-load-dangerous
6884@opindex fsched-spec-load-dangerous
6885Allow speculative motion of more load instructions.  This only makes
6886sense when scheduling before register allocation, i.e.@: with
6887@option{-fschedule-insns} or at @option{-O2} or higher.
6888
6889@item -fsched-stalled-insns
6890@itemx -fsched-stalled-insns=@var{n}
6891@opindex fsched-stalled-insns
6892Define how many insns (if any) can be moved prematurely from the queue
6893of stalled insns into the ready list, during the second scheduling pass.
6894@option{-fno-sched-stalled-insns} means that no insns will be moved
6895prematurely, @option{-fsched-stalled-insns=0} means there is no limit
6896on how many queued insns can be moved prematurely.
6897@option{-fsched-stalled-insns} without a value is equivalent to
6898@option{-fsched-stalled-insns=1}.
6899
6900@item -fsched-stalled-insns-dep
6901@itemx -fsched-stalled-insns-dep=@var{n}
6902@opindex fsched-stalled-insns-dep
6903Define how many insn groups (cycles) will be examined for a dependency
6904on a stalled insn that is candidate for premature removal from the queue
6905of stalled insns.  This has an effect only during the second scheduling pass,
6906and only if @option{-fsched-stalled-insns} is used.
6907@option{-fno-sched-stalled-insns-dep} is equivalent to
6908@option{-fsched-stalled-insns-dep=0}.
6909@option{-fsched-stalled-insns-dep} without a value is equivalent to
6910@option{-fsched-stalled-insns-dep=1}.
6911
6912@item -fsched2-use-superblocks
6913@opindex fsched2-use-superblocks
6914When scheduling after register allocation, do use superblock scheduling
6915algorithm.  Superblock scheduling allows motion across basic block boundaries
6916resulting on faster schedules.  This option is experimental, as not all machine
6917descriptions used by GCC model the CPU closely enough to avoid unreliable
6918results from the algorithm.
6919
6920This only makes sense when scheduling after register allocation, i.e.@: with
6921@option{-fschedule-insns2} or at @option{-O2} or higher.
6922
6923@item -fsched-group-heuristic
6924@opindex fsched-group-heuristic
6925Enable the group heuristic in the scheduler.  This heuristic favors
6926the instruction that belongs to a schedule group.  This is enabled
6927by default when scheduling is enabled, i.e.@: with @option{-fschedule-insns}
6928or @option{-fschedule-insns2} or at @option{-O2} or higher.
6929
6930@item -fsched-critical-path-heuristic
6931@opindex fsched-critical-path-heuristic
6932Enable the critical-path heuristic in the scheduler.  This heuristic favors
6933instructions on the critical path.  This is enabled by default when
6934scheduling is enabled, i.e.@: with @option{-fschedule-insns}
6935or @option{-fschedule-insns2} or at @option{-O2} or higher.
6936
6937@item -fsched-spec-insn-heuristic
6938@opindex fsched-spec-insn-heuristic
6939Enable the speculative instruction heuristic in the scheduler.  This
6940heuristic favors speculative instructions with greater dependency weakness.
6941This is enabled by default when scheduling is enabled, i.e.@:
6942with @option{-fschedule-insns} or @option{-fschedule-insns2}
6943or at @option{-O2} or higher.
6944
6945@item -fsched-rank-heuristic
6946@opindex fsched-rank-heuristic
6947Enable the rank heuristic in the scheduler.  This heuristic favors
6948the instruction belonging to a basic block with greater size or frequency.
6949This is enabled by default when scheduling is enabled, i.e.@:
6950with @option{-fschedule-insns} or @option{-fschedule-insns2} or
6951at @option{-O2} or higher.
6952
6953@item -fsched-last-insn-heuristic
6954@opindex fsched-last-insn-heuristic
6955Enable the last-instruction heuristic in the scheduler.  This heuristic
6956favors the instruction that is less dependent on the last instruction
6957scheduled.  This is enabled by default when scheduling is enabled,
6958i.e.@: with @option{-fschedule-insns} or @option{-fschedule-insns2} or
6959at @option{-O2} or higher.
6960
6961@item -fsched-dep-count-heuristic
6962@opindex fsched-dep-count-heuristic
6963Enable the dependent-count heuristic in the scheduler.  This heuristic
6964favors the instruction that has more instructions depending on it.
6965This is enabled by default when scheduling is enabled, i.e.@:
6966with @option{-fschedule-insns} or @option{-fschedule-insns2} or
6967at @option{-O2} or higher.
6968
6969@item -freschedule-modulo-scheduled-loops
6970@opindex freschedule-modulo-scheduled-loops
6971The modulo scheduling comes before the traditional scheduling, if a loop
6972was modulo scheduled we may want to prevent the later scheduling passes
6973from changing its schedule, we use this option to control that.
6974
6975@item -fselective-scheduling
6976@opindex fselective-scheduling
6977Schedule instructions using selective scheduling algorithm.  Selective
6978scheduling runs instead of the first scheduler pass.
6979
6980@item -fselective-scheduling2
6981@opindex fselective-scheduling2
6982Schedule instructions using selective scheduling algorithm.  Selective
6983scheduling runs instead of the second scheduler pass.
6984
6985@item -fsel-sched-pipelining
6986@opindex fsel-sched-pipelining
6987Enable software pipelining of innermost loops during selective scheduling.
6988This option has no effect until one of @option{-fselective-scheduling} or
6989@option{-fselective-scheduling2} is turned on.
6990
6991@item -fsel-sched-pipelining-outer-loops
6992@opindex fsel-sched-pipelining-outer-loops
6993When pipelining loops during selective scheduling, also pipeline outer loops.
6994This option has no effect until @option{-fsel-sched-pipelining} is turned on.
6995
6996@item -fshrink-wrap
6997@opindex fshrink-wrap
6998Emit function prologues only before parts of the function that need it,
6999rather than at the top of the function.  This flag is enabled by default at
7000@option{-O} and higher.
7001
7002@item -fcaller-saves
7003@opindex fcaller-saves
7004Enable values to be allocated in registers that will be clobbered by
7005function calls, by emitting extra instructions to save and restore the
7006registers around such calls.  Such allocation is done only when it
7007seems to result in better code than would otherwise be produced.
7008
7009This option is always enabled by default on certain machines, usually
7010those which have no call-preserved registers to use instead.
7011
7012Enabled at levels @option{-O2}, @option{-O3}, @option{-Os}.
7013
7014@item -fcombine-stack-adjustments
7015@opindex fcombine-stack-adjustments
7016Tracks stack adjustments (pushes and pops) and stack memory references
7017and then tries to find ways to combine them.
7018
7019Enabled by default at @option{-O1} and higher.
7020
7021@item -fconserve-stack
7022@opindex fconserve-stack
7023Attempt to minimize stack usage.  The compiler will attempt to use less
7024stack space, even if that makes the program slower.  This option
7025implies setting the @option{large-stack-frame} parameter to 100
7026and the @option{large-stack-frame-growth} parameter to 400.
7027
7028@item -ftree-reassoc
7029@opindex ftree-reassoc
7030Perform reassociation on trees.  This flag is enabled by default
7031at @option{-O} and higher.
7032
7033@item -ftree-pre
7034@opindex ftree-pre
7035Perform partial redundancy elimination (PRE) on trees.  This flag is
7036enabled by default at @option{-O2} and @option{-O3}.
7037
7038@item -ftree-forwprop
7039@opindex ftree-forwprop
7040Perform forward propagation on trees.  This flag is enabled by default
7041at @option{-O} and higher.
7042
7043@item -ftree-fre
7044@opindex ftree-fre
7045Perform full redundancy elimination (FRE) on trees.  The difference
7046between FRE and PRE is that FRE only considers expressions
7047that are computed on all paths leading to the redundant computation.
7048This analysis is faster than PRE, though it exposes fewer redundancies.
7049This flag is enabled by default at @option{-O} and higher.
7050
7051@item -ftree-phiprop
7052@opindex ftree-phiprop
7053Perform hoisting of loads from conditional pointers on trees.  This
7054pass is enabled by default at @option{-O} and higher.
7055
7056@item -ftree-copy-prop
7057@opindex ftree-copy-prop
7058Perform copy propagation on trees.  This pass eliminates unnecessary
7059copy operations.  This flag is enabled by default at @option{-O} and
7060higher.
7061
7062@item -fipa-pure-const
7063@opindex fipa-pure-const
7064Discover which functions are pure or constant.
7065Enabled by default at @option{-O} and higher.
7066
7067@item -fipa-reference
7068@opindex fipa-reference
7069Discover which static variables do not escape cannot escape the
7070compilation unit.
7071Enabled by default at @option{-O} and higher.
7072
7073@item -fipa-pta
7074@opindex fipa-pta
7075Perform interprocedural pointer analysis and interprocedural modification
7076and reference analysis.  This option can cause excessive memory and
7077compile-time usage on large compilation units.  It is not enabled by
7078default at any optimization level.
7079
7080@item -fipa-profile
7081@opindex fipa-profile
7082Perform interprocedural profile propagation.  The functions called only from
7083cold functions are marked as cold. Also functions executed once (such as
7084@code{cold}, @code{noreturn}, static constructors or destructors) are identified. Cold
7085functions and loop less parts of functions executed once are then optimized for
7086size.
7087Enabled by default at @option{-O} and higher.
7088
7089@item -fipa-cp
7090@opindex fipa-cp
7091Perform interprocedural constant propagation.
7092This optimization analyzes the program to determine when values passed
7093to functions are constants and then optimizes accordingly.
7094This optimization can substantially increase performance
7095if the application has constants passed to functions.
7096This flag is enabled by default at @option{-O2}, @option{-Os} and @option{-O3}.
7097
7098@item -fipa-cp-clone
7099@opindex fipa-cp-clone
7100Perform function cloning to make interprocedural constant propagation stronger.
7101When enabled, interprocedural constant propagation will perform function cloning
7102when externally visible function can be called with constant arguments.
7103Because this optimization can create multiple copies of functions,
7104it may significantly increase code size
7105(see @option{--param ipcp-unit-growth=@var{value}}).
7106This flag is enabled by default at @option{-O3}.
7107
7108@item -fipa-matrix-reorg
7109@opindex fipa-matrix-reorg
7110Perform matrix flattening and transposing.
7111Matrix flattening tries to replace an @math{m}-dimensional matrix
7112with its equivalent @math{n}-dimensional matrix, where @math{n < m}.
7113This reduces the level of indirection needed for accessing the elements
7114of the matrix. The second optimization is matrix transposing, which
7115attempts to change the order of the matrix's dimensions in order to
7116improve cache locality.
7117Both optimizations need the @option{-fwhole-program} flag.
7118Transposing is enabled only if profiling information is available.
7119
7120@item -ftree-sink
7121@opindex ftree-sink
7122Perform forward store motion  on trees.  This flag is
7123enabled by default at @option{-O} and higher.
7124
7125@item -ftree-bit-ccp
7126@opindex ftree-bit-ccp
7127Perform sparse conditional bit constant propagation on trees and propagate
7128pointer alignment information.
7129This pass only operates on local scalar variables and is enabled by default
7130at @option{-O} and higher.  It requires that @option{-ftree-ccp} is enabled.
7131
7132@item -ftree-ccp
7133@opindex ftree-ccp
7134Perform sparse conditional constant propagation (CCP) on trees.  This
7135pass only operates on local scalar variables and is enabled by default
7136at @option{-O} and higher.
7137
7138@item -ftree-switch-conversion
7139Perform conversion of simple initializations in a switch to
7140initializations from a scalar array.  This flag is enabled by default
7141at @option{-O2} and higher.
7142
7143@item -ftree-tail-merge
7144Look for identical code sequences.  When found, replace one with a jump to the
7145other.  This optimization is known as tail merging or cross jumping.  This flag
7146is enabled by default at @option{-O2} and higher.  The compilation time
7147in this pass can
7148be limited using @option{max-tail-merge-comparisons} parameter and
7149@option{max-tail-merge-iterations} parameter.
7150
7151@item -ftree-dce
7152@opindex ftree-dce
7153Perform dead code elimination (DCE) on trees.  This flag is enabled by
7154default at @option{-O} and higher.
7155
7156@item -ftree-builtin-call-dce
7157@opindex ftree-builtin-call-dce
7158Perform conditional dead code elimination (DCE) for calls to builtin functions
7159that may set @code{errno} but are otherwise side-effect free.  This flag is
7160enabled by default at @option{-O2} and higher if @option{-Os} is not also
7161specified.
7162
7163@item -ftree-dominator-opts
7164@opindex ftree-dominator-opts
7165Perform a variety of simple scalar cleanups (constant/copy
7166propagation, redundancy elimination, range propagation and expression
7167simplification) based on a dominator tree traversal.  This also
7168performs jump threading (to reduce jumps to jumps). This flag is
7169enabled by default at @option{-O} and higher.
7170
7171@item -ftree-dse
7172@opindex ftree-dse
7173Perform dead store elimination (DSE) on trees.  A dead store is a store into
7174a memory location that is later overwritten by another store without
7175any intervening loads.  In this case the earlier store can be deleted.  This
7176flag is enabled by default at @option{-O} and higher.
7177
7178@item -ftree-ch
7179@opindex ftree-ch
7180Perform loop header copying on trees.  This is beneficial since it increases
7181effectiveness of code motion optimizations.  It also saves one jump.  This flag
7182is enabled by default at @option{-O} and higher.  It is not enabled
7183for @option{-Os}, since it usually increases code size.
7184
7185@item -ftree-loop-optimize
7186@opindex ftree-loop-optimize
7187Perform loop optimizations on trees.  This flag is enabled by default
7188at @option{-O} and higher.
7189
7190@item -ftree-loop-linear
7191@opindex ftree-loop-linear
7192Perform loop interchange transformations on tree.  Same as
7193@option{-floop-interchange}.  To use this code transformation, GCC has
7194to be configured with @option{--with-ppl} and @option{--with-cloog} to
7195enable the Graphite loop transformation infrastructure.
7196
7197@item -floop-interchange
7198@opindex floop-interchange
7199Perform loop interchange transformations on loops.  Interchanging two
7200nested loops switches the inner and outer loops.  For example, given a
7201loop like:
7202@smallexample
7203DO J = 1, M
7204  DO I = 1, N
7205    A(J, I) = A(J, I) * C
7206  ENDDO
7207ENDDO
7208@end smallexample
7209loop interchange will transform the loop as if the user had written:
7210@smallexample
7211DO I = 1, N
7212  DO J = 1, M
7213    A(J, I) = A(J, I) * C
7214  ENDDO
7215ENDDO
7216@end smallexample
7217which can be beneficial when @code{N} is larger than the caches,
7218because in Fortran, the elements of an array are stored in memory
7219contiguously by column, and the original loop iterates over rows,
7220potentially creating at each access a cache miss.  This optimization
7221applies to all the languages supported by GCC and is not limited to
7222Fortran.  To use this code transformation, GCC has to be configured
7223with @option{--with-ppl} and @option{--with-cloog} to enable the
7224Graphite loop transformation infrastructure.
7225
7226@item -floop-strip-mine
7227@opindex floop-strip-mine
7228Perform loop strip mining transformations on loops.  Strip mining
7229splits a loop into two nested loops.  The outer loop has strides
7230equal to the strip size and the inner loop has strides of the
7231original loop within a strip.  The strip length can be changed
7232using the @option{loop-block-tile-size} parameter.  For example,
7233given a loop like:
7234@smallexample
7235DO I = 1, N
7236  A(I) = A(I) + C
7237ENDDO
7238@end smallexample
7239loop strip mining will transform the loop as if the user had written:
7240@smallexample
7241DO II = 1, N, 51
7242  DO I = II, min (II + 50, N)
7243    A(I) = A(I) + C
7244  ENDDO
7245ENDDO
7246@end smallexample
7247This optimization applies to all the languages supported by GCC and is
7248not limited to Fortran.  To use this code transformation, GCC has to
7249be configured with @option{--with-ppl} and @option{--with-cloog} to
7250enable the Graphite loop transformation infrastructure.
7251
7252@item -floop-block
7253@opindex floop-block
7254Perform loop blocking transformations on loops.  Blocking strip mines
7255each loop in the loop nest such that the memory accesses of the
7256element loops fit inside caches.  The strip length can be changed
7257using the @option{loop-block-tile-size} parameter.  For example, given
7258a loop like:
7259@smallexample
7260DO I = 1, N
7261  DO J = 1, M
7262    A(J, I) = B(I) + C(J)
7263  ENDDO
7264ENDDO
7265@end smallexample
7266loop blocking will transform the loop as if the user had written:
7267@smallexample
7268DO II = 1, N, 51
7269  DO JJ = 1, M, 51
7270    DO I = II, min (II + 50, N)
7271      DO J = JJ, min (JJ + 50, M)
7272        A(J, I) = B(I) + C(J)
7273      ENDDO
7274    ENDDO
7275  ENDDO
7276ENDDO
7277@end smallexample
7278which can be beneficial when @code{M} is larger than the caches,
7279because the innermost loop will iterate over a smaller amount of data
7280which can be kept in the caches.  This optimization applies to all the
7281languages supported by GCC and is not limited to Fortran.  To use this
7282code transformation, GCC has to be configured with @option{--with-ppl}
7283and @option{--with-cloog} to enable the Graphite loop transformation
7284infrastructure.
7285
7286@item -fgraphite-identity
7287@opindex fgraphite-identity
7288Enable the identity transformation for graphite.  For every SCoP we generate
7289the polyhedral representation and transform it back to gimple.  Using
7290@option{-fgraphite-identity} we can check the costs or benefits of the
7291GIMPLE -> GRAPHITE -> GIMPLE transformation.  Some minimal optimizations
7292are also performed by the code generator CLooG, like index splitting and
7293dead code elimination in loops.
7294
7295@item -floop-flatten
7296@opindex floop-flatten
7297Removes the loop nesting structure: transforms the loop nest into a
7298single loop.  This transformation can be useful as an enablement
7299transform for vectorization and parallelization.  This feature
7300is experimental.
7301To use this code transformation, GCC has to be configured
7302with @option{--with-ppl} and @option{--with-cloog} to enable the
7303Graphite loop transformation infrastructure.
7304
7305@item -floop-parallelize-all
7306@opindex floop-parallelize-all
7307Use the Graphite data dependence analysis to identify loops that can
7308be parallelized.  Parallelize all the loops that can be analyzed to
7309not contain loop carried dependences without checking that it is
7310profitable to parallelize the loops.
7311
7312@item -fcheck-data-deps
7313@opindex fcheck-data-deps
7314Compare the results of several data dependence analyzers.  This option
7315is used for debugging the data dependence analyzers.
7316
7317@item -ftree-loop-if-convert
7318Attempt to transform conditional jumps in the innermost loops to
7319branch-less equivalents.  The intent is to remove control-flow from
7320the innermost loops in order to improve the ability of the
7321vectorization pass to handle these loops.  This is enabled by default
7322if vectorization is enabled.
7323
7324@item -ftree-loop-if-convert-stores
7325Attempt to also if-convert conditional jumps containing memory writes.
7326This transformation can be unsafe for multi-threaded programs as it
7327transforms conditional memory writes into unconditional memory writes.
7328For example,
7329@smallexample
7330for (i = 0; i < N; i++)
7331  if (cond)
7332    A[i] = expr;
7333@end smallexample
7334would be transformed to
7335@smallexample
7336for (i = 0; i < N; i++)
7337  A[i] = cond ? expr : A[i];
7338@end smallexample
7339potentially producing data races.
7340
7341@item -ftree-loop-distribution
7342Perform loop distribution.  This flag can improve cache performance on
7343big loop bodies and allow further loop optimizations, like
7344parallelization or vectorization, to take place.  For example, the loop
7345@smallexample
7346DO I = 1, N
7347  A(I) = B(I) + C
7348  D(I) = E(I) * F
7349ENDDO
7350@end smallexample
7351is transformed to
7352@smallexample
7353DO I = 1, N
7354   A(I) = B(I) + C
7355ENDDO
7356DO I = 1, N
7357   D(I) = E(I) * F
7358ENDDO
7359@end smallexample
7360
7361@item -ftree-loop-distribute-patterns
7362Perform loop distribution of patterns that can be code generated with
7363calls to a library.  This flag is enabled by default at @option{-O3}.
7364
7365This pass distributes the initialization loops and generates a call to
7366memset zero.  For example, the loop
7367@smallexample
7368DO I = 1, N
7369  A(I) = 0
7370  B(I) = A(I) + I
7371ENDDO
7372@end smallexample
7373is transformed to
7374@smallexample
7375DO I = 1, N
7376   A(I) = 0
7377ENDDO
7378DO I = 1, N
7379   B(I) = A(I) + I
7380ENDDO
7381@end smallexample
7382and the initialization loop is transformed into a call to memset zero.
7383
7384@item -ftree-loop-im
7385@opindex ftree-loop-im
7386Perform loop invariant motion on trees.  This pass moves only invariants that
7387would be hard to handle at RTL level (function calls, operations that expand to
7388nontrivial sequences of insns).  With @option{-funswitch-loops} it also moves
7389operands of conditions that are invariant out of the loop, so that we can use
7390just trivial invariantness analysis in loop unswitching.  The pass also includes
7391store motion.
7392
7393@item -ftree-loop-ivcanon
7394@opindex ftree-loop-ivcanon
7395Create a canonical counter for number of iterations in loops for which
7396determining number of iterations requires complicated analysis.  Later
7397optimizations then may determine the number easily.  Useful especially
7398in connection with unrolling.
7399
7400@item -fivopts
7401@opindex fivopts
7402Perform induction variable optimizations (strength reduction, induction
7403variable merging and induction variable elimination) on trees.
7404
7405@item -ftree-parallelize-loops=n
7406@opindex ftree-parallelize-loops
7407Parallelize loops, i.e., split their iteration space to run in n threads.
7408This is only possible for loops whose iterations are independent
7409and can be arbitrarily reordered.  The optimization is only
7410profitable on multiprocessor machines, for loops that are CPU-intensive,
7411rather than constrained e.g.@: by memory bandwidth.  This option
7412implies @option{-pthread}, and thus is only supported on targets
7413that have support for @option{-pthread}.
7414
7415@item -ftree-pta
7416@opindex ftree-pta
7417Perform function-local points-to analysis on trees.  This flag is
7418enabled by default at @option{-O} and higher.
7419
7420@item -ftree-sra
7421@opindex ftree-sra
7422Perform scalar replacement of aggregates.  This pass replaces structure
7423references with scalars to prevent committing structures to memory too
7424early.  This flag is enabled by default at @option{-O} and higher.
7425
7426@item -ftree-copyrename
7427@opindex ftree-copyrename
7428Perform copy renaming on trees.  This pass attempts to rename compiler
7429temporaries to other variables at copy locations, usually resulting in
7430variable names which more closely resemble the original variables.  This flag
7431is enabled by default at @option{-O} and higher.
7432
7433@item -ftree-ter
7434@opindex ftree-ter
7435Perform temporary expression replacement during the SSA->normal phase.  Single
7436use/single def temporaries are replaced at their use location with their
7437defining expression.  This results in non-GIMPLE code, but gives the expanders
7438much more complex trees to work on resulting in better RTL generation.  This is
7439enabled by default at @option{-O} and higher.
7440
7441@item -ftree-vectorize
7442@opindex ftree-vectorize
7443Perform loop vectorization on trees. This flag is enabled by default at
7444@option{-O3}.
7445
7446@item -ftree-slp-vectorize
7447@opindex ftree-slp-vectorize
7448Perform basic block vectorization on trees. This flag is enabled by default at
7449@option{-O3} and when @option{-ftree-vectorize} is enabled.
7450
7451@item -ftree-vect-loop-version
7452@opindex ftree-vect-loop-version
7453Perform loop versioning when doing loop vectorization on trees.  When a loop
7454appears to be vectorizable except that data alignment or data dependence cannot
7455be determined at compile time, then vectorized and non-vectorized versions of
7456the loop are generated along with run-time checks for alignment or dependence
7457to control which version is executed.  This option is enabled by default
7458except at level @option{-Os} where it is disabled.
7459
7460@item -fvect-cost-model
7461@opindex fvect-cost-model
7462Enable cost model for vectorization.
7463
7464@item -ftree-vrp
7465@opindex ftree-vrp
7466Perform Value Range Propagation on trees.  This is similar to the
7467constant propagation pass, but instead of values, ranges of values are
7468propagated.  This allows the optimizers to remove unnecessary range
7469checks like array bound checks and null pointer checks.  This is
7470enabled by default at @option{-O2} and higher.  Null pointer check
7471elimination is only done if @option{-fdelete-null-pointer-checks} is
7472enabled.
7473
7474@item -ftracer
7475@opindex ftracer
7476Perform tail duplication to enlarge superblock size.  This transformation
7477simplifies the control flow of the function allowing other optimizations to do
7478better job.
7479
7480@item -funroll-loops
7481@opindex funroll-loops
7482Unroll loops whose number of iterations can be determined at compile
7483time or upon entry to the loop.  @option{-funroll-loops} implies
7484@option{-frerun-cse-after-loop}.  This option makes code larger,
7485and may or may not make it run faster.
7486
7487@item -funroll-all-loops
7488@opindex funroll-all-loops
7489Unroll all loops, even if their number of iterations is uncertain when
7490the loop is entered.  This usually makes programs run more slowly.
7491@option{-funroll-all-loops} implies the same options as
7492@option{-funroll-loops},
7493
7494@item -fsplit-ivs-in-unroller
7495@opindex fsplit-ivs-in-unroller
7496Enables expressing of values of induction variables in later iterations
7497of the unrolled loop using the value in the first iteration.  This breaks
7498long dependency chains, thus improving efficiency of the scheduling passes.
7499
7500Combination of @option{-fweb} and CSE is often sufficient to obtain the
7501same effect.  However in cases the loop body is more complicated than
7502a single basic block, this is not reliable.  It also does not work at all
7503on some of the architectures due to restrictions in the CSE pass.
7504
7505This optimization is enabled by default.
7506
7507@item -fvariable-expansion-in-unroller
7508@opindex fvariable-expansion-in-unroller
7509With this option, the compiler will create multiple copies of some
7510local variables when unrolling a loop which can result in superior code.
7511
7512@item -fpartial-inlining
7513@opindex fpartial-inlining
7514Inline parts of functions.  This option has any effect only
7515when inlining itself is turned on by the @option{-finline-functions}
7516or @option{-finline-small-functions} options.
7517
7518Enabled at level @option{-O2}.
7519
7520@item -fpredictive-commoning
7521@opindex fpredictive-commoning
7522Perform predictive commoning optimization, i.e., reusing computations
7523(especially memory loads and stores) performed in previous
7524iterations of loops.
7525
7526This option is enabled at level @option{-O3}.
7527
7528@item -fprefetch-loop-arrays
7529@opindex fprefetch-loop-arrays
7530If supported by the target machine, generate instructions to prefetch
7531memory to improve the performance of loops that access large arrays.
7532
7533This option may generate better or worse code; results are highly
7534dependent on the structure of loops within the source code.
7535
7536Disabled at level @option{-Os}.
7537
7538@item -fno-peephole
7539@itemx -fno-peephole2
7540@opindex fno-peephole
7541@opindex fno-peephole2
7542Disable any machine-specific peephole optimizations.  The difference
7543between @option{-fno-peephole} and @option{-fno-peephole2} is in how they
7544are implemented in the compiler; some targets use one, some use the
7545other, a few use both.
7546
7547@option{-fpeephole} is enabled by default.
7548@option{-fpeephole2} enabled at levels @option{-O2}, @option{-O3}, @option{-Os}.
7549
7550@item -fno-guess-branch-probability
7551@opindex fno-guess-branch-probability
7552Do not guess branch probabilities using heuristics.
7553
7554GCC will use heuristics to guess branch probabilities if they are
7555not provided by profiling feedback (@option{-fprofile-arcs}).  These
7556heuristics are based on the control flow graph.  If some branch probabilities
7557are specified by @samp{__builtin_expect}, then the heuristics will be
7558used to guess branch probabilities for the rest of the control flow graph,
7559taking the @samp{__builtin_expect} info into account.  The interactions
7560between the heuristics and @samp{__builtin_expect} can be complex, and in
7561some cases, it may be useful to disable the heuristics so that the effects
7562of @samp{__builtin_expect} are easier to understand.
7563
7564The default is @option{-fguess-branch-probability} at levels
7565@option{-O}, @option{-O2}, @option{-O3}, @option{-Os}.
7566
7567@item -freorder-blocks
7568@opindex freorder-blocks
7569Reorder basic blocks in the compiled function in order to reduce number of
7570taken branches and improve code locality.
7571
7572Enabled at levels @option{-O2}, @option{-O3}.
7573
7574@item -freorder-blocks-and-partition
7575@opindex freorder-blocks-and-partition
7576In addition to reordering basic blocks in the compiled function, in order
7577to reduce number of taken branches, partitions hot and cold basic blocks
7578into separate sections of the assembly and .o files, to improve
7579paging and cache locality performance.
7580
7581This optimization is automatically turned off in the presence of
7582exception handling, for linkonce sections, for functions with a user-defined
7583section attribute and on any architecture that does not support named
7584sections.
7585
7586@item -freorder-functions
7587@opindex freorder-functions
7588Reorder functions in the object file in order to
7589improve code locality.  This is implemented by using special
7590subsections @code{.text.hot} for most frequently executed functions and
7591@code{.text.unlikely} for unlikely executed functions.  Reordering is done by
7592the linker so object file format must support named sections and linker must
7593place them in a reasonable way.
7594
7595Also profile feedback must be available in to make this option effective.  See
7596@option{-fprofile-arcs} for details.
7597
7598Enabled at levels @option{-O2}, @option{-O3}, @option{-Os}.
7599
7600@item -fstrict-aliasing
7601@opindex fstrict-aliasing
7602Allow the compiler to assume the strictest aliasing rules applicable to
7603the language being compiled.  For C (and C++), this activates
7604optimizations based on the type of expressions.  In particular, an
7605object of one type is assumed never to reside at the same address as an
7606object of a different type, unless the types are almost the same.  For
7607example, an @code{unsigned int} can alias an @code{int}, but not a
7608@code{void*} or a @code{double}.  A character type may alias any other
7609type.
7610
7611@anchor{Type-punning}Pay special attention to code like this:
7612@smallexample
7613union a_union @{
7614  int i;
7615  double d;
7616@};
7617
7618int f() @{
7619  union a_union t;
7620  t.d = 3.0;
7621  return t.i;
7622@}
7623@end smallexample
7624The practice of reading from a different union member than the one most
7625recently written to (called ``type-punning'') is common.  Even with
7626@option{-fstrict-aliasing}, type-punning is allowed, provided the memory
7627is accessed through the union type.  So, the code above will work as
7628expected.  @xref{Structures unions enumerations and bit-fields
7629implementation}.  However, this code might not:
7630@smallexample
7631int f() @{
7632  union a_union t;
7633  int* ip;
7634  t.d = 3.0;
7635  ip = &t.i;
7636  return *ip;
7637@}
7638@end smallexample
7639
7640Similarly, access by taking the address, casting the resulting pointer
7641and dereferencing the result has undefined behavior, even if the cast
7642uses a union type, e.g.:
7643@smallexample
7644int f() @{
7645  double d = 3.0;
7646  return ((union a_union *) &d)->i;
7647@}
7648@end smallexample
7649
7650The @option{-fstrict-aliasing} option is enabled at levels
7651@option{-O2}, @option{-O3}, @option{-Os}.
7652
7653@item -fstrict-overflow
7654@opindex fstrict-overflow
7655Allow the compiler to assume strict signed overflow rules, depending
7656on the language being compiled.  For C (and C++) this means that
7657overflow when doing arithmetic with signed numbers is undefined, which
7658means that the compiler may assume that it will not happen.  This
7659permits various optimizations.  For example, the compiler will assume
7660that an expression like @code{i + 10 > i} will always be true for
7661signed @code{i}.  This assumption is only valid if signed overflow is
7662undefined, as the expression is false if @code{i + 10} overflows when
7663using twos complement arithmetic.  When this option is in effect any
7664attempt to determine whether an operation on signed numbers will
7665overflow must be written carefully to not actually involve overflow.
7666
7667This option also allows the compiler to assume strict pointer
7668semantics: given a pointer to an object, if adding an offset to that
7669pointer does not produce a pointer to the same object, the addition is
7670undefined.  This permits the compiler to conclude that @code{p + u >
7671p} is always true for a pointer @code{p} and unsigned integer
7672@code{u}.  This assumption is only valid because pointer wraparound is
7673undefined, as the expression is false if @code{p + u} overflows using
7674twos complement arithmetic.
7675
7676See also the @option{-fwrapv} option.  Using @option{-fwrapv} means
7677that integer signed overflow is fully defined: it wraps.  When
7678@option{-fwrapv} is used, there is no difference between
7679@option{-fstrict-overflow} and @option{-fno-strict-overflow} for
7680integers.  With @option{-fwrapv} certain types of overflow are
7681permitted.  For example, if the compiler gets an overflow when doing
7682arithmetic on constants, the overflowed value can still be used with
7683@option{-fwrapv}, but not otherwise.
7684
7685The @option{-fstrict-overflow} option is enabled at levels
7686@option{-O2}, @option{-O3}, @option{-Os}.
7687
7688@item -falign-functions
7689@itemx -falign-functions=@var{n}
7690@opindex falign-functions
7691Align the start of functions to the next power-of-two greater than
7692@var{n}, skipping up to @var{n} bytes.  For instance,
7693@option{-falign-functions=32} aligns functions to the next 32-byte
7694boundary, but @option{-falign-functions=24} would align to the next
769532-byte boundary only if this can be done by skipping 23 bytes or less.
7696
7697@option{-fno-align-functions} and @option{-falign-functions=1} are
7698equivalent and mean that functions will not be aligned.
7699
7700Some assemblers only support this flag when @var{n} is a power of two;
7701in that case, it is rounded up.
7702
7703If @var{n} is not specified or is zero, use a machine-dependent default.
7704
7705Enabled at levels @option{-O2}, @option{-O3}.
7706
7707@item -falign-labels
7708@itemx -falign-labels=@var{n}
7709@opindex falign-labels
7710Align all branch targets to a power-of-two boundary, skipping up to
7711@var{n} bytes like @option{-falign-functions}.  This option can easily
7712make code slower, because it must insert dummy operations for when the
7713branch target is reached in the usual flow of the code.
7714
7715@option{-fno-align-labels} and @option{-falign-labels=1} are
7716equivalent and mean that labels will not be aligned.
7717
7718If @option{-falign-loops} or @option{-falign-jumps} are applicable and
7719are greater than this value, then their values are used instead.
7720
7721If @var{n} is not specified or is zero, use a machine-dependent default
7722which is very likely to be @samp{1}, meaning no alignment.
7723
7724Enabled at levels @option{-O2}, @option{-O3}.
7725
7726@item -falign-loops
7727@itemx -falign-loops=@var{n}
7728@opindex falign-loops
7729Align loops to a power-of-two boundary, skipping up to @var{n} bytes
7730like @option{-falign-functions}.  The hope is that the loop will be
7731executed many times, which will make up for any execution of the dummy
7732operations.
7733
7734@option{-fno-align-loops} and @option{-falign-loops=1} are
7735equivalent and mean that loops will not be aligned.
7736
7737If @var{n} is not specified or is zero, use a machine-dependent default.
7738
7739Enabled at levels @option{-O2}, @option{-O3}.
7740
7741@item -falign-jumps
7742@itemx -falign-jumps=@var{n}
7743@opindex falign-jumps
7744Align branch targets to a power-of-two boundary, for branch targets
7745where the targets can only be reached by jumping, skipping up to @var{n}
7746bytes like @option{-falign-functions}.  In this case, no dummy operations
7747need be executed.
7748
7749@option{-fno-align-jumps} and @option{-falign-jumps=1} are
7750equivalent and mean that loops will not be aligned.
7751
7752If @var{n} is not specified or is zero, use a machine-dependent default.
7753
7754Enabled at levels @option{-O2}, @option{-O3}.
7755
7756@item -funit-at-a-time
7757@opindex funit-at-a-time
7758This option is left for compatibility reasons. @option{-funit-at-a-time}
7759has no effect, while @option{-fno-unit-at-a-time} implies
7760@option{-fno-toplevel-reorder} and @option{-fno-section-anchors}.
7761
7762Enabled by default.
7763
7764@item -fno-toplevel-reorder
7765@opindex fno-toplevel-reorder
7766Do not reorder top-level functions, variables, and @code{asm}
7767statements.  Output them in the same order that they appear in the
7768input file.  When this option is used, unreferenced static variables
7769will not be removed.  This option is intended to support existing code
7770that relies on a particular ordering.  For new code, it is better to
7771use attributes.
7772
7773Enabled at level @option{-O0}.  When disabled explicitly, it also implies
7774@option{-fno-section-anchors}, which is otherwise enabled at @option{-O0} on some
7775targets.
7776
7777@item -fweb
7778@opindex fweb
7779Constructs webs as commonly used for register allocation purposes and assign
7780each web individual pseudo register.  This allows the register allocation pass
7781to operate on pseudos directly, but also strengthens several other optimization
7782passes, such as CSE, loop optimizer and trivial dead code remover.  It can,
7783however, make debugging impossible, since variables will no longer stay in a
7784``home register''.
7785
7786Enabled by default with @option{-funroll-loops}.
7787
7788@item -fwhole-program
7789@opindex fwhole-program
7790Assume that the current compilation unit represents the whole program being
7791compiled.  All public functions and variables with the exception of @code{main}
7792and those merged by attribute @code{externally_visible} become static functions
7793and in effect are optimized more aggressively by interprocedural optimizers. If @command{gold} is used as the linker plugin, @code{externally_visible} attributes are automatically added to functions (not variable yet due to a current @command{gold} issue) that are accessed outside of LTO objects according to resolution file produced by @command{gold}.  For other linkers that cannot generate resolution file, explicit @code{externally_visible} attributes are still necessary.
7794While this option is equivalent to proper use of the @code{static} keyword for
7795programs consisting of a single file, in combination with option
7796@option{-flto} this flag can be used to
7797compile many smaller scale programs since the functions and variables become
7798local for the whole combined compilation unit, not for the single source file
7799itself.
7800
7801This option implies @option{-fwhole-file} for Fortran programs.
7802
7803@item -flto[=@var{n}]
7804@opindex flto
7805This option runs the standard link-time optimizer.  When invoked
7806with source code, it generates GIMPLE (one of GCC's internal
7807representations) and writes it to special ELF sections in the object
7808file.  When the object files are linked together, all the function
7809bodies are read from these ELF sections and instantiated as if they
7810had been part of the same translation unit.
7811
7812To use the link-time optimizer, @option{-flto} needs to be specified at
7813compile time and during the final link.  For example:
7814
7815@smallexample
7816gcc -c -O2 -flto foo.c
7817gcc -c -O2 -flto bar.c
7818gcc -o myprog -flto -O2 foo.o bar.o
7819@end smallexample
7820
7821The first two invocations to GCC save a bytecode representation
7822of GIMPLE into special ELF sections inside @file{foo.o} and
7823@file{bar.o}.  The final invocation reads the GIMPLE bytecode from
7824@file{foo.o} and @file{bar.o}, merges the two files into a single
7825internal image, and compiles the result as usual.  Since both
7826@file{foo.o} and @file{bar.o} are merged into a single image, this
7827causes all the interprocedural analyses and optimizations in GCC to
7828work across the two files as if they were a single one.  This means,
7829for example, that the inliner is able to inline functions in
7830@file{bar.o} into functions in @file{foo.o} and vice-versa.
7831
7832Another (simpler) way to enable link-time optimization is:
7833
7834@smallexample
7835gcc -o myprog -flto -O2 foo.c bar.c
7836@end smallexample
7837
7838The above generates bytecode for @file{foo.c} and @file{bar.c},
7839merges them together into a single GIMPLE representation and optimizes
7840them as usual to produce @file{myprog}.
7841
7842The only important thing to keep in mind is that to enable link-time
7843optimizations the @option{-flto} flag needs to be passed to both the
7844compile and the link commands.
7845
7846To make whole program optimization effective, it is necessary to make
7847certain whole program assumptions.  The compiler needs to know
7848what functions and variables can be accessed by libraries and runtime
7849outside of the link-time optimized unit.  When supported by the linker,
7850the linker plugin (see @option{-fuse-linker-plugin}) passes information
7851to the compiler about used and externally visible symbols.  When
7852the linker plugin is not available, @option{-fwhole-program} should be
7853used to allow the compiler to make these assumptions, which leads
7854to more aggressive optimization decisions.
7855
7856Note that when a file is compiled with @option{-flto}, the generated
7857object file is larger than a regular object file because it
7858contains GIMPLE bytecodes and the usual final code.  This means that
7859object files with LTO information can be linked as normal object
7860files; if @option{-flto} is not passed to the linker, no
7861interprocedural optimizations are applied.
7862
7863Additionally, the optimization flags used to compile individual files
7864are not necessarily related to those used at link time.  For instance,
7865
7866@smallexample
7867gcc -c -O0 -flto foo.c
7868gcc -c -O0 -flto bar.c
7869gcc -o myprog -flto -O3 foo.o bar.o
7870@end smallexample
7871
7872This produces individual object files with unoptimized assembler
7873code, but the resulting binary @file{myprog} is optimized at
7874@option{-O3}.  If, instead, the final binary is generated without
7875@option{-flto}, then @file{myprog} is not optimized.
7876
7877When producing the final binary with @option{-flto}, GCC only
7878applies link-time optimizations to those files that contain bytecode.
7879Therefore, you can mix and match object files and libraries with
7880GIMPLE bytecodes and final object code.  GCC automatically selects
7881which files to optimize in LTO mode and which files to link without
7882further processing.
7883
7884There are some code generation flags preserved by GCC when
7885generating bytecodes, as they need to be used during the final link
7886stage.  Currently, the following options are saved into the GIMPLE
7887bytecode files: @option{-fPIC}, @option{-fcommon} and all the
7888@option{-m} target flags.
7889
7890At link time, these options are read in and reapplied.  Note that the
7891current implementation makes no attempt to recognize conflicting
7892values for these options.  If different files have conflicting option
7893values (e.g., one file is compiled with @option{-fPIC} and another
7894isn't), the compiler simply uses the last value read from the
7895bytecode files.  It is recommended, then, that you compile all the files
7896participating in the same link with the same options.
7897
7898If LTO encounters objects with C linkage declared with incompatible
7899types in separate translation units to be linked together (undefined
7900behavior according to ISO C99 6.2.7), a non-fatal diagnostic may be
7901issued.  The behavior is still undefined at run time.
7902
7903Another feature of LTO is that it is possible to apply interprocedural
7904optimizations on files written in different languages.  This requires
7905support in the language front end.  Currently, the C, C++ and
7906Fortran front ends are capable of emitting GIMPLE bytecodes, so
7907something like this should work:
7908
7909@smallexample
7910gcc -c -flto foo.c
7911g++ -c -flto bar.cc
7912gfortran -c -flto baz.f90
7913g++ -o myprog -flto -O3 foo.o bar.o baz.o -lgfortran
7914@end smallexample
7915
7916Notice that the final link is done with @command{g++} to get the C++
7917runtime libraries and @option{-lgfortran} is added to get the Fortran
7918runtime libraries.  In general, when mixing languages in LTO mode, you
7919should use the same link command options as when mixing languages in a
7920regular (non-LTO) compilation; all you need to add is @option{-flto} to
7921all the compile and link commands.
7922
7923If object files containing GIMPLE bytecode are stored in a library archive, say
7924@file{libfoo.a}, it is possible to extract and use them in an LTO link if you
7925are using a linker with plugin support.  To enable this feature, use
7926the flag @option{-fuse-linker-plugin} at link time:
7927
7928@smallexample
7929gcc -o myprog -O2 -flto -fuse-linker-plugin a.o b.o -lfoo
7930@end smallexample
7931
7932With the linker plugin enabled, the linker extracts the needed
7933GIMPLE files from @file{libfoo.a} and passes them on to the running GCC
7934to make them part of the aggregated GIMPLE image to be optimized.
7935
7936If you are not using a linker with plugin support and/or do not
7937enable the linker plugin, then the objects inside @file{libfoo.a}
7938are extracted and linked as usual, but they do not participate
7939in the LTO optimization process.
7940
7941Link-time optimizations do not require the presence of the whole program to
7942operate.  If the program does not require any symbols to be exported, it is
7943possible to combine @option{-flto} and @option{-fwhole-program} to allow
7944the interprocedural optimizers to use more aggressive assumptions which may
7945lead to improved optimization opportunities.
7946Use of @option{-fwhole-program} is not needed when linker plugin is
7947active (see @option{-fuse-linker-plugin}).
7948
7949The current implementation of LTO makes no
7950attempt to generate bytecode that is portable between different
7951types of hosts.  The bytecode files are versioned and there is a
7952strict version check, so bytecode files generated in one version of
7953GCC will not work with an older/newer version of GCC.
7954
7955Link-time optimization does not work well with generation of debugging
7956information.  Combining @option{-flto} with
7957@option{-g} is currently experimental and expected to produce wrong
7958results.
7959
7960If you specify the optional @var{n}, the optimization and code
7961generation done at link time is executed in parallel using @var{n}
7962parallel jobs by utilizing an installed @command{make} program.  The
7963environment variable @env{MAKE} may be used to override the program
7964used.  The default value for @var{n} is 1.
7965
7966You can also specify @option{-flto=jobserver} to use GNU make's
7967job server mode to determine the number of parallel jobs. This
7968is useful when the Makefile calling GCC is already executing in parallel.
7969You must prepend a @samp{+} to the command recipe in the parent Makefile
7970for this to work.  This option likely only works if @env{MAKE} is
7971GNU make.
7972
7973This option is disabled by default
7974
7975@item -flto-partition=@var{alg}
7976@opindex flto-partition
7977Specify the partitioning algorithm used by the link-time optimizer.
7978The value is either @code{1to1} to specify a partitioning mirroring
7979the original source files or @code{balanced} to specify partitioning
7980into equally sized chunks (whenever possible).  Specifying @code{none}
7981as an algorithm disables partitioning and streaming completely. The
7982default value is @code{balanced}.
7983
7984@item -flto-compression-level=@var{n}
7985This option specifies the level of compression used for intermediate
7986language written to LTO object files, and is only meaningful in
7987conjunction with LTO mode (@option{-flto}).  Valid
7988values are 0 (no compression) to 9 (maximum compression).  Values
7989outside this range are clamped to either 0 or 9.  If the option is not
7990given, a default balanced compression setting is used.
7991
7992@item -flto-report
7993Prints a report with internal details on the workings of the link-time
7994optimizer.  The contents of this report vary from version to version.
7995It is meant to be useful to GCC developers when processing object
7996files in LTO mode (via @option{-flto}).
7997
7998Disabled by default.
7999
8000@item -fuse-linker-plugin
8001Enables the use of a linker plugin during link-time optimization.  This
8002option relies on plugin support in the linker, which is available in gold
8003or in GNU ld 2.21 or newer.
8004
8005This option enables the extraction of object files with GIMPLE bytecode out
8006of library archives. This improves the quality of optimization by exposing
8007more code to the link-time optimizer.  This information specifies what
8008symbols can be accessed externally (by non-LTO object or during dynamic
8009linking).  Resulting code quality improvements on binaries (and shared
8010libraries that use hidden visibility) are similar to @code{-fwhole-program}.
8011See @option{-flto} for a description of the effect of this flag and how to
8012use it.
8013
8014This option is enabled by default when LTO support in GCC is enabled
8015and GCC was configured for use with
8016a linker supporting plugins (GNU ld 2.21 or newer or gold).
8017
8018@item -ffat-lto-objects
8019@opindex ffat-lto-objects
8020Fat LTO objects are object files that contain both the intermediate language
8021and the object code. This makes them usable for both LTO linking and normal
8022linking. This option is effective only when compiling with @option{-flto}
8023and is ignored at link time.
8024
8025@option{-fno-fat-lto-objects} improves compilation time over plain LTO, but
8026requires the complete toolchain to be aware of LTO. It requires a linker with
8027linker plugin support for basic functionality.  Additionally, nm, ar and ranlib
8028need to support linker plugins to allow a full-featured build environment
8029(capable of building static libraries etc).
8030
8031The default is @option{-ffat-lto-objects} but this default is intended to
8032change in future releases when linker plugin enabled environments become more
8033common.
8034
8035@item -fcompare-elim
8036@opindex fcompare-elim
8037After register allocation and post-register allocation instruction splitting,
8038identify arithmetic instructions that compute processor flags similar to a
8039comparison operation based on that arithmetic.  If possible, eliminate the
8040explicit comparison operation.
8041
8042This pass only applies to certain targets that cannot explicitly represent
8043the comparison operation before register allocation is complete.
8044
8045Enabled at levels @option{-O}, @option{-O2}, @option{-O3}, @option{-Os}.
8046
8047@item -fcprop-registers
8048@opindex fcprop-registers
8049After register allocation and post-register allocation instruction splitting,
8050we perform a copy-propagation pass to try to reduce scheduling dependencies
8051and occasionally eliminate the copy.
8052
8053Enabled at levels @option{-O}, @option{-O2}, @option{-O3}, @option{-Os}.
8054
8055@item -fprofile-correction
8056@opindex fprofile-correction
8057Profiles collected using an instrumented binary for multi-threaded programs may
8058be inconsistent due to missed counter updates. When this option is specified,
8059GCC will use heuristics to correct or smooth out such inconsistencies. By
8060default, GCC will emit an error message when an inconsistent profile is detected.
8061
8062@item -fprofile-dir=@var{path}
8063@opindex fprofile-dir
8064
8065Set the directory to search for the profile data files in to @var{path}.
8066This option affects only the profile data generated by
8067@option{-fprofile-generate}, @option{-ftest-coverage}, @option{-fprofile-arcs}
8068and used by @option{-fprofile-use} and @option{-fbranch-probabilities}
8069and its related options.  Both absolute and relative paths can be used.
8070By default, GCC will use the current directory as @var{path}, thus the
8071profile data file will appear in the same directory as the object file.
8072
8073@item -fprofile-generate
8074@itemx -fprofile-generate=@var{path}
8075@opindex fprofile-generate
8076
8077Enable options usually used for instrumenting application to produce
8078profile useful for later recompilation with profile feedback based
8079optimization.  You must use @option{-fprofile-generate} both when
8080compiling and when linking your program.
8081
8082The following options are enabled: @code{-fprofile-arcs}, @code{-fprofile-values}, @code{-fvpt}.
8083
8084If @var{path} is specified, GCC will look at the @var{path} to find
8085the profile feedback data files. See @option{-fprofile-dir}.
8086
8087@item -fprofile-use
8088@itemx -fprofile-use=@var{path}
8089@opindex fprofile-use
8090Enable profile feedback directed optimizations, and optimizations
8091generally profitable only with profile feedback available.
8092
8093The following options are enabled: @code{-fbranch-probabilities}, @code{-fvpt},
8094@code{-funroll-loops}, @code{-fpeel-loops}, @code{-ftracer}
8095
8096By default, GCC emits an error message if the feedback profiles do not
8097match the source code.  This error can be turned into a warning by using
8098@option{-Wcoverage-mismatch}.  Note this may result in poorly optimized
8099code.
8100
8101If @var{path} is specified, GCC will look at the @var{path} to find
8102the profile feedback data files. See @option{-fprofile-dir}.
8103@end table
8104
8105The following options control compiler behavior regarding floating-point
8106arithmetic.  These options trade off between speed and
8107correctness.  All must be specifically enabled.
8108
8109@table @gcctabopt
8110@item -ffloat-store
8111@opindex ffloat-store
8112Do not store floating-point variables in registers, and inhibit other
8113options that might change whether a floating-point value is taken from a
8114register or memory.
8115
8116@cindex floating-point precision
8117This option prevents undesirable excess precision on machines such as
8118the 68000 where the floating registers (of the 68881) keep more
8119precision than a @code{double} is supposed to have.  Similarly for the
8120x86 architecture.  For most programs, the excess precision does only
8121good, but a few programs rely on the precise definition of IEEE floating
8122point.  Use @option{-ffloat-store} for such programs, after modifying
8123them to store all pertinent intermediate computations into variables.
8124
8125@item -fexcess-precision=@var{style}
8126@opindex fexcess-precision
8127This option allows further control over excess precision on machines
8128where floating-point registers have more precision than the IEEE
8129@code{float} and @code{double} types and the processor does not
8130support operations rounding to those types.  By default,
8131@option{-fexcess-precision=fast} is in effect; this means that
8132operations are carried out in the precision of the registers and that
8133it is unpredictable when rounding to the types specified in the source
8134code takes place.  When compiling C, if
8135@option{-fexcess-precision=standard} is specified then excess
8136precision will follow the rules specified in ISO C99; in particular,
8137both casts and assignments cause values to be rounded to their
8138semantic types (whereas @option{-ffloat-store} only affects
8139assignments).  This option is enabled by default for C if a strict
8140conformance option such as @option{-std=c99} is used.
8141
8142@opindex mfpmath
8143@option{-fexcess-precision=standard} is not implemented for languages
8144other than C, and has no effect if
8145@option{-funsafe-math-optimizations} or @option{-ffast-math} is
8146specified.  On the x86, it also has no effect if @option{-mfpmath=sse}
8147or @option{-mfpmath=sse+387} is specified; in the former case, IEEE
8148semantics apply without excess precision, and in the latter, rounding
8149is unpredictable.
8150
8151@item -ffast-math
8152@opindex ffast-math
8153Sets @option{-fno-math-errno}, @option{-funsafe-math-optimizations},
8154@option{-ffinite-math-only}, @option{-fno-rounding-math},
8155@option{-fno-signaling-nans} and @option{-fcx-limited-range}.
8156
8157This option causes the preprocessor macro @code{__FAST_MATH__} to be defined.
8158
8159This option is not turned on by any @option{-O} option besides
8160@option{-Ofast} since it can result in incorrect output for programs
8161that depend on an exact implementation of IEEE or ISO rules/specifications
8162for math functions. It may, however, yield faster code for programs
8163that do not require the guarantees of these specifications.
8164
8165@item -fno-math-errno
8166@opindex fno-math-errno
8167Do not set ERRNO after calling math functions that are executed
8168with a single instruction, e.g., sqrt.  A program that relies on
8169IEEE exceptions for math error handling may want to use this flag
8170for speed while maintaining IEEE arithmetic compatibility.
8171
8172This option is not turned on by any @option{-O} option since
8173it can result in incorrect output for programs that depend on
8174an exact implementation of IEEE or ISO rules/specifications for
8175math functions. It may, however, yield faster code for programs
8176that do not require the guarantees of these specifications.
8177
8178The default is @option{-fmath-errno}.
8179
8180On Darwin systems, the math library never sets @code{errno}.  There is
8181therefore no reason for the compiler to consider the possibility that
8182it might, and @option{-fno-math-errno} is the default.
8183
8184@item -funsafe-math-optimizations
8185@opindex funsafe-math-optimizations
8186
8187Allow optimizations for floating-point arithmetic that (a) assume
8188that arguments and results are valid and (b) may violate IEEE or
8189ANSI standards.  When used at link-time, it may include libraries
8190or startup files that change the default FPU control word or other
8191similar optimizations.
8192
8193This option is not turned on by any @option{-O} option since
8194it can result in incorrect output for programs that depend on
8195an exact implementation of IEEE or ISO rules/specifications for
8196math functions. It may, however, yield faster code for programs
8197that do not require the guarantees of these specifications.
8198Enables @option{-fno-signed-zeros}, @option{-fno-trapping-math},
8199@option{-fassociative-math} and @option{-freciprocal-math}.
8200
8201The default is @option{-fno-unsafe-math-optimizations}.
8202
8203@item -fassociative-math
8204@opindex fassociative-math
8205
8206Allow re-association of operands in series of floating-point operations.
8207This violates the ISO C and C++ language standard by possibly changing
8208computation result.  NOTE: re-ordering may change the sign of zero as
8209well as ignore NaNs and inhibit or create underflow or overflow (and
8210thus cannot be used on code that relies on rounding behavior like
8211@code{(x + 2**52) - 2**52}.  May also reorder floating-point comparisons
8212and thus may not be used when ordered comparisons are required.
8213This option requires that both @option{-fno-signed-zeros} and
8214@option{-fno-trapping-math} be in effect.  Moreover, it doesn't make
8215much sense with @option{-frounding-math}. For Fortran the option
8216is automatically enabled when both @option{-fno-signed-zeros} and
8217@option{-fno-trapping-math} are in effect.
8218
8219The default is @option{-fno-associative-math}.
8220
8221@item -freciprocal-math
8222@opindex freciprocal-math
8223
8224Allow the reciprocal of a value to be used instead of dividing by
8225the value if this enables optimizations.  For example @code{x / y}
8226can be replaced with @code{x * (1/y)}, which is useful if @code{(1/y)}
8227is subject to common subexpression elimination.  Note that this loses
8228precision and increases the number of flops operating on the value.
8229
8230The default is @option{-fno-reciprocal-math}.
8231
8232@item -ffinite-math-only
8233@opindex ffinite-math-only
8234Allow optimizations for floating-point arithmetic that assume
8235that arguments and results are not NaNs or +-Infs.
8236
8237This option is not turned on by any @option{-O} option since
8238it can result in incorrect output for programs that depend on
8239an exact implementation of IEEE or ISO rules/specifications for
8240math functions. It may, however, yield faster code for programs
8241that do not require the guarantees of these specifications.
8242
8243The default is @option{-fno-finite-math-only}.
8244
8245@item -fno-signed-zeros
8246@opindex fno-signed-zeros
8247Allow optimizations for floating-point arithmetic that ignore the
8248signedness of zero.  IEEE arithmetic specifies the behavior of
8249distinct +0.0 and @minus{}0.0 values, which then prohibits simplification
8250of expressions such as x+0.0 or 0.0*x (even with @option{-ffinite-math-only}).
8251This option implies that the sign of a zero result isn't significant.
8252
8253The default is @option{-fsigned-zeros}.
8254
8255@item -fno-trapping-math
8256@opindex fno-trapping-math
8257Compile code assuming that floating-point operations cannot generate
8258user-visible traps.  These traps include division by zero, overflow,
8259underflow, inexact result and invalid operation.  This option requires
8260that @option{-fno-signaling-nans} be in effect.  Setting this option may
8261allow faster code if one relies on ``non-stop'' IEEE arithmetic, for example.
8262
8263This option should never be turned on by any @option{-O} option since
8264it can result in incorrect output for programs that depend on
8265an exact implementation of IEEE or ISO rules/specifications for
8266math functions.
8267
8268The default is @option{-ftrapping-math}.
8269
8270@item -frounding-math
8271@opindex frounding-math
8272Disable transformations and optimizations that assume default floating-point
8273rounding behavior.  This is round-to-zero for all floating point
8274to integer conversions, and round-to-nearest for all other arithmetic
8275truncations.  This option should be specified for programs that change
8276the FP rounding mode dynamically, or that may be executed with a
8277non-default rounding mode.  This option disables constant folding of
8278floating-point expressions at compile time (which may be affected by
8279rounding mode) and arithmetic transformations that are unsafe in the
8280presence of sign-dependent rounding modes.
8281
8282The default is @option{-fno-rounding-math}.
8283
8284This option is experimental and does not currently guarantee to
8285disable all GCC optimizations that are affected by rounding mode.
8286Future versions of GCC may provide finer control of this setting
8287using C99's @code{FENV_ACCESS} pragma.  This command-line option
8288will be used to specify the default state for @code{FENV_ACCESS}.
8289
8290@item -fsignaling-nans
8291@opindex fsignaling-nans
8292Compile code assuming that IEEE signaling NaNs may generate user-visible
8293traps during floating-point operations.  Setting this option disables
8294optimizations that may change the number of exceptions visible with
8295signaling NaNs.  This option implies @option{-ftrapping-math}.
8296
8297This option causes the preprocessor macro @code{__SUPPORT_SNAN__} to
8298be defined.
8299
8300The default is @option{-fno-signaling-nans}.
8301
8302This option is experimental and does not currently guarantee to
8303disable all GCC optimizations that affect signaling NaN behavior.
8304
8305@item -fsingle-precision-constant
8306@opindex fsingle-precision-constant
8307Treat floating-point constants as single precision instead of
8308implicitly converting them to double-precision constants.
8309
8310@item -fcx-limited-range
8311@opindex fcx-limited-range
8312When enabled, this option states that a range reduction step is not
8313needed when performing complex division.  Also, there is no checking
8314whether the result of a complex multiplication or division is @code{NaN
8315+ I*NaN}, with an attempt to rescue the situation in that case.  The
8316default is @option{-fno-cx-limited-range}, but is enabled by
8317@option{-ffast-math}.
8318
8319This option controls the default setting of the ISO C99
8320@code{CX_LIMITED_RANGE} pragma.  Nevertheless, the option applies to
8321all languages.
8322
8323@item -fcx-fortran-rules
8324@opindex fcx-fortran-rules
8325Complex multiplication and division follow Fortran rules.  Range
8326reduction is done as part of complex division, but there is no checking
8327whether the result of a complex multiplication or division is @code{NaN
8328+ I*NaN}, with an attempt to rescue the situation in that case.
8329
8330The default is @option{-fno-cx-fortran-rules}.
8331
8332@end table
8333
8334The following options control optimizations that may improve
8335performance, but are not enabled by any @option{-O} options.  This
8336section includes experimental options that may produce broken code.
8337
8338@table @gcctabopt
8339@item -fbranch-probabilities
8340@opindex fbranch-probabilities
8341After running a program compiled with @option{-fprofile-arcs}
8342(@pxref{Debugging Options,, Options for Debugging Your Program or
8343@command{gcc}}), you can compile it a second time using
8344@option{-fbranch-probabilities}, to improve optimizations based on
8345the number of times each branch was taken.  When the program
8346compiled with @option{-fprofile-arcs} exits it saves arc execution
8347counts to a file called @file{@var{sourcename}.gcda} for each source
8348file.  The information in this data file is very dependent on the
8349structure of the generated code, so you must use the same source code
8350and the same optimization options for both compilations.
8351
8352With @option{-fbranch-probabilities}, GCC puts a
8353@samp{REG_BR_PROB} note on each @samp{JUMP_INSN} and @samp{CALL_INSN}.
8354These can be used to improve optimization.  Currently, they are only
8355used in one place: in @file{reorg.c}, instead of guessing which path a
8356branch is most likely to take, the @samp{REG_BR_PROB} values are used to
8357exactly determine which path is taken more often.
8358
8359@item -fprofile-values
8360@opindex fprofile-values
8361If combined with @option{-fprofile-arcs}, it adds code so that some
8362data about values of expressions in the program is gathered.
8363
8364With @option{-fbranch-probabilities}, it reads back the data gathered
8365from profiling values of expressions for usage in optimizations.
8366
8367Enabled with @option{-fprofile-generate} and @option{-fprofile-use}.
8368
8369@item -fvpt
8370@opindex fvpt
8371If combined with @option{-fprofile-arcs}, it instructs the compiler to add
8372a code to gather information about values of expressions.
8373
8374With @option{-fbranch-probabilities}, it reads back the data gathered
8375and actually performs the optimizations based on them.
8376Currently the optimizations include specialization of division operation
8377using the knowledge about the value of the denominator.
8378
8379@item -frename-registers
8380@opindex frename-registers
8381Attempt to avoid false dependencies in scheduled code by making use
8382of registers left over after register allocation.  This optimization
8383will most benefit processors with lots of registers.  Depending on the
8384debug information format adopted by the target, however, it can
8385make debugging impossible, since variables will no longer stay in
8386a ``home register''.
8387
8388Enabled by default with @option{-funroll-loops} and @option{-fpeel-loops}.
8389
8390@item -ftracer
8391@opindex ftracer
8392Perform tail duplication to enlarge superblock size.  This transformation
8393simplifies the control flow of the function allowing other optimizations to do
8394better job.
8395
8396Enabled with @option{-fprofile-use}.
8397
8398@item -funroll-loops
8399@opindex funroll-loops
8400Unroll loops whose number of iterations can be determined at compile time or
8401upon entry to the loop.  @option{-funroll-loops} implies
8402@option{-frerun-cse-after-loop}, @option{-fweb} and @option{-frename-registers}.
8403It also turns on complete loop peeling (i.e.@: complete removal of loops with
8404small constant number of iterations).  This option makes code larger, and may
8405or may not make it run faster.
8406
8407Enabled with @option{-fprofile-use}.
8408
8409@item -funroll-all-loops
8410@opindex funroll-all-loops
8411Unroll all loops, even if their number of iterations is uncertain when
8412the loop is entered.  This usually makes programs run more slowly.
8413@option{-funroll-all-loops} implies the same options as
8414@option{-funroll-loops}.
8415
8416@item -fpeel-loops
8417@opindex fpeel-loops
8418Peels loops for which there is enough information that they do not
8419roll much (from profile feedback).  It also turns on complete loop peeling
8420(i.e.@: complete removal of loops with small constant number of iterations).
8421
8422Enabled with @option{-fprofile-use}.
8423
8424@item -fmove-loop-invariants
8425@opindex fmove-loop-invariants
8426Enables the loop invariant motion pass in the RTL loop optimizer.  Enabled
8427at level @option{-O1}
8428
8429@item -funswitch-loops
8430@opindex funswitch-loops
8431Move branches with loop invariant conditions out of the loop, with duplicates
8432of the loop on both branches (modified according to result of the condition).
8433
8434@item -ffunction-sections
8435@itemx -fdata-sections
8436@opindex ffunction-sections
8437@opindex fdata-sections
8438Place each function or data item into its own section in the output
8439file if the target supports arbitrary sections.  The name of the
8440function or the name of the data item determines the section's name
8441in the output file.
8442
8443Use these options on systems where the linker can perform optimizations
8444to improve locality of reference in the instruction space.  Most systems
8445using the ELF object format and SPARC processors running Solaris 2 have
8446linkers with such optimizations.  AIX may have these optimizations in
8447the future.
8448
8449Only use these options when there are significant benefits from doing
8450so.  When you specify these options, the assembler and linker will
8451create larger object and executable files and will also be slower.
8452You will not be able to use @code{gprof} on all systems if you
8453specify this option and you may have problems with debugging if
8454you specify both this option and @option{-g}.
8455
8456@item -fbranch-target-load-optimize
8457@opindex fbranch-target-load-optimize
8458Perform branch target register load optimization before prologue / epilogue
8459threading.
8460The use of target registers can typically be exposed only during reload,
8461thus hoisting loads out of loops and doing inter-block scheduling needs
8462a separate optimization pass.
8463
8464@item -fbranch-target-load-optimize2
8465@opindex fbranch-target-load-optimize2
8466Perform branch target register load optimization after prologue / epilogue
8467threading.
8468
8469@item -fbtr-bb-exclusive
8470@opindex fbtr-bb-exclusive
8471When performing branch target register load optimization, don't reuse
8472branch target registers in within any basic block.
8473
8474@item -fstack-protector
8475@opindex fstack-protector
8476Emit extra code to check for buffer overflows, such as stack smashing
8477attacks.  This is done by adding a guard variable to functions with
8478vulnerable objects.  This includes functions that call alloca, and
8479functions with buffers larger than 8 bytes.  The guards are initialized
8480when a function is entered and then checked when the function exits.
8481If a guard check fails, an error message is printed and the program exits.
8482
8483@item -fstack-protector-all
8484@opindex fstack-protector-all
8485Like @option{-fstack-protector} except that all functions are protected.
8486
8487@item -fsection-anchors
8488@opindex fsection-anchors
8489Try to reduce the number of symbolic address calculations by using
8490shared ``anchor'' symbols to address nearby objects.  This transformation
8491can help to reduce the number of GOT entries and GOT accesses on some
8492targets.
8493
8494For example, the implementation of the following function @code{foo}:
8495
8496@smallexample
8497static int a, b, c;
8498int foo (void) @{ return a + b + c; @}
8499@end smallexample
8500
8501would usually calculate the addresses of all three variables, but if you
8502compile it with @option{-fsection-anchors}, it will access the variables
8503from a common anchor point instead.  The effect is similar to the
8504following pseudocode (which isn't valid C):
8505
8506@smallexample
8507int foo (void)
8508@{
8509  register int *xr = &x;
8510  return xr[&a - &x] + xr[&b - &x] + xr[&c - &x];
8511@}
8512@end smallexample
8513
8514Not all targets support this option.
8515
8516@item --param @var{name}=@var{value}
8517@opindex param
8518In some places, GCC uses various constants to control the amount of
8519optimization that is done.  For example, GCC will not inline functions
8520that contain more than a certain number of instructions.  You can
8521control some of these constants on the command line using the
8522@option{--param} option.
8523
8524The names of specific parameters, and the meaning of the values, are
8525tied to the internals of the compiler, and are subject to change
8526without notice in future releases.
8527
8528In each case, the @var{value} is an integer.  The allowable choices for
8529@var{name} are given in the following table:
8530
8531@table @gcctabopt
8532@item predictable-branch-outcome
8533When branch is predicted to be taken with probability lower than this threshold
8534(in percent), then it is considered well predictable. The default is 10.
8535
8536@item max-crossjump-edges
8537The maximum number of incoming edges to consider for crossjumping.
8538The algorithm used by @option{-fcrossjumping} is @math{O(N^2)} in
8539the number of edges incoming to each block.  Increasing values mean
8540more aggressive optimization, making the compilation time increase with
8541probably small improvement in executable size.
8542
8543@item min-crossjump-insns
8544The minimum number of instructions that must be matched at the end
8545of two blocks before crossjumping will be performed on them.  This
8546value is ignored in the case where all instructions in the block being
8547crossjumped from are matched.  The default value is 5.
8548
8549@item max-grow-copy-bb-insns
8550The maximum code size expansion factor when copying basic blocks
8551instead of jumping.  The expansion is relative to a jump instruction.
8552The default value is 8.
8553
8554@item max-goto-duplication-insns
8555The maximum number of instructions to duplicate to a block that jumps
8556to a computed goto.  To avoid @math{O(N^2)} behavior in a number of
8557passes, GCC factors computed gotos early in the compilation process,
8558and unfactors them as late as possible.  Only computed jumps at the
8559end of a basic blocks with no more than max-goto-duplication-insns are
8560unfactored.  The default value is 8.
8561
8562@item max-delay-slot-insn-search
8563The maximum number of instructions to consider when looking for an
8564instruction to fill a delay slot.  If more than this arbitrary number of
8565instructions is searched, the time savings from filling the delay slot
8566will be minimal so stop searching.  Increasing values mean more
8567aggressive optimization, making the compilation time increase with probably
8568small improvement in execution time.
8569
8570@item max-delay-slot-live-search
8571When trying to fill delay slots, the maximum number of instructions to
8572consider when searching for a block with valid live register
8573information.  Increasing this arbitrarily chosen value means more
8574aggressive optimization, increasing the compilation time.  This parameter
8575should be removed when the delay slot code is rewritten to maintain the
8576control-flow graph.
8577
8578@item max-gcse-memory
8579The approximate maximum amount of memory that will be allocated in
8580order to perform the global common subexpression elimination
8581optimization.  If more memory than specified is required, the
8582optimization will not be done.
8583
8584@item max-gcse-insertion-ratio
8585If the ratio of expression insertions to deletions is larger than this value
8586for any expression, then RTL PRE will insert or remove the expression and thus
8587leave partially redundant computations in the instruction stream.  The default value is 20.
8588
8589@item max-pending-list-length
8590The maximum number of pending dependencies scheduling will allow
8591before flushing the current state and starting over.  Large functions
8592with few branches or calls can create excessively large lists which
8593needlessly consume memory and resources.
8594
8595@item max-modulo-backtrack-attempts
8596The maximum number of backtrack attempts the scheduler should make
8597when modulo scheduling a loop.  Larger values can exponentially increase
8598compilation time.
8599
8600@item max-inline-insns-single
8601Several parameters control the tree inliner used in gcc.
8602This number sets the maximum number of instructions (counted in GCC's
8603internal representation) in a single function that the tree inliner
8604will consider for inlining.  This only affects functions declared
8605inline and methods implemented in a class declaration (C++).
8606The default value is 400.
8607
8608@item max-inline-insns-auto
8609When you use @option{-finline-functions} (included in @option{-O3}),
8610a lot of functions that would otherwise not be considered for inlining
8611by the compiler will be investigated.  To those functions, a different
8612(more restrictive) limit compared to functions declared inline can
8613be applied.
8614The default value is 40.
8615
8616@item large-function-insns
8617The limit specifying really large functions.  For functions larger than this
8618limit after inlining, inlining is constrained by
8619@option{--param large-function-growth}.  This parameter is useful primarily
8620to avoid extreme compilation time caused by non-linear algorithms used by the
8621back end.
8622The default value is 2700.
8623
8624@item large-function-growth
8625Specifies maximal growth of large function caused by inlining in percents.
8626The default value is 100 which limits large function growth to 2.0 times
8627the original size.
8628
8629@item large-unit-insns
8630The limit specifying large translation unit.  Growth caused by inlining of
8631units larger than this limit is limited by @option{--param inline-unit-growth}.
8632For small units this might be too tight (consider unit consisting of function A
8633that is inline and B that just calls A three time.  If B is small relative to
8634A, the growth of unit is 300\% and yet such inlining is very sane.  For very
8635large units consisting of small inlineable functions however the overall unit
8636growth limit is needed to avoid exponential explosion of code size.  Thus for
8637smaller units, the size is increased to @option{--param large-unit-insns}
8638before applying @option{--param inline-unit-growth}.  The default is 10000
8639
8640@item inline-unit-growth
8641Specifies maximal overall growth of the compilation unit caused by inlining.
8642The default value is 30 which limits unit growth to 1.3 times the original
8643size.
8644
8645@item ipcp-unit-growth
8646Specifies maximal overall growth of the compilation unit caused by
8647interprocedural constant propagation.  The default value is 10 which limits
8648unit growth to 1.1 times the original size.
8649
8650@item large-stack-frame
8651The limit specifying large stack frames.  While inlining the algorithm is trying
8652to not grow past this limit too much.  Default value is 256 bytes.
8653
8654@item large-stack-frame-growth
8655Specifies maximal growth of large stack frames caused by inlining in percents.
8656The default value is 1000 which limits large stack frame growth to 11 times
8657the original size.
8658
8659@item max-inline-insns-recursive
8660@itemx max-inline-insns-recursive-auto
8661Specifies maximum number of instructions out-of-line copy of self recursive inline
8662function can grow into by performing recursive inlining.
8663
8664For functions declared inline @option{--param max-inline-insns-recursive} is
8665taken into account.  For function not declared inline, recursive inlining
8666happens only when @option{-finline-functions} (included in @option{-O3}) is
8667enabled and @option{--param max-inline-insns-recursive-auto} is used.  The
8668default value is 450.
8669
8670@item max-inline-recursive-depth
8671@itemx max-inline-recursive-depth-auto
8672Specifies maximum recursion depth used by the recursive inlining.
8673
8674For functions declared inline @option{--param max-inline-recursive-depth} is
8675taken into account.  For function not declared inline, recursive inlining
8676happens only when @option{-finline-functions} (included in @option{-O3}) is
8677enabled and @option{--param max-inline-recursive-depth-auto} is used.  The
8678default value is 8.
8679
8680@item min-inline-recursive-probability
8681Recursive inlining is profitable only for function having deep recursion
8682in average and can hurt for function having little recursion depth by
8683increasing the prologue size or complexity of function body to other
8684optimizers.
8685
8686When profile feedback is available (see @option{-fprofile-generate}) the actual
8687recursion depth can be guessed from probability that function will recurse via
8688given call expression.  This parameter limits inlining only to call expression
8689whose probability exceeds given threshold (in percents).  The default value is
869010.
8691
8692@item early-inlining-insns
8693Specify growth that early inliner can make.  In effect it increases amount of
8694inlining for code having large abstraction penalty.  The default value is 10.
8695
8696@item max-early-inliner-iterations
8697@itemx max-early-inliner-iterations
8698Limit of iterations of early inliner.  This basically bounds number of nested
8699indirect calls early inliner can resolve.  Deeper chains are still handled by
8700late inlining.
8701
8702@item comdat-sharing-probability
8703@itemx comdat-sharing-probability
8704Probability (in percent) that C++ inline function with comdat visibility
8705will be shared across multiple compilation units.  The default value is 20.
8706
8707@item min-vect-loop-bound
8708The minimum number of iterations under which a loop will not get vectorized
8709when @option{-ftree-vectorize} is used.  The number of iterations after
8710vectorization needs to be greater than the value specified by this option
8711to allow vectorization.  The default value is 0.
8712
8713@item gcse-cost-distance-ratio
8714Scaling factor in calculation of maximum distance an expression
8715can be moved by GCSE optimizations.  This is currently supported only in the
8716code hoisting pass.  The bigger the ratio, the more aggressive code hoisting
8717will be with simple expressions, i.e., the expressions that have cost
8718less than @option{gcse-unrestricted-cost}.  Specifying 0 will disable
8719hoisting of simple expressions.  The default value is 10.
8720
8721@item gcse-unrestricted-cost
8722Cost, roughly measured as the cost of a single typical machine
8723instruction, at which GCSE optimizations will not constrain
8724the distance an expression can travel.  This is currently
8725supported only in the code hoisting pass.  The lesser the cost,
8726the more aggressive code hoisting will be.  Specifying 0 will
8727allow all expressions to travel unrestricted distances.
8728The default value is 3.
8729
8730@item max-hoist-depth
8731The depth of search in the dominator tree for expressions to hoist.
8732This is used to avoid quadratic behavior in hoisting algorithm.
8733The value of 0 will avoid limiting the search, but may slow down compilation
8734of huge functions.  The default value is 30.
8735
8736@item max-tail-merge-comparisons
8737The maximum amount of similar bbs to compare a bb with.  This is used to
8738avoid quadratic behavior in tree tail merging.  The default value is 10.
8739
8740@item max-tail-merge-iterations
8741The maximum amount of iterations of the pass over the function.  This is used to
8742limit compilation time in tree tail merging.  The default value is 2.
8743
8744@item max-unrolled-insns
8745The maximum number of instructions that a loop should have if that loop
8746is unrolled, and if the loop is unrolled, it determines how many times
8747the loop code is unrolled.
8748
8749@item max-average-unrolled-insns
8750The maximum number of instructions biased by probabilities of their execution
8751that a loop should have if that loop is unrolled, and if the loop is unrolled,
8752it determines how many times the loop code is unrolled.
8753
8754@item max-unroll-times
8755The maximum number of unrollings of a single loop.
8756
8757@item max-peeled-insns
8758The maximum number of instructions that a loop should have if that loop
8759is peeled, and if the loop is peeled, it determines how many times
8760the loop code is peeled.
8761
8762@item max-peel-times
8763The maximum number of peelings of a single loop.
8764
8765@item max-completely-peeled-insns
8766The maximum number of insns of a completely peeled loop.
8767
8768@item max-completely-peel-times
8769The maximum number of iterations of a loop to be suitable for complete peeling.
8770
8771@item max-completely-peel-loop-nest-depth
8772The maximum depth of a loop nest suitable for complete peeling.
8773
8774@item max-unswitch-insns
8775The maximum number of insns of an unswitched loop.
8776
8777@item max-unswitch-level
8778The maximum number of branches unswitched in a single loop.
8779
8780@item lim-expensive
8781The minimum cost of an expensive expression in the loop invariant motion.
8782
8783@item iv-consider-all-candidates-bound
8784Bound on number of candidates for induction variables below that
8785all candidates are considered for each use in induction variable
8786optimizations.  Only the most relevant candidates are considered
8787if there are more candidates, to avoid quadratic time complexity.
8788
8789@item iv-max-considered-uses
8790The induction variable optimizations give up on loops that contain more
8791induction variable uses.
8792
8793@item iv-always-prune-cand-set-bound
8794If number of candidates in the set is smaller than this value,
8795we always try to remove unnecessary ivs from the set during its
8796optimization when a new iv is added to the set.
8797
8798@item scev-max-expr-size
8799Bound on size of expressions used in the scalar evolutions analyzer.
8800Large expressions slow the analyzer.
8801
8802@item scev-max-expr-complexity
8803Bound on the complexity of the expressions in the scalar evolutions analyzer.
8804Complex expressions slow the analyzer.
8805
8806@item omega-max-vars
8807The maximum number of variables in an Omega constraint system.
8808The default value is 128.
8809
8810@item omega-max-geqs
8811The maximum number of inequalities in an Omega constraint system.
8812The default value is 256.
8813
8814@item omega-max-eqs
8815The maximum number of equalities in an Omega constraint system.
8816The default value is 128.
8817
8818@item omega-max-wild-cards
8819The maximum number of wildcard variables that the Omega solver will
8820be able to insert.  The default value is 18.
8821
8822@item omega-hash-table-size
8823The size of the hash table in the Omega solver.  The default value is
8824550.
8825
8826@item omega-max-keys
8827The maximal number of keys used by the Omega solver.  The default
8828value is 500.
8829
8830@item omega-eliminate-redundant-constraints
8831When set to 1, use expensive methods to eliminate all redundant
8832constraints.  The default value is 0.
8833
8834@item vect-max-version-for-alignment-checks
8835The maximum number of run-time checks that can be performed when
8836doing loop versioning for alignment in the vectorizer.  See option
8837ftree-vect-loop-version for more information.
8838
8839@item vect-max-version-for-alias-checks
8840The maximum number of run-time checks that can be performed when
8841doing loop versioning for alias in the vectorizer.  See option
8842ftree-vect-loop-version for more information.
8843
8844@item max-iterations-to-track
8845
8846The maximum number of iterations of a loop the brute force algorithm
8847for analysis of # of iterations of the loop tries to evaluate.
8848
8849@item hot-bb-count-fraction
8850Select fraction of the maximal count of repetitions of basic block in program
8851given basic block needs to have to be considered hot.
8852
8853@item hot-bb-frequency-fraction
8854Select fraction of the entry block frequency of executions of basic block in
8855function given basic block needs to have to be considered hot.
8856
8857@item max-predicted-iterations
8858The maximum number of loop iterations we predict statically.  This is useful
8859in cases where function contain single loop with known bound and other loop
8860with unknown.  We predict the known number of iterations correctly, while
8861the unknown number of iterations average to roughly 10.  This means that the
8862loop without bounds would appear artificially cold relative to the other one.
8863
8864@item align-threshold
8865
8866Select fraction of the maximal frequency of executions of basic block in
8867function given basic block will get aligned.
8868
8869@item align-loop-iterations
8870
8871A loop expected to iterate at lest the selected number of iterations will get
8872aligned.
8873
8874@item tracer-dynamic-coverage
8875@itemx tracer-dynamic-coverage-feedback
8876
8877This value is used to limit superblock formation once the given percentage of
8878executed instructions is covered.  This limits unnecessary code size
8879expansion.
8880
8881The @option{tracer-dynamic-coverage-feedback} is used only when profile
8882feedback is available.  The real profiles (as opposed to statically estimated
8883ones) are much less balanced allowing the threshold to be larger value.
8884
8885@item tracer-max-code-growth
8886Stop tail duplication once code growth has reached given percentage.  This is
8887rather hokey argument, as most of the duplicates will be eliminated later in
8888cross jumping, so it may be set to much higher values than is the desired code
8889growth.
8890
8891@item tracer-min-branch-ratio
8892
8893Stop reverse growth when the reverse probability of best edge is less than this
8894threshold (in percent).
8895
8896@item tracer-min-branch-ratio
8897@itemx tracer-min-branch-ratio-feedback
8898
8899Stop forward growth if the best edge do have probability lower than this
8900threshold.
8901
8902Similarly to @option{tracer-dynamic-coverage} two values are present, one for
8903compilation for profile feedback and one for compilation without.  The value
8904for compilation with profile feedback needs to be more conservative (higher) in
8905order to make tracer effective.
8906
8907@item max-cse-path-length
8908
8909Maximum number of basic blocks on path that cse considers.  The default is 10.
8910
8911@item max-cse-insns
8912The maximum instructions CSE process before flushing. The default is 1000.
8913
8914@item ggc-min-expand
8915
8916GCC uses a garbage collector to manage its own memory allocation.  This
8917parameter specifies the minimum percentage by which the garbage
8918collector's heap should be allowed to expand between collections.
8919Tuning this may improve compilation speed; it has no effect on code
8920generation.
8921
8922The default is 30% + 70% * (RAM/1GB) with an upper bound of 100% when
8923RAM >= 1GB@.  If @code{getrlimit} is available, the notion of "RAM" is
8924the smallest of actual RAM and @code{RLIMIT_DATA} or @code{RLIMIT_AS}.  If
8925GCC is not able to calculate RAM on a particular platform, the lower
8926bound of 30% is used.  Setting this parameter and
8927@option{ggc-min-heapsize} to zero causes a full collection to occur at
8928every opportunity.  This is extremely slow, but can be useful for
8929debugging.
8930
8931@item ggc-min-heapsize
8932
8933Minimum size of the garbage collector's heap before it begins bothering
8934to collect garbage.  The first collection occurs after the heap expands
8935by @option{ggc-min-expand}% beyond @option{ggc-min-heapsize}.  Again,
8936tuning this may improve compilation speed, and has no effect on code
8937generation.
8938
8939The default is the smaller of RAM/8, RLIMIT_RSS, or a limit that
8940tries to ensure that RLIMIT_DATA or RLIMIT_AS are not exceeded, but
8941with a lower bound of 4096 (four megabytes) and an upper bound of
8942131072 (128 megabytes).  If GCC is not able to calculate RAM on a
8943particular platform, the lower bound is used.  Setting this parameter
8944very large effectively disables garbage collection.  Setting this
8945parameter and @option{ggc-min-expand} to zero causes a full collection
8946to occur at every opportunity.
8947
8948@item max-reload-search-insns
8949The maximum number of instruction reload should look backward for equivalent
8950register.  Increasing values mean more aggressive optimization, making the
8951compilation time increase with probably slightly better performance.
8952The default value is 100.
8953
8954@item max-cselib-memory-locations
8955The maximum number of memory locations cselib should take into account.
8956Increasing values mean more aggressive optimization, making the compilation time
8957increase with probably slightly better performance.  The default value is 500.
8958
8959@item reorder-blocks-duplicate
8960@itemx reorder-blocks-duplicate-feedback
8961
8962Used by basic block reordering pass to decide whether to use unconditional
8963branch or duplicate the code on its destination.  Code is duplicated when its
8964estimated size is smaller than this value multiplied by the estimated size of
8965unconditional jump in the hot spots of the program.
8966
8967The @option{reorder-block-duplicate-feedback} is used only when profile
8968feedback is available and may be set to higher values than
8969@option{reorder-block-duplicate} since information about the hot spots is more
8970accurate.
8971
8972@item max-sched-ready-insns
8973The maximum number of instructions ready to be issued the scheduler should
8974consider at any given time during the first scheduling pass.  Increasing
8975values mean more thorough searches, making the compilation time increase
8976with probably little benefit.  The default value is 100.
8977
8978@item max-sched-region-blocks
8979The maximum number of blocks in a region to be considered for
8980interblock scheduling.  The default value is 10.
8981
8982@item max-pipeline-region-blocks
8983The maximum number of blocks in a region to be considered for
8984pipelining in the selective scheduler.  The default value is 15.
8985
8986@item max-sched-region-insns
8987The maximum number of insns in a region to be considered for
8988interblock scheduling.  The default value is 100.
8989
8990@item max-pipeline-region-insns
8991The maximum number of insns in a region to be considered for
8992pipelining in the selective scheduler.  The default value is 200.
8993
8994@item min-spec-prob
8995The minimum probability (in percents) of reaching a source block
8996for interblock speculative scheduling.  The default value is 40.
8997
8998@item max-sched-extend-regions-iters
8999The maximum number of iterations through CFG to extend regions.
90000 - disable region extension,
9001N - do at most N iterations.
9002The default value is 0.
9003
9004@item max-sched-insn-conflict-delay
9005The maximum conflict delay for an insn to be considered for speculative motion.
9006The default value is 3.
9007
9008@item sched-spec-prob-cutoff
9009The minimal probability of speculation success (in percents), so that
9010speculative insn will be scheduled.
9011The default value is 40.
9012
9013@item sched-mem-true-dep-cost
9014Minimal distance (in CPU cycles) between store and load targeting same
9015memory locations.  The default value is 1.
9016
9017@item selsched-max-lookahead
9018The maximum size of the lookahead window of selective scheduling.  It is a
9019depth of search for available instructions.
9020The default value is 50.
9021
9022@item selsched-max-sched-times
9023The maximum number of times that an instruction will be scheduled during
9024selective scheduling.  This is the limit on the number of iterations
9025through which the instruction may be pipelined.  The default value is 2.
9026
9027@item selsched-max-insns-to-rename
9028The maximum number of best instructions in the ready list that are considered
9029for renaming in the selective scheduler.  The default value is 2.
9030
9031@item sms-min-sc
9032The minimum value of stage count that swing modulo scheduler will
9033generate.  The default value is 2.
9034
9035@item max-last-value-rtl
9036The maximum size measured as number of RTLs that can be recorded in an expression
9037in combiner for a pseudo register as last known value of that register.  The default
9038is 10000.
9039
9040@item integer-share-limit
9041Small integer constants can use a shared data structure, reducing the
9042compiler's memory usage and increasing its speed.  This sets the maximum
9043value of a shared integer constant.  The default value is 256.
9044
9045@item min-virtual-mappings
9046Specifies the minimum number of virtual mappings in the incremental
9047SSA updater that should be registered to trigger the virtual mappings
9048heuristic defined by virtual-mappings-ratio.  The default value is
9049100.
9050
9051@item virtual-mappings-ratio
9052If the number of virtual mappings is virtual-mappings-ratio bigger
9053than the number of virtual symbols to be updated, then the incremental
9054SSA updater switches to a full update for those symbols.  The default
9055ratio is 3.
9056
9057@item ssp-buffer-size
9058The minimum size of buffers (i.e.@: arrays) that will receive stack smashing
9059protection when @option{-fstack-protection} is used.
9060
9061@item max-jump-thread-duplication-stmts
9062Maximum number of statements allowed in a block that needs to be
9063duplicated when threading jumps.
9064
9065@item max-fields-for-field-sensitive
9066Maximum number of fields in a structure we will treat in
9067a field sensitive manner during pointer analysis.  The default is zero
9068for -O0, and -O1 and 100 for -Os, -O2, and -O3.
9069
9070@item prefetch-latency
9071Estimate on average number of instructions that are executed before
9072prefetch finishes.  The distance we prefetch ahead is proportional
9073to this constant.  Increasing this number may also lead to less
9074streams being prefetched (see @option{simultaneous-prefetches}).
9075
9076@item simultaneous-prefetches
9077Maximum number of prefetches that can run at the same time.
9078
9079@item l1-cache-line-size
9080The size of cache line in L1 cache, in bytes.
9081
9082@item l1-cache-size
9083The size of L1 cache, in kilobytes.
9084
9085@item l2-cache-size
9086The size of L2 cache, in kilobytes.
9087
9088@item min-insn-to-prefetch-ratio
9089The minimum ratio between the number of instructions and the
9090number of prefetches to enable prefetching in a loop.
9091
9092@item prefetch-min-insn-to-mem-ratio
9093The minimum ratio between the number of instructions and the
9094number of memory references to enable prefetching in a loop.
9095
9096@item use-canonical-types
9097Whether the compiler should use the ``canonical'' type system.  By
9098default, this should always be 1, which uses a more efficient internal
9099mechanism for comparing types in C++ and Objective-C++.  However, if
9100bugs in the canonical type system are causing compilation failures,
9101set this value to 0 to disable canonical types.
9102
9103@item switch-conversion-max-branch-ratio
9104Switch initialization conversion will refuse to create arrays that are
9105bigger than @option{switch-conversion-max-branch-ratio} times the number of
9106branches in the switch.
9107
9108@item max-partial-antic-length
9109Maximum length of the partial antic set computed during the tree
9110partial redundancy elimination optimization (@option{-ftree-pre}) when
9111optimizing at @option{-O3} and above.  For some sorts of source code
9112the enhanced partial redundancy elimination optimization can run away,
9113consuming all of the memory available on the host machine.  This
9114parameter sets a limit on the length of the sets that are computed,
9115which prevents the runaway behavior.  Setting a value of 0 for
9116this parameter will allow an unlimited set length.
9117
9118@item sccvn-max-scc-size
9119Maximum size of a strongly connected component (SCC) during SCCVN
9120processing.  If this limit is hit, SCCVN processing for the whole
9121function will not be done and optimizations depending on it will
9122be disabled.  The default maximum SCC size is 10000.
9123
9124@item ira-max-loops-num
9125IRA uses regional register allocation by default.  If a function
9126contains more loops than the number given by this parameter, only at most
9127the given number of the most frequently-executed loops form regions
9128for regional register allocation.  The default value of the
9129parameter is 100.
9130
9131@item ira-max-conflict-table-size
9132Although IRA uses a sophisticated algorithm to compress the conflict
9133table, the table can still require excessive amounts of memory for
9134huge functions.  If the conflict table for a function could be more
9135than the size in MB given by this parameter, the register allocator
9136instead uses a faster, simpler, and lower-quality
9137algorithm that does not require building a pseudo-register conflict table.
9138The default value of the parameter is 2000.
9139
9140@item ira-loop-reserved-regs
9141IRA can be used to evaluate more accurate register pressure in loops
9142for decisions to move loop invariants (see @option{-O3}).  The number
9143of available registers reserved for some other purposes is given
9144by this parameter.  The default value of the parameter is 2, which is
9145the minimal number of registers needed by typical instructions.
9146This value is the best found from numerous experiments.
9147
9148@item loop-invariant-max-bbs-in-loop
9149Loop invariant motion can be very expensive, both in compilation time and
9150in amount of needed compile-time memory, with very large loops.  Loops
9151with more basic blocks than this parameter won't have loop invariant
9152motion optimization performed on them.  The default value of the
9153parameter is 1000 for -O1 and 10000 for -O2 and above.
9154
9155@item loop-max-datarefs-for-datadeps
9156Building data dapendencies is expensive for very large loops.  This
9157parameter limits the number of data references in loops that are
9158considered for data dependence analysis.  These large loops will not
9159be handled then by the optimizations using loop data dependencies.
9160The default value is 1000.
9161
9162@item max-vartrack-size
9163Sets a maximum number of hash table slots to use during variable
9164tracking dataflow analysis of any function.  If this limit is exceeded
9165with variable tracking at assignments enabled, analysis for that
9166function is retried without it, after removing all debug insns from
9167the function.  If the limit is exceeded even without debug insns, var
9168tracking analysis is completely disabled for the function.  Setting
9169the parameter to zero makes it unlimited.
9170
9171@item max-vartrack-expr-depth
9172Sets a maximum number of recursion levels when attempting to map
9173variable names or debug temporaries to value expressions.  This trades
9174compilation time for more complete debug information.  If this is set too
9175low, value expressions that are available and could be represented in
9176debug information may end up not being used; setting this higher may
9177enable the compiler to find more complex debug expressions, but compile
9178time and memory use may grow.  The default is 12.
9179
9180@item min-nondebug-insn-uid
9181Use uids starting at this parameter for nondebug insns.  The range below
9182the parameter is reserved exclusively for debug insns created by
9183@option{-fvar-tracking-assignments}, but debug insns may get
9184(non-overlapping) uids above it if the reserved range is exhausted.
9185
9186@item ipa-sra-ptr-growth-factor
9187IPA-SRA will replace a pointer to an aggregate with one or more new
9188parameters only when their cumulative size is less or equal to
9189@option{ipa-sra-ptr-growth-factor} times the size of the original
9190pointer parameter.
9191
9192@item tm-max-aggregate-size
9193When making copies of thread-local variables in a transaction, this
9194parameter specifies the size in bytes after which variables will be
9195saved with the logging functions as opposed to save/restore code
9196sequence pairs.  This option only applies when using
9197@option{-fgnu-tm}.
9198
9199@item graphite-max-nb-scop-params
9200To avoid exponential effects in the Graphite loop transforms, the
9201number of parameters in a Static Control Part (SCoP) is bounded.  The
9202default value is 10 parameters.  A variable whose value is unknown at
9203compilation time and defined outside a SCoP is a parameter of the SCoP.
9204
9205@item graphite-max-bbs-per-function
9206To avoid exponential effects in the detection of SCoPs, the size of
9207the functions analyzed by Graphite is bounded.  The default value is
9208100 basic blocks.
9209
9210@item loop-block-tile-size
9211Loop blocking or strip mining transforms, enabled with
9212@option{-floop-block} or @option{-floop-strip-mine}, strip mine each
9213loop in the loop nest by a given number of iterations.  The strip
9214length can be changed using the @option{loop-block-tile-size}
9215parameter.  The default value is 51 iterations.
9216
9217@item ipa-cp-value-list-size
9218IPA-CP attempts to track all possible values and types passed to a function's
9219parameter in order to propagate them and perform devirtualization.
9220@option{ipa-cp-value-list-size} is the maximum number of values and types it
9221stores per one formal parameter of a function.
9222
9223@item lto-partitions
9224Specify desired number of partitions produced during WHOPR compilation.
9225The number of partitions should exceed the number of CPUs used for compilation.
9226The default value is 32.
9227
9228@item lto-minpartition
9229Size of minimal partition for WHOPR (in estimated instructions).
9230This prevents expenses of splitting very small programs into too many
9231partitions.
9232
9233@item cxx-max-namespaces-for-diagnostic-help
9234The maximum number of namespaces to consult for suggestions when C++
9235name lookup fails for an identifier.  The default is 1000.
9236
9237@item sink-frequency-threshold
9238The maximum relative execution frequency (in percents) of the target block
9239relative to a statement's original block to allow statement sinking of a
9240statement.  Larger numbers result in more aggressive statement sinking.
9241The default value is 75.  A small positive adjustment is applied for
9242statements with memory operands as those are even more profitable so sink.
9243
9244@item max-stores-to-sink
9245The maximum number of conditional stores paires that can be sunk.  Set to 0
9246if either vectorization (@option{-ftree-vectorize}) or if-conversion
9247(@option{-ftree-loop-if-convert}) is disabled.  The default is 2.
9248
9249@item allow-load-data-races
9250Allow optimizers to introduce new data races on loads.
9251Set to 1 to allow, otherwise to 0.  This option is enabled by default
9252unless implicitly set by the @option{-fmemory-model=} option.
9253
9254@item allow-store-data-races
9255Allow optimizers to introduce new data races on stores.
9256Set to 1 to allow, otherwise to 0.  This option is enabled by default
9257unless implicitly set by the @option{-fmemory-model=} option.
9258
9259@item allow-packed-load-data-races
9260Allow optimizers to introduce new data races on packed data loads.
9261Set to 1 to allow, otherwise to 0.  This option is enabled by default
9262unless implicitly set by the @option{-fmemory-model=} option.
9263
9264@item allow-packed-store-data-races
9265Allow optimizers to introduce new data races on packed data stores.
9266Set to 1 to allow, otherwise to 0.  This option is enabled by default
9267unless implicitly set by the @option{-fmemory-model=} option.
9268
9269@item case-values-threshold
9270The smallest number of different values for which it is best to use a
9271jump-table instead of a tree of conditional branches.  If the value is
92720, use the default for the machine.  The default is 0.
9273
9274@item tree-reassoc-width
9275Set the maximum number of instructions executed in parallel in
9276reassociated tree. This parameter overrides target dependent
9277heuristics used by default if has non zero value.
9278
9279@end table
9280@end table
9281
9282@node Preprocessor Options
9283@section Options Controlling the Preprocessor
9284@cindex preprocessor options
9285@cindex options, preprocessor
9286
9287These options control the C preprocessor, which is run on each C source
9288file before actual compilation.
9289
9290If you use the @option{-E} option, nothing is done except preprocessing.
9291Some of these options make sense only together with @option{-E} because
9292they cause the preprocessor output to be unsuitable for actual
9293compilation.
9294
9295@table @gcctabopt
9296@item -Wp,@var{option}
9297@opindex Wp
9298You can use @option{-Wp,@var{option}} to bypass the compiler driver
9299and pass @var{option} directly through to the preprocessor.  If
9300@var{option} contains commas, it is split into multiple options at the
9301commas.  However, many options are modified, translated or interpreted
9302by the compiler driver before being passed to the preprocessor, and
9303@option{-Wp} forcibly bypasses this phase.  The preprocessor's direct
9304interface is undocumented and subject to change, so whenever possible
9305you should avoid using @option{-Wp} and let the driver handle the
9306options instead.
9307
9308@item -Xpreprocessor @var{option}
9309@opindex Xpreprocessor
9310Pass @var{option} as an option to the preprocessor.  You can use this to
9311supply system-specific preprocessor options that GCC does not know how to
9312recognize.
9313
9314If you want to pass an option that takes an argument, you must use
9315@option{-Xpreprocessor} twice, once for the option and once for the argument.
9316@end table
9317
9318@include cppopts.texi
9319
9320@node Assembler Options
9321@section Passing Options to the Assembler
9322
9323@c prevent bad page break with this line
9324You can pass options to the assembler.
9325
9326@table @gcctabopt
9327@item -Wa,@var{option}
9328@opindex Wa
9329Pass @var{option} as an option to the assembler.  If @var{option}
9330contains commas, it is split into multiple options at the commas.
9331
9332@item -Xassembler @var{option}
9333@opindex Xassembler
9334Pass @var{option} as an option to the assembler.  You can use this to
9335supply system-specific assembler options that GCC does not know how to
9336recognize.
9337
9338If you want to pass an option that takes an argument, you must use
9339@option{-Xassembler} twice, once for the option and once for the argument.
9340
9341@end table
9342
9343@node Link Options
9344@section Options for Linking
9345@cindex link options
9346@cindex options, linking
9347
9348These options come into play when the compiler links object files into
9349an executable output file.  They are meaningless if the compiler is
9350not doing a link step.
9351
9352@table @gcctabopt
9353@cindex file names
9354@item @var{object-file-name}
9355A file name that does not end in a special recognized suffix is
9356considered to name an object file or library.  (Object files are
9357distinguished from libraries by the linker according to the file
9358contents.)  If linking is done, these object files are used as input
9359to the linker.
9360
9361@item -c
9362@itemx -S
9363@itemx -E
9364@opindex c
9365@opindex S
9366@opindex E
9367If any of these options is used, then the linker is not run, and
9368object file names should not be used as arguments.  @xref{Overall
9369Options}.
9370
9371@cindex Libraries
9372@item -l@var{library}
9373@itemx -l @var{library}
9374@opindex l
9375Search the library named @var{library} when linking.  (The second
9376alternative with the library as a separate argument is only for
9377POSIX compliance and is not recommended.)
9378
9379It makes a difference where in the command you write this option; the
9380linker searches and processes libraries and object files in the order they
9381are specified.  Thus, @samp{foo.o -lz bar.o} searches library @samp{z}
9382after file @file{foo.o} but before @file{bar.o}.  If @file{bar.o} refers
9383to functions in @samp{z}, those functions may not be loaded.
9384
9385The linker searches a standard list of directories for the library,
9386which is actually a file named @file{lib@var{library}.a}.  The linker
9387then uses this file as if it had been specified precisely by name.
9388
9389The directories searched include several standard system directories
9390plus any that you specify with @option{-L}.
9391
9392Normally the files found this way are library files---archive files
9393whose members are object files.  The linker handles an archive file by
9394scanning through it for members which define symbols that have so far
9395been referenced but not defined.  But if the file that is found is an
9396ordinary object file, it is linked in the usual fashion.  The only
9397difference between using an @option{-l} option and specifying a file name
9398is that @option{-l} surrounds @var{library} with @samp{lib} and @samp{.a}
9399and searches several directories.
9400
9401@item -lobjc
9402@opindex lobjc
9403You need this special case of the @option{-l} option in order to
9404link an Objective-C or Objective-C++ program.
9405
9406@item -nostartfiles
9407@opindex nostartfiles
9408Do not use the standard system startup files when linking.
9409The standard system libraries are used normally, unless @option{-nostdlib}
9410or @option{-nodefaultlibs} is used.
9411
9412@item -nodefaultlibs
9413@opindex nodefaultlibs
9414Do not use the standard system libraries when linking.
9415Only the libraries you specify will be passed to the linker, options
9416specifying linkage of the system libraries, such as @code{-static-libgcc}
9417or @code{-shared-libgcc}, will be ignored.
9418The standard startup files are used normally, unless @option{-nostartfiles}
9419is used.  The compiler may generate calls to @code{memcmp},
9420@code{memset}, @code{memcpy} and @code{memmove}.
9421These entries are usually resolved by entries in
9422libc.  These entry points should be supplied through some other
9423mechanism when this option is specified.
9424
9425@item -nostdlib
9426@opindex nostdlib
9427Do not use the standard system startup files or libraries when linking.
9428No startup files and only the libraries you specify will be passed to
9429the linker, options specifying linkage of the system libraries, such as
9430@code{-static-libgcc} or @code{-shared-libgcc}, will be ignored.
9431The compiler may generate calls to @code{memcmp}, @code{memset},
9432@code{memcpy} and @code{memmove}.
9433These entries are usually resolved by entries in
9434libc.  These entry points should be supplied through some other
9435mechanism when this option is specified.
9436
9437@cindex @option{-lgcc}, use with @option{-nostdlib}
9438@cindex @option{-nostdlib} and unresolved references
9439@cindex unresolved references and @option{-nostdlib}
9440@cindex @option{-lgcc}, use with @option{-nodefaultlibs}
9441@cindex @option{-nodefaultlibs} and unresolved references
9442@cindex unresolved references and @option{-nodefaultlibs}
9443One of the standard libraries bypassed by @option{-nostdlib} and
9444@option{-nodefaultlibs} is @file{libgcc.a}, a library of internal subroutines
9445which GCC uses to overcome shortcomings of particular machines, or special
9446needs for some languages.
9447(@xref{Interface,,Interfacing to GCC Output,gccint,GNU Compiler
9448Collection (GCC) Internals},
9449for more discussion of @file{libgcc.a}.)
9450In most cases, you need @file{libgcc.a} even when you want to avoid
9451other standard libraries.  In other words, when you specify @option{-nostdlib}
9452or @option{-nodefaultlibs} you should usually specify @option{-lgcc} as well.
9453This ensures that you have no unresolved references to internal GCC
9454library subroutines.  (For example, @samp{__main}, used to ensure C++
9455constructors will be called; @pxref{Collect2,,@code{collect2}, gccint,
9456GNU Compiler Collection (GCC) Internals}.)
9457
9458@item -pie
9459@opindex pie
9460Produce a position independent executable on targets that support it.
9461For predictable results, you must also specify the same set of options
9462that were used to generate code (@option{-fpie}, @option{-fPIE},
9463or model suboptions) when you specify this option.
9464
9465@item -rdynamic
9466@opindex rdynamic
9467Pass the flag @option{-export-dynamic} to the ELF linker, on targets
9468that support it. This instructs the linker to add all symbols, not
9469only used ones, to the dynamic symbol table. This option is needed
9470for some uses of @code{dlopen} or to allow obtaining backtraces
9471from within a program.
9472
9473@item -s
9474@opindex s
9475Remove all symbol table and relocation information from the executable.
9476
9477@item -static
9478@opindex static
9479On systems that support dynamic linking, this prevents linking with the shared
9480libraries.  On other systems, this option has no effect.
9481
9482@item -shared
9483@opindex shared
9484Produce a shared object which can then be linked with other objects to
9485form an executable.  Not all systems support this option.  For predictable
9486results, you must also specify the same set of options that were used to
9487generate code (@option{-fpic}, @option{-fPIC}, or model suboptions)
9488when you specify this option.@footnote{On some systems, @samp{gcc -shared}
9489needs to build supplementary stub code for constructors to work.  On
9490multi-libbed systems, @samp{gcc -shared} must select the correct support
9491libraries to link against.  Failing to supply the correct flags may lead
9492to subtle defects.  Supplying them in cases where they are not necessary
9493is innocuous.}
9494
9495@item -shared-libgcc
9496@itemx -static-libgcc
9497@opindex shared-libgcc
9498@opindex static-libgcc
9499On systems that provide @file{libgcc} as a shared library, these options
9500force the use of either the shared or static version respectively.
9501If no shared version of @file{libgcc} was built when the compiler was
9502configured, these options have no effect.
9503
9504There are several situations in which an application should use the
9505shared @file{libgcc} instead of the static version.  The most common
9506of these is when the application wishes to throw and catch exceptions
9507across different shared libraries.  In that case, each of the libraries
9508as well as the application itself should use the shared @file{libgcc}.
9509
9510Therefore, the G++ and GCJ drivers automatically add
9511@option{-shared-libgcc} whenever you build a shared library or a main
9512executable, because C++ and Java programs typically use exceptions, so
9513this is the right thing to do.
9514
9515If, instead, you use the GCC driver to create shared libraries, you may
9516find that they will not always be linked with the shared @file{libgcc}.
9517If GCC finds, at its configuration time, that you have a non-GNU linker
9518or a GNU linker that does not support option @option{--eh-frame-hdr},
9519it will link the shared version of @file{libgcc} into shared libraries
9520by default.  Otherwise, it will take advantage of the linker and optimize
9521away the linking with the shared version of @file{libgcc}, linking with
9522the static version of libgcc by default.  This allows exceptions to
9523propagate through such shared libraries, without incurring relocation
9524costs at library load time.
9525
9526However, if a library or main executable is supposed to throw or catch
9527exceptions, you must link it using the G++ or GCJ driver, as appropriate
9528for the languages used in the program, or using the option
9529@option{-shared-libgcc}, such that it is linked with the shared
9530@file{libgcc}.
9531
9532@item -static-libstdc++
9533When the @command{g++} program is used to link a C++ program, it will
9534normally automatically link against @option{libstdc++}.  If
9535@file{libstdc++} is available as a shared library, and the
9536@option{-static} option is not used, then this will link against the
9537shared version of @file{libstdc++}.  That is normally fine.  However, it
9538is sometimes useful to freeze the version of @file{libstdc++} used by
9539the program without going all the way to a fully static link.  The
9540@option{-static-libstdc++} option directs the @command{g++} driver to
9541link @file{libstdc++} statically, without necessarily linking other
9542libraries statically.
9543
9544@item -symbolic
9545@opindex symbolic
9546Bind references to global symbols when building a shared object.  Warn
9547about any unresolved references (unless overridden by the link editor
9548option @samp{-Xlinker -z -Xlinker defs}).  Only a few systems support
9549this option.
9550
9551@item -T @var{script}
9552@opindex T
9553@cindex linker script
9554Use @var{script} as the linker script.  This option is supported by most
9555systems using the GNU linker.  On some targets, such as bare-board
9556targets without an operating system, the @option{-T} option may be required
9557when linking to avoid references to undefined symbols.
9558
9559@item -Xlinker @var{option}
9560@opindex Xlinker
9561Pass @var{option} as an option to the linker.  You can use this to
9562supply system-specific linker options that GCC does not recognize.
9563
9564If you want to pass an option that takes a separate argument, you must use
9565@option{-Xlinker} twice, once for the option and once for the argument.
9566For example, to pass @option{-assert definitions}, you must write
9567@samp{-Xlinker -assert -Xlinker definitions}.  It does not work to write
9568@option{-Xlinker "-assert definitions"}, because this passes the entire
9569string as a single argument, which is not what the linker expects.
9570
9571When using the GNU linker, it is usually more convenient to pass
9572arguments to linker options using the @option{@var{option}=@var{value}}
9573syntax than as separate arguments.  For example, you can specify
9574@samp{-Xlinker -Map=output.map} rather than
9575@samp{-Xlinker -Map -Xlinker output.map}.  Other linkers may not support
9576this syntax for command-line options.
9577
9578@item -Wl,@var{option}
9579@opindex Wl
9580Pass @var{option} as an option to the linker.  If @var{option} contains
9581commas, it is split into multiple options at the commas.  You can use this
9582syntax to pass an argument to the option.
9583For example, @samp{-Wl,-Map,output.map} passes @samp{-Map output.map} to the
9584linker.  When using the GNU linker, you can also get the same effect with
9585@samp{-Wl,-Map=output.map}.
9586
9587@item -u @var{symbol}
9588@opindex u
9589Pretend the symbol @var{symbol} is undefined, to force linking of
9590library modules to define it.  You can use @option{-u} multiple times with
9591different symbols to force loading of additional library modules.
9592@end table
9593
9594@node Directory Options
9595@section Options for Directory Search
9596@cindex directory options
9597@cindex options, directory search
9598@cindex search path
9599
9600These options specify directories to search for header files, for
9601libraries and for parts of the compiler:
9602
9603@table @gcctabopt
9604@item -I@var{dir}
9605@opindex I
9606Add the directory @var{dir} to the head of the list of directories to be
9607searched for header files.  This can be used to override a system header
9608file, substituting your own version, since these directories are
9609searched before the system header file directories.  However, you should
9610not use this option to add directories that contain vendor-supplied
9611system header files (use @option{-isystem} for that).  If you use more than
9612one @option{-I} option, the directories are scanned in left-to-right
9613order; the standard system directories come after.
9614
9615If a standard system include directory, or a directory specified with
9616@option{-isystem}, is also specified with @option{-I}, the @option{-I}
9617option will be ignored.  The directory will still be searched but as a
9618system directory at its normal position in the system include chain.
9619This is to ensure that GCC's procedure to fix buggy system headers and
9620the ordering for the include_next directive are not inadvertently changed.
9621If you really need to change the search order for system directories,
9622use the @option{-nostdinc} and/or @option{-isystem} options.
9623
9624@item -iplugindir=@var{dir}
9625Set the directory to search for plugins that are passed
9626by @option{-fplugin=@var{name}} instead of
9627@option{-fplugin=@var{path}/@var{name}.so}.  This option is not meant
9628to be used by the user, but only passed by the driver.
9629
9630@item -iquote@var{dir}
9631@opindex iquote
9632Add the directory @var{dir} to the head of the list of directories to
9633be searched for header files only for the case of @samp{#include
9634"@var{file}"}; they are not searched for @samp{#include <@var{file}>},
9635otherwise just like @option{-I}.
9636
9637@item -L@var{dir}
9638@opindex L
9639Add directory @var{dir} to the list of directories to be searched
9640for @option{-l}.
9641
9642@item -B@var{prefix}
9643@opindex B
9644This option specifies where to find the executables, libraries,
9645include files, and data files of the compiler itself.
9646
9647The compiler driver program runs one or more of the subprograms
9648@file{cpp}, @file{cc1}, @file{as} and @file{ld}.  It tries
9649@var{prefix} as a prefix for each program it tries to run, both with and
9650without @samp{@var{machine}/@var{version}/} (@pxref{Target Options}).
9651
9652For each subprogram to be run, the compiler driver first tries the
9653@option{-B} prefix, if any.  If that name is not found, or if @option{-B}
9654was not specified, the driver tries two standard prefixes,
9655@file{/usr/lib/gcc/} and @file{/usr/local/lib/gcc/}.  If neither of
9656those results in a file name that is found, the unmodified program
9657name is searched for using the directories specified in your
9658@env{PATH} environment variable.
9659
9660The compiler will check to see if the path provided by the @option{-B}
9661refers to a directory, and if necessary it will add a directory
9662separator character at the end of the path.
9663
9664@option{-B} prefixes that effectively specify directory names also apply
9665to libraries in the linker, because the compiler translates these
9666options into @option{-L} options for the linker.  They also apply to
9667includes files in the preprocessor, because the compiler translates these
9668options into @option{-isystem} options for the preprocessor.  In this case,
9669the compiler appends @samp{include} to the prefix.
9670
9671The runtime support file @file{libgcc.a} can also be searched for using
9672the @option{-B} prefix, if needed.  If it is not found there, the two
9673standard prefixes above are tried, and that is all.  The file is left
9674out of the link if it is not found by those means.
9675
9676Another way to specify a prefix much like the @option{-B} prefix is to use
9677the environment variable @env{GCC_EXEC_PREFIX}.  @xref{Environment
9678Variables}.
9679
9680As a special kludge, if the path provided by @option{-B} is
9681@file{[dir/]stage@var{N}/}, where @var{N} is a number in the range 0 to
96829, then it will be replaced by @file{[dir/]include}.  This is to help
9683with boot-strapping the compiler.
9684
9685@item -specs=@var{file}
9686@opindex specs
9687Process @var{file} after the compiler reads in the standard @file{specs}
9688file, in order to override the defaults which the @file{gcc} driver
9689program uses when determining what switches to pass to @file{cc1},
9690@file{cc1plus}, @file{as}, @file{ld}, etc.  More than one
9691@option{-specs=@var{file}} can be specified on the command line, and they
9692are processed in order, from left to right.
9693
9694@item --sysroot=@var{dir}
9695@opindex sysroot
9696Use @var{dir} as the logical root directory for headers and libraries.
9697For example, if the compiler would normally search for headers in
9698@file{/usr/include} and libraries in @file{/usr/lib}, it will instead
9699search @file{@var{dir}/usr/include} and @file{@var{dir}/usr/lib}.
9700
9701If you use both this option and the @option{-isysroot} option, then
9702the @option{--sysroot} option will apply to libraries, but the
9703@option{-isysroot} option will apply to header files.
9704
9705The GNU linker (beginning with version 2.16) has the necessary support
9706for this option.  If your linker does not support this option, the
9707header file aspect of @option{--sysroot} will still work, but the
9708library aspect will not.
9709
9710@item -I-
9711@opindex I-
9712This option has been deprecated.  Please use @option{-iquote} instead for
9713@option{-I} directories before the @option{-I-} and remove the @option{-I-}.
9714Any directories you specify with @option{-I} options before the @option{-I-}
9715option are searched only for the case of @samp{#include "@var{file}"};
9716they are not searched for @samp{#include <@var{file}>}.
9717
9718If additional directories are specified with @option{-I} options after
9719the @option{-I-}, these directories are searched for all @samp{#include}
9720directives.  (Ordinarily @emph{all} @option{-I} directories are used
9721this way.)
9722
9723In addition, the @option{-I-} option inhibits the use of the current
9724directory (where the current input file came from) as the first search
9725directory for @samp{#include "@var{file}"}.  There is no way to
9726override this effect of @option{-I-}.  With @option{-I.} you can specify
9727searching the directory that was current when the compiler was
9728invoked.  That is not exactly the same as what the preprocessor does
9729by default, but it is often satisfactory.
9730
9731@option{-I-} does not inhibit the use of the standard system directories
9732for header files.  Thus, @option{-I-} and @option{-nostdinc} are
9733independent.
9734@end table
9735
9736@c man end
9737
9738@node Spec Files
9739@section Specifying subprocesses and the switches to pass to them
9740@cindex Spec Files
9741
9742@command{gcc} is a driver program.  It performs its job by invoking a
9743sequence of other programs to do the work of compiling, assembling and
9744linking.  GCC interprets its command-line parameters and uses these to
9745deduce which programs it should invoke, and which command-line options
9746it ought to place on their command lines.  This behavior is controlled
9747by @dfn{spec strings}.  In most cases there is one spec string for each
9748program that GCC can invoke, but a few programs have multiple spec
9749strings to control their behavior.  The spec strings built into GCC can
9750be overridden by using the @option{-specs=} command-line switch to specify
9751a spec file.
9752
9753@dfn{Spec files} are plaintext files that are used to construct spec
9754strings.  They consist of a sequence of directives separated by blank
9755lines.  The type of directive is determined by the first non-whitespace
9756character on the line, which can be one of the following:
9757
9758@table @code
9759@item %@var{command}
9760Issues a @var{command} to the spec file processor.  The commands that can
9761appear here are:
9762
9763@table @code
9764@item %include <@var{file}>
9765@cindex @code{%include}
9766Search for @var{file} and insert its text at the current point in the
9767specs file.
9768
9769@item %include_noerr <@var{file}>
9770@cindex @code{%include_noerr}
9771Just like @samp{%include}, but do not generate an error message if the include
9772file cannot be found.
9773
9774@item %rename @var{old_name} @var{new_name}
9775@cindex @code{%rename}
9776Rename the spec string @var{old_name} to @var{new_name}.
9777
9778@end table
9779
9780@item *[@var{spec_name}]:
9781This tells the compiler to create, override or delete the named spec
9782string.  All lines after this directive up to the next directive or
9783blank line are considered to be the text for the spec string.  If this
9784results in an empty string then the spec will be deleted.  (Or, if the
9785spec did not exist, then nothing will happen.)  Otherwise, if the spec
9786does not currently exist a new spec will be created.  If the spec does
9787exist then its contents will be overridden by the text of this
9788directive, unless the first character of that text is the @samp{+}
9789character, in which case the text will be appended to the spec.
9790
9791@item [@var{suffix}]:
9792Creates a new @samp{[@var{suffix}] spec} pair.  All lines after this directive
9793and up to the next directive or blank line are considered to make up the
9794spec string for the indicated suffix.  When the compiler encounters an
9795input file with the named suffix, it will processes the spec string in
9796order to work out how to compile that file.  For example:
9797
9798@smallexample
9799.ZZ:
9800z-compile -input %i
9801@end smallexample
9802
9803This says that any input file whose name ends in @samp{.ZZ} should be
9804passed to the program @samp{z-compile}, which should be invoked with the
9805command-line switch @option{-input} and with the result of performing the
9806@samp{%i} substitution.  (See below.)
9807
9808As an alternative to providing a spec string, the text that follows a
9809suffix directive can be one of the following:
9810
9811@table @code
9812@item @@@var{language}
9813This says that the suffix is an alias for a known @var{language}.  This is
9814similar to using the @option{-x} command-line switch to GCC to specify a
9815language explicitly.  For example:
9816
9817@smallexample
9818.ZZ:
9819@@c++
9820@end smallexample
9821
9822Says that .ZZ files are, in fact, C++ source files.
9823
9824@item #@var{name}
9825This causes an error messages saying:
9826
9827@smallexample
9828@var{name} compiler not installed on this system.
9829@end smallexample
9830@end table
9831
9832GCC already has an extensive list of suffixes built into it.
9833This directive will add an entry to the end of the list of suffixes, but
9834since the list is searched from the end backwards, it is effectively
9835possible to override earlier entries using this technique.
9836
9837@end table
9838
9839GCC has the following spec strings built into it.  Spec files can
9840override these strings or create their own.  Note that individual
9841targets can also add their own spec strings to this list.
9842
9843@smallexample
9844asm          Options to pass to the assembler
9845asm_final    Options to pass to the assembler post-processor
9846cpp          Options to pass to the C preprocessor
9847cc1          Options to pass to the C compiler
9848cc1plus      Options to pass to the C++ compiler
9849endfile      Object files to include at the end of the link
9850link         Options to pass to the linker
9851lib          Libraries to include on the command line to the linker
9852libgcc       Decides which GCC support library to pass to the linker
9853linker       Sets the name of the linker
9854predefines   Defines to be passed to the C preprocessor
9855signed_char  Defines to pass to CPP to say whether @code{char} is signed
9856             by default
9857startfile    Object files to include at the start of the link
9858@end smallexample
9859
9860Here is a small example of a spec file:
9861
9862@smallexample
9863%rename lib                 old_lib
9864
9865*lib:
9866--start-group -lgcc -lc -leval1 --end-group %(old_lib)
9867@end smallexample
9868
9869This example renames the spec called @samp{lib} to @samp{old_lib} and
9870then overrides the previous definition of @samp{lib} with a new one.
9871The new definition adds in some extra command-line options before
9872including the text of the old definition.
9873
9874@dfn{Spec strings} are a list of command-line options to be passed to their
9875corresponding program.  In addition, the spec strings can contain
9876@samp{%}-prefixed sequences to substitute variable text or to
9877conditionally insert text into the command line.  Using these constructs
9878it is possible to generate quite complex command lines.
9879
9880Here is a table of all defined @samp{%}-sequences for spec
9881strings.  Note that spaces are not generated automatically around the
9882results of expanding these sequences.  Therefore you can concatenate them
9883together or combine them with constant text in a single argument.
9884
9885@table @code
9886@item %%
9887Substitute one @samp{%} into the program name or argument.
9888
9889@item %i
9890Substitute the name of the input file being processed.
9891
9892@item %b
9893Substitute the basename of the input file being processed.
9894This is the substring up to (and not including) the last period
9895and not including the directory.
9896
9897@item %B
9898This is the same as @samp{%b}, but include the file suffix (text after
9899the last period).
9900
9901@item %d
9902Marks the argument containing or following the @samp{%d} as a
9903temporary file name, so that that file will be deleted if GCC exits
9904successfully.  Unlike @samp{%g}, this contributes no text to the
9905argument.
9906
9907@item %g@var{suffix}
9908Substitute a file name that has suffix @var{suffix} and is chosen
9909once per compilation, and mark the argument in the same way as
9910@samp{%d}.  To reduce exposure to denial-of-service attacks, the file
9911name is now chosen in a way that is hard to predict even when previously
9912chosen file names are known.  For example, @samp{%g.s @dots{} %g.o @dots{} %g.s}
9913might turn into @samp{ccUVUUAU.s ccXYAXZ12.o ccUVUUAU.s}.  @var{suffix} matches
9914the regexp @samp{[.A-Za-z]*} or the special string @samp{%O}, which is
9915treated exactly as if @samp{%O} had been preprocessed.  Previously, @samp{%g}
9916was simply substituted with a file name chosen once per compilation,
9917without regard to any appended suffix (which was therefore treated
9918just like ordinary text), making such attacks more likely to succeed.
9919
9920@item %u@var{suffix}
9921Like @samp{%g}, but generates a new temporary file name even if
9922@samp{%u@var{suffix}} was already seen.
9923
9924@item %U@var{suffix}
9925Substitutes the last file name generated with @samp{%u@var{suffix}}, generating a
9926new one if there is no such last file name.  In the absence of any
9927@samp{%u@var{suffix}}, this is just like @samp{%g@var{suffix}}, except they don't share
9928the same suffix @emph{space}, so @samp{%g.s @dots{} %U.s @dots{} %g.s @dots{} %U.s}
9929would involve the generation of two distinct file names, one
9930for each @samp{%g.s} and another for each @samp{%U.s}.  Previously, @samp{%U} was
9931simply substituted with a file name chosen for the previous @samp{%u},
9932without regard to any appended suffix.
9933
9934@item %j@var{suffix}
9935Substitutes the name of the @code{HOST_BIT_BUCKET}, if any, and if it is
9936writable, and if save-temps is off; otherwise, substitute the name
9937of a temporary file, just like @samp{%u}.  This temporary file is not
9938meant for communication between processes, but rather as a junk
9939disposal mechanism.
9940
9941@item %|@var{suffix}
9942@itemx %m@var{suffix}
9943Like @samp{%g}, except if @option{-pipe} is in effect.  In that case
9944@samp{%|} substitutes a single dash and @samp{%m} substitutes nothing at
9945all.  These are the two most common ways to instruct a program that it
9946should read from standard input or write to standard output.  If you
9947need something more elaborate you can use an @samp{%@{pipe:@code{X}@}}
9948construct: see for example @file{f/lang-specs.h}.
9949
9950@item %.@var{SUFFIX}
9951Substitutes @var{.SUFFIX} for the suffixes of a matched switch's args
9952when it is subsequently output with @samp{%*}.  @var{SUFFIX} is
9953terminated by the next space or %.
9954
9955@item %w
9956Marks the argument containing or following the @samp{%w} as the
9957designated output file of this compilation.  This puts the argument
9958into the sequence of arguments that @samp{%o} will substitute later.
9959
9960@item %o
9961Substitutes the names of all the output files, with spaces
9962automatically placed around them.  You should write spaces
9963around the @samp{%o} as well or the results are undefined.
9964@samp{%o} is for use in the specs for running the linker.
9965Input files whose names have no recognized suffix are not compiled
9966at all, but they are included among the output files, so they will
9967be linked.
9968
9969@item %O
9970Substitutes the suffix for object files.  Note that this is
9971handled specially when it immediately follows @samp{%g, %u, or %U},
9972because of the need for those to form complete file names.  The
9973handling is such that @samp{%O} is treated exactly as if it had already
9974been substituted, except that @samp{%g, %u, and %U} do not currently
9975support additional @var{suffix} characters following @samp{%O} as they would
9976following, for example, @samp{.o}.
9977
9978@item %p
9979Substitutes the standard macro predefinitions for the
9980current target machine.  Use this when running @code{cpp}.
9981
9982@item %P
9983Like @samp{%p}, but puts @samp{__} before and after the name of each
9984predefined macro, except for macros that start with @samp{__} or with
9985@samp{_@var{L}}, where @var{L} is an uppercase letter.  This is for ISO
9986C@.
9987
9988@item %I
9989Substitute any of @option{-iprefix} (made from @env{GCC_EXEC_PREFIX}),
9990@option{-isysroot} (made from @env{TARGET_SYSTEM_ROOT}),
9991@option{-isystem} (made from @env{COMPILER_PATH} and @option{-B} options)
9992and @option{-imultilib} as necessary.
9993
9994@item %s
9995Current argument is the name of a library or startup file of some sort.
9996Search for that file in a standard list of directories and substitute
9997the full name found.  The current working directory is included in the
9998list of directories scanned.
9999
10000@item %T
10001Current argument is the name of a linker script.  Search for that file
10002in the current list of directories to scan for libraries. If the file
10003is located insert a @option{--script} option into the command line
10004followed by the full path name found.  If the file is not found then
10005generate an error message.  Note: the current working directory is not
10006searched.
10007
10008@item %e@var{str}
10009Print @var{str} as an error message.  @var{str} is terminated by a newline.
10010Use this when inconsistent options are detected.
10011
10012@item %(@var{name})
10013Substitute the contents of spec string @var{name} at this point.
10014
10015@item %x@{@var{option}@}
10016Accumulate an option for @samp{%X}.
10017
10018@item %X
10019Output the accumulated linker options specified by @option{-Wl} or a @samp{%x}
10020spec string.
10021
10022@item %Y
10023Output the accumulated assembler options specified by @option{-Wa}.
10024
10025@item %Z
10026Output the accumulated preprocessor options specified by @option{-Wp}.
10027
10028@item %a
10029Process the @code{asm} spec.  This is used to compute the
10030switches to be passed to the assembler.
10031
10032@item %A
10033Process the @code{asm_final} spec.  This is a spec string for
10034passing switches to an assembler post-processor, if such a program is
10035needed.
10036
10037@item %l
10038Process the @code{link} spec.  This is the spec for computing the
10039command line passed to the linker.  Typically it will make use of the
10040@samp{%L %G %S %D and %E} sequences.
10041
10042@item %D
10043Dump out a @option{-L} option for each directory that GCC believes might
10044contain startup files.  If the target supports multilibs then the
10045current multilib directory will be prepended to each of these paths.
10046
10047@item %L
10048Process the @code{lib} spec.  This is a spec string for deciding which
10049libraries should be included on the command line to the linker.
10050
10051@item %G
10052Process the @code{libgcc} spec.  This is a spec string for deciding
10053which GCC support library should be included on the command line to the linker.
10054
10055@item %S
10056Process the @code{startfile} spec.  This is a spec for deciding which
10057object files should be the first ones passed to the linker.  Typically
10058this might be a file named @file{crt0.o}.
10059
10060@item %E
10061Process the @code{endfile} spec.  This is a spec string that specifies
10062the last object files that will be passed to the linker.
10063
10064@item %C
10065Process the @code{cpp} spec.  This is used to construct the arguments
10066to be passed to the C preprocessor.
10067
10068@item %1
10069Process the @code{cc1} spec.  This is used to construct the options to be
10070passed to the actual C compiler (@samp{cc1}).
10071
10072@item %2
10073Process the @code{cc1plus} spec.  This is used to construct the options to be
10074passed to the actual C++ compiler (@samp{cc1plus}).
10075
10076@item %*
10077Substitute the variable part of a matched option.  See below.
10078Note that each comma in the substituted string is replaced by
10079a single space.
10080
10081@item %<@code{S}
10082Remove all occurrences of @code{-S} from the command line.  Note---this
10083command is position dependent.  @samp{%} commands in the spec string
10084before this one will see @code{-S}, @samp{%} commands in the spec string
10085after this one will not.
10086
10087@item %:@var{function}(@var{args})
10088Call the named function @var{function}, passing it @var{args}.
10089@var{args} is first processed as a nested spec string, then split
10090into an argument vector in the usual fashion.  The function returns
10091a string which is processed as if it had appeared literally as part
10092of the current spec.
10093
10094The following built-in spec functions are provided:
10095
10096@table @code
10097@item @code{getenv}
10098The @code{getenv} spec function takes two arguments: an environment
10099variable name and a string.  If the environment variable is not
10100defined, a fatal error is issued.  Otherwise, the return value is the
10101value of the environment variable concatenated with the string.  For
10102example, if @env{TOPDIR} is defined as @file{/path/to/top}, then:
10103
10104@smallexample
10105%:getenv(TOPDIR /include)
10106@end smallexample
10107
10108expands to @file{/path/to/top/include}.
10109
10110@item @code{if-exists}
10111The @code{if-exists} spec function takes one argument, an absolute
10112pathname to a file.  If the file exists, @code{if-exists} returns the
10113pathname.  Here is a small example of its usage:
10114
10115@smallexample
10116*startfile:
10117crt0%O%s %:if-exists(crti%O%s) crtbegin%O%s
10118@end smallexample
10119
10120@item @code{if-exists-else}
10121The @code{if-exists-else} spec function is similar to the @code{if-exists}
10122spec function, except that it takes two arguments.  The first argument is
10123an absolute pathname to a file.  If the file exists, @code{if-exists-else}
10124returns the pathname.  If it does not exist, it returns the second argument.
10125This way, @code{if-exists-else} can be used to select one file or another,
10126based on the existence of the first.  Here is a small example of its usage:
10127
10128@smallexample
10129*startfile:
10130crt0%O%s %:if-exists(crti%O%s) \
10131%:if-exists-else(crtbeginT%O%s crtbegin%O%s)
10132@end smallexample
10133
10134@item @code{replace-outfile}
10135The @code{replace-outfile} spec function takes two arguments.  It looks for the
10136first argument in the outfiles array and replaces it with the second argument.  Here
10137is a small example of its usage:
10138
10139@smallexample
10140%@{fgnu-runtime:%:replace-outfile(-lobjc -lobjc-gnu)@}
10141@end smallexample
10142
10143@item @code{remove-outfile}
10144The @code{remove-outfile} spec function takes one argument.  It looks for the
10145first argument in the outfiles array and removes it.  Here is a small example
10146its usage:
10147
10148@smallexample
10149%:remove-outfile(-lm)
10150@end smallexample
10151
10152@item @code{pass-through-libs}
10153The @code{pass-through-libs} spec function takes any number of arguments.  It
10154finds any @option{-l} options and any non-options ending in ".a" (which it
10155assumes are the names of linker input library archive files) and returns a
10156result containing all the found arguments each prepended by
10157@option{-plugin-opt=-pass-through=} and joined by spaces.  This list is
10158intended to be passed to the LTO linker plugin.
10159
10160@smallexample
10161%:pass-through-libs(%G %L %G)
10162@end smallexample
10163
10164@item @code{print-asm-header}
10165The @code{print-asm-header} function takes no arguments and simply
10166prints a banner like:
10167
10168@smallexample
10169Assembler options
10170=================
10171
10172Use "-Wa,OPTION" to pass "OPTION" to the assembler.
10173@end smallexample
10174
10175It is used to separate compiler options from assembler options
10176in the @option{--target-help} output.
10177@end table
10178
10179@item %@{@code{S}@}
10180Substitutes the @code{-S} switch, if that switch was given to GCC@.
10181If that switch was not specified, this substitutes nothing.  Note that
10182the leading dash is omitted when specifying this option, and it is
10183automatically inserted if the substitution is performed.  Thus the spec
10184string @samp{%@{foo@}} would match the command-line option @option{-foo}
10185and would output the command-line option @option{-foo}.
10186
10187@item %W@{@code{S}@}
10188Like %@{@code{S}@} but mark last argument supplied within as a file to be
10189deleted on failure.
10190
10191@item %@{@code{S}*@}
10192Substitutes all the switches specified to GCC whose names start
10193with @code{-S}, but which also take an argument.  This is used for
10194switches like @option{-o}, @option{-D}, @option{-I}, etc.
10195GCC considers @option{-o foo} as being
10196one switch whose names starts with @samp{o}.  %@{o*@} would substitute this
10197text, including the space.  Thus two arguments would be generated.
10198
10199@item %@{@code{S}*&@code{T}*@}
10200Like %@{@code{S}*@}, but preserve order of @code{S} and @code{T} options
10201(the order of @code{S} and @code{T} in the spec is not significant).
10202There can be any number of ampersand-separated variables; for each the
10203wild card is optional.  Useful for CPP as @samp{%@{D*&U*&A*@}}.
10204
10205@item %@{@code{S}:@code{X}@}
10206Substitutes @code{X}, if the @samp{-S} switch was given to GCC@.
10207
10208@item %@{!@code{S}:@code{X}@}
10209Substitutes @code{X}, if the @samp{-S} switch was @emph{not} given to GCC@.
10210
10211@item %@{@code{S}*:@code{X}@}
10212Substitutes @code{X} if one or more switches whose names start with
10213@code{-S} are specified to GCC@.  Normally @code{X} is substituted only
10214once, no matter how many such switches appeared.  However, if @code{%*}
10215appears somewhere in @code{X}, then @code{X} will be substituted once
10216for each matching switch, with the @code{%*} replaced by the part of
10217that switch that matched the @code{*}.
10218
10219@item %@{.@code{S}:@code{X}@}
10220Substitutes @code{X}, if processing a file with suffix @code{S}.
10221
10222@item %@{!.@code{S}:@code{X}@}
10223Substitutes @code{X}, if @emph{not} processing a file with suffix @code{S}.
10224
10225@item %@{,@code{S}:@code{X}@}
10226Substitutes @code{X}, if processing a file for language @code{S}.
10227
10228@item %@{!,@code{S}:@code{X}@}
10229Substitutes @code{X}, if not processing a file for language @code{S}.
10230
10231@item %@{@code{S}|@code{P}:@code{X}@}
10232Substitutes @code{X} if either @code{-S} or @code{-P} was given to
10233GCC@.  This may be combined with @samp{!}, @samp{.}, @samp{,}, and
10234@code{*} sequences as well, although they have a stronger binding than
10235the @samp{|}.  If @code{%*} appears in @code{X}, all of the
10236alternatives must be starred, and only the first matching alternative
10237is substituted.
10238
10239For example, a spec string like this:
10240
10241@smallexample
10242%@{.c:-foo@} %@{!.c:-bar@} %@{.c|d:-baz@} %@{!.c|d:-boggle@}
10243@end smallexample
10244
10245will output the following command-line options from the following input
10246command-line options:
10247
10248@smallexample
10249fred.c        -foo -baz
10250jim.d         -bar -boggle
10251-d fred.c     -foo -baz -boggle
10252-d jim.d      -bar -baz -boggle
10253@end smallexample
10254
10255@item %@{S:X; T:Y; :D@}
10256
10257If @code{S} was given to GCC, substitutes @code{X}; else if @code{T} was
10258given to GCC, substitutes @code{Y}; else substitutes @code{D}.  There can
10259be as many clauses as you need.  This may be combined with @code{.},
10260@code{,}, @code{!}, @code{|}, and @code{*} as needed.
10261
10262
10263@end table
10264
10265The conditional text @code{X} in a %@{@code{S}:@code{X}@} or similar
10266construct may contain other nested @samp{%} constructs or spaces, or
10267even newlines.  They are processed as usual, as described above.
10268Trailing white space in @code{X} is ignored.  White space may also
10269appear anywhere on the left side of the colon in these constructs,
10270except between @code{.} or @code{*} and the corresponding word.
10271
10272The @option{-O}, @option{-f}, @option{-m}, and @option{-W} switches are
10273handled specifically in these constructs.  If another value of
10274@option{-O} or the negated form of a @option{-f}, @option{-m}, or
10275@option{-W} switch is found later in the command line, the earlier
10276switch value is ignored, except with @{@code{S}*@} where @code{S} is
10277just one letter, which passes all matching options.
10278
10279The character @samp{|} at the beginning of the predicate text is used to
10280indicate that a command should be piped to the following command, but
10281only if @option{-pipe} is specified.
10282
10283It is built into GCC which switches take arguments and which do not.
10284(You might think it would be useful to generalize this to allow each
10285compiler's spec to say which switches take arguments.  But this cannot
10286be done in a consistent fashion.  GCC cannot even decide which input
10287files have been specified without knowing which switches take arguments,
10288and it must know which input files to compile in order to tell which
10289compilers to run).
10290
10291GCC also knows implicitly that arguments starting in @option{-l} are to be
10292treated as compiler output files, and passed to the linker in their
10293proper position among the other output files.
10294
10295@c man begin OPTIONS
10296
10297@node Target Options
10298@section Specifying Target Machine and Compiler Version
10299@cindex target options
10300@cindex cross compiling
10301@cindex specifying machine version
10302@cindex specifying compiler version and target machine
10303@cindex compiler version, specifying
10304@cindex target machine, specifying
10305
10306The usual way to run GCC is to run the executable called @command{gcc}, or
10307@command{@var{machine}-gcc} when cross-compiling, or
10308@command{@var{machine}-gcc-@var{version}} to run a version other than the
10309one that was installed last.
10310
10311@node Submodel Options
10312@section Hardware Models and Configurations
10313@cindex submodel options
10314@cindex specifying hardware config
10315@cindex hardware models and configurations, specifying
10316@cindex machine dependent options
10317
10318Each target machine types can have its own
10319special options, starting with @samp{-m}, to choose among various
10320hardware models or configurations---for example, 68010 vs 68020,
10321floating coprocessor or none.  A single installed version of the
10322compiler can compile for any model or configuration, according to the
10323options specified.
10324
10325Some configurations of the compiler also support additional special
10326options, usually for compatibility with other compilers on the same
10327platform.
10328
10329@c This list is ordered alphanumerically by subsection name.
10330@c It should be the same order and spelling as these options are listed
10331@c in Machine Dependent Options
10332
10333@menu
10334* Adapteva Epiphany Options::
10335* ARM Options::
10336* AVR Options::
10337* Blackfin Options::
10338* C6X Options::
10339* CRIS Options::
10340* CR16 Options::
10341* Darwin Options::
10342* DEC Alpha Options::
10343* DEC Alpha/VMS Options::
10344* FR30 Options::
10345* FRV Options::
10346* GNU/Linux Options::
10347* H8/300 Options::
10348* HPPA Options::
10349* i386 and x86-64 Options::
10350* i386 and x86-64 Windows Options::
10351* IA-64 Options::
10352* IA-64/VMS Options::
10353* LM32 Options::
10354* M32C Options::
10355* M32R/D Options::
10356* M680x0 Options::
10357* MCore Options::
10358* MeP Options::
10359* MicroBlaze Options::
10360* MIPS Options::
10361* MMIX Options::
10362* MN10300 Options::
10363* PDP-11 Options::
10364* picoChip Options::
10365* PowerPC Options::
10366* RL78 Options::
10367* RS/6000 and PowerPC Options::
10368* RX Options::
10369* S/390 and zSeries Options::
10370* Score Options::
10371* SH Options::
10372* Solaris 2 Options::
10373* SPARC Options::
10374* SPU Options::
10375* System V Options::
10376* TILE-Gx Options::
10377* TILEPro Options::
10378* V850 Options::
10379* VAX Options::
10380* VxWorks Options::
10381* x86-64 Options::
10382* Xstormy16 Options::
10383* Xtensa Options::
10384* zSeries Options::
10385@end menu
10386
10387@node Adapteva Epiphany Options
10388@subsection Adapteva Epiphany Options
10389
10390These @samp{-m} options are defined for Adapteva Epiphany:
10391
10392@table @gcctabopt
10393@item -mhalf-reg-file
10394@opindex mhalf-reg-file
10395Don't allocate any register in the range @code{r32}@dots{}@code{r63}.
10396That allows code to run on hardware variants that lack these registers.
10397
10398@item -mprefer-short-insn-regs
10399@opindex mprefer-short-insn-regs
10400Preferrentially allocate registers that allow short instruction generation.
10401This can result in increasesd instruction count, so if this reduces or
10402increases code size might vary from case to case.
10403
10404@item -mbranch-cost=@var{num}
10405@opindex mbranch-cost
10406Set the cost of branches to roughly @var{num} ``simple'' instructions.
10407This cost is only a heuristic and is not guaranteed to produce
10408consistent results across releases.
10409
10410@item -mcmove
10411@opindex mcmove
10412Enable the generation of conditional moves.
10413
10414@item -mnops=@var{num}
10415@opindex mnops
10416Emit @var{num} nops before every other generated instruction.
10417
10418@item -mno-soft-cmpsf
10419@opindex mno-soft-cmpsf
10420For single-precision floating-point comparisons, emit an fsub instruction
10421and test the flags.  This is faster than a software comparison, but can
10422get incorrect results in the presence of NaNs, or when two different small
10423numbers are compared such that their difference is calculated as zero.
10424The default is @option{-msoft-cmpsf}, which uses slower, but IEEE-compliant,
10425software comparisons.
10426
10427@item -mstack-offset=@var{num}
10428@opindex mstack-offset
10429Set the offset between the top of the stack and the stack pointer.
10430E.g., a value of 8 means that the eight bytes in the range sp+0@dots{}sp+7
10431can be used by leaf functions without stack allocation.
10432Values other than @samp{8} or @samp{16} are untested and unlikely to work.
10433Note also that this option changes the ABI, compiling a program with a
10434different stack offset than the libraries have been compiled with
10435will generally not work.
10436This option can be useful if you want to evaluate if a different stack
10437offset would give you better code, but to actually use a different stack
10438offset to build working programs, it is recommended to configure the
10439toolchain with the appropriate @samp{--with-stack-offset=@var{num}} option.
10440
10441@item -mno-round-nearest
10442@opindex mno-round-nearest
10443Make the scheduler assume that the rounding mode has been set to
10444truncating.  The default is @option{-mround-nearest}.
10445
10446@item -mlong-calls
10447@opindex mlong-calls
10448If not otherwise specified by an attribute, assume all calls might be beyond
10449the offset range of the b / bl instructions, and therefore load the
10450function address into a register before performing a (otherwise direct) call.
10451This is the default.
10452
10453@item -mshort-calls
10454@opindex short-calls
10455If not otherwise specified by an attribute, assume all direct calls are
10456in the range of the b / bl instructions, so use these instructions
10457for direct calls.  The default is @option{-mlong-calls}.
10458
10459@item -msmall16
10460@opindex msmall16
10461Assume addresses can be loaded as 16-bit unsigned values.  This does not
10462apply to function addresses for which @option{-mlong-calls} semantics
10463are in effect.
10464
10465@item -mfp-mode=@var{mode}
10466@opindex mfp-mode
10467Set the prevailing mode of the floating-point unit.
10468This determines the floating-point mode that is provided and expected
10469at function call and return time.  Making this mode match the mode you
10470predominantly need at function start can make your programs smaller and
10471faster by avoiding unnecessary mode switches.
10472
10473@var{mode} can be set to one the following values:
10474
10475@table @samp
10476@item caller
10477Any mode at function entry is valid, and retained or restored when
10478the function returns, and when it calls other functions.
10479This mode is useful for compiling libraries or other compilation units
10480you might want to incorporate into different programs with different
10481prevailing FPU modes, and the convenience of being able to use a single
10482object file outweighs the size and speed overhead for any extra
10483mode switching that might be needed, compared with what would be needed
10484with a more specific choice of prevailing FPU mode.
10485
10486@item truncate
10487This is the mode used for floating-point calculations with
10488truncating (i.e.@: round towards zero) rounding mode.  That includes
10489conversion from floating point to integer.
10490
10491@item round-nearest
10492This is the mode used for floating-point calculations with
10493round-to-nearest-or-even rounding mode.
10494
10495@item int
10496This is the mode used to perform integer calculations in the FPU, e.g.@:
10497integer multiply, or integer multiply-and-accumulate.
10498@end table
10499
10500The default is @option{-mfp-mode=caller}
10501
10502@item -mnosplit-lohi
10503@opindex mnosplit-lohi
10504@item -mno-postinc
10505@opindex mno-postinc
10506@item -mno-postmodify
10507@opindex mno-postmodify
10508Code generation tweaks that disable, respectively, splitting of 32-bit
10509loads, generation of post-increment addresses, and generation of
10510post-modify addresses.  The defaults are @option{msplit-lohi},
10511@option{-mpost-inc}, and @option{-mpost-modify}.
10512
10513@item -mnovect-double
10514@opindex mno-vect-double
10515Change the preferred SIMD mode to SImode.  The default is
10516@option{-mvect-double}, which uses DImode as preferred SIMD mode.
10517
10518@item -max-vect-align=@var{num}
10519@opindex max-vect-align
10520The maximum alignment for SIMD vector mode types.
10521@var{num} may be 4 or 8.  The default is 8.
10522Note that this is an ABI change, even though many library function
10523interfaces will be unaffected, if they don't use SIMD vector modes
10524in places where they affect size and/or alignment of relevant types.
10525
10526@item -msplit-vecmove-early
10527@opindex msplit-vecmove-early
10528Split vector moves into single word moves before reload.  In theory this
10529could give better register allocation, but so far the reverse seems to be
10530generally the case.
10531
10532@item -m1reg-@var{reg}
10533@opindex m1reg-
10534Specify a register to hold the constant @minus{}1, which makes loading small negative
10535constants and certain bitmasks faster.
10536Allowable values for reg are r43 and r63, which specify to use that register
10537as a fixed register, and none, which means that no register is used for this
10538purpose.  The default is @option{-m1reg-none}.
10539
10540@end table
10541
10542@node ARM Options
10543@subsection ARM Options
10544@cindex ARM options
10545
10546These @samp{-m} options are defined for Advanced RISC Machines (ARM)
10547architectures:
10548
10549@table @gcctabopt
10550@item -mabi=@var{name}
10551@opindex mabi
10552Generate code for the specified ABI@.  Permissible values are: @samp{apcs-gnu},
10553@samp{atpcs}, @samp{aapcs}, @samp{aapcs-linux} and @samp{iwmmxt}.
10554
10555@item -mapcs-frame
10556@opindex mapcs-frame
10557Generate a stack frame that is compliant with the ARM Procedure Call
10558Standard for all functions, even if this is not strictly necessary for
10559correct execution of the code.  Specifying @option{-fomit-frame-pointer}
10560with this option will cause the stack frames not to be generated for
10561leaf functions.  The default is @option{-mno-apcs-frame}.
10562
10563@item -mapcs
10564@opindex mapcs
10565This is a synonym for @option{-mapcs-frame}.
10566
10567@ignore
10568@c not currently implemented
10569@item -mapcs-stack-check
10570@opindex mapcs-stack-check
10571Generate code to check the amount of stack space available upon entry to
10572every function (that actually uses some stack space).  If there is
10573insufficient space available then either the function
10574@samp{__rt_stkovf_split_small} or @samp{__rt_stkovf_split_big} will be
10575called, depending upon the amount of stack space required.  The runtime
10576system is required to provide these functions.  The default is
10577@option{-mno-apcs-stack-check}, since this produces smaller code.
10578
10579@c not currently implemented
10580@item -mapcs-float
10581@opindex mapcs-float
10582Pass floating-point arguments using the floating-point registers.  This is
10583one of the variants of the APCS@.  This option is recommended if the
10584target hardware has a floating-point unit or if a lot of floating-point
10585arithmetic is going to be performed by the code.  The default is
10586@option{-mno-apcs-float}, since integer only code is slightly increased in
10587size if @option{-mapcs-float} is used.
10588
10589@c not currently implemented
10590@item -mapcs-reentrant
10591@opindex mapcs-reentrant
10592Generate reentrant, position independent code.  The default is
10593@option{-mno-apcs-reentrant}.
10594@end ignore
10595
10596@item -mthumb-interwork
10597@opindex mthumb-interwork
10598Generate code that supports calling between the ARM and Thumb
10599instruction sets.  Without this option, on pre-v5 architectures, the
10600two instruction sets cannot be reliably used inside one program.  The
10601default is @option{-mno-thumb-interwork}, since slightly larger code
10602is generated when @option{-mthumb-interwork} is specified.  In AAPCS
10603configurations this option is meaningless.
10604
10605@item -mno-sched-prolog
10606@opindex mno-sched-prolog
10607Prevent the reordering of instructions in the function prologue, or the
10608merging of those instruction with the instructions in the function's
10609body.  This means that all functions will start with a recognizable set
10610of instructions (or in fact one of a choice from a small set of
10611different function prologues), and this information can be used to
10612locate the start if functions inside an executable piece of code.  The
10613default is @option{-msched-prolog}.
10614
10615@item -mfloat-abi=@var{name}
10616@opindex mfloat-abi
10617Specifies which floating-point ABI to use.  Permissible values
10618are: @samp{soft}, @samp{softfp} and @samp{hard}.
10619
10620Specifying @samp{soft} causes GCC to generate output containing
10621library calls for floating-point operations.
10622@samp{softfp} allows the generation of code using hardware floating-point
10623instructions, but still uses the soft-float calling conventions.
10624@samp{hard} allows generation of floating-point instructions
10625and uses FPU-specific calling conventions.
10626
10627The default depends on the specific target configuration.  Note that
10628the hard-float and soft-float ABIs are not link-compatible; you must
10629compile your entire program with the same ABI, and link with a
10630compatible set of libraries.
10631
10632@item -mlittle-endian
10633@opindex mlittle-endian
10634Generate code for a processor running in little-endian mode.  This is
10635the default for all standard configurations.
10636
10637@item -mbig-endian
10638@opindex mbig-endian
10639Generate code for a processor running in big-endian mode; the default is
10640to compile code for a little-endian processor.
10641
10642@item -mwords-little-endian
10643@opindex mwords-little-endian
10644This option only applies when generating code for big-endian processors.
10645Generate code for a little-endian word order but a big-endian byte
10646order.  That is, a byte order of the form @samp{32107654}.  Note: this
10647option should only be used if you require compatibility with code for
10648big-endian ARM processors generated by versions of the compiler prior to
106492.8.  This option is now deprecated.
10650
10651@item -march=@var{name}
10652@opindex march
10653This specifies the name of the target ARM architecture.  GCC uses this
10654name to determine what kind of instructions it can emit when generating
10655assembly code.  This option can be used in conjunction with or instead
10656of the @option{-mcpu=} option.  Permissible names are: @samp{armv2},
10657@samp{armv2a}, @samp{armv3}, @samp{armv3m}, @samp{armv4}, @samp{armv4t},
10658@samp{armv5}, @samp{armv5t}, @samp{armv5e}, @samp{armv5te},
10659@samp{armv6}, @samp{armv6j},
10660@samp{armv6t2}, @samp{armv6z}, @samp{armv6zk}, @samp{armv6-m},
10661@samp{armv7}, @samp{armv7-a}, @samp{armv7-r}, @samp{armv7-m}, @samp{armv7e-m},
10662@samp{iwmmxt}, @samp{iwmmxt2}, @samp{ep9312}.
10663
10664@option{-march=native} causes the compiler to auto-detect the architecture
10665of the build computer.  At present, this feature is only supported on
10666Linux, and not all architectures are recognized.  If the auto-detect is
10667unsuccessful the option has no effect.
10668
10669@item -mtune=@var{name}
10670@opindex mtune
10671This option specifies the name of the target ARM processor for
10672which GCC should tune the performance of the code.
10673For some ARM implementations better performance can be obtained by using
10674this option.
10675Permissible names are: @samp{arm2}, @samp{arm250},
10676@samp{arm3}, @samp{arm6}, @samp{arm60}, @samp{arm600}, @samp{arm610},
10677@samp{arm620}, @samp{arm7}, @samp{arm7m}, @samp{arm7d}, @samp{arm7dm},
10678@samp{arm7di}, @samp{arm7dmi}, @samp{arm70}, @samp{arm700},
10679@samp{arm700i}, @samp{arm710}, @samp{arm710c}, @samp{arm7100},
10680@samp{arm720},
10681@samp{arm7500}, @samp{arm7500fe}, @samp{arm7tdmi}, @samp{arm7tdmi-s},
10682@samp{arm710t}, @samp{arm720t}, @samp{arm740t},
10683@samp{strongarm}, @samp{strongarm110}, @samp{strongarm1100},
10684@samp{strongarm1110},
10685@samp{arm8}, @samp{arm810}, @samp{arm9}, @samp{arm9e}, @samp{arm920},
10686@samp{arm920t}, @samp{arm922t}, @samp{arm946e-s}, @samp{arm966e-s},
10687@samp{arm968e-s}, @samp{arm926ej-s}, @samp{arm940t}, @samp{arm9tdmi},
10688@samp{arm10tdmi}, @samp{arm1020t}, @samp{arm1026ej-s},
10689@samp{arm10e}, @samp{arm1020e}, @samp{arm1022e},
10690@samp{arm1136j-s}, @samp{arm1136jf-s}, @samp{mpcore}, @samp{mpcorenovfp},
10691@samp{arm1156t2-s}, @samp{arm1156t2f-s}, @samp{arm1176jz-s}, @samp{arm1176jzf-s},
10692@samp{cortex-a5}, @samp{cortex-a7}, @samp{cortex-a8}, @samp{cortex-a9},
10693@samp{cortex-a15}, @samp{cortex-r4}, @samp{cortex-r4f}, @samp{cortex-r5},
10694@samp{cortex-m4}, @samp{cortex-m3},
10695@samp{cortex-m1},
10696@samp{cortex-m0},
10697@samp{xscale}, @samp{iwmmxt}, @samp{iwmmxt2}, @samp{ep9312},
10698@samp{fa526}, @samp{fa626},
10699@samp{fa606te}, @samp{fa626te}, @samp{fmp626}, @samp{fa726te}.
10700
10701@option{-mtune=generic-@var{arch}} specifies that GCC should tune the
10702performance for a blend of processors within architecture @var{arch}.
10703The aim is to generate code that run well on the current most popular
10704processors, balancing between optimizations that benefit some CPUs in the
10705range, and avoiding performance pitfalls of other CPUs.  The effects of
10706this option may change in future GCC versions as CPU models come and go.
10707
10708@option{-mtune=native} causes the compiler to auto-detect the CPU
10709of the build computer.  At present, this feature is only supported on
10710Linux, and not all architectures are recognized.  If the auto-detect is
10711unsuccessful the option has no effect.
10712
10713@item -mcpu=@var{name}
10714@opindex mcpu
10715This specifies the name of the target ARM processor.  GCC uses this name
10716to derive the name of the target ARM architecture (as if specified
10717by @option{-march}) and the ARM processor type for which to tune for
10718performance (as if specified by @option{-mtune}).  Where this option
10719is used in conjunction with @option{-march} or @option{-mtune},
10720those options take precedence over the appropriate part of this option.
10721
10722Permissible names for this option are the same as those for
10723@option{-mtune}.
10724
10725@option{-mcpu=generic-@var{arch}} is also permissible, and is
10726equivalent to @option{-march=@var{arch} -mtune=generic-@var{arch}}.
10727See @option{-mtune} for more information.
10728
10729@option{-mcpu=native} causes the compiler to auto-detect the CPU
10730of the build computer.  At present, this feature is only supported on
10731Linux, and not all architectures are recognized.  If the auto-detect is
10732unsuccessful the option has no effect.
10733
10734@item -mfpu=@var{name}
10735@itemx -mfpe=@var{number}
10736@itemx -mfp=@var{number}
10737@opindex mfpu
10738@opindex mfpe
10739@opindex mfp
10740This specifies what floating-point hardware (or hardware emulation) is
10741available on the target.  Permissible names are: @samp{fpa}, @samp{fpe2},
10742@samp{fpe3}, @samp{maverick}, @samp{vfp}, @samp{vfpv3}, @samp{vfpv3-fp16},
10743@samp{vfpv3-d16}, @samp{vfpv3-d16-fp16}, @samp{vfpv3xd}, @samp{vfpv3xd-fp16},
10744@samp{neon}, @samp{neon-fp16}, @samp{vfpv4}, @samp{vfpv4-d16},
10745@samp{fpv4-sp-d16} and @samp{neon-vfpv4}.
10746@option{-mfp} and @option{-mfpe} are synonyms for
10747@option{-mfpu}=@samp{fpe}@var{number}, for compatibility with older versions
10748of GCC@.
10749
10750If @option{-msoft-float} is specified this specifies the format of
10751floating-point values.
10752
10753If the selected floating-point hardware includes the NEON extension
10754(e.g. @option{-mfpu}=@samp{neon}), note that floating-point
10755operations will not be used by GCC's auto-vectorization pass unless
10756@option{-funsafe-math-optimizations} is also specified.  This is
10757because NEON hardware does not fully implement the IEEE 754 standard for
10758floating-point arithmetic (in particular denormal values are treated as
10759zero), so the use of NEON instructions may lead to a loss of precision.
10760
10761@item -mfp16-format=@var{name}
10762@opindex mfp16-format
10763Specify the format of the @code{__fp16} half-precision floating-point type.
10764Permissible names are @samp{none}, @samp{ieee}, and @samp{alternative};
10765the default is @samp{none}, in which case the @code{__fp16} type is not
10766defined.  @xref{Half-Precision}, for more information.
10767
10768@item -mstructure-size-boundary=@var{n}
10769@opindex mstructure-size-boundary
10770The size of all structures and unions will be rounded up to a multiple
10771of the number of bits set by this option.  Permissible values are 8, 32
10772and 64.  The default value varies for different toolchains.  For the COFF
10773targeted toolchain the default value is 8.  A value of 64 is only allowed
10774if the underlying ABI supports it.
10775
10776Specifying the larger number can produce faster, more efficient code, but
10777can also increase the size of the program.  Different values are potentially
10778incompatible.  Code compiled with one value cannot necessarily expect to
10779work with code or libraries compiled with another value, if they exchange
10780information using structures or unions.
10781
10782@item -mabort-on-noreturn
10783@opindex mabort-on-noreturn
10784Generate a call to the function @code{abort} at the end of a
10785@code{noreturn} function.  It will be executed if the function tries to
10786return.
10787
10788@item -mlong-calls
10789@itemx -mno-long-calls
10790@opindex mlong-calls
10791@opindex mno-long-calls
10792Tells the compiler to perform function calls by first loading the
10793address of the function into a register and then performing a subroutine
10794call on this register.  This switch is needed if the target function
10795will lie outside of the 64 megabyte addressing range of the offset based
10796version of subroutine call instruction.
10797
10798Even if this switch is enabled, not all function calls will be turned
10799into long calls.  The heuristic is that static functions, functions
10800that have the @samp{short-call} attribute, functions that are inside
10801the scope of a @samp{#pragma no_long_calls} directive and functions whose
10802definitions have already been compiled within the current compilation
10803unit, will not be turned into long calls.  The exception to this rule is
10804that weak function definitions, functions with the @samp{long-call}
10805attribute or the @samp{section} attribute, and functions that are within
10806the scope of a @samp{#pragma long_calls} directive, will always be
10807turned into long calls.
10808
10809This feature is not enabled by default.  Specifying
10810@option{-mno-long-calls} will restore the default behavior, as will
10811placing the function calls within the scope of a @samp{#pragma
10812long_calls_off} directive.  Note these switches have no effect on how
10813the compiler generates code to handle function calls via function
10814pointers.
10815
10816@item -msingle-pic-base
10817@opindex msingle-pic-base
10818Treat the register used for PIC addressing as read-only, rather than
10819loading it in the prologue for each function.  The runtime system is
10820responsible for initializing this register with an appropriate value
10821before execution begins.
10822
10823@item -mpic-register=@var{reg}
10824@opindex mpic-register
10825Specify the register to be used for PIC addressing.  The default is R10
10826unless stack-checking is enabled, when R9 is used.
10827
10828@item -mcirrus-fix-invalid-insns
10829@opindex mcirrus-fix-invalid-insns
10830@opindex mno-cirrus-fix-invalid-insns
10831Insert NOPs into the instruction stream to in order to work around
10832problems with invalid Maverick instruction combinations.  This option
10833is only valid if the @option{-mcpu=ep9312} option has been used to
10834enable generation of instructions for the Cirrus Maverick floating-point
10835co-processor.  This option is not enabled by default, since the
10836problem is only present in older Maverick implementations.  The default
10837can be re-enabled by use of the @option{-mno-cirrus-fix-invalid-insns}
10838switch.
10839
10840@item -mpoke-function-name
10841@opindex mpoke-function-name
10842Write the name of each function into the text section, directly
10843preceding the function prologue.  The generated code is similar to this:
10844
10845@smallexample
10846     t0
10847         .ascii "arm_poke_function_name", 0
10848         .align
10849     t1
10850         .word 0xff000000 + (t1 - t0)
10851     arm_poke_function_name
10852         mov     ip, sp
10853         stmfd   sp!, @{fp, ip, lr, pc@}
10854         sub     fp, ip, #4
10855@end smallexample
10856
10857When performing a stack backtrace, code can inspect the value of
10858@code{pc} stored at @code{fp + 0}.  If the trace function then looks at
10859location @code{pc - 12} and the top 8 bits are set, then we know that
10860there is a function name embedded immediately preceding this location
10861and has length @code{((pc[-3]) & 0xff000000)}.
10862
10863@item -mthumb
10864@itemx -marm
10865@opindex marm
10866@opindex mthumb
10867
10868Select between generating code that executes in ARM and Thumb
10869states.  The default for most configurations is to generate code
10870that executes in ARM state, but the default can be changed by
10871configuring GCC with the @option{--with-mode=}@var{state}
10872configure option.
10873
10874@item -mtpcs-frame
10875@opindex mtpcs-frame
10876Generate a stack frame that is compliant with the Thumb Procedure Call
10877Standard for all non-leaf functions.  (A leaf function is one that does
10878not call any other functions.)  The default is @option{-mno-tpcs-frame}.
10879
10880@item -mtpcs-leaf-frame
10881@opindex mtpcs-leaf-frame
10882Generate a stack frame that is compliant with the Thumb Procedure Call
10883Standard for all leaf functions.  (A leaf function is one that does
10884not call any other functions.)  The default is @option{-mno-apcs-leaf-frame}.
10885
10886@item -mcallee-super-interworking
10887@opindex mcallee-super-interworking
10888Gives all externally visible functions in the file being compiled an ARM
10889instruction set header which switches to Thumb mode before executing the
10890rest of the function.  This allows these functions to be called from
10891non-interworking code.  This option is not valid in AAPCS configurations
10892because interworking is enabled by default.
10893
10894@item -mcaller-super-interworking
10895@opindex mcaller-super-interworking
10896Allows calls via function pointers (including virtual functions) to
10897execute correctly regardless of whether the target code has been
10898compiled for interworking or not.  There is a small overhead in the cost
10899of executing a function pointer if this option is enabled.  This option
10900is not valid in AAPCS configurations because interworking is enabled
10901by default.
10902
10903@item -mtp=@var{name}
10904@opindex mtp
10905Specify the access model for the thread local storage pointer.  The valid
10906models are @option{soft}, which generates calls to @code{__aeabi_read_tp},
10907@option{cp15}, which fetches the thread pointer from @code{cp15} directly
10908(supported in the arm6k architecture), and @option{auto}, which uses the
10909best available method for the selected processor.  The default setting is
10910@option{auto}.
10911
10912@item -mtls-dialect=@var{dialect}
10913@opindex mtls-dialect
10914Specify the dialect to use for accessing thread local storage.  Two
10915dialects are supported --- @option{gnu} and @option{gnu2}.  The
10916@option{gnu} dialect selects the original GNU scheme for supporting
10917local and global dynamic TLS models.  The @option{gnu2} dialect
10918selects the GNU descriptor scheme, which provides better performance
10919for shared libraries.  The GNU descriptor scheme is compatible with
10920the original scheme, but does require new assembler, linker and
10921library support.  Initial and local exec TLS models are unaffected by
10922this option and always use the original scheme.
10923
10924@item -mword-relocations
10925@opindex mword-relocations
10926Only generate absolute relocations on word-sized values (i.e. R_ARM_ABS32).
10927This is enabled by default on targets (uClinux, SymbianOS) where the runtime
10928loader imposes this restriction, and when @option{-fpic} or @option{-fPIC}
10929is specified.
10930
10931@item -mfix-cortex-m3-ldrd
10932@opindex mfix-cortex-m3-ldrd
10933Some Cortex-M3 cores can cause data corruption when @code{ldrd} instructions
10934with overlapping destination and base registers are used.  This option avoids
10935generating these instructions.  This option is enabled by default when
10936@option{-mcpu=cortex-m3} is specified.
10937
10938@item -munaligned-access
10939@itemx -mno-unaligned-access
10940@opindex munaligned-access
10941@opindex mno-unaligned-access
10942Enables (or disables) reading and writing of 16- and 32- bit values
10943from addresses that are not 16- or 32- bit aligned.  By default
10944unaligned access is disabled for all pre-ARMv6 and all ARMv6-M
10945architectures, and enabled for all other architectures.  If unaligned
10946access is not enabled then words in packed data structures will be
10947accessed a byte at a time.
10948
10949The ARM attribute @code{Tag_CPU_unaligned_access} will be set in the
10950generated object file to either true or false, depending upon the
10951setting of this option.  If unaligned access is enabled then the
10952preprocessor symbol @code{__ARM_FEATURE_UNALIGNED} will also be
10953defined.
10954
10955@end table
10956
10957@node AVR Options
10958@subsection AVR Options
10959@cindex AVR Options
10960
10961@table @gcctabopt
10962@item -mmcu=@var{mcu}
10963@opindex mmcu
10964Specify Atmel AVR instruction set architectures (ISA) or MCU type.
10965
10966The default for this option is@tie{}@code{avr2}.
10967
10968GCC supports the following AVR devices and ISAs:
10969
10970@table @code
10971
10972@item avr2
10973``Classic'' devices with up to 8@tie{}KiB of program memory.
10974@*@var{mcu}@tie{}= @code{attiny22}, @code{attiny26}, @code{at90c8534},
10975@code{at90s2313}, @code{at90s2323}, @code{at90s2333},
10976@code{at90s2343}, @code{at90s4414}, @code{at90s4433},
10977@code{at90s4434}, @code{at90s8515}, @code{at90s8535}.
10978
10979@item avr25
10980``Classic'' devices with up to 8@tie{}KiB of program memory and with
10981the @code{MOVW} instruction.
10982@*@var{mcu}@tie{}= @code{ata6289}, @code{attiny13}, @code{attiny13a},
10983@code{attiny2313}, @code{attiny2313a}, @code{attiny24},
10984@code{attiny24a}, @code{attiny25}, @code{attiny261},
10985@code{attiny261a}, @code{attiny43u}, @code{attiny4313},
10986@code{attiny44}, @code{attiny44a}, @code{attiny45}, @code{attiny461},
10987@code{attiny461a}, @code{attiny48}, @code{attiny84}, @code{attiny84a},
10988@code{attiny85}, @code{attiny861}, @code{attiny861a}, @code{attiny87},
10989@code{attiny88}, @code{at86rf401}.
10990
10991@item avr3
10992``Classic'' devices with 16@tie{}KiB up to 64@tie{}KiB of  program memory.
10993@*@var{mcu}@tie{}= @code{at43usb355}, @code{at76c711}.
10994
10995@item avr31
10996``Classic'' devices with 128@tie{}KiB of program memory.
10997@*@var{mcu}@tie{}= @code{atmega103}, @code{at43usb320}.
10998
10999@item avr35
11000``Classic'' devices with 16@tie{}KiB up to 64@tie{}KiB of program
11001memory and with the @code{MOVW} instruction.
11002@*@var{mcu}@tie{}= @code{atmega16u2}, @code{atmega32u2},
11003@code{atmega8u2}, @code{attiny167}, @code{at90usb162},
11004@code{at90usb82}.
11005
11006@item avr4
11007``Enhanced'' devices with up to 8@tie{}KiB of program memory.
11008@*@var{mcu}@tie{}= @code{atmega48}, @code{atmega48a},
11009@code{atmega48p}, @code{atmega8}, @code{atmega8hva},
11010@code{atmega8515}, @code{atmega8535}, @code{atmega88},
11011@code{atmega88a}, @code{atmega88p}, @code{atmega88pa},
11012@code{at90pwm1}, @code{at90pwm2}, @code{at90pwm2b}, @code{at90pwm3},
11013@code{at90pwm3b}, @code{at90pwm81}.
11014
11015@item avr5
11016``Enhanced'' devices with 16@tie{}KiB up to 64@tie{}KiB of program memory.
11017@*@var{mcu}@tie{}= @code{atmega16}, @code{atmega16a},
11018@code{atmega16hva}, @code{atmega16hva2}, @code{atmega16hvb},
11019@code{atmega16m1}, @code{atmega16u4}, @code{atmega161},
11020@code{atmega162}, @code{atmega163}, @code{atmega164a},
11021@code{atmega164p}, @code{atmega165}, @code{atmega165a},
11022@code{atmega165p}, @code{atmega168}, @code{atmega168a},
11023@code{atmega168p}, @code{atmega169}, @code{atmega169a},
11024@code{atmega169p}, @code{atmega169pa}, @code{atmega32},
11025@code{atmega32c1}, @code{atmega32hvb}, @code{atmega32m1},
11026@code{atmega32u4}, @code{atmega32u6}, @code{atmega323},
11027@code{atmega324a}, @code{atmega324p}, @code{atmega324pa},
11028@code{atmega325}, @code{atmega325a}, @code{atmega325p},
11029@code{atmega3250}, @code{atmega3250a}, @code{atmega3250p},
11030@code{atmega328}, @code{atmega328p}, @code{atmega329},
11031@code{atmega329a}, @code{atmega329p}, @code{atmega329pa},
11032@code{atmega3290}, @code{atmega3290a}, @code{atmega3290p},
11033@code{atmega406}, @code{atmega64}, @code{atmega64c1},
11034@code{atmega64hve}, @code{atmega64m1}, @code{atmega640},
11035@code{atmega644}, @code{atmega644a}, @code{atmega644p},
11036@code{atmega644pa}, @code{atmega645}, @code{atmega645a},
11037@code{atmega645p}, @code{atmega6450}, @code{atmega6450a},
11038@code{atmega6450p}, @code{atmega649}, @code{atmega649a},
11039@code{atmega649p}, @code{atmega6490}, @code{at90can32},
11040@code{at90can64}, @code{at90pwm216}, @code{at90pwm316},
11041@code{at90scr100}, @code{at90usb646}, @code{at90usb647}, @code{at94k},
11042@code{m3000}.
11043
11044@item avr51
11045``Enhanced'' devices with 128@tie{}KiB of program memory.
11046@*@var{mcu}@tie{}= @code{atmega128}, @code{atmega128rfa1},
11047@code{atmega1280}, @code{atmega1281}, @code{atmega1284p},
11048@code{at90can128}, @code{at90usb1286}, @code{at90usb1287}.
11049
11050@item avr6
11051``Enhanced'' devices with 3-byte PC, i.e.@: with more than
11052128@tie{}KiB of program memory.
11053@*@var{mcu}@tie{}= @code{atmega2560}, @code{atmega2561}.
11054
11055@item avrxmega2
11056``XMEGA'' devices with more than 8@tie{}KiB and up to 64@tie{}KiB of
11057program memory.
11058@*@var{mcu}@tie{}= @code{atxmega16a4}, @code{atxmega16d4},
11059@code{atxmega16x1}, @code{atxmega32a4}, @code{atxmega32d4},
11060@code{atxmega32x1}.
11061
11062@item avrxmega4
11063``XMEGA'' devices with more than 64@tie{}KiB and up to 128@tie{}KiB of
11064program memory.
11065@*@var{mcu}@tie{}= @code{atxmega64a3}, @code{atxmega64d3}.
11066
11067@item avrxmega5
11068``XMEGA'' devices with more than 64@tie{}KiB and up to 128@tie{}KiB of
11069program memory and more than 64@tie{}KiB of RAM.
11070@*@var{mcu}@tie{}= @code{atxmega64a1}, @code{atxmega64a1u}.
11071
11072@item avrxmega6
11073``XMEGA'' devices with more than 128@tie{}KiB of program memory.
11074@*@var{mcu}@tie{}= @code{atxmega128a3}, @code{atxmega128d3},
11075@code{atxmega192a3}, @code{atxmega192d3}, @code{atxmega256a3},
11076@code{atxmega256a3b}, @code{atxmega256a3bu}, @code{atxmega256d3}.
11077
11078@item avrxmega7
11079``XMEGA'' devices with more than 128@tie{}KiB of program memory and
11080more than 64@tie{}KiB of RAM.
11081@*@var{mcu}@tie{}= @code{atxmega128a1}, @code{atxmega128a1u}.
11082
11083@item avr1
11084This ISA is implemented by the minimal AVR core and supported for
11085assembler only.
11086@*@var{mcu}@tie{}= @code{attiny11}, @code{attiny12}, @code{attiny15},
11087@code{attiny28}, @code{at90s1200}.
11088
11089@end table
11090
11091@item -maccumulate-args
11092@opindex maccumulate-args
11093Accumulate outgoing function arguments and acquire/release the needed
11094stack space for outgoing function arguments once in function
11095prologue/epilogue.  Without this option, outgoing arguments are pushed
11096before calling a function and popped afterwards.
11097
11098Popping the arguments after the function call can be expensive on
11099AVR so that accumulating the stack space might lead to smaller
11100executables because arguments need not to be removed from the
11101stack after such a function call.
11102
11103This option can lead to reduced code size for functions that perform
11104several calls to functions that get their arguments on the stack like
11105calls to printf-like functions.
11106
11107@item -mbranch-cost=@var{cost}
11108@opindex mbranch-cost
11109Set the branch costs for conditional branch instructions to
11110@var{cost}.  Reasonable values for @var{cost} are small, non-negative
11111integers. The default branch cost is 0.
11112
11113@item -mcall-prologues
11114@opindex mcall-prologues
11115Functions prologues/epilogues are expanded as calls to appropriate
11116subroutines.  Code size is smaller.
11117
11118@item -mint8
11119@opindex mint8
11120Assume @code{int} to be 8-bit integer.  This affects the sizes of all types: a
11121@code{char} is 1 byte, an @code{int} is 1 byte, a @code{long} is 2 bytes,
11122and @code{long long} is 4 bytes.  Please note that this option does not
11123conform to the C standards, but it results in smaller code
11124size.
11125
11126@item -mno-interrupts
11127@opindex mno-interrupts
11128Generated code is not compatible with hardware interrupts.
11129Code size is smaller.
11130
11131@item -mrelax
11132@opindex mrelax
11133Try to replace @code{CALL} resp.@: @code{JMP} instruction by the shorter
11134@code{RCALL} resp.@: @code{RJMP} instruction if applicable.
11135Setting @code{-mrelax} just adds the @code{--relax} option to the
11136linker command line when the linker is called.
11137
11138Jump relaxing is performed by the linker because jump offsets are not
11139known before code is located. Therefore, the assembler code generated by the
11140compiler is the same, but the instructions in the executable may
11141differ from instructions in the assembler code.
11142
11143Relaxing must be turned on if linker stubs are needed, see the
11144section on @code{EIND} and linker stubs below.
11145
11146@item -mshort-calls
11147@opindex mshort-calls
11148This option has been deprecated and will be removed in GCC 4.8.
11149See @code{-mrelax} for a replacement.
11150
11151Use @code{RCALL}/@code{RJMP} instructions even on devices with
1115216@tie{}KiB or more of program memory, i.e.@: on devices that
11153have the @code{CALL} and @code{JMP} instructions.
11154
11155@item -msp8
11156@opindex msp8
11157Treat the stack pointer register as an 8-bit register,
11158i.e.@: assume the high byte of the stack pointer is zero.
11159In general, you don't need to set this option by hand.
11160
11161This option is used internally by the compiler to select and
11162build multilibs for architectures @code{avr2} and @code{avr25}.
11163These architectures mix devices with and without @code{SPH}.
11164For any setting other than @code{-mmcu=avr2} or @code{-mmcu=avr25}
11165the compiler driver will add or remove this option from the compiler
11166proper's command line, because the compiler then knows if the device
11167or architecture has an 8-bit stack pointer and thus no @code{SPH}
11168register or not.
11169
11170@item -mstrict-X
11171@opindex mstrict-X
11172Use address register @code{X} in a way proposed by the hardware.  This means
11173that @code{X} is only used in indirect, post-increment or
11174pre-decrement addressing.
11175
11176Without this option, the @code{X} register may be used in the same way
11177as @code{Y} or @code{Z} which then is emulated by additional
11178instructions.
11179For example, loading a value with @code{X+const} addressing with a
11180small non-negative @code{const < 64} to a register @var{Rn} is
11181performed as
11182
11183@example
11184adiw r26, const   ; X += const
11185ld   @var{Rn}, X        ; @var{Rn} = *X
11186sbiw r26, const   ; X -= const
11187@end example
11188
11189@item -mtiny-stack
11190@opindex mtiny-stack
11191Only change the lower 8@tie{}bits of the stack pointer.
11192@end table
11193
11194@subsubsection @code{EIND} and Devices with more than 128 Ki Bytes of Flash
11195@cindex @code{EIND}
11196Pointers in the implementation are 16@tie{}bits wide.
11197The address of a function or label is represented as word address so
11198that indirect jumps and calls can target any code address in the
11199range of 64@tie{}Ki words.
11200
11201In order to facilitate indirect jump on devices with more than 128@tie{}Ki
11202bytes of program memory space, there is a special function register called
11203@code{EIND} that serves as most significant part of the target address
11204when @code{EICALL} or @code{EIJMP} instructions are used.
11205
11206Indirect jumps and calls on these devices are handled as follows by
11207the compiler and are subject to some limitations:
11208
11209@itemize @bullet
11210
11211@item
11212The compiler never sets @code{EIND}.
11213
11214@item
11215The compiler uses @code{EIND} implicitely in @code{EICALL}/@code{EIJMP}
11216instructions or might read @code{EIND} directly in order to emulate an
11217indirect call/jump by means of a @code{RET} instruction.
11218
11219@item
11220The compiler assumes that @code{EIND} never changes during the startup
11221code or during the application. In particular, @code{EIND} is not
11222saved/restored in function or interrupt service routine
11223prologue/epilogue.
11224
11225@item
11226For indirect calls to functions and computed goto, the linker
11227generates @emph{stubs}. Stubs are jump pads sometimes also called
11228@emph{trampolines}. Thus, the indirect call/jump jumps to such a stub.
11229The stub contains a direct jump to the desired address.
11230
11231@item
11232Linker relaxation must be turned on so that the linker will generate
11233the stubs correctly an all situaltion. See the compiler option
11234@code{-mrelax} and the linler option @code{--relax}.
11235There are corner cases where the linker is supposed to generate stubs
11236but aborts without relaxation and without a helpful error message.
11237
11238@item
11239The default linker script is arranged for code with @code{EIND = 0}.
11240If code is supposed to work for a setup with @code{EIND != 0}, a custom
11241linker script has to be used in order to place the sections whose
11242name start with @code{.trampolines} into the segment where @code{EIND}
11243points to.
11244
11245@item
11246The startup code from libgcc never sets @code{EIND}.
11247Notice that startup code is a blend of code from libgcc and AVR-LibC.
11248For the impact of AVR-LibC on @code{EIND}, see the
11249@w{@uref{http://nongnu.org/avr-libc/user-manual/,AVR-LibC user manual}}.
11250
11251@item
11252It is legitimate for user-specific startup code to set up @code{EIND}
11253early, for example by means of initialization code located in
11254section @code{.init3}. Such code runs prior to general startup code
11255that initializes RAM and calls constructors, but after the bit
11256of startup code from AVR-LibC that sets @code{EIND} to the segment
11257where the vector table is located.
11258@example
11259#include <avr/io.h>
11260
11261static void
11262__attribute__((section(".init3"),naked,used,no_instrument_function))
11263init3_set_eind (void)
11264@{
11265  __asm volatile ("ldi r24,pm_hh8(__trampolines_start)\n\t"
11266                  "out %i0,r24" :: "n" (&EIND) : "r24","memory");
11267@}
11268@end example
11269
11270@noindent
11271The @code{__trampolines_start} symbol is defined in the linker script.
11272
11273@item
11274Stubs are generated automatically by the linker if
11275the following two conditions are met:
11276@itemize @minus
11277
11278@item The address of a label is taken by means of the @code{gs} modifier
11279(short for @emph{generate stubs}) like so:
11280@example
11281LDI r24, lo8(gs(@var{func}))
11282LDI r25, hi8(gs(@var{func}))
11283@end example
11284@item The final location of that label is in a code segment
11285@emph{outside} the segment where the stubs are located.
11286@end itemize
11287
11288@item
11289The compiler emits such @code{gs} modifiers for code labels in the
11290following situations:
11291@itemize @minus
11292@item Taking address of a function or code label.
11293@item Computed goto.
11294@item If prologue-save function is used, see @option{-mcall-prologues}
11295command-line option.
11296@item Switch/case dispatch tables. If you do not want such dispatch
11297tables you can specify the @option{-fno-jump-tables} command-line option.
11298@item C and C++ constructors/destructors called during startup/shutdown.
11299@item If the tools hit a @code{gs()} modifier explained above.
11300@end itemize
11301
11302@item
11303Jumping to non-symbolic addresses like so is @emph{not} supported:
11304
11305@example
11306int main (void)
11307@{
11308    /* Call function at word address 0x2 */
11309    return ((int(*)(void)) 0x2)();
11310@}
11311@end example
11312
11313Instead, a stub has to be set up, i.e.@: the function has to be called
11314through a symbol (@code{func_4} in the example):
11315
11316@example
11317int main (void)
11318@{
11319    extern int func_4 (void);
11320
11321    /* Call function at byte address 0x4 */
11322    return func_4();
11323@}
11324@end example
11325
11326and the application be linked with @code{-Wl,--defsym,func_4=0x4}.
11327Alternatively, @code{func_4} can be defined in the linker script.
11328@end itemize
11329
11330@subsubsection Handling of the @code{RAMPD}, @code{RAMPX}, @code{RAMPY} and @code{RAMPZ} Special Function Registers
11331@cindex @code{RAMPD}
11332@cindex @code{RAMPX}
11333@cindex @code{RAMPY}
11334@cindex @code{RAMPZ}
11335Some AVR devices support memories larger than the 64@tie{}KiB range
11336that can be accessed with 16-bit pointers.  To access memory locations
11337outside this 64@tie{}KiB range, the contentent of a @code{RAMP}
11338register is used as high part of the address:
11339The @code{X}, @code{Y}, @code{Z} address register is concatenated
11340with the @code{RAMPX}, @code{RAMPY}, @code{RAMPZ} special function
11341register, respectively, to get a wide address. Similarly,
11342@code{RAMPD} is used together with direct addressing.
11343
11344@itemize
11345@item
11346The startup code initializes the @code{RAMP} special function
11347registers with zero.
11348
11349@item
11350If a @ref{AVR Named Address Spaces,named address space} other than
11351generic or @code{__flash} is used, then @code{RAMPZ} is set
11352as needed before the operation.
11353
11354@item
11355If the device supports RAM larger than 64@tie{KiB} and the compiler
11356needs to change @code{RAMPZ} to accomplish an operation, @code{RAMPZ}
11357is reset to zero after the operation.
11358
11359@item
11360If the device comes with a specific @code{RAMP} register, the ISR
11361prologue/epilogue saves/restores that SFR and initializes it with
11362zero in case the ISR code might (implicitly) use it.
11363
11364@item
11365RAM larger than 64@tie{KiB} is not supported by GCC for AVR targets.
11366If you use inline assembler to read from locations outside the
1136716-bit address range and change one of the @code{RAMP} registers,
11368you must reset it to zero after the access.
11369
11370@end itemize
11371
11372@subsubsection AVR Built-in Macros
11373
11374GCC defines several built-in macros so that the user code can test
11375for the presence or absence of features.  Almost any of the following
11376built-in macros are deduced from device capabilities and thus
11377triggered by the @code{-mmcu=} command-line option.
11378
11379For even more AVR-specific built-in macros see
11380@ref{AVR Named Address Spaces} and @ref{AVR Built-in Functions}.
11381
11382@table @code
11383
11384@item __AVR_ARCH__
11385Build-in macro that resolves to a decimal number that identifies the
11386architecture and depends on the @code{-mmcu=@var{mcu}} option.
11387Possible values are:
11388
11389@code{2}, @code{25}, @code{3}, @code{31}, @code{35},
11390@code{4}, @code{5}, @code{51}, @code{6}, @code{102}, @code{104},
11391@code{105}, @code{106}, @code{107}
11392
11393for @var{mcu}=@code{avr2}, @code{avr25}, @code{avr3},
11394@code{avr31}, @code{avr35}, @code{avr4}, @code{avr5}, @code{avr51},
11395@code{avr6}, @code{avrxmega2}, @code{avrxmega4}, @code{avrxmega5},
11396@code{avrxmega6}, @code{avrxmega7}, respectively.
11397If @var{mcu} specifies a device, this built-in macro is set
11398accordingly. For example, with @code{-mmcu=atmega8} the macro will be
11399defined to @code{4}.
11400
11401@item __AVR_@var{Device}__
11402Setting @code{-mmcu=@var{device}} defines this built-in macro which reflects
11403the device's name. For example, @code{-mmcu=atmega8} defines the
11404built-in macro @code{__AVR_ATmega8__}, @code{-mmcu=attiny261a} defines
11405@code{__AVR_ATtiny261A__}, etc.
11406
11407The built-in macros' names follow
11408the scheme @code{__AVR_@var{Device}__} where @var{Device} is
11409the device name as from the AVR user manual. The difference between
11410@var{Device} in the built-in macro and @var{device} in
11411@code{-mmcu=@var{device}} is that the latter is always lowercase.
11412
11413If @var{device} is not a device but only a core architecture like
11414@code{avr51}, this macro will not be defined.
11415
11416@item __AVR_XMEGA__
11417The device/architecture belongs to the XMEGA family of devices.
11418
11419@item __AVR_HAVE_ELPM__
11420The device has the the @code{ELPM} instruction.
11421
11422@item __AVR_HAVE_ELPMX__
11423The device has the @code{ELPM R@var{n},Z} and @code{ELPM
11424R@var{n},Z+} instructions.
11425
11426@item __AVR_HAVE_MOVW__
11427The device has the @code{MOVW} instruction to perform 16-bit
11428register-register moves.
11429
11430@item __AVR_HAVE_LPMX__
11431The device has the @code{LPM R@var{n},Z} and
11432@code{LPM R@var{n},Z+} instructions.
11433
11434@item __AVR_HAVE_MUL__
11435The device has a hardware multiplier.
11436
11437@item __AVR_HAVE_JMP_CALL__
11438The device has the @code{JMP} and @code{CALL} instructions.
11439This is the case for devices with at least 16@tie{}KiB of program
11440memory and if @code{-mshort-calls} is not set.
11441
11442@item __AVR_HAVE_EIJMP_EICALL__
11443@item __AVR_3_BYTE_PC__
11444The device has the @code{EIJMP} and @code{EICALL} instructions.
11445This is the case for devices with more than 128@tie{}KiB of program memory.
11446This also means that the program counter
11447(PC) is 3@tie{}bytes wide.
11448
11449@item __AVR_2_BYTE_PC__
11450The program counter (PC) is 2@tie{}bytes wide. This is the case for devices
11451with up to 128@tie{}KiB of program memory.
11452
11453@item __AVR_HAVE_8BIT_SP__
11454@item __AVR_HAVE_16BIT_SP__
11455The stack pointer (SP) register is treated as 8-bit respectively
1145616-bit register by the compiler.
11457The definition of these macros is affected by @code{-mtiny-stack}.
11458
11459@item __AVR_HAVE_SPH__
11460@item __AVR_SP8__
11461The device has the SPH (high part of stack pointer) special function
11462register or has an 8-bit stack pointer, respectively.
11463The definition of these macros is affected by @code{-mmcu=} and
11464in the cases of @code{-mmcu=avr2} and @code{-mmcu=avr25} also
11465by @code{-msp8}.
11466
11467@item __AVR_HAVE_RAMPD__
11468@item __AVR_HAVE_RAMPX__
11469@item __AVR_HAVE_RAMPY__
11470@item __AVR_HAVE_RAMPZ__
11471The device has the @code{RAMPD}, @code{RAMPX}, @code{RAMPY},
11472@code{RAMPZ} special function register, respectively.
11473
11474@item __NO_INTERRUPTS__
11475This macro reflects the @code{-mno-interrupts} command line option.
11476
11477@item __AVR_ERRATA_SKIP__
11478@item __AVR_ERRATA_SKIP_JMP_CALL__
11479Some AVR devices (AT90S8515, ATmega103) must not skip 32-bit
11480instructions because of a hardware erratum.  Skip instructions are
11481@code{SBRS}, @code{SBRC}, @code{SBIS}, @code{SBIC} and @code{CPSE}.
11482The second macro is only defined if @code{__AVR_HAVE_JMP_CALL__} is also
11483set.
11484
11485@item __AVR_SFR_OFFSET__=@var{offset}
11486Instructions that can address I/O special function registers directly
11487like @code{IN}, @code{OUT}, @code{SBI}, etc.@: may use a different
11488address as if addressed by an instruction to access RAM like @code{LD}
11489or @code{STS}. This offset depends on the device architecture and has
11490to be subtracted from the RAM address in order to get the
11491respective I/O@tie{}address.
11492
11493@item __WITH_AVRLIBC__
11494The compiler is configured to be used together with AVR-Libc.
11495See the @code{--with-avrlibc} configure option.
11496
11497@end table
11498
11499@node Blackfin Options
11500@subsection Blackfin Options
11501@cindex Blackfin Options
11502
11503@table @gcctabopt
11504@item -mcpu=@var{cpu}@r{[}-@var{sirevision}@r{]}
11505@opindex mcpu=
11506Specifies the name of the target Blackfin processor.  Currently, @var{cpu}
11507can be one of @samp{bf512}, @samp{bf514}, @samp{bf516}, @samp{bf518},
11508@samp{bf522}, @samp{bf523}, @samp{bf524}, @samp{bf525}, @samp{bf526},
11509@samp{bf527}, @samp{bf531}, @samp{bf532}, @samp{bf533},
11510@samp{bf534}, @samp{bf536}, @samp{bf537}, @samp{bf538}, @samp{bf539},
11511@samp{bf542}, @samp{bf544}, @samp{bf547}, @samp{bf548}, @samp{bf549},
11512@samp{bf542m}, @samp{bf544m}, @samp{bf547m}, @samp{bf548m}, @samp{bf549m},
11513@samp{bf561}, @samp{bf592}.
11514The optional @var{sirevision} specifies the silicon revision of the target
11515Blackfin processor.  Any workarounds available for the targeted silicon revision
11516will be enabled.  If @var{sirevision} is @samp{none}, no workarounds are enabled.
11517If @var{sirevision} is @samp{any}, all workarounds for the targeted processor
11518will be enabled.  The @code{__SILICON_REVISION__} macro is defined to two
11519hexadecimal digits representing the major and minor numbers in the silicon
11520revision.  If @var{sirevision} is @samp{none}, the @code{__SILICON_REVISION__}
11521is not defined.  If @var{sirevision} is @samp{any}, the
11522@code{__SILICON_REVISION__} is defined to be @code{0xffff}.
11523If this optional @var{sirevision} is not used, GCC assumes the latest known
11524silicon revision of the targeted Blackfin processor.
11525
11526Support for @samp{bf561} is incomplete.  For @samp{bf561},
11527Only the processor macro is defined.
11528Without this option, @samp{bf532} is used as the processor by default.
11529The corresponding predefined processor macros for @var{cpu} is to
11530be defined.  And for @samp{bfin-elf} toolchain, this causes the hardware BSP
11531provided by libgloss to be linked in if @option{-msim} is not given.
11532
11533@item -msim
11534@opindex msim
11535Specifies that the program will be run on the simulator.  This causes
11536the simulator BSP provided by libgloss to be linked in.  This option
11537has effect only for @samp{bfin-elf} toolchain.
11538Certain other options, such as @option{-mid-shared-library} and
11539@option{-mfdpic}, imply @option{-msim}.
11540
11541@item -momit-leaf-frame-pointer
11542@opindex momit-leaf-frame-pointer
11543Don't keep the frame pointer in a register for leaf functions.  This
11544avoids the instructions to save, set up and restore frame pointers and
11545makes an extra register available in leaf functions.  The option
11546@option{-fomit-frame-pointer} removes the frame pointer for all functions,
11547which might make debugging harder.
11548
11549@item -mspecld-anomaly
11550@opindex mspecld-anomaly
11551When enabled, the compiler will ensure that the generated code does not
11552contain speculative loads after jump instructions. If this option is used,
11553@code{__WORKAROUND_SPECULATIVE_LOADS} is defined.
11554
11555@item -mno-specld-anomaly
11556@opindex mno-specld-anomaly
11557Don't generate extra code to prevent speculative loads from occurring.
11558
11559@item -mcsync-anomaly
11560@opindex mcsync-anomaly
11561When enabled, the compiler will ensure that the generated code does not
11562contain CSYNC or SSYNC instructions too soon after conditional branches.
11563If this option is used, @code{__WORKAROUND_SPECULATIVE_SYNCS} is defined.
11564
11565@item -mno-csync-anomaly
11566@opindex mno-csync-anomaly
11567Don't generate extra code to prevent CSYNC or SSYNC instructions from
11568occurring too soon after a conditional branch.
11569
11570@item -mlow-64k
11571@opindex mlow-64k
11572When enabled, the compiler is free to take advantage of the knowledge that
11573the entire program fits into the low 64k of memory.
11574
11575@item -mno-low-64k
11576@opindex mno-low-64k
11577Assume that the program is arbitrarily large.  This is the default.
11578
11579@item -mstack-check-l1
11580@opindex mstack-check-l1
11581Do stack checking using information placed into L1 scratchpad memory by the
11582uClinux kernel.
11583
11584@item -mid-shared-library
11585@opindex mid-shared-library
11586Generate code that supports shared libraries via the library ID method.
11587This allows for execute in place and shared libraries in an environment
11588without virtual memory management.  This option implies @option{-fPIC}.
11589With a @samp{bfin-elf} target, this option implies @option{-msim}.
11590
11591@item -mno-id-shared-library
11592@opindex mno-id-shared-library
11593Generate code that doesn't assume ID based shared libraries are being used.
11594This is the default.
11595
11596@item -mleaf-id-shared-library
11597@opindex mleaf-id-shared-library
11598Generate code that supports shared libraries via the library ID method,
11599but assumes that this library or executable won't link against any other
11600ID shared libraries.  That allows the compiler to use faster code for jumps
11601and calls.
11602
11603@item -mno-leaf-id-shared-library
11604@opindex mno-leaf-id-shared-library
11605Do not assume that the code being compiled won't link against any ID shared
11606libraries.  Slower code will be generated for jump and call insns.
11607
11608@item -mshared-library-id=n
11609@opindex mshared-library-id
11610Specified the identification number of the ID based shared library being
11611compiled.  Specifying a value of 0 will generate more compact code, specifying
11612other values will force the allocation of that number to the current
11613library but is no more space or time efficient than omitting this option.
11614
11615@item -msep-data
11616@opindex msep-data
11617Generate code that allows the data segment to be located in a different
11618area of memory from the text segment.  This allows for execute in place in
11619an environment without virtual memory management by eliminating relocations
11620against the text section.
11621
11622@item -mno-sep-data
11623@opindex mno-sep-data
11624Generate code that assumes that the data segment follows the text segment.
11625This is the default.
11626
11627@item -mlong-calls
11628@itemx -mno-long-calls
11629@opindex mlong-calls
11630@opindex mno-long-calls
11631Tells the compiler to perform function calls by first loading the
11632address of the function into a register and then performing a subroutine
11633call on this register.  This switch is needed if the target function
11634lies outside of the 24-bit addressing range of the offset-based
11635version of subroutine call instruction.
11636
11637This feature is not enabled by default.  Specifying
11638@option{-mno-long-calls} will restore the default behavior.  Note these
11639switches have no effect on how the compiler generates code to handle
11640function calls via function pointers.
11641
11642@item -mfast-fp
11643@opindex mfast-fp
11644Link with the fast floating-point library. This library relaxes some of
11645the IEEE floating-point standard's rules for checking inputs against
11646Not-a-Number (NAN), in the interest of performance.
11647
11648@item -minline-plt
11649@opindex minline-plt
11650Enable inlining of PLT entries in function calls to functions that are
11651not known to bind locally.  It has no effect without @option{-mfdpic}.
11652
11653@item -mmulticore
11654@opindex mmulticore
11655Build standalone application for multicore Blackfin processor. Proper
11656start files and link scripts will be used to support multicore.
11657This option defines @code{__BFIN_MULTICORE}. It can only be used with
11658@option{-mcpu=bf561@r{[}-@var{sirevision}@r{]}}. It can be used with
11659@option{-mcorea} or @option{-mcoreb}. If it's used without
11660@option{-mcorea} or @option{-mcoreb}, single application/dual core
11661programming model is used. In this model, the main function of Core B
11662should be named as coreb_main. If it's used with @option{-mcorea} or
11663@option{-mcoreb}, one application per core programming model is used.
11664If this option is not used, single core application programming
11665model is used.
11666
11667@item -mcorea
11668@opindex mcorea
11669Build standalone application for Core A of BF561 when using
11670one application per core programming model. Proper start files
11671and link scripts will be used to support Core A. This option
11672defines @code{__BFIN_COREA}. It must be used with @option{-mmulticore}.
11673
11674@item -mcoreb
11675@opindex mcoreb
11676Build standalone application for Core B of BF561 when using
11677one application per core programming model. Proper start files
11678and link scripts will be used to support Core B. This option
11679defines @code{__BFIN_COREB}. When this option is used, coreb_main
11680should be used instead of main. It must be used with
11681@option{-mmulticore}.
11682
11683@item -msdram
11684@opindex msdram
11685Build standalone application for SDRAM. Proper start files and
11686link scripts will be used to put the application into SDRAM.
11687Loader should initialize SDRAM before loading the application
11688into SDRAM. This option defines @code{__BFIN_SDRAM}.
11689
11690@item -micplb
11691@opindex micplb
11692Assume that ICPLBs are enabled at run time.  This has an effect on certain
11693anomaly workarounds.  For Linux targets, the default is to assume ICPLBs
11694are enabled; for standalone applications the default is off.
11695@end table
11696
11697@node C6X Options
11698@subsection C6X Options
11699@cindex C6X Options
11700
11701@table @gcctabopt
11702@item -march=@var{name}
11703@opindex march
11704This specifies the name of the target architecture.  GCC uses this
11705name to determine what kind of instructions it can emit when generating
11706assembly code.  Permissible names are: @samp{c62x},
11707@samp{c64x}, @samp{c64x+}, @samp{c67x}, @samp{c67x+}, @samp{c674x}.
11708
11709@item -mbig-endian
11710@opindex mbig-endian
11711Generate code for a big-endian target.
11712
11713@item -mlittle-endian
11714@opindex mlittle-endian
11715Generate code for a little-endian target.  This is the default.
11716
11717@item -msim
11718@opindex msim
11719Choose startup files and linker script suitable for the simulator.
11720
11721@item -msdata=default
11722@opindex msdata=default
11723Put small global and static data in the @samp{.neardata} section,
11724which is pointed to by register @code{B14}.  Put small uninitialized
11725global and static data in the @samp{.bss} section, which is adjacent
11726to the @samp{.neardata} section.  Put small read-only data into the
11727@samp{.rodata} section.  The corresponding sections used for large
11728pieces of data are @samp{.fardata}, @samp{.far} and @samp{.const}.
11729
11730@item -msdata=all
11731@opindex msdata=all
11732Put all data, not just small objets, into the sections reserved for
11733small data, and use addressing relative to the @code{B14} register to
11734access them.
11735
11736@item -msdata=none
11737@opindex msdata=none
11738Make no use of the sections reserved for small data, and use absolute
11739addresses to access all data.  Put all initialized global and static
11740data in the @samp{.fardata} section, and all uninitialized data in the
11741@samp{.far} section.  Put all constant data into the @samp{.const}
11742section.
11743@end table
11744
11745@node CRIS Options
11746@subsection CRIS Options
11747@cindex CRIS Options
11748
11749These options are defined specifically for the CRIS ports.
11750
11751@table @gcctabopt
11752@item -march=@var{architecture-type}
11753@itemx -mcpu=@var{architecture-type}
11754@opindex march
11755@opindex mcpu
11756Generate code for the specified architecture.  The choices for
11757@var{architecture-type} are @samp{v3}, @samp{v8} and @samp{v10} for
11758respectively ETRAX@w{ }4, ETRAX@w{ }100, and ETRAX@w{ }100@w{ }LX@.
11759Default is @samp{v0} except for cris-axis-linux-gnu, where the default is
11760@samp{v10}.
11761
11762@item -mtune=@var{architecture-type}
11763@opindex mtune
11764Tune to @var{architecture-type} everything applicable about the generated
11765code, except for the ABI and the set of available instructions.  The
11766choices for @var{architecture-type} are the same as for
11767@option{-march=@var{architecture-type}}.
11768
11769@item -mmax-stack-frame=@var{n}
11770@opindex mmax-stack-frame
11771Warn when the stack frame of a function exceeds @var{n} bytes.
11772
11773@item -metrax4
11774@itemx -metrax100
11775@opindex metrax4
11776@opindex metrax100
11777The options @option{-metrax4} and @option{-metrax100} are synonyms for
11778@option{-march=v3} and @option{-march=v8} respectively.
11779
11780@item -mmul-bug-workaround
11781@itemx -mno-mul-bug-workaround
11782@opindex mmul-bug-workaround
11783@opindex mno-mul-bug-workaround
11784Work around a bug in the @code{muls} and @code{mulu} instructions for CPU
11785models where it applies.  This option is active by default.
11786
11787@item -mpdebug
11788@opindex mpdebug
11789Enable CRIS-specific verbose debug-related information in the assembly
11790code.  This option also has the effect to turn off the @samp{#NO_APP}
11791formatted-code indicator to the assembler at the beginning of the
11792assembly file.
11793
11794@item -mcc-init
11795@opindex mcc-init
11796Do not use condition-code results from previous instruction; always emit
11797compare and test instructions before use of condition codes.
11798
11799@item -mno-side-effects
11800@opindex mno-side-effects
11801Do not emit instructions with side-effects in addressing modes other than
11802post-increment.
11803
11804@item -mstack-align
11805@itemx -mno-stack-align
11806@itemx -mdata-align
11807@itemx -mno-data-align
11808@itemx -mconst-align
11809@itemx -mno-const-align
11810@opindex mstack-align
11811@opindex mno-stack-align
11812@opindex mdata-align
11813@opindex mno-data-align
11814@opindex mconst-align
11815@opindex mno-const-align
11816These options (no-options) arranges (eliminate arrangements) for the
11817stack-frame, individual data and constants to be aligned for the maximum
11818single data access size for the chosen CPU model.  The default is to
11819arrange for 32-bit alignment.  ABI details such as structure layout are
11820not affected by these options.
11821
11822@item -m32-bit
11823@itemx -m16-bit
11824@itemx -m8-bit
11825@opindex m32-bit
11826@opindex m16-bit
11827@opindex m8-bit
11828Similar to the stack- data- and const-align options above, these options
11829arrange for stack-frame, writable data and constants to all be 32-bit,
1183016-bit or 8-bit aligned.  The default is 32-bit alignment.
11831
11832@item -mno-prologue-epilogue
11833@itemx -mprologue-epilogue
11834@opindex mno-prologue-epilogue
11835@opindex mprologue-epilogue
11836With @option{-mno-prologue-epilogue}, the normal function prologue and
11837epilogue which set up the stack frame are omitted and no return
11838instructions or return sequences are generated in the code.  Use this
11839option only together with visual inspection of the compiled code: no
11840warnings or errors are generated when call-saved registers must be saved,
11841or storage for local variable needs to be allocated.
11842
11843@item -mno-gotplt
11844@itemx -mgotplt
11845@opindex mno-gotplt
11846@opindex mgotplt
11847With @option{-fpic} and @option{-fPIC}, don't generate (do generate)
11848instruction sequences that load addresses for functions from the PLT part
11849of the GOT rather than (traditional on other architectures) calls to the
11850PLT@.  The default is @option{-mgotplt}.
11851
11852@item -melf
11853@opindex melf
11854Legacy no-op option only recognized with the cris-axis-elf and
11855cris-axis-linux-gnu targets.
11856
11857@item -mlinux
11858@opindex mlinux
11859Legacy no-op option only recognized with the cris-axis-linux-gnu target.
11860
11861@item -sim
11862@opindex sim
11863This option, recognized for the cris-axis-elf arranges
11864to link with input-output functions from a simulator library.  Code,
11865initialized data and zero-initialized data are allocated consecutively.
11866
11867@item -sim2
11868@opindex sim2
11869Like @option{-sim}, but pass linker options to locate initialized data at
118700x40000000 and zero-initialized data at 0x80000000.
11871@end table
11872
11873@node CR16 Options
11874@subsection CR16 Options
11875@cindex CR16 Options
11876
11877These options are defined specifically for the CR16 ports.
11878
11879@table @gcctabopt
11880
11881@item -mmac
11882@opindex mmac
11883Enable the use of multiply-accumulate instructions. Disabled by default.
11884
11885@item -mcr16cplus
11886@itemx -mcr16c
11887@opindex mcr16cplus
11888@opindex mcr16c
11889Generate code for CR16C or CR16C+ architecture. CR16C+ architecture
11890is default.
11891
11892@item -msim
11893@opindex msim
11894Links the library libsim.a which is in compatible with simulator. Applicable
11895to elf compiler only.
11896
11897@item -mint32
11898@opindex mint32
11899Choose integer type as 32-bit wide.
11900
11901@item -mbit-ops
11902@opindex mbit-ops
11903Generates sbit/cbit instructions for bit manipulations.
11904
11905@item -mdata-model=@var{model}
11906@opindex mdata-model
11907Choose a data model. The choices for @var{model} are @samp{near},
11908@samp{far} or @samp{medium}. @samp{medium} is default.
11909However, @samp{far} is not valid when -mcr16c option is chosen as
11910CR16C architecture does not support far data model.
11911@end table
11912
11913@node Darwin Options
11914@subsection Darwin Options
11915@cindex Darwin options
11916
11917These options are defined for all architectures running the Darwin operating
11918system.
11919
11920FSF GCC on Darwin does not create ``fat'' object files; it will create
11921an object file for the single architecture that it was built to
11922target.  Apple's GCC on Darwin does create ``fat'' files if multiple
11923@option{-arch} options are used; it does so by running the compiler or
11924linker multiple times and joining the results together with
11925@file{lipo}.
11926
11927The subtype of the file created (like @samp{ppc7400} or @samp{ppc970} or
11928@samp{i686}) is determined by the flags that specify the ISA
11929that GCC is targetting, like @option{-mcpu} or @option{-march}.  The
11930@option{-force_cpusubtype_ALL} option can be used to override this.
11931
11932The Darwin tools vary in their behavior when presented with an ISA
11933mismatch.  The assembler, @file{as}, will only permit instructions to
11934be used that are valid for the subtype of the file it is generating,
11935so you cannot put 64-bit instructions in a @samp{ppc750} object file.
11936The linker for shared libraries, @file{/usr/bin/libtool}, will fail
11937and print an error if asked to create a shared library with a less
11938restrictive subtype than its input files (for instance, trying to put
11939a @samp{ppc970} object file in a @samp{ppc7400} library).  The linker
11940for executables, @file{ld}, will quietly give the executable the most
11941restrictive subtype of any of its input files.
11942
11943@table @gcctabopt
11944@item -F@var{dir}
11945@opindex F
11946Add the framework directory @var{dir} to the head of the list of
11947directories to be searched for header files.  These directories are
11948interleaved with those specified by @option{-I} options and are
11949scanned in a left-to-right order.
11950
11951A framework directory is a directory with frameworks in it.  A
11952framework is a directory with a @samp{"Headers"} and/or
11953@samp{"PrivateHeaders"} directory contained directly in it that ends
11954in @samp{".framework"}.  The name of a framework is the name of this
11955directory excluding the @samp{".framework"}.  Headers associated with
11956the framework are found in one of those two directories, with
11957@samp{"Headers"} being searched first.  A subframework is a framework
11958directory that is in a framework's @samp{"Frameworks"} directory.
11959Includes of subframework headers can only appear in a header of a
11960framework that contains the subframework, or in a sibling subframework
11961header.  Two subframeworks are siblings if they occur in the same
11962framework.  A subframework should not have the same name as a
11963framework, a warning will be issued if this is violated.  Currently a
11964subframework cannot have subframeworks, in the future, the mechanism
11965may be extended to support this.  The standard frameworks can be found
11966in @samp{"/System/Library/Frameworks"} and
11967@samp{"/Library/Frameworks"}.  An example include looks like
11968@code{#include <Framework/header.h>}, where @samp{Framework} denotes
11969the name of the framework and header.h is found in the
11970@samp{"PrivateHeaders"} or @samp{"Headers"} directory.
11971
11972@item -iframework@var{dir}
11973@opindex iframework
11974Like @option{-F} except the directory is a treated as a system
11975directory.  The main difference between this @option{-iframework} and
11976@option{-F} is that with @option{-iframework} the compiler does not
11977warn about constructs contained within header files found via
11978@var{dir}.  This option is valid only for the C family of languages.
11979
11980@item -gused
11981@opindex gused
11982Emit debugging information for symbols that are used.  For STABS
11983debugging format, this enables @option{-feliminate-unused-debug-symbols}.
11984This is by default ON@.
11985
11986@item -gfull
11987@opindex gfull
11988Emit debugging information for all symbols and types.
11989
11990@item -mmacosx-version-min=@var{version}
11991The earliest version of MacOS X that this executable will run on
11992is @var{version}.  Typical values of @var{version} include @code{10.1},
11993@code{10.2}, and @code{10.3.9}.
11994
11995If the compiler was built to use the system's headers by default,
11996then the default for this option is the system version on which the
11997compiler is running, otherwise the default is to make choices that
11998are compatible with as many systems and code bases as possible.
11999
12000@item -mkernel
12001@opindex mkernel
12002Enable kernel development mode.  The @option{-mkernel} option sets
12003@option{-static}, @option{-fno-common}, @option{-fno-cxa-atexit},
12004@option{-fno-exceptions}, @option{-fno-non-call-exceptions},
12005@option{-fapple-kext}, @option{-fno-weak} and @option{-fno-rtti} where
12006applicable.  This mode also sets @option{-mno-altivec},
12007@option{-msoft-float}, @option{-fno-builtin} and
12008@option{-mlong-branch} for PowerPC targets.
12009
12010@item -mone-byte-bool
12011@opindex mone-byte-bool
12012Override the defaults for @samp{bool} so that @samp{sizeof(bool)==1}.
12013By default @samp{sizeof(bool)} is @samp{4} when compiling for
12014Darwin/PowerPC and @samp{1} when compiling for Darwin/x86, so this
12015option has no effect on x86.
12016
12017@strong{Warning:} The @option{-mone-byte-bool} switch causes GCC
12018to generate code that is not binary compatible with code generated
12019without that switch.  Using this switch may require recompiling all
12020other modules in a program, including system libraries.  Use this
12021switch to conform to a non-default data model.
12022
12023@item -mfix-and-continue
12024@itemx -ffix-and-continue
12025@itemx -findirect-data
12026@opindex mfix-and-continue
12027@opindex ffix-and-continue
12028@opindex findirect-data
12029Generate code suitable for fast turn around development.  Needed to
12030enable gdb to dynamically load @code{.o} files into already running
12031programs.  @option{-findirect-data} and @option{-ffix-and-continue}
12032are provided for backwards compatibility.
12033
12034@item -all_load
12035@opindex all_load
12036Loads all members of static archive libraries.
12037See man ld(1) for more information.
12038
12039@item -arch_errors_fatal
12040@opindex arch_errors_fatal
12041Cause the errors having to do with files that have the wrong architecture
12042to be fatal.
12043
12044@item -bind_at_load
12045@opindex bind_at_load
12046Causes the output file to be marked such that the dynamic linker will
12047bind all undefined references when the file is loaded or launched.
12048
12049@item -bundle
12050@opindex bundle
12051Produce a Mach-o bundle format file.
12052See man ld(1) for more information.
12053
12054@item -bundle_loader @var{executable}
12055@opindex bundle_loader
12056This option specifies the @var{executable} that will be loading the build
12057output file being linked.  See man ld(1) for more information.
12058
12059@item -dynamiclib
12060@opindex dynamiclib
12061When passed this option, GCC will produce a dynamic library instead of
12062an executable when linking, using the Darwin @file{libtool} command.
12063
12064@item -force_cpusubtype_ALL
12065@opindex force_cpusubtype_ALL
12066This causes GCC's output file to have the @var{ALL} subtype, instead of
12067one controlled by the @option{-mcpu} or @option{-march} option.
12068
12069@item -allowable_client  @var{client_name}
12070@itemx -client_name
12071@itemx -compatibility_version
12072@itemx -current_version
12073@itemx -dead_strip
12074@itemx -dependency-file
12075@itemx -dylib_file
12076@itemx -dylinker_install_name
12077@itemx -dynamic
12078@itemx -exported_symbols_list
12079@itemx -filelist
12080@need 800
12081@itemx -flat_namespace
12082@itemx -force_flat_namespace
12083@itemx -headerpad_max_install_names
12084@itemx -image_base
12085@itemx -init
12086@itemx -install_name
12087@itemx -keep_private_externs
12088@itemx -multi_module
12089@itemx -multiply_defined
12090@itemx -multiply_defined_unused
12091@need 800
12092@itemx -noall_load
12093@itemx -no_dead_strip_inits_and_terms
12094@itemx -nofixprebinding
12095@itemx -nomultidefs
12096@itemx -noprebind
12097@itemx -noseglinkedit
12098@itemx -pagezero_size
12099@itemx -prebind
12100@itemx -prebind_all_twolevel_modules
12101@itemx -private_bundle
12102@need 800
12103@itemx -read_only_relocs
12104@itemx -sectalign
12105@itemx -sectobjectsymbols
12106@itemx -whyload
12107@itemx -seg1addr
12108@itemx -sectcreate
12109@itemx -sectobjectsymbols
12110@itemx -sectorder
12111@itemx -segaddr
12112@itemx -segs_read_only_addr
12113@need 800
12114@itemx -segs_read_write_addr
12115@itemx -seg_addr_table
12116@itemx -seg_addr_table_filename
12117@itemx -seglinkedit
12118@itemx -segprot
12119@itemx -segs_read_only_addr
12120@itemx -segs_read_write_addr
12121@itemx -single_module
12122@itemx -static
12123@itemx -sub_library
12124@need 800
12125@itemx -sub_umbrella
12126@itemx -twolevel_namespace
12127@itemx -umbrella
12128@itemx -undefined
12129@itemx -unexported_symbols_list
12130@itemx -weak_reference_mismatches
12131@itemx -whatsloaded
12132@opindex allowable_client
12133@opindex client_name
12134@opindex compatibility_version
12135@opindex current_version
12136@opindex dead_strip
12137@opindex dependency-file
12138@opindex dylib_file
12139@opindex dylinker_install_name
12140@opindex dynamic
12141@opindex exported_symbols_list
12142@opindex filelist
12143@opindex flat_namespace
12144@opindex force_flat_namespace
12145@opindex headerpad_max_install_names
12146@opindex image_base
12147@opindex init
12148@opindex install_name
12149@opindex keep_private_externs
12150@opindex multi_module
12151@opindex multiply_defined
12152@opindex multiply_defined_unused
12153@opindex noall_load
12154@opindex no_dead_strip_inits_and_terms
12155@opindex nofixprebinding
12156@opindex nomultidefs
12157@opindex noprebind
12158@opindex noseglinkedit
12159@opindex pagezero_size
12160@opindex prebind
12161@opindex prebind_all_twolevel_modules
12162@opindex private_bundle
12163@opindex read_only_relocs
12164@opindex sectalign
12165@opindex sectobjectsymbols
12166@opindex whyload
12167@opindex seg1addr
12168@opindex sectcreate
12169@opindex sectobjectsymbols
12170@opindex sectorder
12171@opindex segaddr
12172@opindex segs_read_only_addr
12173@opindex segs_read_write_addr
12174@opindex seg_addr_table
12175@opindex seg_addr_table_filename
12176@opindex seglinkedit
12177@opindex segprot
12178@opindex segs_read_only_addr
12179@opindex segs_read_write_addr
12180@opindex single_module
12181@opindex static
12182@opindex sub_library
12183@opindex sub_umbrella
12184@opindex twolevel_namespace
12185@opindex umbrella
12186@opindex undefined
12187@opindex unexported_symbols_list
12188@opindex weak_reference_mismatches
12189@opindex whatsloaded
12190These options are passed to the Darwin linker.  The Darwin linker man page
12191describes them in detail.
12192@end table
12193
12194@node DEC Alpha Options
12195@subsection DEC Alpha Options
12196
12197These @samp{-m} options are defined for the DEC Alpha implementations:
12198
12199@table @gcctabopt
12200@item -mno-soft-float
12201@itemx -msoft-float
12202@opindex mno-soft-float
12203@opindex msoft-float
12204Use (do not use) the hardware floating-point instructions for
12205floating-point operations.  When @option{-msoft-float} is specified,
12206functions in @file{libgcc.a} will be used to perform floating-point
12207operations.  Unless they are replaced by routines that emulate the
12208floating-point operations, or compiled in such a way as to call such
12209emulations routines, these routines will issue floating-point
12210operations.   If you are compiling for an Alpha without floating-point
12211operations, you must ensure that the library is built so as not to call
12212them.
12213
12214Note that Alpha implementations without floating-point operations are
12215required to have floating-point registers.
12216
12217@item -mfp-reg
12218@itemx -mno-fp-regs
12219@opindex mfp-reg
12220@opindex mno-fp-regs
12221Generate code that uses (does not use) the floating-point register set.
12222@option{-mno-fp-regs} implies @option{-msoft-float}.  If the floating-point
12223register set is not used, floating-point operands are passed in integer
12224registers as if they were integers and floating-point results are passed
12225in @code{$0} instead of @code{$f0}.  This is a non-standard calling sequence,
12226so any function with a floating-point argument or return value called by code
12227compiled with @option{-mno-fp-regs} must also be compiled with that
12228option.
12229
12230A typical use of this option is building a kernel that does not use,
12231and hence need not save and restore, any floating-point registers.
12232
12233@item -mieee
12234@opindex mieee
12235The Alpha architecture implements floating-point hardware optimized for
12236maximum performance.  It is mostly compliant with the IEEE floating-point
12237standard.  However, for full compliance, software assistance is
12238required.  This option generates code fully IEEE-compliant code
12239@emph{except} that the @var{inexact-flag} is not maintained (see below).
12240If this option is turned on, the preprocessor macro @code{_IEEE_FP} is
12241defined during compilation.  The resulting code is less efficient but is
12242able to correctly support denormalized numbers and exceptional IEEE
12243values such as not-a-number and plus/minus infinity.  Other Alpha
12244compilers call this option @option{-ieee_with_no_inexact}.
12245
12246@item -mieee-with-inexact
12247@opindex mieee-with-inexact
12248This is like @option{-mieee} except the generated code also maintains
12249the IEEE @var{inexact-flag}.  Turning on this option causes the
12250generated code to implement fully-compliant IEEE math.  In addition to
12251@code{_IEEE_FP}, @code{_IEEE_FP_EXACT} is defined as a preprocessor
12252macro.  On some Alpha implementations the resulting code may execute
12253significantly slower than the code generated by default.  Since there is
12254very little code that depends on the @var{inexact-flag}, you should
12255normally not specify this option.  Other Alpha compilers call this
12256option @option{-ieee_with_inexact}.
12257
12258@item -mfp-trap-mode=@var{trap-mode}
12259@opindex mfp-trap-mode
12260This option controls what floating-point related traps are enabled.
12261Other Alpha compilers call this option @option{-fptm @var{trap-mode}}.
12262The trap mode can be set to one of four values:
12263
12264@table @samp
12265@item n
12266This is the default (normal) setting.  The only traps that are enabled
12267are the ones that cannot be disabled in software (e.g., division by zero
12268trap).
12269
12270@item u
12271In addition to the traps enabled by @samp{n}, underflow traps are enabled
12272as well.
12273
12274@item su
12275Like @samp{u}, but the instructions are marked to be safe for software
12276completion (see Alpha architecture manual for details).
12277
12278@item sui
12279Like @samp{su}, but inexact traps are enabled as well.
12280@end table
12281
12282@item -mfp-rounding-mode=@var{rounding-mode}
12283@opindex mfp-rounding-mode
12284Selects the IEEE rounding mode.  Other Alpha compilers call this option
12285@option{-fprm @var{rounding-mode}}.  The @var{rounding-mode} can be one
12286of:
12287
12288@table @samp
12289@item n
12290Normal IEEE rounding mode.  Floating-point numbers are rounded towards
12291the nearest machine number or towards the even machine number in case
12292of a tie.
12293
12294@item m
12295Round towards minus infinity.
12296
12297@item c
12298Chopped rounding mode.  Floating-point numbers are rounded towards zero.
12299
12300@item d
12301Dynamic rounding mode.  A field in the floating-point control register
12302(@var{fpcr}, see Alpha architecture reference manual) controls the
12303rounding mode in effect.  The C library initializes this register for
12304rounding towards plus infinity.  Thus, unless your program modifies the
12305@var{fpcr}, @samp{d} corresponds to round towards plus infinity.
12306@end table
12307
12308@item -mtrap-precision=@var{trap-precision}
12309@opindex mtrap-precision
12310In the Alpha architecture, floating-point traps are imprecise.  This
12311means without software assistance it is impossible to recover from a
12312floating trap and program execution normally needs to be terminated.
12313GCC can generate code that can assist operating system trap handlers
12314in determining the exact location that caused a floating-point trap.
12315Depending on the requirements of an application, different levels of
12316precisions can be selected:
12317
12318@table @samp
12319@item p
12320Program precision.  This option is the default and means a trap handler
12321can only identify which program caused a floating-point exception.
12322
12323@item f
12324Function precision.  The trap handler can determine the function that
12325caused a floating-point exception.
12326
12327@item i
12328Instruction precision.  The trap handler can determine the exact
12329instruction that caused a floating-point exception.
12330@end table
12331
12332Other Alpha compilers provide the equivalent options called
12333@option{-scope_safe} and @option{-resumption_safe}.
12334
12335@item -mieee-conformant
12336@opindex mieee-conformant
12337This option marks the generated code as IEEE conformant.  You must not
12338use this option unless you also specify @option{-mtrap-precision=i} and either
12339@option{-mfp-trap-mode=su} or @option{-mfp-trap-mode=sui}.  Its only effect
12340is to emit the line @samp{.eflag 48} in the function prologue of the
12341generated assembly file.  Under DEC Unix, this has the effect that
12342IEEE-conformant math library routines will be linked in.
12343
12344@item -mbuild-constants
12345@opindex mbuild-constants
12346Normally GCC examines a 32- or 64-bit integer constant to
12347see if it can construct it from smaller constants in two or three
12348instructions.  If it cannot, it will output the constant as a literal and
12349generate code to load it from the data segment at run time.
12350
12351Use this option to require GCC to construct @emph{all} integer constants
12352using code, even if it takes more instructions (the maximum is six).
12353
12354You would typically use this option to build a shared library dynamic
12355loader.  Itself a shared library, it must relocate itself in memory
12356before it can find the variables and constants in its own data segment.
12357
12358@item -malpha-as
12359@itemx -mgas
12360@opindex malpha-as
12361@opindex mgas
12362Select whether to generate code to be assembled by the vendor-supplied
12363assembler (@option{-malpha-as}) or by the GNU assembler @option{-mgas}.
12364
12365@item -mbwx
12366@itemx -mno-bwx
12367@itemx -mcix
12368@itemx -mno-cix
12369@itemx -mfix
12370@itemx -mno-fix
12371@itemx -mmax
12372@itemx -mno-max
12373@opindex mbwx
12374@opindex mno-bwx
12375@opindex mcix
12376@opindex mno-cix
12377@opindex mfix
12378@opindex mno-fix
12379@opindex mmax
12380@opindex mno-max
12381Indicate whether GCC should generate code to use the optional BWX,
12382CIX, FIX and MAX instruction sets.  The default is to use the instruction
12383sets supported by the CPU type specified via @option{-mcpu=} option or that
12384of the CPU on which GCC was built if none was specified.
12385
12386@item -mfloat-vax
12387@itemx -mfloat-ieee
12388@opindex mfloat-vax
12389@opindex mfloat-ieee
12390Generate code that uses (does not use) VAX F and G floating-point
12391arithmetic instead of IEEE single and double precision.
12392
12393@item -mexplicit-relocs
12394@itemx -mno-explicit-relocs
12395@opindex mexplicit-relocs
12396@opindex mno-explicit-relocs
12397Older Alpha assemblers provided no way to generate symbol relocations
12398except via assembler macros.  Use of these macros does not allow
12399optimal instruction scheduling.  GNU binutils as of version 2.12
12400supports a new syntax that allows the compiler to explicitly mark
12401which relocations should apply to which instructions.  This option
12402is mostly useful for debugging, as GCC detects the capabilities of
12403the assembler when it is built and sets the default accordingly.
12404
12405@item -msmall-data
12406@itemx -mlarge-data
12407@opindex msmall-data
12408@opindex mlarge-data
12409When @option{-mexplicit-relocs} is in effect, static data is
12410accessed via @dfn{gp-relative} relocations.  When @option{-msmall-data}
12411is used, objects 8 bytes long or smaller are placed in a @dfn{small data area}
12412(the @code{.sdata} and @code{.sbss} sections) and are accessed via
1241316-bit relocations off of the @code{$gp} register.  This limits the
12414size of the small data area to 64KB, but allows the variables to be
12415directly accessed via a single instruction.
12416
12417The default is @option{-mlarge-data}.  With this option the data area
12418is limited to just below 2GB@.  Programs that require more than 2GB of
12419data must use @code{malloc} or @code{mmap} to allocate the data in the
12420heap instead of in the program's data segment.
12421
12422When generating code for shared libraries, @option{-fpic} implies
12423@option{-msmall-data} and @option{-fPIC} implies @option{-mlarge-data}.
12424
12425@item -msmall-text
12426@itemx -mlarge-text
12427@opindex msmall-text
12428@opindex mlarge-text
12429When @option{-msmall-text} is used, the compiler assumes that the
12430code of the entire program (or shared library) fits in 4MB, and is
12431thus reachable with a branch instruction.  When @option{-msmall-data}
12432is used, the compiler can assume that all local symbols share the
12433same @code{$gp} value, and thus reduce the number of instructions
12434required for a function call from 4 to 1.
12435
12436The default is @option{-mlarge-text}.
12437
12438@item -mcpu=@var{cpu_type}
12439@opindex mcpu
12440Set the instruction set and instruction scheduling parameters for
12441machine type @var{cpu_type}.  You can specify either the @samp{EV}
12442style name or the corresponding chip number.  GCC supports scheduling
12443parameters for the EV4, EV5 and EV6 family of processors and will
12444choose the default values for the instruction set from the processor
12445you specify.  If you do not specify a processor type, GCC will default
12446to the processor on which the compiler was built.
12447
12448Supported values for @var{cpu_type} are
12449
12450@table @samp
12451@item ev4
12452@itemx ev45
12453@itemx 21064
12454Schedules as an EV4 and has no instruction set extensions.
12455
12456@item ev5
12457@itemx 21164
12458Schedules as an EV5 and has no instruction set extensions.
12459
12460@item ev56
12461@itemx 21164a
12462Schedules as an EV5 and supports the BWX extension.
12463
12464@item pca56
12465@itemx 21164pc
12466@itemx 21164PC
12467Schedules as an EV5 and supports the BWX and MAX extensions.
12468
12469@item ev6
12470@itemx 21264
12471Schedules as an EV6 and supports the BWX, FIX, and MAX extensions.
12472
12473@item ev67
12474@itemx 21264a
12475Schedules as an EV6 and supports the BWX, CIX, FIX, and MAX extensions.
12476@end table
12477
12478Native toolchains also support the value @samp{native},
12479which selects the best architecture option for the host processor.
12480@option{-mcpu=native} has no effect if GCC does not recognize
12481the processor.
12482
12483@item -mtune=@var{cpu_type}
12484@opindex mtune
12485Set only the instruction scheduling parameters for machine type
12486@var{cpu_type}.  The instruction set is not changed.
12487
12488Native toolchains also support the value @samp{native},
12489which selects the best architecture option for the host processor.
12490@option{-mtune=native} has no effect if GCC does not recognize
12491the processor.
12492
12493@item -mmemory-latency=@var{time}
12494@opindex mmemory-latency
12495Sets the latency the scheduler should assume for typical memory
12496references as seen by the application.  This number is highly
12497dependent on the memory access patterns used by the application
12498and the size of the external cache on the machine.
12499
12500Valid options for @var{time} are
12501
12502@table @samp
12503@item @var{number}
12504A decimal number representing clock cycles.
12505
12506@item L1
12507@itemx L2
12508@itemx L3
12509@itemx main
12510The compiler contains estimates of the number of clock cycles for
12511``typical'' EV4 & EV5 hardware for the Level 1, 2 & 3 caches
12512(also called Dcache, Scache, and Bcache), as well as to main memory.
12513Note that L3 is only valid for EV5.
12514
12515@end table
12516@end table
12517
12518@node DEC Alpha/VMS Options
12519@subsection DEC Alpha/VMS Options
12520
12521These @samp{-m} options are defined for the DEC Alpha/VMS implementations:
12522
12523@table @gcctabopt
12524@item -mvms-return-codes
12525@opindex mvms-return-codes
12526Return VMS condition codes from main.  The default is to return POSIX
12527style condition (e.g.@: error) codes.
12528
12529@item -mdebug-main=@var{prefix}
12530@opindex mdebug-main=@var{prefix}
12531Flag the first routine whose name starts with @var{prefix} as the main
12532routine for the debugger.
12533
12534@item -mmalloc64
12535@opindex mmalloc64
12536Default to 64-bit memory allocation routines.
12537@end table
12538
12539@node FR30 Options
12540@subsection FR30 Options
12541@cindex FR30 Options
12542
12543These options are defined specifically for the FR30 port.
12544
12545@table @gcctabopt
12546
12547@item -msmall-model
12548@opindex msmall-model
12549Use the small address space model.  This can produce smaller code, but
12550it does assume that all symbolic values and addresses will fit into a
1255120-bit range.
12552
12553@item -mno-lsim
12554@opindex mno-lsim
12555Assume that runtime support has been provided and so there is no need
12556to include the simulator library (@file{libsim.a}) on the linker
12557command line.
12558
12559@end table
12560
12561@node FRV Options
12562@subsection FRV Options
12563@cindex FRV Options
12564
12565@table @gcctabopt
12566@item -mgpr-32
12567@opindex mgpr-32
12568
12569Only use the first 32 general-purpose registers.
12570
12571@item -mgpr-64
12572@opindex mgpr-64
12573
12574Use all 64 general-purpose registers.
12575
12576@item -mfpr-32
12577@opindex mfpr-32
12578
12579Use only the first 32 floating-point registers.
12580
12581@item -mfpr-64
12582@opindex mfpr-64
12583
12584Use all 64 floating-point registers.
12585
12586@item -mhard-float
12587@opindex mhard-float
12588
12589Use hardware instructions for floating-point operations.
12590
12591@item -msoft-float
12592@opindex msoft-float
12593
12594Use library routines for floating-point operations.
12595
12596@item -malloc-cc
12597@opindex malloc-cc
12598
12599Dynamically allocate condition code registers.
12600
12601@item -mfixed-cc
12602@opindex mfixed-cc
12603
12604Do not try to dynamically allocate condition code registers, only
12605use @code{icc0} and @code{fcc0}.
12606
12607@item -mdword
12608@opindex mdword
12609
12610Change ABI to use double word insns.
12611
12612@item -mno-dword
12613@opindex mno-dword
12614
12615Do not use double word instructions.
12616
12617@item -mdouble
12618@opindex mdouble
12619
12620Use floating-point double instructions.
12621
12622@item -mno-double
12623@opindex mno-double
12624
12625Do not use floating-point double instructions.
12626
12627@item -mmedia
12628@opindex mmedia
12629
12630Use media instructions.
12631
12632@item -mno-media
12633@opindex mno-media
12634
12635Do not use media instructions.
12636
12637@item -mmuladd
12638@opindex mmuladd
12639
12640Use multiply and add/subtract instructions.
12641
12642@item -mno-muladd
12643@opindex mno-muladd
12644
12645Do not use multiply and add/subtract instructions.
12646
12647@item -mfdpic
12648@opindex mfdpic
12649
12650Select the FDPIC ABI, which uses function descriptors to represent
12651pointers to functions.  Without any PIC/PIE-related options, it
12652implies @option{-fPIE}.  With @option{-fpic} or @option{-fpie}, it
12653assumes GOT entries and small data are within a 12-bit range from the
12654GOT base address; with @option{-fPIC} or @option{-fPIE}, GOT offsets
12655are computed with 32 bits.
12656With a @samp{bfin-elf} target, this option implies @option{-msim}.
12657
12658@item -minline-plt
12659@opindex minline-plt
12660
12661Enable inlining of PLT entries in function calls to functions that are
12662not known to bind locally.  It has no effect without @option{-mfdpic}.
12663It's enabled by default if optimizing for speed and compiling for
12664shared libraries (i.e., @option{-fPIC} or @option{-fpic}), or when an
12665optimization option such as @option{-O3} or above is present in the
12666command line.
12667
12668@item -mTLS
12669@opindex mTLS
12670
12671Assume a large TLS segment when generating thread-local code.
12672
12673@item -mtls
12674@opindex mtls
12675
12676Do not assume a large TLS segment when generating thread-local code.
12677
12678@item -mgprel-ro
12679@opindex mgprel-ro
12680
12681Enable the use of @code{GPREL} relocations in the FDPIC ABI for data
12682that is known to be in read-only sections.  It's enabled by default,
12683except for @option{-fpic} or @option{-fpie}: even though it may help
12684make the global offset table smaller, it trades 1 instruction for 4.
12685With @option{-fPIC} or @option{-fPIE}, it trades 3 instructions for 4,
12686one of which may be shared by multiple symbols, and it avoids the need
12687for a GOT entry for the referenced symbol, so it's more likely to be a
12688win.  If it is not, @option{-mno-gprel-ro} can be used to disable it.
12689
12690@item -multilib-library-pic
12691@opindex multilib-library-pic
12692
12693Link with the (library, not FD) pic libraries.  It's implied by
12694@option{-mlibrary-pic}, as well as by @option{-fPIC} and
12695@option{-fpic} without @option{-mfdpic}.  You should never have to use
12696it explicitly.
12697
12698@item -mlinked-fp
12699@opindex mlinked-fp
12700
12701Follow the EABI requirement of always creating a frame pointer whenever
12702a stack frame is allocated.  This option is enabled by default and can
12703be disabled with @option{-mno-linked-fp}.
12704
12705@item -mlong-calls
12706@opindex mlong-calls
12707
12708Use indirect addressing to call functions outside the current
12709compilation unit.  This allows the functions to be placed anywhere
12710within the 32-bit address space.
12711
12712@item -malign-labels
12713@opindex malign-labels
12714
12715Try to align labels to an 8-byte boundary by inserting nops into the
12716previous packet.  This option only has an effect when VLIW packing
12717is enabled.  It doesn't create new packets; it merely adds nops to
12718existing ones.
12719
12720@item -mlibrary-pic
12721@opindex mlibrary-pic
12722
12723Generate position-independent EABI code.
12724
12725@item -macc-4
12726@opindex macc-4
12727
12728Use only the first four media accumulator registers.
12729
12730@item -macc-8
12731@opindex macc-8
12732
12733Use all eight media accumulator registers.
12734
12735@item -mpack
12736@opindex mpack
12737
12738Pack VLIW instructions.
12739
12740@item -mno-pack
12741@opindex mno-pack
12742
12743Do not pack VLIW instructions.
12744
12745@item -mno-eflags
12746@opindex mno-eflags
12747
12748Do not mark ABI switches in e_flags.
12749
12750@item -mcond-move
12751@opindex mcond-move
12752
12753Enable the use of conditional-move instructions (default).
12754
12755This switch is mainly for debugging the compiler and will likely be removed
12756in a future version.
12757
12758@item -mno-cond-move
12759@opindex mno-cond-move
12760
12761Disable the use of conditional-move instructions.
12762
12763This switch is mainly for debugging the compiler and will likely be removed
12764in a future version.
12765
12766@item -mscc
12767@opindex mscc
12768
12769Enable the use of conditional set instructions (default).
12770
12771This switch is mainly for debugging the compiler and will likely be removed
12772in a future version.
12773
12774@item -mno-scc
12775@opindex mno-scc
12776
12777Disable the use of conditional set instructions.
12778
12779This switch is mainly for debugging the compiler and will likely be removed
12780in a future version.
12781
12782@item -mcond-exec
12783@opindex mcond-exec
12784
12785Enable the use of conditional execution (default).
12786
12787This switch is mainly for debugging the compiler and will likely be removed
12788in a future version.
12789
12790@item -mno-cond-exec
12791@opindex mno-cond-exec
12792
12793Disable the use of conditional execution.
12794
12795This switch is mainly for debugging the compiler and will likely be removed
12796in a future version.
12797
12798@item -mvliw-branch
12799@opindex mvliw-branch
12800
12801Run a pass to pack branches into VLIW instructions (default).
12802
12803This switch is mainly for debugging the compiler and will likely be removed
12804in a future version.
12805
12806@item -mno-vliw-branch
12807@opindex mno-vliw-branch
12808
12809Do not run a pass to pack branches into VLIW instructions.
12810
12811This switch is mainly for debugging the compiler and will likely be removed
12812in a future version.
12813
12814@item -mmulti-cond-exec
12815@opindex mmulti-cond-exec
12816
12817Enable optimization of @code{&&} and @code{||} in conditional execution
12818(default).
12819
12820This switch is mainly for debugging the compiler and will likely be removed
12821in a future version.
12822
12823@item -mno-multi-cond-exec
12824@opindex mno-multi-cond-exec
12825
12826Disable optimization of @code{&&} and @code{||} in conditional execution.
12827
12828This switch is mainly for debugging the compiler and will likely be removed
12829in a future version.
12830
12831@item -mnested-cond-exec
12832@opindex mnested-cond-exec
12833
12834Enable nested conditional execution optimizations (default).
12835
12836This switch is mainly for debugging the compiler and will likely be removed
12837in a future version.
12838
12839@item -mno-nested-cond-exec
12840@opindex mno-nested-cond-exec
12841
12842Disable nested conditional execution optimizations.
12843
12844This switch is mainly for debugging the compiler and will likely be removed
12845in a future version.
12846
12847@item -moptimize-membar
12848@opindex moptimize-membar
12849
12850This switch removes redundant @code{membar} instructions from the
12851compiler generated code.  It is enabled by default.
12852
12853@item -mno-optimize-membar
12854@opindex mno-optimize-membar
12855
12856This switch disables the automatic removal of redundant @code{membar}
12857instructions from the generated code.
12858
12859@item -mtomcat-stats
12860@opindex mtomcat-stats
12861
12862Cause gas to print out tomcat statistics.
12863
12864@item -mcpu=@var{cpu}
12865@opindex mcpu
12866
12867Select the processor type for which to generate code.  Possible values are
12868@samp{frv}, @samp{fr550}, @samp{tomcat}, @samp{fr500}, @samp{fr450},
12869@samp{fr405}, @samp{fr400}, @samp{fr300} and @samp{simple}.
12870
12871@end table
12872
12873@node GNU/Linux Options
12874@subsection GNU/Linux Options
12875
12876These @samp{-m} options are defined for GNU/Linux targets:
12877
12878@table @gcctabopt
12879@item -mglibc
12880@opindex mglibc
12881Use the GNU C library.  This is the default except
12882on @samp{*-*-linux-*uclibc*} and @samp{*-*-linux-*android*} targets.
12883
12884@item -muclibc
12885@opindex muclibc
12886Use uClibc C library.  This is the default on
12887@samp{*-*-linux-*uclibc*} targets.
12888
12889@item -mbionic
12890@opindex mbionic
12891Use Bionic C library.  This is the default on
12892@samp{*-*-linux-*android*} targets.
12893
12894@item -mandroid
12895@opindex mandroid
12896Compile code compatible with Android platform.  This is the default on
12897@samp{*-*-linux-*android*} targets.
12898
12899When compiling, this option enables @option{-mbionic}, @option{-fPIC},
12900@option{-fno-exceptions} and @option{-fno-rtti} by default.  When linking,
12901this option makes the GCC driver pass Android-specific options to the linker.
12902Finally, this option causes the preprocessor macro @code{__ANDROID__}
12903to be defined.
12904
12905@item -tno-android-cc
12906@opindex tno-android-cc
12907Disable compilation effects of @option{-mandroid}, i.e., do not enable
12908@option{-mbionic}, @option{-fPIC}, @option{-fno-exceptions} and
12909@option{-fno-rtti} by default.
12910
12911@item -tno-android-ld
12912@opindex tno-android-ld
12913Disable linking effects of @option{-mandroid}, i.e., pass standard Linux
12914linking options to the linker.
12915
12916@end table
12917
12918@node H8/300 Options
12919@subsection H8/300 Options
12920
12921These @samp{-m} options are defined for the H8/300 implementations:
12922
12923@table @gcctabopt
12924@item -mrelax
12925@opindex mrelax
12926Shorten some address references at link time, when possible; uses the
12927linker option @option{-relax}.  @xref{H8/300,, @code{ld} and the H8/300,
12928ld, Using ld}, for a fuller description.
12929
12930@item -mh
12931@opindex mh
12932Generate code for the H8/300H@.
12933
12934@item -ms
12935@opindex ms
12936Generate code for the H8S@.
12937
12938@item -mn
12939@opindex mn
12940Generate code for the H8S and H8/300H in the normal mode.  This switch
12941must be used either with @option{-mh} or @option{-ms}.
12942
12943@item -ms2600
12944@opindex ms2600
12945Generate code for the H8S/2600.  This switch must be used with @option{-ms}.
12946
12947@item -mint32
12948@opindex mint32
12949Make @code{int} data 32 bits by default.
12950
12951@item -malign-300
12952@opindex malign-300
12953On the H8/300H and H8S, use the same alignment rules as for the H8/300.
12954The default for the H8/300H and H8S is to align longs and floats on
129554-byte boundaries.
12956@option{-malign-300} causes them to be aligned on 2-byte boundaries.
12957This option has no effect on the H8/300.
12958@end table
12959
12960@node HPPA Options
12961@subsection HPPA Options
12962@cindex HPPA Options
12963
12964These @samp{-m} options are defined for the HPPA family of computers:
12965
12966@table @gcctabopt
12967@item -march=@var{architecture-type}
12968@opindex march
12969Generate code for the specified architecture.  The choices for
12970@var{architecture-type} are @samp{1.0} for PA 1.0, @samp{1.1} for PA
129711.1, and @samp{2.0} for PA 2.0 processors.  Refer to
12972@file{/usr/lib/sched.models} on an HP-UX system to determine the proper
12973architecture option for your machine.  Code compiled for lower numbered
12974architectures will run on higher numbered architectures, but not the
12975other way around.
12976
12977@item -mpa-risc-1-0
12978@itemx -mpa-risc-1-1
12979@itemx -mpa-risc-2-0
12980@opindex mpa-risc-1-0
12981@opindex mpa-risc-1-1
12982@opindex mpa-risc-2-0
12983Synonyms for @option{-march=1.0}, @option{-march=1.1}, and @option{-march=2.0} respectively.
12984
12985@item -mbig-switch
12986@opindex mbig-switch
12987Generate code suitable for big switch tables.  Use this option only if
12988the assembler/linker complain about out of range branches within a switch
12989table.
12990
12991@item -mjump-in-delay
12992@opindex mjump-in-delay
12993Fill delay slots of function calls with unconditional jump instructions
12994by modifying the return pointer for the function call to be the target
12995of the conditional jump.
12996
12997@item -mdisable-fpregs
12998@opindex mdisable-fpregs
12999Prevent floating-point registers from being used in any manner.  This is
13000necessary for compiling kernels that perform lazy context switching of
13001floating-point registers.  If you use this option and attempt to perform
13002floating-point operations, the compiler aborts.
13003
13004@item -mdisable-indexing
13005@opindex mdisable-indexing
13006Prevent the compiler from using indexing address modes.  This avoids some
13007rather obscure problems when compiling MIG generated code under MACH@.
13008
13009@item -mno-space-regs
13010@opindex mno-space-regs
13011Generate code that assumes the target has no space registers.  This allows
13012GCC to generate faster indirect calls and use unscaled index address modes.
13013
13014Such code is suitable for level 0 PA systems and kernels.
13015
13016@item -mfast-indirect-calls
13017@opindex mfast-indirect-calls
13018Generate code that assumes calls never cross space boundaries.  This
13019allows GCC to emit code that performs faster indirect calls.
13020
13021This option will not work in the presence of shared libraries or nested
13022functions.
13023
13024@item -mfixed-range=@var{register-range}
13025@opindex mfixed-range
13026Generate code treating the given register range as fixed registers.
13027A fixed register is one that the register allocator can not use.  This is
13028useful when compiling kernel code.  A register range is specified as
13029two registers separated by a dash.  Multiple register ranges can be
13030specified separated by a comma.
13031
13032@item -mlong-load-store
13033@opindex mlong-load-store
13034Generate 3-instruction load and store sequences as sometimes required by
13035the HP-UX 10 linker.  This is equivalent to the @samp{+k} option to
13036the HP compilers.
13037
13038@item -mportable-runtime
13039@opindex mportable-runtime
13040Use the portable calling conventions proposed by HP for ELF systems.
13041
13042@item -mgas
13043@opindex mgas
13044Enable the use of assembler directives only GAS understands.
13045
13046@item -mschedule=@var{cpu-type}
13047@opindex mschedule
13048Schedule code according to the constraints for the machine type
13049@var{cpu-type}.  The choices for @var{cpu-type} are @samp{700}
13050@samp{7100}, @samp{7100LC}, @samp{7200}, @samp{7300} and @samp{8000}.  Refer
13051to @file{/usr/lib/sched.models} on an HP-UX system to determine the
13052proper scheduling option for your machine.  The default scheduling is
13053@samp{8000}.
13054
13055@item -mlinker-opt
13056@opindex mlinker-opt
13057Enable the optimization pass in the HP-UX linker.  Note this makes symbolic
13058debugging impossible.  It also triggers a bug in the HP-UX 8 and HP-UX 9
13059linkers in which they give bogus error messages when linking some programs.
13060
13061@item -msoft-float
13062@opindex msoft-float
13063Generate output containing library calls for floating point.
13064@strong{Warning:} the requisite libraries are not available for all HPPA
13065targets.  Normally the facilities of the machine's usual C compiler are
13066used, but this cannot be done directly in cross-compilation.  You must make
13067your own arrangements to provide suitable library functions for
13068cross-compilation.
13069
13070@option{-msoft-float} changes the calling convention in the output file;
13071therefore, it is only useful if you compile @emph{all} of a program with
13072this option.  In particular, you need to compile @file{libgcc.a}, the
13073library that comes with GCC, with @option{-msoft-float} in order for
13074this to work.
13075
13076@item -msio
13077@opindex msio
13078Generate the predefine, @code{_SIO}, for server IO@.  The default is
13079@option{-mwsio}.  This generates the predefines, @code{__hp9000s700},
13080@code{__hp9000s700__} and @code{_WSIO}, for workstation IO@.  These
13081options are available under HP-UX and HI-UX@.
13082
13083@item -mgnu-ld
13084@opindex mgnu-ld
13085Use GNU ld specific options.  This passes @option{-shared} to ld when
13086building a shared library.  It is the default when GCC is configured,
13087explicitly or implicitly, with the GNU linker.  This option does not
13088have any affect on which ld is called, it only changes what parameters
13089are passed to that ld.  The ld that is called is determined by the
13090@option{--with-ld} configure option, GCC's program search path, and
13091finally by the user's @env{PATH}.  The linker used by GCC can be printed
13092using @samp{which `gcc -print-prog-name=ld`}.  This option is only available
13093on the 64-bit HP-UX GCC, i.e.@: configured with @samp{hppa*64*-*-hpux*}.
13094
13095@item -mhp-ld
13096@opindex mhp-ld
13097Use HP ld specific options.  This passes @option{-b} to ld when building
13098a shared library and passes @option{+Accept TypeMismatch} to ld on all
13099links.  It is the default when GCC is configured, explicitly or
13100implicitly, with the HP linker.  This option does not have any affect on
13101which ld is called, it only changes what parameters are passed to that
13102ld.  The ld that is called is determined by the @option{--with-ld}
13103configure option, GCC's program search path, and finally by the user's
13104@env{PATH}.  The linker used by GCC can be printed using @samp{which
13105`gcc -print-prog-name=ld`}.  This option is only available on the 64-bit
13106HP-UX GCC, i.e.@: configured with @samp{hppa*64*-*-hpux*}.
13107
13108@item -mlong-calls
13109@opindex mno-long-calls
13110Generate code that uses long call sequences.  This ensures that a call
13111is always able to reach linker generated stubs.  The default is to generate
13112long calls only when the distance from the call site to the beginning
13113of the function or translation unit, as the case may be, exceeds a
13114predefined limit set by the branch type being used.  The limits for
13115normal calls are 7,600,000 and 240,000 bytes, respectively for the
13116PA 2.0 and PA 1.X architectures.  Sibcalls are always limited at
13117240,000 bytes.
13118
13119Distances are measured from the beginning of functions when using the
13120@option{-ffunction-sections} option, or when using the @option{-mgas}
13121and @option{-mno-portable-runtime} options together under HP-UX with
13122the SOM linker.
13123
13124It is normally not desirable to use this option as it will degrade
13125performance.  However, it may be useful in large applications,
13126particularly when partial linking is used to build the application.
13127
13128The types of long calls used depends on the capabilities of the
13129assembler and linker, and the type of code being generated.  The
13130impact on systems that support long absolute calls, and long pic
13131symbol-difference or pc-relative calls should be relatively small.
13132However, an indirect call is used on 32-bit ELF systems in pic code
13133and it is quite long.
13134
13135@item -munix=@var{unix-std}
13136@opindex march
13137Generate compiler predefines and select a startfile for the specified
13138UNIX standard.  The choices for @var{unix-std} are @samp{93}, @samp{95}
13139and @samp{98}.  @samp{93} is supported on all HP-UX versions.  @samp{95}
13140is available on HP-UX 10.10 and later.  @samp{98} is available on HP-UX
1314111.11 and later.  The default values are @samp{93} for HP-UX 10.00,
13142@samp{95} for HP-UX 10.10 though to 11.00, and @samp{98} for HP-UX 11.11
13143and later.
13144
13145@option{-munix=93} provides the same predefines as GCC 3.3 and 3.4.
13146@option{-munix=95} provides additional predefines for @code{XOPEN_UNIX}
13147and @code{_XOPEN_SOURCE_EXTENDED}, and the startfile @file{unix95.o}.
13148@option{-munix=98} provides additional predefines for @code{_XOPEN_UNIX},
13149@code{_XOPEN_SOURCE_EXTENDED}, @code{_INCLUDE__STDC_A1_SOURCE} and
13150@code{_INCLUDE_XOPEN_SOURCE_500}, and the startfile @file{unix98.o}.
13151
13152It is @emph{important} to note that this option changes the interfaces
13153for various library routines.  It also affects the operational behavior
13154of the C library.  Thus, @emph{extreme} care is needed in using this
13155option.
13156
13157Library code that is intended to operate with more than one UNIX
13158standard must test, set and restore the variable @var{__xpg4_extended_mask}
13159as appropriate.  Most GNU software doesn't provide this capability.
13160
13161@item -nolibdld
13162@opindex nolibdld
13163Suppress the generation of link options to search libdld.sl when the
13164@option{-static} option is specified on HP-UX 10 and later.
13165
13166@item -static
13167@opindex static
13168The HP-UX implementation of setlocale in libc has a dependency on
13169libdld.sl.  There isn't an archive version of libdld.sl.  Thus,
13170when the @option{-static} option is specified, special link options
13171are needed to resolve this dependency.
13172
13173On HP-UX 10 and later, the GCC driver adds the necessary options to
13174link with libdld.sl when the @option{-static} option is specified.
13175This causes the resulting binary to be dynamic.  On the 64-bit port,
13176the linkers generate dynamic binaries by default in any case.  The
13177@option{-nolibdld} option can be used to prevent the GCC driver from
13178adding these link options.
13179
13180@item -threads
13181@opindex threads
13182Add support for multithreading with the @dfn{dce thread} library
13183under HP-UX@.  This option sets flags for both the preprocessor and
13184linker.
13185@end table
13186
13187@node i386 and x86-64 Options
13188@subsection Intel 386 and AMD x86-64 Options
13189@cindex i386 Options
13190@cindex x86-64 Options
13191@cindex Intel 386 Options
13192@cindex AMD x86-64 Options
13193
13194These @samp{-m} options are defined for the i386 and x86-64 family of
13195computers:
13196
13197@table @gcctabopt
13198@item -mtune=@var{cpu-type}
13199@opindex mtune
13200Tune to @var{cpu-type} everything applicable about the generated code, except
13201for the ABI and the set of available instructions.  The choices for
13202@var{cpu-type} are:
13203@table @emph
13204@item generic
13205Produce code optimized for the most common IA32/@/AMD64/@/EM64T processors.
13206If you know the CPU on which your code will run, then you should use
13207the corresponding @option{-mtune} option instead of
13208@option{-mtune=generic}.  But, if you do not know exactly what CPU users
13209of your application will have, then you should use this option.
13210
13211As new processors are deployed in the marketplace, the behavior of this
13212option will change.  Therefore, if you upgrade to a newer version of
13213GCC, the code generated option will change to reflect the processors
13214that were most common when that version of GCC was released.
13215
13216There is no @option{-march=generic} option because @option{-march}
13217indicates the instruction set the compiler can use, and there is no
13218generic instruction set applicable to all processors.  In contrast,
13219@option{-mtune} indicates the processor (or, in this case, collection of
13220processors) for which the code is optimized.
13221@item native
13222This selects the CPU to tune for at compilation time by determining
13223the processor type of the compiling machine.  Using @option{-mtune=native}
13224will produce code optimized for the local machine under the constraints
13225of the selected instruction set.  Using @option{-march=native} will
13226enable all instruction subsets supported by the local machine (hence
13227the result might not run on different machines).
13228@item i386
13229Original Intel's i386 CPU@.
13230@item i486
13231Intel's i486 CPU@.  (No scheduling is implemented for this chip.)
13232@item i586, pentium
13233Intel Pentium CPU with no MMX support.
13234@item pentium-mmx
13235Intel PentiumMMX CPU based on Pentium core with MMX instruction set support.
13236@item pentiumpro
13237Intel PentiumPro CPU@.
13238@item i686
13239Same as @code{generic}, but when used as @code{march} option, PentiumPro
13240instruction set will be used, so the code will run on all i686 family chips.
13241@item pentium2
13242Intel Pentium2 CPU based on PentiumPro core with MMX instruction set support.
13243@item pentium3, pentium3m
13244Intel Pentium3 CPU based on PentiumPro core with MMX and SSE instruction set
13245support.
13246@item pentium-m
13247Low power version of Intel Pentium3 CPU with MMX, SSE and SSE2 instruction set
13248support.  Used by Centrino notebooks.
13249@item pentium4, pentium4m
13250Intel Pentium4 CPU with MMX, SSE and SSE2 instruction set support.
13251@item prescott
13252Improved version of Intel Pentium4 CPU with MMX, SSE, SSE2 and SSE3 instruction
13253set support.
13254@item nocona
13255Improved version of Intel Pentium4 CPU with 64-bit extensions, MMX, SSE,
13256SSE2 and SSE3 instruction set support.
13257@item core2
13258Intel Core2 CPU with 64-bit extensions, MMX, SSE, SSE2, SSE3 and SSSE3
13259instruction set support.
13260@item corei7
13261Intel Core i7 CPU with 64-bit extensions, MMX, SSE, SSE2, SSE3, SSSE3, SSE4.1
13262and SSE4.2 instruction set support.
13263@item corei7-avx
13264Intel Core i7 CPU with 64-bit extensions, MMX, SSE, SSE2, SSE3, SSSE3,
13265SSE4.1, SSE4.2, AVX, AES and PCLMUL instruction set support.
13266@item core-avx-i
13267Intel Core CPU with 64-bit extensions, MMX, SSE, SSE2, SSE3, SSSE3,
13268SSE4.1, SSE4.2, AVX, AES, PCLMUL, FSGSBASE, RDRND and F16C instruction
13269set support.
13270@item atom
13271Intel Atom CPU with 64-bit extensions, MMX, SSE, SSE2, SSE3 and SSSE3
13272instruction set support.
13273@item k6
13274AMD K6 CPU with MMX instruction set support.
13275@item k6-2, k6-3
13276Improved versions of AMD K6 CPU with MMX and 3DNow!@: instruction set support.
13277@item athlon, athlon-tbird
13278AMD Athlon CPU with MMX, 3dNOW!, enhanced 3DNow!@: and SSE prefetch instructions
13279support.
13280@item athlon-4, athlon-xp, athlon-mp
13281Improved AMD Athlon CPU with MMX, 3DNow!, enhanced 3DNow!@: and full SSE
13282instruction set support.
13283@item k8, opteron, athlon64, athlon-fx
13284AMD K8 core based CPUs with x86-64 instruction set support.  (This supersets
13285MMX, SSE, SSE2, 3DNow!, enhanced 3DNow!@: and 64-bit instruction set extensions.)
13286@item k8-sse3, opteron-sse3, athlon64-sse3
13287Improved versions of k8, opteron and athlon64 with SSE3 instruction set support.
13288@item amdfam10, barcelona
13289AMD Family 10h core based CPUs with x86-64 instruction set support.  (This
13290supersets MMX, SSE, SSE2, SSE3, SSE4A, 3DNow!, enhanced 3DNow!, ABM and 64-bit
13291instruction set extensions.)
13292@item bdver1
13293AMD Family 15h core based CPUs with x86-64 instruction set support.  (This
13294supersets FMA4, AVX, XOP, LWP, AES, PCL_MUL, CX16, MMX, SSE, SSE2, SSE3, SSE4A,
13295SSSE3, SSE4.1, SSE4.2, ABM and 64-bit instruction set extensions.)
13296@item bdver2
13297AMD Family 15h core based CPUs with x86-64 instruction set support.  (This
13298supersets BMI, TBM, F16C, FMA, AVX, XOP, LWP, AES, PCL_MUL, CX16, MMX, SSE,
13299SSE2, SSE3, SSE4A, SSSE3, SSE4.1, SSE4.2, ABM and 64-bit instruction set
13300extensions.)
13301@item btver1
13302AMD Family 14h core based CPUs with x86-64 instruction set support.  (This
13303supersets MMX, SSE, SSE2, SSE3, SSSE3, SSE4A, CX16, ABM and 64-bit
13304instruction set extensions.)
13305@item winchip-c6
13306IDT Winchip C6 CPU, dealt in same way as i486 with additional MMX instruction
13307set support.
13308@item winchip2
13309IDT Winchip2 CPU, dealt in same way as i486 with additional MMX and 3DNow!@:
13310instruction set support.
13311@item c3
13312Via C3 CPU with MMX and 3DNow!@: instruction set support.  (No scheduling is
13313implemented for this chip.)
13314@item c3-2
13315Via C3-2 CPU with MMX and SSE instruction set support.  (No scheduling is
13316implemented for this chip.)
13317@item geode
13318Embedded AMD CPU with MMX and 3DNow!@: instruction set support.
13319@end table
13320
13321While picking a specific @var{cpu-type} will schedule things appropriately
13322for that particular chip, the compiler will not generate any code that
13323does not run on the default machine type without the @option{-march=@var{cpu-type}}
13324option being used. For example, if GCC is configured for i686-pc-linux-gnu
13325then @option{-mtune=pentium4} will generate code that is tuned for Pentium4
13326but will still run on i686 machines.
13327
13328@item -march=@var{cpu-type}
13329@opindex march
13330Generate instructions for the machine type @var{cpu-type}.  The choices
13331for @var{cpu-type} are the same as for @option{-mtune}.  Moreover,
13332specifying @option{-march=@var{cpu-type}} implies @option{-mtune=@var{cpu-type}}.
13333
13334@item -mcpu=@var{cpu-type}
13335@opindex mcpu
13336A deprecated synonym for @option{-mtune}.
13337
13338@item -mfpmath=@var{unit}
13339@opindex mfpmath
13340Generate floating-point arithmetic for selected unit @var{unit}.  The choices
13341for @var{unit} are:
13342
13343@table @samp
13344@item 387
13345Use the standard 387 floating-point coprocessor present on the majority of chips and
13346emulated otherwise.  Code compiled with this option runs almost everywhere.
13347The temporary results are computed in 80-bit precision instead of the precision
13348specified by the type, resulting in slightly different results compared to most
13349of other chips.  See @option{-ffloat-store} for more detailed description.
13350
13351This is the default choice for i386 compiler.
13352
13353@item sse
13354Use scalar floating-point instructions present in the SSE instruction set.
13355This instruction set is supported by Pentium3 and newer chips, in the AMD line
13356by Athlon-4, Athlon-xp and Athlon-mp chips.  The earlier version of SSE
13357instruction set supports only single-precision arithmetic, thus the double and
13358extended-precision arithmetic are still done using 387.  A later version, present
13359only in Pentium4 and the future AMD x86-64 chips, supports double-precision
13360arithmetic too.
13361
13362For the i386 compiler, you need to use @option{-march=@var{cpu-type}}, @option{-msse}
13363or @option{-msse2} switches to enable SSE extensions and make this option
13364effective.  For the x86-64 compiler, these extensions are enabled by default.
13365
13366The resulting code should be considerably faster in the majority of cases and avoid
13367the numerical instability problems of 387 code, but may break some existing
13368code that expects temporaries to be 80 bits.
13369
13370This is the default choice for the x86-64 compiler.
13371
13372@item sse,387
13373@itemx sse+387
13374@itemx both
13375Attempt to utilize both instruction sets at once.  This effectively double the
13376amount of available registers and on chips with separate execution units for
13377387 and SSE the execution resources too.  Use this option with care, as it is
13378still experimental, because the GCC register allocator does not model separate
13379functional units well resulting in instable performance.
13380@end table
13381
13382@item -masm=@var{dialect}
13383@opindex masm=@var{dialect}
13384Output asm instructions using selected @var{dialect}.  Supported
13385choices are @samp{intel} or @samp{att} (the default one).  Darwin does
13386not support @samp{intel}.
13387
13388@item -mieee-fp
13389@itemx -mno-ieee-fp
13390@opindex mieee-fp
13391@opindex mno-ieee-fp
13392Control whether or not the compiler uses IEEE floating-point
13393comparisons.  These handle correctly the case where the result of a
13394comparison is unordered.
13395
13396@item -msoft-float
13397@opindex msoft-float
13398Generate output containing library calls for floating point.
13399@strong{Warning:} the requisite libraries are not part of GCC@.
13400Normally the facilities of the machine's usual C compiler are used, but
13401this can't be done directly in cross-compilation.  You must make your
13402own arrangements to provide suitable library functions for
13403cross-compilation.
13404
13405On machines where a function returns floating-point results in the 80387
13406register stack, some floating-point opcodes may be emitted even if
13407@option{-msoft-float} is used.
13408
13409@item -mno-fp-ret-in-387
13410@opindex mno-fp-ret-in-387
13411Do not use the FPU registers for return values of functions.
13412
13413The usual calling convention has functions return values of types
13414@code{float} and @code{double} in an FPU register, even if there
13415is no FPU@.  The idea is that the operating system should emulate
13416an FPU@.
13417
13418The option @option{-mno-fp-ret-in-387} causes such values to be returned
13419in ordinary CPU registers instead.
13420
13421@item -mno-fancy-math-387
13422@opindex mno-fancy-math-387
13423Some 387 emulators do not support the @code{sin}, @code{cos} and
13424@code{sqrt} instructions for the 387.  Specify this option to avoid
13425generating those instructions.  This option is the default on FreeBSD,
13426OpenBSD and NetBSD@.  This option is overridden when @option{-march}
13427indicates that the target CPU will always have an FPU and so the
13428instruction will not need emulation.  As of revision 2.6.1, these
13429instructions are not generated unless you also use the
13430@option{-funsafe-math-optimizations} switch.
13431
13432@item -malign-double
13433@itemx -mno-align-double
13434@opindex malign-double
13435@opindex mno-align-double
13436Control whether GCC aligns @code{double}, @code{long double}, and
13437@code{long long} variables on a two-word boundary or a one-word
13438boundary.  Aligning @code{double} variables on a two-word boundary
13439produces code that runs somewhat faster on a @samp{Pentium} at the
13440expense of more memory.
13441
13442On x86-64, @option{-malign-double} is enabled by default.
13443
13444@strong{Warning:} if you use the @option{-malign-double} switch,
13445structures containing the above types will be aligned differently than
13446the published application binary interface specifications for the 386
13447and will not be binary compatible with structures in code compiled
13448without that switch.
13449
13450@item -m96bit-long-double
13451@itemx -m128bit-long-double
13452@opindex m96bit-long-double
13453@opindex m128bit-long-double
13454These switches control the size of @code{long double} type.  The i386
13455application binary interface specifies the size to be 96 bits,
13456so @option{-m96bit-long-double} is the default in 32-bit mode.
13457
13458Modern architectures (Pentium and newer) prefer @code{long double}
13459to be aligned to an 8- or 16-byte boundary.  In arrays or structures
13460conforming to the ABI, this is not possible.  So specifying
13461@option{-m128bit-long-double} aligns @code{long double}
13462to a 16-byte boundary by padding the @code{long double} with an additional
1346332-bit zero.
13464
13465In the x86-64 compiler, @option{-m128bit-long-double} is the default choice as
13466its ABI specifies that @code{long double} is to be aligned on 16-byte boundary.
13467
13468Notice that neither of these options enable any extra precision over the x87
13469standard of 80 bits for a @code{long double}.
13470
13471@strong{Warning:} if you override the default value for your target ABI, the
13472structures and arrays containing @code{long double} variables will change
13473their size as well as function calling convention for function taking
13474@code{long double} will be modified.  Hence they will not be binary
13475compatible with arrays or structures in code compiled without that switch.
13476
13477@item -mlarge-data-threshold=@var{number}
13478@opindex mlarge-data-threshold=@var{number}
13479When @option{-mcmodel=medium} is specified, the data greater than
13480@var{threshold} are placed in large data section.  This value must be the
13481same across all object linked into the binary and defaults to 65535.
13482
13483@item -mrtd
13484@opindex mrtd
13485Use a different function-calling convention, in which functions that
13486take a fixed number of arguments return with the @code{ret} @var{num}
13487instruction, which pops their arguments while returning.  This saves one
13488instruction in the caller since there is no need to pop the arguments
13489there.
13490
13491You can specify that an individual function is called with this calling
13492sequence with the function attribute @samp{stdcall}.  You can also
13493override the @option{-mrtd} option by using the function attribute
13494@samp{cdecl}.  @xref{Function Attributes}.
13495
13496@strong{Warning:} this calling convention is incompatible with the one
13497normally used on Unix, so you cannot use it if you need to call
13498libraries compiled with the Unix compiler.
13499
13500Also, you must provide function prototypes for all functions that
13501take variable numbers of arguments (including @code{printf});
13502otherwise incorrect code will be generated for calls to those
13503functions.
13504
13505In addition, seriously incorrect code will result if you call a
13506function with too many arguments.  (Normally, extra arguments are
13507harmlessly ignored.)
13508
13509@item -mregparm=@var{num}
13510@opindex mregparm
13511Control how many registers are used to pass integer arguments.  By
13512default, no registers are used to pass arguments, and at most 3
13513registers can be used.  You can control this behavior for a specific
13514function by using the function attribute @samp{regparm}.
13515@xref{Function Attributes}.
13516
13517@strong{Warning:} if you use this switch, and
13518@var{num} is nonzero, then you must build all modules with the same
13519value, including any libraries.  This includes the system libraries and
13520startup modules.
13521
13522@item -msseregparm
13523@opindex msseregparm
13524Use SSE register passing conventions for float and double arguments
13525and return values.  You can control this behavior for a specific
13526function by using the function attribute @samp{sseregparm}.
13527@xref{Function Attributes}.
13528
13529@strong{Warning:} if you use this switch then you must build all
13530modules with the same value, including any libraries.  This includes
13531the system libraries and startup modules.
13532
13533@item -mvect8-ret-in-mem
13534@opindex mvect8-ret-in-mem
13535Return 8-byte vectors in memory instead of MMX registers.  This is the
13536default on Solaris@tie{}8 and 9 and VxWorks to match the ABI of the Sun
13537Studio compilers until version 12.  Later compiler versions (starting
13538with Studio 12 Update@tie{}1) follow the ABI used by other x86 targets, which
13539is the default on Solaris@tie{}10 and later.  @emph{Only} use this option if
13540you need to remain compatible with existing code produced by those
13541previous compiler versions or older versions of GCC.
13542
13543@item -mpc32
13544@itemx -mpc64
13545@itemx -mpc80
13546@opindex mpc32
13547@opindex mpc64
13548@opindex mpc80
13549
13550Set 80387 floating-point precision to 32, 64 or 80 bits.  When @option{-mpc32}
13551is specified, the significands of results of floating-point operations are
13552rounded to 24 bits (single precision); @option{-mpc64} rounds the
13553significands of results of floating-point operations to 53 bits (double
13554precision) and @option{-mpc80} rounds the significands of results of
13555floating-point operations to 64 bits (extended double precision), which is
13556the default.  When this option is used, floating-point operations in higher
13557precisions are not available to the programmer without setting the FPU
13558control word explicitly.
13559
13560Setting the rounding of floating-point operations to less than the default
1356180 bits can speed some programs by 2% or more.  Note that some mathematical
13562libraries assume that extended-precision (80-bit) floating-point operations
13563are enabled by default; routines in such libraries could suffer significant
13564loss of accuracy, typically through so-called "catastrophic cancellation",
13565when this option is used to set the precision to less than extended precision.
13566
13567@item -mstackrealign
13568@opindex mstackrealign
13569Realign the stack at entry.  On the Intel x86, the @option{-mstackrealign}
13570option will generate an alternate prologue and epilogue that realigns the
13571run-time stack if necessary.  This supports mixing legacy codes that keep
13572a 4-byte aligned stack with modern codes that keep a 16-byte stack for
13573SSE compatibility.  See also the attribute @code{force_align_arg_pointer},
13574applicable to individual functions.
13575
13576@item -mpreferred-stack-boundary=@var{num}
13577@opindex mpreferred-stack-boundary
13578Attempt to keep the stack boundary aligned to a 2 raised to @var{num}
13579byte boundary.  If @option{-mpreferred-stack-boundary} is not specified,
13580the default is 4 (16 bytes or 128 bits).
13581
13582@item -mincoming-stack-boundary=@var{num}
13583@opindex mincoming-stack-boundary
13584Assume the incoming stack is aligned to a 2 raised to @var{num} byte
13585boundary.  If @option{-mincoming-stack-boundary} is not specified,
13586the one specified by @option{-mpreferred-stack-boundary} will be used.
13587
13588On Pentium and PentiumPro, @code{double} and @code{long double} values
13589should be aligned to an 8-byte boundary (see @option{-malign-double}) or
13590suffer significant run time performance penalties.  On Pentium III, the
13591Streaming SIMD Extension (SSE) data type @code{__m128} may not work
13592properly if it is not 16-byte aligned.
13593
13594To ensure proper alignment of this values on the stack, the stack boundary
13595must be as aligned as that required by any value stored on the stack.
13596Further, every function must be generated such that it keeps the stack
13597aligned.  Thus calling a function compiled with a higher preferred
13598stack boundary from a function compiled with a lower preferred stack
13599boundary will most likely misalign the stack.  It is recommended that
13600libraries that use callbacks always use the default setting.
13601
13602This extra alignment does consume extra stack space, and generally
13603increases code size.  Code that is sensitive to stack space usage, such
13604as embedded systems and operating system kernels, may want to reduce the
13605preferred alignment to @option{-mpreferred-stack-boundary=2}.
13606
13607@item -mmmx
13608@itemx -mno-mmx
13609@itemx -msse
13610@itemx -mno-sse
13611@itemx -msse2
13612@itemx -mno-sse2
13613@itemx -msse3
13614@itemx -mno-sse3
13615@itemx -mssse3
13616@itemx -mno-ssse3
13617@itemx -msse4.1
13618@need 800
13619@itemx -mno-sse4.1
13620@itemx -msse4.2
13621@itemx -mno-sse4.2
13622@itemx -msse4
13623@itemx -mno-sse4
13624@itemx -mavx
13625@itemx -mno-avx
13626@itemx -mavx2
13627@itemx -mno-avx2
13628@itemx -maes
13629@itemx -mno-aes
13630@itemx -mpclmul
13631@need 800
13632@itemx -mno-pclmul
13633@itemx -mfsgsbase
13634@itemx -mno-fsgsbase
13635@itemx -mrdrnd
13636@itemx -mno-rdrnd
13637@itemx -mf16c
13638@itemx -mno-f16c
13639@itemx -mfma
13640@itemx -mno-fma
13641@itemx -msse4a
13642@itemx -mno-sse4a
13643@itemx -mfma4
13644@need 800
13645@itemx -mno-fma4
13646@itemx -mxop
13647@itemx -mno-xop
13648@itemx -mlwp
13649@itemx -mno-lwp
13650@itemx -m3dnow
13651@itemx -mno-3dnow
13652@itemx -mpopcnt
13653@itemx -mno-popcnt
13654@itemx -mabm
13655@itemx -mno-abm
13656@itemx -mbmi
13657@itemx -mbmi2
13658@itemx -mno-bmi
13659@itemx -mno-bmi2
13660@itemx -mlzcnt
13661@itemx -mno-lzcnt
13662@itemx -mtbm
13663@itemx -mno-tbm
13664@opindex mmmx
13665@opindex mno-mmx
13666@opindex msse
13667@opindex mno-sse
13668@opindex m3dnow
13669@opindex mno-3dnow
13670These switches enable or disable the use of instructions in the MMX, SSE,
13671SSE2, SSE3, SSSE3, SSE4.1, AVX, AVX2, AES, PCLMUL, FSGSBASE, RDRND, F16C,
13672FMA, SSE4A, FMA4, XOP, LWP, ABM, BMI, BMI2, LZCNT or 3DNow!
13673@: extended instruction sets.
13674These extensions are also available as built-in functions: see
13675@ref{X86 Built-in Functions}, for details of the functions enabled and
13676disabled by these switches.
13677
13678To have SSE/SSE2 instructions generated automatically from floating-point
13679code (as opposed to 387 instructions), see @option{-mfpmath=sse}.
13680
13681GCC depresses SSEx instructions when @option{-mavx} is used. Instead, it
13682generates new AVX instructions or AVX equivalence for all SSEx instructions
13683when needed.
13684
13685These options will enable GCC to use these extended instructions in
13686generated code, even without @option{-mfpmath=sse}.  Applications that
13687perform run-time CPU detection must compile separate files for each
13688supported architecture, using the appropriate flags.  In particular,
13689the file containing the CPU detection code should be compiled without
13690these options.
13691
13692@item -mcld
13693@opindex mcld
13694This option instructs GCC to emit a @code{cld} instruction in the prologue
13695of functions that use string instructions.  String instructions depend on
13696the DF flag to select between autoincrement or autodecrement mode.  While the
13697ABI specifies the DF flag to be cleared on function entry, some operating
13698systems violate this specification by not clearing the DF flag in their
13699exception dispatchers.  The exception handler can be invoked with the DF flag
13700set, which leads to wrong direction mode when string instructions are used.
13701This option can be enabled by default on 32-bit x86 targets by configuring
13702GCC with the @option{--enable-cld} configure option.  Generation of @code{cld}
13703instructions can be suppressed with the @option{-mno-cld} compiler option
13704in this case.
13705
13706@item -mvzeroupper
13707@opindex mvzeroupper
13708This option instructs GCC to emit a @code{vzeroupper} instruction
13709before a transfer of control flow out of the function to minimize
13710AVX to SSE transition penalty as well as remove unnecessary zeroupper
13711intrinsics.
13712
13713@item -mprefer-avx128
13714@opindex mprefer-avx128
13715This option instructs GCC to use 128-bit AVX instructions instead of
13716256-bit AVX instructions in the auto-vectorizer.
13717
13718@item -mcx16
13719@opindex mcx16
13720This option will enable GCC to use CMPXCHG16B instruction in generated code.
13721CMPXCHG16B allows for atomic operations on 128-bit double quadword (or oword)
13722data types.  This is useful for high resolution counters that could be updated
13723by multiple processors (or cores).  This instruction is generated as part of
13724atomic built-in functions: see @ref{__sync Builtins} or
13725@ref{__atomic Builtins} for details.
13726
13727@item -msahf
13728@opindex msahf
13729This option will enable GCC to use SAHF instruction in generated 64-bit code.
13730Early Intel CPUs with Intel 64 lacked LAHF and SAHF instructions supported
13731by AMD64 until introduction of Pentium 4 G1 step in December 2005.  LAHF and
13732SAHF are load and store instructions, respectively, for certain status flags.
13733In 64-bit mode, SAHF instruction is used to optimize @code{fmod}, @code{drem}
13734or @code{remainder} built-in functions: see @ref{Other Builtins} for details.
13735
13736@item -mmovbe
13737@opindex mmovbe
13738This option will enable GCC to use movbe instruction to implement
13739@code{__builtin_bswap32} and @code{__builtin_bswap64}.
13740
13741@item -mcrc32
13742@opindex mcrc32
13743This option will enable built-in functions, @code{__builtin_ia32_crc32qi},
13744@code{__builtin_ia32_crc32hi}. @code{__builtin_ia32_crc32si} and
13745@code{__builtin_ia32_crc32di} to generate the crc32 machine instruction.
13746
13747@item -mrecip
13748@opindex mrecip
13749This option will enable GCC to use RCPSS and RSQRTSS instructions (and their
13750vectorized variants RCPPS and RSQRTPS) with an additional Newton-Raphson step
13751to increase precision instead of DIVSS and SQRTSS (and their vectorized
13752variants) for single-precision floating-point arguments.  These instructions
13753are generated only when @option{-funsafe-math-optimizations} is enabled
13754together with @option{-finite-math-only} and @option{-fno-trapping-math}.
13755Note that while the throughput of the sequence is higher than the throughput
13756of the non-reciprocal instruction, the precision of the sequence can be
13757decreased by up to 2 ulp (i.e. the inverse of 1.0 equals 0.99999994).
13758
13759Note that GCC implements @code{1.0f/sqrtf(@var{x})} in terms of RSQRTSS
13760(or RSQRTPS) already with @option{-ffast-math} (or the above option
13761combination), and doesn't need @option{-mrecip}.
13762
13763Also note that GCC emits the above sequence with additional Newton-Raphson step
13764for vectorized single-float division and vectorized @code{sqrtf(@var{x})}
13765already with @option{-ffast-math} (or the above option combination), and
13766doesn't need @option{-mrecip}.
13767
13768@item -mrecip=@var{opt}
13769@opindex mrecip=opt
13770This option allows to control which reciprocal estimate instructions
13771may be used.  @var{opt} is a comma separated list of options, which may
13772be preceded by a @code{!} to invert the option:
13773@code{all}: enable all estimate instructions,
13774@code{default}: enable the default instructions, equivalent to @option{-mrecip},
13775@code{none}: disable all estimate instructions, equivalent to @option{-mno-recip},
13776@code{div}: enable the approximation for scalar division,
13777@code{vec-div}: enable the approximation for vectorized division,
13778@code{sqrt}: enable the approximation for scalar square root,
13779@code{vec-sqrt}: enable the approximation for vectorized square root.
13780
13781So for example, @option{-mrecip=all,!sqrt} would enable
13782all of the reciprocal approximations, except for square root.
13783
13784@item -mveclibabi=@var{type}
13785@opindex mveclibabi
13786Specifies the ABI type to use for vectorizing intrinsics using an
13787external library.  Supported types are @code{svml} for the Intel short
13788vector math library and @code{acml} for the AMD math core library style
13789of interfacing.  GCC will currently emit calls to @code{vmldExp2},
13790@code{vmldLn2}, @code{vmldLog102}, @code{vmldLog102}, @code{vmldPow2},
13791@code{vmldTanh2}, @code{vmldTan2}, @code{vmldAtan2}, @code{vmldAtanh2},
13792@code{vmldCbrt2}, @code{vmldSinh2}, @code{vmldSin2}, @code{vmldAsinh2},
13793@code{vmldAsin2}, @code{vmldCosh2}, @code{vmldCos2}, @code{vmldAcosh2},
13794@code{vmldAcos2}, @code{vmlsExp4}, @code{vmlsLn4}, @code{vmlsLog104},
13795@code{vmlsLog104}, @code{vmlsPow4}, @code{vmlsTanh4}, @code{vmlsTan4},
13796@code{vmlsAtan4}, @code{vmlsAtanh4}, @code{vmlsCbrt4}, @code{vmlsSinh4},
13797@code{vmlsSin4}, @code{vmlsAsinh4}, @code{vmlsAsin4}, @code{vmlsCosh4},
13798@code{vmlsCos4}, @code{vmlsAcosh4} and @code{vmlsAcos4} for corresponding
13799function type when @option{-mveclibabi=svml} is used and @code{__vrd2_sin},
13800@code{__vrd2_cos}, @code{__vrd2_exp}, @code{__vrd2_log}, @code{__vrd2_log2},
13801@code{__vrd2_log10}, @code{__vrs4_sinf}, @code{__vrs4_cosf},
13802@code{__vrs4_expf}, @code{__vrs4_logf}, @code{__vrs4_log2f},
13803@code{__vrs4_log10f} and @code{__vrs4_powf} for corresponding function type
13804when @option{-mveclibabi=acml} is used. Both @option{-ftree-vectorize} and
13805@option{-funsafe-math-optimizations} have to be enabled. A SVML or ACML ABI
13806compatible library will have to be specified at link time.
13807
13808@item -mabi=@var{name}
13809@opindex mabi
13810Generate code for the specified calling convention.  Permissible values
13811are: @samp{sysv} for the ABI used on GNU/Linux and other systems and
13812@samp{ms} for the Microsoft ABI.  The default is to use the Microsoft
13813ABI when targeting Windows.  On all other systems, the default is the
13814SYSV ABI.  You can control this behavior for a specific function by
13815using the function attribute @samp{ms_abi}/@samp{sysv_abi}.
13816@xref{Function Attributes}.
13817
13818@item -mtls-dialect=@var{type}
13819@opindex mtls-dialect
13820Generate code to access thread-local storage using the @samp{gnu} or
13821@samp{gnu2} conventions.  @samp{gnu} is the conservative default;
13822@samp{gnu2} is more efficient, but it may add compile- and run-time
13823requirements that cannot be satisfied on all systems.
13824
13825@item -mpush-args
13826@itemx -mno-push-args
13827@opindex mpush-args
13828@opindex mno-push-args
13829Use PUSH operations to store outgoing parameters.  This method is shorter
13830and usually equally fast as method using SUB/MOV operations and is enabled
13831by default.  In some cases disabling it may improve performance because of
13832improved scheduling and reduced dependencies.
13833
13834@item -maccumulate-outgoing-args
13835@opindex maccumulate-outgoing-args
13836If enabled, the maximum amount of space required for outgoing arguments will be
13837computed in the function prologue.  This is faster on most modern CPUs
13838because of reduced dependencies, improved scheduling and reduced stack usage
13839when preferred stack boundary is not equal to 2.  The drawback is a notable
13840increase in code size.  This switch implies @option{-mno-push-args}.
13841
13842@item -mthreads
13843@opindex mthreads
13844Support thread-safe exception handling on @samp{Mingw32}.  Code that relies
13845on thread-safe exception handling must compile and link all code with the
13846@option{-mthreads} option.  When compiling, @option{-mthreads} defines
13847@option{-D_MT}; when linking, it links in a special thread helper library
13848@option{-lmingwthrd} which cleans up per thread exception handling data.
13849
13850@item -mno-align-stringops
13851@opindex mno-align-stringops
13852Do not align destination of inlined string operations.  This switch reduces
13853code size and improves performance in case the destination is already aligned,
13854but GCC doesn't know about it.
13855
13856@item -minline-all-stringops
13857@opindex minline-all-stringops
13858By default GCC inlines string operations only when the destination is
13859known to be aligned to least a 4-byte boundary.
13860This enables more inlining, increase code
13861size, but may improve performance of code that depends on fast memcpy, strlen
13862and memset for short lengths.
13863
13864@item -minline-stringops-dynamically
13865@opindex minline-stringops-dynamically
13866For string operations of unknown size, use run-time checks with
13867inline code for small blocks and a library call for large blocks.
13868
13869@item -mstringop-strategy=@var{alg}
13870@opindex mstringop-strategy=@var{alg}
13871Overwrite internal decision heuristic about particular algorithm to inline
13872string operation with.  The allowed values are @code{rep_byte},
13873@code{rep_4byte}, @code{rep_8byte} for expanding using i386 @code{rep} prefix
13874of specified size, @code{byte_loop}, @code{loop}, @code{unrolled_loop} for
13875expanding inline loop, @code{libcall} for always expanding library call.
13876
13877@item -momit-leaf-frame-pointer
13878@opindex momit-leaf-frame-pointer
13879Don't keep the frame pointer in a register for leaf functions.  This
13880avoids the instructions to save, set up and restore frame pointers and
13881makes an extra register available in leaf functions.  The option
13882@option{-fomit-frame-pointer} removes the frame pointer for all functions,
13883which might make debugging harder.
13884
13885@item -mtls-direct-seg-refs
13886@itemx -mno-tls-direct-seg-refs
13887@opindex mtls-direct-seg-refs
13888Controls whether TLS variables may be accessed with offsets from the
13889TLS segment register (@code{%gs} for 32-bit, @code{%fs} for 64-bit),
13890or whether the thread base pointer must be added.  Whether or not this
13891is legal depends on the operating system, and whether it maps the
13892segment to cover the entire TLS area.
13893
13894For systems that use GNU libc, the default is on.
13895
13896@item -msse2avx
13897@itemx -mno-sse2avx
13898@opindex msse2avx
13899Specify that the assembler should encode SSE instructions with VEX
13900prefix.  The option @option{-mavx} turns this on by default.
13901
13902@item -mfentry
13903@itemx -mno-fentry
13904@opindex mfentry
13905If profiling is active @option{-pg} put the profiling
13906counter call before prologue.
13907Note: On x86 architectures the attribute @code{ms_hook_prologue}
13908isn't possible at the moment for @option{-mfentry} and @option{-pg}.
13909
13910@item -m8bit-idiv
13911@itemx -mno-8bit-idiv
13912@opindex 8bit-idiv
13913On some processors, like Intel Atom, 8-bit unsigned integer divide is
13914much faster than 32-bit/64-bit integer divide.  This option generates a
13915run-time check.  If both dividend and divisor are within range of 0
13916to 255, 8-bit unsigned integer divide is used instead of
1391732-bit/64-bit integer divide.
13918
13919@item -mavx256-split-unaligned-load
13920@item -mavx256-split-unaligned-store
13921@opindex avx256-split-unaligned-load
13922@opindex avx256-split-unaligned-store
13923Split 32-byte AVX unaligned load and store.
13924
13925@end table
13926
13927These @samp{-m} switches are supported in addition to the above
13928on AMD x86-64 processors in 64-bit environments.
13929
13930@table @gcctabopt
13931@item -m32
13932@itemx -m64
13933@itemx -mx32
13934@opindex m32
13935@opindex m64
13936@opindex mx32
13937Generate code for a 32-bit or 64-bit environment.
13938The @option{-m32} option sets int, long and pointer to 32 bits and
13939generates code that runs on any i386 system.
13940The @option{-m64} option sets int to 32 bits and long and pointer
13941to 64 bits and generates code for AMD's x86-64 architecture.
13942The @option{-mx32} option sets int, long and pointer to 32 bits and
13943generates code for AMD's x86-64 architecture.
13944For darwin only the @option{-m64} option turns off the @option{-fno-pic}
13945and @option{-mdynamic-no-pic} options.
13946
13947@item -mno-red-zone
13948@opindex mno-red-zone
13949Do not use a so called red zone for x86-64 code.  The red zone is mandated
13950by the x86-64 ABI, it is a 128-byte area beyond the location of the
13951stack pointer that will not be modified by signal or interrupt handlers
13952and therefore can be used for temporary data without adjusting the stack
13953pointer.  The flag @option{-mno-red-zone} disables this red zone.
13954
13955@item -mcmodel=small
13956@opindex mcmodel=small
13957Generate code for the small code model: the program and its symbols must
13958be linked in the lower 2 GB of the address space.  Pointers are 64 bits.
13959Programs can be statically or dynamically linked.  This is the default
13960code model.
13961
13962@item -mcmodel=kernel
13963@opindex mcmodel=kernel
13964Generate code for the kernel code model.  The kernel runs in the
13965negative 2 GB of the address space.
13966This model has to be used for Linux kernel code.
13967
13968@item -mcmodel=medium
13969@opindex mcmodel=medium
13970Generate code for the medium model: The program is linked in the lower 2
13971GB of the address space.  Small symbols are also placed there.  Symbols
13972with sizes larger than @option{-mlarge-data-threshold} are put into
13973large data or bss sections and can be located above 2GB.  Programs can
13974be statically or dynamically linked.
13975
13976@item -mcmodel=large
13977@opindex mcmodel=large
13978Generate code for the large model: This model makes no assumptions
13979about addresses and sizes of sections.
13980@end table
13981
13982@node i386 and x86-64 Windows Options
13983@subsection i386 and x86-64 Windows Options
13984@cindex i386 and x86-64 Windows Options
13985
13986These additional options are available for Windows targets:
13987
13988@table @gcctabopt
13989@item -mconsole
13990@opindex mconsole
13991This option is available for Cygwin and MinGW targets.  It
13992specifies that a console application is to be generated, by
13993instructing the linker to set the PE header subsystem type
13994required for console applications.
13995This is the default behavior for Cygwin and MinGW targets.
13996
13997@item -mdll
13998@opindex mdll
13999This option is available for Cygwin and MinGW targets.  It
14000specifies that a DLL - a dynamic link library - is to be
14001generated, enabling the selection of the required runtime
14002startup object and entry point.
14003
14004@item -mnop-fun-dllimport
14005@opindex mnop-fun-dllimport
14006This option is available for Cygwin and MinGW targets.  It
14007specifies that the dllimport attribute should be ignored.
14008
14009@item -mthread
14010@opindex mthread
14011This option is available for MinGW targets. It specifies
14012that MinGW-specific thread support is to be used.
14013
14014@item -municode
14015@opindex municode
14016This option is available for mingw-w64 targets.  It specifies
14017that the UNICODE macro is getting pre-defined and that the
14018unicode capable runtime startup code is chosen.
14019
14020@item -mwin32
14021@opindex mwin32
14022This option is available for Cygwin and MinGW targets.  It
14023specifies that the typical Windows pre-defined macros are to
14024be set in the pre-processor, but does not influence the choice
14025of runtime library/startup code.
14026
14027@item -mwindows
14028@opindex mwindows
14029This option is available for Cygwin and MinGW targets.  It
14030specifies that a GUI application is to be generated by
14031instructing the linker to set the PE header subsystem type
14032appropriately.
14033
14034@item -fno-set-stack-executable
14035@opindex fno-set-stack-executable
14036This option is available for MinGW targets. It specifies that
14037the executable flag for stack used by nested functions isn't
14038set. This is necessary for binaries running in kernel mode of
14039Windows, as there the user32 API, which is used to set executable
14040privileges, isn't available.
14041
14042@item -mpe-aligned-commons
14043@opindex mpe-aligned-commons
14044This option is available for Cygwin and MinGW targets.  It
14045specifies that the GNU extension to the PE file format that
14046permits the correct alignment of COMMON variables should be
14047used when generating code.  It will be enabled by default if
14048GCC detects that the target assembler found during configuration
14049supports the feature.
14050@end table
14051
14052See also under @ref{i386 and x86-64 Options} for standard options.
14053
14054@node IA-64 Options
14055@subsection IA-64 Options
14056@cindex IA-64 Options
14057
14058These are the @samp{-m} options defined for the Intel IA-64 architecture.
14059
14060@table @gcctabopt
14061@item -mbig-endian
14062@opindex mbig-endian
14063Generate code for a big-endian target.  This is the default for HP-UX@.
14064
14065@item -mlittle-endian
14066@opindex mlittle-endian
14067Generate code for a little-endian target.  This is the default for AIX5
14068and GNU/Linux.
14069
14070@item -mgnu-as
14071@itemx -mno-gnu-as
14072@opindex mgnu-as
14073@opindex mno-gnu-as
14074Generate (or don't) code for the GNU assembler.  This is the default.
14075@c Also, this is the default if the configure option @option{--with-gnu-as}
14076@c is used.
14077
14078@item -mgnu-ld
14079@itemx -mno-gnu-ld
14080@opindex mgnu-ld
14081@opindex mno-gnu-ld
14082Generate (or don't) code for the GNU linker.  This is the default.
14083@c Also, this is the default if the configure option @option{--with-gnu-ld}
14084@c is used.
14085
14086@item -mno-pic
14087@opindex mno-pic
14088Generate code that does not use a global pointer register.  The result
14089is not position independent code, and violates the IA-64 ABI@.
14090
14091@item -mvolatile-asm-stop
14092@itemx -mno-volatile-asm-stop
14093@opindex mvolatile-asm-stop
14094@opindex mno-volatile-asm-stop
14095Generate (or don't) a stop bit immediately before and after volatile asm
14096statements.
14097
14098@item -mregister-names
14099@itemx -mno-register-names
14100@opindex mregister-names
14101@opindex mno-register-names
14102Generate (or don't) @samp{in}, @samp{loc}, and @samp{out} register names for
14103the stacked registers.  This may make assembler output more readable.
14104
14105@item -mno-sdata
14106@itemx -msdata
14107@opindex mno-sdata
14108@opindex msdata
14109Disable (or enable) optimizations that use the small data section.  This may
14110be useful for working around optimizer bugs.
14111
14112@item -mconstant-gp
14113@opindex mconstant-gp
14114Generate code that uses a single constant global pointer value.  This is
14115useful when compiling kernel code.
14116
14117@item -mauto-pic
14118@opindex mauto-pic
14119Generate code that is self-relocatable.  This implies @option{-mconstant-gp}.
14120This is useful when compiling firmware code.
14121
14122@item -minline-float-divide-min-latency
14123@opindex minline-float-divide-min-latency
14124Generate code for inline divides of floating-point values
14125using the minimum latency algorithm.
14126
14127@item -minline-float-divide-max-throughput
14128@opindex minline-float-divide-max-throughput
14129Generate code for inline divides of floating-point values
14130using the maximum throughput algorithm.
14131
14132@item -mno-inline-float-divide
14133@opindex mno-inline-float-divide
14134Do not generate inline code for divides of floating-point values.
14135
14136@item -minline-int-divide-min-latency
14137@opindex minline-int-divide-min-latency
14138Generate code for inline divides of integer values
14139using the minimum latency algorithm.
14140
14141@item -minline-int-divide-max-throughput
14142@opindex minline-int-divide-max-throughput
14143Generate code for inline divides of integer values
14144using the maximum throughput algorithm.
14145
14146@item -mno-inline-int-divide
14147@opindex mno-inline-int-divide
14148Do not generate inline code for divides of integer values.
14149
14150@item -minline-sqrt-min-latency
14151@opindex minline-sqrt-min-latency
14152Generate code for inline square roots
14153using the minimum latency algorithm.
14154
14155@item -minline-sqrt-max-throughput
14156@opindex minline-sqrt-max-throughput
14157Generate code for inline square roots
14158using the maximum throughput algorithm.
14159
14160@item -mno-inline-sqrt
14161@opindex mno-inline-sqrt
14162Do not generate inline code for sqrt.
14163
14164@item -mfused-madd
14165@itemx -mno-fused-madd
14166@opindex mfused-madd
14167@opindex mno-fused-madd
14168Do (don't) generate code that uses the fused multiply/add or multiply/subtract
14169instructions.  The default is to use these instructions.
14170
14171@item -mno-dwarf2-asm
14172@itemx -mdwarf2-asm
14173@opindex mno-dwarf2-asm
14174@opindex mdwarf2-asm
14175Don't (or do) generate assembler code for the DWARF2 line number debugging
14176info.  This may be useful when not using the GNU assembler.
14177
14178@item -mearly-stop-bits
14179@itemx -mno-early-stop-bits
14180@opindex mearly-stop-bits
14181@opindex mno-early-stop-bits
14182Allow stop bits to be placed earlier than immediately preceding the
14183instruction that triggered the stop bit.  This can improve instruction
14184scheduling, but does not always do so.
14185
14186@item -mfixed-range=@var{register-range}
14187@opindex mfixed-range
14188Generate code treating the given register range as fixed registers.
14189A fixed register is one that the register allocator can not use.  This is
14190useful when compiling kernel code.  A register range is specified as
14191two registers separated by a dash.  Multiple register ranges can be
14192specified separated by a comma.
14193
14194@item -mtls-size=@var{tls-size}
14195@opindex mtls-size
14196Specify bit size of immediate TLS offsets.  Valid values are 14, 22, and
1419764.
14198
14199@item -mtune=@var{cpu-type}
14200@opindex mtune
14201Tune the instruction scheduling for a particular CPU, Valid values are
14202itanium, itanium1, merced, itanium2, and mckinley.
14203
14204@item -milp32
14205@itemx -mlp64
14206@opindex milp32
14207@opindex mlp64
14208Generate code for a 32-bit or 64-bit environment.
14209The 32-bit environment sets int, long and pointer to 32 bits.
14210The 64-bit environment sets int to 32 bits and long and pointer
14211to 64 bits.  These are HP-UX specific flags.
14212
14213@item -mno-sched-br-data-spec
14214@itemx -msched-br-data-spec
14215@opindex mno-sched-br-data-spec
14216@opindex msched-br-data-spec
14217(Dis/En)able data speculative scheduling before reload.
14218This will result in generation of the ld.a instructions and
14219the corresponding check instructions (ld.c / chk.a).
14220The default is 'disable'.
14221
14222@item -msched-ar-data-spec
14223@itemx -mno-sched-ar-data-spec
14224@opindex msched-ar-data-spec
14225@opindex mno-sched-ar-data-spec
14226(En/Dis)able data speculative scheduling after reload.
14227This will result in generation of the ld.a instructions and
14228the corresponding check instructions (ld.c / chk.a).
14229The default is 'enable'.
14230
14231@item -mno-sched-control-spec
14232@itemx -msched-control-spec
14233@opindex mno-sched-control-spec
14234@opindex msched-control-spec
14235(Dis/En)able control speculative scheduling.  This feature is
14236available only during region scheduling (i.e.@: before reload).
14237This will result in generation of the ld.s instructions and
14238the corresponding check instructions chk.s .
14239The default is 'disable'.
14240
14241@item -msched-br-in-data-spec
14242@itemx -mno-sched-br-in-data-spec
14243@opindex msched-br-in-data-spec
14244@opindex mno-sched-br-in-data-spec
14245(En/Dis)able speculative scheduling of the instructions that
14246are dependent on the data speculative loads before reload.
14247This is effective only with @option{-msched-br-data-spec} enabled.
14248The default is 'enable'.
14249
14250@item -msched-ar-in-data-spec
14251@itemx -mno-sched-ar-in-data-spec
14252@opindex msched-ar-in-data-spec
14253@opindex mno-sched-ar-in-data-spec
14254(En/Dis)able speculative scheduling of the instructions that
14255are dependent on the data speculative loads after reload.
14256This is effective only with @option{-msched-ar-data-spec} enabled.
14257The default is 'enable'.
14258
14259@item -msched-in-control-spec
14260@itemx -mno-sched-in-control-spec
14261@opindex msched-in-control-spec
14262@opindex mno-sched-in-control-spec
14263(En/Dis)able speculative scheduling of the instructions that
14264are dependent on the control speculative loads.
14265This is effective only with @option{-msched-control-spec} enabled.
14266The default is 'enable'.
14267
14268@item -mno-sched-prefer-non-data-spec-insns
14269@itemx -msched-prefer-non-data-spec-insns
14270@opindex mno-sched-prefer-non-data-spec-insns
14271@opindex msched-prefer-non-data-spec-insns
14272If enabled, data speculative instructions will be chosen for schedule
14273only if there are no other choices at the moment.  This will make
14274the use of the data speculation much more conservative.
14275The default is 'disable'.
14276
14277@item -mno-sched-prefer-non-control-spec-insns
14278@itemx -msched-prefer-non-control-spec-insns
14279@opindex mno-sched-prefer-non-control-spec-insns
14280@opindex msched-prefer-non-control-spec-insns
14281If enabled, control speculative instructions will be chosen for schedule
14282only if there are no other choices at the moment.  This will make
14283the use of the control speculation much more conservative.
14284The default is 'disable'.
14285
14286@item -mno-sched-count-spec-in-critical-path
14287@itemx -msched-count-spec-in-critical-path
14288@opindex mno-sched-count-spec-in-critical-path
14289@opindex msched-count-spec-in-critical-path
14290If enabled, speculative dependencies will be considered during
14291computation of the instructions priorities.  This will make the use of the
14292speculation a bit more conservative.
14293The default is 'disable'.
14294
14295@item -msched-spec-ldc
14296@opindex msched-spec-ldc
14297Use a simple data speculation check.  This option is on by default.
14298
14299@item -msched-control-spec-ldc
14300@opindex msched-spec-ldc
14301Use a simple check for control speculation.  This option is on by default.
14302
14303@item -msched-stop-bits-after-every-cycle
14304@opindex msched-stop-bits-after-every-cycle
14305Place a stop bit after every cycle when scheduling.  This option is on
14306by default.
14307
14308@item -msched-fp-mem-deps-zero-cost
14309@opindex msched-fp-mem-deps-zero-cost
14310Assume that floating-point stores and loads are not likely to cause a conflict
14311when placed into the same instruction group.  This option is disabled by
14312default.
14313
14314@item -msel-sched-dont-check-control-spec
14315@opindex msel-sched-dont-check-control-spec
14316Generate checks for control speculation in selective scheduling.
14317This flag is disabled by default.
14318
14319@item -msched-max-memory-insns=@var{max-insns}
14320@opindex msched-max-memory-insns
14321Limit on the number of memory insns per instruction group, giving lower
14322priority to subsequent memory insns attempting to schedule in the same
14323instruction group. Frequently useful to prevent cache bank conflicts.
14324The default value is 1.
14325
14326@item -msched-max-memory-insns-hard-limit
14327@opindex msched-max-memory-insns-hard-limit
14328Disallow more than `msched-max-memory-insns' in instruction group.
14329Otherwise, limit is `soft' meaning that we would prefer non-memory operations
14330when limit is reached but may still schedule memory operations.
14331
14332@end table
14333
14334@node IA-64/VMS Options
14335@subsection IA-64/VMS Options
14336
14337These @samp{-m} options are defined for the IA-64/VMS implementations:
14338
14339@table @gcctabopt
14340@item -mvms-return-codes
14341@opindex mvms-return-codes
14342Return VMS condition codes from main. The default is to return POSIX
14343style condition (e.g.@ error) codes.
14344
14345@item -mdebug-main=@var{prefix}
14346@opindex mdebug-main=@var{prefix}
14347Flag the first routine whose name starts with @var{prefix} as the main
14348routine for the debugger.
14349
14350@item -mmalloc64
14351@opindex mmalloc64
14352Default to 64-bit memory allocation routines.
14353@end table
14354
14355@node LM32 Options
14356@subsection LM32 Options
14357@cindex LM32 options
14358
14359These @option{-m} options are defined for the Lattice Mico32 architecture:
14360
14361@table @gcctabopt
14362@item -mbarrel-shift-enabled
14363@opindex mbarrel-shift-enabled
14364Enable barrel-shift instructions.
14365
14366@item -mdivide-enabled
14367@opindex mdivide-enabled
14368Enable divide and modulus instructions.
14369
14370@item -mmultiply-enabled
14371@opindex multiply-enabled
14372Enable multiply instructions.
14373
14374@item -msign-extend-enabled
14375@opindex msign-extend-enabled
14376Enable sign extend instructions.
14377
14378@item -muser-enabled
14379@opindex muser-enabled
14380Enable user-defined instructions.
14381
14382@end table
14383
14384@node M32C Options
14385@subsection M32C Options
14386@cindex M32C options
14387
14388@table @gcctabopt
14389@item -mcpu=@var{name}
14390@opindex mcpu=
14391Select the CPU for which code is generated.  @var{name} may be one of
14392@samp{r8c} for the R8C/Tiny series, @samp{m16c} for the M16C (up to
14393/60) series, @samp{m32cm} for the M16C/80 series, or @samp{m32c} for
14394the M32C/80 series.
14395
14396@item -msim
14397@opindex msim
14398Specifies that the program will be run on the simulator.  This causes
14399an alternate runtime library to be linked in which supports, for
14400example, file I/O@.  You must not use this option when generating
14401programs that will run on real hardware; you must provide your own
14402runtime library for whatever I/O functions are needed.
14403
14404@item -memregs=@var{number}
14405@opindex memregs=
14406Specifies the number of memory-based pseudo-registers GCC will use
14407during code generation.  These pseudo-registers will be used like real
14408registers, so there is a tradeoff between GCC's ability to fit the
14409code into available registers, and the performance penalty of using
14410memory instead of registers.  Note that all modules in a program must
14411be compiled with the same value for this option.  Because of that, you
14412must not use this option with the default runtime libraries gcc
14413builds.
14414
14415@end table
14416
14417@node M32R/D Options
14418@subsection M32R/D Options
14419@cindex M32R/D options
14420
14421These @option{-m} options are defined for Renesas M32R/D architectures:
14422
14423@table @gcctabopt
14424@item -m32r2
14425@opindex m32r2
14426Generate code for the M32R/2@.
14427
14428@item -m32rx
14429@opindex m32rx
14430Generate code for the M32R/X@.
14431
14432@item -m32r
14433@opindex m32r
14434Generate code for the M32R@.  This is the default.
14435
14436@item -mmodel=small
14437@opindex mmodel=small
14438Assume all objects live in the lower 16MB of memory (so that their addresses
14439can be loaded with the @code{ld24} instruction), and assume all subroutines
14440are reachable with the @code{bl} instruction.
14441This is the default.
14442
14443The addressability of a particular object can be set with the
14444@code{model} attribute.
14445
14446@item -mmodel=medium
14447@opindex mmodel=medium
14448Assume objects may be anywhere in the 32-bit address space (the compiler
14449will generate @code{seth/add3} instructions to load their addresses), and
14450assume all subroutines are reachable with the @code{bl} instruction.
14451
14452@item -mmodel=large
14453@opindex mmodel=large
14454Assume objects may be anywhere in the 32-bit address space (the compiler
14455will generate @code{seth/add3} instructions to load their addresses), and
14456assume subroutines may not be reachable with the @code{bl} instruction
14457(the compiler will generate the much slower @code{seth/add3/jl}
14458instruction sequence).
14459
14460@item -msdata=none
14461@opindex msdata=none
14462Disable use of the small data area.  Variables will be put into
14463one of @samp{.data}, @samp{bss}, or @samp{.rodata} (unless the
14464@code{section} attribute has been specified).
14465This is the default.
14466
14467The small data area consists of sections @samp{.sdata} and @samp{.sbss}.
14468Objects may be explicitly put in the small data area with the
14469@code{section} attribute using one of these sections.
14470
14471@item -msdata=sdata
14472@opindex msdata=sdata
14473Put small global and static data in the small data area, but do not
14474generate special code to reference them.
14475
14476@item -msdata=use
14477@opindex msdata=use
14478Put small global and static data in the small data area, and generate
14479special instructions to reference them.
14480
14481@item -G @var{num}
14482@opindex G
14483@cindex smaller data references
14484Put global and static objects less than or equal to @var{num} bytes
14485into the small data or bss sections instead of the normal data or bss
14486sections.  The default value of @var{num} is 8.
14487The @option{-msdata} option must be set to one of @samp{sdata} or @samp{use}
14488for this option to have any effect.
14489
14490All modules should be compiled with the same @option{-G @var{num}} value.
14491Compiling with different values of @var{num} may or may not work; if it
14492doesn't the linker will give an error message---incorrect code will not be
14493generated.
14494
14495@item -mdebug
14496@opindex mdebug
14497Makes the M32R specific code in the compiler display some statistics
14498that might help in debugging programs.
14499
14500@item -malign-loops
14501@opindex malign-loops
14502Align all loops to a 32-byte boundary.
14503
14504@item -mno-align-loops
14505@opindex mno-align-loops
14506Do not enforce a 32-byte alignment for loops.  This is the default.
14507
14508@item -missue-rate=@var{number}
14509@opindex missue-rate=@var{number}
14510Issue @var{number} instructions per cycle.  @var{number} can only be 1
14511or 2.
14512
14513@item -mbranch-cost=@var{number}
14514@opindex mbranch-cost=@var{number}
14515@var{number} can only be 1 or 2.  If it is 1 then branches will be
14516preferred over conditional code, if it is 2, then the opposite will
14517apply.
14518
14519@item -mflush-trap=@var{number}
14520@opindex mflush-trap=@var{number}
14521Specifies the trap number to use to flush the cache.  The default is
1452212.  Valid numbers are between 0 and 15 inclusive.
14523
14524@item -mno-flush-trap
14525@opindex mno-flush-trap
14526Specifies that the cache cannot be flushed by using a trap.
14527
14528@item -mflush-func=@var{name}
14529@opindex mflush-func=@var{name}
14530Specifies the name of the operating system function to call to flush
14531the cache.  The default is @emph{_flush_cache}, but a function call
14532will only be used if a trap is not available.
14533
14534@item -mno-flush-func
14535@opindex mno-flush-func
14536Indicates that there is no OS function for flushing the cache.
14537
14538@end table
14539
14540@node M680x0 Options
14541@subsection M680x0 Options
14542@cindex M680x0 options
14543
14544These are the @samp{-m} options defined for M680x0 and ColdFire processors.
14545The default settings depend on which architecture was selected when
14546the compiler was configured; the defaults for the most common choices
14547are given below.
14548
14549@table @gcctabopt
14550@item -march=@var{arch}
14551@opindex march
14552Generate code for a specific M680x0 or ColdFire instruction set
14553architecture.  Permissible values of @var{arch} for M680x0
14554architectures are: @samp{68000}, @samp{68010}, @samp{68020},
14555@samp{68030}, @samp{68040}, @samp{68060} and @samp{cpu32}.  ColdFire
14556architectures are selected according to Freescale's ISA classification
14557and the permissible values are: @samp{isaa}, @samp{isaaplus},
14558@samp{isab} and @samp{isac}.
14559
14560gcc defines a macro @samp{__mcf@var{arch}__} whenever it is generating
14561code for a ColdFire target.  The @var{arch} in this macro is one of the
14562@option{-march} arguments given above.
14563
14564When used together, @option{-march} and @option{-mtune} select code
14565that runs on a family of similar processors but that is optimized
14566for a particular microarchitecture.
14567
14568@item -mcpu=@var{cpu}
14569@opindex mcpu
14570Generate code for a specific M680x0 or ColdFire processor.
14571The M680x0 @var{cpu}s are: @samp{68000}, @samp{68010}, @samp{68020},
14572@samp{68030}, @samp{68040}, @samp{68060}, @samp{68302}, @samp{68332}
14573and @samp{cpu32}.  The ColdFire @var{cpu}s are given by the table
14574below, which also classifies the CPUs into families:
14575
14576@multitable @columnfractions 0.20 0.80
14577@item @strong{Family} @tab @strong{@samp{-mcpu} arguments}
14578@item @samp{51} @tab @samp{51} @samp{51ac} @samp{51cn} @samp{51em} @samp{51qe}
14579@item @samp{5206} @tab @samp{5202} @samp{5204} @samp{5206}
14580@item @samp{5206e} @tab @samp{5206e}
14581@item @samp{5208} @tab @samp{5207} @samp{5208}
14582@item @samp{5211a} @tab @samp{5210a} @samp{5211a}
14583@item @samp{5213} @tab @samp{5211} @samp{5212} @samp{5213}
14584@item @samp{5216} @tab @samp{5214} @samp{5216}
14585@item @samp{52235} @tab @samp{52230} @samp{52231} @samp{52232} @samp{52233} @samp{52234} @samp{52235}
14586@item @samp{5225} @tab @samp{5224} @samp{5225}
14587@item @samp{52259} @tab @samp{52252} @samp{52254} @samp{52255} @samp{52256} @samp{52258} @samp{52259}
14588@item @samp{5235} @tab @samp{5232} @samp{5233} @samp{5234} @samp{5235} @samp{523x}
14589@item @samp{5249} @tab @samp{5249}
14590@item @samp{5250} @tab @samp{5250}
14591@item @samp{5271} @tab @samp{5270} @samp{5271}
14592@item @samp{5272} @tab @samp{5272}
14593@item @samp{5275} @tab @samp{5274} @samp{5275}
14594@item @samp{5282} @tab @samp{5280} @samp{5281} @samp{5282} @samp{528x}
14595@item @samp{53017} @tab @samp{53011} @samp{53012} @samp{53013} @samp{53014} @samp{53015} @samp{53016} @samp{53017}
14596@item @samp{5307} @tab @samp{5307}
14597@item @samp{5329} @tab @samp{5327} @samp{5328} @samp{5329} @samp{532x}
14598@item @samp{5373} @tab @samp{5372} @samp{5373} @samp{537x}
14599@item @samp{5407} @tab @samp{5407}
14600@item @samp{5475} @tab @samp{5470} @samp{5471} @samp{5472} @samp{5473} @samp{5474} @samp{5475} @samp{547x} @samp{5480} @samp{5481} @samp{5482} @samp{5483} @samp{5484} @samp{5485}
14601@end multitable
14602
14603@option{-mcpu=@var{cpu}} overrides @option{-march=@var{arch}} if
14604@var{arch} is compatible with @var{cpu}.  Other combinations of
14605@option{-mcpu} and @option{-march} are rejected.
14606
14607gcc defines the macro @samp{__mcf_cpu_@var{cpu}} when ColdFire target
14608@var{cpu} is selected.  It also defines @samp{__mcf_family_@var{family}},
14609where the value of @var{family} is given by the table above.
14610
14611@item -mtune=@var{tune}
14612@opindex mtune
14613Tune the code for a particular microarchitecture, within the
14614constraints set by @option{-march} and @option{-mcpu}.
14615The M680x0 microarchitectures are: @samp{68000}, @samp{68010},
14616@samp{68020}, @samp{68030}, @samp{68040}, @samp{68060}
14617and @samp{cpu32}.  The ColdFire microarchitectures
14618are: @samp{cfv1}, @samp{cfv2}, @samp{cfv3}, @samp{cfv4} and @samp{cfv4e}.
14619
14620You can also use @option{-mtune=68020-40} for code that needs
14621to run relatively well on 68020, 68030 and 68040 targets.
14622@option{-mtune=68020-60} is similar but includes 68060 targets
14623as well.  These two options select the same tuning decisions as
14624@option{-m68020-40} and @option{-m68020-60} respectively.
14625
14626gcc defines the macros @samp{__mc@var{arch}} and @samp{__mc@var{arch}__}
14627when tuning for 680x0 architecture @var{arch}.  It also defines
14628@samp{mc@var{arch}} unless either @option{-ansi} or a non-GNU @option{-std}
14629option is used.  If gcc is tuning for a range of architectures,
14630as selected by @option{-mtune=68020-40} or @option{-mtune=68020-60},
14631it defines the macros for every architecture in the range.
14632
14633gcc also defines the macro @samp{__m@var{uarch}__} when tuning for
14634ColdFire microarchitecture @var{uarch}, where @var{uarch} is one
14635of the arguments given above.
14636
14637@item -m68000
14638@itemx -mc68000
14639@opindex m68000
14640@opindex mc68000
14641Generate output for a 68000.  This is the default
14642when the compiler is configured for 68000-based systems.
14643It is equivalent to @option{-march=68000}.
14644
14645Use this option for microcontrollers with a 68000 or EC000 core,
14646including the 68008, 68302, 68306, 68307, 68322, 68328 and 68356.
14647
14648@item -m68010
14649@opindex m68010
14650Generate output for a 68010.  This is the default
14651when the compiler is configured for 68010-based systems.
14652It is equivalent to @option{-march=68010}.
14653
14654@item -m68020
14655@itemx -mc68020
14656@opindex m68020
14657@opindex mc68020
14658Generate output for a 68020.  This is the default
14659when the compiler is configured for 68020-based systems.
14660It is equivalent to @option{-march=68020}.
14661
14662@item -m68030
14663@opindex m68030
14664Generate output for a 68030.  This is the default when the compiler is
14665configured for 68030-based systems.  It is equivalent to
14666@option{-march=68030}.
14667
14668@item -m68040
14669@opindex m68040
14670Generate output for a 68040.  This is the default when the compiler is
14671configured for 68040-based systems.  It is equivalent to
14672@option{-march=68040}.
14673
14674This option inhibits the use of 68881/68882 instructions that have to be
14675emulated by software on the 68040.  Use this option if your 68040 does not
14676have code to emulate those instructions.
14677
14678@item -m68060
14679@opindex m68060
14680Generate output for a 68060.  This is the default when the compiler is
14681configured for 68060-based systems.  It is equivalent to
14682@option{-march=68060}.
14683
14684This option inhibits the use of 68020 and 68881/68882 instructions that
14685have to be emulated by software on the 68060.  Use this option if your 68060
14686does not have code to emulate those instructions.
14687
14688@item -mcpu32
14689@opindex mcpu32
14690Generate output for a CPU32.  This is the default
14691when the compiler is configured for CPU32-based systems.
14692It is equivalent to @option{-march=cpu32}.
14693
14694Use this option for microcontrollers with a
14695CPU32 or CPU32+ core, including the 68330, 68331, 68332, 68333, 68334,
1469668336, 68340, 68341, 68349 and 68360.
14697
14698@item -m5200
14699@opindex m5200
14700Generate output for a 520X ColdFire CPU@.  This is the default
14701when the compiler is configured for 520X-based systems.
14702It is equivalent to @option{-mcpu=5206}, and is now deprecated
14703in favor of that option.
14704
14705Use this option for microcontroller with a 5200 core, including
14706the MCF5202, MCF5203, MCF5204 and MCF5206.
14707
14708@item -m5206e
14709@opindex m5206e
14710Generate output for a 5206e ColdFire CPU@.  The option is now
14711deprecated in favor of the equivalent @option{-mcpu=5206e}.
14712
14713@item -m528x
14714@opindex m528x
14715Generate output for a member of the ColdFire 528X family.
14716The option is now deprecated in favor of the equivalent
14717@option{-mcpu=528x}.
14718
14719@item -m5307
14720@opindex m5307
14721Generate output for a ColdFire 5307 CPU@.  The option is now deprecated
14722in favor of the equivalent @option{-mcpu=5307}.
14723
14724@item -m5407
14725@opindex m5407
14726Generate output for a ColdFire 5407 CPU@.  The option is now deprecated
14727in favor of the equivalent @option{-mcpu=5407}.
14728
14729@item -mcfv4e
14730@opindex mcfv4e
14731Generate output for a ColdFire V4e family CPU (e.g.@: 547x/548x).
14732This includes use of hardware floating-point instructions.
14733The option is equivalent to @option{-mcpu=547x}, and is now
14734deprecated in favor of that option.
14735
14736@item -m68020-40
14737@opindex m68020-40
14738Generate output for a 68040, without using any of the new instructions.
14739This results in code that can run relatively efficiently on either a
1474068020/68881 or a 68030 or a 68040.  The generated code does use the
1474168881 instructions that are emulated on the 68040.
14742
14743The option is equivalent to @option{-march=68020} @option{-mtune=68020-40}.
14744
14745@item -m68020-60
14746@opindex m68020-60
14747Generate output for a 68060, without using any of the new instructions.
14748This results in code that can run relatively efficiently on either a
1474968020/68881 or a 68030 or a 68040.  The generated code does use the
1475068881 instructions that are emulated on the 68060.
14751
14752The option is equivalent to @option{-march=68020} @option{-mtune=68020-60}.
14753
14754@item -mhard-float
14755@itemx -m68881
14756@opindex mhard-float
14757@opindex m68881
14758Generate floating-point instructions.  This is the default for 68020
14759and above, and for ColdFire devices that have an FPU@.  It defines the
14760macro @samp{__HAVE_68881__} on M680x0 targets and @samp{__mcffpu__}
14761on ColdFire targets.
14762
14763@item -msoft-float
14764@opindex msoft-float
14765Do not generate floating-point instructions; use library calls instead.
14766This is the default for 68000, 68010, and 68832 targets.  It is also
14767the default for ColdFire devices that have no FPU.
14768
14769@item -mdiv
14770@itemx -mno-div
14771@opindex mdiv
14772@opindex mno-div
14773Generate (do not generate) ColdFire hardware divide and remainder
14774instructions.  If @option{-march} is used without @option{-mcpu},
14775the default is ``on'' for ColdFire architectures and ``off'' for M680x0
14776architectures.  Otherwise, the default is taken from the target CPU
14777(either the default CPU, or the one specified by @option{-mcpu}).  For
14778example, the default is ``off'' for @option{-mcpu=5206} and ``on'' for
14779@option{-mcpu=5206e}.
14780
14781gcc defines the macro @samp{__mcfhwdiv__} when this option is enabled.
14782
14783@item -mshort
14784@opindex mshort
14785Consider type @code{int} to be 16 bits wide, like @code{short int}.
14786Additionally, parameters passed on the stack are also aligned to a
1478716-bit boundary even on targets whose API mandates promotion to 32-bit.
14788
14789@item -mno-short
14790@opindex mno-short
14791Do not consider type @code{int} to be 16 bits wide.  This is the default.
14792
14793@item -mnobitfield
14794@itemx -mno-bitfield
14795@opindex mnobitfield
14796@opindex mno-bitfield
14797Do not use the bit-field instructions.  The @option{-m68000}, @option{-mcpu32}
14798and @option{-m5200} options imply @w{@option{-mnobitfield}}.
14799
14800@item -mbitfield
14801@opindex mbitfield
14802Do use the bit-field instructions.  The @option{-m68020} option implies
14803@option{-mbitfield}.  This is the default if you use a configuration
14804designed for a 68020.
14805
14806@item -mrtd
14807@opindex mrtd
14808Use a different function-calling convention, in which functions
14809that take a fixed number of arguments return with the @code{rtd}
14810instruction, which pops their arguments while returning.  This
14811saves one instruction in the caller since there is no need to pop
14812the arguments there.
14813
14814This calling convention is incompatible with the one normally
14815used on Unix, so you cannot use it if you need to call libraries
14816compiled with the Unix compiler.
14817
14818Also, you must provide function prototypes for all functions that
14819take variable numbers of arguments (including @code{printf});
14820otherwise incorrect code will be generated for calls to those
14821functions.
14822
14823In addition, seriously incorrect code will result if you call a
14824function with too many arguments.  (Normally, extra arguments are
14825harmlessly ignored.)
14826
14827The @code{rtd} instruction is supported by the 68010, 68020, 68030,
1482868040, 68060 and CPU32 processors, but not by the 68000 or 5200.
14829
14830@item -mno-rtd
14831@opindex mno-rtd
14832Do not use the calling conventions selected by @option{-mrtd}.
14833This is the default.
14834
14835@item -malign-int
14836@itemx -mno-align-int
14837@opindex malign-int
14838@opindex mno-align-int
14839Control whether GCC aligns @code{int}, @code{long}, @code{long long},
14840@code{float}, @code{double}, and @code{long double} variables on a 32-bit
14841boundary (@option{-malign-int}) or a 16-bit boundary (@option{-mno-align-int}).
14842Aligning variables on 32-bit boundaries produces code that runs somewhat
14843faster on processors with 32-bit busses at the expense of more memory.
14844
14845@strong{Warning:} if you use the @option{-malign-int} switch, GCC will
14846align structures containing the above types  differently than
14847most published application binary interface specifications for the m68k.
14848
14849@item -mpcrel
14850@opindex mpcrel
14851Use the pc-relative addressing mode of the 68000 directly, instead of
14852using a global offset table.  At present, this option implies @option{-fpic},
14853allowing at most a 16-bit offset for pc-relative addressing.  @option{-fPIC} is
14854not presently supported with @option{-mpcrel}, though this could be supported for
1485568020 and higher processors.
14856
14857@item -mno-strict-align
14858@itemx -mstrict-align
14859@opindex mno-strict-align
14860@opindex mstrict-align
14861Do not (do) assume that unaligned memory references will be handled by
14862the system.
14863
14864@item -msep-data
14865Generate code that allows the data segment to be located in a different
14866area of memory from the text segment.  This allows for execute in place in
14867an environment without virtual memory management.  This option implies
14868@option{-fPIC}.
14869
14870@item -mno-sep-data
14871Generate code that assumes that the data segment follows the text segment.
14872This is the default.
14873
14874@item -mid-shared-library
14875Generate code that supports shared libraries via the library ID method.
14876This allows for execute in place and shared libraries in an environment
14877without virtual memory management.  This option implies @option{-fPIC}.
14878
14879@item -mno-id-shared-library
14880Generate code that doesn't assume ID based shared libraries are being used.
14881This is the default.
14882
14883@item -mshared-library-id=n
14884Specified the identification number of the ID based shared library being
14885compiled.  Specifying a value of 0 will generate more compact code, specifying
14886other values will force the allocation of that number to the current
14887library but is no more space or time efficient than omitting this option.
14888
14889@item -mxgot
14890@itemx -mno-xgot
14891@opindex mxgot
14892@opindex mno-xgot
14893When generating position-independent code for ColdFire, generate code
14894that works if the GOT has more than 8192 entries.  This code is
14895larger and slower than code generated without this option.  On M680x0
14896processors, this option is not needed; @option{-fPIC} suffices.
14897
14898GCC normally uses a single instruction to load values from the GOT@.
14899While this is relatively efficient, it only works if the GOT
14900is smaller than about 64k.  Anything larger causes the linker
14901to report an error such as:
14902
14903@cindex relocation truncated to fit (ColdFire)
14904@smallexample
14905relocation truncated to fit: R_68K_GOT16O foobar
14906@end smallexample
14907
14908If this happens, you should recompile your code with @option{-mxgot}.
14909It should then work with very large GOTs.  However, code generated with
14910@option{-mxgot} is less efficient, since it takes 4 instructions to fetch
14911the value of a global symbol.
14912
14913Note that some linkers, including newer versions of the GNU linker,
14914can create multiple GOTs and sort GOT entries.  If you have such a linker,
14915you should only need to use @option{-mxgot} when compiling a single
14916object file that accesses more than 8192 GOT entries.  Very few do.
14917
14918These options have no effect unless GCC is generating
14919position-independent code.
14920
14921@end table
14922
14923@node MCore Options
14924@subsection MCore Options
14925@cindex MCore options
14926
14927These are the @samp{-m} options defined for the Motorola M*Core
14928processors.
14929
14930@table @gcctabopt
14931
14932@item -mhardlit
14933@itemx -mno-hardlit
14934@opindex mhardlit
14935@opindex mno-hardlit
14936Inline constants into the code stream if it can be done in two
14937instructions or less.
14938
14939@item -mdiv
14940@itemx -mno-div
14941@opindex mdiv
14942@opindex mno-div
14943Use the divide instruction.  (Enabled by default).
14944
14945@item -mrelax-immediate
14946@itemx -mno-relax-immediate
14947@opindex mrelax-immediate
14948@opindex mno-relax-immediate
14949Allow arbitrary sized immediates in bit operations.
14950
14951@item -mwide-bitfields
14952@itemx -mno-wide-bitfields
14953@opindex mwide-bitfields
14954@opindex mno-wide-bitfields
14955Always treat bit-fields as int-sized.
14956
14957@item -m4byte-functions
14958@itemx -mno-4byte-functions
14959@opindex m4byte-functions
14960@opindex mno-4byte-functions
14961Force all functions to be aligned to a 4-byte boundary.
14962
14963@item -mcallgraph-data
14964@itemx -mno-callgraph-data
14965@opindex mcallgraph-data
14966@opindex mno-callgraph-data
14967Emit callgraph information.
14968
14969@item -mslow-bytes
14970@itemx -mno-slow-bytes
14971@opindex mslow-bytes
14972@opindex mno-slow-bytes
14973Prefer word access when reading byte quantities.
14974
14975@item -mlittle-endian
14976@itemx -mbig-endian
14977@opindex mlittle-endian
14978@opindex mbig-endian
14979Generate code for a little-endian target.
14980
14981@item -m210
14982@itemx -m340
14983@opindex m210
14984@opindex m340
14985Generate code for the 210 processor.
14986
14987@item -mno-lsim
14988@opindex mno-lsim
14989Assume that runtime support has been provided and so omit the
14990simulator library (@file{libsim.a)} from the linker command line.
14991
14992@item -mstack-increment=@var{size}
14993@opindex mstack-increment
14994Set the maximum amount for a single stack increment operation.  Large
14995values can increase the speed of programs that contain functions
14996that need a large amount of stack space, but they can also trigger a
14997segmentation fault if the stack is extended too much.  The default
14998value is 0x1000.
14999
15000@end table
15001
15002@node MeP Options
15003@subsection MeP Options
15004@cindex MeP options
15005
15006@table @gcctabopt
15007
15008@item -mabsdiff
15009@opindex mabsdiff
15010Enables the @code{abs} instruction, which is the absolute difference
15011between two registers.
15012
15013@item -mall-opts
15014@opindex mall-opts
15015Enables all the optional instructions - average, multiply, divide, bit
15016operations, leading zero, absolute difference, min/max, clip, and
15017saturation.
15018
15019
15020@item -maverage
15021@opindex maverage
15022Enables the @code{ave} instruction, which computes the average of two
15023registers.
15024
15025@item -mbased=@var{n}
15026@opindex mbased=
15027Variables of size @var{n} bytes or smaller will be placed in the
15028@code{.based} section by default.  Based variables use the @code{$tp}
15029register as a base register, and there is a 128-byte limit to the
15030@code{.based} section.
15031
15032@item -mbitops
15033@opindex mbitops
15034Enables the bit operation instructions - bit test (@code{btstm}), set
15035(@code{bsetm}), clear (@code{bclrm}), invert (@code{bnotm}), and
15036test-and-set (@code{tas}).
15037
15038@item -mc=@var{name}
15039@opindex mc=
15040Selects which section constant data will be placed in.  @var{name} may
15041be @code{tiny}, @code{near}, or @code{far}.
15042
15043@item -mclip
15044@opindex mclip
15045Enables the @code{clip} instruction.  Note that @code{-mclip} is not
15046useful unless you also provide @code{-mminmax}.
15047
15048@item -mconfig=@var{name}
15049@opindex mconfig=
15050Selects one of the build-in core configurations.  Each MeP chip has
15051one or more modules in it; each module has a core CPU and a variety of
15052coprocessors, optional instructions, and peripherals.  The
15053@code{MeP-Integrator} tool, not part of GCC, provides these
15054configurations through this option; using this option is the same as
15055using all the corresponding command-line options.  The default
15056configuration is @code{default}.
15057
15058@item -mcop
15059@opindex mcop
15060Enables the coprocessor instructions.  By default, this is a 32-bit
15061coprocessor.  Note that the coprocessor is normally enabled via the
15062@code{-mconfig=} option.
15063
15064@item -mcop32
15065@opindex mcop32
15066Enables the 32-bit coprocessor's instructions.
15067
15068@item -mcop64
15069@opindex mcop64
15070Enables the 64-bit coprocessor's instructions.
15071
15072@item -mivc2
15073@opindex mivc2
15074Enables IVC2 scheduling.  IVC2 is a 64-bit VLIW coprocessor.
15075
15076@item -mdc
15077@opindex mdc
15078Causes constant variables to be placed in the @code{.near} section.
15079
15080@item -mdiv
15081@opindex mdiv
15082Enables the @code{div} and @code{divu} instructions.
15083
15084@item -meb
15085@opindex meb
15086Generate big-endian code.
15087
15088@item -mel
15089@opindex mel
15090Generate little-endian code.
15091
15092@item -mio-volatile
15093@opindex mio-volatile
15094Tells the compiler that any variable marked with the @code{io}
15095attribute is to be considered volatile.
15096
15097@item -ml
15098@opindex ml
15099Causes variables to be assigned to the @code{.far} section by default.
15100
15101@item -mleadz
15102@opindex mleadz
15103Enables the @code{leadz} (leading zero) instruction.
15104
15105@item -mm
15106@opindex mm
15107Causes variables to be assigned to the @code{.near} section by default.
15108
15109@item -mminmax
15110@opindex mminmax
15111Enables the @code{min} and @code{max} instructions.
15112
15113@item -mmult
15114@opindex mmult
15115Enables the multiplication and multiply-accumulate instructions.
15116
15117@item -mno-opts
15118@opindex mno-opts
15119Disables all the optional instructions enabled by @code{-mall-opts}.
15120
15121@item -mrepeat
15122@opindex mrepeat
15123Enables the @code{repeat} and @code{erepeat} instructions, used for
15124low-overhead looping.
15125
15126@item -ms
15127@opindex ms
15128Causes all variables to default to the @code{.tiny} section.  Note
15129that there is a 65536-byte limit to this section.  Accesses to these
15130variables use the @code{%gp} base register.
15131
15132@item -msatur
15133@opindex msatur
15134Enables the saturation instructions.  Note that the compiler does not
15135currently generate these itself, but this option is included for
15136compatibility with other tools, like @code{as}.
15137
15138@item -msdram
15139@opindex msdram
15140Link the SDRAM-based runtime instead of the default ROM-based runtime.
15141
15142@item -msim
15143@opindex msim
15144Link the simulator runtime libraries.
15145
15146@item -msimnovec
15147@opindex msimnovec
15148Link the simulator runtime libraries, excluding built-in support
15149for reset and exception vectors and tables.
15150
15151@item -mtf
15152@opindex mtf
15153Causes all functions to default to the @code{.far} section.  Without
15154this option, functions default to the @code{.near} section.
15155
15156@item -mtiny=@var{n}
15157@opindex mtiny=
15158Variables that are @var{n} bytes or smaller will be allocated to the
15159@code{.tiny} section.  These variables use the @code{$gp} base
15160register.  The default for this option is 4, but note that there's a
1516165536-byte limit to the @code{.tiny} section.
15162
15163@end table
15164
15165@node MicroBlaze Options
15166@subsection MicroBlaze Options
15167@cindex MicroBlaze Options
15168
15169@table @gcctabopt
15170
15171@item -msoft-float
15172@opindex msoft-float
15173Use software emulation for floating point (default).
15174
15175@item -mhard-float
15176@opindex mhard-float
15177Use hardware floating-point instructions.
15178
15179@item -mmemcpy
15180@opindex mmemcpy
15181Do not optimize block moves, use @code{memcpy}.
15182
15183@item -mno-clearbss
15184@opindex mno-clearbss
15185This option is deprecated.  Use @option{-fno-zero-initialized-in-bss} instead.
15186
15187@item -mcpu=@var{cpu-type}
15188@opindex mcpu=
15189Use features of and schedule code for given CPU.
15190Supported values are in the format @samp{v@var{X}.@var{YY}.@var{Z}},
15191where @var{X} is a major version, @var{YY} is the minor version, and
15192@var{Z} is compatibility code.  Example values are @samp{v3.00.a},
15193@samp{v4.00.b}, @samp{v5.00.a}, @samp{v5.00.b}, @samp{v5.00.b}, @samp{v6.00.a}.
15194
15195@item -mxl-soft-mul
15196@opindex mxl-soft-mul
15197Use software multiply emulation (default).
15198
15199@item -mxl-soft-div
15200@opindex mxl-soft-div
15201Use software emulation for divides (default).
15202
15203@item -mxl-barrel-shift
15204@opindex mxl-barrel-shift
15205Use the hardware barrel shifter.
15206
15207@item -mxl-pattern-compare
15208@opindex mxl-pattern-compare
15209Use pattern compare instructions.
15210
15211@item -msmall-divides
15212@opindex msmall-divides
15213Use table lookup optimization for small signed integer divisions.
15214
15215@item -mxl-stack-check
15216@opindex mxl-stack-check
15217This option is deprecated.  Use -fstack-check instead.
15218
15219@item -mxl-gp-opt
15220@opindex mxl-gp-opt
15221Use GP relative sdata/sbss sections.
15222
15223@item -mxl-multiply-high
15224@opindex mxl-multiply-high
15225Use multiply high instructions for high part of 32x32 multiply.
15226
15227@item -mxl-float-convert
15228@opindex mxl-float-convert
15229Use hardware floating-point conversion instructions.
15230
15231@item -mxl-float-sqrt
15232@opindex mxl-float-sqrt
15233Use hardware floating-point square root instruction.
15234
15235@item -mxl-mode-@var{app-model}
15236Select application model @var{app-model}.  Valid models are
15237@table @samp
15238@item executable
15239normal executable (default), uses startup code @file{crt0.o}.
15240
15241@item xmdstub
15242for use with Xilinx Microprocessor Debugger (XMD) based
15243software intrusive debug agent called xmdstub. This uses startup file
15244@file{crt1.o} and sets the start address of the program to be 0x800.
15245
15246@item bootstrap
15247for applications that are loaded using a bootloader.
15248This model uses startup file @file{crt2.o} which does not contain a processor
15249reset vector handler. This is suitable for transferring control on a
15250processor reset to the bootloader rather than the application.
15251
15252@item novectors
15253for applications that do not require any of the
15254MicroBlaze vectors. This option may be useful for applications running
15255within a monitoring application. This model uses @file{crt3.o} as a startup file.
15256@end table
15257
15258Option @option{-xl-mode-@var{app-model}} is a deprecated alias for
15259@option{-mxl-mode-@var{app-model}}.
15260
15261@end table
15262
15263@node MIPS Options
15264@subsection MIPS Options
15265@cindex MIPS options
15266
15267@table @gcctabopt
15268
15269@item -EB
15270@opindex EB
15271Generate big-endian code.
15272
15273@item -EL
15274@opindex EL
15275Generate little-endian code.  This is the default for @samp{mips*el-*-*}
15276configurations.
15277
15278@item -march=@var{arch}
15279@opindex march
15280Generate code that will run on @var{arch}, which can be the name of a
15281generic MIPS ISA, or the name of a particular processor.
15282The ISA names are:
15283@samp{mips1}, @samp{mips2}, @samp{mips3}, @samp{mips4},
15284@samp{mips32}, @samp{mips32r2}, @samp{mips64} and @samp{mips64r2}.
15285The processor names are:
15286@samp{4kc}, @samp{4km}, @samp{4kp}, @samp{4ksc},
15287@samp{4kec}, @samp{4kem}, @samp{4kep}, @samp{4ksd},
15288@samp{5kc}, @samp{5kf},
15289@samp{20kc},
15290@samp{24kc}, @samp{24kf2_1}, @samp{24kf1_1},
15291@samp{24kec}, @samp{24kef2_1}, @samp{24kef1_1},
15292@samp{34kc}, @samp{34kf2_1}, @samp{34kf1_1},
15293@samp{74kc}, @samp{74kf2_1}, @samp{74kf1_1}, @samp{74kf3_2},
15294@samp{1004kc}, @samp{1004kf2_1}, @samp{1004kf1_1},
15295@samp{loongson2e}, @samp{loongson2f}, @samp{loongson3a},
15296@samp{m4k},
15297@samp{octeon}, @samp{octeon+}, @samp{octeon2},
15298@samp{orion},
15299@samp{r2000}, @samp{r3000}, @samp{r3900}, @samp{r4000}, @samp{r4400},
15300@samp{r4600}, @samp{r4650}, @samp{r6000}, @samp{r8000},
15301@samp{rm7000}, @samp{rm9000},
15302@samp{r10000}, @samp{r12000}, @samp{r14000}, @samp{r16000},
15303@samp{sb1},
15304@samp{sr71000},
15305@samp{vr4100}, @samp{vr4111}, @samp{vr4120}, @samp{vr4130}, @samp{vr4300},
15306@samp{vr5000}, @samp{vr5400}, @samp{vr5500}
15307and @samp{xlr}.
15308The special value @samp{from-abi} selects the
15309most compatible architecture for the selected ABI (that is,
15310@samp{mips1} for 32-bit ABIs and @samp{mips3} for 64-bit ABIs)@.
15311
15312Native Linux/GNU and IRIX toolchains also support the value @samp{native},
15313which selects the best architecture option for the host processor.
15314@option{-march=native} has no effect if GCC does not recognize
15315the processor.
15316
15317In processor names, a final @samp{000} can be abbreviated as @samp{k}
15318(for example, @samp{-march=r2k}).  Prefixes are optional, and
15319@samp{vr} may be written @samp{r}.
15320
15321Names of the form @samp{@var{n}f2_1} refer to processors with
15322FPUs clocked at half the rate of the core, names of the form
15323@samp{@var{n}f1_1} refer to processors with FPUs clocked at the same
15324rate as the core, and names of the form @samp{@var{n}f3_2} refer to
15325processors with FPUs clocked a ratio of 3:2 with respect to the core.
15326For compatibility reasons, @samp{@var{n}f} is accepted as a synonym
15327for @samp{@var{n}f2_1} while @samp{@var{n}x} and @samp{@var{b}fx} are
15328accepted as synonyms for @samp{@var{n}f1_1}.
15329
15330GCC defines two macros based on the value of this option.  The first
15331is @samp{_MIPS_ARCH}, which gives the name of target architecture, as
15332a string.  The second has the form @samp{_MIPS_ARCH_@var{foo}},
15333where @var{foo} is the capitalized value of @samp{_MIPS_ARCH}@.
15334For example, @samp{-march=r2000} will set @samp{_MIPS_ARCH}
15335to @samp{"r2000"} and define the macro @samp{_MIPS_ARCH_R2000}.
15336
15337Note that the @samp{_MIPS_ARCH} macro uses the processor names given
15338above.  In other words, it will have the full prefix and will not
15339abbreviate @samp{000} as @samp{k}.  In the case of @samp{from-abi},
15340the macro names the resolved architecture (either @samp{"mips1"} or
15341@samp{"mips3"}).  It names the default architecture when no
15342@option{-march} option is given.
15343
15344@item -mtune=@var{arch}
15345@opindex mtune
15346Optimize for @var{arch}.  Among other things, this option controls
15347the way instructions are scheduled, and the perceived cost of arithmetic
15348operations.  The list of @var{arch} values is the same as for
15349@option{-march}.
15350
15351When this option is not used, GCC will optimize for the processor
15352specified by @option{-march}.  By using @option{-march} and
15353@option{-mtune} together, it is possible to generate code that will
15354run on a family of processors, but optimize the code for one
15355particular member of that family.
15356
15357@samp{-mtune} defines the macros @samp{_MIPS_TUNE} and
15358@samp{_MIPS_TUNE_@var{foo}}, which work in the same way as the
15359@samp{-march} ones described above.
15360
15361@item -mips1
15362@opindex mips1
15363Equivalent to @samp{-march=mips1}.
15364
15365@item -mips2
15366@opindex mips2
15367Equivalent to @samp{-march=mips2}.
15368
15369@item -mips3
15370@opindex mips3
15371Equivalent to @samp{-march=mips3}.
15372
15373@item -mips4
15374@opindex mips4
15375Equivalent to @samp{-march=mips4}.
15376
15377@item -mips32
15378@opindex mips32
15379Equivalent to @samp{-march=mips32}.
15380
15381@item -mips32r2
15382@opindex mips32r2
15383Equivalent to @samp{-march=mips32r2}.
15384
15385@item -mips64
15386@opindex mips64
15387Equivalent to @samp{-march=mips64}.
15388
15389@item -mips64r2
15390@opindex mips64r2
15391Equivalent to @samp{-march=mips64r2}.
15392
15393@item -mips16
15394@itemx -mno-mips16
15395@opindex mips16
15396@opindex mno-mips16
15397Generate (do not generate) MIPS16 code.  If GCC is targetting a
15398MIPS32 or MIPS64 architecture, it will make use of the MIPS16e ASE@.
15399
15400MIPS16 code generation can also be controlled on a per-function basis
15401by means of @code{mips16} and @code{nomips16} attributes.
15402@xref{Function Attributes}, for more information.
15403
15404@item -mflip-mips16
15405@opindex mflip-mips16
15406Generate MIPS16 code on alternating functions.  This option is provided
15407for regression testing of mixed MIPS16/non-MIPS16 code generation, and is
15408not intended for ordinary use in compiling user code.
15409
15410@item -minterlink-mips16
15411@itemx -mno-interlink-mips16
15412@opindex minterlink-mips16
15413@opindex mno-interlink-mips16
15414Require (do not require) that non-MIPS16 code be link-compatible with
15415MIPS16 code.
15416
15417For example, non-MIPS16 code cannot jump directly to MIPS16 code;
15418it must either use a call or an indirect jump.  @option{-minterlink-mips16}
15419therefore disables direct jumps unless GCC knows that the target of the
15420jump is not MIPS16.
15421
15422@item -mabi=32
15423@itemx -mabi=o64
15424@itemx -mabi=n32
15425@itemx -mabi=64
15426@itemx -mabi=eabi
15427@opindex mabi=32
15428@opindex mabi=o64
15429@opindex mabi=n32
15430@opindex mabi=64
15431@opindex mabi=eabi
15432Generate code for the given ABI@.
15433
15434Note that the EABI has a 32-bit and a 64-bit variant.  GCC normally
15435generates 64-bit code when you select a 64-bit architecture, but you
15436can use @option{-mgp32} to get 32-bit code instead.
15437
15438For information about the O64 ABI, see
15439@uref{http://gcc.gnu.org/@/projects/@/mipso64-abi.html}.
15440
15441GCC supports a variant of the o32 ABI in which floating-point registers
15442are 64 rather than 32 bits wide.  You can select this combination with
15443@option{-mabi=32} @option{-mfp64}.  This ABI relies on the @samp{mthc1}
15444and @samp{mfhc1} instructions and is therefore only supported for
15445MIPS32R2 processors.
15446
15447The register assignments for arguments and return values remain the
15448same, but each scalar value is passed in a single 64-bit register
15449rather than a pair of 32-bit registers.  For example, scalar
15450floating-point values are returned in @samp{$f0} only, not a
15451@samp{$f0}/@samp{$f1} pair.  The set of call-saved registers also
15452remains the same, but all 64 bits are saved.
15453
15454@item -mabicalls
15455@itemx -mno-abicalls
15456@opindex mabicalls
15457@opindex mno-abicalls
15458Generate (do not generate) code that is suitable for SVR4-style
15459dynamic objects.  @option{-mabicalls} is the default for SVR4-based
15460systems.
15461
15462@item -mshared
15463@itemx -mno-shared
15464Generate (do not generate) code that is fully position-independent,
15465and that can therefore be linked into shared libraries.  This option
15466only affects @option{-mabicalls}.
15467
15468All @option{-mabicalls} code has traditionally been position-independent,
15469regardless of options like @option{-fPIC} and @option{-fpic}.  However,
15470as an extension, the GNU toolchain allows executables to use absolute
15471accesses for locally-binding symbols.  It can also use shorter GP
15472initialization sequences and generate direct calls to locally-defined
15473functions.  This mode is selected by @option{-mno-shared}.
15474
15475@option{-mno-shared} depends on binutils 2.16 or higher and generates
15476objects that can only be linked by the GNU linker.  However, the option
15477does not affect the ABI of the final executable; it only affects the ABI
15478of relocatable objects.  Using @option{-mno-shared} will generally make
15479executables both smaller and quicker.
15480
15481@option{-mshared} is the default.
15482
15483@item -mplt
15484@itemx -mno-plt
15485@opindex mplt
15486@opindex mno-plt
15487Assume (do not assume) that the static and dynamic linkers
15488support PLTs and copy relocations.  This option only affects
15489@samp{-mno-shared -mabicalls}.  For the n64 ABI, this option
15490has no effect without @samp{-msym32}.
15491
15492You can make @option{-mplt} the default by configuring
15493GCC with @option{--with-mips-plt}.  The default is
15494@option{-mno-plt} otherwise.
15495
15496@item -mxgot
15497@itemx -mno-xgot
15498@opindex mxgot
15499@opindex mno-xgot
15500Lift (do not lift) the usual restrictions on the size of the global
15501offset table.
15502
15503GCC normally uses a single instruction to load values from the GOT@.
15504While this is relatively efficient, it will only work if the GOT
15505is smaller than about 64k.  Anything larger will cause the linker
15506to report an error such as:
15507
15508@cindex relocation truncated to fit (MIPS)
15509@smallexample
15510relocation truncated to fit: R_MIPS_GOT16 foobar
15511@end smallexample
15512
15513If this happens, you should recompile your code with @option{-mxgot}.
15514It should then work with very large GOTs, although it will also be
15515less efficient, since it will take three instructions to fetch the
15516value of a global symbol.
15517
15518Note that some linkers can create multiple GOTs.  If you have such a
15519linker, you should only need to use @option{-mxgot} when a single object
15520file accesses more than 64k's worth of GOT entries.  Very few do.
15521
15522These options have no effect unless GCC is generating position
15523independent code.
15524
15525@item -mgp32
15526@opindex mgp32
15527Assume that general-purpose registers are 32 bits wide.
15528
15529@item -mgp64
15530@opindex mgp64
15531Assume that general-purpose registers are 64 bits wide.
15532
15533@item -mfp32
15534@opindex mfp32
15535Assume that floating-point registers are 32 bits wide.
15536
15537@item -mfp64
15538@opindex mfp64
15539Assume that floating-point registers are 64 bits wide.
15540
15541@item -mhard-float
15542@opindex mhard-float
15543Use floating-point coprocessor instructions.
15544
15545@item -msoft-float
15546@opindex msoft-float
15547Do not use floating-point coprocessor instructions.  Implement
15548floating-point calculations using library calls instead.
15549
15550@item -msingle-float
15551@opindex msingle-float
15552Assume that the floating-point coprocessor only supports single-precision
15553operations.
15554
15555@item -mdouble-float
15556@opindex mdouble-float
15557Assume that the floating-point coprocessor supports double-precision
15558operations.  This is the default.
15559
15560@item -mllsc
15561@itemx -mno-llsc
15562@opindex mllsc
15563@opindex mno-llsc
15564Use (do not use) @samp{ll}, @samp{sc}, and @samp{sync} instructions to
15565implement atomic memory built-in functions.  When neither option is
15566specified, GCC will use the instructions if the target architecture
15567supports them.
15568
15569@option{-mllsc} is useful if the runtime environment can emulate the
15570instructions and @option{-mno-llsc} can be useful when compiling for
15571nonstandard ISAs.  You can make either option the default by
15572configuring GCC with @option{--with-llsc} and @option{--without-llsc}
15573respectively.  @option{--with-llsc} is the default for some
15574configurations; see the installation documentation for details.
15575
15576@item -mdsp
15577@itemx -mno-dsp
15578@opindex mdsp
15579@opindex mno-dsp
15580Use (do not use) revision 1 of the MIPS DSP ASE@.
15581@xref{MIPS DSP Built-in Functions}.  This option defines the
15582preprocessor macro @samp{__mips_dsp}.  It also defines
15583@samp{__mips_dsp_rev} to 1.
15584
15585@item -mdspr2
15586@itemx -mno-dspr2
15587@opindex mdspr2
15588@opindex mno-dspr2
15589Use (do not use) revision 2 of the MIPS DSP ASE@.
15590@xref{MIPS DSP Built-in Functions}.  This option defines the
15591preprocessor macros @samp{__mips_dsp} and @samp{__mips_dspr2}.
15592It also defines @samp{__mips_dsp_rev} to 2.
15593
15594@item -msmartmips
15595@itemx -mno-smartmips
15596@opindex msmartmips
15597@opindex mno-smartmips
15598Use (do not use) the MIPS SmartMIPS ASE.
15599
15600@item -mpaired-single
15601@itemx -mno-paired-single
15602@opindex mpaired-single
15603@opindex mno-paired-single
15604Use (do not use) paired-single floating-point instructions.
15605@xref{MIPS Paired-Single Support}.  This option requires
15606hardware floating-point support to be enabled.
15607
15608@item -mdmx
15609@itemx -mno-mdmx
15610@opindex mdmx
15611@opindex mno-mdmx
15612Use (do not use) MIPS Digital Media Extension instructions.
15613This option can only be used when generating 64-bit code and requires
15614hardware floating-point support to be enabled.
15615
15616@item -mips3d
15617@itemx -mno-mips3d
15618@opindex mips3d
15619@opindex mno-mips3d
15620Use (do not use) the MIPS-3D ASE@.  @xref{MIPS-3D Built-in Functions}.
15621The option @option{-mips3d} implies @option{-mpaired-single}.
15622
15623@item -mmt
15624@itemx -mno-mt
15625@opindex mmt
15626@opindex mno-mt
15627Use (do not use) MT Multithreading instructions.
15628
15629@item -mlong64
15630@opindex mlong64
15631Force @code{long} types to be 64 bits wide.  See @option{-mlong32} for
15632an explanation of the default and the way that the pointer size is
15633determined.
15634
15635@item -mlong32
15636@opindex mlong32
15637Force @code{long}, @code{int}, and pointer types to be 32 bits wide.
15638
15639The default size of @code{int}s, @code{long}s and pointers depends on
15640the ABI@.  All the supported ABIs use 32-bit @code{int}s.  The n64 ABI
15641uses 64-bit @code{long}s, as does the 64-bit EABI; the others use
1564232-bit @code{long}s.  Pointers are the same size as @code{long}s,
15643or the same size as integer registers, whichever is smaller.
15644
15645@item -msym32
15646@itemx -mno-sym32
15647@opindex msym32
15648@opindex mno-sym32
15649Assume (do not assume) that all symbols have 32-bit values, regardless
15650of the selected ABI@.  This option is useful in combination with
15651@option{-mabi=64} and @option{-mno-abicalls} because it allows GCC
15652to generate shorter and faster references to symbolic addresses.
15653
15654@item -G @var{num}
15655@opindex G
15656Put definitions of externally-visible data in a small data section
15657if that data is no bigger than @var{num} bytes.  GCC can then access
15658the data more efficiently; see @option{-mgpopt} for details.
15659
15660The default @option{-G} option depends on the configuration.
15661
15662@item -mlocal-sdata
15663@itemx -mno-local-sdata
15664@opindex mlocal-sdata
15665@opindex mno-local-sdata
15666Extend (do not extend) the @option{-G} behavior to local data too,
15667such as to static variables in C@.  @option{-mlocal-sdata} is the
15668default for all configurations.
15669
15670If the linker complains that an application is using too much small data,
15671you might want to try rebuilding the less performance-critical parts with
15672@option{-mno-local-sdata}.  You might also want to build large
15673libraries with @option{-mno-local-sdata}, so that the libraries leave
15674more room for the main program.
15675
15676@item -mextern-sdata
15677@itemx -mno-extern-sdata
15678@opindex mextern-sdata
15679@opindex mno-extern-sdata
15680Assume (do not assume) that externally-defined data will be in
15681a small data section if that data is within the @option{-G} limit.
15682@option{-mextern-sdata} is the default for all configurations.
15683
15684If you compile a module @var{Mod} with @option{-mextern-sdata} @option{-G
15685@var{num}} @option{-mgpopt}, and @var{Mod} references a variable @var{Var}
15686that is no bigger than @var{num} bytes, you must make sure that @var{Var}
15687is placed in a small data section.  If @var{Var} is defined by another
15688module, you must either compile that module with a high-enough
15689@option{-G} setting or attach a @code{section} attribute to @var{Var}'s
15690definition.  If @var{Var} is common, you must link the application
15691with a high-enough @option{-G} setting.
15692
15693The easiest way of satisfying these restrictions is to compile
15694and link every module with the same @option{-G} option.  However,
15695you may wish to build a library that supports several different
15696small data limits.  You can do this by compiling the library with
15697the highest supported @option{-G} setting and additionally using
15698@option{-mno-extern-sdata} to stop the library from making assumptions
15699about externally-defined data.
15700
15701@item -mgpopt
15702@itemx -mno-gpopt
15703@opindex mgpopt
15704@opindex mno-gpopt
15705Use (do not use) GP-relative accesses for symbols that are known to be
15706in a small data section; see @option{-G}, @option{-mlocal-sdata} and
15707@option{-mextern-sdata}.  @option{-mgpopt} is the default for all
15708configurations.
15709
15710@option{-mno-gpopt} is useful for cases where the @code{$gp} register
15711might not hold the value of @code{_gp}.  For example, if the code is
15712part of a library that might be used in a boot monitor, programs that
15713call boot monitor routines will pass an unknown value in @code{$gp}.
15714(In such situations, the boot monitor itself would usually be compiled
15715with @option{-G0}.)
15716
15717@option{-mno-gpopt} implies @option{-mno-local-sdata} and
15718@option{-mno-extern-sdata}.
15719
15720@item -membedded-data
15721@itemx -mno-embedded-data
15722@opindex membedded-data
15723@opindex mno-embedded-data
15724Allocate variables to the read-only data section first if possible, then
15725next in the small data section if possible, otherwise in data.  This gives
15726slightly slower code than the default, but reduces the amount of RAM required
15727when executing, and thus may be preferred for some embedded systems.
15728
15729@item -muninit-const-in-rodata
15730@itemx -mno-uninit-const-in-rodata
15731@opindex muninit-const-in-rodata
15732@opindex mno-uninit-const-in-rodata
15733Put uninitialized @code{const} variables in the read-only data section.
15734This option is only meaningful in conjunction with @option{-membedded-data}.
15735
15736@item -mcode-readable=@var{setting}
15737@opindex mcode-readable
15738Specify whether GCC may generate code that reads from executable sections.
15739There are three possible settings:
15740
15741@table @gcctabopt
15742@item -mcode-readable=yes
15743Instructions may freely access executable sections.  This is the
15744default setting.
15745
15746@item -mcode-readable=pcrel
15747MIPS16 PC-relative load instructions can access executable sections,
15748but other instructions must not do so.  This option is useful on 4KSc
15749and 4KSd processors when the code TLBs have the Read Inhibit bit set.
15750It is also useful on processors that can be configured to have a dual
15751instruction/data SRAM interface and that, like the M4K, automatically
15752redirect PC-relative loads to the instruction RAM.
15753
15754@item -mcode-readable=no
15755Instructions must not access executable sections.  This option can be
15756useful on targets that are configured to have a dual instruction/data
15757SRAM interface but that (unlike the M4K) do not automatically redirect
15758PC-relative loads to the instruction RAM.
15759@end table
15760
15761@item -msplit-addresses
15762@itemx -mno-split-addresses
15763@opindex msplit-addresses
15764@opindex mno-split-addresses
15765Enable (disable) use of the @code{%hi()} and @code{%lo()} assembler
15766relocation operators.  This option has been superseded by
15767@option{-mexplicit-relocs} but is retained for backwards compatibility.
15768
15769@item -mexplicit-relocs
15770@itemx -mno-explicit-relocs
15771@opindex mexplicit-relocs
15772@opindex mno-explicit-relocs
15773Use (do not use) assembler relocation operators when dealing with symbolic
15774addresses.  The alternative, selected by @option{-mno-explicit-relocs},
15775is to use assembler macros instead.
15776
15777@option{-mexplicit-relocs} is the default if GCC was configured
15778to use an assembler that supports relocation operators.
15779
15780@item -mcheck-zero-division
15781@itemx -mno-check-zero-division
15782@opindex mcheck-zero-division
15783@opindex mno-check-zero-division
15784Trap (do not trap) on integer division by zero.
15785
15786The default is @option{-mcheck-zero-division}.
15787
15788@item -mdivide-traps
15789@itemx -mdivide-breaks
15790@opindex mdivide-traps
15791@opindex mdivide-breaks
15792MIPS systems check for division by zero by generating either a
15793conditional trap or a break instruction.  Using traps results in
15794smaller code, but is only supported on MIPS II and later.  Also, some
15795versions of the Linux kernel have a bug that prevents trap from
15796generating the proper signal (@code{SIGFPE}).  Use @option{-mdivide-traps} to
15797allow conditional traps on architectures that support them and
15798@option{-mdivide-breaks} to force the use of breaks.
15799
15800The default is usually @option{-mdivide-traps}, but this can be
15801overridden at configure time using @option{--with-divide=breaks}.
15802Divide-by-zero checks can be completely disabled using
15803@option{-mno-check-zero-division}.
15804
15805@item -mmemcpy
15806@itemx -mno-memcpy
15807@opindex mmemcpy
15808@opindex mno-memcpy
15809Force (do not force) the use of @code{memcpy()} for non-trivial block
15810moves.  The default is @option{-mno-memcpy}, which allows GCC to inline
15811most constant-sized copies.
15812
15813@item -mlong-calls
15814@itemx -mno-long-calls
15815@opindex mlong-calls
15816@opindex mno-long-calls
15817Disable (do not disable) use of the @code{jal} instruction.  Calling
15818functions using @code{jal} is more efficient but requires the caller
15819and callee to be in the same 256 megabyte segment.
15820
15821This option has no effect on abicalls code.  The default is
15822@option{-mno-long-calls}.
15823
15824@item -mmad
15825@itemx -mno-mad
15826@opindex mmad
15827@opindex mno-mad
15828Enable (disable) use of the @code{mad}, @code{madu} and @code{mul}
15829instructions, as provided by the R4650 ISA@.
15830
15831@item -mfused-madd
15832@itemx -mno-fused-madd
15833@opindex mfused-madd
15834@opindex mno-fused-madd
15835Enable (disable) use of the floating-point multiply-accumulate
15836instructions, when they are available.  The default is
15837@option{-mfused-madd}.
15838
15839When multiply-accumulate instructions are used, the intermediate
15840product is calculated to infinite precision and is not subject to
15841the FCSR Flush to Zero bit.  This may be undesirable in some
15842circumstances.
15843
15844@item -nocpp
15845@opindex nocpp
15846Tell the MIPS assembler to not run its preprocessor over user
15847assembler files (with a @samp{.s} suffix) when assembling them.
15848
15849@item -mfix-24k
15850@item -mno-fix-24k
15851@opindex mfix-24k
15852@opindex mno-fix-24k
15853Work around the 24K E48 (lost data on stores during refill) errata.
15854The workarounds are implemented by the assembler rather than by GCC.
15855
15856@item -mfix-r4000
15857@itemx -mno-fix-r4000
15858@opindex mfix-r4000
15859@opindex mno-fix-r4000
15860Work around certain R4000 CPU errata:
15861@itemize @minus
15862@item
15863A double-word or a variable shift may give an incorrect result if executed
15864immediately after starting an integer division.
15865@item
15866A double-word or a variable shift may give an incorrect result if executed
15867while an integer multiplication is in progress.
15868@item
15869An integer division may give an incorrect result if started in a delay slot
15870of a taken branch or a jump.
15871@end itemize
15872
15873@item -mfix-r4400
15874@itemx -mno-fix-r4400
15875@opindex mfix-r4400
15876@opindex mno-fix-r4400
15877Work around certain R4400 CPU errata:
15878@itemize @minus
15879@item
15880A double-word or a variable shift may give an incorrect result if executed
15881immediately after starting an integer division.
15882@end itemize
15883
15884@item -mfix-r10000
15885@itemx -mno-fix-r10000
15886@opindex mfix-r10000
15887@opindex mno-fix-r10000
15888Work around certain R10000 errata:
15889@itemize @minus
15890@item
15891@code{ll}/@code{sc} sequences may not behave atomically on revisions
15892prior to 3.0.  They may deadlock on revisions 2.6 and earlier.
15893@end itemize
15894
15895This option can only be used if the target architecture supports
15896branch-likely instructions.  @option{-mfix-r10000} is the default when
15897@option{-march=r10000} is used; @option{-mno-fix-r10000} is the default
15898otherwise.
15899
15900@item -mfix-vr4120
15901@itemx -mno-fix-vr4120
15902@opindex mfix-vr4120
15903Work around certain VR4120 errata:
15904@itemize @minus
15905@item
15906@code{dmultu} does not always produce the correct result.
15907@item
15908@code{div} and @code{ddiv} do not always produce the correct result if one
15909of the operands is negative.
15910@end itemize
15911The workarounds for the division errata rely on special functions in
15912@file{libgcc.a}.  At present, these functions are only provided by
15913the @code{mips64vr*-elf} configurations.
15914
15915Other VR4120 errata require a nop to be inserted between certain pairs of
15916instructions.  These errata are handled by the assembler, not by GCC itself.
15917
15918@item -mfix-vr4130
15919@opindex mfix-vr4130
15920Work around the VR4130 @code{mflo}/@code{mfhi} errata.  The
15921workarounds are implemented by the assembler rather than by GCC,
15922although GCC will avoid using @code{mflo} and @code{mfhi} if the
15923VR4130 @code{macc}, @code{macchi}, @code{dmacc} and @code{dmacchi}
15924instructions are available instead.
15925
15926@item -mfix-sb1
15927@itemx -mno-fix-sb1
15928@opindex mfix-sb1
15929Work around certain SB-1 CPU core errata.
15930(This flag currently works around the SB-1 revision 2
15931``F1'' and ``F2'' floating-point errata.)
15932
15933@item -mr10k-cache-barrier=@var{setting}
15934@opindex mr10k-cache-barrier
15935Specify whether GCC should insert cache barriers to avoid the
15936side-effects of speculation on R10K processors.
15937
15938In common with many processors, the R10K tries to predict the outcome
15939of a conditional branch and speculatively executes instructions from
15940the ``taken'' branch.  It later aborts these instructions if the
15941predicted outcome was wrong.  However, on the R10K, even aborted
15942instructions can have side effects.
15943
15944This problem only affects kernel stores and, depending on the system,
15945kernel loads.  As an example, a speculatively-executed store may load
15946the target memory into cache and mark the cache line as dirty, even if
15947the store itself is later aborted.  If a DMA operation writes to the
15948same area of memory before the ``dirty'' line is flushed, the cached
15949data will overwrite the DMA-ed data.  See the R10K processor manual
15950for a full description, including other potential problems.
15951
15952One workaround is to insert cache barrier instructions before every memory
15953access that might be speculatively executed and that might have side
15954effects even if aborted.  @option{-mr10k-cache-barrier=@var{setting}}
15955controls GCC's implementation of this workaround.  It assumes that
15956aborted accesses to any byte in the following regions will not have
15957side effects:
15958
15959@enumerate
15960@item
15961the memory occupied by the current function's stack frame;
15962
15963@item
15964the memory occupied by an incoming stack argument;
15965
15966@item
15967the memory occupied by an object with a link-time-constant address.
15968@end enumerate
15969
15970It is the kernel's responsibility to ensure that speculative
15971accesses to these regions are indeed safe.
15972
15973If the input program contains a function declaration such as:
15974
15975@smallexample
15976void foo (void);
15977@end smallexample
15978
15979then the implementation of @code{foo} must allow @code{j foo} and
15980@code{jal foo} to be executed speculatively.  GCC honors this
15981restriction for functions it compiles itself.  It expects non-GCC
15982functions (such as hand-written assembly code) to do the same.
15983
15984The option has three forms:
15985
15986@table @gcctabopt
15987@item -mr10k-cache-barrier=load-store
15988Insert a cache barrier before a load or store that might be
15989speculatively executed and that might have side effects even
15990if aborted.
15991
15992@item -mr10k-cache-barrier=store
15993Insert a cache barrier before a store that might be speculatively
15994executed and that might have side effects even if aborted.
15995
15996@item -mr10k-cache-barrier=none
15997Disable the insertion of cache barriers.  This is the default setting.
15998@end table
15999
16000@item -mflush-func=@var{func}
16001@itemx -mno-flush-func
16002@opindex mflush-func
16003Specifies the function to call to flush the I and D caches, or to not
16004call any such function.  If called, the function must take the same
16005arguments as the common @code{_flush_func()}, that is, the address of the
16006memory range for which the cache is being flushed, the size of the
16007memory range, and the number 3 (to flush both caches).  The default
16008depends on the target GCC was configured for, but commonly is either
16009@samp{_flush_func} or @samp{__cpu_flush}.
16010
16011@item mbranch-cost=@var{num}
16012@opindex mbranch-cost
16013Set the cost of branches to roughly @var{num} ``simple'' instructions.
16014This cost is only a heuristic and is not guaranteed to produce
16015consistent results across releases.  A zero cost redundantly selects
16016the default, which is based on the @option{-mtune} setting.
16017
16018@item -mbranch-likely
16019@itemx -mno-branch-likely
16020@opindex mbranch-likely
16021@opindex mno-branch-likely
16022Enable or disable use of Branch Likely instructions, regardless of the
16023default for the selected architecture.  By default, Branch Likely
16024instructions may be generated if they are supported by the selected
16025architecture.  An exception is for the MIPS32 and MIPS64 architectures
16026and processors that implement those architectures; for those, Branch
16027Likely instructions will not be generated by default because the MIPS32
16028and MIPS64 architectures specifically deprecate their use.
16029
16030@item -mfp-exceptions
16031@itemx -mno-fp-exceptions
16032@opindex mfp-exceptions
16033Specifies whether FP exceptions are enabled.  This affects how we schedule
16034FP instructions for some processors.  The default is that FP exceptions are
16035enabled.
16036
16037For instance, on the SB-1, if FP exceptions are disabled, and we are emitting
1603864-bit code, then we can use both FP pipes.  Otherwise, we can only use one
16039FP pipe.
16040
16041@item -mvr4130-align
16042@itemx -mno-vr4130-align
16043@opindex mvr4130-align
16044The VR4130 pipeline is two-way superscalar, but can only issue two
16045instructions together if the first one is 8-byte aligned.  When this
16046option is enabled, GCC will align pairs of instructions that it
16047thinks should execute in parallel.
16048
16049This option only has an effect when optimizing for the VR4130.
16050It normally makes code faster, but at the expense of making it bigger.
16051It is enabled by default at optimization level @option{-O3}.
16052
16053@item -msynci
16054@itemx -mno-synci
16055@opindex msynci
16056Enable (disable) generation of @code{synci} instructions on
16057architectures that support it.  The @code{synci} instructions (if
16058enabled) will be generated when @code{__builtin___clear_cache()} is
16059compiled.
16060
16061This option defaults to @code{-mno-synci}, but the default can be
16062overridden by configuring with @code{--with-synci}.
16063
16064When compiling code for single processor systems, it is generally safe
16065to use @code{synci}.  However, on many multi-core (SMP) systems, it
16066will not invalidate the instruction caches on all cores and may lead
16067to undefined behavior.
16068
16069@item -mrelax-pic-calls
16070@itemx -mno-relax-pic-calls
16071@opindex mrelax-pic-calls
16072Try to turn PIC calls that are normally dispatched via register
16073@code{$25} into direct calls.  This is only possible if the linker can
16074resolve the destination at link-time and if the destination is within
16075range for a direct call.
16076
16077@option{-mrelax-pic-calls} is the default if GCC was configured to use
16078an assembler and a linker that supports the @code{.reloc} assembly
16079directive and @code{-mexplicit-relocs} is in effect.  With
16080@code{-mno-explicit-relocs}, this optimization can be performed by the
16081assembler and the linker alone without help from the compiler.
16082
16083@item -mmcount-ra-address
16084@itemx -mno-mcount-ra-address
16085@opindex mmcount-ra-address
16086@opindex mno-mcount-ra-address
16087Emit (do not emit) code that allows @code{_mcount} to modify the
16088calling function's return address.  When enabled, this option extends
16089the usual @code{_mcount} interface with a new @var{ra-address}
16090parameter, which has type @code{intptr_t *} and is passed in register
16091@code{$12}.  @code{_mcount} can then modify the return address by
16092doing both of the following:
16093@itemize
16094@item
16095Returning the new address in register @code{$31}.
16096@item
16097Storing the new address in @code{*@var{ra-address}},
16098if @var{ra-address} is nonnull.
16099@end itemize
16100
16101The default is @option{-mno-mcount-ra-address}.
16102
16103@end table
16104
16105@node MMIX Options
16106@subsection MMIX Options
16107@cindex MMIX Options
16108
16109These options are defined for the MMIX:
16110
16111@table @gcctabopt
16112@item -mlibfuncs
16113@itemx -mno-libfuncs
16114@opindex mlibfuncs
16115@opindex mno-libfuncs
16116Specify that intrinsic library functions are being compiled, passing all
16117values in registers, no matter the size.
16118
16119@item -mepsilon
16120@itemx -mno-epsilon
16121@opindex mepsilon
16122@opindex mno-epsilon
16123Generate floating-point comparison instructions that compare with respect
16124to the @code{rE} epsilon register.
16125
16126@item -mabi=mmixware
16127@itemx -mabi=gnu
16128@opindex mabi=mmixware
16129@opindex mabi=gnu
16130Generate code that passes function parameters and return values that (in
16131the called function) are seen as registers @code{$0} and up, as opposed to
16132the GNU ABI which uses global registers @code{$231} and up.
16133
16134@item -mzero-extend
16135@itemx -mno-zero-extend
16136@opindex mzero-extend
16137@opindex mno-zero-extend
16138When reading data from memory in sizes shorter than 64 bits, use (do not
16139use) zero-extending load instructions by default, rather than
16140sign-extending ones.
16141
16142@item -mknuthdiv
16143@itemx -mno-knuthdiv
16144@opindex mknuthdiv
16145@opindex mno-knuthdiv
16146Make the result of a division yielding a remainder have the same sign as
16147the divisor.  With the default, @option{-mno-knuthdiv}, the sign of the
16148remainder follows the sign of the dividend.  Both methods are
16149arithmetically valid, the latter being almost exclusively used.
16150
16151@item -mtoplevel-symbols
16152@itemx -mno-toplevel-symbols
16153@opindex mtoplevel-symbols
16154@opindex mno-toplevel-symbols
16155Prepend (do not prepend) a @samp{:} to all global symbols, so the assembly
16156code can be used with the @code{PREFIX} assembly directive.
16157
16158@item -melf
16159@opindex melf
16160Generate an executable in the ELF format, rather than the default
16161@samp{mmo} format used by the @command{mmix} simulator.
16162
16163@item -mbranch-predict
16164@itemx -mno-branch-predict
16165@opindex mbranch-predict
16166@opindex mno-branch-predict
16167Use (do not use) the probable-branch instructions, when static branch
16168prediction indicates a probable branch.
16169
16170@item -mbase-addresses
16171@itemx -mno-base-addresses
16172@opindex mbase-addresses
16173@opindex mno-base-addresses
16174Generate (do not generate) code that uses @emph{base addresses}.  Using a
16175base address automatically generates a request (handled by the assembler
16176and the linker) for a constant to be set up in a global register.  The
16177register is used for one or more base address requests within the range 0
16178to 255 from the value held in the register.  The generally leads to short
16179and fast code, but the number of different data items that can be
16180addressed is limited.  This means that a program that uses lots of static
16181data may require @option{-mno-base-addresses}.
16182
16183@item -msingle-exit
16184@itemx -mno-single-exit
16185@opindex msingle-exit
16186@opindex mno-single-exit
16187Force (do not force) generated code to have a single exit point in each
16188function.
16189@end table
16190
16191@node MN10300 Options
16192@subsection MN10300 Options
16193@cindex MN10300 options
16194
16195These @option{-m} options are defined for Matsushita MN10300 architectures:
16196
16197@table @gcctabopt
16198@item -mmult-bug
16199@opindex mmult-bug
16200Generate code to avoid bugs in the multiply instructions for the MN10300
16201processors.  This is the default.
16202
16203@item -mno-mult-bug
16204@opindex mno-mult-bug
16205Do not generate code to avoid bugs in the multiply instructions for the
16206MN10300 processors.
16207
16208@item -mam33
16209@opindex mam33
16210Generate code using features specific to the AM33 processor.
16211
16212@item -mno-am33
16213@opindex mno-am33
16214Do not generate code using features specific to the AM33 processor.  This
16215is the default.
16216
16217@item -mam33-2
16218@opindex mam33-2
16219Generate code using features specific to the AM33/2.0 processor.
16220
16221@item -mam34
16222@opindex mam34
16223Generate code using features specific to the AM34 processor.
16224
16225@item -mtune=@var{cpu-type}
16226@opindex mtune
16227Use the timing characteristics of the indicated CPU type when
16228scheduling instructions.  This does not change the targeted processor
16229type.  The CPU type must be one of @samp{mn10300}, @samp{am33},
16230@samp{am33-2} or @samp{am34}.
16231
16232@item -mreturn-pointer-on-d0
16233@opindex mreturn-pointer-on-d0
16234When generating a function that returns a pointer, return the pointer
16235in both @code{a0} and @code{d0}.  Otherwise, the pointer is returned
16236only in a0, and attempts to call such functions without a prototype
16237would result in errors.  Note that this option is on by default; use
16238@option{-mno-return-pointer-on-d0} to disable it.
16239
16240@item -mno-crt0
16241@opindex mno-crt0
16242Do not link in the C run-time initialization object file.
16243
16244@item -mrelax
16245@opindex mrelax
16246Indicate to the linker that it should perform a relaxation optimization pass
16247to shorten branches, calls and absolute memory addresses.  This option only
16248has an effect when used on the command line for the final link step.
16249
16250This option makes symbolic debugging impossible.
16251
16252@item -mliw
16253@opindex mliw
16254Allow the compiler to generate @emph{Long Instruction Word}
16255instructions if the target is the @samp{AM33} or later.  This is the
16256default.  This option defines the preprocessor macro @samp{__LIW__}.
16257
16258@item -mnoliw
16259@opindex mnoliw
16260Do not allow the compiler to generate @emph{Long Instruction Word}
16261instructions.  This option defines the preprocessor macro
16262@samp{__NO_LIW__}.
16263
16264@item -msetlb
16265@opindex msetlb
16266Allow the compiler to generate the @emph{SETLB} and @emph{Lcc}
16267instructions if the target is the @samp{AM33} or later.  This is the
16268default.  This option defines the preprocessor macro @samp{__SETLB__}.
16269
16270@item -mnosetlb
16271@opindex mnosetlb
16272Do not allow the compiler to generate @emph{SETLB} or @emph{Lcc}
16273instructions.  This option defines the preprocessor macro
16274@samp{__NO_SETLB__}.
16275
16276@end table
16277
16278@node PDP-11 Options
16279@subsection PDP-11 Options
16280@cindex PDP-11 Options
16281
16282These options are defined for the PDP-11:
16283
16284@table @gcctabopt
16285@item -mfpu
16286@opindex mfpu
16287Use hardware FPP floating point.  This is the default.  (FIS floating
16288point on the PDP-11/40 is not supported.)
16289
16290@item -msoft-float
16291@opindex msoft-float
16292Do not use hardware floating point.
16293
16294@item -mac0
16295@opindex mac0
16296Return floating-point results in ac0 (fr0 in Unix assembler syntax).
16297
16298@item -mno-ac0
16299@opindex mno-ac0
16300Return floating-point results in memory.  This is the default.
16301
16302@item -m40
16303@opindex m40
16304Generate code for a PDP-11/40.
16305
16306@item -m45
16307@opindex m45
16308Generate code for a PDP-11/45.  This is the default.
16309
16310@item -m10
16311@opindex m10
16312Generate code for a PDP-11/10.
16313
16314@item -mbcopy-builtin
16315@opindex mbcopy-builtin
16316Use inline @code{movmemhi} patterns for copying memory.  This is the
16317default.
16318
16319@item -mbcopy
16320@opindex mbcopy
16321Do not use inline @code{movmemhi} patterns for copying memory.
16322
16323@item -mint16
16324@itemx -mno-int32
16325@opindex mint16
16326@opindex mno-int32
16327Use 16-bit @code{int}.  This is the default.
16328
16329@item -mint32
16330@itemx -mno-int16
16331@opindex mint32
16332@opindex mno-int16
16333Use 32-bit @code{int}.
16334
16335@item -mfloat64
16336@itemx -mno-float32
16337@opindex mfloat64
16338@opindex mno-float32
16339Use 64-bit @code{float}.  This is the default.
16340
16341@item -mfloat32
16342@itemx -mno-float64
16343@opindex mfloat32
16344@opindex mno-float64
16345Use 32-bit @code{float}.
16346
16347@item -mabshi
16348@opindex mabshi
16349Use @code{abshi2} pattern.  This is the default.
16350
16351@item -mno-abshi
16352@opindex mno-abshi
16353Do not use @code{abshi2} pattern.
16354
16355@item -mbranch-expensive
16356@opindex mbranch-expensive
16357Pretend that branches are expensive.  This is for experimenting with
16358code generation only.
16359
16360@item -mbranch-cheap
16361@opindex mbranch-cheap
16362Do not pretend that branches are expensive.  This is the default.
16363
16364@item -munix-asm
16365@opindex munix-asm
16366Use Unix assembler syntax.  This is the default when configured for
16367@samp{pdp11-*-bsd}.
16368
16369@item -mdec-asm
16370@opindex mdec-asm
16371Use DEC assembler syntax.  This is the default when configured for any
16372PDP-11 target other than @samp{pdp11-*-bsd}.
16373@end table
16374
16375@node picoChip Options
16376@subsection picoChip Options
16377@cindex picoChip options
16378
16379These @samp{-m} options are defined for picoChip implementations:
16380
16381@table @gcctabopt
16382
16383@item -mae=@var{ae_type}
16384@opindex mcpu
16385Set the instruction set, register set, and instruction scheduling
16386parameters for array element type @var{ae_type}.  Supported values
16387for @var{ae_type} are @samp{ANY}, @samp{MUL}, and @samp{MAC}.
16388
16389@option{-mae=ANY} selects a completely generic AE type.  Code
16390generated with this option will run on any of the other AE types.  The
16391code will not be as efficient as it would be if compiled for a specific
16392AE type, and some types of operation (e.g., multiplication) will not
16393work properly on all types of AE.
16394
16395@option{-mae=MUL} selects a MUL AE type.  This is the most useful AE type
16396for compiled code, and is the default.
16397
16398@option{-mae=MAC} selects a DSP-style MAC AE.  Code compiled with this
16399option may suffer from poor performance of byte (char) manipulation,
16400since the DSP AE does not provide hardware support for byte load/stores.
16401
16402@item -msymbol-as-address
16403Enable the compiler to directly use a symbol name as an address in a
16404load/store instruction, without first loading it into a
16405register.  Typically, the use of this option will generate larger
16406programs, which run faster than when the option isn't used.  However, the
16407results vary from program to program, so it is left as a user option,
16408rather than being permanently enabled.
16409
16410@item -mno-inefficient-warnings
16411Disables warnings about the generation of inefficient code.  These
16412warnings can be generated, for example, when compiling code that
16413performs byte-level memory operations on the MAC AE type.  The MAC AE has
16414no hardware support for byte-level memory operations, so all byte
16415load/stores must be synthesized from word load/store operations.  This is
16416inefficient and a warning will be generated indicating to the programmer
16417that they should rewrite the code to avoid byte operations, or to target
16418an AE type that has the necessary hardware support.  This option enables
16419the warning to be turned off.
16420
16421@end table
16422
16423@node PowerPC Options
16424@subsection PowerPC Options
16425@cindex PowerPC options
16426
16427These are listed under @xref{RS/6000 and PowerPC Options}.
16428
16429@node RL78 Options
16430@subsection RL78 Options
16431@cindex RL78 Options
16432
16433@table @gcctabopt
16434
16435@item -msim
16436@opindex msim
16437Links in additional target libraries to support operation within a
16438simulator.
16439
16440@item -mmul=none
16441@itemx -mmul=g13
16442@itemx -mmul=rl78
16443@opindex mmul
16444Specifies the type of hardware multiplication support to be used.  The
16445default is @code{none}, which uses software multiplication functions.
16446The @code{g13} option is for the hardware multiply/divide peripheral
16447only on the RL78/G13 targets.  The @code{rl78} option is for the
16448standard hardware multiplication defined in the RL78 software manual.
16449
16450@end table
16451
16452@node RS/6000 and PowerPC Options
16453@subsection IBM RS/6000 and PowerPC Options
16454@cindex RS/6000 and PowerPC Options
16455@cindex IBM RS/6000 and PowerPC Options
16456
16457These @samp{-m} options are defined for the IBM RS/6000 and PowerPC:
16458@table @gcctabopt
16459@item -mpower
16460@itemx -mno-power
16461@itemx -mpower2
16462@itemx -mno-power2
16463@itemx -mpowerpc
16464@itemx -mno-powerpc
16465@itemx -mpowerpc-gpopt
16466@itemx -mno-powerpc-gpopt
16467@itemx -mpowerpc-gfxopt
16468@itemx -mno-powerpc-gfxopt
16469@need 800
16470@itemx -mpowerpc64
16471@itemx -mno-powerpc64
16472@itemx -mmfcrf
16473@itemx -mno-mfcrf
16474@itemx -mpopcntb
16475@itemx -mno-popcntb
16476@itemx -mpopcntd
16477@itemx -mno-popcntd
16478@itemx -mfprnd
16479@itemx -mno-fprnd
16480@need 800
16481@itemx -mcmpb
16482@itemx -mno-cmpb
16483@itemx -mmfpgpr
16484@itemx -mno-mfpgpr
16485@itemx -mhard-dfp
16486@itemx -mno-hard-dfp
16487@opindex mpower
16488@opindex mno-power
16489@opindex mpower2
16490@opindex mno-power2
16491@opindex mpowerpc
16492@opindex mno-powerpc
16493@opindex mpowerpc-gpopt
16494@opindex mno-powerpc-gpopt
16495@opindex mpowerpc-gfxopt
16496@opindex mno-powerpc-gfxopt
16497@opindex mpowerpc64
16498@opindex mno-powerpc64
16499@opindex mmfcrf
16500@opindex mno-mfcrf
16501@opindex mpopcntb
16502@opindex mno-popcntb
16503@opindex mpopcntd
16504@opindex mno-popcntd
16505@opindex mfprnd
16506@opindex mno-fprnd
16507@opindex mcmpb
16508@opindex mno-cmpb
16509@opindex mmfpgpr
16510@opindex mno-mfpgpr
16511@opindex mhard-dfp
16512@opindex mno-hard-dfp
16513GCC supports two related instruction set architectures for the
16514RS/6000 and PowerPC@.  The @dfn{POWER} instruction set are those
16515instructions supported by the @samp{rios} chip set used in the original
16516RS/6000 systems and the @dfn{PowerPC} instruction set is the
16517architecture of the Freescale MPC5xx, MPC6xx, MPC8xx microprocessors, and
16518the IBM 4xx, 6xx, and follow-on microprocessors.
16519
16520Neither architecture is a subset of the other.  However there is a
16521large common subset of instructions supported by both.  An MQ
16522register is included in processors supporting the POWER architecture.
16523
16524You use these options to specify which instructions are available on the
16525processor you are using.  The default value of these options is
16526determined when configuring GCC@.  Specifying the
16527@option{-mcpu=@var{cpu_type}} overrides the specification of these
16528options.  We recommend you use the @option{-mcpu=@var{cpu_type}} option
16529rather than the options listed above.
16530
16531The @option{-mpower} option allows GCC to generate instructions that
16532are found only in the POWER architecture and to use the MQ register.
16533Specifying @option{-mpower2} implies @option{-power} and also allows GCC
16534to generate instructions that are present in the POWER2 architecture but
16535not the original POWER architecture.
16536
16537The @option{-mpowerpc} option allows GCC to generate instructions that
16538are found only in the 32-bit subset of the PowerPC architecture.
16539Specifying @option{-mpowerpc-gpopt} implies @option{-mpowerpc} and also allows
16540GCC to use the optional PowerPC architecture instructions in the
16541General Purpose group, including floating-point square root.  Specifying
16542@option{-mpowerpc-gfxopt} implies @option{-mpowerpc} and also allows GCC to
16543use the optional PowerPC architecture instructions in the Graphics
16544group, including floating-point select.
16545
16546The @option{-mmfcrf} option allows GCC to generate the move from
16547condition register field instruction implemented on the POWER4
16548processor and other processors that support the PowerPC V2.01
16549architecture.
16550The @option{-mpopcntb} option allows GCC to generate the popcount and
16551double-precision FP reciprocal estimate instruction implemented on the
16552POWER5 processor and other processors that support the PowerPC V2.02
16553architecture.
16554The @option{-mpopcntd} option allows GCC to generate the popcount
16555instruction implemented on the POWER7 processor and other processors
16556that support the PowerPC V2.06 architecture.
16557The @option{-mfprnd} option allows GCC to generate the FP round to
16558integer instructions implemented on the POWER5+ processor and other
16559processors that support the PowerPC V2.03 architecture.
16560The @option{-mcmpb} option allows GCC to generate the compare bytes
16561instruction implemented on the POWER6 processor and other processors
16562that support the PowerPC V2.05 architecture.
16563The @option{-mmfpgpr} option allows GCC to generate the FP move to/from
16564general-purpose register instructions implemented on the POWER6X
16565processor and other processors that support the extended PowerPC V2.05
16566architecture.
16567The @option{-mhard-dfp} option allows GCC to generate the decimal
16568floating-point instructions implemented on some POWER processors.
16569
16570The @option{-mpowerpc64} option allows GCC to generate the additional
1657164-bit instructions that are found in the full PowerPC64 architecture
16572and to treat GPRs as 64-bit, doubleword quantities.  GCC defaults to
16573@option{-mno-powerpc64}.
16574
16575If you specify both @option{-mno-power} and @option{-mno-powerpc}, GCC
16576will use only the instructions in the common subset of both
16577architectures plus some special AIX common-mode calls, and will not use
16578the MQ register.  Specifying both @option{-mpower} and @option{-mpowerpc}
16579permits GCC to use any instruction from either architecture and to
16580allow use of the MQ register; specify this for the Motorola MPC601.
16581
16582@item -mnew-mnemonics
16583@itemx -mold-mnemonics
16584@opindex mnew-mnemonics
16585@opindex mold-mnemonics
16586Select which mnemonics to use in the generated assembler code.  With
16587@option{-mnew-mnemonics}, GCC uses the assembler mnemonics defined for
16588the PowerPC architecture.  With @option{-mold-mnemonics} it uses the
16589assembler mnemonics defined for the POWER architecture.  Instructions
16590defined in only one architecture have only one mnemonic; GCC uses that
16591mnemonic irrespective of which of these options is specified.
16592
16593GCC defaults to the mnemonics appropriate for the architecture in
16594use.  Specifying @option{-mcpu=@var{cpu_type}} sometimes overrides the
16595value of these option.  Unless you are building a cross-compiler, you
16596should normally not specify either @option{-mnew-mnemonics} or
16597@option{-mold-mnemonics}, but should instead accept the default.
16598
16599@item -mcpu=@var{cpu_type}
16600@opindex mcpu
16601Set architecture type, register usage, choice of mnemonics, and
16602instruction scheduling parameters for machine type @var{cpu_type}.
16603Supported values for @var{cpu_type} are @samp{401}, @samp{403},
16604@samp{405}, @samp{405fp}, @samp{440}, @samp{440fp}, @samp{464}, @samp{464fp},
16605@samp{476}, @samp{476fp}, @samp{505}, @samp{601}, @samp{602}, @samp{603},
16606@samp{603e}, @samp{604}, @samp{604e}, @samp{620}, @samp{630}, @samp{740},
16607@samp{7400}, @samp{7450}, @samp{750}, @samp{801}, @samp{821}, @samp{823},
16608@samp{860}, @samp{970}, @samp{8540}, @samp{a2}, @samp{e300c2},
16609@samp{e300c3}, @samp{e500mc}, @samp{e500mc64}, @samp{ec603e}, @samp{G3},
16610@samp{G4}, @samp{G5}, @samp{titan}, @samp{power}, @samp{power2}, @samp{power3},
16611@samp{power4}, @samp{power5}, @samp{power5+}, @samp{power6}, @samp{power6x},
16612@samp{power7}, @samp{common}, @samp{powerpc}, @samp{powerpc64}, @samp{rios},
16613@samp{rios1}, @samp{rios2}, @samp{rsc}, and @samp{rs64}.
16614
16615@option{-mcpu=common} selects a completely generic processor.  Code
16616generated under this option will run on any POWER or PowerPC processor.
16617GCC will use only the instructions in the common subset of both
16618architectures, and will not use the MQ register.  GCC assumes a generic
16619processor model for scheduling purposes.
16620
16621@option{-mcpu=power}, @option{-mcpu=power2}, @option{-mcpu=powerpc}, and
16622@option{-mcpu=powerpc64} specify generic POWER, POWER2, pure 32-bit
16623PowerPC (i.e., not MPC601), and 64-bit PowerPC architecture machine
16624types, with an appropriate, generic processor model assumed for
16625scheduling purposes.
16626
16627The other options specify a specific processor.  Code generated under
16628those options will run best on that processor, and may not run at all on
16629others.
16630
16631The @option{-mcpu} options automatically enable or disable the
16632following options:
16633
16634@gccoptlist{-maltivec  -mfprnd  -mhard-float  -mmfcrf  -mmultiple @gol
16635-mnew-mnemonics  -mpopcntb -mpopcntd  -mpower  -mpower2  -mpowerpc64 @gol
16636-mpowerpc-gpopt  -mpowerpc-gfxopt  -msingle-float -mdouble-float @gol
16637-msimple-fpu -mstring  -mmulhw  -mdlmzb  -mmfpgpr -mvsx}
16638
16639The particular options set for any particular CPU will vary between
16640compiler versions, depending on what setting seems to produce optimal
16641code for that CPU; it doesn't necessarily reflect the actual hardware's
16642capabilities.  If you wish to set an individual option to a particular
16643value, you may specify it after the @option{-mcpu} option, like
16644@samp{-mcpu=970 -mno-altivec}.
16645
16646On AIX, the @option{-maltivec} and @option{-mpowerpc64} options are
16647not enabled or disabled by the @option{-mcpu} option at present because
16648AIX does not have full support for these options.  You may still
16649enable or disable them individually if you're sure it'll work in your
16650environment.
16651
16652@item -mtune=@var{cpu_type}
16653@opindex mtune
16654Set the instruction scheduling parameters for machine type
16655@var{cpu_type}, but do not set the architecture type, register usage, or
16656choice of mnemonics, as @option{-mcpu=@var{cpu_type}} would.  The same
16657values for @var{cpu_type} are used for @option{-mtune} as for
16658@option{-mcpu}.  If both are specified, the code generated will use the
16659architecture, registers, and mnemonics set by @option{-mcpu}, but the
16660scheduling parameters set by @option{-mtune}.
16661
16662@item -mcmodel=small
16663@opindex mcmodel=small
16664Generate PowerPC64 code for the small model: The TOC is limited to
1666564k.
16666
16667@item -mcmodel=medium
16668@opindex mcmodel=medium
16669Generate PowerPC64 code for the medium model: The TOC and other static
16670data may be up to a total of 4G in size.
16671
16672@item -mcmodel=large
16673@opindex mcmodel=large
16674Generate PowerPC64 code for the large model: The TOC may be up to 4G
16675in size.  Other data and code is only limited by the 64-bit address
16676space.
16677
16678@item -maltivec
16679@itemx -mno-altivec
16680@opindex maltivec
16681@opindex mno-altivec
16682Generate code that uses (does not use) AltiVec instructions, and also
16683enable the use of built-in functions that allow more direct access to
16684the AltiVec instruction set.  You may also need to set
16685@option{-mabi=altivec} to adjust the current ABI with AltiVec ABI
16686enhancements.
16687
16688@item -mvrsave
16689@itemx -mno-vrsave
16690@opindex mvrsave
16691@opindex mno-vrsave
16692Generate VRSAVE instructions when generating AltiVec code.
16693
16694@item -mgen-cell-microcode
16695@opindex mgen-cell-microcode
16696Generate Cell microcode instructions
16697
16698@item -mwarn-cell-microcode
16699@opindex mwarn-cell-microcode
16700Warning when a Cell microcode instruction is going to emitted.  An example
16701of a Cell microcode instruction is a variable shift.
16702
16703@item -msecure-plt
16704@opindex msecure-plt
16705Generate code that allows ld and ld.so to build executables and shared
16706libraries with non-exec .plt and .got sections.  This is a PowerPC
1670732-bit SYSV ABI option.
16708
16709@item -mbss-plt
16710@opindex mbss-plt
16711Generate code that uses a BSS .plt section that ld.so fills in, and
16712requires .plt and .got sections that are both writable and executable.
16713This is a PowerPC 32-bit SYSV ABI option.
16714
16715@item -misel
16716@itemx -mno-isel
16717@opindex misel
16718@opindex mno-isel
16719This switch enables or disables the generation of ISEL instructions.
16720
16721@item -misel=@var{yes/no}
16722This switch has been deprecated.  Use @option{-misel} and
16723@option{-mno-isel} instead.
16724
16725@item -mspe
16726@itemx -mno-spe
16727@opindex mspe
16728@opindex mno-spe
16729This switch enables or disables the generation of SPE simd
16730instructions.
16731
16732@item -mpaired
16733@itemx -mno-paired
16734@opindex mpaired
16735@opindex mno-paired
16736This switch enables or disables the generation of PAIRED simd
16737instructions.
16738
16739@item -mspe=@var{yes/no}
16740This option has been deprecated.  Use @option{-mspe} and
16741@option{-mno-spe} instead.
16742
16743@item -mvsx
16744@itemx -mno-vsx
16745@opindex mvsx
16746@opindex mno-vsx
16747Generate code that uses (does not use) vector/scalar (VSX)
16748instructions, and also enable the use of built-in functions that allow
16749more direct access to the VSX instruction set.
16750
16751@item -mfloat-gprs=@var{yes/single/double/no}
16752@itemx -mfloat-gprs
16753@opindex mfloat-gprs
16754This switch enables or disables the generation of floating-point
16755operations on the general-purpose registers for architectures that
16756support it.
16757
16758The argument @var{yes} or @var{single} enables the use of
16759single-precision floating-point operations.
16760
16761The argument @var{double} enables the use of single and
16762double-precision floating-point operations.
16763
16764The argument @var{no} disables floating-point operations on the
16765general-purpose registers.
16766
16767This option is currently only available on the MPC854x.
16768
16769@item -m32
16770@itemx -m64
16771@opindex m32
16772@opindex m64
16773Generate code for 32-bit or 64-bit environments of Darwin and SVR4
16774targets (including GNU/Linux).  The 32-bit environment sets int, long
16775and pointer to 32 bits and generates code that runs on any PowerPC
16776variant.  The 64-bit environment sets int to 32 bits and long and
16777pointer to 64 bits, and generates code for PowerPC64, as for
16778@option{-mpowerpc64}.
16779
16780@item -mfull-toc
16781@itemx -mno-fp-in-toc
16782@itemx -mno-sum-in-toc
16783@itemx -mminimal-toc
16784@opindex mfull-toc
16785@opindex mno-fp-in-toc
16786@opindex mno-sum-in-toc
16787@opindex mminimal-toc
16788Modify generation of the TOC (Table Of Contents), which is created for
16789every executable file.  The @option{-mfull-toc} option is selected by
16790default.  In that case, GCC will allocate at least one TOC entry for
16791each unique non-automatic variable reference in your program.  GCC
16792will also place floating-point constants in the TOC@.  However, only
1679316,384 entries are available in the TOC@.
16794
16795If you receive a linker error message that saying you have overflowed
16796the available TOC space, you can reduce the amount of TOC space used
16797with the @option{-mno-fp-in-toc} and @option{-mno-sum-in-toc} options.
16798@option{-mno-fp-in-toc} prevents GCC from putting floating-point
16799constants in the TOC and @option{-mno-sum-in-toc} forces GCC to
16800generate code to calculate the sum of an address and a constant at
16801run time instead of putting that sum into the TOC@.  You may specify one
16802or both of these options.  Each causes GCC to produce very slightly
16803slower and larger code at the expense of conserving TOC space.
16804
16805If you still run out of space in the TOC even when you specify both of
16806these options, specify @option{-mminimal-toc} instead.  This option causes
16807GCC to make only one TOC entry for every file.  When you specify this
16808option, GCC will produce code that is slower and larger but which
16809uses extremely little TOC space.  You may wish to use this option
16810only on files that contain less frequently executed code.
16811
16812@item -maix64
16813@itemx -maix32
16814@opindex maix64
16815@opindex maix32
16816Enable 64-bit AIX ABI and calling convention: 64-bit pointers, 64-bit
16817@code{long} type, and the infrastructure needed to support them.
16818Specifying @option{-maix64} implies @option{-mpowerpc64} and
16819@option{-mpowerpc}, while @option{-maix32} disables the 64-bit ABI and
16820implies @option{-mno-powerpc64}.  GCC defaults to @option{-maix32}.
16821
16822@item -mxl-compat
16823@itemx -mno-xl-compat
16824@opindex mxl-compat
16825@opindex mno-xl-compat
16826Produce code that conforms more closely to IBM XL compiler semantics
16827when using AIX-compatible ABI@.  Pass floating-point arguments to
16828prototyped functions beyond the register save area (RSA) on the stack
16829in addition to argument FPRs.  Do not assume that most significant
16830double in 128-bit long double value is properly rounded when comparing
16831values and converting to double.  Use XL symbol names for long double
16832support routines.
16833
16834The AIX calling convention was extended but not initially documented to
16835handle an obscure K&R C case of calling a function that takes the
16836address of its arguments with fewer arguments than declared.  IBM XL
16837compilers access floating-point arguments that do not fit in the
16838RSA from the stack when a subroutine is compiled without
16839optimization.  Because always storing floating-point arguments on the
16840stack is inefficient and rarely needed, this option is not enabled by
16841default and only is necessary when calling subroutines compiled by IBM
16842XL compilers without optimization.
16843
16844@item -mpe
16845@opindex mpe
16846Support @dfn{IBM RS/6000 SP} @dfn{Parallel Environment} (PE)@.  Link an
16847application written to use message passing with special startup code to
16848enable the application to run.  The system must have PE installed in the
16849standard location (@file{/usr/lpp/ppe.poe/}), or the @file{specs} file
16850must be overridden with the @option{-specs=} option to specify the
16851appropriate directory location.  The Parallel Environment does not
16852support threads, so the @option{-mpe} option and the @option{-pthread}
16853option are incompatible.
16854
16855@item -malign-natural
16856@itemx -malign-power
16857@opindex malign-natural
16858@opindex malign-power
16859On AIX, 32-bit Darwin, and 64-bit PowerPC GNU/Linux, the option
16860@option{-malign-natural} overrides the ABI-defined alignment of larger
16861types, such as floating-point doubles, on their natural size-based boundary.
16862The option @option{-malign-power} instructs GCC to follow the ABI-specified
16863alignment rules.  GCC defaults to the standard alignment defined in the ABI@.
16864
16865On 64-bit Darwin, natural alignment is the default, and @option{-malign-power}
16866is not supported.
16867
16868@item -msoft-float
16869@itemx -mhard-float
16870@opindex msoft-float
16871@opindex mhard-float
16872Generate code that does not use (uses) the floating-point register set.
16873Software floating-point emulation is provided if you use the
16874@option{-msoft-float} option, and pass the option to GCC when linking.
16875
16876@item -msingle-float
16877@itemx -mdouble-float
16878@opindex msingle-float
16879@opindex mdouble-float
16880Generate code for single- or double-precision floating-point operations.
16881@option{-mdouble-float} implies @option{-msingle-float}.
16882
16883@item -msimple-fpu
16884@opindex msimple-fpu
16885Do not generate sqrt and div instructions for hardware floating-point unit.
16886
16887@item -mfpu
16888@opindex mfpu
16889Specify type of floating-point unit.  Valid values are @var{sp_lite}
16890(equivalent to -msingle-float -msimple-fpu), @var{dp_lite} (equivalent
16891to -mdouble-float -msimple-fpu), @var{sp_full} (equivalent to -msingle-float),
16892and @var{dp_full} (equivalent to -mdouble-float).
16893
16894@item -mxilinx-fpu
16895@opindex mxilinx-fpu
16896Perform optimizations for the floating-point unit on Xilinx PPC 405/440.
16897
16898@item -mmultiple
16899@itemx -mno-multiple
16900@opindex mmultiple
16901@opindex mno-multiple
16902Generate code that uses (does not use) the load multiple word
16903instructions and the store multiple word instructions.  These
16904instructions are generated by default on POWER systems, and not
16905generated on PowerPC systems.  Do not use @option{-mmultiple} on little-endian
16906PowerPC systems, since those instructions do not work when the
16907processor is in little-endian mode.  The exceptions are PPC740 and
16908PPC750 which permit these instructions in little-endian mode.
16909
16910@item -mstring
16911@itemx -mno-string
16912@opindex mstring
16913@opindex mno-string
16914Generate code that uses (does not use) the load string instructions
16915and the store string word instructions to save multiple registers and
16916do small block moves.  These instructions are generated by default on
16917POWER systems, and not generated on PowerPC systems.  Do not use
16918@option{-mstring} on little-endian PowerPC systems, since those
16919instructions do not work when the processor is in little-endian mode.
16920The exceptions are PPC740 and PPC750 which permit these instructions
16921in little-endian mode.
16922
16923@item -mupdate
16924@itemx -mno-update
16925@opindex mupdate
16926@opindex mno-update
16927Generate code that uses (does not use) the load or store instructions
16928that update the base register to the address of the calculated memory
16929location.  These instructions are generated by default.  If you use
16930@option{-mno-update}, there is a small window between the time that the
16931stack pointer is updated and the address of the previous frame is
16932stored, which means code that walks the stack frame across interrupts or
16933signals may get corrupted data.
16934
16935@item -mavoid-indexed-addresses
16936@itemx -mno-avoid-indexed-addresses
16937@opindex mavoid-indexed-addresses
16938@opindex mno-avoid-indexed-addresses
16939Generate code that tries to avoid (not avoid) the use of indexed load
16940or store instructions. These instructions can incur a performance
16941penalty on Power6 processors in certain situations, such as when
16942stepping through large arrays that cross a 16M boundary.  This option
16943is enabled by default when targetting Power6 and disabled otherwise.
16944
16945@item -mfused-madd
16946@itemx -mno-fused-madd
16947@opindex mfused-madd
16948@opindex mno-fused-madd
16949Generate code that uses (does not use) the floating-point multiply and
16950accumulate instructions.  These instructions are generated by default
16951if hardware floating point is used.  The machine-dependent
16952@option{-mfused-madd} option is now mapped to the machine-independent
16953@option{-ffp-contract=fast} option, and @option{-mno-fused-madd} is
16954mapped to @option{-ffp-contract=off}.
16955
16956@item -mmulhw
16957@itemx -mno-mulhw
16958@opindex mmulhw
16959@opindex mno-mulhw
16960Generate code that uses (does not use) the half-word multiply and
16961multiply-accumulate instructions on the IBM 405, 440, 464 and 476 processors.
16962These instructions are generated by default when targetting those
16963processors.
16964
16965@item -mdlmzb
16966@itemx -mno-dlmzb
16967@opindex mdlmzb
16968@opindex mno-dlmzb
16969Generate code that uses (does not use) the string-search @samp{dlmzb}
16970instruction on the IBM 405, 440, 464 and 476 processors.  This instruction is
16971generated by default when targetting those processors.
16972
16973@item -mno-bit-align
16974@itemx -mbit-align
16975@opindex mno-bit-align
16976@opindex mbit-align
16977On System V.4 and embedded PowerPC systems do not (do) force structures
16978and unions that contain bit-fields to be aligned to the base type of the
16979bit-field.
16980
16981For example, by default a structure containing nothing but 8
16982@code{unsigned} bit-fields of length 1 is aligned to a 4-byte
16983boundary and has a size of 4 bytes.  By using @option{-mno-bit-align},
16984the structure is aligned to a 1-byte boundary and is 1 byte in
16985size.
16986
16987@item -mno-strict-align
16988@itemx -mstrict-align
16989@opindex mno-strict-align
16990@opindex mstrict-align
16991On System V.4 and embedded PowerPC systems do not (do) assume that
16992unaligned memory references will be handled by the system.
16993
16994@item -mrelocatable
16995@itemx -mno-relocatable
16996@opindex mrelocatable
16997@opindex mno-relocatable
16998Generate code that allows (does not allow) a static executable to be
16999relocated to a different address at run time.  A simple embedded
17000PowerPC system loader should relocate the entire contents of
17001@code{.got2} and 4-byte locations listed in the @code{.fixup} section,
17002a table of 32-bit addresses generated by this option.  For this to
17003work, all objects linked together must be compiled with
17004@option{-mrelocatable} or @option{-mrelocatable-lib}.
17005@option{-mrelocatable} code aligns the stack to an 8-byte boundary.
17006
17007@item -mrelocatable-lib
17008@itemx -mno-relocatable-lib
17009@opindex mrelocatable-lib
17010@opindex mno-relocatable-lib
17011Like @option{-mrelocatable}, @option{-mrelocatable-lib} generates a
17012@code{.fixup} section to allow static executables to be relocated at
17013run time, but @option{-mrelocatable-lib} does not use the smaller stack
17014alignment of @option{-mrelocatable}.  Objects compiled with
17015@option{-mrelocatable-lib} may be linked with objects compiled with
17016any combination of the @option{-mrelocatable} options.
17017
17018@item -mno-toc
17019@itemx -mtoc
17020@opindex mno-toc
17021@opindex mtoc
17022On System V.4 and embedded PowerPC systems do not (do) assume that
17023register 2 contains a pointer to a global area pointing to the addresses
17024used in the program.
17025
17026@item -mlittle
17027@itemx -mlittle-endian
17028@opindex mlittle
17029@opindex mlittle-endian
17030On System V.4 and embedded PowerPC systems compile code for the
17031processor in little-endian mode.  The @option{-mlittle-endian} option is
17032the same as @option{-mlittle}.
17033
17034@item -mbig
17035@itemx -mbig-endian
17036@opindex mbig
17037@opindex mbig-endian
17038On System V.4 and embedded PowerPC systems compile code for the
17039processor in big-endian mode.  The @option{-mbig-endian} option is
17040the same as @option{-mbig}.
17041
17042@item -mdynamic-no-pic
17043@opindex mdynamic-no-pic
17044On Darwin and Mac OS X systems, compile code so that it is not
17045relocatable, but that its external references are relocatable.  The
17046resulting code is suitable for applications, but not shared
17047libraries.
17048
17049@item -msingle-pic-base
17050@opindex msingle-pic-base
17051Treat the register used for PIC addressing as read-only, rather than
17052loading it in the prologue for each function.  The runtime system is
17053responsible for initializing this register with an appropriate value
17054before execution begins.
17055
17056@item -mprioritize-restricted-insns=@var{priority}
17057@opindex mprioritize-restricted-insns
17058This option controls the priority that is assigned to
17059dispatch-slot restricted instructions during the second scheduling
17060pass.  The argument @var{priority} takes the value @var{0/1/2} to assign
17061@var{no/highest/second-highest} priority to dispatch slot restricted
17062instructions.
17063
17064@item -msched-costly-dep=@var{dependence_type}
17065@opindex msched-costly-dep
17066This option controls which dependences are considered costly
17067by the target during instruction scheduling.  The argument
17068@var{dependence_type} takes one of the following values:
17069@var{no}: no dependence is costly,
17070@var{all}: all dependences are costly,
17071@var{true_store_to_load}: a true dependence from store to load is costly,
17072@var{store_to_load}: any dependence from store to load is costly,
17073@var{number}: any dependence for which latency >= @var{number} is costly.
17074
17075@item -minsert-sched-nops=@var{scheme}
17076@opindex minsert-sched-nops
17077This option controls which nop insertion scheme will be used during
17078the second scheduling pass.  The argument @var{scheme} takes one of the
17079following values:
17080@var{no}: Don't insert nops.
17081@var{pad}: Pad with nops any dispatch group that has vacant issue slots,
17082according to the scheduler's grouping.
17083@var{regroup_exact}: Insert nops to force costly dependent insns into
17084separate groups.  Insert exactly as many nops as needed to force an insn
17085to a new group, according to the estimated processor grouping.
17086@var{number}: Insert nops to force costly dependent insns into
17087separate groups.  Insert @var{number} nops to force an insn to a new group.
17088
17089@item -mcall-sysv
17090@opindex mcall-sysv
17091On System V.4 and embedded PowerPC systems compile code using calling
17092conventions that adheres to the March 1995 draft of the System V
17093Application Binary Interface, PowerPC processor supplement.  This is the
17094default unless you configured GCC using @samp{powerpc-*-eabiaix}.
17095
17096@item -mcall-sysv-eabi
17097@itemx -mcall-eabi
17098@opindex mcall-sysv-eabi
17099@opindex mcall-eabi
17100Specify both @option{-mcall-sysv} and @option{-meabi} options.
17101
17102@item -mcall-sysv-noeabi
17103@opindex mcall-sysv-noeabi
17104Specify both @option{-mcall-sysv} and @option{-mno-eabi} options.
17105
17106@item -mcall-aixdesc
17107@opindex m
17108On System V.4 and embedded PowerPC systems compile code for the AIX
17109operating system.
17110
17111@item -mcall-linux
17112@opindex mcall-linux
17113On System V.4 and embedded PowerPC systems compile code for the
17114Linux-based GNU system.
17115
17116@item -mcall-freebsd
17117@opindex mcall-freebsd
17118On System V.4 and embedded PowerPC systems compile code for the
17119FreeBSD operating system.
17120
17121@item -mcall-netbsd
17122@opindex mcall-netbsd
17123On System V.4 and embedded PowerPC systems compile code for the
17124NetBSD operating system.
17125
17126@item -mcall-openbsd
17127@opindex mcall-netbsd
17128On System V.4 and embedded PowerPC systems compile code for the
17129OpenBSD operating system.
17130
17131@item -maix-struct-return
17132@opindex maix-struct-return
17133Return all structures in memory (as specified by the AIX ABI)@.
17134
17135@item -msvr4-struct-return
17136@opindex msvr4-struct-return
17137Return structures smaller than 8 bytes in registers (as specified by the
17138SVR4 ABI)@.
17139
17140@item -mabi=@var{abi-type}
17141@opindex mabi
17142Extend the current ABI with a particular extension, or remove such extension.
17143Valid values are @var{altivec}, @var{no-altivec}, @var{spe},
17144@var{no-spe}, @var{ibmlongdouble}, @var{ieeelongdouble}@.
17145
17146@item -mabi=spe
17147@opindex mabi=spe
17148Extend the current ABI with SPE ABI extensions.  This does not change
17149the default ABI, instead it adds the SPE ABI extensions to the current
17150ABI@.
17151
17152@item -mabi=no-spe
17153@opindex mabi=no-spe
17154Disable Booke SPE ABI extensions for the current ABI@.
17155
17156@item -mabi=ibmlongdouble
17157@opindex mabi=ibmlongdouble
17158Change the current ABI to use IBM extended-precision long double.
17159This is a PowerPC 32-bit SYSV ABI option.
17160
17161@item -mabi=ieeelongdouble
17162@opindex mabi=ieeelongdouble
17163Change the current ABI to use IEEE extended-precision long double.
17164This is a PowerPC 32-bit Linux ABI option.
17165
17166@item -mprototype
17167@itemx -mno-prototype
17168@opindex mprototype
17169@opindex mno-prototype
17170On System V.4 and embedded PowerPC systems assume that all calls to
17171variable argument functions are properly prototyped.  Otherwise, the
17172compiler must insert an instruction before every non prototyped call to
17173set or clear bit 6 of the condition code register (@var{CR}) to
17174indicate whether floating-point values were passed in the floating-point
17175registers in case the function takes variable arguments.  With
17176@option{-mprototype}, only calls to prototyped variable argument functions
17177will set or clear the bit.
17178
17179@item -msim
17180@opindex msim
17181On embedded PowerPC systems, assume that the startup module is called
17182@file{sim-crt0.o} and that the standard C libraries are @file{libsim.a} and
17183@file{libc.a}.  This is the default for @samp{powerpc-*-eabisim}
17184configurations.
17185
17186@item -mmvme
17187@opindex mmvme
17188On embedded PowerPC systems, assume that the startup module is called
17189@file{crt0.o} and the standard C libraries are @file{libmvme.a} and
17190@file{libc.a}.
17191
17192@item -mads
17193@opindex mads
17194On embedded PowerPC systems, assume that the startup module is called
17195@file{crt0.o} and the standard C libraries are @file{libads.a} and
17196@file{libc.a}.
17197
17198@item -myellowknife
17199@opindex myellowknife
17200On embedded PowerPC systems, assume that the startup module is called
17201@file{crt0.o} and the standard C libraries are @file{libyk.a} and
17202@file{libc.a}.
17203
17204@item -mvxworks
17205@opindex mvxworks
17206On System V.4 and embedded PowerPC systems, specify that you are
17207compiling for a VxWorks system.
17208
17209@item -memb
17210@opindex memb
17211On embedded PowerPC systems, set the @var{PPC_EMB} bit in the ELF flags
17212header to indicate that @samp{eabi} extended relocations are used.
17213
17214@item -meabi
17215@itemx -mno-eabi
17216@opindex meabi
17217@opindex mno-eabi
17218On System V.4 and embedded PowerPC systems do (do not) adhere to the
17219Embedded Applications Binary Interface (eabi) which is a set of
17220modifications to the System V.4 specifications.  Selecting @option{-meabi}
17221means that the stack is aligned to an 8-byte boundary, a function
17222@code{__eabi} is called to from @code{main} to set up the eabi
17223environment, and the @option{-msdata} option can use both @code{r2} and
17224@code{r13} to point to two separate small data areas.  Selecting
17225@option{-mno-eabi} means that the stack is aligned to a 16-byte boundary,
17226do not call an initialization function from @code{main}, and the
17227@option{-msdata} option will only use @code{r13} to point to a single
17228small data area.  The @option{-meabi} option is on by default if you
17229configured GCC using one of the @samp{powerpc*-*-eabi*} options.
17230
17231@item -msdata=eabi
17232@opindex msdata=eabi
17233On System V.4 and embedded PowerPC systems, put small initialized
17234@code{const} global and static data in the @samp{.sdata2} section, which
17235is pointed to by register @code{r2}.  Put small initialized
17236non-@code{const} global and static data in the @samp{.sdata} section,
17237which is pointed to by register @code{r13}.  Put small uninitialized
17238global and static data in the @samp{.sbss} section, which is adjacent to
17239the @samp{.sdata} section.  The @option{-msdata=eabi} option is
17240incompatible with the @option{-mrelocatable} option.  The
17241@option{-msdata=eabi} option also sets the @option{-memb} option.
17242
17243@item -msdata=sysv
17244@opindex msdata=sysv
17245On System V.4 and embedded PowerPC systems, put small global and static
17246data in the @samp{.sdata} section, which is pointed to by register
17247@code{r13}.  Put small uninitialized global and static data in the
17248@samp{.sbss} section, which is adjacent to the @samp{.sdata} section.
17249The @option{-msdata=sysv} option is incompatible with the
17250@option{-mrelocatable} option.
17251
17252@item -msdata=default
17253@itemx -msdata
17254@opindex msdata=default
17255@opindex msdata
17256On System V.4 and embedded PowerPC systems, if @option{-meabi} is used,
17257compile code the same as @option{-msdata=eabi}, otherwise compile code the
17258same as @option{-msdata=sysv}.
17259
17260@item -msdata=data
17261@opindex msdata=data
17262On System V.4 and embedded PowerPC systems, put small global
17263data in the @samp{.sdata} section.  Put small uninitialized global
17264data in the @samp{.sbss} section.  Do not use register @code{r13}
17265to address small data however.  This is the default behavior unless
17266other @option{-msdata} options are used.
17267
17268@item -msdata=none
17269@itemx -mno-sdata
17270@opindex msdata=none
17271@opindex mno-sdata
17272On embedded PowerPC systems, put all initialized global and static data
17273in the @samp{.data} section, and all uninitialized data in the
17274@samp{.bss} section.
17275
17276@item -mblock-move-inline-limit=@var{num}
17277@opindex mblock-move-inline-limit
17278Inline all block moves (such as calls to @code{memcpy} or structure
17279copies) less than or equal to @var{num} bytes.  The minimum value for
17280@var{num} is 32 bytes on 32-bit targets and 64 bytes on 64-bit
17281targets.  The default value is target-specific.
17282
17283@item -G @var{num}
17284@opindex G
17285@cindex smaller data references (PowerPC)
17286@cindex .sdata/.sdata2 references (PowerPC)
17287On embedded PowerPC systems, put global and static items less than or
17288equal to @var{num} bytes into the small data or bss sections instead of
17289the normal data or bss section.  By default, @var{num} is 8.  The
17290@option{-G @var{num}} switch is also passed to the linker.
17291All modules should be compiled with the same @option{-G @var{num}} value.
17292
17293@item -mregnames
17294@itemx -mno-regnames
17295@opindex mregnames
17296@opindex mno-regnames
17297On System V.4 and embedded PowerPC systems do (do not) emit register
17298names in the assembly language output using symbolic forms.
17299
17300@item -mlongcall
17301@itemx -mno-longcall
17302@opindex mlongcall
17303@opindex mno-longcall
17304By default assume that all calls are far away so that a longer more
17305expensive calling sequence is required.  This is required for calls
17306further than 32 megabytes (33,554,432 bytes) from the current location.
17307A short call will be generated if the compiler knows
17308the call cannot be that far away.  This setting can be overridden by
17309the @code{shortcall} function attribute, or by @code{#pragma
17310longcall(0)}.
17311
17312Some linkers are capable of detecting out-of-range calls and generating
17313glue code on the fly.  On these systems, long calls are unnecessary and
17314generate slower code.  As of this writing, the AIX linker can do this,
17315as can the GNU linker for PowerPC/64.  It is planned to add this feature
17316to the GNU linker for 32-bit PowerPC systems as well.
17317
17318On Darwin/PPC systems, @code{#pragma longcall} will generate ``jbsr
17319callee, L42'', plus a ``branch island'' (glue code).  The two target
17320addresses represent the callee and the ``branch island''.  The
17321Darwin/PPC linker will prefer the first address and generate a ``bl
17322callee'' if the PPC ``bl'' instruction will reach the callee directly;
17323otherwise, the linker will generate ``bl L42'' to call the ``branch
17324island''.  The ``branch island'' is appended to the body of the
17325calling function; it computes the full 32-bit address of the callee
17326and jumps to it.
17327
17328On Mach-O (Darwin) systems, this option directs the compiler emit to
17329the glue for every direct call, and the Darwin linker decides whether
17330to use or discard it.
17331
17332In the future, we may cause GCC to ignore all longcall specifications
17333when the linker is known to generate glue.
17334
17335@item -mtls-markers
17336@itemx -mno-tls-markers
17337@opindex mtls-markers
17338@opindex mno-tls-markers
17339Mark (do not mark) calls to @code{__tls_get_addr} with a relocation
17340specifying the function argument.  The relocation allows ld to
17341reliably associate function call with argument setup instructions for
17342TLS optimization, which in turn allows gcc to better schedule the
17343sequence.
17344
17345@item -pthread
17346@opindex pthread
17347Adds support for multithreading with the @dfn{pthreads} library.
17348This option sets flags for both the preprocessor and linker.
17349
17350@item -mrecip
17351@itemx -mno-recip
17352@opindex mrecip
17353This option will enable GCC to use the reciprocal estimate and
17354reciprocal square root estimate instructions with additional
17355Newton-Raphson steps to increase precision instead of doing a divide or
17356square root and divide for floating-point arguments.  You should use
17357the @option{-ffast-math} option when using @option{-mrecip} (or at
17358least @option{-funsafe-math-optimizations},
17359@option{-finite-math-only}, @option{-freciprocal-math} and
17360@option{-fno-trapping-math}).  Note that while the throughput of the
17361sequence is generally higher than the throughput of the non-reciprocal
17362instruction, the precision of the sequence can be decreased by up to 2
17363ulp (i.e. the inverse of 1.0 equals 0.99999994) for reciprocal square
17364roots.
17365
17366@item -mrecip=@var{opt}
17367@opindex mrecip=opt
17368This option allows to control which reciprocal estimate instructions
17369may be used.  @var{opt} is a comma separated list of options, which may
17370be preceded by a @code{!} to invert the option:
17371@code{all}: enable all estimate instructions,
17372@code{default}: enable the default instructions, equivalent to @option{-mrecip},
17373@code{none}: disable all estimate instructions, equivalent to @option{-mno-recip};
17374@code{div}: enable the reciprocal approximation instructions for both single and double precision;
17375@code{divf}: enable the single-precision reciprocal approximation instructions;
17376@code{divd}: enable the double-precision reciprocal approximation instructions;
17377@code{rsqrt}: enable the reciprocal square root approximation instructions for both single and double precision;
17378@code{rsqrtf}: enable the single-precision reciprocal square root approximation instructions;
17379@code{rsqrtd}: enable the double-precision reciprocal square root approximation instructions;
17380
17381So for example, @option{-mrecip=all,!rsqrtd} would enable the
17382all of the reciprocal estimate instructions, except for the
17383@code{FRSQRTE}, @code{XSRSQRTEDP}, and @code{XVRSQRTEDP} instructions
17384which handle the double-precision reciprocal square root calculations.
17385
17386@item -mrecip-precision
17387@itemx -mno-recip-precision
17388@opindex mrecip-precision
17389Assume (do not assume) that the reciprocal estimate instructions
17390provide higher-precision estimates than is mandated by the PowerPC
17391ABI.  Selecting @option{-mcpu=power6} or @option{-mcpu=power7}
17392automatically selects @option{-mrecip-precision}.  The double-precision
17393square root estimate instructions are not generated by
17394default on low-precision machines, since they do not provide an
17395estimate that converges after three steps.
17396
17397@item -mveclibabi=@var{type}
17398@opindex mveclibabi
17399Specifies the ABI type to use for vectorizing intrinsics using an
17400external library.  The only type supported at present is @code{mass},
17401which specifies to use IBM's Mathematical Acceleration Subsystem
17402(MASS) libraries for vectorizing intrinsics using external libraries.
17403GCC will currently emit calls to @code{acosd2}, @code{acosf4},
17404@code{acoshd2}, @code{acoshf4}, @code{asind2}, @code{asinf4},
17405@code{asinhd2}, @code{asinhf4}, @code{atan2d2}, @code{atan2f4},
17406@code{atand2}, @code{atanf4}, @code{atanhd2}, @code{atanhf4},
17407@code{cbrtd2}, @code{cbrtf4}, @code{cosd2}, @code{cosf4},
17408@code{coshd2}, @code{coshf4}, @code{erfcd2}, @code{erfcf4},
17409@code{erfd2}, @code{erff4}, @code{exp2d2}, @code{exp2f4},
17410@code{expd2}, @code{expf4}, @code{expm1d2}, @code{expm1f4},
17411@code{hypotd2}, @code{hypotf4}, @code{lgammad2}, @code{lgammaf4},
17412@code{log10d2}, @code{log10f4}, @code{log1pd2}, @code{log1pf4},
17413@code{log2d2}, @code{log2f4}, @code{logd2}, @code{logf4},
17414@code{powd2}, @code{powf4}, @code{sind2}, @code{sinf4}, @code{sinhd2},
17415@code{sinhf4}, @code{sqrtd2}, @code{sqrtf4}, @code{tand2},
17416@code{tanf4}, @code{tanhd2}, and @code{tanhf4} when generating code
17417for power7.  Both @option{-ftree-vectorize} and
17418@option{-funsafe-math-optimizations} have to be enabled.  The MASS
17419libraries will have to be specified at link time.
17420
17421@item -mfriz
17422@itemx -mno-friz
17423@opindex mfriz
17424Generate (do not generate) the @code{friz} instruction when the
17425@option{-funsafe-math-optimizations} option is used to optimize
17426rounding of floating-point values to 64-bit integer and back to floating
17427point.  The @code{friz} instruction does not return the same value if
17428the floating-point number is too large to fit in an integer.
17429
17430@item -mpointers-to-nested-functions
17431@itemx -mno-pointers-to-nested-functions
17432@opindex mpointers-to-nested-functions
17433Generate (do not generate) code to load up the static chain register
17434(@var{r11}) when calling through a pointer on AIX and 64-bit Linux
17435systems where a function pointer points to a 3-word descriptor giving
17436the function address, TOC value to be loaded in register @var{r2}, and
17437static chain value to be loaded in register @var{r11}.  The
17438@option{-mpointers-to-nested-functions} is on by default.  You will
17439not be able to call through pointers to nested functions or pointers
17440to functions compiled in other languages that use the static chain if
17441you use the @option{-mno-pointers-to-nested-functions}.
17442
17443@item -msave-toc-indirect
17444@itemx -mno-save-toc-indirect
17445@opindex msave-toc-indirect
17446Generate (do not generate) code to save the TOC value in the reserved
17447stack location in the function prologue if the function calls through
17448a pointer on AIX and 64-bit Linux systems.  If the TOC value is not
17449saved in the prologue, it is saved just before the call through the
17450pointer.  The @option{-mno-save-toc-indirect} option is the default.
17451@end table
17452
17453@node RX Options
17454@subsection RX Options
17455@cindex RX Options
17456
17457These command-line options are defined for RX targets:
17458
17459@table @gcctabopt
17460@item -m64bit-doubles
17461@itemx -m32bit-doubles
17462@opindex m64bit-doubles
17463@opindex m32bit-doubles
17464Make the @code{double} data type be 64 bits (@option{-m64bit-doubles})
17465or 32 bits (@option{-m32bit-doubles}) in size.  The default is
17466@option{-m32bit-doubles}.  @emph{Note} RX floating-point hardware only
17467works on 32-bit values, which is why the default is
17468@option{-m32bit-doubles}.
17469
17470@item -fpu
17471@itemx -nofpu
17472@opindex fpu
17473@opindex nofpu
17474Enables (@option{-fpu}) or disables (@option{-nofpu}) the use of RX
17475floating-point hardware.  The default is enabled for the @var{RX600}
17476series and disabled for the @var{RX200} series.
17477
17478Floating-point instructions will only be generated for 32-bit floating-point
17479values however, so if the @option{-m64bit-doubles} option is in
17480use then the FPU hardware will not be used for doubles.
17481
17482@emph{Note} If the @option{-fpu} option is enabled then
17483@option{-funsafe-math-optimizations} is also enabled automatically.
17484This is because the RX FPU instructions are themselves unsafe.
17485
17486@item -mcpu=@var{name}
17487@opindex -mcpu
17488Selects the type of RX CPU to be targeted.  Currently three types are
17489supported, the generic @var{RX600} and @var{RX200} series hardware and
17490the specific @var{RX610} CPU.  The default is @var{RX600}.
17491
17492The only difference between @var{RX600} and @var{RX610} is that the
17493@var{RX610} does not support the @code{MVTIPL} instruction.
17494
17495The @var{RX200} series does not have a hardware floating-point unit
17496and so @option{-nofpu} is enabled by default when this type is
17497selected.
17498
17499@item -mbig-endian-data
17500@itemx -mlittle-endian-data
17501@opindex mbig-endian-data
17502@opindex mlittle-endian-data
17503Store data (but not code) in the big-endian format.  The default is
17504@option{-mlittle-endian-data}, i.e.@: to store data in the little-endian
17505format.
17506
17507@item -msmall-data-limit=@var{N}
17508@opindex msmall-data-limit
17509Specifies the maximum size in bytes of global and static variables
17510which can be placed into the small data area.  Using the small data
17511area can lead to smaller and faster code, but the size of area is
17512limited and it is up to the programmer to ensure that the area does
17513not overflow.  Also when the small data area is used one of the RX's
17514registers (usually @code{r13}) is reserved for use pointing to this
17515area, so it is no longer available for use by the compiler.  This
17516could result in slower and/or larger code if variables which once
17517could have been held in the reserved register are now pushed onto the
17518stack.
17519
17520Note, common variables (variables that have not been initialized) and
17521constants are not placed into the small data area as they are assigned
17522to other sections in the output executable.
17523
17524The default value is zero, which disables this feature.  Note, this
17525feature is not enabled by default with higher optimization levels
17526(@option{-O2} etc) because of the potentially detrimental effects of
17527reserving a register.  It is up to the programmer to experiment and
17528discover whether this feature is of benefit to their program.  See the
17529description of the @option{-mpid} option for a description of how the
17530actual register to hold the small data area pointer is chosen.
17531
17532@item -msim
17533@itemx -mno-sim
17534@opindex msim
17535@opindex mno-sim
17536Use the simulator runtime.  The default is to use the libgloss board
17537specific runtime.
17538
17539@item -mas100-syntax
17540@itemx -mno-as100-syntax
17541@opindex mas100-syntax
17542@opindex mno-as100-syntax
17543When generating assembler output use a syntax that is compatible with
17544Renesas's AS100 assembler.  This syntax can also be handled by the GAS
17545assembler but it has some restrictions so generating it is not the
17546default option.
17547
17548@item -mmax-constant-size=@var{N}
17549@opindex mmax-constant-size
17550Specifies the maximum size, in bytes, of a constant that can be used as
17551an operand in a RX instruction.  Although the RX instruction set does
17552allow constants of up to 4 bytes in length to be used in instructions,
17553a longer value equates to a longer instruction.  Thus in some
17554circumstances it can be beneficial to restrict the size of constants
17555that are used in instructions.  Constants that are too big are instead
17556placed into a constant pool and referenced via register indirection.
17557
17558The value @var{N} can be between 0 and 4.  A value of 0 (the default)
17559or 4 means that constants of any size are allowed.
17560
17561@item -mrelax
17562@opindex mrelax
17563Enable linker relaxation.  Linker relaxation is a process whereby the
17564linker will attempt to reduce the size of a program by finding shorter
17565versions of various instructions.  Disabled by default.
17566
17567@item -mint-register=@var{N}
17568@opindex mint-register
17569Specify the number of registers to reserve for fast interrupt handler
17570functions.  The value @var{N} can be between 0 and 4.  A value of 1
17571means that register @code{r13} will be reserved for the exclusive use
17572of fast interrupt handlers.  A value of 2 reserves @code{r13} and
17573@code{r12}.  A value of 3 reserves @code{r13}, @code{r12} and
17574@code{r11}, and a value of 4 reserves @code{r13} through @code{r10}.
17575A value of 0, the default, does not reserve any registers.
17576
17577@item -msave-acc-in-interrupts
17578@opindex msave-acc-in-interrupts
17579Specifies that interrupt handler functions should preserve the
17580accumulator register.  This is only necessary if normal code might use
17581the accumulator register, for example because it performs 64-bit
17582multiplications.  The default is to ignore the accumulator as this
17583makes the interrupt handlers faster.
17584
17585@item -mpid
17586@itemx -mno-pid
17587@opindex mpid
17588@opindex mno-pid
17589Enables the generation of position independent data.  When enabled any
17590access to constant data will done via an offset from a base address
17591held in a register.  This allows the location of constant data to be
17592determined at run time without requiring the executable to be
17593relocated, which is a benefit to embedded applications with tight
17594memory constraints.  Data that can be modified is not affected by this
17595option.
17596
17597Note, using this feature reserves a register, usually @code{r13}, for
17598the constant data base address.  This can result in slower and/or
17599larger code, especially in complicated functions.
17600
17601The actual register chosen to hold the constant data base address
17602depends upon whether the @option{-msmall-data-limit} and/or the
17603@option{-mint-register} command-line options are enabled.  Starting
17604with register @code{r13} and proceeding downwards, registers are
17605allocated first to satisfy the requirements of @option{-mint-register},
17606then @option{-mpid} and finally @option{-msmall-data-limit}.  Thus it
17607is possible for the small data area register to be @code{r8} if both
17608@option{-mint-register=4} and @option{-mpid} are specified on the
17609command line.
17610
17611By default this feature is not enabled.  The default can be restored
17612via the @option{-mno-pid} command-line option.
17613
17614@end table
17615
17616@emph{Note:} The generic GCC command-line option @option{-ffixed-@var{reg}}
17617has special significance to the RX port when used with the
17618@code{interrupt} function attribute.  This attribute indicates a
17619function intended to process fast interrupts.  GCC will will ensure
17620that it only uses the registers @code{r10}, @code{r11}, @code{r12}
17621and/or @code{r13} and only provided that the normal use of the
17622corresponding registers have been restricted via the
17623@option{-ffixed-@var{reg}} or @option{-mint-register} command-line
17624options.
17625
17626@node S/390 and zSeries Options
17627@subsection S/390 and zSeries Options
17628@cindex S/390 and zSeries Options
17629
17630These are the @samp{-m} options defined for the S/390 and zSeries architecture.
17631
17632@table @gcctabopt
17633@item -mhard-float
17634@itemx -msoft-float
17635@opindex mhard-float
17636@opindex msoft-float
17637Use (do not use) the hardware floating-point instructions and registers
17638for floating-point operations.  When @option{-msoft-float} is specified,
17639functions in @file{libgcc.a} will be used to perform floating-point
17640operations.  When @option{-mhard-float} is specified, the compiler
17641generates IEEE floating-point instructions.  This is the default.
17642
17643@item -mhard-dfp
17644@itemx -mno-hard-dfp
17645@opindex mhard-dfp
17646@opindex mno-hard-dfp
17647Use (do not use) the hardware decimal-floating-point instructions for
17648decimal-floating-point operations.  When @option{-mno-hard-dfp} is
17649specified, functions in @file{libgcc.a} will be used to perform
17650decimal-floating-point operations.  When @option{-mhard-dfp} is
17651specified, the compiler generates decimal-floating-point hardware
17652instructions.  This is the default for @option{-march=z9-ec} or higher.
17653
17654@item -mlong-double-64
17655@itemx -mlong-double-128
17656@opindex mlong-double-64
17657@opindex mlong-double-128
17658These switches control the size of @code{long double} type. A size
17659of 64 bits makes the @code{long double} type equivalent to the @code{double}
17660type. This is the default.
17661
17662@item -mbackchain
17663@itemx -mno-backchain
17664@opindex mbackchain
17665@opindex mno-backchain
17666Store (do not store) the address of the caller's frame as backchain pointer
17667into the callee's stack frame.
17668A backchain may be needed to allow debugging using tools that do not understand
17669DWARF-2 call frame information.
17670When @option{-mno-packed-stack} is in effect, the backchain pointer is stored
17671at the bottom of the stack frame; when @option{-mpacked-stack} is in effect,
17672the backchain is placed into the topmost word of the 96/160 byte register
17673save area.
17674
17675In general, code compiled with @option{-mbackchain} is call-compatible with
17676code compiled with @option{-mmo-backchain}; however, use of the backchain
17677for debugging purposes usually requires that the whole binary is built with
17678@option{-mbackchain}.  Note that the combination of @option{-mbackchain},
17679@option{-mpacked-stack} and @option{-mhard-float} is not supported.  In order
17680to build a linux kernel use @option{-msoft-float}.
17681
17682The default is to not maintain the backchain.
17683
17684@item -mpacked-stack
17685@itemx -mno-packed-stack
17686@opindex mpacked-stack
17687@opindex mno-packed-stack
17688Use (do not use) the packed stack layout.  When @option{-mno-packed-stack} is
17689specified, the compiler uses the all fields of the 96/160 byte register save
17690area only for their default purpose; unused fields still take up stack space.
17691When @option{-mpacked-stack} is specified, register save slots are densely
17692packed at the top of the register save area; unused space is reused for other
17693purposes, allowing for more efficient use of the available stack space.
17694However, when @option{-mbackchain} is also in effect, the topmost word of
17695the save area is always used to store the backchain, and the return address
17696register is always saved two words below the backchain.
17697
17698As long as the stack frame backchain is not used, code generated with
17699@option{-mpacked-stack} is call-compatible with code generated with
17700@option{-mno-packed-stack}.  Note that some non-FSF releases of GCC 2.95 for
17701S/390 or zSeries generated code that uses the stack frame backchain at run
17702time, not just for debugging purposes.  Such code is not call-compatible
17703with code compiled with @option{-mpacked-stack}.  Also, note that the
17704combination of @option{-mbackchain},
17705@option{-mpacked-stack} and @option{-mhard-float} is not supported.  In order
17706to build a linux kernel use @option{-msoft-float}.
17707
17708The default is to not use the packed stack layout.
17709
17710@item -msmall-exec
17711@itemx -mno-small-exec
17712@opindex msmall-exec
17713@opindex mno-small-exec
17714Generate (or do not generate) code using the @code{bras} instruction
17715to do subroutine calls.
17716This only works reliably if the total executable size does not
17717exceed 64k.  The default is to use the @code{basr} instruction instead,
17718which does not have this limitation.
17719
17720@item -m64
17721@itemx -m31
17722@opindex m64
17723@opindex m31
17724When @option{-m31} is specified, generate code compliant to the
17725GNU/Linux for S/390 ABI@.  When @option{-m64} is specified, generate
17726code compliant to the GNU/Linux for zSeries ABI@.  This allows GCC in
17727particular to generate 64-bit instructions.  For the @samp{s390}
17728targets, the default is @option{-m31}, while the @samp{s390x}
17729targets default to @option{-m64}.
17730
17731@item -mzarch
17732@itemx -mesa
17733@opindex mzarch
17734@opindex mesa
17735When @option{-mzarch} is specified, generate code using the
17736instructions available on z/Architecture.
17737When @option{-mesa} is specified, generate code using the
17738instructions available on ESA/390.  Note that @option{-mesa} is
17739not possible with @option{-m64}.
17740When generating code compliant to the GNU/Linux for S/390 ABI,
17741the default is @option{-mesa}.  When generating code compliant
17742to the GNU/Linux for zSeries ABI, the default is @option{-mzarch}.
17743
17744@item -mmvcle
17745@itemx -mno-mvcle
17746@opindex mmvcle
17747@opindex mno-mvcle
17748Generate (or do not generate) code using the @code{mvcle} instruction
17749to perform block moves.  When @option{-mno-mvcle} is specified,
17750use a @code{mvc} loop instead.  This is the default unless optimizing for
17751size.
17752
17753@item -mdebug
17754@itemx -mno-debug
17755@opindex mdebug
17756@opindex mno-debug
17757Print (or do not print) additional debug information when compiling.
17758The default is to not print debug information.
17759
17760@item -march=@var{cpu-type}
17761@opindex march
17762Generate code that will run on @var{cpu-type}, which is the name of a system
17763representing a certain processor type.  Possible values for
17764@var{cpu-type} are @samp{g5}, @samp{g6}, @samp{z900}, @samp{z990},
17765@samp{z9-109}, @samp{z9-ec} and @samp{z10}.
17766When generating code using the instructions available on z/Architecture,
17767the default is @option{-march=z900}.  Otherwise, the default is
17768@option{-march=g5}.
17769
17770@item -mtune=@var{cpu-type}
17771@opindex mtune
17772Tune to @var{cpu-type} everything applicable about the generated code,
17773except for the ABI and the set of available instructions.
17774The list of @var{cpu-type} values is the same as for @option{-march}.
17775The default is the value used for @option{-march}.
17776
17777@item -mtpf-trace
17778@itemx -mno-tpf-trace
17779@opindex mtpf-trace
17780@opindex mno-tpf-trace
17781Generate code that adds (does not add) in TPF OS specific branches to trace
17782routines in the operating system.  This option is off by default, even
17783when compiling for the TPF OS@.
17784
17785@item -mfused-madd
17786@itemx -mno-fused-madd
17787@opindex mfused-madd
17788@opindex mno-fused-madd
17789Generate code that uses (does not use) the floating-point multiply and
17790accumulate instructions.  These instructions are generated by default if
17791hardware floating point is used.
17792
17793@item -mwarn-framesize=@var{framesize}
17794@opindex mwarn-framesize
17795Emit a warning if the current function exceeds the given frame size.  Because
17796this is a compile-time check it doesn't need to be a real problem when the program
17797runs.  It is intended to identify functions that most probably cause
17798a stack overflow.  It is useful to be used in an environment with limited stack
17799size e.g.@: the linux kernel.
17800
17801@item -mwarn-dynamicstack
17802@opindex mwarn-dynamicstack
17803Emit a warning if the function calls alloca or uses dynamically
17804sized arrays.  This is generally a bad idea with a limited stack size.
17805
17806@item -mstack-guard=@var{stack-guard}
17807@itemx -mstack-size=@var{stack-size}
17808@opindex mstack-guard
17809@opindex mstack-size
17810If these options are provided the s390 back end emits additional instructions in
17811the function prologue which trigger a trap if the stack size is @var{stack-guard}
17812bytes above the @var{stack-size} (remember that the stack on s390 grows downward).
17813If the @var{stack-guard} option is omitted the smallest power of 2 larger than
17814the frame size of the compiled function is chosen.
17815These options are intended to be used to help debugging stack overflow problems.
17816The additionally emitted code causes only little overhead and hence can also be
17817used in production like systems without greater performance degradation.  The given
17818values have to be exact powers of 2 and @var{stack-size} has to be greater than
17819@var{stack-guard} without exceeding 64k.
17820In order to be efficient the extra code makes the assumption that the stack starts
17821at an address aligned to the value given by @var{stack-size}.
17822The @var{stack-guard} option can only be used in conjunction with @var{stack-size}.
17823@end table
17824
17825@node Score Options
17826@subsection Score Options
17827@cindex Score Options
17828
17829These options are defined for Score implementations:
17830
17831@table @gcctabopt
17832@item -meb
17833@opindex meb
17834Compile code for big-endian mode.  This is the default.
17835
17836@item -mel
17837@opindex mel
17838Compile code for little-endian mode.
17839
17840@item -mnhwloop
17841@opindex mnhwloop
17842Disable generate bcnz instruction.
17843
17844@item -muls
17845@opindex muls
17846Enable generate unaligned load and store instruction.
17847
17848@item -mmac
17849@opindex mmac
17850Enable the use of multiply-accumulate instructions. Disabled by default.
17851
17852@item -mscore5
17853@opindex mscore5
17854Specify the SCORE5 as the target architecture.
17855
17856@item -mscore5u
17857@opindex mscore5u
17858Specify the SCORE5U of the target architecture.
17859
17860@item -mscore7
17861@opindex mscore7
17862Specify the SCORE7 as the target architecture. This is the default.
17863
17864@item -mscore7d
17865@opindex mscore7d
17866Specify the SCORE7D as the target architecture.
17867@end table
17868
17869@node SH Options
17870@subsection SH Options
17871
17872These @samp{-m} options are defined for the SH implementations:
17873
17874@table @gcctabopt
17875@item -m1
17876@opindex m1
17877Generate code for the SH1.
17878
17879@item -m2
17880@opindex m2
17881Generate code for the SH2.
17882
17883@item -m2e
17884Generate code for the SH2e.
17885
17886@item -m2a-nofpu
17887@opindex m2a-nofpu
17888Generate code for the SH2a without FPU, or for a SH2a-FPU in such a way
17889that the floating-point unit is not used.
17890
17891@item -m2a-single-only
17892@opindex m2a-single-only
17893Generate code for the SH2a-FPU, in such a way that no double-precision
17894floating-point operations are used.
17895
17896@item -m2a-single
17897@opindex m2a-single
17898Generate code for the SH2a-FPU assuming the floating-point unit is in
17899single-precision mode by default.
17900
17901@item -m2a
17902@opindex m2a
17903Generate code for the SH2a-FPU assuming the floating-point unit is in
17904double-precision mode by default.
17905
17906@item -m3
17907@opindex m3
17908Generate code for the SH3.
17909
17910@item -m3e
17911@opindex m3e
17912Generate code for the SH3e.
17913
17914@item -m4-nofpu
17915@opindex m4-nofpu
17916Generate code for the SH4 without a floating-point unit.
17917
17918@item -m4-single-only
17919@opindex m4-single-only
17920Generate code for the SH4 with a floating-point unit that only
17921supports single-precision arithmetic.
17922
17923@item -m4-single
17924@opindex m4-single
17925Generate code for the SH4 assuming the floating-point unit is in
17926single-precision mode by default.
17927
17928@item -m4
17929@opindex m4
17930Generate code for the SH4.
17931
17932@item -m4a-nofpu
17933@opindex m4a-nofpu
17934Generate code for the SH4al-dsp, or for a SH4a in such a way that the
17935floating-point unit is not used.
17936
17937@item -m4a-single-only
17938@opindex m4a-single-only
17939Generate code for the SH4a, in such a way that no double-precision
17940floating-point operations are used.
17941
17942@item -m4a-single
17943@opindex m4a-single
17944Generate code for the SH4a assuming the floating-point unit is in
17945single-precision mode by default.
17946
17947@item -m4a
17948@opindex m4a
17949Generate code for the SH4a.
17950
17951@item -m4al
17952@opindex m4al
17953Same as @option{-m4a-nofpu}, except that it implicitly passes
17954@option{-dsp} to the assembler.  GCC doesn't generate any DSP
17955instructions at the moment.
17956
17957@item -mb
17958@opindex mb
17959Compile code for the processor in big-endian mode.
17960
17961@item -ml
17962@opindex ml
17963Compile code for the processor in little-endian mode.
17964
17965@item -mdalign
17966@opindex mdalign
17967Align doubles at 64-bit boundaries.  Note that this changes the calling
17968conventions, and thus some functions from the standard C library will
17969not work unless you recompile it first with @option{-mdalign}.
17970
17971@item -mrelax
17972@opindex mrelax
17973Shorten some address references at link time, when possible; uses the
17974linker option @option{-relax}.
17975
17976@item -mbigtable
17977@opindex mbigtable
17978Use 32-bit offsets in @code{switch} tables.  The default is to use
1797916-bit offsets.
17980
17981@item -mbitops
17982@opindex mbitops
17983Enable the use of bit manipulation instructions on SH2A.
17984
17985@item -mfmovd
17986@opindex mfmovd
17987Enable the use of the instruction @code{fmovd}.  Check @option{-mdalign} for
17988alignment constraints.
17989
17990@item -mhitachi
17991@opindex mhitachi
17992Comply with the calling conventions defined by Renesas.
17993
17994@item -mrenesas
17995@opindex mhitachi
17996Comply with the calling conventions defined by Renesas.
17997
17998@item -mno-renesas
17999@opindex mhitachi
18000Comply with the calling conventions defined for GCC before the Renesas
18001conventions were available.  This option is the default for all
18002targets of the SH toolchain.
18003
18004@item -mnomacsave
18005@opindex mnomacsave
18006Mark the @code{MAC} register as call-clobbered, even if
18007@option{-mhitachi} is given.
18008
18009@item -mieee
18010@item -mno-ieee
18011@opindex mieee
18012@opindex mnoieee
18013Control the IEEE compliance of floating-point comparisons, which affects the
18014handling of cases where the result of a comparison is unordered.  By default
18015@option{-mieee} is implicitly enabled.  If @option{-ffinite-math-only} is
18016enabled @option{-mno-ieee} is implicitly set, which results in faster
18017floating-point greater-equal and less-equal comparisons.  The implcit settings
18018can be overridden by specifying either @option{-mieee} or @option{-mno-ieee}.
18019
18020@item -minline-ic_invalidate
18021@opindex minline-ic_invalidate
18022Inline code to invalidate instruction cache entries after setting up
18023nested function trampolines.
18024This option has no effect if -musermode is in effect and the selected
18025code generation option (e.g. -m4) does not allow the use of the icbi
18026instruction.
18027If the selected code generation option does not allow the use of the icbi
18028instruction, and -musermode is not in effect, the inlined code will
18029manipulate the instruction cache address array directly with an associative
18030write.  This not only requires privileged mode, but it will also
18031fail if the cache line had been mapped via the TLB and has become unmapped.
18032
18033@item -misize
18034@opindex misize
18035Dump instruction size and location in the assembly code.
18036
18037@item -mpadstruct
18038@opindex mpadstruct
18039This option is deprecated.  It pads structures to multiple of 4 bytes,
18040which is incompatible with the SH ABI@.
18041
18042@item -msoft-atomic
18043@opindex msoft-atomic
18044Generate GNU/Linux compatible gUSA software atomic sequences for the atomic
18045built-in functions.  The generated atomic sequences require support from the
18046interrupt / exception handling code of the system and are only suitable for
18047single-core systems.  They will not perform correctly on multi-core systems.
18048This option is enabled by default when the target is @code{sh-*-linux*}.
18049For details on the atomic built-in functions see @ref{__atomic Builtins}.
18050
18051@item -mspace
18052@opindex mspace
18053Optimize for space instead of speed.  Implied by @option{-Os}.
18054
18055@item -mprefergot
18056@opindex mprefergot
18057When generating position-independent code, emit function calls using
18058the Global Offset Table instead of the Procedure Linkage Table.
18059
18060@item -musermode
18061@opindex musermode
18062Don't generate privileged mode only code; implies -mno-inline-ic_invalidate
18063if the inlined code would not work in user mode.
18064This is the default when the target is @code{sh-*-linux*}.
18065
18066@item -multcost=@var{number}
18067@opindex multcost=@var{number}
18068Set the cost to assume for a multiply insn.
18069
18070@item -mdiv=@var{strategy}
18071@opindex mdiv=@var{strategy}
18072Set the division strategy to be used for integer division operations.
18073For SHmedia @var{strategy} can be one of:
18074
18075@table @samp
18076
18077@item fp
18078Performs the operation in floating point.  This has a very high latency,
18079but needs only a few instructions, so it might be a good choice if
18080your code has enough easily-exploitable ILP to allow the compiler to
18081schedule the floating-point instructions together with other instructions.
18082Division by zero causes a floating-point exception.
18083
18084@item inv
18085Uses integer operations to calculate the inverse of the divisor,
18086and then multiplies the dividend with the inverse.  This strategy allows
18087CSE and hoisting of the inverse calculation.  Division by zero calculates
18088an unspecified result, but does not trap.
18089
18090@item inv:minlat
18091A variant of @samp{inv} where, if no CSE or hoisting opportunities
18092have been found, or if the entire operation has been hoisted to the same
18093place, the last stages of the inverse calculation are intertwined with the
18094final multiply to reduce the overall latency, at the expense of using a few
18095more instructions, and thus offering fewer scheduling opportunities with
18096other code.
18097
18098@item call
18099Calls a library function that usually implements the @samp{inv:minlat}
18100strategy.
18101This gives high code density for @code{m5-*media-nofpu} compilations.
18102
18103@item call2
18104Uses a different entry point of the same library function, where it
18105assumes that a pointer to a lookup table has already been set up, which
18106exposes the pointer load to CSE and code hoisting optimizations.
18107
18108@item inv:call
18109@itemx inv:call2
18110@itemx inv:fp
18111Use the @samp{inv} algorithm for initial
18112code generation, but if the code stays unoptimized, revert to the @samp{call},
18113@samp{call2}, or @samp{fp} strategies, respectively.  Note that the
18114potentially-trapping side effect of division by zero is carried by a
18115separate instruction, so it is possible that all the integer instructions
18116are hoisted out, but the marker for the side effect stays where it is.
18117A recombination to floating-point operations or a call is not possible
18118in that case.
18119
18120@item inv20u
18121@itemx inv20l
18122Variants of the @samp{inv:minlat} strategy.  In the case
18123that the inverse calculation is not separated from the multiply, they speed
18124up division where the dividend fits into 20 bits (plus sign where applicable)
18125by inserting a test to skip a number of operations in this case; this test
18126slows down the case of larger dividends.  @samp{inv20u} assumes the case of a such
18127a small dividend to be unlikely, and @samp{inv20l} assumes it to be likely.
18128
18129@end table
18130
18131For targets other than SHmedia @var{strategy} can be one of:
18132
18133@table @samp
18134
18135@item call-div1
18136Calls a library function that uses the single-step division instruction
18137@code{div1} to perform the operation.  Division by zero calculates an
18138unspecified result and does not trap.  This is the default except for SH4,
18139SH2A and SHcompact.
18140
18141@item call-fp
18142Calls a library function that performs the operation in double precision
18143floating point.  Division by zero causes a floating-point exception.  This is
18144the default for SHcompact with FPU.  Specifying this for targets that do not
18145have a double precision FPU will default to @code{call-div1}.
18146
18147@item call-table
18148Calls a library function that uses a lookup table for small divisors and
18149the @code{div1} instruction with case distinction for larger divisors.  Division
18150by zero calculates an unspecified result and does not trap.  This is the default
18151for SH4.  Specifying this for targets that do not have dynamic shift
18152instructions will default to @code{call-div1}.
18153
18154@end table
18155
18156When a division strategy has not been specified the default strategy will be
18157selected based on the current target.  For SH2A the default strategy is to
18158use the @code{divs} and @code{divu} instructions instead of library function
18159calls.
18160
18161@item -maccumulate-outgoing-args
18162@opindex maccumulate-outgoing-args
18163Reserve space once for outgoing arguments in the function prologue rather
18164than around each call.  Generally beneficial for performance and size.  Also
18165needed for unwinding to avoid changing the stack frame around conditional code.
18166
18167@item -mdivsi3_libfunc=@var{name}
18168@opindex mdivsi3_libfunc=@var{name}
18169Set the name of the library function used for 32-bit signed division to
18170@var{name}.  This only affect the name used in the call and inv:call
18171division strategies, and the compiler will still expect the same
18172sets of input/output/clobbered registers as if this option was not present.
18173
18174@item -mfixed-range=@var{register-range}
18175@opindex mfixed-range
18176Generate code treating the given register range as fixed registers.
18177A fixed register is one that the register allocator can not use.  This is
18178useful when compiling kernel code.  A register range is specified as
18179two registers separated by a dash.  Multiple register ranges can be
18180specified separated by a comma.
18181
18182@item -madjust-unroll
18183@opindex madjust-unroll
18184Throttle unrolling to avoid thrashing target registers.
18185This option only has an effect if the gcc code base supports the
18186TARGET_ADJUST_UNROLL_MAX target hook.
18187
18188@item -mindexed-addressing
18189@opindex mindexed-addressing
18190Enable the use of the indexed addressing mode for SHmedia32/SHcompact.
18191This is only safe if the hardware and/or OS implement 32-bit wrap-around
18192semantics for the indexed addressing mode.  The architecture allows the
18193implementation of processors with 64-bit MMU, which the OS could use to
18194get 32-bit addressing, but since no current hardware implementation supports
18195this or any other way to make the indexed addressing mode safe to use in
18196the 32-bit ABI, the default is @option{-mno-indexed-addressing}.
18197
18198@item -mgettrcost=@var{number}
18199@opindex mgettrcost=@var{number}
18200Set the cost assumed for the gettr instruction to @var{number}.
18201The default is 2 if @option{-mpt-fixed} is in effect, 100 otherwise.
18202
18203@item -mpt-fixed
18204@opindex mpt-fixed
18205Assume pt* instructions won't trap.  This will generally generate better
18206scheduled code, but is unsafe on current hardware.  The current architecture
18207definition says that ptabs and ptrel trap when the target anded with 3 is 3.
18208This has the unintentional effect of making it unsafe to schedule ptabs /
18209ptrel before a branch, or hoist it out of a loop.  For example,
18210__do_global_ctors, a part of libgcc that runs constructors at program
18211startup, calls functions in a list which is delimited by @minus{}1.  With the
18212-mpt-fixed option, the ptabs will be done before testing against @minus{}1.
18213That means that all the constructors will be run a bit quicker, but when
18214the loop comes to the end of the list, the program crashes because ptabs
18215loads @minus{}1 into a target register.  Since this option is unsafe for any
18216hardware implementing the current architecture specification, the default
18217is -mno-pt-fixed.  Unless the user specifies a specific cost with
18218@option{-mgettrcost}, -mno-pt-fixed also implies @option{-mgettrcost=100};
18219this deters register allocation using target registers for storing
18220ordinary integers.
18221
18222@item -minvalid-symbols
18223@opindex minvalid-symbols
18224Assume symbols might be invalid.  Ordinary function symbols generated by
18225the compiler will always be valid to load with movi/shori/ptabs or
18226movi/shori/ptrel, but with assembler and/or linker tricks it is possible
18227to generate symbols that will cause ptabs / ptrel to trap.
18228This option is only meaningful when @option{-mno-pt-fixed} is in effect.
18229It will then prevent cross-basic-block cse, hoisting and most scheduling
18230of symbol loads.  The default is @option{-mno-invalid-symbols}.
18231
18232@item -mbranch-cost=@var{num}
18233@opindex mbranch-cost=@var{num}
18234Assume @var{num} to be the cost for a branch instruction.  Higher numbers
18235will make the compiler try to generate more branch-free code if possible.
18236If not specified the value is selected depending on the processor type that
18237is being compiled for.
18238
18239@item -mcbranchdi
18240@opindex mcbranchdi
18241Enable the @code{cbranchdi4} instruction pattern.
18242
18243@item -mcmpeqdi
18244@opindex mcmpeqdi
18245Emit the @code{cmpeqdi_t} instruction pattern even when @option{-mcbranchdi}
18246is in effect.
18247
18248@item -mfused-madd
18249@opindex mfused-madd
18250Allow the usage of the @code{fmac} instruction (floating-point
18251multiply-accumulate) if the processor type supports it.  Enabling this
18252option might generate code that produces different numeric floating-point
18253results compared to strict IEEE 754 arithmetic.
18254
18255@item -mpretend-cmove
18256@opindex mpretend-cmove
18257Prefer zero-displacement conditional branches for conditional move instruction
18258patterns.  This can result in faster code on the SH4 processor.
18259
18260@end table
18261
18262@node Solaris 2 Options
18263@subsection Solaris 2 Options
18264@cindex Solaris 2 options
18265
18266These @samp{-m} options are supported on Solaris 2:
18267
18268@table @gcctabopt
18269@item -mimpure-text
18270@opindex mimpure-text
18271@option{-mimpure-text}, used in addition to @option{-shared}, tells
18272the compiler to not pass @option{-z text} to the linker when linking a
18273shared object.  Using this option, you can link position-dependent
18274code into a shared object.
18275
18276@option{-mimpure-text} suppresses the ``relocations remain against
18277allocatable but non-writable sections'' linker error message.
18278However, the necessary relocations will trigger copy-on-write, and the
18279shared object is not actually shared across processes.  Instead of
18280using @option{-mimpure-text}, you should compile all source code with
18281@option{-fpic} or @option{-fPIC}.
18282
18283@end table
18284
18285These switches are supported in addition to the above on Solaris 2:
18286
18287@table @gcctabopt
18288@item -pthreads
18289@opindex pthreads
18290Add support for multithreading using the POSIX threads library.  This
18291option sets flags for both the preprocessor and linker.  This option does
18292not affect the thread safety of object code produced  by the compiler or
18293that of libraries supplied with it.
18294
18295@item -pthread
18296@opindex pthread
18297This is a synonym for @option{-pthreads}.
18298@end table
18299
18300@node SPARC Options
18301@subsection SPARC Options
18302@cindex SPARC options
18303
18304These @samp{-m} options are supported on the SPARC:
18305
18306@table @gcctabopt
18307@item -mno-app-regs
18308@itemx -mapp-regs
18309@opindex mno-app-regs
18310@opindex mapp-regs
18311Specify @option{-mapp-regs} to generate output using the global registers
183122 through 4, which the SPARC SVR4 ABI reserves for applications.  Like the
18313global register 1, each global register 2 through 4 is then treated as an
18314allocable register that is clobbered by function calls.  This is the default.
18315
18316To be fully SVR4 ABI compliant at the cost of some performance loss,
18317specify @option{-mno-app-regs}.  You should compile libraries and system
18318software with this option.
18319
18320@item -mflat
18321@itemx -mno-flat
18322@opindex mflat
18323@opindex mno-flat
18324With @option{-mflat}, the compiler does not generate save/restore instructions
18325and uses a ``flat'' or single register window model.  This model is compatible
18326with the regular register window model.  The local registers and the input
18327registers (0--5) are still treated as ``call-saved'' registers and will be
18328saved on the stack as needed.
18329
18330With @option{-mno-flat} (the default), the compiler generates save/restore
18331instructions (except for leaf functions).  This is the normal operating mode.
18332
18333@item -mfpu
18334@itemx -mhard-float
18335@opindex mfpu
18336@opindex mhard-float
18337Generate output containing floating-point instructions.  This is the
18338default.
18339
18340@item -mno-fpu
18341@itemx -msoft-float
18342@opindex mno-fpu
18343@opindex msoft-float
18344Generate output containing library calls for floating point.
18345@strong{Warning:} the requisite libraries are not available for all SPARC
18346targets.  Normally the facilities of the machine's usual C compiler are
18347used, but this cannot be done directly in cross-compilation.  You must make
18348your own arrangements to provide suitable library functions for
18349cross-compilation.  The embedded targets @samp{sparc-*-aout} and
18350@samp{sparclite-*-*} do provide software floating-point support.
18351
18352@option{-msoft-float} changes the calling convention in the output file;
18353therefore, it is only useful if you compile @emph{all} of a program with
18354this option.  In particular, you need to compile @file{libgcc.a}, the
18355library that comes with GCC, with @option{-msoft-float} in order for
18356this to work.
18357
18358@item -mhard-quad-float
18359@opindex mhard-quad-float
18360Generate output containing quad-word (long double) floating-point
18361instructions.
18362
18363@item -msoft-quad-float
18364@opindex msoft-quad-float
18365Generate output containing library calls for quad-word (long double)
18366floating-point instructions.  The functions called are those specified
18367in the SPARC ABI@.  This is the default.
18368
18369As of this writing, there are no SPARC implementations that have hardware
18370support for the quad-word floating-point instructions.  They all invoke
18371a trap handler for one of these instructions, and then the trap handler
18372emulates the effect of the instruction.  Because of the trap handler overhead,
18373this is much slower than calling the ABI library routines.  Thus the
18374@option{-msoft-quad-float} option is the default.
18375
18376@item -mno-unaligned-doubles
18377@itemx -munaligned-doubles
18378@opindex mno-unaligned-doubles
18379@opindex munaligned-doubles
18380Assume that doubles have 8-byte alignment.  This is the default.
18381
18382With @option{-munaligned-doubles}, GCC assumes that doubles have 8-byte
18383alignment only if they are contained in another type, or if they have an
18384absolute address.  Otherwise, it assumes they have 4-byte alignment.
18385Specifying this option avoids some rare compatibility problems with code
18386generated by other compilers.  It is not the default because it results
18387in a performance loss, especially for floating-point code.
18388
18389@item -mno-faster-structs
18390@itemx -mfaster-structs
18391@opindex mno-faster-structs
18392@opindex mfaster-structs
18393With @option{-mfaster-structs}, the compiler assumes that structures
18394should have 8-byte alignment.  This enables the use of pairs of
18395@code{ldd} and @code{std} instructions for copies in structure
18396assignment, in place of twice as many @code{ld} and @code{st} pairs.
18397However, the use of this changed alignment directly violates the SPARC
18398ABI@.  Thus, it's intended only for use on targets where the developer
18399acknowledges that their resulting code will not be directly in line with
18400the rules of the ABI@.
18401
18402@item -mcpu=@var{cpu_type}
18403@opindex mcpu
18404Set the instruction set, register set, and instruction scheduling parameters
18405for machine type @var{cpu_type}.  Supported values for @var{cpu_type} are
18406@samp{v7}, @samp{cypress}, @samp{v8}, @samp{supersparc}, @samp{hypersparc},
18407@samp{leon}, @samp{sparclite}, @samp{f930}, @samp{f934}, @samp{sparclite86x},
18408@samp{sparclet}, @samp{tsc701}, @samp{v9}, @samp{ultrasparc},
18409@samp{ultrasparc3}, @samp{niagara}, @samp{niagara2}, @samp{niagara3},
18410and @samp{niagara4}.
18411
18412Native Solaris and GNU/Linux toolchains also support the value @samp{native},
18413which selects the best architecture option for the host processor.
18414@option{-mcpu=native} has no effect if GCC does not recognize
18415the processor.
18416
18417Default instruction scheduling parameters are used for values that select
18418an architecture and not an implementation.  These are @samp{v7}, @samp{v8},
18419@samp{sparclite}, @samp{sparclet}, @samp{v9}.
18420
18421Here is a list of each supported architecture and their supported
18422implementations.
18423
18424@table @asis
18425@item v7
18426cypress
18427
18428@item v8
18429supersparc, hypersparc, leon
18430
18431@item sparclite
18432f930, f934, sparclite86x
18433
18434@item sparclet
18435tsc701
18436
18437@item v9
18438ultrasparc, ultrasparc3, niagara, niagara2, niagara3, niagara4
18439@end table
18440
18441By default (unless configured otherwise), GCC generates code for the V7
18442variant of the SPARC architecture.  With @option{-mcpu=cypress}, the compiler
18443additionally optimizes it for the Cypress CY7C602 chip, as used in the
18444SPARCStation/SPARCServer 3xx series.  This is also appropriate for the older
18445SPARCStation 1, 2, IPX etc.
18446
18447With @option{-mcpu=v8}, GCC generates code for the V8 variant of the SPARC
18448architecture.  The only difference from V7 code is that the compiler emits
18449the integer multiply and integer divide instructions which exist in SPARC-V8
18450but not in SPARC-V7.  With @option{-mcpu=supersparc}, the compiler additionally
18451optimizes it for the SuperSPARC chip, as used in the SPARCStation 10, 1000 and
184522000 series.
18453
18454With @option{-mcpu=sparclite}, GCC generates code for the SPARClite variant of
18455the SPARC architecture.  This adds the integer multiply, integer divide step
18456and scan (@code{ffs}) instructions which exist in SPARClite but not in SPARC-V7.
18457With @option{-mcpu=f930}, the compiler additionally optimizes it for the
18458Fujitsu MB86930 chip, which is the original SPARClite, with no FPU@.  With
18459@option{-mcpu=f934}, the compiler additionally optimizes it for the Fujitsu
18460MB86934 chip, which is the more recent SPARClite with FPU@.
18461
18462With @option{-mcpu=sparclet}, GCC generates code for the SPARClet variant of
18463the SPARC architecture.  This adds the integer multiply, multiply/accumulate,
18464integer divide step and scan (@code{ffs}) instructions which exist in SPARClet
18465but not in SPARC-V7.  With @option{-mcpu=tsc701}, the compiler additionally
18466optimizes it for the TEMIC SPARClet chip.
18467
18468With @option{-mcpu=v9}, GCC generates code for the V9 variant of the SPARC
18469architecture.  This adds 64-bit integer and floating-point move instructions,
184703 additional floating-point condition code registers and conditional move
18471instructions.  With @option{-mcpu=ultrasparc}, the compiler additionally
18472optimizes it for the Sun UltraSPARC I/II/IIi chips.  With
18473@option{-mcpu=ultrasparc3}, the compiler additionally optimizes it for the
18474Sun UltraSPARC III/III+/IIIi/IIIi+/IV/IV+ chips.  With
18475@option{-mcpu=niagara}, the compiler additionally optimizes it for
18476Sun UltraSPARC T1 chips.  With @option{-mcpu=niagara2}, the compiler
18477additionally optimizes it for Sun UltraSPARC T2 chips. With
18478@option{-mcpu=niagara3}, the compiler additionally optimizes it for Sun
18479UltraSPARC T3 chips.  With @option{-mcpu=niagara4}, the compiler
18480additionally optimizes it for Sun UltraSPARC T4 chips.
18481
18482@item -mtune=@var{cpu_type}
18483@opindex mtune
18484Set the instruction scheduling parameters for machine type
18485@var{cpu_type}, but do not set the instruction set or register set that the
18486option @option{-mcpu=@var{cpu_type}} would.
18487
18488The same values for @option{-mcpu=@var{cpu_type}} can be used for
18489@option{-mtune=@var{cpu_type}}, but the only useful values are those
18490that select a particular CPU implementation.  Those are @samp{cypress},
18491@samp{supersparc}, @samp{hypersparc}, @samp{leon}, @samp{f930}, @samp{f934},
18492@samp{sparclite86x}, @samp{tsc701}, @samp{ultrasparc}, @samp{ultrasparc3},
18493@samp{niagara}, @samp{niagara2}, @samp{niagara3} and @samp{niagara4}.  With
18494native Solaris and GNU/Linux toolchains, @samp{native} can also be used.
18495
18496@item -mv8plus
18497@itemx -mno-v8plus
18498@opindex mv8plus
18499@opindex mno-v8plus
18500With @option{-mv8plus}, GCC generates code for the SPARC-V8+ ABI@.  The
18501difference from the V8 ABI is that the global and out registers are
18502considered 64 bits wide.  This is enabled by default on Solaris in 32-bit
18503mode for all SPARC-V9 processors.
18504
18505@item -mvis
18506@itemx -mno-vis
18507@opindex mvis
18508@opindex mno-vis
18509With @option{-mvis}, GCC generates code that takes advantage of the UltraSPARC
18510Visual Instruction Set extensions.  The default is @option{-mno-vis}.
18511
18512@item -mvis2
18513@itemx -mno-vis2
18514@opindex mvis2
18515@opindex mno-vis2
18516With @option{-mvis2}, GCC generates code that takes advantage of
18517version 2.0 of the UltraSPARC Visual Instruction Set extensions.  The
18518default is @option{-mvis2} when targetting a cpu that supports such
18519instructions, such as UltraSPARC-III and later.  Setting @option{-mvis2}
18520also sets @option{-mvis}.
18521
18522@item -mvis3
18523@itemx -mno-vis3
18524@opindex mvis3
18525@opindex mno-vis3
18526With @option{-mvis3}, GCC generates code that takes advantage of
18527version 3.0 of the UltraSPARC Visual Instruction Set extensions.  The
18528default is @option{-mvis3} when targetting a cpu that supports such
18529instructions, such as niagara-3 and later.  Setting @option{-mvis3}
18530also sets @option{-mvis2} and @option{-mvis}.
18531
18532@item -mpopc
18533@itemx -mno-popc
18534@opindex mpopc
18535@opindex mno-popc
18536With @option{-mpopc}, GCC generates code that takes advantage of the UltraSPARC
18537population count instruction.  The default is @option{-mpopc}
18538when targetting a cpu that supports such instructions, such as Niagara-2 and
18539later.
18540
18541@item -mfmaf
18542@itemx -mno-fmaf
18543@opindex mfmaf
18544@opindex mno-fmaf
18545With @option{-mfmaf}, GCC generates code that takes advantage of the UltraSPARC
18546Fused Multiply-Add Floating-point extensions.  The default is @option{-mfmaf}
18547when targetting a cpu that supports such instructions, such as Niagara-3 and
18548later.
18549
18550@item -mfix-at697f
18551@opindex mfix-at697f
18552Enable the documented workaround for the single erratum of the Atmel AT697F
18553processor (which corresponds to erratum #13 of the AT697E processor).
18554@end table
18555
18556These @samp{-m} options are supported in addition to the above
18557on SPARC-V9 processors in 64-bit environments:
18558
18559@table @gcctabopt
18560@item -m32
18561@itemx -m64
18562@opindex m32
18563@opindex m64
18564Generate code for a 32-bit or 64-bit environment.
18565The 32-bit environment sets int, long and pointer to 32 bits.
18566The 64-bit environment sets int to 32 bits and long and pointer
18567to 64 bits.
18568
18569@item -mcmodel=@var{which}
18570@opindex mcmodel
18571Set the code model to one of
18572
18573@table @samp
18574@item medlow
18575The Medium/Low code model: 64-bit addresses, programs
18576must be linked in the low 32 bits of memory.  Programs can be statically
18577or dynamically linked.
18578
18579@item medmid
18580The Medium/Middle code model: 64-bit addresses, programs
18581must be linked in the low 44 bits of memory, the text and data segments must
18582be less than 2GB in size and the data segment must be located within 2GB of
18583the text segment.
18584
18585@item medany
18586The Medium/Anywhere code model: 64-bit addresses, programs
18587may be linked anywhere in memory, the text and data segments must be less
18588than 2GB in size and the data segment must be located within 2GB of the
18589text segment.
18590
18591@item embmedany
18592The Medium/Anywhere code model for embedded systems:
1859364-bit addresses, the text and data segments must be less than 2GB in
18594size, both starting anywhere in memory (determined at link time).  The
18595global register %g4 points to the base of the data segment.  Programs
18596are statically linked and PIC is not supported.
18597@end table
18598
18599@item -mmemory-model=@var{mem-model}
18600@opindex mmemory-model
18601Set the memory model in force on the processor to one of
18602
18603@table @samp
18604@item default
18605The default memory model for the processor and operating system.
18606
18607@item rmo
18608Relaxed Memory Order
18609
18610@item pso
18611Partial Store Order
18612
18613@item tso
18614Total Store Order
18615
18616@item sc
18617Sequential Consistency
18618@end table
18619
18620These memory models are formally defined in Appendix D of the Sparc V9
18621architecture manual, as set in the processor's @code{PSTATE.MM} field.
18622
18623@item -mstack-bias
18624@itemx -mno-stack-bias
18625@opindex mstack-bias
18626@opindex mno-stack-bias
18627With @option{-mstack-bias}, GCC assumes that the stack pointer, and
18628frame pointer if present, are offset by @minus{}2047 which must be added back
18629when making stack frame references.  This is the default in 64-bit mode.
18630Otherwise, assume no such offset is present.
18631@end table
18632
18633@node SPU Options
18634@subsection SPU Options
18635@cindex SPU options
18636
18637These @samp{-m} options are supported on the SPU:
18638
18639@table @gcctabopt
18640@item -mwarn-reloc
18641@itemx -merror-reloc
18642@opindex mwarn-reloc
18643@opindex merror-reloc
18644
18645The loader for SPU does not handle dynamic relocations.  By default, GCC
18646will give an error when it generates code that requires a dynamic
18647relocation.  @option{-mno-error-reloc} disables the error,
18648@option{-mwarn-reloc} will generate a warning instead.
18649
18650@item -msafe-dma
18651@itemx -munsafe-dma
18652@opindex msafe-dma
18653@opindex munsafe-dma
18654
18655Instructions that initiate or test completion of DMA must not be
18656reordered with respect to loads and stores of the memory that is being
18657accessed.  Users typically address this problem using the volatile
18658keyword, but that can lead to inefficient code in places where the
18659memory is known to not change.  Rather than mark the memory as volatile
18660we treat the DMA instructions as potentially effecting all memory.  With
18661@option{-munsafe-dma} users must use the volatile keyword to protect
18662memory accesses.
18663
18664@item -mbranch-hints
18665@opindex mbranch-hints
18666
18667By default, GCC will generate a branch hint instruction to avoid
18668pipeline stalls for always taken or probably taken branches.  A hint
18669will not be generated closer than 8 instructions away from its branch.
18670There is little reason to disable them, except for debugging purposes,
18671or to make an object a little bit smaller.
18672
18673@item -msmall-mem
18674@itemx -mlarge-mem
18675@opindex msmall-mem
18676@opindex mlarge-mem
18677
18678By default, GCC generates code assuming that addresses are never larger
18679than 18 bits.  With @option{-mlarge-mem} code is generated that assumes
18680a full 32-bit address.
18681
18682@item -mstdmain
18683@opindex mstdmain
18684
18685By default, GCC links against startup code that assumes the SPU-style
18686main function interface (which has an unconventional parameter list).
18687With @option{-mstdmain}, GCC will link your program against startup
18688code that assumes a C99-style interface to @code{main}, including a
18689local copy of @code{argv} strings.
18690
18691@item -mfixed-range=@var{register-range}
18692@opindex mfixed-range
18693Generate code treating the given register range as fixed registers.
18694A fixed register is one that the register allocator can not use.  This is
18695useful when compiling kernel code.  A register range is specified as
18696two registers separated by a dash.  Multiple register ranges can be
18697specified separated by a comma.
18698
18699@item -mea32
18700@itemx -mea64
18701@opindex mea32
18702@opindex mea64
18703Compile code assuming that pointers to the PPU address space accessed
18704via the @code{__ea} named address space qualifier are either 32 or 64
18705bits wide.  The default is 32 bits.  As this is an ABI changing option,
18706all object code in an executable must be compiled with the same setting.
18707
18708@item -maddress-space-conversion
18709@itemx -mno-address-space-conversion
18710@opindex maddress-space-conversion
18711@opindex mno-address-space-conversion
18712Allow/disallow treating the @code{__ea} address space as superset
18713of the generic address space.  This enables explicit type casts
18714between @code{__ea} and generic pointer as well as implicit
18715conversions of generic pointers to @code{__ea} pointers.  The
18716default is to allow address space pointer conversions.
18717
18718@item -mcache-size=@var{cache-size}
18719@opindex mcache-size
18720This option controls the version of libgcc that the compiler links to an
18721executable and selects a software-managed cache for accessing variables
18722in the @code{__ea} address space with a particular cache size.  Possible
18723options for @var{cache-size} are @samp{8}, @samp{16}, @samp{32}, @samp{64}
18724and @samp{128}.  The default cache size is 64KB.
18725
18726@item -matomic-updates
18727@itemx -mno-atomic-updates
18728@opindex matomic-updates
18729@opindex mno-atomic-updates
18730This option controls the version of libgcc that the compiler links to an
18731executable and selects whether atomic updates to the software-managed
18732cache of PPU-side variables are used.  If you use atomic updates, changes
18733to a PPU variable from SPU code using the @code{__ea} named address space
18734qualifier will not interfere with changes to other PPU variables residing
18735in the same cache line from PPU code.  If you do not use atomic updates,
18736such interference may occur; however, writing back cache lines will be
18737more efficient.  The default behavior is to use atomic updates.
18738
18739@item -mdual-nops
18740@itemx -mdual-nops=@var{n}
18741@opindex mdual-nops
18742By default, GCC will insert nops to increase dual issue when it expects
18743it to increase performance.  @var{n} can be a value from 0 to 10.  A
18744smaller @var{n} will insert fewer nops.  10 is the default, 0 is the
18745same as @option{-mno-dual-nops}.  Disabled with @option{-Os}.
18746
18747@item -mhint-max-nops=@var{n}
18748@opindex mhint-max-nops
18749Maximum number of nops to insert for a branch hint.  A branch hint must
18750be at least 8 instructions away from the branch it is effecting.  GCC
18751will insert up to @var{n} nops to enforce this, otherwise it will not
18752generate the branch hint.
18753
18754@item -mhint-max-distance=@var{n}
18755@opindex mhint-max-distance
18756The encoding of the branch hint instruction limits the hint to be within
18757256 instructions of the branch it is effecting.  By default, GCC makes
18758sure it is within 125.
18759
18760@item -msafe-hints
18761@opindex msafe-hints
18762Work around a hardware bug that causes the SPU to stall indefinitely.
18763By default, GCC will insert the @code{hbrp} instruction to make sure
18764this stall won't happen.
18765
18766@end table
18767
18768@node System V Options
18769@subsection Options for System V
18770
18771These additional options are available on System V Release 4 for
18772compatibility with other compilers on those systems:
18773
18774@table @gcctabopt
18775@item -G
18776@opindex G
18777Create a shared object.
18778It is recommended that @option{-symbolic} or @option{-shared} be used instead.
18779
18780@item -Qy
18781@opindex Qy
18782Identify the versions of each tool used by the compiler, in a
18783@code{.ident} assembler directive in the output.
18784
18785@item -Qn
18786@opindex Qn
18787Refrain from adding @code{.ident} directives to the output file (this is
18788the default).
18789
18790@item -YP,@var{dirs}
18791@opindex YP
18792Search the directories @var{dirs}, and no others, for libraries
18793specified with @option{-l}.
18794
18795@item -Ym,@var{dir}
18796@opindex Ym
18797Look in the directory @var{dir} to find the M4 preprocessor.
18798The assembler uses this option.
18799@c This is supposed to go with a -Yd for predefined M4 macro files, but
18800@c the generic assembler that comes with Solaris takes just -Ym.
18801@end table
18802
18803@node TILE-Gx Options
18804@subsection TILE-Gx Options
18805@cindex TILE-Gx options
18806
18807These @samp{-m} options are supported on the TILE-Gx:
18808
18809@table @gcctabopt
18810@item -mcpu=@var{name}
18811@opindex mcpu
18812Selects the type of CPU to be targeted.  Currently the only supported
18813type is @samp{tilegx}.
18814
18815@item -m32
18816@itemx -m64
18817@opindex m32
18818@opindex m64
18819Generate code for a 32-bit or 64-bit environment.  The 32-bit
18820environment sets int, long, and pointer to 32 bits.  The 64-bit
18821environment sets int to 32 bits and long and pointer to 64 bits.
18822@end table
18823
18824@node TILEPro Options
18825@subsection TILEPro Options
18826@cindex TILEPro options
18827
18828These @samp{-m} options are supported on the TILEPro:
18829
18830@table @gcctabopt
18831@item -mcpu=@var{name}
18832@opindex mcpu
18833Selects the type of CPU to be targeted.  Currently the only supported
18834type is @samp{tilepro}.
18835
18836@item -m32
18837@opindex m32
18838Generate code for a 32-bit environment, which sets int, long, and
18839pointer to 32 bits.  This is the only supported behavior so the flag
18840is essentially ignored.
18841@end table
18842
18843@node V850 Options
18844@subsection V850 Options
18845@cindex V850 Options
18846
18847These @samp{-m} options are defined for V850 implementations:
18848
18849@table @gcctabopt
18850@item -mlong-calls
18851@itemx -mno-long-calls
18852@opindex mlong-calls
18853@opindex mno-long-calls
18854Treat all calls as being far away (near).  If calls are assumed to be
18855far away, the compiler will always load the functions address up into a
18856register, and call indirect through the pointer.
18857
18858@item -mno-ep
18859@itemx -mep
18860@opindex mno-ep
18861@opindex mep
18862Do not optimize (do optimize) basic blocks that use the same index
18863pointer 4 or more times to copy pointer into the @code{ep} register, and
18864use the shorter @code{sld} and @code{sst} instructions.  The @option{-mep}
18865option is on by default if you optimize.
18866
18867@item -mno-prolog-function
18868@itemx -mprolog-function
18869@opindex mno-prolog-function
18870@opindex mprolog-function
18871Do not use (do use) external functions to save and restore registers
18872at the prologue and epilogue of a function.  The external functions
18873are slower, but use less code space if more than one function saves
18874the same number of registers.  The @option{-mprolog-function} option
18875is on by default if you optimize.
18876
18877@item -mspace
18878@opindex mspace
18879Try to make the code as small as possible.  At present, this just turns
18880on the @option{-mep} and @option{-mprolog-function} options.
18881
18882@item -mtda=@var{n}
18883@opindex mtda
18884Put static or global variables whose size is @var{n} bytes or less into
18885the tiny data area that register @code{ep} points to.  The tiny data
18886area can hold up to 256 bytes in total (128 bytes for byte references).
18887
18888@item -msda=@var{n}
18889@opindex msda
18890Put static or global variables whose size is @var{n} bytes or less into
18891the small data area that register @code{gp} points to.  The small data
18892area can hold up to 64 kilobytes.
18893
18894@item -mzda=@var{n}
18895@opindex mzda
18896Put static or global variables whose size is @var{n} bytes or less into
18897the first 32 kilobytes of memory.
18898
18899@item -mv850
18900@opindex mv850
18901Specify that the target processor is the V850.
18902
18903@item -mbig-switch
18904@opindex mbig-switch
18905Generate code suitable for big switch tables.  Use this option only if
18906the assembler/linker complain about out of range branches within a switch
18907table.
18908
18909@item -mapp-regs
18910@opindex mapp-regs
18911This option will cause r2 and r5 to be used in the code generated by
18912the compiler.  This setting is the default.
18913
18914@item -mno-app-regs
18915@opindex mno-app-regs
18916This option will cause r2 and r5 to be treated as fixed registers.
18917
18918@item -mv850e2v3
18919@opindex mv850e2v3
18920Specify that the target processor is the V850E2V3.  The preprocessor
18921constants @samp{__v850e2v3__} will be defined if
18922this option is used.
18923
18924@item -mv850e2
18925@opindex mv850e2
18926Specify that the target processor is the V850E2.  The preprocessor
18927constants @samp{__v850e2__} will be defined if this option is used.
18928
18929@item -mv850e1
18930@opindex mv850e1
18931Specify that the target processor is the V850E1.  The preprocessor
18932constants @samp{__v850e1__} and @samp{__v850e__} will be defined if
18933this option is used.
18934
18935@item -mv850es
18936@opindex mv850es
18937Specify that the target processor is the V850ES.  This is an alias for
18938the @option{-mv850e1} option.
18939
18940@item -mv850e
18941@opindex mv850e
18942Specify that the target processor is the V850E@.  The preprocessor
18943constant @samp{__v850e__} will be defined if this option is used.
18944
18945If neither @option{-mv850} nor @option{-mv850e} nor @option{-mv850e1}
18946nor @option{-mv850e2} nor @option{-mv850e2v3}
18947are defined then a default target processor will be chosen and the
18948relevant @samp{__v850*__} preprocessor constant will be defined.
18949
18950The preprocessor constants @samp{__v850} and @samp{__v851__} are always
18951defined, regardless of which processor variant is the target.
18952
18953@item -mdisable-callt
18954@opindex mdisable-callt
18955This option will suppress generation of the CALLT instruction for the
18956v850e, v850e1, v850e2 and v850e2v3 flavors of the v850 architecture.  The default is
18957@option{-mno-disable-callt} which allows the CALLT instruction to be used.
18958
18959@end table
18960
18961@node VAX Options
18962@subsection VAX Options
18963@cindex VAX options
18964
18965These @samp{-m} options are defined for the VAX:
18966
18967@table @gcctabopt
18968@item -munix
18969@opindex munix
18970Do not output certain jump instructions (@code{aobleq} and so on)
18971that the Unix assembler for the VAX cannot handle across long
18972ranges.
18973
18974@item -mgnu
18975@opindex mgnu
18976Do output those jump instructions, on the assumption that you
18977will assemble with the GNU assembler.
18978
18979@item -mg
18980@opindex mg
18981Output code for G-format floating-point numbers instead of D-format.
18982@end table
18983
18984@node VxWorks Options
18985@subsection VxWorks Options
18986@cindex VxWorks Options
18987
18988The options in this section are defined for all VxWorks targets.
18989Options specific to the target hardware are listed with the other
18990options for that target.
18991
18992@table @gcctabopt
18993@item -mrtp
18994@opindex mrtp
18995GCC can generate code for both VxWorks kernels and real time processes
18996(RTPs).  This option switches from the former to the latter.  It also
18997defines the preprocessor macro @code{__RTP__}.
18998
18999@item -non-static
19000@opindex non-static
19001Link an RTP executable against shared libraries rather than static
19002libraries.  The options @option{-static} and @option{-shared} can
19003also be used for RTPs (@pxref{Link Options}); @option{-static}
19004is the default.
19005
19006@item -Bstatic
19007@itemx -Bdynamic
19008@opindex Bstatic
19009@opindex Bdynamic
19010These options are passed down to the linker.  They are defined for
19011compatibility with Diab.
19012
19013@item -Xbind-lazy
19014@opindex Xbind-lazy
19015Enable lazy binding of function calls.  This option is equivalent to
19016@option{-Wl,-z,now} and is defined for compatibility with Diab.
19017
19018@item -Xbind-now
19019@opindex Xbind-now
19020Disable lazy binding of function calls.  This option is the default and
19021is defined for compatibility with Diab.
19022@end table
19023
19024@node x86-64 Options
19025@subsection x86-64 Options
19026@cindex x86-64 options
19027
19028These are listed under @xref{i386 and x86-64 Options}.
19029
19030@node Xstormy16 Options
19031@subsection Xstormy16 Options
19032@cindex Xstormy16 Options
19033
19034These options are defined for Xstormy16:
19035
19036@table @gcctabopt
19037@item -msim
19038@opindex msim
19039Choose startup files and linker script suitable for the simulator.
19040@end table
19041
19042@node Xtensa Options
19043@subsection Xtensa Options
19044@cindex Xtensa Options
19045
19046These options are supported for Xtensa targets:
19047
19048@table @gcctabopt
19049@item -mconst16
19050@itemx -mno-const16
19051@opindex mconst16
19052@opindex mno-const16
19053Enable or disable use of @code{CONST16} instructions for loading
19054constant values.  The @code{CONST16} instruction is currently not a
19055standard option from Tensilica.  When enabled, @code{CONST16}
19056instructions are always used in place of the standard @code{L32R}
19057instructions.  The use of @code{CONST16} is enabled by default only if
19058the @code{L32R} instruction is not available.
19059
19060@item -mfused-madd
19061@itemx -mno-fused-madd
19062@opindex mfused-madd
19063@opindex mno-fused-madd
19064Enable or disable use of fused multiply/add and multiply/subtract
19065instructions in the floating-point option.  This has no effect if the
19066floating-point option is not also enabled.  Disabling fused multiply/add
19067and multiply/subtract instructions forces the compiler to use separate
19068instructions for the multiply and add/subtract operations.  This may be
19069desirable in some cases where strict IEEE 754-compliant results are
19070required: the fused multiply add/subtract instructions do not round the
19071intermediate result, thereby producing results with @emph{more} bits of
19072precision than specified by the IEEE standard.  Disabling fused multiply
19073add/subtract instructions also ensures that the program output is not
19074sensitive to the compiler's ability to combine multiply and add/subtract
19075operations.
19076
19077@item -mserialize-volatile
19078@itemx -mno-serialize-volatile
19079@opindex mserialize-volatile
19080@opindex mno-serialize-volatile
19081When this option is enabled, GCC inserts @code{MEMW} instructions before
19082@code{volatile} memory references to guarantee sequential consistency.
19083The default is @option{-mserialize-volatile}.  Use
19084@option{-mno-serialize-volatile} to omit the @code{MEMW} instructions.
19085
19086@item -mforce-no-pic
19087@opindex mforce-no-pic
19088For targets, like GNU/Linux, where all user-mode Xtensa code must be
19089position-independent code (PIC), this option disables PIC for compiling
19090kernel code.
19091
19092@item -mtext-section-literals
19093@itemx -mno-text-section-literals
19094@opindex mtext-section-literals
19095@opindex mno-text-section-literals
19096Control the treatment of literal pools.  The default is
19097@option{-mno-text-section-literals}, which places literals in a separate
19098section in the output file.  This allows the literal pool to be placed
19099in a data RAM/ROM, and it also allows the linker to combine literal
19100pools from separate object files to remove redundant literals and
19101improve code size.  With @option{-mtext-section-literals}, the literals
19102are interspersed in the text section in order to keep them as close as
19103possible to their references.  This may be necessary for large assembly
19104files.
19105
19106@item -mtarget-align
19107@itemx -mno-target-align
19108@opindex mtarget-align
19109@opindex mno-target-align
19110When this option is enabled, GCC instructs the assembler to
19111automatically align instructions to reduce branch penalties at the
19112expense of some code density.  The assembler attempts to widen density
19113instructions to align branch targets and the instructions following call
19114instructions.  If there are not enough preceding safe density
19115instructions to align a target, no widening will be performed.  The
19116default is @option{-mtarget-align}.  These options do not affect the
19117treatment of auto-aligned instructions like @code{LOOP}, which the
19118assembler will always align, either by widening density instructions or
19119by inserting no-op instructions.
19120
19121@item -mlongcalls
19122@itemx -mno-longcalls
19123@opindex mlongcalls
19124@opindex mno-longcalls
19125When this option is enabled, GCC instructs the assembler to translate
19126direct calls to indirect calls unless it can determine that the target
19127of a direct call is in the range allowed by the call instruction.  This
19128translation typically occurs for calls to functions in other source
19129files.  Specifically, the assembler translates a direct @code{CALL}
19130instruction into an @code{L32R} followed by a @code{CALLX} instruction.
19131The default is @option{-mno-longcalls}.  This option should be used in
19132programs where the call target can potentially be out of range.  This
19133option is implemented in the assembler, not the compiler, so the
19134assembly code generated by GCC will still show direct call
19135instructions---look at the disassembled object code to see the actual
19136instructions.  Note that the assembler will use an indirect call for
19137every cross-file call, not just those that really will be out of range.
19138@end table
19139
19140@node zSeries Options
19141@subsection zSeries Options
19142@cindex zSeries options
19143
19144These are listed under @xref{S/390 and zSeries Options}.
19145
19146@node Code Gen Options
19147@section Options for Code Generation Conventions
19148@cindex code generation conventions
19149@cindex options, code generation
19150@cindex run-time options
19151
19152These machine-independent options control the interface conventions
19153used in code generation.
19154
19155Most of them have both positive and negative forms; the negative form
19156of @option{-ffoo} would be @option{-fno-foo}.  In the table below, only
19157one of the forms is listed---the one that is not the default.  You
19158can figure out the other form by either removing @samp{no-} or adding
19159it.
19160
19161@table @gcctabopt
19162@item -fbounds-check
19163@opindex fbounds-check
19164For front ends that support it, generate additional code to check that
19165indices used to access arrays are within the declared range.  This is
19166currently only supported by the Java and Fortran front ends, where
19167this option defaults to true and false respectively.
19168
19169@item -ftrapv
19170@opindex ftrapv
19171This option generates traps for signed overflow on addition, subtraction,
19172multiplication operations.
19173
19174@item -fwrapv
19175@opindex fwrapv
19176This option instructs the compiler to assume that signed arithmetic
19177overflow of addition, subtraction and multiplication wraps around
19178using twos-complement representation.  This flag enables some optimizations
19179and disables others.  This option is enabled by default for the Java
19180front end, as required by the Java language specification.
19181
19182@item -fexceptions
19183@opindex fexceptions
19184Enable exception handling.  Generates extra code needed to propagate
19185exceptions.  For some targets, this implies GCC will generate frame
19186unwind information for all functions, which can produce significant data
19187size overhead, although it does not affect execution.  If you do not
19188specify this option, GCC will enable it by default for languages like
19189C++ that normally require exception handling, and disable it for
19190languages like C that do not normally require it.  However, you may need
19191to enable this option when compiling C code that needs to interoperate
19192properly with exception handlers written in C++.  You may also wish to
19193disable this option if you are compiling older C++ programs that don't
19194use exception handling.
19195
19196@item -fnon-call-exceptions
19197@opindex fnon-call-exceptions
19198Generate code that allows trapping instructions to throw exceptions.
19199Note that this requires platform-specific runtime support that does
19200not exist everywhere.  Moreover, it only allows @emph{trapping}
19201instructions to throw exceptions, i.e.@: memory references or floating-point
19202instructions.  It does not allow exceptions to be thrown from
19203arbitrary signal handlers such as @code{SIGALRM}.
19204
19205@item -funwind-tables
19206@opindex funwind-tables
19207Similar to @option{-fexceptions}, except that it will just generate any needed
19208static data, but will not affect the generated code in any other way.
19209You will normally not enable this option; instead, a language processor
19210that needs this handling would enable it on your behalf.
19211
19212@item -fasynchronous-unwind-tables
19213@opindex fasynchronous-unwind-tables
19214Generate unwind table in dwarf2 format, if supported by target machine.  The
19215table is exact at each instruction boundary, so it can be used for stack
19216unwinding from asynchronous events (such as debugger or garbage collector).
19217
19218@item -fpcc-struct-return
19219@opindex fpcc-struct-return
19220Return ``short'' @code{struct} and @code{union} values in memory like
19221longer ones, rather than in registers.  This convention is less
19222efficient, but it has the advantage of allowing intercallability between
19223GCC-compiled files and files compiled with other compilers, particularly
19224the Portable C Compiler (pcc).
19225
19226The precise convention for returning structures in memory depends
19227on the target configuration macros.
19228
19229Short structures and unions are those whose size and alignment match
19230that of some integer type.
19231
19232@strong{Warning:} code compiled with the @option{-fpcc-struct-return}
19233switch is not binary compatible with code compiled with the
19234@option{-freg-struct-return} switch.
19235Use it to conform to a non-default application binary interface.
19236
19237@item -freg-struct-return
19238@opindex freg-struct-return
19239Return @code{struct} and @code{union} values in registers when possible.
19240This is more efficient for small structures than
19241@option{-fpcc-struct-return}.
19242
19243If you specify neither @option{-fpcc-struct-return} nor
19244@option{-freg-struct-return}, GCC defaults to whichever convention is
19245standard for the target.  If there is no standard convention, GCC
19246defaults to @option{-fpcc-struct-return}, except on targets where GCC is
19247the principal compiler.  In those cases, we can choose the standard, and
19248we chose the more efficient register return alternative.
19249
19250@strong{Warning:} code compiled with the @option{-freg-struct-return}
19251switch is not binary compatible with code compiled with the
19252@option{-fpcc-struct-return} switch.
19253Use it to conform to a non-default application binary interface.
19254
19255@item -fshort-enums
19256@opindex fshort-enums
19257Allocate to an @code{enum} type only as many bytes as it needs for the
19258declared range of possible values.  Specifically, the @code{enum} type
19259will be equivalent to the smallest integer type that has enough room.
19260
19261@strong{Warning:} the @option{-fshort-enums} switch causes GCC to generate
19262code that is not binary compatible with code generated without that switch.
19263Use it to conform to a non-default application binary interface.
19264
19265@item -fshort-double
19266@opindex fshort-double
19267Use the same size for @code{double} as for @code{float}.
19268
19269@strong{Warning:} the @option{-fshort-double} switch causes GCC to generate
19270code that is not binary compatible with code generated without that switch.
19271Use it to conform to a non-default application binary interface.
19272
19273@item -fshort-wchar
19274@opindex fshort-wchar
19275Override the underlying type for @samp{wchar_t} to be @samp{short
19276unsigned int} instead of the default for the target.  This option is
19277useful for building programs to run under WINE@.
19278
19279@strong{Warning:} the @option{-fshort-wchar} switch causes GCC to generate
19280code that is not binary compatible with code generated without that switch.
19281Use it to conform to a non-default application binary interface.
19282
19283@item -fno-common
19284@opindex fno-common
19285In C code, controls the placement of uninitialized global variables.
19286Unix C compilers have traditionally permitted multiple definitions of
19287such variables in different compilation units by placing the variables
19288in a common block.
19289This is the behavior specified by @option{-fcommon}, and is the default
19290for GCC on most targets.
19291On the other hand, this behavior is not required by ISO C, and on some
19292targets may carry a speed or code size penalty on variable references.
19293The @option{-fno-common} option specifies that the compiler should place
19294uninitialized global variables in the data section of the object file,
19295rather than generating them as common blocks.
19296This has the effect that if the same variable is declared
19297(without @code{extern}) in two different compilations,
19298you will get a multiple-definition error when you link them.
19299In this case, you must compile with @option{-fcommon} instead.
19300Compiling with @option{-fno-common} is useful on targets for which
19301it provides better performance, or if you wish to verify that the
19302program will work on other systems that always treat uninitialized
19303variable declarations this way.
19304
19305@item -fno-ident
19306@opindex fno-ident
19307Ignore the @samp{#ident} directive.
19308
19309@item -finhibit-size-directive
19310@opindex finhibit-size-directive
19311Don't output a @code{.size} assembler directive, or anything else that
19312would cause trouble if the function is split in the middle, and the
19313two halves are placed at locations far apart in memory.  This option is
19314used when compiling @file{crtstuff.c}; you should not need to use it
19315for anything else.
19316
19317@item -fverbose-asm
19318@opindex fverbose-asm
19319Put extra commentary information in the generated assembly code to
19320make it more readable.  This option is generally only of use to those
19321who actually need to read the generated assembly code (perhaps while
19322debugging the compiler itself).
19323
19324@option{-fno-verbose-asm}, the default, causes the
19325extra information to be omitted and is useful when comparing two assembler
19326files.
19327
19328@item -frecord-gcc-switches
19329@opindex frecord-gcc-switches
19330This switch causes the command line that was used to invoke the
19331compiler to be recorded into the object file that is being created.
19332This switch is only implemented on some targets and the exact format
19333of the recording is target and binary file format dependent, but it
19334usually takes the form of a section containing ASCII text.  This
19335switch is related to the @option{-fverbose-asm} switch, but that
19336switch only records information in the assembler output file as
19337comments, so it never reaches the object file.
19338See also @option{-grecord-gcc-switches} for another
19339way of storing compiler options into the object file.
19340
19341@item -fpic
19342@opindex fpic
19343@cindex global offset table
19344@cindex PIC
19345Generate position-independent code (PIC) suitable for use in a shared
19346library, if supported for the target machine.  Such code accesses all
19347constant addresses through a global offset table (GOT)@.  The dynamic
19348loader resolves the GOT entries when the program starts (the dynamic
19349loader is not part of GCC; it is part of the operating system).  If
19350the GOT size for the linked executable exceeds a machine-specific
19351maximum size, you get an error message from the linker indicating that
19352@option{-fpic} does not work; in that case, recompile with @option{-fPIC}
19353instead.  (These maximums are 8k on the SPARC and 32k
19354on the m68k and RS/6000.  The 386 has no such limit.)
19355
19356Position-independent code requires special support, and therefore works
19357only on certain machines.  For the 386, GCC supports PIC for System V
19358but not for the Sun 386i.  Code generated for the IBM RS/6000 is always
19359position-independent.
19360
19361When this flag is set, the macros @code{__pic__} and @code{__PIC__}
19362are defined to 1.
19363
19364@item -fPIC
19365@opindex fPIC
19366If supported for the target machine, emit position-independent code,
19367suitable for dynamic linking and avoiding any limit on the size of the
19368global offset table.  This option makes a difference on the m68k,
19369PowerPC and SPARC@.
19370
19371Position-independent code requires special support, and therefore works
19372only on certain machines.
19373
19374When this flag is set, the macros @code{__pic__} and @code{__PIC__}
19375are defined to 2.
19376
19377@item -fpie
19378@itemx -fPIE
19379@opindex fpie
19380@opindex fPIE
19381These options are similar to @option{-fpic} and @option{-fPIC}, but
19382generated position independent code can be only linked into executables.
19383Usually these options are used when @option{-pie} GCC option will be
19384used during linking.
19385
19386@option{-fpie} and @option{-fPIE} both define the macros
19387@code{__pie__} and @code{__PIE__}.  The macros have the value 1
19388for @option{-fpie} and 2 for @option{-fPIE}.
19389
19390@item -fno-jump-tables
19391@opindex fno-jump-tables
19392Do not use jump tables for switch statements even where it would be
19393more efficient than other code generation strategies.  This option is
19394of use in conjunction with @option{-fpic} or @option{-fPIC} for
19395building code that forms part of a dynamic linker and cannot
19396reference the address of a jump table.  On some targets, jump tables
19397do not require a GOT and this option is not needed.
19398
19399@item -ffixed-@var{reg}
19400@opindex ffixed
19401Treat the register named @var{reg} as a fixed register; generated code
19402should never refer to it (except perhaps as a stack pointer, frame
19403pointer or in some other fixed role).
19404
19405@var{reg} must be the name of a register.  The register names accepted
19406are machine-specific and are defined in the @code{REGISTER_NAMES}
19407macro in the machine description macro file.
19408
19409This flag does not have a negative form, because it specifies a
19410three-way choice.
19411
19412@item -fcall-used-@var{reg}
19413@opindex fcall-used
19414Treat the register named @var{reg} as an allocable register that is
19415clobbered by function calls.  It may be allocated for temporaries or
19416variables that do not live across a call.  Functions compiled this way
19417will not save and restore the register @var{reg}.
19418
19419It is an error to used this flag with the frame pointer or stack pointer.
19420Use of this flag for other registers that have fixed pervasive roles in
19421the machine's execution model will produce disastrous results.
19422
19423This flag does not have a negative form, because it specifies a
19424three-way choice.
19425
19426@item -fcall-saved-@var{reg}
19427@opindex fcall-saved
19428Treat the register named @var{reg} as an allocable register saved by
19429functions.  It may be allocated even for temporaries or variables that
19430live across a call.  Functions compiled this way will save and restore
19431the register @var{reg} if they use it.
19432
19433It is an error to used this flag with the frame pointer or stack pointer.
19434Use of this flag for other registers that have fixed pervasive roles in
19435the machine's execution model will produce disastrous results.
19436
19437A different sort of disaster will result from the use of this flag for
19438a register in which function values may be returned.
19439
19440This flag does not have a negative form, because it specifies a
19441three-way choice.
19442
19443@item -fpack-struct[=@var{n}]
19444@opindex fpack-struct
19445Without a value specified, pack all structure members together without
19446holes.  When a value is specified (which must be a small power of two), pack
19447structure members according to this value, representing the maximum
19448alignment (that is, objects with default alignment requirements larger than
19449this will be output potentially unaligned at the next fitting location.
19450
19451@strong{Warning:} the @option{-fpack-struct} switch causes GCC to generate
19452code that is not binary compatible with code generated without that switch.
19453Additionally, it makes the code suboptimal.
19454Use it to conform to a non-default application binary interface.
19455
19456@item -finstrument-functions
19457@opindex finstrument-functions
19458Generate instrumentation calls for entry and exit to functions.  Just
19459after function entry and just before function exit, the following
19460profiling functions will be called with the address of the current
19461function and its call site.  (On some platforms,
19462@code{__builtin_return_address} does not work beyond the current
19463function, so the call site information may not be available to the
19464profiling functions otherwise.)
19465
19466@smallexample
19467void __cyg_profile_func_enter (void *this_fn,
19468                               void *call_site);
19469void __cyg_profile_func_exit  (void *this_fn,
19470                               void *call_site);
19471@end smallexample
19472
19473The first argument is the address of the start of the current function,
19474which may be looked up exactly in the symbol table.
19475
19476This instrumentation is also done for functions expanded inline in other
19477functions.  The profiling calls will indicate where, conceptually, the
19478inline function is entered and exited.  This means that addressable
19479versions of such functions must be available.  If all your uses of a
19480function are expanded inline, this may mean an additional expansion of
19481code size.  If you use @samp{extern inline} in your C code, an
19482addressable version of such functions must be provided.  (This is
19483normally the case anyways, but if you get lucky and the optimizer always
19484expands the functions inline, you might have gotten away without
19485providing static copies.)
19486
19487A function may be given the attribute @code{no_instrument_function}, in
19488which case this instrumentation will not be done.  This can be used, for
19489example, for the profiling functions listed above, high-priority
19490interrupt routines, and any functions from which the profiling functions
19491cannot safely be called (perhaps signal handlers, if the profiling
19492routines generate output or allocate memory).
19493
19494@item -finstrument-functions-exclude-file-list=@var{file},@var{file},@dots{}
19495@opindex finstrument-functions-exclude-file-list
19496
19497Set the list of functions that are excluded from instrumentation (see
19498the description of @code{-finstrument-functions}).  If the file that
19499contains a function definition matches with one of @var{file}, then
19500that function is not instrumented.  The match is done on substrings:
19501if the @var{file} parameter is a substring of the file name, it is
19502considered to be a match.
19503
19504For example:
19505
19506@smallexample
19507-finstrument-functions-exclude-file-list=/bits/stl,include/sys
19508@end smallexample
19509
19510@noindent
19511will exclude any inline function defined in files whose pathnames
19512contain @code{/bits/stl} or @code{include/sys}.
19513
19514If, for some reason, you want to include letter @code{','} in one of
19515@var{sym}, write @code{'\,'}. For example,
19516@code{-finstrument-functions-exclude-file-list='\,\,tmp'}
19517(note the single quote surrounding the option).
19518
19519@item -finstrument-functions-exclude-function-list=@var{sym},@var{sym},@dots{}
19520@opindex finstrument-functions-exclude-function-list
19521
19522This is similar to @code{-finstrument-functions-exclude-file-list},
19523but this option sets the list of function names to be excluded from
19524instrumentation.  The function name to be matched is its user-visible
19525name, such as @code{vector<int> blah(const vector<int> &)}, not the
19526internal mangled name (e.g., @code{_Z4blahRSt6vectorIiSaIiEE}).  The
19527match is done on substrings: if the @var{sym} parameter is a substring
19528of the function name, it is considered to be a match.  For C99 and C++
19529extended identifiers, the function name must be given in UTF-8, not
19530using universal character names.
19531
19532@item -fstack-check
19533@opindex fstack-check
19534Generate code to verify that you do not go beyond the boundary of the
19535stack.  You should specify this flag if you are running in an
19536environment with multiple threads, but only rarely need to specify it in
19537a single-threaded environment since stack overflow is automatically
19538detected on nearly all systems if there is only one stack.
19539
19540Note that this switch does not actually cause checking to be done; the
19541operating system or the language runtime must do that.  The switch causes
19542generation of code to ensure that they see the stack being extended.
19543
19544You can additionally specify a string parameter: @code{no} means no
19545checking, @code{generic} means force the use of old-style checking,
19546@code{specific} means use the best checking method and is equivalent
19547to bare @option{-fstack-check}.
19548
19549Old-style checking is a generic mechanism that requires no specific
19550target support in the compiler but comes with the following drawbacks:
19551
19552@enumerate
19553@item
19554Modified allocation strategy for large objects: they will always be
19555allocated dynamically if their size exceeds a fixed threshold.
19556
19557@item
19558Fixed limit on the size of the static frame of functions: when it is
19559topped by a particular function, stack checking is not reliable and
19560a warning is issued by the compiler.
19561
19562@item
19563Inefficiency: because of both the modified allocation strategy and the
19564generic implementation, the performances of the code are hampered.
19565@end enumerate
19566
19567Note that old-style stack checking is also the fallback method for
19568@code{specific} if no target support has been added in the compiler.
19569
19570@item -fstack-limit-register=@var{reg}
19571@itemx -fstack-limit-symbol=@var{sym}
19572@itemx -fno-stack-limit
19573@opindex fstack-limit-register
19574@opindex fstack-limit-symbol
19575@opindex fno-stack-limit
19576Generate code to ensure that the stack does not grow beyond a certain value,
19577either the value of a register or the address of a symbol.  If the stack
19578would grow beyond the value, a signal is raised.  For most targets,
19579the signal is raised before the stack overruns the boundary, so
19580it is possible to catch the signal without taking special precautions.
19581
19582For instance, if the stack starts at absolute address @samp{0x80000000}
19583and grows downwards, you can use the flags
19584@option{-fstack-limit-symbol=__stack_limit} and
19585@option{-Wl,--defsym,__stack_limit=0x7ffe0000} to enforce a stack limit
19586of 128KB@.  Note that this may only work with the GNU linker.
19587
19588@item -fsplit-stack
19589@opindex fsplit-stack
19590Generate code to automatically split the stack before it overflows.
19591The resulting program has a discontiguous stack which can only
19592overflow if the program is unable to allocate any more memory.  This
19593is most useful when running threaded programs, as it is no longer
19594necessary to calculate a good stack size to use for each thread.  This
19595is currently only implemented for the i386 and x86_64 back ends running
19596GNU/Linux.
19597
19598When code compiled with @option{-fsplit-stack} calls code compiled
19599without @option{-fsplit-stack}, there may not be much stack space
19600available for the latter code to run.  If compiling all code,
19601including library code, with @option{-fsplit-stack} is not an option,
19602then the linker can fix up these calls so that the code compiled
19603without @option{-fsplit-stack} always has a large stack.  Support for
19604this is implemented in the gold linker in GNU binutils release 2.21
19605and later.
19606
19607@item -fleading-underscore
19608@opindex fleading-underscore
19609This option and its counterpart, @option{-fno-leading-underscore}, forcibly
19610change the way C symbols are represented in the object file.  One use
19611is to help link with legacy assembly code.
19612
19613@strong{Warning:} the @option{-fleading-underscore} switch causes GCC to
19614generate code that is not binary compatible with code generated without that
19615switch.  Use it to conform to a non-default application binary interface.
19616Not all targets provide complete support for this switch.
19617
19618@item -ftls-model=@var{model}
19619@opindex ftls-model
19620Alter the thread-local storage model to be used (@pxref{Thread-Local}).
19621The @var{model} argument should be one of @code{global-dynamic},
19622@code{local-dynamic}, @code{initial-exec} or @code{local-exec}.
19623
19624The default without @option{-fpic} is @code{initial-exec}; with
19625@option{-fpic} the default is @code{global-dynamic}.
19626
19627@item -fvisibility=@var{default|internal|hidden|protected}
19628@opindex fvisibility
19629Set the default ELF image symbol visibility to the specified option---all
19630symbols will be marked with this unless overridden within the code.
19631Using this feature can very substantially improve linking and
19632load times of shared object libraries, produce more optimized
19633code, provide near-perfect API export and prevent symbol clashes.
19634It is @strong{strongly} recommended that you use this in any shared objects
19635you distribute.
19636
19637Despite the nomenclature, @code{default} always means public; i.e.,
19638available to be linked against from outside the shared object.
19639@code{protected} and @code{internal} are pretty useless in real-world
19640usage so the only other commonly used option will be @code{hidden}.
19641The default if @option{-fvisibility} isn't specified is
19642@code{default}, i.e., make every
19643symbol public---this causes the same behavior as previous versions of
19644GCC@.
19645
19646A good explanation of the benefits offered by ensuring ELF
19647symbols have the correct visibility is given by ``How To Write
19648Shared Libraries'' by Ulrich Drepper (which can be found at
19649@w{@uref{http://people.redhat.com/~drepper/}})---however a superior
19650solution made possible by this option to marking things hidden when
19651the default is public is to make the default hidden and mark things
19652public.  This is the norm with DLL's on Windows and with @option{-fvisibility=hidden}
19653and @code{__attribute__ ((visibility("default")))} instead of
19654@code{__declspec(dllexport)} you get almost identical semantics with
19655identical syntax.  This is a great boon to those working with
19656cross-platform projects.
19657
19658For those adding visibility support to existing code, you may find
19659@samp{#pragma GCC visibility} of use.  This works by you enclosing
19660the declarations you wish to set visibility for with (for example)
19661@samp{#pragma GCC visibility push(hidden)} and
19662@samp{#pragma GCC visibility pop}.
19663Bear in mind that symbol visibility should be viewed @strong{as
19664part of the API interface contract} and thus all new code should
19665always specify visibility when it is not the default; i.e., declarations
19666only for use within the local DSO should @strong{always} be marked explicitly
19667as hidden as so to avoid PLT indirection overheads---making this
19668abundantly clear also aids readability and self-documentation of the code.
19669Note that due to ISO C++ specification requirements, operator new and
19670operator delete must always be of default visibility.
19671
19672Be aware that headers from outside your project, in particular system
19673headers and headers from any other library you use, may not be
19674expecting to be compiled with visibility other than the default.  You
19675may need to explicitly say @samp{#pragma GCC visibility push(default)}
19676before including any such headers.
19677
19678@samp{extern} declarations are not affected by @samp{-fvisibility}, so
19679a lot of code can be recompiled with @samp{-fvisibility=hidden} with
19680no modifications.  However, this means that calls to @samp{extern}
19681functions with no explicit visibility will use the PLT, so it is more
19682effective to use @samp{__attribute ((visibility))} and/or
19683@samp{#pragma GCC visibility} to tell the compiler which @samp{extern}
19684declarations should be treated as hidden.
19685
19686Note that @samp{-fvisibility} does affect C++ vague linkage
19687entities. This means that, for instance, an exception class that will
19688be thrown between DSOs must be explicitly marked with default
19689visibility so that the @samp{type_info} nodes will be unified between
19690the DSOs.
19691
19692An overview of these techniques, their benefits and how to use them
19693is at @uref{http://gcc.gnu.org/@/wiki/@/Visibility}.
19694
19695@item -fstrict-volatile-bitfields
19696@opindex fstrict-volatile-bitfields
19697This option should be used if accesses to volatile bit-fields (or other
19698structure fields, although the compiler usually honors those types
19699anyway) should use a single access of the width of the
19700field's type, aligned to a natural alignment if possible.  For
19701example, targets with memory-mapped peripheral registers might require
19702all such accesses to be 16 bits wide; with this flag the user could
19703declare all peripheral bit-fields as ``unsigned short'' (assuming short
19704is 16 bits on these targets) to force GCC to use 16-bit accesses
19705instead of, perhaps, a more efficient 32-bit access.
19706
19707If this option is disabled, the compiler will use the most efficient
19708instruction.  In the previous example, that might be a 32-bit load
19709instruction, even though that will access bytes that do not contain
19710any portion of the bit-field, or memory-mapped registers unrelated to
19711the one being updated.
19712
19713If the target requires strict alignment, and honoring the field
19714type would require violating this alignment, a warning is issued.
19715If the field has @code{packed} attribute, the access is done without
19716honoring the field type.  If the field doesn't have @code{packed}
19717attribute, the access is done honoring the field type.  In both cases,
19718GCC assumes that the user knows something about the target hardware
19719that it is unaware of.
19720
19721The default value of this option is determined by the application binary
19722interface for the target processor.
19723
19724@end table
19725
19726@c man end
19727
19728@node Environment Variables
19729@section Environment Variables Affecting GCC
19730@cindex environment variables
19731
19732@c man begin ENVIRONMENT
19733This section describes several environment variables that affect how GCC
19734operates.  Some of them work by specifying directories or prefixes to use
19735when searching for various kinds of files.  Some are used to specify other
19736aspects of the compilation environment.
19737
19738Note that you can also specify places to search using options such as
19739@option{-B}, @option{-I} and @option{-L} (@pxref{Directory Options}).  These
19740take precedence over places specified using environment variables, which
19741in turn take precedence over those specified by the configuration of GCC@.
19742@xref{Driver,, Controlling the Compilation Driver @file{gcc}, gccint,
19743GNU Compiler Collection (GCC) Internals}.
19744
19745@table @env
19746@item LANG
19747@itemx LC_CTYPE
19748@c @itemx LC_COLLATE
19749@itemx LC_MESSAGES
19750@c @itemx LC_MONETARY
19751@c @itemx LC_NUMERIC
19752@c @itemx LC_TIME
19753@itemx LC_ALL
19754@findex LANG
19755@findex LC_CTYPE
19756@c @findex LC_COLLATE
19757@findex LC_MESSAGES
19758@c @findex LC_MONETARY
19759@c @findex LC_NUMERIC
19760@c @findex LC_TIME
19761@findex LC_ALL
19762@cindex locale
19763These environment variables control the way that GCC uses
19764localization information which allows GCC to work with different
19765national conventions.  GCC inspects the locale categories
19766@env{LC_CTYPE} and @env{LC_MESSAGES} if it has been configured to do
19767so.  These locale categories can be set to any value supported by your
19768installation.  A typical value is @samp{en_GB.UTF-8} for English in the United
19769Kingdom encoded in UTF-8.
19770
19771The @env{LC_CTYPE} environment variable specifies character
19772classification.  GCC uses it to determine the character boundaries in
19773a string; this is needed for some multibyte encodings that contain quote
19774and escape characters that would otherwise be interpreted as a string
19775end or escape.
19776
19777The @env{LC_MESSAGES} environment variable specifies the language to
19778use in diagnostic messages.
19779
19780If the @env{LC_ALL} environment variable is set, it overrides the value
19781of @env{LC_CTYPE} and @env{LC_MESSAGES}; otherwise, @env{LC_CTYPE}
19782and @env{LC_MESSAGES} default to the value of the @env{LANG}
19783environment variable.  If none of these variables are set, GCC
19784defaults to traditional C English behavior.
19785
19786@item TMPDIR
19787@findex TMPDIR
19788If @env{TMPDIR} is set, it specifies the directory to use for temporary
19789files.  GCC uses temporary files to hold the output of one stage of
19790compilation which is to be used as input to the next stage: for example,
19791the output of the preprocessor, which is the input to the compiler
19792proper.
19793
19794@item GCC_COMPARE_DEBUG
19795@findex GCC_COMPARE_DEBUG
19796Setting @env{GCC_COMPARE_DEBUG} is nearly equivalent to passing
19797@option{-fcompare-debug} to the compiler driver.  See the documentation
19798of this option for more details.
19799
19800@item GCC_EXEC_PREFIX
19801@findex GCC_EXEC_PREFIX
19802If @env{GCC_EXEC_PREFIX} is set, it specifies a prefix to use in the
19803names of the subprograms executed by the compiler.  No slash is added
19804when this prefix is combined with the name of a subprogram, but you can
19805specify a prefix that ends with a slash if you wish.
19806
19807If @env{GCC_EXEC_PREFIX} is not set, GCC will attempt to figure out
19808an appropriate prefix to use based on the pathname it was invoked with.
19809
19810If GCC cannot find the subprogram using the specified prefix, it
19811tries looking in the usual places for the subprogram.
19812
19813The default value of @env{GCC_EXEC_PREFIX} is
19814@file{@var{prefix}/lib/gcc/} where @var{prefix} is the prefix to
19815the installed compiler. In many cases @var{prefix} is the value
19816of @code{prefix} when you ran the @file{configure} script.
19817
19818Other prefixes specified with @option{-B} take precedence over this prefix.
19819
19820This prefix is also used for finding files such as @file{crt0.o} that are
19821used for linking.
19822
19823In addition, the prefix is used in an unusual way in finding the
19824directories to search for header files.  For each of the standard
19825directories whose name normally begins with @samp{/usr/local/lib/gcc}
19826(more precisely, with the value of @env{GCC_INCLUDE_DIR}), GCC tries
19827replacing that beginning with the specified prefix to produce an
19828alternate directory name.  Thus, with @option{-Bfoo/}, GCC will search
19829@file{foo/bar} where it would normally search @file{/usr/local/lib/bar}.
19830These alternate directories are searched first; the standard directories
19831come next. If a standard directory begins with the configured
19832@var{prefix} then the value of @var{prefix} is replaced by
19833@env{GCC_EXEC_PREFIX} when looking for header files.
19834
19835@item COMPILER_PATH
19836@findex COMPILER_PATH
19837The value of @env{COMPILER_PATH} is a colon-separated list of
19838directories, much like @env{PATH}.  GCC tries the directories thus
19839specified when searching for subprograms, if it can't find the
19840subprograms using @env{GCC_EXEC_PREFIX}.
19841
19842@item LIBRARY_PATH
19843@findex LIBRARY_PATH
19844The value of @env{LIBRARY_PATH} is a colon-separated list of
19845directories, much like @env{PATH}.  When configured as a native compiler,
19846GCC tries the directories thus specified when searching for special
19847linker files, if it can't find them using @env{GCC_EXEC_PREFIX}.  Linking
19848using GCC also uses these directories when searching for ordinary
19849libraries for the @option{-l} option (but directories specified with
19850@option{-L} come first).
19851
19852@item LANG
19853@findex LANG
19854@cindex locale definition
19855This variable is used to pass locale information to the compiler.  One way in
19856which this information is used is to determine the character set to be used
19857when character literals, string literals and comments are parsed in C and C++.
19858When the compiler is configured to allow multibyte characters,
19859the following values for @env{LANG} are recognized:
19860
19861@table @samp
19862@item C-JIS
19863Recognize JIS characters.
19864@item C-SJIS
19865Recognize SJIS characters.
19866@item C-EUCJP
19867Recognize EUCJP characters.
19868@end table
19869
19870If @env{LANG} is not defined, or if it has some other value, then the
19871compiler will use mblen and mbtowc as defined by the default locale to
19872recognize and translate multibyte characters.
19873@end table
19874
19875@noindent
19876Some additional environments variables affect the behavior of the
19877preprocessor.
19878
19879@include cppenv.texi
19880
19881@c man end
19882
19883@node Precompiled Headers
19884@section Using Precompiled Headers
19885@cindex precompiled headers
19886@cindex speed of compilation
19887
19888Often large projects have many header files that are included in every
19889source file.  The time the compiler takes to process these header files
19890over and over again can account for nearly all of the time required to
19891build the project.  To make builds faster, GCC allows users to
19892`precompile' a header file; then, if builds can use the precompiled
19893header file they will be much faster.
19894
19895To create a precompiled header file, simply compile it as you would any
19896other file, if necessary using the @option{-x} option to make the driver
19897treat it as a C or C++ header file.  You will probably want to use a
19898tool like @command{make} to keep the precompiled header up-to-date when
19899the headers it contains change.
19900
19901A precompiled header file will be searched for when @code{#include} is
19902seen in the compilation.  As it searches for the included file
19903(@pxref{Search Path,,Search Path,cpp,The C Preprocessor}) the
19904compiler looks for a precompiled header in each directory just before it
19905looks for the include file in that directory.  The name searched for is
19906the name specified in the @code{#include} with @samp{.gch} appended.  If
19907the precompiled header file can't be used, it is ignored.
19908
19909For instance, if you have @code{#include "all.h"}, and you have
19910@file{all.h.gch} in the same directory as @file{all.h}, then the
19911precompiled header file will be used if possible, and the original
19912header will be used otherwise.
19913
19914Alternatively, you might decide to put the precompiled header file in a
19915directory and use @option{-I} to ensure that directory is searched
19916before (or instead of) the directory containing the original header.
19917Then, if you want to check that the precompiled header file is always
19918used, you can put a file of the same name as the original header in this
19919directory containing an @code{#error} command.
19920
19921This also works with @option{-include}.  So yet another way to use
19922precompiled headers, good for projects not designed with precompiled
19923header files in mind, is to simply take most of the header files used by
19924a project, include them from another header file, precompile that header
19925file, and @option{-include} the precompiled header.  If the header files
19926have guards against multiple inclusion, they will be skipped because
19927they've already been included (in the precompiled header).
19928
19929If you need to precompile the same header file for different
19930languages, targets, or compiler options, you can instead make a
19931@emph{directory} named like @file{all.h.gch}, and put each precompiled
19932header in the directory, perhaps using @option{-o}.  It doesn't matter
19933what you call the files in the directory, every precompiled header in
19934the directory will be considered.  The first precompiled header
19935encountered in the directory that is valid for this compilation will
19936be used; they're searched in no particular order.
19937
19938There are many other possibilities, limited only by your imagination,
19939good sense, and the constraints of your build system.
19940
19941A precompiled header file can be used only when these conditions apply:
19942
19943@itemize
19944@item
19945Only one precompiled header can be used in a particular compilation.
19946
19947@item
19948A precompiled header can't be used once the first C token is seen.  You
19949can have preprocessor directives before a precompiled header; you can
19950even include a precompiled header from inside another header, so long as
19951there are no C tokens before the @code{#include}.
19952
19953@item
19954The precompiled header file must be produced for the same language as
19955the current compilation.  You can't use a C precompiled header for a C++
19956compilation.
19957
19958@item
19959The precompiled header file must have been produced by the same compiler
19960binary as the current compilation is using.
19961
19962@item
19963Any macros defined before the precompiled header is included must
19964either be defined in the same way as when the precompiled header was
19965generated, or must not affect the precompiled header, which usually
19966means that they don't appear in the precompiled header at all.
19967
19968The @option{-D} option is one way to define a macro before a
19969precompiled header is included; using a @code{#define} can also do it.
19970There are also some options that define macros implicitly, like
19971@option{-O} and @option{-Wdeprecated}; the same rule applies to macros
19972defined this way.
19973
19974@item If debugging information is output when using the precompiled
19975header, using @option{-g} or similar, the same kind of debugging information
19976must have been output when building the precompiled header.  However,
19977a precompiled header built using @option{-g} can be used in a compilation
19978when no debugging information is being output.
19979
19980@item The same @option{-m} options must generally be used when building
19981and using the precompiled header.  @xref{Submodel Options},
19982for any cases where this rule is relaxed.
19983
19984@item Each of the following options must be the same when building and using
19985the precompiled header:
19986
19987@gccoptlist{-fexceptions}
19988
19989@item
19990Some other command-line options starting with @option{-f},
19991@option{-p}, or @option{-O} must be defined in the same way as when
19992the precompiled header was generated.  At present, it's not clear
19993which options are safe to change and which are not; the safest choice
19994is to use exactly the same options when generating and using the
19995precompiled header.  The following are known to be safe:
19996
19997@gccoptlist{-fmessage-length=  -fpreprocessed  -fsched-interblock @gol
19998-fsched-spec  -fsched-spec-load  -fsched-spec-load-dangerous @gol
19999-fsched-verbose=@var{number}  -fschedule-insns  -fvisibility= @gol
20000-pedantic-errors}
20001
20002@end itemize
20003
20004For all of these except the last, the compiler will automatically
20005ignore the precompiled header if the conditions aren't met.  If you
20006find an option combination that doesn't work and doesn't cause the
20007precompiled header to be ignored, please consider filing a bug report,
20008see @ref{Bugs}.
20009
20010If you do use differing options when generating and using the
20011precompiled header, the actual behavior will be a mixture of the
20012behavior for the options.  For instance, if you use @option{-g} to
20013generate the precompiled header but not when using it, you may or may
20014not get debugging information for routines in the precompiled header.
20015